This is a modern-English version of The Coral Island: A Tale of the Pacific Ocean, originally written by Ballantyne, R. M. (Robert Michael). It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling, and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.

Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.

[Illustration]

The Coral Island:
A Tale of the Pacific Ocean

by

by

ROBERT MICHAEL BALLANTYNE,
author ofhudson’s bay; or, every-day life in the wilds of north america;
snow-flakes and sun-beams; or, the young fur-traders;”
ungava: a tale of the esquimaux,” etc., etc.

ROBERT MICHAEL BALLANTYNE,
writer ofHudson's Bay Company; or, Daily Life in the Wilds of North America;
Snowflakes and Sunbeams; or, The Young Fur Traders;”
Ungava: A Story of the Inuit,” etc., etc.

with illustrations by dalziel.

with illustrations by Dalziel.

London:
THOMAS NELSON AND SONS, PATERNOSTER ROW.
edinburgh; and new york.
1884.

London:
THOMAS NELSON AND SONS, PATERNOSTER ROW.
Edinburgh; and NYC.
1884.

Preface

I was a boy when I went through the wonderful adventures herein set down. With the memory of my boyish feelings strong upon me, I present my book specially to boys, in the earnest hope that they may derive valuable information, much pleasure, great profit, and unbounded amusement from its pages.

I was a kid when I went through the amazing adventures described here. With the memories of my youthful feelings fresh in my mind, I present my book especially to boys, hoping they will gain valuable knowledge, a lot of enjoyment, great benefits, and endless fun from its pages.

One word more. If there is any boy or man who loves to be melancholy and morose, and who cannot enter with kindly sympathy into the regions of fun, let me seriously advise him to shut my book and put it away. It is not meant for him.

One more thing. If there’s any boy or man who enjoys being gloomy and sad, and who can’t join in the spirit of fun, I seriously suggest he close my book and put it aside. It’s not meant for him.

RALPH ROVER

RALPH ROVER

CHAPTER I.

The beginning—My early life and character—I thirst for adventure in foreign lands and go to sea.

The beginning—My early life and character—I crave adventure in distant places and set out to sea.

Roving has always been, and still is, my ruling passion, the joy of my heart, the very sunshine of my existence. In childhood, in boyhood, and in man’s estate, I have been a rover; not a mere rambler among the woody glens and upon the hill-tops of my own native land, but an enthusiastic rover throughout the length and breadth of the wide wide world.

Roving has always been, and still is, my main passion, the joy of my heart, the very sunshine of my life. In childhood, in my teenage years, and now as an adult, I've been a wanderer; not just a casual explorer of the forests and hills of my home country, but an eager traveler across the entire globe.

It was a wild, black night of howling storm, the night in which I was born on the foaming bosom of the broad Atlantic Ocean. My father was a sea-captain; my grandfather was a sea-captain; my great-grandfather had been a marine. Nobody could tell positively what occupation his father had followed; but my dear mother used to assert that he had been a midshipman, whose grandfather, on the mother’s side, had been an admiral in the royal navy. At anyrate we knew that, as far back as our family could be traced, it had been intimately connected with the great watery waste. Indeed this was the case on both sides of the house; for my mother always went to sea with my father on his long voyages, and so spent the greater part of her life upon the water.

It was a wild, dark night with a howling storm, the night I was born on the churning waves of the Atlantic Ocean. My dad was a sea captain; my grandfather was a sea captain; my great-grandfather had served in the navy. No one could say for sure what my great-great-grandfather did, but my mom always claimed he had been a midshipman, whose grandfather on her side had been an admiral in the royal navy. In any case, we knew that our family had always been closely connected to the vast ocean. This was true on both sides of the family; my mom always went to sea with my dad on his long voyages, spending most of her life on the water.

Thus it was, I suppose, that I came to inherit a roving disposition. Soon after I was born, my father, being old, retired from a seafaring life, purchased a small cottage in a fishing village on the west coast of England, and settled down to spend the evening of his life on the shores of that sea which had for so many years been his home. It was not long after this that I began to show the roving spirit that dwelt within me. For some time past my infant legs had been gaining strength, so that I came to be dissatisfied with rubbing the skin off my chubby knees by walking on them, and made many attempts to stand up and walk like a man; all of which attempts, however, resulted in my sitting down violently and in sudden surprise. One day I took advantage of my dear mother’s absence to make another effort; and, to my joy, I actually succeeded in reaching the doorstep, over which I tumbled into a pool of muddy water that lay before my father’s cottage door. Ah, how vividly I remember the horror of my poor mother when she found me sweltering in the mud amongst a group of cackling ducks, and the tenderness with which she stripped off my dripping clothes and washed my dirty little body! From this time forth my rambles became more frequent, and, as I grew older, more distant, until at last I had wandered far and near on the shore and in the woods around our humble dwelling, and did not rest content until my father bound me apprentice to a coasting vessel, and let me go to sea.

So, I guess that's how I developed a wandering nature. Shortly after I was born, my father, being older, retired from a life at sea, bought a small cottage in a fishing village on the west coast of England, and settled down to spend his later years by the sea that had been his home for so long. It wasn't long after this that my restless spirit began to show. My baby legs had been getting stronger for a while, so I grew tired of crawling and tried to stand up and walk like a grown-up; but every attempt ended with me sitting down hard, surprised by the fall. One day, while my dear mother was out, I decided to try again; to my delight, I actually made it to the doorstep, but then I fell into a puddle of muddy water right outside my father's cottage. I will never forget the shock on my poor mother's face when she found me floundering in the mud among a bunch of quacking ducks, and how gently she took off my soaked clothes and cleaned up my dirty little body! From then on, my explorations became more frequent, and as I grew older, they took me further away, until I had roamed all over the shore and through the woods surrounding our little home. I was not satisfied until my father officially made me an apprentice on a coasting ship and let me go to sea.

For some years I was happy in visiting the sea-ports, and in coasting along the shores of my native land. My Christian name was Ralph, and my comrades added to this the name of Rover, in consequence of the passion which I always evinced for travelling. Rover was not my real name, but as I never received any other I came at last to answer to it as naturally as to my proper name; and, as it is not a bad one, I see no good reason why I should not introduce myself to the reader as Ralph Rover. My shipmates were kind, good-natured fellows, and they and I got on very well together. They did, indeed, very frequently make game of and banter me, but not unkindly; and I overheard them sometimes saying that Ralph Rover was a “queer, old-fashioned fellow.” This, I must confess, surprised me much, and I pondered the saying long, but could come at no satisfactory conclusion as to that wherein my old-fashionedness lay. It is true I was a quiet lad, and seldom spoke except when spoken to. Moreover, I never could understand the jokes of my companions even when they were explained to me: which dulness in apprehension occasioned me much grief; however, I tried to make up for it by smiling and looking pleased when I observed that they were laughing at some witticism which I had failed to detect. I was also very fond of inquiring into the nature of things and their causes, and often fell into fits of abstraction while thus engaged in my mind. But in all this I saw nothing that did not seem to be exceedingly natural, and could by no means understand why my comrades should call me “an old-fashioned fellow.”

For several years, I enjoyed visiting the ports and sailing along the shores of my home country. My first name is Ralph, and my friends started calling me Rover because of my love for traveling. Rover isn’t my real name, but since I never received another, I eventually responded to it just as naturally as I would to my actual name. Since it's not a bad name, I see no reason not to introduce myself to the reader as Ralph Rover. My shipmates were kind, easygoing guys, and we got along really well. They often teased and joked with me, but not mean-spiritedly. I sometimes heard them say that Ralph Rover was a “weird, old-fashioned guy.” This really surprised me, and I thought about it for a long time, but I couldn't figure out what made me old-fashioned. It's true I was a quiet kid and rarely spoke unless someone talked to me first. Besides, I never understood my friends' jokes, even when they explained them to me, which upset me a lot; nonetheless, I tried to make up for it by smiling and looking happy when I noticed they were laughing at some joke I didn’t get. I also loved asking about how things work and why, and I often got lost in thought while I was doing this. But I didn’t see anything unusual about it, and I just couldn’t understand why my friends called me “an old-fashioned guy.”

Now, while engaged in the coasting trade, I fell in with many seamen who had travelled to almost every quarter of the globe; and I freely confess that my heart glowed ardently within me as they recounted their wild adventures in foreign lands,—the dreadful storms they had weathered, the appalling dangers they had escaped, the wonderful creatures they had seen both on the land and in the sea, and the interesting lands and strange people they had visited. But of all the places of which they told me, none captivated and charmed my imagination so much as the Coral Islands of the Southern Seas. They told me of thousands of beautiful fertile islands that had been formed by a small creature called the coral insect, where summer reigned nearly all the year round,—where the trees were laden with a constant harvest of luxuriant fruit,—where the climate was almost perpetually delightful,—yet where, strange to say, men were wild, bloodthirsty savages, excepting in those favoured isles to which the gospel of our Saviour had been conveyed. These exciting accounts had so great an effect upon my mind, that, when I reached the age of fifteen, I resolved to make a voyage to the South Seas.

While working in coastal trade, I met many sailors who had traveled to almost every part of the world. I honestly admit that my heart swelled with excitement as they shared their thrilling adventures in faraway lands—the terrifying storms they had survived, the incredible dangers they had avoided, the amazing creatures they had encountered both on land and at sea, and the fascinating places and unusual people they had visited. But out of all the places they described, none captured my imagination quite like the Coral Islands of the Southern Seas. They spoke of thousands of beautiful, fertile islands created by tiny creatures called coral insects, where summer lasted nearly all year, where trees were heavy with luscious fruit, and where the weather was almost always perfect. Yet, strangely, the inhabitants were wild, bloodthirsty savages, except in those blessed islands where the teachings of our Savior had reached. These thrilling stories had such a profound impact on me that, by the time I turned fifteen, I decided to embark on a journey to the South Seas.

I had no little difficulty at first in prevailing on my dear parents to let me go; but when I urged on my father that he would never have become a great captain had he remained in the coasting trade, he saw the truth of what I said, and gave his consent. My dear mother, seeing that my father had made up his mind, no longer offered opposition to my wishes. “But oh, Ralph,” she said, on the day I bade her adieu, “come back soon to us, my dear boy, for we are getting old now, Ralph, and may not have many years to live.”

I had quite a bit of trouble at first convincing my dear parents to let me go; but when I pointed out to my father that he would never have become a great captain if he had stayed in the coasting trade, he realized I was right and agreed. My dear mother, seeing that my father had made his decision, stopped opposing my wishes. “But oh, Ralph,” she said on the day I said goodbye, “come back to us soon, my dear boy, because we’re getting older now, Ralph, and we may not have many years left.”

I will not take up my reader’s time with a minute account of all that occurred before I took my final leave of my dear parents. Suffice it to say, that my father placed me under the charge of an old mess-mate of his own, a merchant captain, who was on the point of sailing to the South Seas in his own ship, the Arrow. My mother gave me her blessing and a small Bible; and her last request was, that I would never forget to read a chapter every day, and say my prayers; which I promised, with tears in my eyes, that I would certainly do.

I won't waste my reader's time with a detailed account of everything that happened before I finally said goodbye to my beloved parents. It’s enough to say that my dad put me in the care of an old friend of his, a merchant captain who was about to set sail to the South Seas on his ship, the Arrow. My mom gave me her blessing and a small Bible; her last request was that I would always remember to read a chapter every day and say my prayers. I promised, with tears in my eyes, that I would definitely do that.

Soon afterwards I went on board the Arrow, which was a fine large ship, and set sail for the islands of the Pacific Ocean.

Soon after, I boarded the Arrow, which was a big, impressive ship, and we set sail for the islands of the Pacific Ocean.

CHAPTER II.

The departure—The sea—My companions—Some account of the wonderful sights we saw on the great deep—A dreadful storm and a frightful wreck.

The departure—The sea—My friends—Some description of the amazing sights we experienced on the vast ocean—A terrible storm and a horrifying shipwreck.

It was a bright, beautiful, warm day when our ship spread her canvass to the breeze, and sailed for the regions of the south. Oh, how my heart bounded with delight as I listened to the merry chorus of the sailors, while they hauled at the ropes and got in the anchor! The captain shouted—the men ran to obey—the noble ship bent over to the breeze, and the shore gradually faded from my view, while I stood looking on with a kind of feeling that the whole was a delightful dream.

It was a bright, beautiful, warm day when our ship caught the wind in her sails and set off for the southern regions. Oh, how my heart soared with joy as I listened to the cheerful singing of the sailors while they pulled on the ropes and brought in the anchor! The captain shouted—the crew rushed to follow orders—the proud ship leaned into the breeze, and the shore slowly disappeared from my sight, as I watched with a sense that it was all a wonderful dream.

The first thing that struck me as being different from anything I had yet seen during my short career on the sea, was the hoisting of the anchor on deck, and lashing it firmly down with ropes, as if we had now bid adieu to the land for ever, and would require its services no more.

The first thing that caught my attention as being different from anything I had seen so far in my brief career at sea was the raising of the anchor onto the deck and securing it tightly with ropes, as if we had now said goodbye to the land forever and wouldn't need its help anymore.

“There, lass,” cried a broad-shouldered jack-tar, giving the fluke of the anchor a hearty slap with his hand after the housing was completed—“there, lass, take a good nap now, for we shan’t ask you to kiss the mud again for many a long day to come!”

“There, girl,” shouted a sturdy sailor, giving the tail of the anchor a solid smack with his hand after the housing was finished—“there, girl, go ahead and take a good nap now, because we won’t make you kiss the mud again for a long time!”

And so it was. That anchor did not “kiss the mud” for many long days afterwards; and when at last it did, it was for the last time!

And that's how it went. That anchor didn't "touch the ground" for many long days after; and when it finally did, it was for the last time!

There were a number of boys in the ship, but two of them were my special favourites. Jack Martin was a tall, strapping, broad-shouldered youth of eighteen, with a handsome, good-humoured, firm face. He had had a good education, was clever and hearty and lion-like in his actions, but mild and quiet in disposition. Jack was a general favourite, and had a peculiar fondness for me. My other companion was Peterkin Gay. He was little, quick, funny, decidedly mischievous, and about fourteen years old. But Peterkin’s mischief was almost always harmless, else he could not have been so much beloved as he was.

There were a bunch of boys on the ship, but two of them were my favorites. Jack Martin was a tall, strong, broad-shouldered guy of eighteen, with a handsome, cheerful, strong face. He had a good education, was smart and hearty, and acted like a lion, but was mild and quiet by nature. Jack was a general favorite and had a special fondness for me. My other friend was Peterkin Gay. He was small, quick, funny, definitely mischievous, and about fourteen years old. But Peterkin’s mischief was almost always harmless; otherwise, he wouldn’t have been so well-liked.

“Hallo! youngster,” cried Jack Martin, giving me a slap on the shoulder, the day I joined the ship, “come below and I’ll show you your berth. You and I are to be mess-mates, and I think we shall be good friends, for I like the look o’ you.”

“Hey there, kid,” shouted Jack Martin, giving me a slap on the shoulder the day I joined the ship. “Come below and I’ll show you your bunk. You and I are going to be mess-mates, and I think we’ll be good friends because I like the way you look.”

Jack was right. He and I and Peterkin afterwards became the best and stanchest friends that ever tossed together on the stormy waves.

Jack was right. He, Peterkin, and I later became the best and most loyal friends who ever navigated the stormy seas together.

I shall say little about the first part of our voyage. We had the usual amount of rough weather and calm; also we saw many strange fish rolling in the sea, and I was greatly delighted one day by seeing a shoal of flying fish dart out of the water and skim through the air about a foot above the surface. They were pursued by dolphins, which feed on them, and one flying-fish in its terror flew over the ship, struck on the rigging, and fell upon the deck. Its wings were just fins elongated, and we found that they could never fly far at a time, and never mounted into the air like birds, but skimmed along the surface of the sea. Jack and I had it for dinner, and found it remarkably good.

I won’t say much about the first part of our journey. We experienced the usual mix of rough weather and calm; plus, we spotted many unusual fish rolling in the sea. One day, I was really excited to see a school of flying fish jump out of the water and glide through the air about a foot above the surface. They were being chased by dolphins that feed on them, and one terrified flying fish flew over the ship, hit the rigging, and landed on the deck. Its wings were just elongated fins, and we discovered they couldn't fly far at a time, nor did they soar into the air like birds, but rather skimmed along the surface of the sea. Jack and I had it for dinner, and we found it surprisingly tasty.

When we approached Cape Horn, at the southern extremity of America, the weather became very cold and stormy, and the sailors began to tell stories about the furious gales and the dangers of that terrible cape.

When we got close to Cape Horn, at the southern tip of America, the weather turned really cold and stormy, and the sailors started sharing tales about the fierce winds and the dangers of that dreadful cape.

“Cape Horn,” said one, “is the most horrible headland I ever doubled. I’ve sailed round it twice already, and both times the ship was a’most blow’d out o’ the water.”

“Cape Horn,” one person said, “is the most terrifying headland I’ve ever rounded. I’ve sailed around it twice already, and both times the ship was nearly blown out of the water.”

“An’ I’ve been round it once,” said another, “an’ that time the sails were split, and the ropes frozen in the blocks, so that they wouldn’t work, and we wos all but lost.”

“Yeah, I’ve been through it once,” said another, “and that time the sails were ripped, and the ropes were frozen in the pulleys, so they wouldn’t move, and we were almost lost.”

“An’ I’ve been round it five times,” cried a third, “an’ every time wos wuss than another, the gales wos so tree-mendous!”

“An’ I’ve been around it five times,” cried a third, “and every time was worse than the last, the winds were so tremendous!”

“And I’ve been round it no times at all,” cried Peterkin, with an impudent wink of his eye, “an’ that time I wos blow’d inside out!”

“And I’ve been around it zero times,” cried Peterkin, with a cheeky wink, “and that time I was blown inside out!”

Nevertheless, we passed the dreaded cape without much rough weather, and, in the course of a few weeks afterwards, were sailing gently, before a warm tropical breeze, over the Pacific Ocean. Thus we proceeded on our voyage, sometimes bounding merrily before a fair breeze, at other times floating calmly on the glassy wave and fishing for the curious inhabitants of the deep,—all of which, although the sailors thought little of them, were strange, and interesting, and very wonderful to me.

Nevertheless, we rounded the feared cape without encountering much bad weather, and a few weeks later, we were sailing smoothly in a warm tropical breeze over the Pacific Ocean. We continued on our journey, sometimes racing happily with a good wind, other times drifting gently on the calm water and fishing for the fascinating creatures of the deep—each of which, although the sailors didn't think much of them, was strange, interesting, and truly amazing to me.

At last we came among the Coral Islands of the Pacific, and I shall never forget the delight with which I gazed,—when we chanced to pass one,—at the pure, white, dazzling shores, and the verdant palm-trees, which looked bright and beautiful in the sunshine. And often did we three long to be landed on one, imagining that we should certainly find perfect happiness there! Our wish was granted sooner than we expected.

At last, we arrived at the Coral Islands of the Pacific, and I'll never forget how thrilled I was when we happened to pass one. The pure, white, dazzling shores and the lush palm trees looked bright and beautiful in the sunlight. We often wished to set foot on one, imagining that we would surely find perfect happiness there! Our wish came true sooner than we expected.

One night, soon after we entered the tropics, an awful storm burst upon our ship. The first squall of wind carried away two of our masts; and left only the foremast standing. Even this, however, was more than enough, for we did not dare to hoist a rag of sail on it. For five days the tempest raged in all its fury. Everything was swept off the decks except one small boat. The steersman was lashed to the wheel, lest he should be washed away, and we all gave ourselves up for lost. The captain said that he had no idea where we were, as we had been blown far out of our course; and we feared much that we might get among the dangerous coral reefs which are so numerous in the Pacific. At day-break on the sixth morning of the gale we saw land ahead. It was an island encircled by a reef of coral on which the waves broke in fury. There was calm water within this reef, but we could only see one narrow opening into it. For this opening we steered, but, ere we reached it, a tremendous wave broke on our stern, tore the rudder completely off, and left us at the mercy of the winds and waves.

One night, shortly after we entered the tropics, a terrible storm hit our ship. The first gust of wind knocked down two of our masts, leaving only the foremast upright. Even that was more than we could handle, as we didn't dare to raise a scrap of sail on it. For five days, the storm raged with all its might. Everything was swept off the decks except for one small boat. The helmsman was tied to the wheel to prevent being washed away, and we all resigned ourselves to our fate. The captain said he had no idea where we were since we had been blown far off course, and we feared we might drift into the dangerous coral reefs that are so common in the Pacific. At dawn on the sixth morning of the storm, we saw land ahead. It was an island surrounded by a coral reef where the waves crashed violently. There was calm water inside the reef, but we could only see one narrow opening. We aimed for that opening, but before we could reach it, a massive wave crashed against our stern, completely tore off the rudder, and left us at the mercy of the winds and waves.

“It’s all over with us now, lads,” said the captain to the men; “get the boat ready to launch; we shall be on the rocks in less than half an hour.”

“It’s all over for us now, guys,” said the captain to the crew; “get the boat ready to launch; we’ll be on the rocks in less than half an hour.”

The men obeyed in gloomy silence, for they felt that there was little hope of so small a boat living in such a sea.

The men followed orders in silence, feeling that there was little chance of such a small boat surviving in those rough waters.

“Come boys,” said Jack Martin, in a grave tone, to me and Peterkin, as we stood on the quarterdeck awaiting our fate;—“Come boys, we three shall stick together. You see it is impossible that the little boat can reach the shore, crowded with men. It will be sure to upset, so I mean rather to trust myself to a large oar. I see through the telescope that the ship will strike at the tail of the reef, where the waves break into the quiet water inside; so, if we manage to cling to the oar till it is driven over the breakers, we may perhaps gain the shore. What say you; will you join me?”

“Come on, guys,” said Jack Martin, in a serious tone, to me and Peterkin, as we stood on the quarterdeck waiting for our fate;—“Come on, we three will stick together. You see, it’s impossible for the small boat to reach the shore with so many people in it. It’s bound to capsize, so I’d rather trust myself to a large oar. I can see through the telescope that the ship will hit the edge of the reef, where the waves break into the calm water inside; so, if we can hang onto the oar until it's pushed over the breakers, we might actually make it to shore. What do you say; will you join me?”

We gladly agreed to follow Jack, for he inspired us with confidence, although I could perceive, by the sad tone of his voice, that he had little hope; and, indeed, when I looked at the white waves that lashed the reef and boiled against the rocks as if in fury, I felt that there was but a step between us and death. My heart sank within me; but at that moment my thoughts turned to my beloved mother, and I remembered those words, which were among the last that she said to me—“Ralph, my dearest child, always remember in the hour of danger to look to your Lord and Saviour Jesus Christ. He alone is both able and willing to save your body and your soul.” So I felt much comforted when I thought thereon.

We happily agreed to follow Jack because he gave us confidence, even though I could tell from the sad tone of his voice that he felt little hope. In fact, when I looked at the white waves crashing against the reef and boiling against the rocks with fury, I felt we were just a step away from death. My heart sank, but in that moment, my thoughts turned to my beloved mother, and I remembered her words, which were among the last she said to me—“Ralph, my dearest child, always remember in times of danger to look to your Lord and Savior, Jesus Christ. He alone can and wants to save your body and your soul.” This thought brought me a lot of comfort.

The ship was now very near the rocks. The men were ready with the boat, and the captain beside them giving orders, when a tremendous wave came towards us. We three ran towards the bow to lay hold of our oar, and had barely reached it when the wave fell on the deck with a crash like thunder. At the same moment the ship struck, the foremast broke off close to the deck and went over the side, carrying the boat and men along with it. Our oar got entangled with the wreck, and Jack seized an axe to cut it free, but, owing to the motion of the ship, he missed the cordage and struck the axe deep into the oar. Another wave, however, washed it clear of the wreck. We all seized hold of it, and the next instant we were struggling in the wild sea. The last thing I saw was the boat whirling in the surf, and all the sailors tossed into the foaming waves. Then I became insensible.

The ship was now very close to the rocks. The crew was ready with the boat, and the captain was giving orders next to them when a massive wave came toward us. The three of us ran to the front to grab our oar, and we had just reached it when the wave crashed onto the deck with a sound like thunder. At the same moment, the ship hit the rocks, the foremast snapped off close to the deck, and toppled over the side, taking the boat and crew with it. Our oar got tangled in the wreckage, and Jack picked up an axe to cut it free, but due to the ship's movement, he missed the rope and struck the axe deep into the oar. Another wave, however, washed it away from the wreck. We all grabbed onto it, and in the next moment, we were fighting in the tumultuous sea. The last thing I saw was the boat spinning in the surf, and all the sailors thrown into the churning waves. Then I lost consciousness.

On recovering from my swoon, I found myself lying on a bank of soft grass, under the shelter of an overhanging rock, with Peterkin on his knees by my side, tenderly bathing my temples with water, and endeavouring to stop the blood that flowed from a wound in my forehead.

On coming to from my fainting spell, I found myself lying on a patch of soft grass, sheltered by an overhanging rock, with Peterkin on his knees beside me, gently washing my temples with water and trying to stop the bleeding from a wound on my forehead.

CHAPTER III.

The Coral Island—Our first cogitations after landing, and the result of them—We conclude that the island is uninhabited.

The Coral Island—Our first thoughts after landing, and what we concluded from them—We decide that the island is uninhabited.

There is a strange and peculiar sensation experienced in recovering from a state of insensibility, which is almost indescribable; a sort of dreamy, confused consciousness; a half-waking half-sleeping condition, accompanied with a feeling of weariness, which, however, is by no means disagreeable. As I slowly recovered and heard the voice of Peterkin inquiring whether I felt better, I thought that I must have overslept myself, and should be sent to the mast-head for being lazy; but before I could leap up in haste, the thought seemed to vanish suddenly away, and I fancied that I must have been ill. Then a balmy breeze fanned my cheek, and I thought of home, and the garden at the back of my father’s cottage, with its luxuriant flowers, and the sweet-scented honey-suckle that my dear mother trained so carefully upon the trellised porch. But the roaring of the surf put these delightful thoughts to flight, and I was back again at sea, watching the dolphins and the flying-fish, and reefing topsails off the wild and stormy Cape Horn. Gradually the roar of the surf became louder and more distinct. I thought of being wrecked far far away from my native land, and slowly opened my eyes to meet those of my companion Jack, who, with a look of intense anxiety, was gazing into my face.

There’s a strange and unusual feeling when coming back from a faint or unconscious state that’s hard to describe; it’s like a dreamy, confused awareness—a mix between waking and sleeping, along with a sense of tiredness that’s actually not unpleasant. As I gradually came to and heard Peterkin asking if I felt better, I thought I must have slept too long and would have to face punishment by being sent up to the mast for being lazy. But before I could jump up quickly, that thought faded away, and I began to think I must have been unwell. A gentle breeze brushed against my cheek, and I pictured home, especially the garden behind my dad’s cottage, filled with vibrant flowers and the sweet-smelling honeysuckle that my beloved mom tended to so carefully on the trellised porch. But the crashing sound of the waves chased those lovely thoughts away, and I was back at sea, watching dolphins and flying fish, and adjusting the topsails off the wild and stormy Cape Horn. Gradually, the roar of the surf got louder and clearer. I thought about being shipwrecked far away from my homeland, and I slowly opened my eyes to see my companion Jack, who was looking at me with intense worry.

“Speak to us, my dear Ralph,” whispered Jack, tenderly, “are you better now?”

“Talk to us, my dear Ralph,” Jack whispered gently, “are you feeling better now?”

I smiled and looked up, saying, “Better; why, what do you mean, Jack? I’m quite well.”

I smiled and looked up, saying, “Better? What do you mean, Jack? I’m fine."

“Then what are you shamming for, and frightening us in this way?” said Peterkin, smiling through his tears; for the poor boy had been really under the impression that I was dying.

“Then why are you pretending and scaring us like this?” said Peterkin, smiling through his tears; for the poor boy really thought I was dying.

I now raised myself on my elbow, and putting my hand to my forehead, found that it had been cut pretty severely, and that I had lost a good deal of blood.

I propped myself up on my elbow and touched my forehead, realizing it had been cut pretty badly, and that I had lost quite a bit of blood.

“Come, come, Ralph,” said Jack, pressing me gently backward, “lie down, my boy; you’re not right yet. Wet your lips with this water, it’s cool and clear as crystal. I got it from a spring close at hand. There now, don’t say a word, hold your tongue,” said he, seeing me about to speak. “I’ll tell you all about it, but you must not utter a syllable till you have rested well.”

“Come on, Ralph,” Jack said, gently pushing me back. “Lie down, kid; you’re not fully better yet. Wet your lips with this water; it’s cool and as clear as crystal. I got it from a spring nearby. Now, don’t say anything, just stay quiet,” he said, noticing I was about to speak. “I’ll tell you everything, but you have to keep quiet until you’ve rested up.”

“Oh! don’t stop him from speaking, Jack,” said Peterkin, who, now that his fears for my safety were removed, busied himself in erecting a shelter of broken branches in order to protect me from the wind; which, however, was almost unnecessary, for the rock beside which I had been laid completely broke the force of the gale. “Let him speak, Jack; it’s a comfort to hear that he’s alive, after lying there stiff and white and sulky for a whole hour, just like an Egyptian mummy. Never saw such a fellow as you are, Ralph; always up to mischief. You’ve almost knocked out all my teeth and more than half choked me, and now you go shamming dead! It’s very wicked of you, indeed it is.”

“Oh! don’t stop him from talking, Jack,” said Peterkin, who, now that he wasn’t worried about my safety anymore, started building a shelter out of broken branches to protect me from the wind; however, it was almost unnecessary, since the rock I was lying next to blocked most of the wind. “Let him talk, Jack; it’s nice to hear that he’s alive after lying there stiff and pale and sulky for a whole hour, just like an Egyptian mummy. I’ve never seen anyone like you, Ralph; always getting into trouble. You’ve almost knocked out all my teeth and more than half choked me, and now you pretend to be dead! That’s really wicked of you, it truly is.”

While Peterkin ran on in this style, my faculties became quite clear again, and I began to understand my position. “What do you mean by saying I half choked you, Peterkin?” said I.

While Peterkin kept going on like that, my mind became clear again, and I started to understand my situation. “What do you mean by saying I half choked you, Peterkin?” I asked.

“What do I mean? Is English not your mother tongue, or do you want me to repeat it in French, by way of making it clearer? Don’t you remember—”

“What do I mean? Is English not your first language, or do you want me to say it again in French to make it clearer? Don’t you remember—”

“I remember nothing,” said I, interrupting him, “after we were thrown into the sea.”

“I don't remember anything,” I said, cutting him off, “after we were thrown into the sea.”

“Hush, Peterkin,” said Jack, “you’re exciting Ralph with your nonsense. I’ll explain it to you. You recollect that after the ship struck, we three sprang over the bow into the sea; well, I noticed that the oar struck your head and gave you that cut on the brow, which nearly stunned you, so that you grasped Peterkin round the neck without knowing apparently what you were about. In doing so you pushed the telescope,—which you clung to as if it had been your life,—against Peterkin’s mouth—”

“Hush, Peterkin,” Jack said, “you’re making Ralph anxious with your nonsense. Let me explain it to you. Remember when the ship hit something and the three of us jumped over the bow into the water? I noticed that the oar hit your head and gave you that cut on your forehead, which almost knocked you out. You grabbed Peterkin around the neck without really knowing what you were doing. In the process, you pushed the telescope—you were holding onto it like it was your lifeline—against Peterkin’s mouth—”

“Pushed it against his mouth!” interrupted Peterkin, “say crammed it down his throat. Why, there’s a distinct mark of the brass rim on the back of my gullet at this moment!”

“Pushed it against his mouth!” interrupted Peterkin, “say crammed it down his throat. Why, there’s a noticeable mark of the brass rim on the back of my throat right now!”

“Well, well, be that as it may,” continued Jack, “you clung to him, Ralph, till I feared you really would choke him; but I saw that he had a good hold of the oar, so I exerted myself to the utmost to push you towards the shore, which we luckily reached without much trouble, for the water inside the reef is quite calm.”

“Well, well, regardless of that,” continued Jack, “you held on to him, Ralph, so tightly that I was worried you might actually choke him; but I noticed he had a solid grip on the oar, so I did my best to push you toward the shore, which we thankfully reached without much difficulty, because the water inside the reef is pretty calm.”

“But the captain and crew, what of them?” I inquired anxiously.

“But what about the captain and crew?” I asked nervously.

Jack shook his head.

Jack shook his head.

“Are they lost?”

“Are they missing?”

“No, they are not lost, I hope, but I fear there is not much chance of their being saved. The ship struck at the very tail of the island on which we are cast. When the boat was tossed into the sea it fortunately did not upset, although it shipped a good deal of water, and all the men managed to scramble into it; but before they could get the oars out the gale carried them past the point and away to leeward of the island. After we landed I saw them endeavouring to pull towards us, but as they had only one pair of oars out of the eight that belong to the boat, and as the wind was blowing right in their teeth, they gradually lost ground. Then I saw them put about and hoist some sort of sail,—a blanket, I fancy, for it was too small for the boat,—and in half an hour they were out of sight.”

“No, they aren’t lost, I hope, but I’m afraid there’s not much chance of them being saved. The ship hit the very end of the island where we ended up. When the boat was thrown into the sea, it luckily didn’t tip over, even though it took on a lot of water, and all the men managed to climb in; but before they could get the oars out, the strong wind blew them past the point and away from the island. After we landed, I saw them trying to row towards us, but since they only had one out of the eight oars from the boat, and the wind was blowing right against them, they gradually fell behind. Then I saw them turn around and raise some sort of sail — I think it was a blanket, because it was too small for the boat — and in half an hour, they were out of sight.”

“Poor fellows,” I murmured sorrowfully.

"Poor guys," I murmured sadly.

“But the more I think about it, I’ve better hope of them,” continued Jack, in a more cheerful tone. “You see, Ralph, I’ve read a great deal about these South Sea Islands, and I know that in many places they are scattered about in thousands over the sea, so they’re almost sure to fall in with one of them before long.”

“But the more I think about it, I have a better chance of finding them,” Jack continued, sounding more upbeat. “You see, Ralph, I’ve read a lot about these South Sea Islands, and I know that they’re scattered across the sea in the thousands, so we’re almost guaranteed to come across one of them soon.”

“I’m sure I hope so,” said Peterkin, earnestly. “But what has become of the wreck, Jack? I saw you clambering up the rocks there while I was watching Ralph. Did you say she had gone to pieces?”

“I really hope so,” said Peterkin seriously. “But what happened to the wreck, Jack? I saw you climbing up the rocks while I was watching Ralph. Did you say it had broken apart?”

“No, she has not gone to pieces, but she has gone to the bottom,” replied Jack. “As I said before, she struck on the tail of the island and stove in her bow, but the next breaker swung her clear, and she floated away to leeward. The poor fellows in the boat made a hard struggle to reach her, but long before they came near her she filled and went down. It was after she foundered that I saw them trying to pull to the island.”

“No, she hasn’t broken apart, but she has sunk,” Jack replied. “Like I mentioned earlier, she hit the back of the island and smashed her front, but the next wave pushed her clear and she drifted away. The poor guys in the boat really tried to get to her, but long before they got close, she filled up with water and went down. It was after she sank that I saw them trying to row to the island.”

There was a long silence after Jack ceased speaking, and I have no doubt that each was revolving in his mind our extraordinary position. For my part I cannot say that my reflections were very agreeable. I knew that we were on an island, for Jack had said so, but whether it was inhabited or not I did not know. If it should be inhabited, I felt certain, from all I had heard of South Sea Islanders, that we should be roasted alive and eaten. If it should turn out to be uninhabited, I fancied that we should be starved to death. “Oh!” thought I, “if the ship had only stuck on the rocks we might have done pretty well, for we could have obtained provisions from her, and tools to enable us to build a shelter, but now—alas! alas! we are lost!” These last words I uttered aloud in my distress.

There was a long silence after Jack stopped talking, and I have no doubt that each of us was considering our unusual situation. As for me, I can’t say my thoughts were very comforting. I knew we were on an island because Jack had mentioned it, but I didn’t know whether it was inhabited or not. If it was inhabited, I felt sure, based on everything I had heard about South Sea Islanders, that we would be roasted alive and eaten. If it turned out to be uninhabited, I imagined we would starve to death. “Oh!” I thought, “if only the ship had gotten stuck on the rocks, we could have managed quite well, as we could have gotten food from it and tools to help us build a shelter, but now—oh no! we are lost!” I said these last words aloud in my distress.

“Lost! Ralph?” exclaimed Jack, while a smile overspread his hearty countenance. “Saved, you should have said. Your cogitations seem to have taken a wrong road, and led you to a wrong conclusion.”

“Lost! Ralph?” Jack exclaimed, a big smile on his face. “You should have said saved. Your thoughts seem to have gone off track and led you to the wrong conclusion.”

“Do you know what conclusion I have come to?” said Peterkin. “I have made up my mind that it’s capital,—first rate,—the best thing that ever happened to us, and the most splendid prospect that ever lay before three jolly young tars. We’ve got an island all to ourselves. We’ll take possession in the name of the king; we’ll go and enter the service of its black inhabitants. Of course we’ll rise, naturally, to the top of affairs. White men always do in savage countries. You shall be king, Jack; Ralph, prime minister, and I shall be—”

“Do you know what conclusion I have come to?” said Peterkin. “I’ve decided it’s amazing—first-rate—the best thing that ever happened to us, and the greatest opportunity that ever came our way as three happy young sailors. We’ve got an island all to ourselves. We’ll take charge in the name of the king; we’ll join the service of its black inhabitants. Of course, we’ll rise to the top, naturally. White men always do in wild places. You’ll be king, Jack; Ralph, prime minister, and I’ll be—”

“The court jester,” interrupted Jack.

“The court jester,” Jack interrupted.

“No,” retorted Peterkin, “I’ll have no title at all. I shall merely accept a highly responsible situation under government, for you see, Jack, I’m fond of having an enormous salary and nothing to do.”

“No,” replied Peterkin, “I don’t want any title at all. I’ll just take on a highly responsible job in the government because, you know, Jack, I like having a huge salary and doing nothing.”

“But suppose there are no natives?”

“But what if there are no locals?”

“Then we’ll build a charming villa, and plant a lovely garden round it, stuck all full of the most splendiferous tropical flowers, and we’ll farm the land, plant, sow, reap, eat, sleep, and be merry.”

“Then we’ll build a lovely villa and create a beautiful garden around it, filled with the most amazing tropical flowers. We’ll farm the land, plant, sow, harvest, eat, sleep, and be happy.”

“But to be serious,” said Jack, assuming a grave expression of countenance, which I observed always had the effect of checking Peterkin’s disposition to make fun of everything, “we are really in rather an uncomfortable position. If this is a desert island, we shall have to live very much like the wild beasts, for we have not a tool of any kind, not even a knife.”

“But to be serious,” Jack said, putting on a serious face, which I noticed always stopped Peterkin from joking about everything. “We’re actually in a pretty tough spot. If this is a desert island, we’ll have to live like wild animals, because we don’t have any tools at all, not even a knife.”

“Yes, we have that,” said Peterkin, fumbling in his trousers pocket, from which he drew forth a small penknife with only one blade, and that was broken.

“Yes, we have that,” said Peterkin, rummaging through his pants pocket, from which he pulled out a small penknife with just one blade, and that was broken.

“Well, that’s better than nothing; but come,” said Jack, rising, “we are wasting our time in talking instead of doing. You seem well enough to walk now, Ralph, let us see what we have got in our pockets, and then let us climb some hill and ascertain what sort of island we have been cast upon, for, whether good or bad, it seems likely to be our home for some time to come.”

“Well, that’s better than nothing; but come,” said Jack, standing up, “we’re wasting our time talking instead of doing. You look good enough to walk now, Ralph. Let’s see what we have in our pockets, and then let’s climb a hill and figure out what kind of island we’re on, because whether it’s good or bad, it’s likely going to be our home for a while.”

CHAPTER IV.

We examine into our personal property, and make a happy discovery—Our island described—Jack proves himself to be learned and sagacious above his fellows—Curious discoveries—Natural lemonade!

We look into our belongings and make a pleasant discovery—Our island described—Jack shows that he is more knowledgeable and wise than the others—Interesting findings—Natural lemonade!

We now seated ourselves upon a rock and began to examine into our personal property. When we reached the shore, after being wrecked, my companions had taken off part of their clothes and spread them out in the sun to dry, for, although the gale was raging fiercely, there was not a single cloud in the bright sky. They had also stripped off most part of my wet clothes and spread them also on the rocks. Having resumed our garments, we now searched all our pockets with the utmost care, and laid their contents out on a flat stone before us; and, now that our minds were fully alive to our condition, it was with no little anxiety that we turned our several pockets inside out, in order that nothing might escape us. When all was collected together we found that our worldly goods consisted of the following articles:—

We settled on a rock and started going through our belongings. When we got to the shore after the shipwreck, my friends had taken off some of their clothes and laid them out in the sun to dry, because even though the storm was raging, there wasn't a single cloud in the clear sky. They had also taken off most of my wet clothes and spread them on the rocks. After we put our clothes back on, we searched all our pockets very carefully and laid the contents out on a flat stone in front of us. Now that we were fully aware of our situation, we anxiously turned our pockets inside out to make sure we didn’t miss anything. Once everything was gathered together, we discovered that our worldly possessions included the following items:—

First, A small penknife with a single blade broken off about the middle and very rusty, besides having two or three notches on its edge. (Peterkin said of this, with his usual pleasantry, that it would do for a saw as well as a knife, which was a great advantage.) Second, An old German-silver pencil-case without any lead in it. Third, A piece of whip-cord about six yards long. Fourth, A sailmaker’s needle of a small size. Fifth, A ship’s telescope, which I happened to have in my hand at the time the ship struck, and which I had clung to firmly all the time I was in the water. Indeed it was with difficulty that Jack got it out of my grasp when I was lying insensible on the shore. I cannot understand why I kept such a firm hold of this telescope. They say that a drowning man will clutch at a straw. Perhaps it may have been some such feeling in me, for I did not know that it was in my hand at the time we were wrecked. However, we felt some pleasure in having it with us now, although we did not see that it could be of much use to us, as the glass at the small end was broken to pieces. Our sixth article was a brass ring which Jack always wore on his little finger. I never understood why he wore it, for Jack was not vain of his appearance, and did not seem to care for ornaments of any kind. Peterkin said “it was in memory of the girl he left behind him!” But as he never spoke of this girl to either of us, I am inclined to think that Peterkin was either jesting or mistaken. In addition to these articles we had a little bit of tinder, and the clothes on our backs. These last were as follows:—

First, a small penknife with a single blade that was broken off about the middle and very rusty, plus it had two or three notches on its edge. (Peterkin joked that it could work as a saw just as well as a knife, which was quite an advantage.) Second, an old German-silver pencil case with no lead in it. Third, a piece of whip-cord about six yards long. Fourth, a small sailmaker’s needle. Fifth, a ship's telescope, which I happened to have in my hand when the ship struck, and I held onto it tightly the whole time I was in the water. In fact, Jack had a hard time getting it from my grip when I was lying unconscious on the shore. I can't understand why I held onto that telescope so tightly. They say that a drowning man will grab at anything. Maybe that was my instinct, because I didn’t even realize it was in my hand when we were wrecked. Still, we felt some joy in having it with us now, even though we didn’t see how it could be much use since the glass on the small end was shattered. Our sixth item was a brass ring that Jack always wore on his little finger. I never understood why he wore it, since Jack wasn’t vain about his looks and didn’t seem to care for jewelry. Peterkin said it was in memory of the girl he left behind! But since he never mentioned this girl to either of us, I think Peterkin was either joking or wrong. Besides these items, we had a small piece of tinder and the clothes on our backs. These last were as follows:—

Each of us had on a pair of stout canvass trousers, and a pair of sailors’ thick shoes. Jack wore a red flannel shirt, a blue jacket, and a red Kilmarnock bonnet or night-cap, besides a pair of worsted socks, and a cotton pocket-handkerchief, with sixteen portraits of Lord Nelson printed on it, and a union Jack in the middle. Peterkin had on a striped flannel shirt,—which he wore outside his trousers, and belted round his waist, after the manner of a tunic,—and a round black straw hat. He had no jacket, having thrown it off just before we were cast into the sea; but this was not of much consequence, as the climate of the island proved to be extremely mild; so much so, indeed, that Jack and I often preferred to go about without our jackets. Peterkin had also a pair of white cotton socks, and a blue handkerchief with white spots all over it. My own costume consisted of a blue flannel shirt, a blue jacket, a black cap, and a pair of worsted socks, besides the shoes and canvass trousers already mentioned. This was all we had, and besides these things we had nothing else; but, when we thought of the danger from which we had escaped, and how much worse off we might have been had the ship struck on the reef during the night, we felt very thankful that we were possessed of so much, although, I must confess, we sometimes wished that we had had a little more.

Each of us was wearing a pair of sturdy canvas pants and some thick sailor shoes. Jack had on a red flannel shirt, a blue jacket, and a red Kilmarnock hat or nightcap, along with a pair of wool socks and a cotton handkerchief featuring sixteen portraits of Lord Nelson with a Union Jack in the center. Peterkin wore a striped flannel shirt—tucked outside his pants and belted at the waist like a tunic—and a round black straw hat. He didn’t have a jacket since he had taken it off just before we were thrown into the sea, but that wasn’t too big of a deal because the island's climate turned out to be very mild. In fact, Jack and I often chose to go without our jackets. Peterkin also had a pair of white cotton socks and a blue handkerchief with white spots all over it. My outfit consisted of a blue flannel shirt, a blue jacket, a black cap, and a pair of wool socks, in addition to the shoes and canvas pants mentioned earlier. This was all we had, and aside from these items, we possessed nothing else. However, when we thought of the danger we had escaped and how much worse things could have been if the ship had hit the reef during the night, we felt really grateful for what we had, even though I must admit we sometimes wished for a bit more.

While we were examining these things, and talking about them, Jack suddenly started and exclaimed—

While we were looking at these things and discussing them, Jack suddenly jumped and shouted—

“The oar! we have forgotten the oar.”

“The oar! We forgot the oar.”

“What good will that do us?” said Peterkin; “there’s wood enough on the island to make a thousand oars.”

“What good will that do us?” asked Peterkin; “there’s enough wood on the island to make a thousand oars.”

“Ay, lad,” replied Jack, “but there’s a bit of hoop iron at the end of it, and that may be of much use to us.”

“Aye, kid,” replied Jack, “but there’s a piece of hoop iron at the end of it, and that could be really useful to us.”

“Very true,” said I, “let us go fetch it;” and with that we all three rose and hastened down to the beach. I still felt a little weak from loss of blood, so that my companions soon began to leave me behind; but Jack perceived this, and, with his usual considerate good nature, turned back to help me. This was now the first time that I had looked well about me since landing, as the spot where I had been laid was covered with thick bushes which almost hid the country from our view. As we now emerged from among these and walked down the sandy beach together, I cast my eyes about, and, truly, my heart glowed within me and my spirits rose at the beautiful prospect which I beheld on every side. The gale had suddenly died away, just as if it had blown furiously till it dashed our ship upon the rocks, and had nothing more to do after accomplishing that. The island on which we stood was hilly, and covered almost everywhere with the most beautiful and richly coloured trees, bushes, and shrubs, none of which I knew the names of at that time, except, indeed, the cocoa-nut palms, which I recognised at once from the many pictures that I had seen of them before I left home. A sandy beach of dazzling whiteness lined this bright green shore, and upon it there fell a gentle ripple of the sea. This last astonished me much, for I recollected that at home the sea used to fall in huge billows on the shore long after a storm had subsided. But on casting my glance out to sea the cause became apparent. About a mile distant from the shore I saw the great billows of the ocean rolling like a green wall, and falling with a long, loud roar, upon a low coral reef, where they were dashed into white foam and flung up in clouds of spray. This spray sometimes flew exceedingly high, and, every here and there, a beautiful rainbow was formed for a moment among the falling drops. We afterwards found that this coral reef extended quite round the island, and formed a natural breakwater to it. Beyond this the sea rose and tossed violently from the effects of the storm; but between the reef and the shore it was as calm and as smooth as a pond.

“Very true,” I said, “let's go get it;” and with that, the three of us got up and hurried down to the beach. I still felt a bit weak from blood loss, so my friends soon started to pull ahead of me; but Jack noticed and, with his usual kind nature, turned back to help me. This was the first time I really looked around since we landed, as the place where I had been laid was covered with thick bushes that nearly blocked our view of the land. As we stepped out from the bushes and walked along the sandy beach together, I glanced around, and honestly, my heart swelled with joy, and my spirits lifted at the stunning scenery all around us. The wind had suddenly died down, as if it had blown hard enough to crash our ship onto the rocks and had nothing left to do after that. The island we stood on was hilly and almost entirely covered with the most beautiful and vividly colored trees, bushes, and shrubs, none of which I could name at the time, except for the coconut palms, which I recognized right away from the many pictures I had seen before leaving home. A sandy beach of dazzling whiteness bordered this vibrant green shore, and the gentle waves rolled in softly. This surprised me greatly because I remembered that back home the sea would crash in huge waves onto the shore long after a storm had passed. However, when I looked out to sea, the reason became clear. About a mile from the shore, I saw the giant waves of the ocean rolling in like a green wall and crashing with a loud roar onto a low coral reef, where they broke into white foam and shot up in clouds of spray. This spray sometimes soared impressively high, and here and there, a beautiful rainbow briefly appeared among the falling droplets. We later discovered that this coral reef wrapped all the way around the island, acting as a natural breakwater. Beyond the reef, the sea was violent and tossed around from the storm; but between the reef and the shore, it was as calm and smooth as a pond.

My heart was filled with more delight than I can express at sight of so many glorious objects, and my thoughts turned suddenly to the contemplation of the Creator of them all. I mention this the more gladly, because at that time, I am ashamed to say, I very seldom thought of my Creator, although I was constantly surrounded by the most beautiful and wonderful of His works. I observed from the expression of my companion’s countenance that he too derived much joy from the splendid scenery, which was all the more agreeable to us after our long voyage on the salt sea. There, the breeze was fresh and cold, but here it was delightfully mild; and, when a puff blew off the land, it came laden with the most exquisite perfume that can be imagined. While we thus gazed, we were startled by a loud “Huzza!” from Peterkin, and, on looking towards the edge of the sea, we saw him capering and jumping about like a monkey, and ever and anon tugging with all his might at something that lay upon the shore.

My heart was filled with more joy than I can express at the sight of so many amazing things, and my thoughts suddenly turned to reflecting on the Creator of them all. I mention this with particular happiness because, at that time, I’m ashamed to admit, I rarely thought about my Creator, even though I was constantly surrounded by the most beautiful and wonderful of His creations. I could see from my companion's expression that he too was enjoying the stunning scenery, which felt even more wonderful to us after our long journey on the salty sea. There, the breeze was fresh and chilly, but here it was pleasantly mild; and when a gust blew in from the land, it carried the most exquisite scent imaginable. While we were gazing, we were startled by a loud “Huzza!” from Peterkin, and when we looked towards the water’s edge, we saw him jumping around like a monkey and, every now and then, tugging with all his might at something lying on the shore.

“What an odd fellow he is, to be sure,” said Jack, taking me by the arm and hurrying forward; “come, let us hasten to see what it is.”

“What a strange guy he is, for sure,” said Jack, grabbing my arm and rushing ahead; “come on, let’s hurry to see what it is.”

“Here it is, boys, hurrah! come along. Just what we want,” cried Peterkin, as we drew near, still tugging with all his power. “First rate; just the very ticket!”

“Here it is, guys, hooray! Let's go. Exactly what we need,” shouted Peterkin as we got closer, still pulling with all his strength. “Awesome; just perfect!”

I need scarcely say to my readers that my companion Peterkin was in the habit of using very remarkable and peculiar phrases. And I am free to confess that I did not well understand the meaning of some of them,—such, for instance, as “the very ticket;” but I think it my duty to recount everything relating to my adventures with a strict regard to truthfulness in as far as my memory serves me; so I write, as nearly as possible, the exact words that my companions spoke. I often asked Peterkin to explain what he meant by “ticket,” but he always answered me by going into fits of laughter. However, by observing the occasions on which he used it, I came to understand that it meant to show that something was remarkably good, or fortunate.

I hardly need to tell my readers that my friend Peterkin had a habit of using very unusual and distinctive phrases. And I’ll admit that I didn’t quite understand the meaning of some of them—like “the very ticket,” for example—but I feel it's my responsibility to recount everything related to my adventures with strict honesty as far as my memory allows; so I write down, as closely as possible, the exact words that my companions used. I often asked Peterkin to explain what he meant by “ticket,” but he always just burst into laughter. However, by noticing when he used it, I figured out that it meant to indicate something was exceptionally good or fortunate.

On coming up we found that Peterkin was vainly endeavouring to pull the axe out of the oar, into which, it will be remembered, Jack struck it while endeavouring to cut away the cordage among which it had become entangled at the bow of the ship. Fortunately for us the axe had remained fast in the oar, and even now, all Peterkin’s strength could not draw it out of the cut.

When we arrived, we found Peterkin trying in vain to pull the axe out of the oar, into which, as you’ll recall, Jack had struck it while trying to cut away the rope that it had gotten caught in at the front of the ship. Fortunately for us, the axe had stayed stuck in the oar, and even now, Peterkin couldn’t pull it out no matter how hard he tried.

“Ah! that is capital indeed,” cried Jack, at the same time giving the axe a wrench that plucked it out of the tough wood. “How fortunate this is! It will be of more value to us than a hundred knives, and the edge is quite new and sharp.”

“Wow! That’s amazing,” shouted Jack, as he twisted the axe and pulled it out of the tough wood. “How lucky is this! It’s worth more to us than a hundred knives, and the blade is completely new and sharp.”

“I’ll answer for the toughness of the handle at any rate,” cried Peterkin; “my arms are nearly pulled out of the sockets. But see here, our luck is great. There is iron on the blade.” He pointed to a piece of hoop iron, as he spoke, which had been nailed round the blade of the oar to prevent it from splitting.

“I’ll take the blame for how tough the handle is,” shouted Peterkin; “my arms feel like they’re about to come out of their sockets. But look, we’re in luck. There’s iron on the blade.” He pointed to a piece of hoop iron that had been nailed around the blade of the oar to stop it from splitting.

This also was a fortunate discovery. Jack went down on his knees, and with the edge of the axe began carefully to force out the nails. But as they were firmly fixed in, and the operation blunted our axe, we carried the oar up with us to the place where we had left the rest of our things, intending to burn the wood away from the iron at a more convenient time.

This was also a lucky find. Jack got down on his knees and started to carefully pry out the nails with the edge of the axe. But since they were stuck in tight and the effort was dulling our axe, we took the oar back to where we had left the rest of our stuff, planning to burn the wood off the iron at a better time.

“Now, lads,” said Jack, after we had laid it on the stone which contained our little all, “I propose that we should go to the tail of the island, where the ship struck, which is only a quarter of a mile off, and see if anything else has been thrown ashore. I don’t expect anything, but it is well to see. When we get back here it will be time to have our supper and prepare our beds.”

“Okay, guys,” said Jack, after we had put everything we had on the stone, “I suggest we head to the end of the island where the ship crashed, which is just a quarter of a mile away, and check if anything else has washed up on the shore. I don’t really expect to find anything, but it’s good to look. By the time we get back here, it will be time for dinner and to get our beds ready.”

“Agreed!” cried Peterkin and I together, as, indeed, we would have agreed to any proposal that Jack made; for, besides his being older and much stronger and taller than either of us, he was a very clever fellow, and I think would have induced people much older than himself to choose him for their leader, especially if they required to be led on a bold enterprise.

“Agreed!” Peterkin and I shouted at the same time, as we would have agreed to anything Jack suggested. Besides being older, much stronger, and taller than either of us, he was really smart, and I believe he could have convinced people much older than him to pick him as their leader, especially if they needed guidance on a daring mission.

Now, as we hastened along the white beach, which shone so brightly in the rays of the setting sun that our eyes were quite dazzled by its glare, it suddenly came into Peterkin’s head that we had nothing to eat except the wild berries which grew in profusion at our feet.

Now, as we rushed along the white beach, which glowed so brightly in the rays of the setting sun that our eyes were nearly blinded by its glare, it suddenly occurred to Peterkin that we had nothing to eat except for the wild berries that grew in abundance at our feet.

“What shall we do, Jack?” said he, with a rueful look; “perhaps they may be poisonous!”

“What should we do, Jack?” he said, looking regretful. “They might be poisonous!”

“No fear,” replied Jack, confidently; “I have observed that a few of them are not unlike some of the berries that grow wild on our own native hills. Besides, I saw one or two strange birds eating them just a few minutes ago, and what won’t kill the birds won’t kill us. But look up there, Peterkin,” continued Jack, pointing to the branched head of a cocoa-nut palm. “There are nuts for us in all stages.”

“No worries,” replied Jack, confidently. “I’ve noticed that some of them are similar to some of the berries that grow wild on our own hills. Plus, I saw a couple of strange birds eating them just a few minutes ago, and what won’t harm the birds won’t harm us. But look up there, Peterkin,” Jack continued, pointing to the branching top of a coconut palm. “There are nuts for us in all stages.”

“So there are!” cried Peterkin, who being of a very unobservant nature had been too much taken up with other things to notice anything so high above his head as the fruit of a palm tree. But, whatever faults my young comrade had, he could not be blamed for want of activity or animal spirits. Indeed, the nuts had scarcely been pointed out to him when he bounded up the tall stem of the tree like a squirrel, and, in a few minutes, returned with three nuts, each as large as a man’s fist.

“So there they are!” shouted Peterkin, who, being quite oblivious, had been too focused on other things to notice the fruit of the palm tree high above him. But despite his lack of observation, he couldn't be faulted for his energy or enthusiasm. In fact, as soon as the nuts were pointed out to him, he sprang up the tall trunk of the tree like a squirrel and, in just a few minutes, came back with three nuts, each about the size of a fist.

“You had better keep them till we return,” said Jack. “Let us finish our work before eating.”

“You should hold onto them until we get back,” Jack said. “Let’s wrap up our work before we eat.”

“So be it, captain, go ahead,” cried Peterkin, thrusting the nuts into his trousers pocket. “In fact I don’t want to eat just now, but I would give a good deal for a drink. Oh that I could find a spring! but I don’t see the smallest sign of one hereabouts. I say, Jack, how does it happen that you seem to be up to everything? You have told us the names of half-a-dozen trees already, and yet you say that you were never in the South Seas before.”

“So be it, captain, go ahead,” shouted Peterkin, shoving the nuts into his pants pocket. “Actually, I’m not really hungry right now, but I would pay a lot for a drink. I wish I could find a spring! But I don’t see even the tiniest sign of one around here. Hey, Jack, how come you seem to know everything? You’ve already named half a dozen trees, and yet you say you’ve never been to the South Seas before.”

“I’m not up to everything, Peterkin, as you’ll find out ere long,” replied Jack, with a smile; “but I have been a great reader of books of travel and adventure all my life, and that has put me up to a good many things that you are, perhaps, not acquainted with.”

“I’m not into everything, Peterkin, as you’ll see soon enough,” Jack replied with a smile; “but I’ve read a lot of travel and adventure books throughout my life, and that’s given me insight into quite a few things you might not know about.”

“Oh, Jack, that’s all humbug. If you begin to lay everything to the credit of books, I’ll quite lose my opinion of you,” cried Peterkin, with a look of contempt. “I’ve seen a lot o’ fellows that were always poring over books, and when they came to try to do anything, they were no better than baboons!”

“Oh, Jack, that’s just nonsense. If you keep giving all the credit to books, I’ll totally lose my respect for you,” exclaimed Peterkin, looking at him with disdain. “I’ve seen plenty of guys who are always buried in books, and when it comes time to do anything, they’re no better than baboons!”

“You are quite right,” retorted Jack; “and I have seen a lot of fellows who never looked into books at all, who knew nothing about anything except the things they had actually seen, and very little they knew even about these. Indeed, some were so ignorant that they did not know that cocoa-nuts grew on cocoa-nut trees!”

“You're absolutely right,” Jack shot back; “and I've come across plenty of guys who never bothered to pick up a book, who didn't know anything beyond what they had actually experienced, and even then, they knew very little about that. In fact, some were so clueless that they didn't even realize that coconuts come from coconut trees!”

I could not refrain from laughing at this rebuke, for there was much truth in it, as to Peterkin’s ignorance.

I couldn't help but laugh at this criticism because it was very true about Peterkin's ignorance.

“Humph! maybe you’re right,” answered Peterkin; “but I would not give tuppence for a man of books, if he had nothing else in him.”

“Humph! maybe you’re right,” replied Peterkin; “but I wouldn’t give two cents for a man of books if he had nothing else to offer.”

“Neither would I,” said Jack; “but that’s no reason why you should run books down, or think less of me for having read them. Suppose, now, Peterkin, that you wanted to build a ship, and I were to give you a long and particular account of the way to do it, would not that be very useful?”

“Neither would I,” said Jack; “but that doesn't mean you should criticize books or consider me less for having read them. Imagine, Peterkin, that you wanted to build a ship, and I gave you a detailed explanation of how to do it—wouldn't that be really helpful?”

“No doubt of it,” said Peterkin, laughing.

“No doubt about it,” Peterkin said, laughing.

“And suppose I were to write the account in a letter instead of telling you in words, would that be less useful?”

“And what if I wrote the account in a letter instead of telling you? Would that be less helpful?”

“Well—no, perhaps not.”

“Well, maybe not.”

“Well, suppose I were to print it, and send it to you in the form of a book, would it not be as good and useful as ever?”

“Well, what if I printed it and sent it to you as a book? Wouldn't it still be just as good and useful?”

“Oh, bother! Jack, you’re a philosopher, and that’s worse than anything!” cried Peterkin, with a look of pretended horror.

“Oh, come on! Jack, you’re a philosopher, and that’s worse than anything!” cried Peterkin, with a look of fake horror.

“Very well, Peterkin, we shall see,” returned Jack, halting under the shade of a cocoa-nut tree. “You said you were thirsty just a minute ago; now, jump up that tree and bring down a nut,—not a ripe one, bring a green, unripe one.”

“Alright, Peterkin, we'll see,” Jack replied, stopping under the shade of a coconut tree. “You mentioned you were thirsty just a minute ago; now, climb that tree and grab a nut—not a ripe one, but a green, unripe one.”

Peterkin looked surprised, but, seeing that Jack was in earnest, he obeyed.

Peterkin looked surprised, but when he saw that Jack was serious, he went along with it.

“Now, cut a hole in it with your penknife, and clap it to your mouth, old fellow,” said Jack.

“Now, poke a hole in it with your pocket knife, and hold it up to your mouth, buddy,” said Jack.

Peterkin did as he was directed, and we both burst into uncontrollable laughter at the changes that instantly passed over his expressive countenance. No sooner had he put the nut to his mouth, and thrown back his head in order to catch what came out of it, than his eyes opened to twice their ordinary size with astonishment, while his throat moved vigorously in the act of swallowing. Then a smile and look of intense delight overspread his face, except, indeed, the mouth, which, being firmly fixed to the hole in the nut, could not take part in the expression; but he endeavoured to make up for this by winking at us excessively with his right eye. At length he stopped, and, drawing a long breath, exclaimed—

Peterkin did what he was told, and we both burst into uncontrollable laughter at the changes that instantly showed on his expressive face. As soon as he put the nut to his mouth and threw his head back to catch whatever came out, his eyes widened in shock, becoming twice their usual size, while his throat worked hard to swallow. A smile and a look of pure joy spread across his face, except for his mouth, which was firmly pressed against the nut's opening and couldn't join in the expression; but he tried to make up for it by winking at us a lot with his right eye. Finally, he paused, took a deep breath, and exclaimed—

“Nectar! perfect nectar! I say, Jack, you’re a Briton—the best fellow I ever met in my life. Only taste that!” said he, turning to me and holding the nut to my mouth. I immediately drank, and certainly I was much surprised at the delightful liquid that flowed copiously down my throat. It was extremely cool, and had a sweet taste, mingled with acid; in fact, it was the likest thing to lemonade I ever tasted, and was most grateful and refreshing. I handed the nut to Jack, who, after tasting it, said, “Now, Peterkin, you unbeliever, I never saw or tasted a cocoa nut in my life before, except those sold in shops at home; but I once read that the green nuts contain that stuff, and you see it is true!”

“Nectar! Perfect nectar! I tell you, Jack, you’re a Brit— the best guy I’ve ever met. Just try this!” he said, turning to me and bringing the nut to my lips. I took a sip, and I was definitely surprised by the delightful liquid that flowed smoothly down my throat. It was really cool and had a sweet, slightly tangy flavor; honestly, it was the closest thing to lemonade I’ve ever tasted, and it was incredibly refreshing. I handed the nut to Jack, who, after trying it, said, “Now, Peterkin, you doubter, I’ve never seen or tried a coconut in my life before, except for the ones sold in stores back home; but I once read that the green ones have this juice, and look, it’s true!”

“And pray,” asked Peterkin, “what sort of ‘stuff’ does the ripe nut contain?”

“And please,” asked Peterkin, “what kind of ‘stuff’ does the ripe nut have inside?”

“A hollow kernel,” answered Jack, “with a liquid like milk in it; but it does not satisfy thirst so well as hunger. It is very wholesome food I believe.”

“A hollow kernel,” answered Jack, “filled with a liquid like milk; but it doesn’t quench thirst as well as it satisfies hunger. I believe it’s very nutritious food.”

“Meat and drink on the same tree!” cried Peterkin; “washing in the sea, lodging on the ground,—and all for nothing! My dear boys, we’re set up for life; it must be the ancient Paradise,—hurrah!” and Peterkin tossed his straw hat in the air, and ran along the beach hallooing like a madman with delight.

“Food and drinks from the same tree!” shouted Peterkin; “bathing in the sea, sleeping on the ground—and all for free! My dear friends, we’re set for life; it has to be the original Paradise—yay!” Peterkin threw his straw hat up in the air and ran along the beach shouting with joy like a crazy person.

We afterwards found, however, that these lovely islands were very unlike Paradise in many things. But more of this in its proper place.

We later discovered, however, that these beautiful islands were quite different from Paradise in many ways. But more on that later.

We had now come to the point of rocks on which the ship had struck, but did not find a single article, although we searched carefully among the coral rocks, which at this place jutted out so far as nearly to join the reef that encircled the island. Just as we were about to return, however, we saw something black floating in a little cove that had escaped our observation. Running forward, we drew it from the water, and found it to be a long thick leather boot, such as fishermen at home wear; and a few paces farther on we picked up its fellow. We at once recognised these as having belonged to our captain, for he had worn them during the whole of the storm, in order to guard his legs from the waves and spray that constantly washed over our decks. My first thought on seeing them was that our dear captain had been drowned; but Jack soon put my mind more at rest on that point, by saying that if the captain had been drowned with the boots on, he would certainly have been washed ashore along with them, and that he had no doubt whatever he had kicked them off while in the sea, that he might swim more easily.

We had now reached the rocky area where the ship had struck, but we didn’t find anything, even after carefully searching among the coral rocks that jutted out almost to connect with the reef surrounding the island. Just as we were about to head back, we noticed something black floating in a small cove that we had missed. We rushed over, pulled it from the water, and discovered it was a long, thick leather boot, like the kind fishermen wear at home; a few steps further, we found its mate. We immediately recognized these as belonging to our captain, since he had worn them throughout the storm to protect his legs from the waves and spray that constantly washed over the deck. My first thought upon seeing them was that our dear captain had drowned, but Jack quickly eased my worries by pointing out that if the captain had drowned with the boots on, he would have been washed ashore with them. He was sure the captain had kicked them off while in the water to swim more easily.

Peterkin immediately put them on, but they were so large that, as Jack said, they would have done for boots, trousers, and vest too. I also tried them, but, although I was long enough in the legs for them, they were much too large in the feet for me; so we handed them to Jack, who was anxious to make me keep them, but as they fitted his large limbs and feet as if they had been made for him, I would not hear of it, so he consented at last to use them. I may remark, however, that Jack did not use them often, as they were extremely heavy.

Peterkin immediately tried them on, but they were so big that, as Jack said, they could have worked as boots, pants, and a vest too. I also gave them a shot, but even though my legs were long enough for them, the feet were way too big for me; so we passed them to Jack, who was eager for me to keep them. However, since they fit his large body and feet as if they were custom-made for him, I wouldn't allow it, so he finally agreed to wear them. I should note, though, that Jack didn’t wear them often since they were really heavy.

It was beginning to grow dark when we returned to our encampment; so we put off our visit to the top of a hill till next day, and employed the light that yet remained to us in cutting down a quantity of boughs and the broad leaves of a tree, of which none of us knew the name. With these we erected a sort of rustic bower, in which we meant to pass the night. There was no absolute necessity for this, because the air of our island was so genial and balmy that we could have slept quite well without any shelter; but we were so little used to sleeping in the open air, that we did not quite relish the idea of lying down without any covering over us: besides, our bower would shelter us from the night dews or rain, if any should happen to fall. Having strewed the floor with leaves and dry grass, we bethought ourselves of supper.

It was starting to get dark when we got back to our campsite, so we decided to put off our trip to the top of the hill until the next day. Instead, we used the remaining daylight to cut down a bunch of branches and large leaves from a tree none of us could identify. With these, we built a sort of makeshift shelter where we planned to spend the night. It wasn't really necessary since the air on our island was so mild and pleasant that we could have easily slept without any cover; however, we weren't quite used to sleeping outdoors and didn't like the idea of lying down without anything over us. Plus, our shelter would protect us from the night dew or any rain that might occur. After we spread leaves and dry grass on the floor, we started thinking about dinner.

But it now occurred to us, for the first time, that we had no means of making a fire.

But it suddenly struck us, for the first time, that we had no way to start a fire.

“Now, there’s a fix!—what shall we do?” said Peterkin, while we both turned our eyes to Jack, to whom we always looked in our difficulties. Jack seemed not a little perplexed.

“Now, there’s a solution!—what should we do?” said Peterkin, as we both looked to Jack, who we always relied on in tough situations. Jack seemed quite confused.

“There are flints enough, no doubt, on the beach,” said he, “but they are of no use at all without a steel. However, we must try.” So saying, he went to the beach, and soon returned with two flints. On one of these he placed the tinder, and endeavoured to ignite it; but it was with great difficulty that a very small spark was struck out of the flints, and the tinder, being a bad, hard piece, would not catch. He then tried the bit of hoop iron, which would not strike fire at all; and after that the back of the axe, with no better success. During all these trials Peterkin sat with his hands in his pockets, gazing with a most melancholy visage at our comrade, his face growing longer and more miserable at each successive failure.

“There are plenty of flints on the beach,” he said, “but they’re useless without steel. Still, we have to give it a shot.” With that, he went to the beach and came back with two flints. He put the tinder on one of them and tried to light it; but it took a lot of effort to get a tiny spark from the flints, and the tinder, being a tough, hard piece, wouldn’t catch. He then tried the piece of hoop iron, which didn’t strike any fire at all; after that, he used the back of the axe, with no better luck. Meanwhile, Peterkin sat with his hands in his pockets, looking at our friend with a very sad face, his expression growing more and more miserable with each failure.

“Oh dear!” he sighed, “I would not care a button for the cooking of our victuals,—perhaps they don’t need it,—but it’s so dismal to eat one’s supper in the dark, and we have had such a capital day, that it’s a pity to finish off in this glum style. Oh, I have it!” he cried, starting up; “the spy-glass,—the big glass at the end is a burning-glass!”

“Oh no!” he sighed, “I wouldn’t care at all about making our food—maybe we don’t even need to—but it’s just so miserable to have dinner in the dark, and we’ve had such a great day that it would be a shame to end it on such a gloomy note. Oh, I’ve got it!” he exclaimed, jumping up; “the spyglass—the big lens at the end is a magnifying glass!”

“You forget that we have no sun,” said I.

“You forget that we don’t have any sun,” I said.

Peterkin was silent. In his sudden recollection of the telescope he had quite overlooked the absence of the sun.

Peterkin was silent. In his sudden memory of the telescope, he had completely forgotten that the sun was missing.

“Ah, boys, I’ve got it now!” exclaimed Jack, rising and cutting a branch from a neighbouring bush, which be stripped of its leaves. “I recollect seeing this done once at home. Hand me the bit of whip-cord.” With the cord and branch Jack soon formed a bow. Then he cut a piece, about three inches long, off the end of a dead branch, which he pointed at the two ends. Round this he passed the cord of the bow, and placed one end against his chest, which was protected from its point by a chip of wood; the other point he placed against the bit of tinder, and then began to saw vigorously with the bow, just as a blacksmith does with his drill while boring a hole in a piece of iron. In a few seconds the tinder began to smoke; in less than a minute it caught fire; and in less than a quarter of an hour we were drinking our lemonade and eating cocoa nuts round a fire that would have roasted an entire sheep, while the smoke, flames, and sparks, flew up among the broad leaves of the overhanging palm trees, and cast a warm glow upon our leafy bower.

“Ah, guys, I’ve got it now!” Jack shouted, standing up and grabbing a branch from a nearby bush, which he stripped of its leaves. “I remember seeing this done at home. Hand me that piece of cord.” With the cord and branch, Jack quickly made a bow. Then he cut a piece about three inches long from the end of a dead branch and pointed both ends. He wrapped the bow cord around this piece and pressed one end against his chest, which was protected from the point by a small piece of wood; the other end he pressed against the tinder and began to saw vigorously with the bow, just like a blacksmith uses a drill to bore a hole in iron. In a few seconds, the tinder started to smoke; in under a minute, it caught fire; and within less than fifteen minutes, we were sipping lemonade and eating coconuts around a fire that could have roasted an entire sheep, while the smoke, flames, and sparks flew up among the broad leaves of the overhanging palm trees, casting a warm glow over our leafy shelter.

That night the starry sky looked down through the gently rustling trees upon our slumbers, and the distant roaring of the surf upon the coral reef was our lullaby.

That night, the starry sky looked down through the softly swaying trees while we slept, and the distant sound of the waves crashing on the coral reef was our lullaby.

CHAPTER V.

Morning, and cogitations connected therewith—We luxuriate in the sea, try our diving powers, and make enchanting excursions among the coral groves at the bottom of the ocean—The wonders of the deep enlarged upon.

Morning and the thoughts that come with it—We enjoy the sea, test our diving skills, and take delightful trips through the coral gardens at the ocean floor—The wonders of the deep explored.

What a joyful thing it is to awaken, on a fresh glorious morning, and find the rising sun staring into your face with dazzling brilliancy!—to see the birds twittering in the bushes, and to hear the murmuring of a rill, or the soft hissing ripples as they fall upon the sea-shore! At any time and in any place such sights and sounds are most charming, but more especially are they so when one awakens to them, for the first time, in a novel and romantic situation, with the soft sweet air of a tropical climate mingling with the fresh smell of the sea, and stirring the strange leaves that flutter overhead and around one, or ruffling the plumage of the stranger birds that fly inquiringly around, as if to demand what business we have to intrude uninvited on their domains. When I awoke on the morning after the shipwreck, I found myself in this most delightful condition; and, as I lay on my back upon my bed of leaves, gazing up through the branches of the cocoa-nut trees into the clear blue sky, and watched the few fleecy clouds that passed slowly across it, my heart expanded more and more with an exulting gladness, the like of which I had never felt before. While I meditated, my thoughts again turned to the great and kind Creator of this beautiful world, as they had done on the previous day, when I first beheld the sea and the coral reef, with the mighty waves dashing over it into the calm waters of the lagoon.

What a joyful thing it is to wake up on a fresh, glorious morning and find the sun shining brightly in your face!—to see the birds chirping in the bushes and to hear the gentle murmuring of a stream or the soft hissing ripples as they wash up on the shore! These sights and sounds are lovely at any time, but especially enchanting when you first experience them in a new and romantic place, with the sweet, soft air of a tropical climate blending with the fresh scent of the sea, stirring the unusual leaves that flutter above and around you or ruffling the feathers of the exotic birds that fly around as if to question why we have intruded uninvited into their territory. When I woke up the morning after the shipwreck, I found myself in this delightful situation; as I lay on my back on my bed of leaves, gazing up through the branches of the coconut trees into the clear blue sky and watching the few fluffy clouds drifting slowly across it, my heart swelled with a joyful happiness I had never felt before. While I contemplated, my thoughts once again turned to the great and loving Creator of this beautiful world, just as they had the day before when I first saw the sea and the coral reef, with the powerful waves crashing over it into the calm waters of the lagoon.

While thus meditating, I naturally bethought me of my Bible, for I had faithfully kept the promise, which I gave at parting to my beloved mother, that I would read it every morning; and it was with a feeling of dismay that I remembered I had left it in the ship. I was much troubled about this. However, I consoled myself with reflecting that I could keep the second part of my promise to her, namely, that I should never omit to say my prayers. So I rose quietly, lest I should disturb my companions, who were still asleep, and stepped aside into the bushes for this purpose.

While I was meditating, I naturally thought of my Bible, since I had kept the promise I made to my beloved mother when we parted—that I would read it every morning. I felt a sense of dread when I remembered that I had left it on the ship. This really troubled me. However, I comforted myself by remembering that I could still keep the second part of my promise to her, which was that I would always say my prayers. So I quietly got up, trying not to disturb my companions who were still asleep, and stepped aside into the bushes to pray.

On my return I found them still slumbering, so I again lay down to think over our situation. Just at that moment I was attracted by the sight of a very small parrot, which Jack afterwards told me was called a paroquet. It was seated on a twig that overhung Peterkin’s head, and I was speedily lost in admiration of its bright green plumage, which was mingled with other gay colours. While I looked I observed that the bird turned its head slowly from side to side and looked downwards, first with the one eye, and then with the other. On glancing downwards I observed that Peterkin’s mouth was wide open, and that this remarkable bird was looking into it. Peterkin used to say that I had not an atom of fun in my composition, and that I never could understand a joke. In regard to the latter, perhaps he was right; yet I think that, when they were explained to me, I understood jokes as well as most people: but in regard to the former he must certainly have been wrong, for this bird seemed to me to be extremely funny; and I could not help thinking that, if it should happen to faint, or slip its foot, and fall off the twig into Peterkin’s mouth, he would perhaps think it funny too! Suddenly the paroquet bent down its head and uttered a loud scream in his face. This awoke him, and, with a cry of surprise, he started up, while the foolish bird flew precipitately away.

On my way back, I found them still sleeping, so I lay down again to think about our situation. Just then, I spotted a tiny parrot, which Jack later told me was called a paroquet. It was perched on a branch above Peterkin’s head, and I quickly became entranced by its bright green feathers mixed with other vibrant colors. As I watched, I noticed the bird slowly turning its head from side to side and looking down, first with one eye, then the other. Looking down myself, I saw that Peterkin’s mouth was wide open, and this peculiar bird was peering into it. Peterkin used to say that I had no sense of humor and that I could never grasp a joke. As for the latter, he might have been right; still, I believe that when they were explained to me, I understood jokes as well as anyone. But regarding the former, he must have been completely wrong, because I found this bird incredibly funny. I couldn’t help but think that if it happened to faint or slip and fall into Peterkin’s mouth, he might find that funny too! Suddenly, the paroquet leaned down and let out a loud scream right in his face. This startled him awake, and with a surprised shout, he jumped up while the silly bird flew off in a hurry.

“Oh you monster!” cried Peterkin, shaking his fist at the bird. Then he yawned and rubbed his eyes, and asked what o’clock it was.

“Oh you monster!” shouted Peterkin, shaking his fist at the bird. Then he yawned, rubbed his eyes, and asked what time it was.

I smiled at this question, and answered that, as our watches were at the bottom of the sea, I could not tell, but it was a little past sunrise.

I smiled at the question and responded that, since our watches were at the bottom of the sea, I couldn’t say for sure, but it was just after sunrise.

Peterkin now began to remember where we were. As he looked up into the bright sky, and snuffed the scented air, his eyes glistened with delight, and he uttered a faint “hurrah!” and yawned again. Then he gazed slowly round, till, observing the calm sea through an opening in the bushes, he started suddenly up as if he had received an electric shock, uttered a vehement shout, flung off his garments, and, rushing over the white sands, plunged into the water. The cry awoke Jack, who rose on his elbow with a look of grave surprise; but this was followed by a quiet smile of intelligence on seeing Peterkin in the water. With an energy that he only gave way to in moments of excitement, Jack bounded to his feet, threw off his clothes, shook back his hair, and with a lion-like spring, dashed over the sands and plunged into the sea with such force as quite to envelop Peterkin in a shower of spray. Jack was a remarkably good swimmer and diver, so that after his plunge we saw no sign of him for nearly a minute; after which he suddenly emerged, with a cry of joy, a good many yards out from the shore. My spirits were so much raised by seeing all this that I, too, hastily threw off my garments and endeavoured to imitate Jack’s vigorous bound; but I was so awkward that my foot caught on a stump, and I fell to the ground; then I slipped on a stone while running over the mud, and nearly fell again, much to the amusement of Peterkin, who laughed heartily, and called me a “slow coach,” while Jack cried out, “Come along, Ralph, and I’ll help you.” However, when I got into the water I managed very well, for I was really a good swimmer, and diver too. I could not, indeed, equal Jack, who was superior to any Englishman I ever saw, but I infinitely surpassed Peterkin, who could only swim a little, and could not dive at all.

Peterkin started to remember where we were. As he looked up at the bright sky and breathed in the fragrant air, his eyes sparkled with joy, and he let out a soft “hurrah!” before yawning again. Then he slowly looked around until he spotted the calm sea through a gap in the bushes. Suddenly, he jumped up as if he had been electrocuted, let out a loud shout, stripped off his clothes, and, rushing over the white sands, dove into the water. The shout woke Jack, who propped himself up on his elbow with a look of serious surprise, but that quickly turned into a knowing smile when he saw Peterkin in the water. With an energy he only showed in exciting moments, Jack sprang to his feet, took off his clothes, shook his hair back, and with a powerful leap, raced over the sands and plunged into the sea, splashing Peterkin with a shower of spray. Jack was an excellent swimmer and diver, so we didn’t see him for nearly a minute after his dive; then he suddenly surfaced, shouting with joy, quite a distance from the shore. My spirits soared at the sight, and I quickly tossed aside my clothes too, trying to copy Jack's enthusiastic leap. However, I was so clumsy that my foot caught on a stump, and I fell. Then I slipped on a stone while dodging through the mud and almost fell again, which thoroughly amused Peterkin, who laughed heartily and called me a “slow coach,” while Jack shouted, “Come on, Ralph, and I’ll help you.” But once I got into the water, I was just fine because I was actually a good swimmer and diver too. I couldn’t match Jack, who was better than any Englishman I had ever seen, but I was definitely better than Peterkin, who could only swim a little and couldn’t dive at all.

While Peterkin enjoyed himself in the shallow water and in running along the beach, Jack and I swam out into the deep water, and occasionally dived for stones. I shall never forget my surprise and delight on first beholding the bottom of the sea. As I have before stated, the water within the reef was as calm as a pond; and, as there was no wind, it was quite clear, from the surface to the bottom, so that we could see down easily even at a depth of twenty or thirty yards. When Jack and I dived in shallower water, we expected to have found sand and stones, instead of which we found ourselves in what appeared really to be an enchanted garden. The whole of the bottom of the lagoon, as we called the calm water within the reef, was covered with coral of every shape, size, and hue. Some portions were formed like large mushrooms; others appeared like the brain of a man, having stalks or necks attached to them; but the most common kind was a species of branching coral, and some portions were of a lovely pale pink colour, others pure white. Among this there grew large quantities of sea-weed of the richest hues imaginable, and of the most graceful forms; while innumerable fishes—blue, red, yellow, green, and striped—sported in and out amongst the flower-beds of this submarine garden, and did not appear to be at all afraid of our approaching them.

While Peterkin had fun in the shallow water and ran along the beach, Jack and I swam out into the deeper water and occasionally dove for stones. I'll never forget the surprise and excitement I felt when I first saw the bottom of the sea. As I mentioned earlier, the water inside the reef was as calm as a pond, and since there was no wind, it was perfectly clear, allowing us to see easily down to a depth of twenty or thirty yards. When Jack and I dove into shallower water, we expected to find sand and rocks; instead, we discovered what seemed to be an enchanted garden. The entire bottom of the lagoon, as we referred to the calm water within the reef, was covered in coral of every shape, size, and color. Some parts looked like large mushrooms; others resembled the brain of a person, with stalks or necks attached. However, the most common type was branching coral, some of which was a lovely pale pink, while others were pure white. Among this, there was an abundance of seaweed in the richest imaginable hues and most graceful shapes, while countless fish—blue, red, yellow, green, and striped—played among the flower beds of this underwater garden, seemingly unafraid of our approach.

On darting to the surface for breath, after our first dive, Jack and I rose close to each other.

On rushing to the surface for air after our first dive, Jack and I surfaced near each other.

“Did you ever in your life, Ralph, see anything so lovely?” said Jack, as he flung the spray from his hair.

“Have you ever seen anything so beautiful in your life, Ralph?” Jack said, as he shook the water out of his hair.

“Never,” I replied. “It appears to me like fairy realms. I can scarcely believe that we are not dreaming.”

“Never,” I replied. “It feels like we're in a fairy tale. I can hardly believe we’re not dreaming.”

“Dreaming!” cried Jack, “do you know, Ralph, I’m half tempted to think that we really are dreaming. But if so, I am resolved to make the most of it, and dream another dive; so here goes,—down again, my boy!”

“Dreaming!” shouted Jack, “do you realize, Ralph, I’m almost convinced that we really are dreaming. But if that’s the case, I’ve decided to make the most of it and dream up another dive; so here we go—down again, my friend!”

We took the second dive together, and kept beside each other while under water; and I was greatly surprised to find that we could keep down much longer than I ever recollect having done in our own seas at home. I believe that this was owing to the heat of the water, which was so warm that we afterwards found we could remain in it for two and three hours at a time without feeling any unpleasant effects such as we used to experience in the sea at home. When Jack reached the bottom, he grasped the coral stems, and crept along on his hands and knees, peeping under the sea-weed and among the rocks. I observed him also pick up one or two large oysters, and retain them in his grasp, as if he meant to take them up with him, so I also gathered a few. Suddenly he made a grasp at a fish with blue and yellow stripes on its back, and actually touched its tail, but did not catch it. At this he turned towards me and attempted to smile; but no sooner had he done so than he sprang like an arrow to the surface, where, on following him, I found him gasping and coughing, and spitting water from his mouth. In a few minutes he recovered, and we both turned to swim ashore.

We took our second dive together and stayed close to each other underwater. I was really surprised to find that we could stay down much longer than I remember doing in our own seas back home. I think this was because the water was so warm that we later realized we could stay in it for two to three hours at a time without feeling any of the unpleasant effects we were used to experiencing in the sea back home. When Jack reached the bottom, he grabbed the coral stems and crawled along on his hands and knees, peeking under the seaweed and among the rocks. I also saw him pick up a couple of large oysters and hold onto them, as if he planned to take them with him, so I gathered a few too. Suddenly, he lunged for a fish with blue and yellow stripes on its back and actually touched its tail but didn’t catch it. At that, he turned to me and tried to smile, but as soon as he did, he shot up to the surface like an arrow. When I followed him, I found him gasping and coughing, spitting water out of his mouth. A few minutes later, he recovered and we both turned to swim back to shore.

“I declare, Ralph,” said he, “that I actually tried to laugh under water.”

“I swear, Ralph,” he said, “that I actually tried to laugh underwater.”

“So I saw,” I replied; “and I observed that you very nearly caught that fish by the tail. It would have done capitally for breakfast if you had.”

“So I saw,” I replied; “and I noticed that you almost caught that fish by the tail. It would have made a great breakfast if you had.”

“Breakfast enough here,” said he, holding up the oysters, as we landed and ran up the beach. “Hallo! Peterkin, here you are, boy. Split open these fellows while Ralph and I put on our clothes. They’ll agree with the cocoa nuts excellently, I have no doubt.”

“Breakfast is ready here,” he said, holding up the oysters as we got off the boat and hurried up the beach. “Hey! Peterkin, there you are, buddy. Open these up while Ralph and I get dressed. I’m sure they’ll go perfectly with the coconuts.”

Peterkin, who was already dressed, took the oysters, and opened them with the edge of our axe, exclaiming, “Now, that is capital. There’s nothing I’m so fond of.”

Peterkin, already dressed, grabbed the oysters and opened them with the edge of our axe, exclaiming, “Now, that is great. There’s nothing I love more.”

“Ah! that’s lucky,” remarked Jack. “I’ll be able to keep you in good order now, Master Peterkin. You know you can’t dive any better than a cat. So, sir, whenever you behave ill, you shall have no oysters for breakfast.”

“Ah! that’s lucky,” Jack said. “I’ll be able to keep you in line now, Master Peterkin. You know you can’t dive any better than a cat. So, if you misbehave, you won’t be getting any oysters for breakfast.”

“I’m very glad that our prospect of breakfast is so good,” said I, “for I’m very hungry.”

“I’m really glad that our chance of having breakfast looks so good,” I said, “because I’m really hungry.”

“Here, then, stop your mouth with that, Ralph,” said Peterkin, holding a large oyster to my lips. I opened my mouth and swallowed it in silence, and really it was remarkably good.

“Here, then, shut your mouth with this, Ralph,” said Peterkin, holding a big oyster to my lips. I opened my mouth and swallowed it quietly, and honestly, it was surprisingly good.

We now set ourselves earnestly about our preparations for spending the day. We had no difficulty with the fire this morning, as our burning-glass was an admirable one; and while we roasted a few oysters and ate our cocoa nuts, we held a long, animated conversation about our plans for the future. What those plans were, and how we carried them into effect, the reader shall see hereafter.

We now focused seriously on getting ready for the day. We had no trouble with the fire this morning, thanks to our excellent burning glass; and while we roasted some oysters and ate our coconuts, we had a long, lively conversation about our future plans. The reader will find out what those plans were and how we put them into action later.

CHAPTER VI.

An excursion into the interior, in which we make many valuable and interesting discoveries—We get a dreadful fright—The bread-fruit tree—Wonderful peculiarity of some of the fruit trees—Signs of former inhabitants.

An adventure into the interior, where we make many valuable and interesting discoveries—We get a terrifying scare—The breadfruit tree—Amazing features of some of the fruit trees—Evidences of past inhabitants.

Our first care, after breakfast, was to place the few articles we possessed in the crevice of a rock at the farther end of a small cave which we discovered near our encampment. This cave, we hoped, might be useful to us afterwards as a store-house. Then we cut two large clubs off a species of very hard tree which grew near at hand. One of these was given to Peterkin, the other to me, and Jack armed himself with the axe. We took these precautions because we purposed to make an excursion to the top of the mountains of the interior, in order to obtain a better view of our island. Of course we knew not what dangers might befall us by the way, so thought it best to be prepared.

Our first priority, after breakfast, was to stash the few items we had in a crack in a rock at the far end of a small cave we found near our campsite. We hoped this cave could serve as a storage area for us later. Then we chopped off two large branches from a very tough tree that was growing nearby. One of these was handed to Peterkin, the other to me, while Jack took the axe. We took these precautions because we planned to hike to the top of the mountains inland to get a better view of our island. Of course, we had no idea what dangers might come our way, so we thought it was best to be prepared.

Having completed our arrangements and carefully extinguished our fire, we sallied forth and walked a short distance along the sea-beach, till we came to the entrance of a valley, through which flowed the rivulet before mentioned. Here we turned our backs on the sea and struck into the interior.

Having finished our preparations and carefully put out our fire, we headed out and walked a short distance along the beach until we reached the entrance of a valley, where the stream I mentioned earlier flowed. Here, we turned away from the sea and ventured deeper inland.

The prospect that burst upon our view on entering the valley was truly splendid. On either side of us there was a gentle rise in the land, which thus formed two ridges about a mile apart on each side of the valley. These ridges,—which, as well as the low grounds between them, were covered with trees and shrubs of the most luxuriant kind—continued to recede inland for about two miles, when they joined the foot of a small mountain. This hill rose rather abruptly from the head of the valley, and was likewise entirely covered even to the top with trees, except on one particular spot near the left shoulder, where was a bare and rocky place of a broken and savage character. Beyond this hill we could not see, and we therefore directed our course up the banks of the rivulet towards the foot of it, intending to climb to the top, should that be possible, as, indeed, we had no doubt it was.

The view that greeted us as we entered the valley was truly breathtaking. On either side, the land rose gently, forming two ridges about a mile apart. These ridges—and the lush lowlands in between—were covered with vibrant trees and shrubs. They continued to stretch inland for about two miles before meeting the base of a small mountain. This hill rose steeply at the head of the valley and was also completely covered in trees, except for one spot near the left side where there was a bare, rocky area that looked wild and rugged. Beyond this hill, we could see nothing, so we made our way up the banks of the stream toward its base, planning to climb to the top if possible, which we were confident it was.

Jack, being the wisest and boldest among us, took the lead, carrying the axe on his shoulder. Peterkin, with his enormous club, came second, as he said he should like to be in a position to defend me if any danger should threaten. I brought up the rear, but, having been more taken up with the wonderful and curious things I saw at starting than with thoughts of possible danger, I had very foolishly left my club behind me. Although, as I have said the trees and bushes were very luxuriant, they were not so thickly crowded together as to hinder our progress among them. We were able to wind in and out, and to follow the banks of the stream quite easily, although, it is true, the height and thickness of the foliage prevented us from seeing far ahead. But sometimes a jutting-out rock on the hill sides afforded us a position whence we could enjoy the romantic view and mark our progress towards the foot of the hill. I was particularly struck, during the walk, with the richness of the undergrowth in most places, and recognised many berries and plants that resembled those of my native land, especially a tall, elegantly-formed fern, which emitted an agreeable perfume. There were several kinds of flowers, too, but I did not see so many of these as I should have expected in such a climate. We also saw a great variety of small birds of bright plumage, and many paroquets similar to the one that awoke Peterkin so rudely in the morning.

Jack, the smartest and bravest of us, led the way, carrying the axe on his shoulder. Peterkin followed closely with his huge club, saying he wanted to be ready to protect me if any danger came up. I brought up the rear, but I had been so absorbed in the amazing sights at the start that I foolishly left my club behind. Even though, as I mentioned, the trees and bushes were lush, they weren’t so tightly packed that we couldn’t move through them. We could easily weave in and out and follow the banks of the stream, although the height and density of the foliage did prevent us from seeing very far ahead. Sometimes a protruding rock on the hillside gave us a spot from which we could take in the beautiful view and track our progress down the hill. I was particularly impressed by the richness of the undergrowth in many areas and noticed several berries and plants that reminded me of those from my homeland, especially a tall, elegantly shaped fern that had a pleasant scent. There were a few types of flowers as well, but not as many as I would have expected in this climate. We also spotted a wide variety of small birds with bright feathers, plus many parrots like the one that had startled Peterkin awake in the morning.

Thus we advanced to the foot of the hill without encountering anything to alarm us, except, indeed, once, when we were passing close under a part of the hill which was hidden from our view by the broad leaves of the banana trees, which grew in great luxuriance in that part. Jack was just preparing to force his way through this thicket, when we were startled and arrested by a strange pattering or rumbling sound, which appeared to us quite different from any of the sounds we had heard during the previous part of our walk.

Thus, we made our way to the bottom of the hill without running into anything that worried us, except for one time when we were walking right under a section of the hill that was blocked from our view by the large leaves of the banana trees, which were flourishing in that area. Jack was just about to push through this dense growth when we were taken aback and stopped by a peculiar pattering or rumbling noise that sounded completely different from anything we had heard earlier in our walk.

“Hallo!” cried Peterkin, stopping short and grasping his club with both hands, “what’s that?”

“Hey!” shouted Peterkin, stopping suddenly and grabbing his club with both hands, “what’s that?”

Neither of us replied; but Jack seized his axe in his right hand, while with the other he pushed aside the broad leaves and endeavoured to peer amongst them.

Neither of us said anything; but Jack grabbed his axe with one hand and used the other to push aside the broad leaves, trying to see through them.

“I can see nothing,” he said, after a short pause.

“I can’t see anything,” he said, after a brief pause.

“I think it—”

“I think it is—”

Again the rumbling sound came, louder than before, and we all sprang back and stood on the defensive. For myself, having forgotten my club, and not having taken the precaution to cut another, I buttoned my jacket, doubled my fists, and threw myself into a boxing attitude. I must say, however, that I felt somewhat uneasy; and my companions afterwards confessed that their thoughts at this moment had been instantly filled with all they had ever heard or read of wild beasts and savages, torturings at the stake, roastings alive, and such like horrible things. Suddenly the pattering noise increased with tenfold violence. It was followed by a fearful crash among the bushes, which was rapidly repeated, as if some gigantic animal were bounding towards us. In another moment an enormous rock came crashing through the shrubbery, followed by a cloud of dust and small stones, flew close past the spot where we stood, carrying bushes and young trees along with it.

Again, the rumbling sound came, louder than before, and we all jumped back and got ready to defend ourselves. I, having forgotten my club and not having bothered to find another, buttoned my jacket, clenched my fists, and assumed a boxing stance. I have to admit, though, that I felt pretty uneasy; my friends later admitted that their minds were instantly filled with everything they had ever heard or read about wild animals and savages, tortures at the stake, being roasted alive, and other horrific things. Suddenly, the pattering noise grew much louder. It was followed by a terrifying crash in the bushes, repeating rapidly, as if some gigantic animal was leaping towards us. In a moment, an enormous rock came crashing through the underbrush, followed by a cloud of dust and small stones, flying close past where we stood, taking bushes and young trees along with it.

“Pooh! is that all?” exclaimed Peterkin, wiping the perspiration off his forehead. “Why, I thought it was all the wild men and beasts in the South Sea Islands galloping on in one grand charge to sweep us off the face of the earth, instead of a mere stone tumbling down the mountain side.”

“Ugh! Is that it?” Peterkin shouted, wiping the sweat off his forehead. “I thought it was all the wild men and animals in the South Sea Islands charging at us to wipe us off the face of the earth, not just a rock rolling down the mountain.”

“Nevertheless,” remarked Jack, “if that same stone had hit any of us, it would have rendered the charge you speak of quite unnecessary, Peterkin.”

“Still,” Jack said, “if that same stone had hit any of us, it would have made the charge you’re talking about completely unnecessary, Peterkin.”

This was true, and I felt very thankful for our escape. On examining the spot more narrowly, we found that it lay close to the foot of a very rugged precipice, from which stones of various sizes were always tumbling at intervals. Indeed, the numerous fragments lying scattered all around might have suggested the cause of the sound, had we not been too suddenly alarmed to think of anything.

This was true, and I felt really grateful for our escape. When we looked more closely at the area, we noticed it was right at the base of a very steep cliff, from which rocks of different sizes were constantly falling at intervals. In fact, the many pieces scattered around might have hinted at the source of the noise, if we hadn't been too shaken to think of anything.

We now resumed our journey, resolving that, in our future excursions into the interior, we would be careful to avoid this dangerous precipice.

We continued our journey, making a promise that in our future trips into the interior, we would be cautious to steer clear of this dangerous cliff.

Soon afterwards we arrived at the foot of the hill and prepared to ascend it. Here Jack made a discovery which caused us all very great joy. This was a tree of a remarkably beautiful appearance, which Jack confidently declared to be the celebrated bread-fruit tree.

Soon after, we reached the bottom of the hill and got ready to climb it. This is when Jack made a discovery that filled us all with immense joy. He pointed out a tree that looked incredibly beautiful, which Jack confidently claimed was the famous breadfruit tree.

“Is it celebrated?” inquired Peterkin, with a look of great simplicity.

“Is it celebrated?” Peterkin asked, looking very simple.

“It is,” replied Jack

"Yeah," replied Jack

“That’s odd, now,” rejoined Peterkin; “never heard of it before.”

"That's weird, isn't it?" replied Peterkin. "I've never heard of that before."

“Then it’s not so celebrated as I thought it was,” returned Jack, quietly squeezing Peterkin’s hat over his eyes; “but listen, you ignorant boobie! and hear of it now.”

“Then it’s not as famous as I thought it was,” Jack replied, gently pushing Peterkin’s hat down over his eyes; “but listen, you clueless fool! and hear about it now.”

Peterkin re-adjusted his hat, and was soon listening with as much interest as myself, while Jack told us that this tree is one of the most valuable in the islands of the south; that it bears two, sometimes three, crops of fruit in the year; that the fruit is very like wheaten bread in appearance, and that it constitutes the principal food of many of the islanders.

Peterkin adjusted his hat and quickly became as interested as I was while Jack told us that this tree is one of the most valuable in the southern islands. He said it produces two or sometimes three crops of fruit each year, that the fruit looks a lot like wheat bread, and that it’s the main food for many of the islanders.

“So,” said Peterkin, “we seem to have everything ready prepared to our hands in this wonderful island,—lemonade ready bottled in nuts, and loaf-bread growing on the trees!”

“So,” said Peterkin, “it looks like we have everything set for us in this amazing island — lemonade already bottled in nuts, and loaf bread growing on the trees!”

Peterkin, as usual, was jesting; nevertheless, it is a curious fact that he spoke almost the literal truth. “Moreover,” continued Jack, “the bread-fruit tree affords a capital gum, which serves the natives for pitching their canoes; the bark of the young branches is made by them into cloth; and of the wood, which is durable and of a good colour, they build their houses. So you see, lads, that we have no lack of material here to make us comfortable, if we are only clever enough to use it.”

Peterkin, as always, was joking; still, it’s interesting that he was almost speaking the truth. “Also,” Jack went on, “the breadfruit tree provides a great resin that the locals use to waterproof their canoes; they make cloth from the bark of the young branches; and they construct their homes from the durable, nicely colored wood. So you see, guys, we have plenty of resources here to keep us comfortable if we just use them wisely.”

“But are you sure that that’s it?” asked Peterkin.

“But are you sure that’s all there is?” asked Peterkin.

“Quite sure,” replied Jack; “for I was particularly interested in the account I once read of it, and I remember the description well. I am sorry, however, that I have forgotten the descriptions of many other trees which I am sure we have seen to-day, if we could but recognise them. So you see, Peterkin, I’m not up to everything yet.”

“Of course,” Jack replied. “I was really interested in the account I read about it, and I remember the description clearly. I do wish, though, that I hadn’t forgotten the descriptions of many other trees we’ve seen today; I’m sure we could recognize them. So you see, Peterkin, I’m not an expert in everything just yet.”

“Never mind, Jack,” said Peterkin, with a grave, patronizing expression of countenance, patting his tall companion on the shoulder,—“never mind, Jack; you know a good deal for your age. You’re a clever boy, sir,—a promising young man; and if you only go on as you have begun, sir, you will—”

“It's okay, Jack,” said Peterkin, with a serious, condescending look on his face, patting his tall friend on the shoulder. “It's okay, Jack; you know a lot for your age. You’re a smart kid, really—a promising young man; and if you just keep going the way you’ve started, you will—”

The end of this speech was suddenly cut short by Jack tripping up Peterkin’s heels and tumbling him into a mass of thick shrubs, where, finding himself comfortable, he lay still basking in the sunshine, while Jack and I examined the bread-tree.

The end of this speech was suddenly interrupted when Jack tripped Peterkin, sending him tumbling into a thick patch of bushes. Once he landed comfortably, he lay still, soaking up the sunshine, while Jack and I checked out the bread-tree.

We were much struck with the deep, rich green colour of its broad leaves, which were twelve or eighteen inches long, deeply indented, and of a glossy smoothness, like the laurel. The fruit, with which it was loaded, was nearly round, and appeared to be about six inches in diameter, with a rough rind, marked with lozenge-shaped divisions. It was of various colours, from light pea-green to brown and rich yellow. Jack said that the yellow was the ripe fruit. We afterwards found that most of the fruit-trees on the island were evergreens, and that we might, when we wished, pluck the blossom and the ripe fruit from the same tree. Such a wonderful difference from the trees of our own country surprised us not a little. The bark of the tree was rough and light-coloured; the trunk was about two feet in diameter, and it appeared to be twenty feet high, being quite destitute of branches up to that height, where it branched off into a beautiful and umbrageous head. We noticed that the fruit hung in clusters of twos and threes on the branches; but as we were anxious to get to the top of the hill, we refrained from attempting to pluck any at that time.

We were really impressed by the deep, rich green color of its broad leaves, which were twelve to eighteen inches long, deeply indented, and had a glossy smoothness, similar to laurel leaves. The fruit, which weighed down the branches, was nearly round and seemed to be about six inches in diameter, with a rough skin divided into lozenge-shaped sections. It came in various colors, from light pea-green to brown and rich yellow. Jack mentioned that the yellow ones were ripe. Later, we discovered that most of the fruit trees on the island were evergreens, allowing us to pick both blossoms and ripe fruit from the same tree whenever we wanted. We were quite surprised by how different they were from the trees in our own country. The bark of the tree was rough and light-colored; the trunk was about two feet wide and seemed to stand twenty feet tall, lacking branches until that height, where it branched into a beautiful, leafy canopy. We noticed that the fruit hung in clusters of two or three on the branches, but since we were eager to reach the top of the hill, we decided not to try and pick any at that moment.

Our hearts were now very much cheered by our good fortune, and it was with light and active steps that we clambered up the steep sides of the hill. On reaching the summit, a new, and if possible a grander, prospect met our gaze. We found that this was not the highest part of the island, but that another hill lay beyond, with a wide valley between it and the one on which we stood. This valley, like the first, was also full of rich trees, some dark and some light green, some heavy and thick in foliage, and others light, feathery, and graceful, while the beautiful blossoms on many of them threw a sort of rainbow tint over all, and gave to the valley the appearance of a garden of flowers. Among these we recognised many of the bread-fruit trees, laden with yellow fruit, and also a great many cocoa-nut palms. After gazing our fill we pushed down the hill side, crossed the valley, and soon began to ascend the second mountain. It was clothed with trees nearly to the top, but the summit was bare, and in some places broken.

Our hearts were now really lifted by our good fortune, and we climbed up the steep sides of the hill with light, energetic steps. When we reached the top, a new and perhaps even more impressive view greeted us. We discovered that this was not the highest point on the island; another hill lay ahead, separated from us by a wide valley. This valley, like the first, was full of lush trees—some dark, some light green, some thick and leafy, and others delicate, feather-like, and graceful. The beautiful blossoms on many of the trees added a rainbow-like color to everything, making the valley look like a flower garden. Among these trees, we recognized many breadfruit trees loaded with yellow fruit, as well as a lot of coconut palms. After enjoying the view, we made our way down the hillside, crossed the valley, and soon started to climb the second mountain. It was covered in trees nearly all the way to the top, but the summit was bare and jagged in some spots.

While on our way up we came to an object which filled us with much interest. This was the stump of a tree that had evidently been cut down with an axe! So, then, we were not the first who had viewed this beautiful isle. The hand of man had been at work there before us. It now began to recur to us again that perhaps the island was inhabited, although we had not seen any traces of man until now; but a second glance at the stump convinced us that we had not more reason to think so now than formerly; for the surface of the wood was quite decayed, and partly covered with fungus and green matter, so that it must have been cut many years ago.

While we were making our way up, we came across something that really caught our interest. It was the stump of a tree that had clearly been chopped down with an axe! So, we realized we weren't the first ones to explore this beautiful island. Someone had been there before us. It started to dawn on us again that maybe the island was inhabited, even though we hadn’t seen any signs of human presence until now. But a second look at the stump assured us that we had no more reason to believe that than before; the wood was pretty decayed and partly covered with fungus and green growth, indicating it had been cut down many years ago.

“Perhaps,” said Peterkin, “some ship or other has touched here long ago for wood, and only taken one tree.”

“Maybe,” said Peterkin, “some ship came here a long time ago for wood and only took one tree.”

We did not think this likely, however, because, in such circumstances, the crew of a ship would cut wood of small size, and near the shore, whereas this was a large tree and stood near the top of the mountain. In fact it was the highest large tree on the mountain, all above it being wood of very recent growth.

We didn't think this was very likely, because, in situations like this, a ship's crew would typically chop down small trees close to the shore. But this was a large tree, and it was located near the top of the mountain. In fact, it was the tallest large tree on the mountain, with all the trees above it being very new growth.

“I can’t understand it,” said Jack, scratching the surface of the stump with his axe. “I can only suppose that the savages have been here and cut it for some purpose known only to themselves. But, hallo! what have we here?”

“I can’t get it,” said Jack, scratching the stump's surface with his axe. “I can only guess that the savages have been here and chopped it down for some reason known only to them. But, hey! what do we have here?”

As he spoke, Jack began carefully to scrape away the moss and fungus from the stump, and soon laid bare three distinct traces of marks, as if some inscription or initials had been cut thereon. But although the traces were distinct, beyond all doubt, the exact form of the letters could not be made out. Jack thought they looked like J. S. but we could not be certain. They had apparently been carelessly cut, and long exposure to the weather had so broken them up that we could not make out what they were. We were exceedingly perplexed at this discovery, and stayed a long time at the place conjecturing what these marks could have been, but without avail; so, as the day was advancing, we left it and quickly reached the top of the mountain.

As he spoke, Jack started carefully scraping away the moss and fungus from the stump, and soon revealed three distinct markings, as if some inscription or initials had been carved into it. But even though the markings were clear, we couldn't make out the exact shape of the letters. Jack thought they looked like J. S., but we couldn't be sure. They seemed to have been cut carelessly, and long exposure to the weather had deteriorated them so much that we couldn't figure out what they were. We were really puzzled by this discovery and spent a long time there speculating about what these marks could have meant, but to no avail. So, with the day getting on, we left and quickly made our way to the top of the mountain.

We found this to be the highest point of the island, and from it we saw our kingdom lying, as it were, like a map around us. As I have always thought it impossible to get a thing properly into one’s understanding without comprehending it, I shall beg the reader’s patience for a little while I describe our island, thus, shortly:—

We found this to be the highest point of the island, and from it, we saw our kingdom spread out around us like a map. Since I've always believed that you can't truly understand something without seeing it for yourself, I ask for the reader's patience for a moment as I briefly describe our island:—

It consisted of two mountains; the one we guessed at 500 feet; the other, on which we stood, at 1000. Between these lay a rich, beautiful valley, as already said. This valley crossed the island from one end to the other, being high in the middle and sloping on each side towards the sea. The large mountain sloped, on the side farthest from where we had been wrecked, gradually towards the sea; but although, when viewed at a glance, it had thus a regular sloping appearance, a more careful observation showed that it was broken up into a multitude of very small vales, or rather dells and glens, intermingled with little rugged spots and small but abrupt precipices here and there, with rivulets tumbling over their edges and wandering down the slopes in little white streams, sometimes glistening among the broad leaves of the bread-fruit and cocoa-nut trees, or hid altogether beneath the rich underwood. At the base of this mountain lay a narrow bright green plain or meadow, which terminated abruptly at the shore. On the other side of the island, whence we had come, stood the smaller hill, at the foot of which diverged three valleys; one being that which we had ascended, with a smaller vale on each side of it, and separated from it by the two ridges before mentioned. In these smaller valleys there were no streams, but they were clothed with the same luxuriant vegetation.

It was made up of two mountains; one was about 500 feet high, while the one we were on was around 1000 feet. In between them was a beautiful, vibrant valley, as mentioned earlier. This valley stretched across the island from one end to the other, being elevated in the middle and sloping down toward the sea on both sides. The larger mountain sloped gradually toward the ocean on the side farthest from where we had been shipwrecked, giving it a smooth appearance at first glance. However, a closer look revealed it was broken up into many small valleys, or rather dells and glens, mixed with rocky patches and small, steep cliffs here and there, with streams cascading over their edges and meandering down the slopes in little white rivulets. Sometimes these streams sparkled among the broad leaves of the breadfruit and coconut trees or were completely hidden beneath the lush undergrowth. At the bottom of this mountain was a narrow, bright green meadow that ended sharply at the shoreline. On the other side of the island, where we had come from, stood the smaller hill, at the base of which three valleys branched off—one being the one we had come up, with a smaller valley on each side, separated by the two ridges mentioned earlier. In these smaller valleys, there were no streams, but they were covered in the same rich vegetation.

The diameter of the island seemed to be about ten miles, and, as it was almost circular in form, its circumference must have been thirty miles;—perhaps a little more, if allowance be made for the numerous bays and indentations of the shore. The entire island was belted by a beach of pure white sand, on which laved the gentle ripples of the lagoon. We now also observed that the coral reef completely encircled the island; but it varied its distance from it here and there, in some places being a mile from the beach, in others, a few hundred yards, but the average distance was half a mile. The reef lay very low, and the spray of the surf broke quite over it in many places. This surf never ceased its roar, for, however calm the weather might be, there is always a gentle swaying motion in the great Pacific, which, although scarce noticeable out at sea, reaches the shore at last in a huge billow. The water within the lagoon, as before said, was perfectly still. There were three narrow openings in the reef; one opposite each end of the valley which I have described as crossing the island; the other opposite our own valley, which we afterwards named the Valley of the Wreck. At each of these openings the reef rose into two small green islets, covered with bushes and having one or two cocoa-nut palms on each. These islets were very singular, and appeared as if planted expressly for the purpose of marking the channel into the lagoon. Our captain was making for one of these openings the day we were wrecked, and would have reached it too, I doubt not, had not the rudder been torn away. Within the lagoon were several pretty, low coral islands, just opposite our encampment; and, immediately beyond these, out at sea, lay about a dozen other islands, at various distances, from half a mile to ten miles; all of them, as far as we could discern, smaller than ours and apparently uninhabited. They seemed to be low coral islands, raised but little above the sea, yet covered with cocoa-nut trees.

The island's diameter seemed to be about ten miles, and since it was almost circular, its circumference must have been around thirty miles—maybe a little more considering the many bays and indentations along the shore. The entire island was surrounded by a beach of pure white sand, where the gentle ripples of the lagoon washed ashore. We also noticed that the coral reef completely encircled the island, though its distance from the shore varied. In some places, it was a mile away, while in others, it was just a few hundred yards, with an average distance of half a mile. The reef was very shallow, and the surf spray broke over it in many spots. This surf never stopped roaring because, no matter how calm the weather was, there was always a gentle swaying motion in the vast Pacific, which, although subtle out at sea, crashed ashore as a large wave. The water within the lagoon was completely still. There were three narrow openings in the reef: one at each end of the valley I mentioned that crosses the island, and the other opposite our valley, which we eventually named the Valley of the Wreck. At each of these openings, the reef rose to form two small green islets covered in bushes, with one or two coconut palms on each. These islets were quite unique, almost as if they were intentionally placed there to mark the channel into the lagoon. Our captain was heading toward one of these openings the day we were shipwrecked and would have made it too, I have no doubt, if the rudder hadn't been torn away. Inside the lagoon, there were several small, pretty coral islands right in front of our campsite; just beyond them, out at sea, lay about a dozen other islands, ranging in distance from half a mile to ten miles away—all of them, as far as we could see, smaller than ours and seemingly uninhabited. They appeared to be low coral islands, only slightly above sea level, yet covered with coconut trees.

All this we noted, and a great deal more, while we sat on the top of the mountain. After we had satisfied ourselves we prepared to return; but here again we discovered traces of the presence of man. These were a pole or staff and one or two pieces of wood which had been squared with an axe. All of these were, however, very much decayed, and they had evidently not been touched for many years.

All of this we observed, and much more, while we sat on top of the mountain. After we were satisfied, we got ready to head back; but once again we found signs that someone had been there. These included a pole or stick and one or two pieces of wood that had been chopped with an axe. However, all of these items were extremely decayed and clearly hadn’t been disturbed in many years.

Full of these discoveries we returned to our encampment. On the way we fell in with the traces of some four-footed animal, but whether old or of recent date none of us were able to guess. This also tended to raise our hopes of obtaining some animal food on the island, so we reached home in good spirits, quite prepared for supper, and highly satisfied with our excursion.

Full of these discoveries, we made our way back to our camp. Along the path, we came across the tracks of some four-legged animal, but none of us could tell if they were fresh or old. This also boosted our hopes of finding some animal food on the island, so we returned home in good spirits, ready for dinner, and very pleased with our outing.

After much discussion, in which Peterkin took the lead, we came to the conclusion that the island was uninhabited, and went to bed.

After a lot of talking, led by Peterkin, we decided that the island was empty and went to sleep.

CHAPTER VII.

Jack’s ingenuity—We get into difficulties about fishing, and get out of them by a method which gives us a cold bath—Horrible encounter with a shark.

Jack’s resourcefulness—We run into trouble while fishing, and we get out of it by taking a cold bath—Terrifying encounter with a shark.

For several days after the excursion related in the last chapter we did not wander far from our encampment, but gave ourselves up to forming plans for the future and making our present abode comfortable.

For several days after the trip described in the last chapter, we didn’t venture far from our campsite but focused on making plans for the future and making our current home comfortable.

There were various causes that induced this state of comparative inaction. In the first place, although everything around us was so delightful, and we could without difficulty obtain all that we required for our bodily comfort, we did not quite like the idea of settling down here for the rest of our lives, far away from our friends and our native land. To set energetically about preparations for a permanent residence seemed so like making up our minds to saying adieu to home and friends for ever, that we tacitly shrank from it and put off our preparations, for one reason and another, as long as we could. Then there was a little uncertainty still as to there being natives on the island, and we entertained a kind of faint hope that a ship might come and take us off. But as day after day passed, and neither savages nor ships appeared, we gave up all hope of an early deliverance and set diligently to work at our homestead.

There were several reasons for this state of relative inaction. First, even though everything around us was so beautiful, and we could easily get everything we needed for our comfort, we didn't really like the idea of settling down here for the rest of our lives, so far away from our friends and our homeland. Starting to prepare for a permanent stay felt too much like deciding to say goodbye to home and friends forever, so we hesitated and postponed our preparations for various reasons as long as we could. Then, there was still some uncertainty about whether there were natives on the island, and we held onto a faint hope that a ship might come and take us away. But as days turned into weeks, and neither savages nor ships showed up, we lost all hope of a quick escape and got to work on our homestead.

During this time, however, we had not been altogether idle. We made several experiments in cooking the cocoa-nut, most of which did not improve it. Then we removed our goods, and took up our abode in the cave, but found the change so bad that we returned gladly to the bower. Besides this we bathed very frequently, and talked a great deal; at least Jack and Peterkin did,—I listened. Among other useful things, Jack, who was ever the most active and diligent, converted about three inches of the hoop-iron into an excellent knife. First he beat it quite flat with the axe. Then he made a rude handle, and tied the hoop-iron to it with our piece of whip-cord, and ground it to an edge on a piece of sand-stone. When it was finished he used it to shape a better handle, to which he fixed it with a strip of his cotton handkerchief;—in which operation he had, as Peterkin pointed out, torn off one of Lord Nelson’s noses. However, the whip-cord, thus set free, was used by Peterkin as a fishing line. He merely tied a piece of oyster to the end of it. This the fish were allowed to swallow, and then they were pulled quickly ashore. But as the line was very short and we had no boat, the fish we caught were exceedingly small.

During this time, though, we hadn't been completely inactive. We tried several methods for cooking the coconut, most of which didn’t improve it. Then we moved our stuff and settled into the cave, but found it so uncomfortable that we happily returned to the bower. Besides that, we bathed often and chatted a lot; at least Jack and Peterkin did—I just listened. Among other useful things, Jack, who was always the most energetic and hardworking, turned about three inches of hoop iron into a great knife. First, he hammered it flat with the axe. Then, he made a basic handle and tied the hoop iron to it with our piece of whip cord, and sharpened it on a piece of sandstone. Once it was done, he used it to shape a better handle, to which he attached it with a strip of his cotton handkerchief;—in this process, as Peterkin pointed out, he had accidentally torn off one of Lord Nelson’s noses. However, the whip cord, now free, was used by Peterkin as a fishing line. He simply tied a piece of oyster to the end of it. The fish were allowed to swallow it, and then we quickly pulled them ashore. But since the line was very short and we had no boat, the fish we caught were really small.

One day Peterkin came up from the beach, where he had been angling, and said in a very cross tone, “I’ll tell you what, Jack, I’m not going to be humbugged with catching such contemptible things any longer. I want you to swim out with me on your back, and let me fish in deep water!”

One day, Peterkin came back from the beach, where he had been fishing, and said in a very annoyed tone, “I’ll tell you what, Jack, I’m done being tricked into catching such worthless things. I want you to swim out with me on your back and let me fish in deeper water!”

“Dear me, Peterkin,” replied Jack, “I had no idea you were taking the thing so much to heart, else I would have got you out of that difficulty long ago. Let me see,”—and Jack looked down at a piece of timber on which he had been labouring, with a peculiar gaze of abstraction, which he always assumed when trying to invent or discover anything.

“Wow, Peterkin,” Jack said, “I had no clue you were feeling so bad about this; otherwise, I would have helped you out of that mess a long time ago. Let me think,”—and Jack looked down at a piece of wood he had been working on, with that focused expression he always got when he was trying to invent or figure something out.

“What say you to building a boat?” he inquired, looking up hastily.

“What do you think about building a boat?” he asked, looking up quickly.

“Take far too long,” was the reply; “can’t be bothered waiting. I want to begin at once!”

“Take way too long,” was the reply; “can’t be bothered waiting. I want to start right now!”

Again Jack considered. “I have it!” he cried. “We’ll fell a large tree and launch the trunk of it in the water, so that when you want to fish you’ve nothing to do but to swim out to it.”

Again, Jack thought for a moment. “I've got it!” he exclaimed. “We’ll cut down a big tree and put its trunk in the water, so when you want to fish, all you have to do is swim out to it.”

“Would not a small raft do better?” said I.

“Wouldn't a small raft be better?” I said.

“Much better; but we have no ropes to bind it together with. Perhaps we may find something hereafter that will do as well, but, in the meantime, let us try the tree.”

“Much better; but we don’t have any ropes to tie it together. Maybe we’ll find something later that will work, but for now, let’s try the tree.”

This was agreed on, so we started off to a spot not far distant, where we knew of a tree that would suit us, which grew near the water’s edge. As soon as we reached it Jack threw off his coat, and, wielding the axe with his sturdy arms, hacked and hewed at it for a quarter of an hour without stopping. Then he paused, and, while he sat down to rest, I continued the work. Then Peterkin made a vigorous attack on it, so that when Jack renewed his powerful blows, a few minutes cutting brought it down with a terrible crash.

This was agreed upon, so we headed to a nearby spot where we knew of a tree that would work for us, situated by the water's edge. Once we got there, Jack took off his coat and, with his strong arms, swung the axe at it for about fifteen minutes without stopping. Then he took a break, and while he rested, I kept working. After that, Peterkin joined in with a strong effort, and when Jack started striking again, just a few minutes of chopping brought the tree down with a loud crash.

“Hurrah! now for it,” cried Jack; “let us off with its head.”

“Yay! Let’s do it,” shouted Jack; “let’s chop its head off.”

So saying he began to cut through the stem again, at about six yards from the thick end. This done, he cut three strong, short poles or levers from the stout branches, with which to roll the log down the beach into the sea; for, as it was nearly two feet thick at the large end, we could not move it without such helps. With the levers, however, we rolled it slowly into the sea.

So saying, he started to cut through the stem again, about six yards from the thick end. Once that was done, he cut three strong, short poles or levers from the thick branches to roll the log down the beach into the sea; since it was almost two feet thick at the large end, we couldn't move it without those aids. With the levers, we slowly rolled it into the sea.

Having been thus successful in launching our vessel, we next shaped the levers into rude oars or paddles, and then attempted to embark. This was easy enough to do; but, after seating ourselves astride the log, it was with the utmost difficulty we kept it from rolling round and plunging us into the water. Not that we minded that much; but we preferred, if possible, to fish in dry clothes. To be sure, our trousers were necessarily wet, as our legs were dangling in the water on each side of the log; but, as they could be easily dried, we did not care. After half an hour’s practice, we became expert enough to keep our balance pretty steadily. Then Peterkin laid down his paddle, and having baited his line with a whole oyster, dropt it into deep water.

Having successfully launched our boat, we next shaped the levers into makeshift oars or paddles and then tried to get on board. This part was pretty easy, but once we sat astride the log, it was really challenging to keep it from rolling over and dumping us into the water. Not that we minded too much; we just preferred to fish without getting soaked if we could. Sure, our pants were wet since our legs were hanging in the water on either side of the log, but we could easily dry them, so it didn’t matter. After about half an hour of practice, we got good enough to maintain our balance pretty steadily. Then Peterkin set down his paddle, baited his line with a whole oyster, and dropped it into the deep water.

“Now, then, Jack,” said he, “be cautious; steer clear o’ that sea-weed. There; that’s it; gently, now, gently. I see a fellow at least a foot long down there, coming to—ha! that’s it! Oh! bother, he’s off.”

“Okay, Jack,” he said, “be careful; steer clear of that seaweed. There you go; nice and easy, now. I see a guy down there at least a foot long, coming in—ha! There! Oh! Damn, he got away.”

“Did he bite?” said Jack, urging the log onwards a little with his paddle.

“Did he bite?” Jack asked, pushing the log forward a bit with his paddle.

“Bite? ay! He took it into his mouth, but the moment I began to haul he opened his jaws and let it out again.”

“Bite? Yeah! He took it into his mouth, but as soon as I started to pull, he opened his jaws and let it go again.”

“Let him swallow it next time,” said Jack, laughing at the melancholy expression of Peterkin’s visage.

“Let him swallow it next time,” Jack said, laughing at the sad look on Peterkin’s face.

“There he’s again,” cried Peterkin, his eyes flashing with excitement. “Look out! Now then! No! Yes! No! Why, the brute won’t swallow it!”

“There he is again,” shouted Peterkin, his eyes bright with excitement. “Watch out! Now then! No! Yes! No! Why, the beast won’t swallow it!”

“Try to haul him up by the mouth, then,” cried Jack. “Do it gently.”

“Try to pull him up by the mouth, then,” Jack shouted. “Do it carefully.”

A heavy sigh and a look of blank despair showed that poor Peterkin had tried and failed again.

A deep sigh and a look of total despair revealed that poor Peterkin had tried and failed once more.

“Never mind, lad,” said Jack, in a voice of sympathy; “we’ll move on, and offer it to some other fish.” So saying, Jack plied his paddle; but scarcely had he moved from the spot, when a fish with an enormous head and a little body darted from under a rock and swallowed the bait at once.

“Don’t worry about it, kid,” Jack said sympathetically. “Let’s keep going and offer it to another fish.” With that, Jack started paddling, but just as he was leaving the spot, a fish with a huge head and a small body shot out from under a rock and swallowed the bait immediately.

“Got him this time,—that’s a fact!” cried Peterkin, hauling in the line. “He’s swallowed the bait right down to his tail, I declare. Oh what a thumper!”

“Got him this time—that’s for sure!” shouted Peterkin, pulling in the line. “He’s swallowed the bait all the way down to his tail, I swear. Oh what a whopper!”

As the fish came struggling to the surface, we leaned forward to see it, and overbalanced the log. Peterkin threw his arms round the fish’s neck; and, in another instant, we were all floundering in the water!

As the fish struggled to the surface, we leaned forward to get a better look and lost our balance on the log. Peterkin wrapped his arms around the fish's neck, and in a moment, we were all splashing in the water!

A shout of laughter burst from us as we rose to the surface like three drowned rats, and seized hold of the log. We soon recovered our position, and sat more warily, while Peterkin secured the fish, which had well-nigh escaped in the midst of our struggles. It was little worth having, however; but, as Peterkin remarked, it was better than the smouts he had been catching for the last two or three days; so we laid it on the log before us, and having re-baited the line, dropt it in again for another.

A burst of laughter came from us as we surfaced like three drowned rats and grabbed onto the log. We quickly regained our balance and sat more carefully while Peterkin secured the fish, which had almost gotten away during our struggles. It wasn't worth much, though; but, as Peterkin pointed out, it was better than the small fish he had been catching for the past couple of days. So, we placed it on the log in front of us, re-baited the line, and dropped it back in for another catch.

Now, while we were thus intent upon our sport, our attention was suddenly attracted by a ripple on the sea, just a few yards away from us. Peterkin shouted to us to paddle in that direction, as he thought it was a big fish, and we might have a chance of catching it. But Jack, instead of complying, said, in a deep, earnest tone of voice, which I never before heard him use,—

Now, while we were focused on our fun, something caught our attention—a ripple in the sea, just a few yards away. Peterkin yelled at us to paddle over there, thinking it was a big fish, and we might get a shot at catching it. But Jack, instead of going along with it, said in a deep, serious tone that I had never heard from him before,—

“Haul up your line, Peterkin; seize your paddle; quick,—it’s a shark!”

“Pull up your line, Peterkin; grab your paddle; hurry—it’s a shark!”

The horror with which we heard this may well be imagined, for it must be remembered that our legs were hanging down in the water, and we could not venture to pull them up without upsetting the log. Peterkin instantly hauled up the line; and, grasping his paddle, exerted himself to the utmost, while we also did our best to make for shore. But we were a good way off, and the log being, as I have before said, very heavy, moved but slowly through the water. We now saw the shark quite distinctly swimming round and round us, its sharp fin every now and then protruding above the water. From its active and unsteady motions, Jack knew it was making up its mind to attack us, so he urged us vehemently to paddle for our lives, while he himself set us the example. Suddenly he shouted “Look out!—there he comes!” and in a second we saw the monstrous fish dive close under us, and turn half over on his side. But we all made a great commotion with our paddles, which no doubt frightened it away for that time, as we saw it immediately after circling round us as before.

The fright we felt when we heard this is hard to describe, considering our legs were dangling in the water, and we couldn’t pull them up without tipping the log. Peterkin quickly pulled in the line and grabbed his paddle, doing his best to paddle while we all tried hard to reach the shore. But we were still quite far away, and the log, as I mentioned before, was really heavy, so it moved slowly through the water. We could now see the shark clearly swimming around us, its sharp fin occasionally breaking the surface. From its quick and erratic movements, Jack realized it was thinking about attacking us, so he urged us strongly to paddle for our lives, setting an example by paddling himself. Suddenly he shouted, “Watch out!—here it comes!” and in an instant, we saw the huge fish dive just beneath us, turning partially on its side. But we all created a big splash with our paddles, which probably scared it off for the moment, as we soon saw it circling around us again as before.

“Throw the fish to him,” cried Jack, in a quick, suppressed voice; “we’ll make the shore in time yet if we can keep him off for a few minutes.”

“Throw the fish to him,” Jack said urgently, his voice low; “we’ll reach the shore in time if we can hold him off for a few more minutes.”

Peterkin stopped one instant to obey the command, and then plied his paddle again with all his might. No sooner had the fish fallen on the water than we observed the shark to sink. In another second we saw its white breast rising; for sharks always turn over on their sides when about to seize their prey, their mouths being not at the point of their heads like those of other fish, but, as it were, under their chins. In another moment his snout rose above the water,—his wide jaws, armed with a terrific double row of teeth, appeared. The dead fish was engulfed, and the shark sank out of sight. But Jack was mistaken in supposing that it would be satisfied. In a very few minutes it returned to us, and its quick motions led us to fear that it would attack us at once.

Peterkin paused for a moment to follow the command, then started paddling with all his strength again. As soon as the fish hit the water, we noticed the shark diving down. A second later, we saw its white belly surfacing because sharks always flip onto their sides when they’re about to snap up their prey; their mouths are not at the front like those of other fish, but underneath their chins. In another moment, its snout broke the surface—its wide jaws, lined with a terrifying double row of teeth, became visible. The dead fish was swallowed whole, and the shark disappeared from view. But Jack was wrong to think it would be satisfied. Just a few minutes later, it came back to us, and its quick movements made us fear it would attack us right away.

“Stop paddling,” cried Jack suddenly. “I see it coming up behind us. Now, obey my orders quickly. Our lives may depend on it Ralph. Peterkin, do your best to balance the log. Don’t look out for the shark. Don’t glance behind you. Do nothing but balance the log.”

“Stop paddling,” Jack suddenly shouted. “I see it coming up behind us. Now, follow my orders quickly. Our lives might depend on it, Ralph. Peterkin, do your best to balance the log. Don’t look out for the shark. Don’t glance behind you. Just focus on balancing the log.”

Peterkin and I instantly did as we were ordered, being only too glad to do anything that afforded us a chance or a hope of escape, for we had implicit confidence in Jack’s courage and wisdom. For a few seconds, that seemed long minutes to my mind, we sat thus silently; but I could not resist glancing backward, despite the orders to the contrary. On doing so, I saw Jack sitting rigid like a statue, with his paddle raised, his lips compressed, and his eye-brows bent over his eyes, which glared savagely from beneath them down into the water. I also saw the shark, to my horror, quite close under the log, in the act of darting towards Jack’s foot. I could scarce suppress a cry on beholding this. In another moment the shark rose. Jack drew his leg suddenly from the water, and threw it over the log. The monster’s snout rubbed against the log as it passed, and revealed its hideous jaws, into which Jack instantly plunged the paddle, and thrust it down its throat. So violent was the act that Jack rose to his feet in performing it; the log was thereby rolled completely over, and we were once more plunged into the water. We all rose, spluttering and gasping, in a moment.

Peterkin and I quickly did what we were told, eager to do anything that gave us a chance or hope of escaping, because we completely trusted Jack’s bravery and smarts. For a few seconds, which felt like long minutes to me, we sat there in silence; but I couldn’t help glancing back, even though we were instructed not to. When I looked, I saw Jack sitting rigid like a statue, his paddle raised, lips pressed together, and his eyebrows lowered over his eyes, which were glaring fiercely from beneath them into the water. I was horrified to see the shark, close to the log, preparing to dart towards Jack’s foot. I could barely suppress a scream at the sight. In another moment, the shark surfaced. Jack suddenly pulled his leg out of the water and swung it over the log. The shark’s snout brushed against the log as it passed, exposing its terrifying jaws, into which Jack quickly thrust the paddle and pushed it down its throat. The force of the action made Jack rise to his feet while doing it; this rolled the log completely over, and we were once again plunged into the water. We all emerged spluttering and gasping a moment later.

“Now then, strike out for shore,” cried Jack. “Here, Peterkin, catch hold of my collar, and kick out with a will.”

“Alright, head for the shore,” shouted Jack. “Hey, Peterkin, grab my collar and kick hard.”

Peterkin did as he was desired, and Jack struck out with such force that he cut through the water like a boat; while I, being free from all encumbrance, succeeded in keeping up with him. As we had by this time drawn pretty near to the shore, a few minutes more sufficed to carry us into shallow water; and, finally, we landed in safety, though very much exhausted, and not a little frightened by our terrible adventure.

Peterkin did what he was asked, and Jack swam with such power that he glided through the water like a boat; meanwhile, I, being unburdened, managed to keep pace with him. By this time, we had gotten pretty close to the shore, and a few more minutes were enough to bring us into shallow water; ultimately, we landed safely, though we were extremely tired and somewhat scared by our frightening experience.

CHAPTER VIII.

The beauties of the bottom of the sea tempt Peterkin to dive—How he did it—More difficulties overcome—The water garden—Curious creatures of the sea—The tank—Candles missed very much, and the candle-nut tree discovered—Wonderful account of Peterkin’s first voyage—Cloth found growing on a tree—A plan projected, and arms prepared for offence and defence—A dreadful cry.

The wonders of the ocean floor invite Peterkin to dive—How he accomplished it—More challenges faced—The underwater garden—Strange sea creatures—The tank—Candles greatly missed, and the discovery of the candle-nut tree—An amazing story of Peterkin’s first voyage—Fabric found growing on a tree—A plan developed, and weapons ready for attack and defense—A terrifying scream.

Our encounter with the shark was the first great danger that had befallen us since landing on this island, and we felt very seriously affected by it, especially when we considered that we had so often unwittingly incurred the same danger before while bathing. We were now forced to take to fishing again in the shallow water, until we should succeed in constructing a raft. What troubled us most, however, was, that we were compelled to forego our morning swimming excursions. We did, indeed, continue to enjoy our bathe in the shallow water, but Jack and I found that one great source of our enjoyment was gone, when we could no longer dive down among the beautiful coral groves at the bottom of the lagoon. We had come to be so fond of this exercise, and to take such an interest in watching the formations of coral and the gambols of the many beautiful fish amongst the forests of red and green sea-weeds, that we had become quite familiar with the appearance of the fish and the localities that they chiefly haunted. We had also become expert divers. But we made it a rule never to stay long under water at a time. Jack told me that to do so often was bad for the lungs, and, instead of affording us enjoyment, would ere long do us a serious injury. So we never stayed at the bottom as long as we might have done, but came up frequently to the top for fresh air, and dived down again immediately. Sometimes, when Jack happened to be in a humorous frame, he would seat himself at the bottom of the sea on one of the brain corals, as if he were seated on a large paddock-stool, and then make faces at me, in order, if possible, to make me laugh under water. At first, when he took me unawares, he nearly succeeded, and I had to shoot to the surface in order to laugh; but afterwards I became aware of his intentions, and, being naturally of a grave disposition, I had no difficulty in restraining myself. I used often to wonder how poor Peterkin would have liked to be with us; and he sometimes expressed much regret at being unable to join us. I used to do my best to gratify him, poor fellow, by relating all the wonders that we saw; but this, instead of satisfying, seemed only to whet his curiosity the more, so one day we prevailed on him to try to go down with us. But, although a brave boy in every other way, Peterkin was very nervous in the water, and it was with difficulty we got him to consent to be taken down, for he could never have managed to push himself down to the bottom without assistance. But no sooner had we pulled him down a yard or so into the deep clear water, than he began to struggle and kick violently, so we were forced to let him go, when he rose out of the water like a cork, gave a loud gasp and a frightful roar, and struck out for the land with the utmost possible haste.

Our encounter with the shark was the first major danger we faced since landing on this island, and it really affected us, especially considering how often we had unknowingly put ourselves in the same situation while swimming. We were now forced to go back to fishing in the shallow water until we could build a raft. What bothered us the most, though, was that we had to give up our morning swimming sessions. We still enjoyed splashing around in the shallow water, but Jack and I felt that a big part of our fun was gone since we could no longer dive into the stunning coral groves at the bottom of the lagoon. We had grown quite fond of this activity and had become very interested in observing the formations of coral and the playful movements of the many beautiful fish among the forests of red and green seaweeds. We had even become skilled divers. But we made it a rule not to stay underwater for too long. Jack told me that staying down too long was bad for our lungs and could eventually cause us harm instead of pleasure. So, we never lingered on the bottom for as long as we could have; we came up frequently for fresh air and immediately dove back down. Sometimes, when Jack was feeling playful, he would sit on one of the brain corals at the bottom of the sea as if he were sitting on a big stool and then make faces at me to try and make me laugh underwater. At first, when he caught me off guard, he almost succeeded, and I had to shoot up to the surface to laugh; but after a while, I figured out what he was up to, and being naturally serious, I found it easy to hold back my laughter. I often wondered how poor Peterkin would have liked to be with us; he sometimes expressed a lot of regret about not being able to join us. I tried my best to entertain him by sharing all the amazing things we saw, but instead of satisfying him, it only made him more curious. So one day, we convinced him to try to come down with us. But even though he was brave in every other way, Peterkin was very nervous around water, and it took a lot of convincing to get him to agree to be taken down, since he could never have pushed himself down to the bottom without help. However, as soon as we pulled him down a yard or so into the clear deep water, he started to struggle and kick wildly, so we had to let him go, and he shot up to the surface like a cork, gasping loudly and letting out a terrified scream before swimming back to land as fast as he could.

Now, all this pleasure we were to forego, and when we thought thereon, Jack and I felt very much depressed in our spirits. I could see, also, that Peterkin grieved and sympathized with us, for, when talking about this matter, he refrained from jesting and bantering us upon it.

Now, all this enjoyment we were going to miss, and when we thought about it, Jack and I felt really down. I could tell that Peterkin was upset and felt for us too, because when we talked about it, he held back from joking and teasing us.

As, however, a man’s difficulties usually set him upon devising methods to overcome them, whereby he often discovers better things than those he may have lost, so this our difficulty induced us to think of searching for a large pool among the rocks, where the water should be deep enough for diving yet so surrounded by rocks as to prevent sharks from getting at us. And such a pool we afterwards found, which proved to be very much better than our most sanguine hopes anticipated. It was situated not more than ten minutes’ walk from our camp, and was in the form of a small deep bay or basin, the entrance to which, besides being narrow, was so shallow that no fish so large as a shark could get in, at least not unless he should be a remarkably thin one.

As a man's challenges often push him to come up with solutions, leading him to discover even better things than what he may have lost, our own difficulty inspired us to look for a large pool among the rocks. We hoped to find water deep enough for diving but surrounded by rocks to keep sharks away. Eventually, we did find such a pool, and it turned out to be much better than we had hoped. It was located no more than a ten-minute walk from our camp and had the shape of a small, deep bay or basin. The entrance was not only narrow but also shallow enough that no fish larger than a shark could get through, at least not unless it was a particularly thin one.

Inside of this basin, which we called our Water Garden, the coral formations were much more wonderful, and the sea-weed plants far more lovely and vividly coloured, than in the lagoon itself. And the water was so clear and still, that, although very deep, you could see the minutest object at the bottom. Besides this, there was a ledge of rock which overhung the basin at its deepest part, from which we could dive pleasantly and whereon Peterkin could sit and see not only all the wonders I had described to him, but also see Jack and me creeping amongst the marine shrubbery at the bottom, like, as—he expressed it,—“two great white sea-monsters.” During these excursions of ours to the bottom of the sea, we began to get an insight into the manners and customs of its inhabitants, and to make discoveries of wonderful things, the like of which we never before conceived. Among other things, we were deeply interested with the operations of the little coral insect which, I was informed by Jack, is supposed to have entirely constructed many of the numerous islands in Pacific Ocean. And, certainly, when we considered the great reef which these insects had formed round the island on which we were cast, and observed their ceaseless activity in building their myriad cells, it did at first seem as if this might be true; but then, again, when I looked at the mountains of the island, and reflected that there were thousands of such, many of them much higher, in the South Seas, I doubted that there must be some mistake here. But more of this hereafter.

Inside this basin, which we called our Water Garden, the coral formations were much more amazing, and the seaweed plants much prettier and more vividly colored than in the lagoon itself. The water was so clear and still that, even though it was very deep, you could see the tiniest object at the bottom. On top of that, there was a rock ledge that hung over the basin at its deepest part, from which we could dive happily, and where Peterkin could sit and see not only all the wonders I had described to him but also watch Jack and me sneaking around among the marine plants at the bottom, like— as he put it— "two great white sea monsters." During these trips to the ocean floor, we began to learn about the habits and customs of its inhabitants and discovered incredible things that we had never imagined before. One of the things that really fascinated us was the work of the tiny coral insect, which, according to Jack, is believed to have built many of the numerous islands in the Pacific Ocean. And certainly, when we thought about the huge reef that these insects had created around the island where we found ourselves, and watched their endless work building their countless cells, it initially seemed plausible; but then, when I looked at the mountains of the island and realized that there are thousands of such islands, many of them much taller, in the South Seas, I began to doubt that there could be any truth to it. But more on that later.

I also became much taken up with the manners and appearance of the anemones, and star-fish, and crabs, and sea-urchins, and such-like creatures; and was not content with watching those I saw during my dives in the Water Garden, but I must needs scoop out a hole in the coral rock close to it, which I filled with salt water, and stocked with sundry specimens of anemones and shell-fish, in order to watch more closely how they were in the habit of passing their time. Our burning-glass also now became a great treasure to me, as it enabled me to magnify, and so to perceive more clearly the forms and actions of these curious creatures of the deep.

I also got really interested in the behaviors and appearances of anemones, starfish, crabs, sea urchins, and similar creatures. I wasn’t satisfied just watching those I saw while diving in the Water Garden; I felt the need to dig a hole in the coral rock nearby, which I filled with saltwater and stocked with various specimens of anemones and shellfish, so I could observe how they spent their time more closely. My burning glass also became a valuable tool for me, as it allowed me to magnify and better see the shapes and actions of these fascinating deep-sea creatures.

Having now got ourselves into a very comfortable condition, we began to talk of a project which we had long had in contemplation,—namely, to travel entirely round the island; in order, first, to ascertain whether it contained any other productions which might be useful to us; and, second, to see whether there might be any place more convenient and suitable for our permanent residence than that on which we were now encamped. Not that we were in any degree dissatisfied with it; on the contrary, we entertained quite a home-feeling to our bower and its neighbourhood; but if a better place did exist, there was no reason why we should not make use of it. At any rate, it would be well to know of its existence.

Having settled into a really comfortable situation, we started discussing a plan we had been thinking about for a while—specifically, to circle the entire island. The goals were twofold: first, to find out if there were any other resources that could be useful to us, and second, to see if there might be a better spot for our permanent home than where we were currently camped. Not that we were unhappy with our current location; on the contrary, we felt quite at home in our shelter and its surroundings. But if a better place was out there, we should definitely consider it. At the very least, it would be good to know if it existed.

We had much earnest talk over this matter. But Jack proposed that, before undertaking such an excursion, we should supply ourselves with good defensive arms, for, as we intended not only to go round all the shore, but to ascend most of the valleys, before returning home, we should be likely to meet in with, he would not say dangers, but, at least, with everything that existed on the island, whatever that might be.

We had a lot of serious conversations about this issue. But Jack suggested that before we went on such a trip, we should equip ourselves with proper defensive gear, since we planned not only to explore the entire shore but also to climb most of the valleys before heading back home. He thought we might encounter, he wouldn’t call them dangers, but at least everything that was on the island, whatever that might be.

“Besides,” said Jack, “it won’t do for us to live on cocoa-nuts and oysters always. No doubt they are very excellent in their way, but I think a little animal food, now and then, would be agreeable as well as good for us; and as there are many small birds among the trees, some of which are probably very good to eat, I think it would be a capital plan to make bows and arrows, with which we could easily knock them over.”

“Besides,” Jack said, “we can't live on just coconuts and oysters all the time. They're great in their own way, but I think a little meat now and then would be nice and better for us; and since there are a lot of small birds in the trees, some of which are probably tasty, I think it would be a great idea to make bows and arrows so we could easily catch them.”

“First rate!” cried Peterkin. “You will make the bows, Jack, and I’ll try my hand at the arrows. The fact is, I’m quite tired of throwing stones at the birds. I began the very day we landed, I think, and have persevered up to the present time, but I’ve never hit anything yet.”

“First rate!” shouted Peterkin. “You’ll make the bows, Jack, and I’ll give the arrows a shot. Honestly, I’m really tired of throwing stones at the birds. I think I started doing that the day we landed, and I’ve kept at it ever since, but I haven’t hit anything yet.”

“You forget,” said I, “you hit me one day on the shin.”

“You forgot,” I said, “you kicked me in the shin one day.”

“Ah, true,” replied Peterkin, “and a precious shindy you kicked up in consequence. But you were at least four yards away from the impudent paroquet I aimed at; so you see what a horribly bad shot I am.”

“Yeah, that's true,” replied Peterkin, “and you sure made a big fuss because of it. But you were at least four yards away from the cheeky parrot I was aiming at, so you can see how terribly I miss.”

“But,” said I, “Jack, you cannot make three bows and arrows before to-morrow, and would it not be a pity to waste time, now that we have made up our minds to go on this expedition? Suppose that you make one bow and arrow for yourself, and we can take our clubs?”

“But,” I said, “Jack, you can’t make three bows and arrows before tomorrow, and wouldn’t it be a shame to waste time now that we’ve decided to go on this adventure? How about you make one bow and arrow for yourself, and we can take our clubs?”

“That’s true, Ralph. The day is pretty far advanced, and I doubt if I can make even one bow before dark. To be sure I might work by fire-light, after the sun goes down.”

“That’s true, Ralph. The day is pretty far along, and I doubt I can make even one bow before dark. I could work by firelight after the sun goes down, though.”

We had, up to this time, been in the habit of going to bed with the sun, as we had no pressing call to work o’ nights; and, indeed, our work during the day was usually hard enough,—what between fishing, and improving our bower, and diving in the Water Garden, and rambling in the woods; so that, when night came, we were usually very glad to retire to our beds. But now that we had a desire to work at night, we felt a wish for candles.

We had, until now, been used to going to bed with the sun since we didn’t have any urgent need to work at night; and, honestly, our work during the day was usually tough—between fishing, fixing up our shelter, diving in the Water Garden, and wandering in the woods—so, by the time night came, we were typically pretty happy to go to bed. But now that we wanted to work at night, we had a desire for candles.

“Won’t a good blazing fire give you light enough?” inquired Peterkin.

“Won’t a nice, bright fire give you enough light?” Peterkin asked.

“Yes,” replied Jack, “quite enough; but then it will give us a great deal more than enough of heat in this warm climate of ours.”

“Yes,” replied Jack, “that’s definitely plenty; but it’s going to give us way more than enough heat in this warm climate of ours.”

“True,” said Peterkin; “I forgot that. It would roast us.”

“True,” said Peterkin; “I forgot that. It would roast us.”

“Well, as you’re always doing that at any rate,” remarked Jack, “we could scarcely call it a change. But the fact is, I’ve been thinking over this subject before. There is a certain nut growing in these islands which is called the candle-nut, because the natives use it instead of candles, and I know all about it, and how to prepare it for burning—”

“Well, since you’re always doing that anyway,” Jack said, “we can hardly call it a change. But the truth is, I’ve been thinking about this topic before. There’s a particular nut found in these islands called the candle-nut, because the locals use it as a substitute for candles, and I know all about it and how to prepare it for burning—”

“Then why don’t you do it?” interrupted Peterkin. “Why have you kept us in the dark so long, you vile philosopher?”

“Then why don’t you just do it?” interrupted Peterkin. “Why have you kept us in the dark for so long, you horrible philosopher?”

“Because,” said Jack, “I have not seen the tree yet, and I’m not sure that I should know either the tree or the nuts if I did see them. You see, I forget the description.”

“Because,” said Jack, “I haven't seen the tree yet, and I'm not sure I would recognize either the tree or the nuts if I did see them. You see, I forgot the description.”

“Ah! that’s just the way with me,” said Peterkin with a deep sigh. “I never could keep in my mind for half an hour the few descriptions I ever attempted to remember. The very first voyage I ever made was caused by my mistaking a description, or forgetting it, which is the same thing. And a horrible voyage it was. I had to fight with the captain the whole way out, and made the homeward voyage by swimming!”

“Ah! that’s just how I am,” Peterkin said with a deep sigh. “I’ve never been able to remember the few descriptions I tried to keep in my mind for even half an hour. The very first trip I ever took happened because I mixed up a description or forgot it, which is pretty much the same thing. And it was a terrible trip. I had to argue with the captain the entire way out, and I swam back home!”

“Come, Peterkin,” said I, “you can’t get even me to believe that.”

“Come on, Peterkin,” I said, “you can’t even get me to believe that.”

“Perhaps not, but it’s true, notwithstanding,” returned Peterkin, pretending to be hurt at my doubting his word.

“Maybe not, but it's true, regardless,” Peterkin replied, feigning offense at my skepticism about his word.

“Let us hear how it happened,” said Jack, while a good-natured smile overspread his face.

“Let’s hear how it went down,” said Jack, a friendly smile spreading across his face.

“Well, you must know,” began Peterkin, “that the very day before I went to sea, I was greatly taken up with a game at hockey, which I was playing with my old school-fellows for the last time before leaving them. You see I was young then, Ralph.” Peterkin gazed, in an abstracted and melancholy manner, out to sea! “Well, in the midst of the game, my uncle, who had taken all the bother and trouble of getting me bound ’prentice and rigged out, came and took me aside, and told me that he was called suddenly away from home, and would not be able to see me aboard, as he had intended. ‘However,’ said he, ‘the captain knows you are coming, so that’s not of much consequence; but as you’ll have to find the ship yourself, you must remember her name and description. D’ye hear, boy?’ I certainly did hear, but I’m afraid I did not understand, for my mind was so taken up with the game, which I saw my side was losing, that I began to grow impatient, and the moment my uncle finished his description of the ship, and bade me good-bye, I bolted back to my game, with only a confused idea of three masts, and a green painted tafferel, and a gilt figure-head of Hercules with his club at the bow. Next day I was so much cast down with everybody saying good-bye, and a lot o’ my female friends cryin’ horribly over me, that I did not start for the harbour, where the ship was lying among a thousand others, till it was almost too late. So I had to run the whole way. When I reached the pier, there were so many masts, and so much confusion, that I felt quite humblebumbled in my faculties. ‘Now,’ said I to myself, ‘Peterkin, you’re in a fix.’ Then I fancied I saw a gilt figure-head and three masts, belonging to a ship just about to start; so I darted on board, but speedily jumped on shore again, when I found that two of the masts belonged to another vessel, and the figurehead to a third! At last I caught sight of what I made sure was it,—a fine large vessel just casting off her moorings. The tafferel was green. Three masts,—yes, that must be it,—and the gilt figure-head of Hercules. To be sure it had a three-pronged pitchfork in its hand instead of a club; but that might be my uncle’s mistake; or perhaps Hercules sometimes varied his weapons. ‘Cast off!’ roared a voice from the quarter-deck. ‘Hold on!’ cried I, rushing frantically through the crowd. ‘Hold on! hold on!’ repeated some of the bystanders, while the men at the ropes delayed for a minute. This threw the captain into a frightful rage; for some of his friends had come down to see him off, and having his orders contradicted so flatly was too much for him. However, the delay was sufficient. I took a race and a good leap; the ropes were cast off; the steam-tug gave a puff, and we started. Suddenly the captain was up to me: ‘Where did you come from, you scamp, and what do you want here?’

“Well, you should know,” Peterkin started, “that the day before I went to sea, I was really into a game of hockey with my old school friends for the last time before leaving them. You see, I was young back then, Ralph.” Peterkin stared out to sea with a distant and sad look. “In the middle of the game, my uncle, who had gone through all the trouble of getting me apprenticed and equipped, pulled me aside and told me he had to leave home suddenly and wouldn’t be able to see me off as he planned. ‘However,’ he said, ‘the captain knows you’re coming, so that’s not a big deal; but since you’ll have to find the ship on your own, remember her name and what she looks like. Do you hear me, boy?’ I definitely heard, but I’m afraid I didn’t quite get it, because I was so focused on the game, which I saw my team was losing, that I became impatient. The moment my uncle finished describing the ship and said goodbye, I rushed back to the game, only vaguely remembering three masts, a green-painted tafferel, and a golden figurehead of Hercules with his club at the bow. The next day, I was so down with everyone saying goodbye and a bunch of my female friends crying horribly over me, that I didn’t leave for the harbor, where the ship was among a thousand others, until it was almost too late. So I had to run the whole way. When I reached the pier, there were so many masts and so much chaos that I felt completely overwhelmed. ‘Now,’ I told myself, ‘Peterkin, you’re in a jam.’ Then I thought I spotted a golden figurehead and three masts on a ship about to leave; so I dashed on board but quickly jumped back onto the shore when I realized two of the masts belonged to a different ship, and the figurehead was from another one! Finally, I saw what I was sure was it—a large, fine vessel just about to cast off her moorings. The tafferel was green. Three masts—yes, that must be it—and the golden figurehead of Hercules. Sure, it had a three-pronged pitchfork instead of a club; but that could’ve been my uncle’s mistake, or maybe Hercules occasionally changed his weapons. ‘Cast off!’ shouted a voice from the quarter-deck. ‘Wait!’ I yelled, frantically pushing through the crowd. ‘Wait! wait!’ some bystanders echoed, while the guys at the ropes hesitated for a moment. This made the captain furious, as some of his friends had come to see him off, and having his orders openly contradicted was too much for him. Still, the delay was just enough. I made a dash and a good leap; the ropes were cast off; the steam-tug puffed, and we were on our way. Suddenly, the captain confronted me: ‘Where did you come from, you rascal, and what do you want here?’

“‘Please, sir,’ said I, touching my cap, ‘I’m you’re new ’prentice come aboard.’

“‘Please, sir,’ I said, touching my cap, ‘I’m your new apprentice who just came aboard.’”

“‘New ’Prentice,’ said he, stamping, ‘I’ve got no new ’prentice. My boys are all aboard already. This is a trick, you young blackguard. You’ve run away, you have;’ and the captain stamped about the deck and swore dreadfully; for, you see, the thought of having to stop the ship and lower a boat and lose half an hour, all for the slake of sending a small boy ashore, seemed to make him very angry. Besides, it was blowin’ fresh outside the harbour, so that, to have let the steamer alongside to put me into it was no easy job. Just as we were passing the pier-head, where several boats were rowing into harbour, the captain came up to me,—

“‘New apprentice,’ he said, stamping his foot. ‘I don’t have any new apprentice. My boys are all on board already. This is a trick, you young scoundrel. You’ve run away, haven’t you?’ The captain paced around the deck and swore quite a bit because the idea of needing to stop the ship, lower a boat, and waste half an hour just to send a little boy ashore made him really angry. Plus, it was blowing pretty hard outside the harbor, so letting the steamer come alongside to put me into it was no easy task. Just as we were passing the pier head, where several boats were rowing into the harbor, the captain came up to me,—

“‘You’ve run away, you blackguard,’ he said, giving me a box on the ear.

“‘You’ve run away, you scoundrel,’ he said, slapping me on the ear.”

“‘No I haven’t,’ said I, angrily; for the box was by no means a light one.

“‘No, I haven’t,’ I said angrily, because the box was definitely not light.”

“Hark’ee, boy, can you swim?’

"Hey, boy, can you swim?"

“‘Yes,’ said I.

"‘Yes,’ I said."

“‘Then do it,’ and, seizing me by my trousers and the nape of my neck, he tossed me over the side into the sea. The fellows in the boats at the end of the pier, backed their oars on seeing this; but observing that I could swim, they allowed me to make the best of my way to the pier-head. So, you see, Ralph, that I really did swim my first homeward voyage.”

“‘Then go ahead,’ and, grabbing me by my pants and the back of my neck, he threw me over the side into the sea. The guys in the boats at the end of the pier pulled back their oars when they saw this; but noticing that I could swim, they let me make my way to the pier. So, you see, Ralph, I really did swim my first journey home.”

Jack laughed and patted Peterkin on the shoulder. “But tell us about the candle-nut tree,” said I; “you were talking about it.”

Jack laughed and patted Peterkin on the shoulder. “But tell us about the candle-nut tree,” I said; “you were talking about it.”

“Very true,” said Jack, “but I fear I can remember little about it. I believe the nut is about the size of a walnut; and I think that the leaves are white, but I am not sure.”

“Very true,” said Jack, “but I’m afraid I can remember very little about it. I think the nut is about the size of a walnut, and I believe the leaves are white, but I’m not sure.”

“Eh! ha! hum!” exclaimed Peterkin, “I saw a tree answering to that description this very day.”

“Hey! Ha! Huh!” exclaimed Peterkin, “I saw a tree that fits that description today.”

“Did you?” cried Jack. “Is it far from this?”

“Did you?” Jack shouted. “Is it far from here?”

“No, not half a mile.”

“No, not 0.5 miles.”

“Then lead me to it,” said Jack, seizing his axe.

“Then take me there,” said Jack, grabbing his axe.

In a few minutes we were all three pushing through the underwood of the forest, headed by Peterkin.

In just a few minutes, all three of us were pushing through the underbrush of the forest, led by Peterkin.

We soon came to the tree in question, which, after Jack had closely examined it, we concluded must be the candle-nut tree. Its leaves were of a beautiful silvery white, and formed a fine contrast to the dark-green foliage of the surrounding trees. We immediately filled our pockets with the nuts, after which Jack said,—

We quickly reached the tree we were talking about, and after Jack took a good look at it, we figured it had to be the candle-nut tree. Its leaves were a stunning silvery white, creating a great contrast with the dark green leaves of the nearby trees. We instantly filled our pockets with the nuts, and then Jack said,—

“Now, Peterkin, climb that cocoa-nut tree and cut me one of the long branches.”

“Now, Peterkin, climb that coconut tree and get me one of those long branches.”

This was soon done, but it cost some trouble, for the stem was very high, and as Peterkin usually pulled nuts from the younger trees, he was not much accustomed to climbing the high ones. The leaf or branch was a very large one, and we were surprised at its size and strength. Viewed from a little distance, the cocoa-nut tree seems to be a tall, straight stem, without a single branch except at the top, where there is a tuft of feathery-looking leaves, that seem to wave like soft plumes in the wind. But when we saw one of these leaves or branches at our feet, we found it to be a strong stalk, about fifteen feet long, with a number of narrow, pointed leaflets ranged alternately on each side. But what seemed to us the most wonderful thing about it was a curious substance resembling cloth, which was wrapped round the thick end of the stalk, where it had been cut from the tree. Peterkin told us that he had the greatest difficulty in separating the branch from the stem, on account of this substance, as it was wrapped quite round the tree, and, he observed, round all the other branches, thus forming a strong support to the large leaves while exposed to high winds. When I call this substance cloth I do not exaggerate. Indeed, with regard to all the things I saw during my eventful career in the South Seas, I have been exceedingly careful not to exaggerate, or in any way to mislead or deceive my readers. This cloth, I say, was remarkably like to coarse brown cotton cloth. It had a seam or fibre down the centre of it, from which diverged other fibres, about the size of a bristle. There were two layers of these fibres, very long and tough, the one layer crossing the other obliquely, and the whole was cemented together with a still finer fibrous and adhesive substance. When we regarded it attentively, we could with difficulty believe that it had not been woven by human hands. This remarkable piece of cloth we stripped carefully off, and found it to be above two feet long, by a foot broad, and we carried it home with us as a great prize.

This was done quickly, but it took some effort because the trunk was very tall, and since Peterkin usually picked nuts from the shorter trees, he wasn't used to climbing the tall ones. The leaf or branch was quite large, and we were surprised by its size and strength. From a distance, the coconut tree looks like a tall, straight trunk with no branches except at the top, where there's a tuft of feathery leaves that sway like soft plumes in the wind. But when we saw one of these leaves or branches up close, we found it to be a sturdy stalk about fifteen feet long, with a series of narrow, pointed leaflets arranged alternately on either side. What seemed most remarkable to us was a strange substance that looked like cloth, which was wrapped around the thick end of the stalk where it had been cut from the tree. Peterkin told us he had a hard time separating the branch from the trunk because of this material, as it was wrapped all the way around the tree and, he noted, around all the other branches, providing strong support to the large leaves during strong winds. When I call this substance cloth, I’m not exaggerating. In fact, throughout all my experiences in the South Seas, I've been very careful not to exaggerate or mislead my readers in any way. This cloth was strikingly similar to coarse brown cotton fabric. It had a seam or fiber down its center, with other fibers branching off that were about the size of a bristle. There were two layers of these long, tough fibers, each layer crossing the other diagonally, and they were all bound together with an even finer fibrous and sticky substance. When we examined it closely, it was hard to believe that it hadn't been woven by human hands. We carefully stripped off this remarkable piece of cloth, which measured over two feet long and a foot wide, and we took it home with us as a great prize.

Jack now took one of the leaflets, and, cutting out the central spine or stalk, hurried back with it to our camp. Having made a small fire, he baked the nuts slightly, and then pealed off the husks. After this he wished to bore a hole in them, which, not having anything better at hand at the time, he did with the point of our useless pencil-case. Then he strung them on the cocoa-nut spine, and on putting a light to the topmost nut, we found to our joy that it burned with a clear, beautiful flame; upon seeing which, Peterkin sprang up and danced round the fire for at least five minutes in the excess of his satisfaction.

Jack took one of the leaflets, quickly cut out the central spine or stalk, and rushed back to our camp with it. After starting a small fire, he lightly roasted the nuts and then peeled off the husks. Next, he wanted to make a hole in them, so, not having any better tools at the moment, he used the tip of our useless pencil-case. Then he strung them on the coconut spine, and when he lit the top nut, we were delighted to see it burn with a clear, beautiful flame. Seeing this, Peterkin jumped up and danced around the fire for at least five minutes in pure joy.

“Now lads,” said Jack, extinguishing our candle, the sun will set in an hour, so we have no time to lose. “I shall go and cut a young tree to make my bow out of, and you had better each of you go and select good strong sticks for clubs, and we’ll set to work at them after dark.”

“Alright guys,” said Jack, blowing out our candle, “the sun will go down in an hour, so we need to hurry. I’m going to cut down a young tree to make my bow, and you should each pick out some sturdy sticks for clubs. We’ll get started on them after dark.”

So saying he shouldered his axe and went off, followed by Peterkin, while I took up the piece of newly discovered cloth, and fell to examining its structure. So engrossed was I in this that I was still sitting in the same attitude and occupation when my companions returned.

So saying, he picked up his axe and left, followed by Peterkin, while I examined the piece of newly discovered cloth. I was so absorbed in this that I was still in the same position and focused on it when my companions came back.

“I told you so!” cried Peterkin, with a loud laugh. “Oh, Ralph, you’re incorrigible. See, there’s a club for you. I was sure, when we left you looking at that bit of stuff, that we would find you poring over it when we came back, so I just cut a club for you as well as for myself.”

“I told you so!” Peterkin shouted with a loud laugh. “Oh, Ralph, you’re impossible. Look, there’s a club for you. I knew when we left you staring at that piece of stuff that we would find you obsessing over it when we got back, so I made a club for you as well as for myself.”

“Thank you, Peterkin,” said I. “It was kind of you to do that, instead of scolding me for a lazy fellow, as I confess I deserve.”

“Thanks, Peterkin,” I said. “That was really nice of you to do that instead of scolding me for being lazy, which I admit I deserve.”

“Oh! as to that,” returned Peterkin, “I’ll blow you up yet, if you wish it—only it would be of no use if I did, for you’re a perfect mule!”

“Oh! as for that,” replied Peterkin, “I’ll blow you up yet, if that’s what you want—just know it wouldn’t do any good, because you’re completely stubborn!”

As it was now getting dark we lighted our candle, and placing it in a holder made of two crossing branches, inside of our bower, we seated ourselves on our leafy beds and began to work.

As it was getting dark, we lit our candle and placed it in a holder made of two crossed branches inside our bower. We settled onto our leafy beds and started to work.

“I intend to appropriate the bow for my own use,” said Jack, chipping the piece of wood he had brought with his axe. “I used to be a pretty fair shot once. But what’s that you’re doing?” he added, looking at Peterkin, who had drawn the end of a long pole into the tent, and was endeavouring to fit a small piece of the hoop-iron to the end of it.

“I plan to take the bow for myself,” Jack said, whittling the piece of wood he had brought with his axe. “I used to be a decent shot. But what are you up to?” he added, glancing at Peterkin, who had pulled a long pole into the tent and was trying to attach a small piece of hoop iron to the end of it.

“I’m going to enlist into the Lancers,” answered Peterkin. “You see, Jack, I find the club rather an unwieldy instrument for my delicately-formed muscles, and I flatter myself I shall do more execution with a spear.”

“I’m going to join the Lancers,” answered Peterkin. “You see, Jack, I find the club to be pretty cumbersome for my finely-tuned muscles, and I think I’ll be more effective with a spear.”

“Well, if length constitutes power,” said Jack, “you’ll certainly be invincible.”

“Well, if being tall means you’re powerful,” said Jack, “you’ll definitely be unbeatable.”

The pole which Peterkin had cut was full twelve feet long, being a very strong but light and tough young tree, which merely required thinning at the butt to be a serviceable weapon.

The pole that Peterkin had cut was a full twelve feet long, made from a strong but lightweight young tree, which just needed some thinning at the base to be a useful weapon.

“That’s a very good idea,” said I.

"That's a really good idea," I said.

“Which—this?” inquired Peterkin, pointing to the spear.

“Which—this?” Peterkin asked, pointing at the spear.

“Yes;” I replied.

“Yeah,” I replied.

“Humph!” said he; “you’d find it a pretty tough and matter-of-fact idea, if you had it stuck through your gizzard, old boy!”

“Humph!” he said; “you’d find it a pretty tough and realistic idea if it got stuck in your throat, buddy!”

“I mean the idea of making it is a good one,” said I, laughing. “And, now I think of it, I’ll change my plan, too. I don’t think much of a club, so I’ll make me a sling out of this piece of cloth. I used to be very fond of slinging, ever since I read of David slaying Goliath the Philistine, and I was once thought to be expert at it.”

“I mean, the idea of making it is a good one,” I said, laughing. “And now that I think about it, I’ll change my plan too. I’m not a big fan of clubs, so I’ll make a sling out of this piece of cloth. I used to really enjoy slinging ever since I read about David taking down Goliath the Philistine, and people once thought I was really good at it.”

So I set to work to manufacture a sling. For a long time we all worked very busily without speaking. At length Peterkin looked up: “I say, Jack, I’m sorry to say I must apply to you for another strip of your handkerchief, to tie on this rascally head with. It’s pretty well torn at any rate, so you won’t miss it.”

So I got to work making a sling. For a long time, we all worked hard without talking. Finally, Peterkin looked up: “Hey, Jack, I’m afraid I need to ask you for another piece of your handkerchief to tie around this troublesome head. It's pretty much ripped anyway, so you won’t miss it.”

Jack proceeded to comply with this request when Peterkin suddenly laid his hand on his arm and arrested him.

Jack started to follow this request when Peterkin unexpectedly put his hand on his arm and stopped him.

“Hist, man,” said he, “be tender; you should never be needlessly cruel if you can help it. Do try to shave past Lord Nelson’s mouth without tearing it, if possible! Thanks. There are plenty more handkerchiefs on the cocoa-nut trees.”

“Hey, man,” he said, “be gentle; you should never be unnecessarily cruel if you can avoid it. Do your best to shave past Lord Nelson’s mouth without cutting it, if you can! Thanks. There are plenty more handkerchiefs on the coconut trees.”

Poor Peterkin! with what pleasant feelings I recall and record his jests and humorous sayings now!

Poor Peterkin! I have such great memories of his jokes and funny sayings!

While we were thus engaged, we were startled by a distant but most strange and horrible cry. It seemed to come from the sea, but was so far away that we could not clearly distinguish its precise direction. Rushing out of our bower, we hastened down to the beach and stayed to listen. Again it came quite loud and distinct on the night air,—a prolonged, hideous cry, something like the braying of an ass. The moon had risen, and we could see the islands in and beyond the lagoon quite plainly, but there was no object visible to account for such a cry. A strong gust of wind was blowing from the point whence the sound came, but this died away while we were gazing out to sea.

While we were busy, we were shocked by a distant yet very strange and terrifying cry. It seemed to come from the sea, but it was so far away that we couldn't figure out its exact direction. We rushed out of our shelter, hurried down to the beach, and paused to listen. Again, it came loud and clear on the night air—a long, horrible cry, somewhat like a donkey braying. The moon had risen, and we could see the islands in and beyond the lagoon quite clearly, but there was nothing in sight to explain such a cry. A strong gust of wind was blowing from the direction of the sound, but it faded while we were staring out at the sea.

“What can it be?” said Peterkin, in a low whisper, while we all involuntarily crept closer to each other.

“What could it be?” Peterkin said softly, as we all instinctively huddled closer together.

“Do you know,” said Jack, “I have heard that mysterious sound twice before, but never so loud as to-night. Indeed it was so faint that I thought I must have merely fancied it, so, as I did not wish to alarm you, I said nothing about it.”

“Do you know,” Jack said, “I’ve heard that mysterious sound twice before, but never as loud as tonight. In fact, it was so faint that I thought I must have just imagined it, so I didn’t say anything to avoid alarming you.”

We listened for a long time for the sound again, but as it did not come, we returned to the bower and resumed our work.

We listened for a long time for the sound again, but since it didn’t come, we went back to the shelter and continued our work.

“Very strange,” said Peterkin, quite gravely. “Do you believe in ghosts, Ralph?”

“Very strange,” said Peterkin, quite seriously. “Do you believe in ghosts, Ralph?”

“No,” I answered, “I do not. Nevertheless I must confess that strange, unaccountable sounds, such as we have just heard, make me feel a little uneasy.”

“No,” I replied, “I don't. Still, I have to admit that weird, inexplicable noises, like the ones we just heard, make me feel a bit uneasy.”

“What say you to it, Jack?”

"What do you think about it, Jack?"

“I neither believe in ghosts nor feel uneasy,” he replied. “I never saw a ghost myself, and I never met with any one who had; and I have generally found that strange and unaccountable things have almost always been accounted for, and found to be quite simple, on close examination. I certainly can’t imagine what that sound is; but I’m quite sure I shall find out before long,—and if it’s a ghost I’ll—”

“I don’t believe in ghosts, and I’m not really worried,” he said. “I’ve never seen a ghost myself, and I’ve never met anyone who has; usually, I’ve found that strange and unexplainable things can almost always be explained and are quite simple when you look closely. I really can’t imagine what that sound is, but I’m sure I’ll figure it out soon—and if it turns out to be a ghost, I’ll—”

“Eat it,” cried Peterkin.

“Eat it,” shouted Peterkin.

“Yes, I’ll eat it! Now, then, my bow and two arrows are finished; so if you’re ready we had better turn in.”

“Yeah, I'll eat it! Alright, my bow and two arrows are done; so if you're ready, we should get to bed.”

By this time Peterkin had thinned down his spear and tied an iron point very cleverly to the end of it; I had formed a sling, the lines of which were composed of thin strips of the cocoa-nut cloth, plaited; and Jack had made a stout bow, nearly five feet long, with two arrows, feathered with two or three large plumes which some bird had dropt. They had no barbs, but Jack said that if arrows were well feathered, they did not require iron points, but would fly quite well if merely sharpened at the point; which I did not know before.

By this time, Peterkin had sharpened his spear and skillfully attached an iron tip to the end of it. I had made a sling using thin strips of coconut cloth that were braided together, and Jack had crafted a sturdy bow, nearly five feet long, along with two arrows that were fletched with large feathers dropped by a bird. They didn’t have barbs, but Jack mentioned that well-fletched arrows didn't need iron tips and could fly just fine if they were simply sharpened at the point, which I hadn't known before.

“A feathered arrow without a barb,” said he, “is a good weapon, but a barbed arrow without feathers is utterly useless.”

“A feathered arrow without a point,” he said, “is a good weapon, but a pointed arrow without feathers is totally useless.”

The string of the bow was formed of our piece of whip-cord, part of which, as he did not like to cut it, was rolled round the bow.

The bowstring was made from our piece of whip-cord, some of which, since he didn’t want to cut it, was wrapped around the bow.

Although thus prepared for a start on the morrow, we thought it wise to exercise ourselves a little in the use of our weapons before starting, so we spent the whole of the next day in practising. And it was well we did so, for we found that our arms were very imperfect, and that we were far from perfect in the use of them. First, Jack found that the bow was much too strong, and he had to thin it. Also the spear was much too heavy, and so had to be reduced in thickness, although nothing would induce Peterkin to have it shortened. My sling answered very well, but I had fallen so much out of practice that my first stone knocked off Peterkin’s hat, and narrowly missed making a second Goliath of him. However, after having spent the whole day in diligent practice, we began to find some of our former expertness returning—at least Jack and I did. As for Peterkin, being naturally a neat-handed boy, he soon handled his spear well, and could run full tilt at a cocoa nut, and hit it with great precision once out of every five times.

Although we were ready to leave the next day, we thought it was smart to practice with our weapons first, so we spent the entire day training. It turned out to be a good decision because we discovered that our gear wasn't in great shape, and we definitely needed to improve our skills. First, Jack realized that the bow was way too strong, so he had to trim it down. The spear was also too heavy, requiring it to be thinned out, although Peterkin refused to let anyone shorten it. My sling worked pretty well, but I was so out of practice that my first shot knocked off Peterkin’s hat and barely missed giving him a second Goliath experience. After dedicating the whole day to serious practice, Jack and I started to regain some of our old skills. As for Peterkin, being naturally good with his hands, he quickly mastered his spear, running full speed at a coconut and hitting it with impressive accuracy about once out of every five tries.

But I feel satisfied that we owed much of our rapid success to the unflagging energy of Jack, who insisted that, since we had made him Captain, we should obey him; and he kept us at work from morning till night, perseveringly, at the same thing. Peterkin wished very much to run about and stick his spear into everything he passed; but Jack put up a cocoa nut, and would not let him leave off running at that for a moment, except when he wanted to rest. We laughed at Jack for this, but we were both convinced that it did us much good.

But I feel satisfied that we owed a lot of our quick success to Jack's nonstop energy, who insisted that since we made him Captain, we should follow his lead. He kept us working from morning till night, focused on the same task. Peterkin really wanted to run around and poke his spear at everything he saw, but Jack set up a coconut and wouldn’t let him stop running at that for a second, except when he needed to take a break. We teased Jack about this, but we both believed it was really beneficial for us.

That night we examined and repaired our arms ere we lay down to rest, although we were much fatigued, in order that we might be in readiness to set out on our expedition at daylight on the following morning.

That night we checked and fixed our weapons before we went to bed, even though we were really tired, so we would be ready to start our mission at dawn the next morning.

CHAPTER IX.

Prepare for a journey round the island—Sagacious reflections—Mysterious appearances and startling occurrences.

Prepare for a journey around the island—Wise insights—Mysterious sights and surprising events.

Scarcely had the sun shot its first ray across the bosom of the broad Pacific, when Jack sprang to his feet, and, hallooing in Peterkin’s ear to awaken him, ran down the beach to take his customary dip in the sea. We did not, as was our wont, bathe that morning in our Water Garden, but, in order to save time, refreshed ourselves in the shallow water just opposite the bower. Our breakfast was also despatched without loss of time, and in less than an hour afterwards all our preparations for the journey were completed.

As soon as the sun sent its first ray over the wide Pacific, Jack jumped up, shouted in Peterkin’s ear to wake him up, and ran down the beach for his usual swim in the sea. Instead of bathing in our Water Garden like we usually did, we decided to save time and refreshed ourselves in the shallow water right in front of the shelter. We also had our breakfast quickly, and less than an hour later, we finished all our preparations for the journey.

In addition to his ordinary dress, Jack tied a belt of cocoa-nut cloth round his waist, into which he thrust the axe. I was also advised to put on a belt and carry a short cudgel or bludgeon in it; for, as Jack truly remarked, the sling would be of little use if we should chance to come to close quarters with any wild animal. As for Peterkin, notwithstanding that he carried such a long, and I must add, frightful-looking spear over his shoulder, we could not prevail on him to leave his club behind; “for,” said he, “a spear at close quarters is not worth a button.” I must say that it seemed to me that the club was, to use his own style of language, not worth a button-hole; for it was all knotted over at the head, something like the club which I remember to have observed in picture-books of Jack the Giant Killer, besides being so heavy that he required to grasp it with both hands in order to wield it at all. However, he took it with him, and, in this manner we set out upon our travels.

In addition to his usual clothes, Jack tied a belt made of coconut fabric around his waist, where he kept the axe. I was also advised to wear a belt and carry a short stick or bludgeon in it; because, as Jack honestly pointed out, the sling wouldn't be much help if we found ourselves face to face with any wild animal. As for Peterkin, even though he had such a long and, I must say, scary-looking spear slung over his shoulder, we couldn’t convince him to leave his club behind; “because,” he said, “a spear isn’t worth much in close quarters.” I must admit that it seemed to me that the club was, to use his own words, not even worth a button-hole; since it was all knotted up at the head, reminiscent of the clubs I remember from storybooks about Jack the Giant Killer, and it was so heavy that he needed to grip it with both hands just to lift it. Still, he took it with him, and this is how we began our journey.

We did not consider it necessary to carry any food with us, as we knew that wherever we went we should be certain to fall in with cocoa-nut trees; having which, we were amply supplied, as Peterkin said, with meat and drink and pocket-handkerchiefs! I took the precaution, however, to put the burning-glass into my pocket, lest we should want fire.

We didn't think it was necessary to bring any food with us since we knew that wherever we went, we would definitely come across coconut trees. With those, as Peterkin said, we had more than enough food and drink, and even pocket handkerchiefs! I did, however, take the precaution of putting the magnifying glass in my pocket in case we needed a way to start a fire.

The morning was exceeding lovely. It was one of that very still and peaceful sort which made the few noises that we heard seem to be quiet noises. I know no other way of expressing this idea. Noises which so far from interrupting the universal tranquillity of earth, sea, and sky—rather tended to reveal to us how quiet the world around us really was. Such sounds as I refer to were, the peculiarly melancholy—yet, it seemed to me, cheerful—plaint of sea-birds floating on the glassy water, or sailing in the sky, also the subdued twittering of little birds among the bushes, the faint ripples on the beach, and the solemn boom of the surf upon the distant coral reef. We felt very glad in our hearts as we walked along the sands side by side. For my part, I felt so deeply overjoyed, that I was surprised at my own sensations, and fell into a reverie upon the causes of happiness. I came to the conclusion that a state of profound peace and repose, both in regard to outward objects and within the soul, is the happiest condition in which man can be placed; for, although I had many a time been most joyful and happy when engaged in bustling, energetic, active pursuits or amusements, I never found that such joy or satisfaction was so deep or so pleasant to reflect upon as that which I now experienced. And I was the more confirmed in this opinion when I observed, and, indeed, was told by himself, that Peterkin’s happiness was also very great; yet he did not express this by dancing, as was his wont, nor did he give so much as a single shout, but walked quietly between us with his eye sparkling, and a joyful smile upon his countenance. My reader must not suppose that I thought all this in the clear and methodical manner in which I have set it down here. These thoughts did, indeed, pass through my mind, but they did so in a very confused and indefinite manner, for I was young at that time, and not much given to deep reflections. Neither did I consider that the peace whereof I write is not to be found in this world—at least in its perfection, although I have since learned that by religion a man may attain to a very great degree of it.

The morning was incredibly lovely. It was one of those still and peaceful days that made the few sounds we heard feel like quiet sounds. I can’t describe it any other way. The noises did not disturb the peacefulness of earth, sea, and sky; instead, they highlighted how calm the world around us really was. The sounds I’m talking about were the uniquely melancholic—yet, to me, cheerful—calls of sea-birds floating on the smooth water or gliding in the sky, the soft chirping of little birds among the bushes, the gentle ripples on the shore, and the deep roar of the surf against the distant coral reef. We felt so happy in our hearts as we strolled along the sand side by side. Personally, I felt so overwhelmed with joy that I was surprised by my own feelings and slipped into a daydream about the reasons for happiness. I concluded that a state of deep peace and relaxation, both regarding external things and within the soul, is the happiest state a person can be in; for, although I had often felt extremely joyful and happy while engaged in busy, energetic activities or fun, I never found that such joy or satisfaction was as deep or as pleasant to remember as what I was experiencing now. I was even more convinced of this when I noticed, and was even told by him, that Peterkin was also very happy; yet he didn’t show it by dancing, as was his habit, nor did he give a single shout, but walked quietly between us with a sparkle in his eye and a joyful smile on his face. Don’t think I formulated all this in the clear and logical way I’ve just described. These thoughts did cross my mind, but they were jumbled and unclear because I was young back then and not much into deep thinking. I also didn’t realize that the peace I was talking about isn’t fully attainable in this world—at least not in perfection, although I’ve since learned that through religion, a person can achieve a significant level of it.

I have said that Peterkin walked along the sands between us. We had two ways of walking together about our island. When we travelled through the woods, we always did so in single file, as by this method we advanced with greater facility, the one treading in the other’s footsteps. In such cases Jack always took the lead, Peterkin followed, and I brought up the rear. But when we travelled along the sands, which extended almost in an unbroken line of glistening white round the island, we marched abreast, as we found this method more sociable, and every way more pleasant. Jack, being the tallest, walked next the sea, and Peterkin marched between us, as by this arrangement either of us could talk to him or he to us, while if Jack and I happened to wish to converse together, we could conveniently do so over Peterkin’s head. Peterkin used to say, in reference to this arrangement, that had he been as tall as either of us, our order of march might have been the same, for, as Jack often used to scold him for letting everything we said to him pass in at one ear and out at the other, his head could of course form no interruption to our discourse.

I mentioned that Peterkin walked along the beach between us. We had two ways of walking together around our island. When we traveled through the woods, we always went in a single file since that made it easier to move forward, with one person stepping in the other's footsteps. In those situations, Jack always led the way, Peterkin followed, and I brought up the rear. But when we walked along the beach, which stretched in a continuous line of shining white around the island, we walked side by side, as we found it more social and enjoyable. Jack, being the tallest, walked closest to the sea, and Peterkin walked between us, allowing either of us to talk to him or for him to chat with us. If Jack and I wanted to talk to each other, we could do it comfortably over Peterkin’s head. Peterkin used to joke that if he were as tall as either of us, our arrangement would be the same, since Jack often scolded him for letting everything we said go in one ear and out the other, so his height wouldn’t interrupt our conversation.

We were now fairly started. Half a mile’s walk conveyed us round a bend in the land which shut out our bower from view, and for some time we advanced at a brisk pace without speaking, though our eyes were not idle, but noted everything, in the woods, on the shore, or in the sea, that was interesting. After passing the ridge of land that formed one side of our valley—the Valley of the Wreck—we beheld another small vale lying before us in all the luxuriant loveliness of tropical vegetation. We had, indeed, seen it before from the mountain-top, but we had no idea that it would turn out to be so much more lovely when we were close to it. We were about to commence the exploration of this valley, when Peterkin stopped us, and directed our attention to a very remarkable appearance in advance along the shore.

We were now on our way. A half-mile walk took us around a bend that blocked our hideaway from view, and we moved forward at a quick pace without talking, although our eyes were busy noting everything interesting in the woods, on the shore, or in the sea. After passing the ridge that marked one side of our valley—the Valley of the Wreck—we saw another small valley ahead of us, filled with the lush beauty of tropical plants. We had seen it from the mountaintop before, but we had no idea it would be so much more beautiful up close. Just as we were about to explore this valley, Peterkin stopped us and pointed out something very remarkable along the shore ahead.

“What’s yon, think you?” said he, levelling his spear, as if he expected an immediate attack from the object in question, though it was full half a mile distant.

“What do you think that is?” he said, aiming his spear as if he expected an immediate attack from the object in question, even though it was half a mile away.

As he spoke, there appeared a white column above the rocks, as if of steam or spray. It rose upwards to a height of several feet, and then disappeared. Had this been near the sea, we would not have been so greatly surprised, as it might in that case have been the surf, for at this part of the coast the coral reef approached so near to the island that in some parts it almost joined it. There was therefore no lagoon between, and the heavy surf of the ocean beat almost up to the rocks. But this white column appeared about fifty yards inland. The rocks at the place were rugged, and they stretched across the sandy beach into the sea. Scarce had we ceased expressing our surprise at this sight, when another column flew upwards for a few seconds, not far from the spot where the first had been seen, and disappeared; and so, at long irregular intervals, these strange sights recurred. We were now quite sure that the columns were watery or composed of spray, but what caused them we could not guess, so we determined to go and see.

As he spoke, a white column appeared above the rocks, like steam or spray. It rose several feet into the air before disappearing. If this had been near the sea, we wouldn’t have been so surprised, as it could have been the surf, since the coral reef came so close to the island in this part of the coast that in some places it almost connected. There was no lagoon, and the strong surf from the ocean crashed right up to the rocks. But this white column appeared about fifty yards inland. The rocks there were jagged and extended from the sandy beach into the sea. We had barely stopped expressing our astonishment at this sight when another column shot up for a few seconds, not far from where the first one had been seen, then vanished; and so, at long irregular intervals, these strange occurrences continued. We were now pretty sure that the columns were made of water or spray, but we couldn't figure out what caused them, so we decided to go and check it out.

In a few minutes we gained the spot, which was very rugged and precipitous, and, moreover, quite damp with the falling of the spray. We had much ado to pass over dry-shod. The ground also was full of holes here and there. Now, while we stood anxiously waiting for the re-appearance of these water-spouts, we heard a low, rumbling sound near us, which quickly increased to a gargling and hissing noise, and a moment afterwards a thick spout of water burst upwards from a hole in the rock, and spouted into the air with much violence, and so close to where Jack and I were standing that it nearly touched us. We sprang to one side, but not before a cloud of spray descended, and drenched us both to the skin.

In a few minutes, we reached the spot, which was very rugged and steep, and also quite wet from the falling spray. We had a hard time getting across without getting soaked. The ground was full of holes here and there. As we stood there anxiously waiting for the water spouts to reappear, we heard a low, rumbling sound nearby that quickly grew into a gargling and hissing noise. Moments later, a thick jet of water shot up from a hole in the rock, blasting into the air violently, and it was so close to where Jack and I were standing that it nearly got us. We jumped to one side, but not before a cloud of spray fell down and soaked us both.

Peterkin, who was standing farther off, escaped with a few drops, and burst into an uncontrollable fit of laughter on beholding our miserable plight.

Peterkin, who was standing a bit farther away, got splashed with just a few drops and couldn't help but break into a fit of uncontrollable laughter when he saw our miserable situation.

“Mind your eye!” he shouted eagerly, “there goes another!” The words were scarcely out of his mouth when there came up a spout from another hole, which served us exactly in the same manner as before.

“Watch out!” he shouted eagerly, “there goes another one!” The words had hardly left his mouth when another jet shot up from a different hole, doing exactly the same thing as before.

Peterkin now shrieked with laughter; but his merriment was abruptly put a stop to by the gurgling noise occurring close to where he stood.

Peterkin now burst out laughing; but his fun was suddenly interrupted by a gurgling sound coming from right by him.

“Where’ll it spout this time, I wonder?” he said, looking about with some anxiety, and preparing to run. Suddenly there came a loud hiss or snort; a fierce spout of water burst up between Peterkin’s legs, blew him off his feet, enveloped him in its spray, and hurled him to the ground. He fell with so much violence that we feared he must have broken some of his bones, and ran anxiously to his assistance; but fortunately he had fallen on a clump of tangled herbage, in which he lay sprawling in a most deplorable condition.

“Where’s it going to burst out this time, I wonder?” he said, looking around with some worry and getting ready to run. Suddenly, there was a loud hiss or snort; a powerful spout of water shot up between Peterkin’s legs, knocked him off his feet, soaked him in its spray, and slammed him to the ground. He fell with such force that we worried he might have broken a bone, and rushed over to help him; but luckily, he had landed on a patch of tangled grass, where he lay sprawled out in a rather sorry state.

It was now our turn to laugh; but as we were not yet quite sure that he was unhurt, and as we knew not when or where the next spout might arise, we assisted him hastily to jump up and hurry from the spot.

It was now our turn to laugh; but since we weren't completely sure he was okay, and we didn't know when or where the next burst might happen, we quickly helped him to get up and leave the area.

I may here add, that although I am quite certain that the spout of water was very strong, and that it blew Peterkin completely off his legs, I am not quite certain of the exact height to which it lifted him, being somewhat startled by the event, and blinded partially by the spray, so that my power of observation was somewhat impaired for the moment.

I should mention that while I'm sure the water spout was really strong and knocked Peterkin right off his feet, I'm not exactly certain how high it lifted him. I was a bit shocked by what happened and partially blinded by the spray, which made it hard to see clearly at that moment.

“What’s to be done now?” inquired Peterkin ruefully.

“What should we do now?” Peterkin asked sadly.

“Make a fire, lad, and dry ourselves,” replied Jack.

“Start a fire, dude, and let's warm up,” replied Jack.

“And here is material ready to our hand,” said I, picking up a dried branch of a tree, as we hurried up to the woods.

“And here’s some material we can use,” I said, picking up a dried branch from a tree as we rushed into the woods.

In about an hour after this mishap our clothes were again dried. While they were hanging up before the fire, we walked down to the beach, and soon observed that these curious spouts took place immediately after the fall of a huge wave, never before it; and, moreover, that the spouts did not take place excepting when the billow was an extremely large one. From this we concluded that there must be a subterraneous channel in the rock into which the water was driven by the larger waves, and finding no way of escape except through these small holes, was thus forced up violently through them. At any rate, we could not conceive any other reason for these strange water-spouts, and as this seemed a very simple and probable one, we forthwith adopted it.

About an hour after this incident, our clothes were dry again. While they were hanging in front of the fire, we walked down to the beach and quickly noticed that these strange water spouts occurred right after a large wave crashed, never before it; and also, that the spouts only appeared when the wave was really big. From this, we figured there must be an underground channel in the rock where the water was forced in by the bigger waves, and with no way to get out except through these small holes, it shot up through them violently. In any case, we couldn't think of any other reason for these odd water spouts, and since this explanation seemed straightforward and likely, we decided to go with it.

“I say, Ralph, what’s that in the water? is it a shark?” said Jack, just as we were about to quit the place.

“I say, Ralph, what’s that in the water? Is it a shark?” Jack asked, right as we were about to leave the spot.

I immediately ran to the overhanging ledge of rock, from which he was looking down into the sea, and bent over it. There I saw a very faint pale object of a greenish colour, which seemed to move slightly while I looked at it.

I quickly rushed to the overhanging rock ledge where he was peering down at the sea and leaned over. There, I spotted a very faint pale object that had a greenish hue, which appeared to move slightly as I watched it.

“It’s like a fish of some sort,” said I.

“It’s like some kind of fish,” I said.

“Hallo, Peterkin!” cried Jack, “fetch your spear; here’s work for it.”

“Hey, Peterkin!” shouted Jack, “grab your spear; there's work to be done.”

But when we tried to reach the object, the spear proved to be too short.

But when we tried to grab the object, the spear turned out to be too short.

“There, now,” said Peterkin with a sneer, “you were always telling me it was too long.”

“There, now,” Peterkin said with a smirk, “you were always saying it was too long.”

Jack now drove the spear forcibly towards the object, and let go his hold; but, although it seemed to be well aimed, he must have missed, for the handle soon rose again; and when the spear was drawn up, there was the pale green object in exactly the same spot, slowly moving its tail.

Jack now thrust the spear hard at the object and let go of it; however, even though it looked like he aimed well, he must have missed because the handle soon rose again. When the spear was pulled back, the pale green object was right in the same spot, slowly moving its tail.

“Very odd,” said Jack.

"Strange," said Jack.

But although it was undoubtedly very odd, and, although Jack and all of us plunged the spear at it repeatedly, we could neither hit it nor drive it away, so we were compelled to continue our journey without discovering what it was. I was very much perplexed at this strange appearance in the water, and could not get it out of my mind for a long time afterwards. However, I quieted myself by resolving that I would pay a visit to it again at some more convenient season.

But even though it was definitely very strange, and even though Jack and all of us kept thrusting the spear at it over and over, we couldn't hit it or scare it off, so we had to continue our journey without finding out what it was. I was really puzzled by this odd sight in the water and couldn’t stop thinking about it for a long time afterward. However, I calmed myself by deciding that I would go back to check it out again at a better time.

CHAPTER X.

Make discovery of many excellent roots and fruits—The resources of the Coral Island gradually unfolded—The banian-tree—Another tree which is supported by natural planks—Water-fowl found—A very remarkable discovery, and a very peculiar murder—We luxuriate on the fat of the land.

Make discoveries of many great roots and fruits—The resources of Coral Island gradually revealed themselves—The banyan tree—Another tree that is supported by natural planks—Waterfowl found—A very interesting discovery, and a very unusual murder—We indulge in the abundance of the land.

Our examination of the little valley proved to be altogether most satisfactory. We found in it not only similar trees to those we had already seen in our own valley, but also one or two others of a different species. We had also the satisfaction of discovering a peculiar vegetable, which Jack concluded must certainly be that of which he had read as being very common among the South Sea islanders, and which was named taro. Also we found a large supply of yams, and another root like a potato in appearance. As these were all quite new to us, we regarded our lot as a most fortunate one, in being thus cast on an island which was so prolific and so well stored with all the necessaries of life. Long afterwards we found out that this island of ours was no better in these respects than thousands of other islands in those seas. Indeed, many of them were much richer and more productive; but that did not render us the less grateful for our present good fortune. We each put one of these roots in our pocket, intending to use them for our supper; of which more hereafter. We also saw many beautiful birds here, and traces of some four-footed animal again. Meanwhile the sun began to descend, so we returned to the shore, and pushed on round the spouting rocks into the next valley. This was that valley of which I have spoken as running across the entire island. It was by far the largest and most beautiful that we had yet looked upon. Here were trees of every shape and size and hue which it is possible to conceive of, many of which we had not seen in the other valleys; for, the stream in this valley being larger, and the mould much richer than in the Valley of the Wreck, it was clothed with a more luxuriant growth of trees and plants. Some trees were dark glossy green, others of a rich and warm hue, contrasting well with those of a pale light green, which were everywhere abundant. Among these we recognised the broad dark heads of the bread-fruit, with its golden fruit; the pure, silvery foliage of the candle-nut, and several species which bore a strong resemblance to the pine; while here and there, in groups and in single trees, rose the tall forms of the cocoa-nut palms, spreading abroad, and waving their graceful plumes high above all the rest, as if they were a superior race of stately giants keeping guard over these luxuriant forests. Oh! it was a most enchanting scene, and I thanked God for having created such delightful spots for the use of man.

Our exploration of the small valley was incredibly satisfying. We discovered not only the same types of trees we had seen in our own valley but also a couple of others that were different. We were also pleased to find a unique plant that Jack believed was the one he had read about, which was common among the South Sea islanders and called taro. Additionally, we came across a large supply of yams and another root that looked like a potato. Since these were all new to us, we considered ourselves very lucky to be on an island that was so abundant and well-stocked with the essentials of life. Much later, we learned that our island was no better in these aspects than thousands of other islands in those waters. In fact, many were richer and more productive; however, that didn't lessen our gratitude for our current good fortune. We each took one of these roots to put in our pocket, planning to use them for supper, about which I'll say more later. We also saw many beautiful birds and signs of some four-legged animals again. Meanwhile, the sun began to set, so we headed back to the shore and continued around the spouting rocks into the next valley. This was the valley I mentioned that ran across the entire island. It was far the largest and most beautiful we had experienced so far. It featured trees of every shape, size, and color you can imagine, many of which we hadn’t seen in the other valleys; the stream in this valley was larger, and the soil much richer than in the Valley of the Wreck, resulting in a more lush growth of trees and plants. Some trees had dark glossy green leaves, others had rich warm colors, contrasting beautifully with the pale light green trees that were abundant everywhere. Among them, we recognized the broad dark crowns of the breadfruit trees with their golden fruit, the pure silvery leaves of the candle-nut tree, and several species that closely resembled pine trees. Here and there, in groups and as single specimens, the tall forms of the coconut palms rose, spreading their graceful fronds high above everything else, as if they were a superior race of elegant giants guarding these lush forests. Oh! it was a truly enchanting scene, and I thanked God for creating such beautiful places for humanity to enjoy.

Now, while we were gazing around us in silent admiration, Jack uttered an exclamation of surprise, and, pointing to an object a little to one side of us, said,—

Now, while we were looking around in quiet amazement, Jack let out a shout of surprise and, pointing to something a bit off to the side, said,—

“That’s a banian-tree.”

"That's a banyan tree."

“And what’s a banian-tree?” inquired Peterkin, as we walked towards it.

“And what's a banyan tree?” Peterkin asked as we walked toward it.

“A very curious one, as you shall see presently,” replied Jack. “It is called the aoa here, if I recollect rightly, and has a wonderful peculiarity about it. What an enormous one it is, to be sure.”

“A very curious one, as you’ll see shortly,” replied Jack. “It’s called the aoa here, if I remember correctly, and it has a fantastic peculiarity about it. What a huge one it is, for sure.”

It!” repeated Peterkin; “why, there are dozens of banians here! What do you mean by talking bad grammar? Is your philosophy deserting you, Jack?”

It!” Peterkin repeated. “There are tons of banians here! What do you mean by speaking bad grammar? Is your philosophy leaving you, Jack?”

“There is but one tree here of this kind,” returned Jack, “as you will perceive if you will examine it.” And, sure enough, we did find that what we had supposed was a forest of trees was in reality only one. Its bark was of a light colour, and had a shining appearance, the leaves being lance-shaped, small, and of a beautiful pea-green. But the wonderful thing about it was, that the branches, which grew out from the stem horizontally, sent down long shoots or fibres to the ground, which, taking root, had themselves become trees, and were covered with bark like the tree itself. Many of these fibres had descended from the branches at various distances, and thus supported them on natural pillars, some of which were so large and strong, that it was not easy at first to distinguish the offspring from the parent stem. The fibres were of all sizes and in all states of advancement, from the pillars we have just mentioned to small cords which hung down and were about to take root, and thin brown threads still far from the ground, which swayed about with every motion of wind. In short, it seemed to us that, if there were only space afforded to it, this single tree would at length cover the whole island.

“There's only one tree of this kind here,” Jack replied, “as you’ll see if you take a closer look.” And sure enough, we discovered that what we thought was a forest was really just one tree. Its bark was light-colored and shiny, with lance-shaped, small, beautiful pea-green leaves. The amazing thing about it was that the branches, which extended out from the trunk horizontally, sent down long shoots or fibers to the ground, which took root and became trees themselves, covered with bark just like the main tree. Many of these fibers hung down from the branches at different lengths, supporting them on natural pillars, some of which were so large and strong that it was hard at first to tell the offspring from the parent stem. The fibers varied in size and development, from the sturdy pillars we just mentioned to small cords ready to take root and thin brown threads still high above the ground, swaying with every gust of wind. In short, it seemed to us that, given enough space, this single tree would eventually cover the entire island.

Shortly after this we came upon another remarkable tree, which, as its peculiar formation afterwards proved extremely useful to us, merits description. It was a splendid chestnut, but its proper name Jack did not know. However, there were quantities of fine nuts upon it, some of which we put in our pockets. But its stem was the wonderful part of it. It rose to about twelve feet without a branch, and was not of great thickness; on the contrary, it was remarkably slender for the size of the tree; but, to make up for this, there were four or five wonderful projections in this stem, which I cannot better describe than by asking the reader to suppose that five planks of two inches thick and three feet broad had been placed round the trunk of the tree, with their edges closely fixed to it, from the ground up to the branches, and that these planks had been covered over with the bark of the tree and incorporated with it. In short, they were just natural buttresses, without which the stem could not have supported its heavy and umbrageous top. We found these chestnuts to be very numerous. They grew chiefly on the banks of the stream, and were of all sizes.

Shortly after this, we came across another remarkable tree, which, as its unique shape later proved to be very useful to us, deserves a description. It was a beautiful chestnut tree, although Jack didn’t know its proper name. However, it had plenty of fine nuts on it, some of which we pocketed. The trunk was the most impressive part. It rose about twelve feet without any branches and wasn’t very thick; in fact, it was surprisingly slender for the size of the tree. To make up for this, there were four or five amazing projections on the trunk, which I can best describe by asking you to imagine that five planks, two inches thick and three feet wide, had been placed around the trunk, with their edges closely fitted to it, from the ground up to the branches, and that these planks were covered in bark and absorbed into the tree. In short, they were just natural buttresses, without which the trunk couldn’t have supported its heavy and leafy top. We found these chestnuts to be quite common. They mainly grew along the streambanks and came in all sizes.

While we were examining a small tree of this kind, Jack chipped a piece off a buttress with his axe, and found the wood to be firm and easily cut. He then struck the axe into it with all his force, and very soon split it off close to the tree, first, however, having cut it across transversely above and below. By this means he satisfied himself that we could now obtain short planks, as it were all ready sawn, of any size and thickness that we desired; which was a very great discovery indeed, perhaps the most important we had yet made.

While we were looking at a small tree of this type, Jack chipped off a piece of the buttress with his axe and found the wood to be solid and easy to cut. He then swung the axe into it with all his strength and soon split it off right near the tree, first making cuts across the top and bottom. This way, he confirmed that we could now get short planks, as if they were already sawed, in any size and thickness we wanted; this was a really significant discovery, probably the most important one we had made so far.

We now wended our way back to the coast, intending to encamp near the beach, as we found that the mosquitoes were troublesome in the forest. On our way we could not help admiring the birds which flew and chirped around us. Among them we observed a pretty kind of paroquet, with a green body, a blue head, and a red breast; also a few beautiful turtledoves, and several flocks of wood-pigeons. The hues of many of these birds were extremely vivid,—bright green, blue, and scarlet, being the prevailing tints. We made several attempts throughout the day to bring down one of these, both with the bow and the sling,—not for mere sport, but to ascertain whether they were good for food. But we invariably missed, although once or twice we were very near hitting. As evening drew on, however, a flock of pigeons flew past. I slung a stone into the midst of them at a venture, and had the good fortune to kill one. We were startled, soon after, by a loud whistling noise above our heads; and on looking up, saw a flock of wild ducks making for the coast. We watched these, and, observing where they alighted, followed them up until we came upon a most lovely blue lake, not more than two hundred yards long, imbosomed in verdant trees. Its placid surface, which reflected every leaf and stem, as if in a mirror, was covered with various species of wild ducks, feeding among the sedges and broad-leaved water-plants which floated on it, while numerous birds like water-hens ran to and fro most busily on its margin. These all with one accord flew tumultuously away the instant we made our appearance. While walking along the margin we observed fish in the water, but of what sort we could not tell.

We made our way back to the coast, planning to set up camp near the beach since the mosquitoes were a real nuisance in the forest. Along the way, we couldn't help but admire the birds flying and chirping around us. Among them, we spotted a lovely kind of parakeet with a green body, a blue head, and a red chest; there were also some beautiful turtledoves and several flocks of wood pigeons. The colors of many of these birds were incredibly bright—greens, blues, and reds were the main shades. Throughout the day, we tried several times to catch one using both the bow and the sling—not just for fun, but to see if they were good to eat. But we always missed, though we came close a couple of times. As evening approached, a flock of pigeons flew by. I threw a stone into the middle of them on a whim and was lucky enough to hit one. Shortly after, we were startled by a loud whistling noise above us, and when we looked up, we saw a flock of wild ducks heading toward the coast. We followed them and eventually discovered a beautiful blue lake, about two hundred yards long, surrounded by lush trees. Its calm surface reflected every leaf and stem, almost like a mirror, and it was filled with various types of wild ducks feeding among the reeds and broad-leaved water plants floating on the water, while numerous birds that looked like water hens busily scurried along its edge. They all flew away in a frenzy as soon as we showed up. While walking along the shore, we noticed fish in the water, but we couldn't tell what kind they were.

Now, as we neared the shore, Jack and I said we would go a little out of our way to see if we could procure one of those ducks; so, directing Peterkin to go straight to the shore and kindle a fire, we separated, promising to rejoin him speedily. But we did not find the ducks, although we made a diligent search for half an hour. We were about to retrace our steps, when we were arrested by one of the strangest sights that we had yet beheld.

Now, as we got closer to the shore, Jack and I decided to take a slight detour to see if we could get one of those ducks. We told Peterkin to head straight to the shore and start a fire while we split up, promising to meet up with him soon. However, we didn’t find any ducks, even after looking hard for half an hour. Just as we were about to head back, we were stopped in our tracks by one of the strangest sights we had seen yet.

Just in front of us, at the distance of about ten yards, grew a superb tree, which certainly was the largest we had yet seen on the island. Its trunk was at least five feet in diameter, with a smooth gray bark; above this the spreading branches were clothed with light green leaves, amid which were clusters of bright yellow fruit, so numerous as to weigh down the boughs with their great weight. This fruit seemed to be of the plum species, of an oblong form, and a good deal larger than the magnum bonum plum. The ground at the foot of this tree was thickly strewn with the fallen fruit, in the midst of which lay sleeping, in every possible attitude, at least twenty hogs of all ages and sizes, apparently quite surfeited with a recent banquet.

Just ahead of us, about ten yards away, stood a magnificent tree, definitely the largest we had seen on the island. Its trunk was at least five feet wide, with smooth gray bark; above this, the branches spread out, covered in light green leaves, interspersed with clusters of bright yellow fruit that were so plentiful they weighed down the branches. The fruit looked like plums, elongated in shape and much larger than a magnum bonum plum. The ground at the base of this tree was covered with fallen fruit, and sprawled across it, in every possible position, were at least twenty pigs of various ages and sizes, seemingly stuffed from a recent feast.

Jack and I could scarce restrain our laughter as we gazed at these coarse, fat, ill-looking animals, while they lay groaning and snoring heavily amid the remains of their supper.

Jack and I could hardly hold back our laughter as we looked at these rough, overweight, unattractive creatures, groaning and snoring loudly among the leftovers of their dinner.

“Now, Ralph,” said Jack, in a low whisper, “put a stone in your sling,—a good big one,—and let fly at that fat fellow with his back toward you. I’ll try to put an arrow into yon little pig.”

“Now, Ralph,” said Jack, in a low whisper, “put a stone in your sling—a good, big one—and let it fly at that fat guy who's facing away from you. I’ll try to shoot an arrow at that little pig over there.”

“Don’t you think we had better put them up first?” I whispered; “it seems cruel to kill them while asleep.”

“Don’t you think we should put them up first?” I whispered. “It feels cruel to kill them while they’re asleep.”

“If I wanted sport, Ralph, I would certainly set them up; but as we only want pork, we’ll let them lie. Besides, we’re not sure of killing them; so, fire away.”

“If I wanted sport, Ralph, I would definitely set them up; but since we only want pork, we’ll leave them be. Besides, we’re not sure we can kill them; so, go ahead and shoot.”

Thus admonished, I slung my stone with so good aim that it went bang against the hog’s flank as if against the head of a drum; but it had no other effect than that of causing the animal to start to its feet, with a frightful yell of surprise, and scamper away. At the same instant Jack’s bow twanged, and the arrow pinned the little pig to the ground by the ear.

Thus warned, I threw my stone with such precision that it hit the hog's side like a drum; but it only startled the animal, making it jump up with a loud yell of surprise and run off. At the same moment, Jack's bow twanged, and the arrow pinned the little pig to the ground by its ear.

“I’ve missed, after all,” cried Jack, darting forward with uplifted axe, while the little pig uttered a loud squeal, tore the arrow from the ground, and ran away with it, along with the whole drove, into the bushes and disappeared, though we heard them screaming long afterwards in the distance.

“I’ve missed, after all,” shouted Jack, rushing forward with his raised axe, while the little pig let out a loud squeal, pulled the arrow from the ground, and ran off with the whole group into the bushes, disappearing from sight, although we could still hear them squealing in the distance for a long time after.

“That’s very provoking, now,” said Jack, rubbing the point of his nose.

"That's really provoking now," Jack said, rubbing the tip of his nose.

“Very,” I replied, stroking my chin.

“Definitely,” I replied, rubbing my chin.

“Well, we must make haste and rejoin Peterkin,” said Jack. “It’s getting late.” And, without further remark, we threaded our way quickly through the woods towards the shore.

“Well, we need to hurry and catch up with Peterkin,” said Jack. “It’s getting late.” And, without saying anything more, we made our way quickly through the woods toward the shore.

When we reached it, we found wood laid out, the fire lighted and beginning to kindle up, with other signs of preparation for our encampment, but Peterkin was nowhere to be found. We wondered very much at this; but Jack suggested that he might have gone to fetch water; so he gave a shout to let him know that we had arrived, and sat down upon a rock, while I threw off my jacket and seized the axe, intending to split up one or two billets of wood. But I had scarce moved from the spot when, in the distance, we heard a most appalling shriek, which was followed up by a chorus of yells from the hogs, and a loud “hurrah!”

When we got there, we saw firewood stacked, the fire lit and starting to blaze, along with other signs of preparation for our campsite, but Peterkin was nowhere to be seen. We were quite puzzled by this; however, Jack suggested he might have gone to get water. So, he called out to let him know we had arrived and sat down on a rock, while I took off my jacket and grabbed the axe, planning to chop up a couple of pieces of wood. But I had barely moved when, in the distance, we heard a terrifying scream, followed by a chorus of yells from the pigs, and a loud cheer of “hurrah!”

“I do believe,” said I, “that Peterkin has met with the hogs.”

“I really think,” I said, “that Peterkin has come across the pigs.”

“When Greek meets Greek,” said Jack, soliloquizing, “then comes the tug of—”

“When Greek meets Greek,” said Jack, thinking aloud, “then comes the tug of—”

“Hurrah!” shouted Peterkin in the distance.

"Yay!" shouted Peterkin from a distance.

We turned hastily towards the direction whence the sound came, and soon descried Peterkin walking along the beach towards us with a little pig transfixed on the end of his long spear!

We quickly turned to the direction the sound came from, and soon saw Peterkin walking along the beach towards us with a little pig speared on the end of his long spear!

“Well done, my boy!” exclaimed Jack, slapping him on the shoulder when he came up, “you’re the best shot amongst us.”

“Great job, my boy!” Jack said, giving him a friendly slap on the shoulder when he arrived, “you’re the best shooter in the group.”

“Look here Jack!” cried Peterkin, as he disengaged the animal from his spear. “Do you recognise that hole?” said he, pointing to the pig’s ear; “and are you familiar with this arrow, eh?”

“Look over here, Jack!” shouted Peterkin, as he pulled the animal off his spear. “Do you see that hole?” he said, pointing to the pig’s ear; “and do you recognize this arrow, huh?”

“Well, I declare!” said Jack.

“Well, I swear!” said Jack.

“Of course you do,” interrupted Peterkin; “but, pray, restrain your declarations at this time, and let’s have supper, for I’m uncommonly hungry, I can tell you; and it’s no joke to charge a whole herd of swine with their great-grandmother bristling like a giant porcupine at the head of them!”

“Of course you do,” interrupted Peterkin; “but please, hold off on your declarations for now, and let’s have dinner, because I’m really hungry, I can tell you; and it’s no laughing matter to direct a whole herd of pigs with their great-grandmother bristling like a giant porcupine leading them!”

We now set about preparing supper; and, truly, a good display of viands we made, when all was laid out on a flat rock in the light of the blazing fire. There was, first of all, the little pig; then there was the taro-root, and the yam, and the potato, and six plums; and, lastly, the wood-pigeon. To these Peterkin added a bit of sugar-cane, which he had cut from a little patch of that plant which he had found not long after separating from us; “and,” said he, “the patch was somewhat in a square form, which convinces me it must have been planted by man.”

We started getting dinner ready, and honestly, we put together a great spread when we laid everything out on a flat rock next to the blazing fire. First, there was the little pig; then came the taro root, yam, potato, and six plums; and finally, the wood pigeon. Peterkin added a piece of sugarcane that he had cut from a small patch he discovered soon after he separated from us. “And,” he said, “the patch was kind of square, which makes me think it must have been planted by someone.”

“Very likely,” replied Jack. “From all we have seen, I’m inclined to think that some of the savages must have dwelt here long ago.”

“Very likely,” replied Jack. “From everything we’ve seen, I’m starting to believe that some of the locals must have lived here a long time ago.”

We found no small difficulty in making up our minds how we were to cook the pig. None of us had ever cut up one before, and we did not know exactly how to begin; besides, we had nothing but the axe to do it with, our knife having been forgotten. At last Jack started up and said,—

We had quite a bit of trouble deciding how to cook the pig. None of us had ever butchered one before, and we weren't sure where to start; plus, we only had the axe since we forgot the knife. Finally, Jack jumped up and said,—

“Don’t let us waste more time talking about it, boys. Hold it up, Peterkin. There, lay the hind leg on this block of wood, so;” and he cut it off, with a large portion of the haunch, at a single blow of the axe. “Now the other,—that’s it.” And having thus cut off the two hind legs, he made several deep gashes in them, thrust a sharp-pointed stick through each, and stuck them up before the blaze to roast. The wood-pigeon was then split open, quite flat, washed clean in salt water, and treated in a similar manner. While these were cooking, we scraped a hole in the sand and ashes under the fire, into which we put our vegetables, and covered them up.

“Let’s not waste any more time talking about it, boys. Hold it up, Peterkin. There, lay the back leg on this block of wood, like this;” and he chopped it off, taking a large part of the hindquarter in one swing of the axe. “Now the other one,—that’s it.” After cutting off both hind legs, he made several deep cuts in them, pushed a sharp stick through each, and propped them up by the fire to roast. The wood-pigeon was then split open flat, washed clean in salt water, and prepared the same way. While those were cooking, we dug a hole in the sand and ashes under the fire, where we placed our vegetables and covered them up.

The taro-root was of an oval shape, about ten inches long and four or five thick. It was of a mottled-gray colour, and had a thick rind. We found it somewhat like an Irish potato, and exceedingly good. The yam was roundish, and had a rough brown skin. It was very sweet and well-flavoured. The potato, we were surprised to find, was quite sweet and exceedingly palatable, as also were the plums; and, indeed, the pork and pigeon too, when we came to taste them. Altogether this was decidedly the most luxurious supper we had enjoyed for many a day; and Jack said it was out-of-sight better than we ever got on board ship; and Peterkin said he feared that if we should remain long on the island he would infallibly become a glutton or an epicure: whereat Jack remarked that he need not fear that, for he was both already! And so, having eaten our fill, not forgetting to finish off with a plum, we laid ourselves comfortably down to sleep upon a couch of branches under the overhanging ledge of a coral rock.

The taro root was oval-shaped, about ten inches long and four or five inches thick. It had a mottled gray color and a thick skin. We thought it was somewhat like an Irish potato and really tasty. The yam was round and had a rough brown skin. It was very sweet and flavorful. To our surprise, the potato was quite sweet and incredibly delicious, as were the plums; and honestly, the pork and pigeon were great too when we tried them. Overall, this was definitely the most luxurious dinner we’d had in a long time; Jack said it was way better than anything we got on the ship; and Peterkin said he was worried that if we stayed on the island too long, he would definitely become a glutton or a foodie, to which Jack replied he didn't need to worry because he was both already! So, after eating our fill and not forgetting to finish with a plum, we comfortably settled down to sleep on a bed of branches under the overhanging edge of a coral rock.

CHAPTER XI.

Effects of over-eating, and reflections thereon—Humble advice regarding cold water—The “horrible cry” accounted for—The curious birds called penguins—Peculiarity of the cocoa nut palm—Questions on the formation of coral islands—Mysterious footsteps—Strange discoveries and sad sights.

Effects of overeating and thoughts on it—Simple advice about cold water—The “horrible cry” explained—The unique birds known as penguins—The uniqueness of the coconut palm—Inquiries about how coral islands form—Mysterious footprints—Bizarre findings and unfortunate scenes.

When we awoke on the following morning, we found that the sun was already a good way above the horizon, so I came to the conclusion that a heavy supper is not conducive to early rising. Nevertheless, we felt remarkably strong and well, and much disposed to have our breakfast. First, however, we had our customary morning bathe, which refreshed us greatly.

When we woke up the next morning, we discovered that the sun was already quite high in the sky, so I realized that a big dinner doesn’t help with waking up early. Still, we felt really strong and good, and we were eager to have our breakfast. But first, we took our usual morning swim, which really refreshed us.

I have often wondered very much in after years that the inhabitants of my own dear land did not make more frequent use of this most charming element, water. I mean in the way of cold bathing. Of course, I have perceived that it is not convenient for them to go into the sea or the rivers in winter, as we used to do on the Coral Island; but then, I knew from experience that a large washing-tub and a sponge do form a most pleasant substitute. The feelings of freshness, of cleanliness, of vigour, and extreme hilarity, that always followed my bathes in the sea, and even, when in England, my ablutions in the wash-tub, were so delightful, that I would sooner have gone without my breakfast than without my bathe in cold water. My readers will forgive me for asking whether they are in the habit of bathing thus every morning; and if they answer “No,” they will pardon me for recommending them to begin at once. Of late years, since retiring from the stirring life of adventure which I have led so long in foreign climes, I have heard of a system called the cold-water-cure. Now, I do not know much about that system, so I do not mean to uphold it, neither do I intend to run it down. Perhaps, in reference to it, I may just hint that there may be too much of a good thing. I know not; but of this I am quite certain, that there may also be too little of a good thing; and the great delight I have had in cold bathing during the course of my adventurous career inclines me to think that it is better to risk taking too much than to content one’s self with too little. Such is my opinion, derived from much experience; but I put it before my readers with the utmost diffidence and with profound modesty, knowing that it may possibly jar with their feelings of confidence in their own ability to know and judge as to what is best and fittest in reference to their own affairs. But, to return from this digression, for which I humbly crave forgiveness.

I have often thought over the years about why the people in my beloved country don't take more advantage of the wonderful element of water. I'm talking about cold bathing. I understand that it's not practical for them to jump into the sea or rivers in winter, like we did on Coral Island; however, I know from experience that a large washing tub and a sponge can be a great alternative. The refreshing feeling of cleanliness, energy, and sheer joy I always felt after swimming in the sea and even just washing up in England was so delightful that I would rather skip breakfast than miss out on a cold water bath. I hope my readers don’t mind me asking if they take cold baths every morning; and if they say “No,” I kindly suggest they start right away. Recently, since stepping away from my exciting life of adventure abroad, I’ve heard of something called the cold-water cure. I don’t know much about it, so I’m not here to promote or criticize it. Perhaps it’s true that you can have too much of a good thing. I’m not sure, but I’m definitely convinced that you can also have too little of a good thing. My wonderful experiences with cold bathing throughout my adventurous life lead me to believe it’s better to take the risk of having too much than to settle for too little. This is just my opinion, based on a lot of experience; however, I share it with my readers humbly, knowing it may clash with their confidence in knowing what’s best for their own lives. But let’s get back to the main point, for which I sincerely apologize.

We had not advanced on our journey much above a mile or so, and were just beginning to feel the pleasant glow that usually accompanies vigorous exercise, when, on turning a point that revealed to us a new and beautiful cluster of islands, we were suddenly arrested by the appalling cry which had so alarmed us a few nights before. But this time we were by no means so much alarmed as on the previous occasion, because, whereas at that time it was night, now it was day; and I have always found, though I am unable to account for it, that daylight banishes many of the fears that are apt to assail us in the dark.

We hadn’t traveled more than about a mile when we started feeling that nice rush that comes from getting some good exercise. Just as we rounded a bend and saw a stunning new cluster of islands, we were suddenly stopped in our tracks by the horrifying cry that had frightened us a few nights earlier. But this time, we weren’t nearly as scared as before because, unlike that night, it was now broad daylight. I’ve always noticed, though I can’t explain why, that daylight tends to chase away many of the fears that usually creep up on us in the dark.

On hearing the sound, Peterkin instantly threw forward his spear.

On hearing the sound, Peterkin immediately thrust his spear forward.

“Now, what can it be?” said he, looking round at Jack. “I tell you what it is, if we are to go on being pulled up in a constant state of horror and astonishment, as we have been for the last week, the sooner we’re out o’ this island the better, notwithstanding the yams and lemonade, and pork and plums!”

“Now, what could it be?” he said, glancing at Jack. “I’ll tell you what it is. If we’re going to keep feeling this constant state of horror and shock, like we have for the past week, we’d better get off this island as soon as possible, despite the yams, lemonade, pork, and plums!”

Peterkin’s remark was followed by a repetition of the cry, louder than before.

Peterkin’s comment was followed by the shout again, even louder than before.

“It comes from one of these islands,” said Jack.

“It comes from one of these islands,” Jack said.

“It must be the ghost of a jackass, then,” said Peterkin, “for I never heard anything so like.”

“It must be the ghost of a donkey, then,” said Peterkin, “because I’ve never heard anything so similar.”

We all turned our eyes towards the cluster of islands, where, on the largest, we observed curious objects moving on the shore.

We all looked towards the group of islands, where, on the largest one, we saw strange objects moving on the shore.

“Soldiers they are,—that’s flat!” cried Peterkin, gazing at them in the utmost amazement.

“Soldiers, for sure!” cried Peterkin, staring at them in total disbelief.

And, in truth, Peterkin’s remark seemed to me to be correct; for, at the distance from which we saw them, they appeared to be an army of soldiers. There they stood, rank and file, in lines and in squares, marching and countermarching, with blue coats and white trousers. While we were looking at them, the dreadful cry came again over the water, and Peterkin suggested that it must be a regiment sent out to massacre the natives in cold blood. At this remark Jack laughed and said,—

And honestly, I thought Peterkin's comment was spot on; from where we were watching, they looked like an army of soldiers. They stood there in lines and squares, marching back and forth, wearing blue coats and white pants. While we were observing them, that terrifying cry echoed over the water again, and Peterkin suggested it might be a regiment sent out to slaughter the locals without mercy. At this, Jack laughed and said,—

“Why, Peterkin, they are penguins!”

"Wow, Peterkin, they're penguins!"

“Penguins?” repeated Peterkin.

"Penguins?" Peterkin repeated.

“Ay, penguins, Peterkin, penguins,—nothing more or less than big sea-birds, as you shall see one of these days, when we pay them a visit in our boat, which I mean to set about building the moment we return to our bower.”

“Ay, penguins, Peterkin, penguins—nothing more or less than big sea birds, as you'll see one of these days when we visit them in our boat, which I plan to start building the moment we get back to our place.”

“So, then, our dreadful yelling ghosts and our murdering army of soldiers,” remarked Peterkin, “have dwindled down to penguins,—big sea-birds! Very good. Then I propose that we continue our journey as fast as possible, lest our island should be converted into a dream before we get completely round it.”

“So, our terrifying screaming ghosts and our killer army of soldiers,” Peterkin said, “have turned into penguins—huge sea-birds! Alright then. I suggest we keep moving as quickly as we can, or our island might become just a fantasy before we finish exploring it.”

Now, as we continued on our way, I pondered much over this new discovery, and the singular appearance of these birds, of which Jack could only give us a very slight and vague account; and I began to long to commence to our boat, in order that we might go and inspect them more narrowly. But by degrees these thoughts left me, and I began to be much taken up again with the interesting peculiarities of the country which we were passing through.

Now, as we continued on our way, I thought a lot about this new discovery and the unusual appearance of these birds, which Jack could only describe in a very slight and vague way. I started to really want to get to our boat so we could check them out more closely. But gradually, those thoughts faded, and I became much more focused on the interesting features of the landscape we were traveling through.

The second night we passed in a manner somewhat similar to the first, at about two-thirds of the way round the island, as we calculated, and we hoped to sleep on the night following at our bower. I will not here note so particularly all that we said and saw during the course of this second day, as we did not make any further discoveries of great importance. The shore along which we travelled, and the various parts of the woods through which we passed, were similar to those which have been already treated of. There were one or two observations that we made, however, and these were as follows:—

The second night, we spent it in a way that was pretty similar to the first. We figured we were about two-thirds of the way around the island, and we hoped to sleep at our spot the following night. I won't go into detail about everything we talked about and saw during this second day since we didn’t make any major discoveries. The shore we traveled along and the different parts of the woods we passed through were much like what we've already discussed. However, there were one or two observations we made, and they were as follows:—

We saw that, while many of the large fruit-bearing trees grew only in the valleys, and some of them only near the banks of the streams, where the soil was peculiarly rich, the cocoa-nut palm grew in every place whatsoever,—not only on the hill sides, but also on the sea shore, and even, as has been already stated, on the coral reef itself, where the soil, if we may use the name, was nothing better than loose sand mingled with broken shells and coral rock. So near to the sea, too, did this useful tree grow, that in many places its roots were washed by the spray from the breakers. Yet we found the trees growing thus on the sands to be quite as luxuriant as those growing in the valleys, and the fruit as good and refreshing also. Besides this, I noticed that, on the summit of the high mountain, which we once more ascended at a different point from our first ascent, were found abundance of shells and broken coral formations, which Jack and I agreed proved either that this island must have once been under the sea, or that the sea must once have been above the island. In other words, that as shells and coral could not possibly climb to the mountain top, they must have been washed upon it while the mountain top was on a level with the sea. We pondered this very much; and we put to ourselves the question, “What raised the island to its present height above the sea?” But to this we could by no means give to ourselves a satisfactory reply. Jack thought it might have been blown up by a volcano; and Peterkin said he thought it must have jumped up of its own accord! We also noticed, what had escaped us before, that the solid rocks of which the island was formed were quite different from the live coral rocks on the shore, where the wonderful little insects were continually working. They seemed, indeed, to be of the same material,—a substance like limestone; but, while the coral rocks were quite full of minute cells in which the insects lived, the other rocks inland were hard and solid, without the appearance of cells at all. Our thoughts and conversations on this subject were sometimes so profound that Peterkin said we should certainly get drowned in them at last, even although we were such good divers! Nevertheless we did not allow his pleasantry on this and similar points to deter us from making our notes and observations as we went along.

We noticed that while many of the large fruit-bearing trees only grew in the valleys, and some of them only near the banks of the streams where the soil was especially rich, the coconut palm could be found almost anywhere—not just on the hillsides, but also on the beach, and even, as mentioned before, on the coral reef itself, where the soil, if you could call it that, was just loose sand mixed with broken shells and coral rock. This useful tree grew so close to the sea that in many areas its roots were splashed by the waves. Still, we found the trees growing in the sand to be just as lush as those in the valleys, and the fruit was just as good and refreshing. Additionally, I noticed that at the top of the high mountain, which we climbed again from a different direction than our first ascent, there was plenty of shells and broken coral formations, which Jack and I agreed indicated that this island had once been underwater, or that the sea had once been above the island. In other words, since shells and coral couldn’t have climbed to the mountain top, they must have been washed there when the mountain top was level with the sea. We thought about this a lot and asked ourselves, “What raised the island to its current height above the sea?” But we couldn’t come up with a satisfying answer. Jack speculated it might have been pushed up by a volcano, while Peterkin suggested it simply jumped up on its own! We also noticed, which we hadn’t before, that the solid rocks comprising the island were quite different from the live coral rocks along the shore, where the amazing little insects were always at work. They seemed to be made of similar material—a substance like limestone; however, while the coral rocks were packed with tiny cells where the insects lived, the other rocks inland were hard and solid, with no cells visible at all. Our thoughts and discussions on this matter were sometimes so deep that Peterkin joked we would eventually drown in them, even though we were such good divers! Still, we didn’t let his humor on this and similar topics stop us from taking our notes and observations as we went along.

We found several more droves of hogs in the woods, but abstained from killing any of them, having more than sufficient for our present necessities. We saw also many of their foot-prints in this neighbourhood. Among these we also observed the footprints of a smaller animal, which we examined with much care, but could form no certain opinion as to them. Peterkin thought they were those of a little dog, but Jack and I thought differently. We became very curious on this matter, the more so that we observed these foot-prints to lie scattered about in one locality, as if the animal which had made them was wandering round about in a very irregular manner, and without any object in view. Early in the forenoon of our third day we observed these footprints to be much more numerous than ever, and in one particular spot they diverged off into the woods in a regular beaten track, which was, however, so closely beset with bushes, that we pushed through it with difficulty. We had now become so anxious to find out what animal this was, and where it went to, that we determined to follow the track, and, if possible, clear up the mystery. Peterkin said, in a bantering tone, that he was sure it would be cleared up as usual in some frightfully simple way, and prove to be no mystery at all!

We found several more groups of pigs in the woods, but we decided not to kill any of them since we had more than enough for what we needed right now. We also saw many of their footprints nearby. Among these, we noticed the footprints of a smaller animal, which we examined closely, but we couldn't come to a definite conclusion about them. Peterkin thought they belonged to a little dog, but Jack and I disagreed. We became really curious about this, especially since we noticed these footprints scattered around one area, as if the animal that made them was wandering aimlessly without any purpose. Early on the morning of our third day, we saw that these footprints were more numerous than ever, and in one spot, they formed a clear path leading into the woods, which was so thick with bushes that we struggled to push through it. We were now so eager to find out what animal this was and where it was going that we decided to follow the trail and, if possible, solve the mystery. Peterkin joked that he was sure it would turn out to be something ridiculously simple and wouldn't be a mystery at all!

The beaten track seemed much too large to have been formed by the animal itself, and we concluded that some larger animal had made it, and that the smaller one made use of it. But everywhere the creeping plants and tangled bushes crossed our path, so that we forced our way along with some difficulty. Suddenly, as we came upon an open space, we heard a faint cry, and observed a black animal standing in the track before us.

The worn path looked way too big to have been created by the animal itself, so we figured that a larger animal must have made it, and the smaller one was just using it. But all around us, creeping plants and tangled bushes blocked our way, making it difficult to push through. Then, as we entered a clear area, we heard a faint cry and saw a black animal standing in the path ahead of us.

“A wild-cat!” cried Jack, fitting an arrow to his bow, and discharging it so hastily that he missed the animal, and hit the earth about half a foot to one side of it. To our surprise the wild-cat did not fly, but walked slowly towards the arrow, and snuffed at it.

“A wild cat!” shouted Jack, nocking an arrow to his bow and firing so quickly that he missed the animal and hit the ground about six inches to the side. To our surprise, the wild cat didn’t run away; instead, it slowly walked over to the arrow and sniffed at it.

“That’s the most comical wild-cat I ever saw!” cried Jack.

"That’s the funniest wildcat I’ve ever seen!" yelled Jack.

“It’s a tame wild-cat, I think,” said Peterkin, levelling his spear to make a charge.

“It’s a tamed wild cat, I think,” said Peterkin, aiming his spear to make a charge.

“Stop!” cried I, laying my hand on his shoulder; “I do believe the poor beast is blind. See, it strikes against the branches as it walks along. It must be a very old one;” and I hastened towards it.

“Stop!” I shouted, putting my hand on his shoulder; “I think the poor animal is blind. Look, it’s bumping into the branches as it moves. It must be really old;” and I rushed over to it.

“Only think,” said Peterkin, with a suppressed laugh, “of a superannuated wild-cat!”

“Just imagine,” said Peterkin, with a stifled laugh, “an old wildcat!”

We now found that the poor cat was not only blind, or nearly so, but extremely deaf, as it did not hear our footsteps until we were quite close behind it. Then it sprang round, and, putting up its back and tail, while the black hair stood all on end, uttered a hoarse mew and a fuff.

We now realized that the poor cat was not only blind, or almost blind, but also very deaf, as it didn't hear our footsteps until we were right behind it. Then it turned around, arching its back and tail, with the black fur standing on end, and let out a raspy meow and a puff.

“Poor thing,” said Peterkin, gently extending his hand, and endeavouring to pat the cat’s head. “Poor pussy; chee, chee, chee; puss, puss, puss; cheetie pussy!”

“Poor thing,” said Peterkin, gently reaching out his hand and trying to pet the cat’s head. “Poor kitty; here, here, here; kitty, kitty, kitty; sweet kitty!”

No sooner did the cat hear these sounds than all signs of anger fled, and, advancing eagerly to Peterkin, it allowed itself to be stroked, and rubbed itself against his legs, purring loudly all the time, and showing every symptom of the most extreme delight.

No sooner did the cat hear these sounds than all signs of anger disappeared, and, eagerly moving toward Peterkin, it let itself be petted, rubbing against his legs, purring loudly the whole time, and displaying every sign of pure bliss.

“It’s no more a wild cat than I am!” cried Peterkin, taking it in his arms. “It’s quite tame. Poor pussy, cheetie pussy!”

“It’s not any more of a wild cat than I am!” shouted Peterkin, picking it up. “It’s totally tame. Poor kitty, sweet kitty!”

We now crowded around Peterkin, and were not a little surprised, and, to say truth, a good deal affected, by the sight of the poor animal’s excessive joy. It rubbed its head against Peterkin’s cheek, licked his chin, and thrust its head almost violently into his neck, while it purred more loudly than I ever heard a cat purr before, and appeared to be so much overpowered by its feelings, that it occasionally mewed and purred almost in the same breath. Such demonstrations of joy and affection led us at once to conclude that this poor cat must have known man before, and we conjectured that it had been left either accidentally or by design on the island many years ago, and was now evincing its extreme joy at meeting once more with human beings. While we were fondling the cat and talking about it, Jack glanced round the open space in the midst of which we stood.

We all gathered around Peterkin, quite surprised and honestly a bit touched by the sight of the poor animal's overwhelming happiness. It rubbed its head against Peterkin's cheek, licked his chin, and almost violently nudged its head into his neck, purring louder than I had ever heard a cat purr before. It seemed so overwhelmed by its emotions that it occasionally meowed and purred almost at the same time. Such displays of joy and affection led us to believe that this poor cat must have known humans before, and we speculated that it had been left on the island either by accident or on purpose many years ago, now showing its immense joy at encountering humans again. While we were petting the cat and discussing it, Jack looked around the open space where we stood.

“Hallo!” exclaimed he; “this looks something like a clearing. The axe has been at work here. Just look at these tree-stumps.”

“Hey!” he exclaimed; “this looks like a clearing. Someone's been chopping wood here. Just look at these tree stumps.”

We now turned to examine these, and, without doubt, we found trees that had been cut down here and there, also stumps and broken branches; all of which, however, were completely covered over with moss, and bore evidence of having been in this condition for some years. No human foot-prints were to be seen, either on the track or among the bushes; but those of the cat were found everywhere. We now determined to follow up the track as far as it went, and Peterkin put the cat down; but it seemed to be so weak, and mewed so very pitifully, that he took it up again and carried it in his arms, where, in a few minutes, it fell sound asleep.

We now turned our attention to these and, without a doubt, we found trees that had been cut down here and there, along with stumps and broken branches; all of which were completely covered in moss and showed signs of being in this state for several years. No human footprints were visible, either on the trail or among the bushes; however, the cat's tracks were everywhere. We decided to follow the trail as far as it went, and Peterkin set the cat down; but it seemed so weak and mewed so pitifully that he picked it up again and carried it in his arms, where, after a few minutes, it fell fast asleep.

About ten yards farther on, the felled trees became more numerous, and the track, diverging to the right, followed for a short space the banks of a stream. Suddenly we came to a spot where once must have been a rude bridge, the stones of which were scattered in the stream, and those on each bank entirely covered over with moss. In silent surprise and expectancy we continued to advance, and, a few yards farther on, beheld, under the shelter of some bread-fruit trees, a small hut or cottage. I cannot hope to convey to my readers a very correct idea of the feelings that affected us on witnessing this unexpected sight. We stood for a long time in silent wonder, for there was a deep and most melancholy stillness about the place that quite overpowered us; and when we did at length speak, it was in subdued whispers, as if we were surrounded by some awful or supernatural influence. Even Peterkin’s voice, usually so quick and lively on all occasions, was hushed now; for there was a dreariness about this silent, lonely, uninhabited cottage,—so strange in its appearance, so far away from the usual dwellings of man, so old, decayed, and deserted in its aspect,—that fell upon our spirits like a thick cloud, and blotted out as with a pall the cheerful sunshine that had filled us since the commencement of our tour round the island.

About ten yards farther on, the fallen trees became more numerous, and the path veered to the right, briefly following the banks of a stream. Suddenly, we reached a spot where there must have once been a makeshift bridge, with stones scattered in the water and those on each bank completely covered in moss. In silent surprise and expectation, we continued onward, and a few yards later, we saw, under the shelter of some breadfruit trees, a small hut or cottage. I can’t convey to my readers the exact feelings we experienced upon witnessing this unexpected sight. We stood in silence for a long time, filled with wonder, as there was a deep and profoundly melancholic stillness about the place that overwhelmed us; and when we finally spoke, it was in hushed tones, as if we were under some dreadful or supernatural spell. Even Peterkin's voice, usually so lively and quick in any situation, was quiet now, for there was a sense of bleakness surrounding this silent, solitary, uninhabited cottage—so odd in its appearance, so far from typical human dwellings, so old, decayed, and deserted in its look—that it weighed on our spirits like a thick cloud, overshadowing the cheerful sunshine that had filled us since the start of our tour around the island.

The hut or cottage was rude and simple in its construction. It was not more than twelve feet long by ten feet broad, and about seven or eight feet high. It had one window, or rather a small frame in which a window might, perhaps, once have been, but which was now empty. The door was exceedingly low, and formed of rough boards, and the roof was covered with broad cocoa-nut and plantain leaves. But every part of it was in a state of the utmost decay. Moss and green matter grew in spots all over it. The woodwork was quite perforated with holes; the roof had nearly fallen in, and appeared to be prevented from doing so altogether by the thick matting of creeping-plants and the interlaced branches which years of neglect had allowed to cover it almost entirely; while the thick, luxuriant branches of the bread-fruit and other trees spread above it, and flung a deep, sombre shadow over the spot, as if to guard it from the heat and the light of day. We conversed long and in whispers about this strange habitation ere we ventured to approach it; and when at length we did so it was, at least on my part, with feelings of awe.

The hut was basic and simple in its design. It measured about twelve feet long by ten feet wide and stood around seven or eight feet tall. It had one window, or more accurately, a small frame where a window might have been at one time, but now it was empty. The door was very low and made of rough boards, and the roof was covered with large coconut and plantain leaves. However, every part of it was in a state of severe decay. Moss and green growth covered various spots all over it. The wood had holes all over; the roof was almost caved in, held up only by the thick mat of creeping plants and intertwined branches that years of neglect had allowed to cover it nearly entirely. Above, the thick, lush branches of the breadfruit and other trees cast a deep, dark shadow over the area, as if to protect it from the heat and light of day. We whispered for a long time about this strange dwelling before we decided to approach it, and when we finally did, I felt a sense of awe.

At first Jack endeavoured to peep in at the window, but from the deep shadow of the trees already mentioned, and the gloom within, he could not clearly discern objects; so we lifted the latch and pushed open the door. We observed that the latch was made of iron, and almost eaten away with rust. In the like condition were also the hinges, which creaked as the door swung back. On entering, we stood still and gazed around us, while we were much impressed with the dreary stillness of the room. But what we saw there surprised and shocked us not a little. There was no furniture in the apartment save a little wooden stool and an iron pot, the latter almost eaten through with rust. In the corner farthest from the door was a low bedstead, on which lay two skeletons, imbedded in a little heap of dry dust. With beating hearts we went forward to examine them. One was the skeleton of a man, the other that of a dog, which was extended close beside that of the man, with its head resting on his bosom

At first, Jack tried to peek in through the window, but because of the deep shadows from the trees and the darkness inside, he couldn’t see much. So, we lifted the latch and pushed the door open. We noticed that the latch was made of iron and was almost completely rusted away. The hinges were in the same condition, creaking as the door swung open. Once inside, we paused and looked around, struck by the eerie silence of the room. But what we discovered there surprised and shocked us immensely. There was no furniture in the room except for a small wooden stool and an iron pot, which was nearly rusted through. In the corner farthest from the door was a low bed frame, with two skeletons lying on it, entombed in a small pile of dry dust. With racing hearts, we approached to examine them. One was the skeleton of a man, and the other was a dog, stretched out next to the man, with its head resting on his chest.

Now we were very much concerned about this discovery, and could scarce refrain from tears on beholding these sad remains. After some time, we began to talk about what we had seen, and to examine in and around the hut, in order to discover some clue to the name or history of this poor man, who had thus died in solitude, with none to mourn his loss save his cat and his faithful dog. But we found nothing,—neither a book nor a scrap of paper. We found, however, the decayed remnants of what appeared to have been clothing, and an old axe. But none of these things bore marks of any kind; and, indeed, they were so much decayed as to convince us that they had lain in the condition in which we found them for many years.

Now we were really concerned about this discovery and could hardly hold back our tears when we saw the sad remains. After a while, we started to talk about what we had found and began to search inside and around the hut to find any clue about the name or story of this poor man who had died alone, with only his cat and loyal dog to mourn him. But we found nothing—neither a book nor a scrap of paper. We did find the rotting remnants of what looked like clothing and an old axe. However, none of these items had any identifying marks, and they were so decayed that it was clear they had been left in that condition for many years.

This discovery now accounted to us for the tree stump at the top of the mountain with the initials cut on it; also for the patch of sugar-cane and other traces of man which we had met with in the course of our rambles over the island. And we were much saddened by the reflection that the lot of this poor wanderer might possibly be our own, after many years’ residence on the island, unless we should be rescued by the visit of some vessel or the arrival of natives. Having no clue whatever to account for the presence of this poor human being in such a lonely spot, we fell to conjecturing what could have brought him there. I was inclined to think that he must have been a shipwrecked sailor, whose vessel had been lost here, and all the crew been drowned except himself and his dog and cat. But Jack thought it more likely that he had run away from his vessel, and had taken the dog and cat to keep him company. We were also much occupied in our minds with the wonderful difference between the cat and the dog. For here we saw that while the one perished, like a loving friend, by its master’s side, with its head resting on his bosom, the other had sought to sustain itself by prowling abroad in the forest, and had lived in solitude to a good old age. However, we did not conclude from this that the cat was destitute of affection, for we could not forget its emotions on first meeting with us; but we saw from this, that the dog had a great deal more of generous love in its nature than the cat, because it not only found it impossible to live after the death of its master, but it must needs, when it came to die, crawl to his side and rest its head upon his lifeless breast.

This discovery now explained the tree stump at the top of the mountain with the initials carved into it, as well as the patch of sugarcane and other signs of human presence we had come across during our explorations of the island. We felt quite sad thinking that the fate of this poor wanderer might end up being our own after many years on the island, unless we were rescued by a passing ship or the arrival of locals. With no clue as to how this unfortunate person ended up in such a remote place, we began to speculate about what could have brought him there. I thought he might have been a shipwrecked sailor whose ship sank here, with all the crew drowned except for him and his dog and cat. But Jack believed he was more likely to have escaped from his ship, taking the dog and cat with him for company. We were also preoccupied with the striking difference between the cat and the dog. We noted that while the dog perished like a loyal friend by its master’s side, resting its head on his chest, the cat had tried to survive by roaming the forest and lived a long life in solitude. However, we didn't take this to mean that the cat lacked affection; we couldn't forget how it had reacted when it first met us. Yet, we realized that the dog seemed to possess a much greater capacity for love than the cat, as it could not bear to live after its master died and, when it was time to die, it crawled to his side and laid its head on his lifeless chest.

While we were thinking on these things, and examining into everything about the room, we were attracted by an exclamation from Peterkin.

While we were thinking about these things and checking out everything in the room, we were drawn in by an exclamation from Peterkin.

“I say, Jack,” said he, “here is something that will be of use to us.”

“I’ve got something for us, Jack,” he said.

“What is it?” said Jack, hastening across the room.

"What is it?" Jack asked, quickly crossing the room.

“An old pistol,” replied Peterkin, holding up the weapon, which he had just pulled from under a heap of broken wood and rubbish that lay in a corner.

“An old pistol,” Peterkin replied, holding up the weapon he had just pulled from under a pile of broken wood and trash in the corner.

“That, indeed, might have been useful,” said Jack, examining it, “if we had any powder; but I suspect the bow and the sling will prove more serviceable.”

“That could have been helpful,” said Jack, looking it over, “if we had any gunpowder; but I think the bow and the sling will be more useful.”

“True, I forgot that,” said Peterkin; “but we may as well take it with us, for the flint will serve to strike fire with when the sun does not shine.”

“True, I forgot that,” said Peterkin; “but we might as well take it with us, because the flint will help us start a fire when the sun isn’t shining.”

After having spent more than an hour at this place without discovering anything of further interest, Peterkin took up the old cat, which had lain very contentedly asleep on the stool whereon he had placed it, and we prepared to take our departure. In leaving the hut, Jack stumbled heavily against the door-post, which was so much decayed as to break across, and the whole fabric of the hut seemed ready to tumble about our ears. This put into our heads that we might as well pull it down, and so form a mound over the skeleton. Jack, therefore, with his axe, cut down the other door-post, which, when it was done, brought the whole hut in ruins to the ground, and thus formed a grave to the bones of the poor recluse and his dog. Then we left the spot, having brought away the iron pot, the pistol, and the old axe, as they might be of much use to us hereafter.

After spending over an hour in this place without finding anything else of interest, Peterkin picked up the old cat that had been sleeping contentedly on the stool where he’d placed it, and we got ready to leave. As we were leaving the hut, Jack accidentally bumped heavily into the doorpost, which was so rotted that it broke apart, and the entire structure of the hut seemed ready to collapse around us. This made us think it would be better to tear it down and create a mound over the skeleton. So, Jack took his axe and chopped down the other doorpost, and once he did that, the whole hut fell down in ruins, creating a grave for the bones of the poor recluse and his dog. After that, we left the area, taking the iron pot, the pistol, and the old axe with us since they could be really useful later.

During the rest of this day we pursued our journey, and examined the other end of the large valley, which we found to be so much alike to the parts already described, that I shall not recount the particulars of what we saw in this place. I may, however, remark, that we did not quite recover our former cheerful spirits until we arrived at our bower, which we did late in the evening, and found everything just in the same condition as we had left it three days before.

During the rest of the day, we continued our journey and explored the other end of the large valley. We found it so similar to the parts we've already described that I won’t go into details about what we saw there. However, I will mention that we didn't fully regain our cheerful spirits until we reached our shelter late in the evening, where we found everything just as we had left it three days earlier.

CHAPTER XII.

Something wrong with the tank—Jack’s wisdom and Peterkin’s impertinence—Wonderful behaviour of a crab—Good wishes for those who dwell far from the sea—Jack commences to build a little boat.

Something's wrong with the tank—Jack’s insight and Peterkin’s cheekiness—Amazing behavior of a crab—Best wishes for those who live far from the sea—Jack starts building a small boat.

Rest is sweet as well for the body as for the mind. During my long experience, amid the vicissitudes of a chequered life, I have found that periods of profound rest at certain intervals, in addition to the ordinary hours of repose, are necessary to the wellbeing of man. And the nature as well as the period of this rest varies, according to the different temperaments of individuals, and the peculiar circumstances in which they may chance to be placed. To those who work with their minds, bodily labour is rest. To those who labour with the body, deep sleep is rest. To the downcast, the weary, and the sorrowful, joy and peace are rest. Nay, further, I think that to the gay, the frivolous, the reckless, when sated with pleasures that cannot last, even sorrow proves to be rest of a kind, although, perchance, it were better that I should call it relief than rest. There is, indeed, but one class of men to whom rest is denied. There is no rest to the wicked. At this I do but hint, however, as I treat not of that rest which is spiritual, but, more particularly, of that which applies to the mind and to the body.

Rest is refreshing for both the body and the mind. Throughout my long experience with the ups and downs of a varied life, I’ve discovered that periods of deep rest at certain intervals, in addition to regular hours of sleep, are essential for a person's wellbeing. The type and duration of this rest differs based on individuals' temperaments and the specific situations they find themselves in. For those who work mentally, physical labor serves as a form of rest. For those who work physically, a deep sleep provides rest. For the downhearted, the tired, and the mournful, joy and peace offer rest. Moreover, I believe that for the cheerful, the carefree, and the reckless, when they’re exhausted from fleeting pleasures, even sadness can be a form of rest, although perhaps it's better described as relief rather than true rest. In fact, there’s only one group of people to whom rest is denied. The wicked know no rest. I only allude to this here, as I am not discussing the spiritual rest but rather focusing on that which pertains to the mind and body.

Of this rest we stood much in need on our return home, and we found it exceedingly sweet, when we indulged in it, after completing the journey just related. It had not, indeed, been a very long journey, nevertheless we had pursued it so diligently that our frames were not a little prostrated. Our minds were also very much exhausted in consequence of the many surprises, frequent alarms, and much profound thought, to which they had been subjected; so that when we lay down on the night of our return under the shelter of the bower, we fell immediately into very deep repose. I can state this with much certainty, for Jack afterwards admitted the fact, and Peterkin, although he stoutly denied it, I heard snoring loudly at least two minutes after lying down. In this condition we remained all night and the whole of the following day without awaking once, or so much as moving our positions. When we did awake it was near sunset, and we were all in such a state of lassitude that we merely rose to swallow a mouthful of food. As Peterkin remarked, in the midst of a yawn, we took breakfast at tea-time, and then went to bed again, where we lay till the following forenoon.

We really needed that rest when we got back home, and it felt incredibly refreshing after completing the journey we just experienced. It wasn't a particularly long journey, but we had worked so hard that we were pretty worn out. Our minds were also drained from all the surprises, constant scares, and deep thinking we had to deal with. So when we lay down that night under the shelter of the bower, we immediately fell into a deep sleep. I can say this for sure, since Jack later admitted it, and even though Peterkin strongly denied it, I heard him snoring loudly at least two minutes after we lay down. We stayed in that state all night and through the next day without waking up at all or even changing positions. When we finally did wake up, it was near sunset, and we felt so sluggish that we just got up to eat a quick bite. As Peterkin said with a yawn, we had breakfast at tea time and then went back to bed, where we stayed until the following morning.

After this we arose very greatly refreshed, but much alarmed lest we had lost count of a day. I say we were much alarmed on this head, for we had carefully kept count of the days since we were cast upon our island, in order that we might remember the Sabbath-day, which day we had hitherto with one accord kept as a day of rest, and refrained from all work whatsoever. However, on considering the subject, we all three entertained the same opinion as to how long we had slept, and so our minds were put at ease.

After this, we got up feeling really refreshed but quite worried that we might have lost track of a day. I say we were very anxious about this because we had been carefully counting the days since we ended up on our island, so we could remember the Sabbath, which we had all agreed to keep as a day of rest, avoiding any work at all. However, after thinking it over, all three of us agreed on how long we had slept, and that eased our minds.

We now hastened to our Water Garden to enjoy a bathe, and to see how did the animals which I had placed in the tank. We found the garden more charming, pelucid, and inviting than ever, and Jack and I plunged into its depth, and gambolled among its radiant coral groves; while Peterkin wallowed at the surface, and tried occasionally to kick us as we passed below. Having dressed, I then hastened to the tank; but what was my surprise and grief to find nearly all the animals dead, and the water in a putrid condition! I was greatly distressed at this, and wondered what could be the cause of it.

We quickly made our way to our Water Garden to enjoy a swim and check on the animals I’d put in the tank. We found the garden more beautiful, clear, and inviting than ever, and Jack and I dove in happily, playing among the vibrant coral groves while Peterkin splashed around on the surface and tried to kick us as we swam below. After getting dressed, I rushed over to the tank, but I was shocked and heartbroken to find that nearly all the animals were dead and the water was in a disgusting state! I was very upset about this and wondered what could have caused it.

“Why, you precious humbug,” said Peterkin, coming up to me, “how could you expect it to be otherwise? When fishes are accustomed to live in the Pacific Ocean, how can you expect them to exist in a hole like that?”

“Why, you clever trickster,” said Peterkin, walking up to me, “how could you think it would be any different? When fish are used to living in the Pacific Ocean, how can you expect them to survive in a hole like that?”

“Indeed, Peterkin,” I replied, “there seems to be truth in what you say. Nevertheless, now I think of it, there must be some error in your reasoning; for, if I put in but a few very small animals, they will bear the same proportion to this pond that the millions of fish bear to the ocean.”

“Yeah, Peterkin,” I replied, “there’s definitely some truth in what you’re saying. However, now that I think about it, I think there’s an error in your reasoning; because if I add just a few tiny animals, they’ll be in the same proportion to this pond as the millions of fish are to the ocean.”

“I say, Jack,” cried Peterkin, waving his hand, “come here, like a good fellow. Ralph is actually talking philosophy. Do come to our assistance, for he’s out o’ sight beyond me already!”

“I say, Jack,” yelled Peterkin, waving his hand, “come here, like a good friend. Ralph is actually discussing philosophy. Please help us, because he’s already way beyond me!”

“What’s the matter?” inquired Jack, coming up, while he endeavoured to scrub his long hair dry with a towel of cocoa-nut cloth.

“What's wrong?” asked Jack, approaching as he tried to dry his long hair with a towel made of coconut fiber.

I repeated my thoughts to Jack, who, I was happy to find, quite agreed with me. “Your best plan,” he said, “will be to put very few animals at first into your tank, and add more as you find it will bear them. And look here,” he added, pointing to the sides of the tank, which, for the space of two inches above the water-level, were incrusted with salt, “you must carry your philosophy a little farther, Ralph. That water has evaporated so much that it is too salt for anything to live in. You will require to add fresh water now and then, in order to keep it at the same degree of saltness as the sea.”

I shared my thoughts with Jack, who I was glad to see agreed with me. “Your best approach,” he said, “is to start with very few animals in your tank and add more as you see it can handle them. And look here,” he added, pointing to the sides of the tank, which were covered in salt for about two inches above the water level, “you need to take your thinking a bit further, Ralph. That water has evaporated so much that it’s too salty for anything to survive in. You’ll need to add fresh water every now and then to keep it at the same saltiness as the sea.”

“Very true, Jack, that never struck me before,” said I.

“That's so true, Jack, I never thought of that before,” I said.

“And, now I think of it,” continued Jack, “it seems to me that the surest way of arranging your tank so as to get it to keep pure and in good condition, will be to imitate the ocean in it. In fact make it a miniature Pacific. I don’t see how you can hope to succeed unless you do that.”

“And now that I think about it,” Jack went on, “it seems to me the best way to set up your tank to keep it clean and in good shape is to mimic the ocean. In fact, make it a little Pacific. I don’t see how you can expect to succeed without doing that.”

“Most true,” said I, pondering what my companion said. “But I fear that that will be very difficult.”

“That's mostly true,” I replied, thinking about what my friend said. “But I worry that it will be really hard.”

“Not at all,” cried Jack, rolling his towel up into a ball, and throwing it into the face of Peterkin, who had been grinning and winking at him during the last five minutes. “Not at all. Look here. There is water of a certain saltness in the sea; well, fill your tank with sea water, and keep it at that saltness by marking the height at which the water stands on the sides. When it evaporates a little, pour in fresh water from the brook till it comes up to the mark, and then it will be right, for the salt does not evaporate with the water. Then, there’s lots of sea-weed in the sea;—well, go and get one or two bits of sea-weed, and put them into your tank. Of course the weed must be alive, and growing to little stones; or you can chip a bit off the rocks with the weed sticking to it. Then, if you like, you can throw a little sand and gravel into your tank, and the thing’s complete.”

“Not at all,” shouted Jack, rolling his towel into a ball and tossing it at Peterkin, who had been grinning and winking at him for the last five minutes. “Not at all. Look, the sea has water with a certain level of saltiness; so, fill your tank with sea water and keep it at that level of saltness by marking how high the water reaches on the sides. When it evaporates a bit, add in some fresh water from the brook until it reaches the mark, and then it’ll be right because the salt doesn’t evaporate with the water. Also, there’s plenty of seaweed in the sea—so, go grab one or two pieces of seaweed and put them in your tank. Of course, the weed has to be alive and attached to some small rocks; or you can chip off a piece of the rock with the weed still on it. Then, if you want, you can toss in a little sand and gravel into your tank, and it’ll be all set.”

“Nay, not quite,” said Peterkin, who had been gravely attentive to this off-hand advice, “not quite; you must first make three little men to dive in it before it can be said to be perfect, and that would be rather difficult, I fear, for two of them would require to be philosophers. But hallo! what’s this? I say, Ralph, look here. There’s one o’ your crabs up to something uncommon. It’s performing the most remarkable operation for a crab I ever saw,—taking off its coat, I do believe, before going to bed!”

“Nah, not really,” said Peterkin, who had been seriously considering this casual advice. “Not really; you first need to make three little guys dive in it before it can be called perfect, and that might be kind of tough, since two of them would need to be philosophers. But hey! What’s this? I say, Ralph, check this out. There’s one of your crabs doing something unusual. It’s doing the most amazing thing for a crab I’ve ever seen—it’s taking off its shell, I think, before going to bed!”

We hastily stooped over the tank, and certainly were not a little amused at the conduct of one of the crabs which still survived it companions. It was one of the common small crabs, like to those that are found running about everywhere on the coasts of England. While we gazed at it, we observed its back to split away from the lower part of its body, and out of the gap thus formed came a soft lump which moved and writhed unceasingly. This lump continued to increase in size until it appeared like a bunch of crab’s legs: and, indeed, such it proved in a very few minutes to be; for the points of the toes were at length extricated from this hole in its back, the legs spread out, the body followed, and the crab walked away quite entire, even to the points of its nipper-claws, leaving a perfectly entire shell behind it, so that, when we looked, it seemed as though there were two complete crabs instead of one!

We quickly leaned over the tank and were definitely amused by the actions of one of the crabs that was still alive. It was one of the common small crabs, similar to those that are found scurrying around everywhere along the coasts of England. As we watched it, we noticed its back splitting away from the lower part of its body, and out of the opening came a soft lump that moved and wriggled constantly. This lump kept growing until it looked like a bunch of crab legs; and in just a few minutes, that’s exactly what it turned out to be. The tips of the legs finally emerged from the hole in its back, the legs spread out, the body followed, and the crab walked away completely intact, including its claws, leaving behind a perfectly intact shell. It was like there were suddenly two complete crabs instead of one!

“Well!” exclaimed Peterkin, drawing a long breath, “I’ve heard of a man jumping out of his skin and sitting down in his skeleton in order to cool himself, but I never expected to see a crab do it!”

“Well!” exclaimed Peterkin, taking a deep breath, “I’ve heard of a man jumping out of his skin and sitting in his skeleton to cool off, but I never expected to see a crab do it!”

We were, in truth, much amazed at this spectacle, and the more so when we observed that the new crab was larger than the crab that it came out of. It was also quite soft, but by next morning its skin had hardened into a good shell. We came thus to know that crabs grow in this way, and not by the growing of their shells, as we had always thought before we saw this wonderful operation.

We were honestly pretty amazed by this sight, especially when we saw that the new crab was bigger than the one it had come out of. It was also quite soft, but by the next morning, its skin had hardened into a solid shell. This helped us understand that crabs grow like this, rather than just their shells growing, which is what we had always believed before witnessing this incredible process.

Now I considered well the advice which Jack had given me about preparing my tank, and the more I thought of it, the more I came to regard it as very sound and worthy of being acted on. So I forthwith put his plan in execution, and found it to answer excellently well, indeed much beyond my expectation; for I found that after a little experience had taught me the proper proportion of sea-weed and animals to put into a certain amount of water, the tank needed no farther attendance; and, moreover, I did not require ever afterwards to renew or change the sea-water, but only to add a very little fresh water from the brook, now and then, as the other evaporated. I therefore concluded that if I had been suddenly conveyed, along with my tank, into some region where there was no salt sea at all, my little sea and my sea-fish would have continued to thrive and to prosper notwithstanding. This made me greatly to desire that those people in the world who live far inland might know of my wonderful tank, and, by having materials like to those of which it was made conveyed to them, thus be enabled to watch the habits of those most mysterious animals that reside in the sea, and examine with their own eyes the wonders of the great deep.

Now I really thought about the advice Jack had given me about setting up my tank, and the more I considered it, the more I realized it was wise and worth following. So I immediately put his plan into action, and it worked better than I expected; after a bit of experience taught me the right mix of seaweed and sea creatures to add to a certain amount of water, the tank required no further care. Plus, I never had to replace or change the seawater again; I just needed to add a little fresh water from the brook now and then as the other water evaporated. I concluded that if I had suddenly been transported, along with my tank, to a place with no saltwater at all, my little sea and my sea creatures would still have thrived. This made me really wish that those people who live far inland could hear about my amazing tank, and by getting materials similar to what it was made of, they could observe the habits of those strange animals that live in the sea and see the wonders of the deep for themselves.

For many days after this, while Peterkin and Jack were busily employed in building a little boat out of the curious natural planks of the chestnut tree, I spent much of my time in examining with the burning-glass the marvellous operations that were constantly going on in my tank. Here I saw those anemones which cling, like little red, yellow, and green blobs of jelly, to the rocks, put forth, as it were, a multitude of arms and wait till little fish or other small animalcules unwarily touched them, when they would instantly seize them, fold arm after arm around their victims, and so engulf them in their stomachs. Here I saw the ceaseless working of those little coral insects whose efforts have encrusted the islands of the Pacific with vast rocks, and surrounded them with enormous reefs. And I observed that many of these insects, though extremely minute, were very beautiful, coming out of their holes in a circle of fine threads, and having the form of a shuttle-cock. Here I saw curious little barnacles opening a hole in their backs and constantly putting out a thin feathery hand, with which, I doubt not, they dragged their food into their mouths. Here, also, I saw those crabs which have shells only on the front of their bodies, but no shell whatever on their remarkably tender tails, so that, in order to find a protection to them, they thrust them into the empty shells of wilks, or some such fish, and when they grow too big for one, change into another. But, most curious of all, I saw an animal which had the wonderful power, when it became ill, of casting its stomach and its teeth away from it, and getting an entirely new set in the course of a few months! All this I saw, and a great deal more, by means of my tank and my burning-glass, but I refrain from setting down more particulars here, as I have still much to tell of the adventures that befell us while we remained on this island.

For many days after this, while Peterkin and Jack were busy building a small boat out of the interesting natural planks from the chestnut tree, I spent a lot of my time using my burning glass to study the amazing activities happening in my tank. Here, I saw those anemones that cling to the rocks like little red, yellow, and green blobs of jelly, extending a multitude of arms and waiting for small fish or other tiny creatures to unwittingly touch them. They would immediately seize their prey, wrapping arm after arm around them and engulfing them. I witnessed the continuous work of tiny coral insects, whose efforts have formed vast rocky islands in the Pacific and surrounded them with huge reefs. I noticed that many of these tiny insects were quite beautiful, emerging from their holes surrounded by fine threads and resembling a shuttlecock. I also observed curious little barnacles that opened a hole in their backs and constantly extended a thin, feathery hand, which I believe they used to pull food into their mouths. Additionally, I saw crabs that have shells only on the front of their bodies but no shell covering their sensitive tails, so they find protection by stuffing them into vacant shells from whelks or similar fish, switching to new ones as they grow too big for the old ones. But the most amazing of all was an animal that had the incredible ability to cast off its stomach and teeth when it fell ill and develop an entirely new set in just a few months! I observed all this and much more through my tank and burning glass, but I'll hold back from sharing more details here since I still have plenty to recount about the adventures we experienced while we were on this island.

CHAPTER XIII.

Notable discovery at the spouting cliffs—The mysterious green monster explained—We are thrown into unutterable terror by the idea that Jack is drowned—The Diamond Cave.

Notable discovery at the spouting cliffs—The mysterious green monster explained—We are overwhelmed with unimaginable fear at the thought that Jack has drowned—The Diamond Cave.

“Come, Jack,” cried Peterkin, one morning about three weeks after our return from our long excursion, “let’s be jolly to-day, and do something vigorous. I’m quite tired of hammering and hammering, hewing and screwing, cutting and butting, at that little boat of ours, that seems as hard to build as Noah’s ark; let us go on an excursion to the mountain top, or have a hunt after the wild ducks, or make a dash at the pigs. I’m quite flat—flat as bad ginger-beer—flat as a pancake; in fact, I want something to rouse me, to toss me up, as it were. Eh! what do you say to it?”

“Come on, Jack,” shouted Peterkin one morning about three weeks after we got back from our long trip, “let’s have some fun today and do something active. I’m really tired of working away at that little boat of ours, which feels as difficult to build as Noah’s ark; let’s go on an adventure to the mountain top, or hunt for wild ducks, or try to catch some pigs. I’m feeling really down—down like bad ginger beer—flat like a pancake; honestly, I need something to wake me up, to get me moving again. What do you think?”

“Well,” answered Jack, throwing down the axe with which he was just about to proceed towards the boat, “if that’s what you want, I would recommend you to make an excursion to the water-spouts; the last one we had to do with tossed you up a considerable height, perhaps the next will send you higher, who knows, if you’re at all reasonable or moderate in your expectations!”

“Well,” Jack said, dropping the axe he was about to use to head to the boat, “if that’s what you want, I suggest you take a trip to the water-spouts. The last one we dealt with threw you up really high; maybe the next one will launch you even higher. Who knows, if you keep your expectations reasonable or moderate!”

“Jack, my dear boy,” said Peterkin, gravely, “you are really becoming too fond of jesting. It’s a thing I don’t at all approve of, and if you don’t give it up, I fear that, for our mutual good, we shall have to part.”

“Jack, my dear boy,” said Peterkin, seriously, “you’re really getting too into joking around. I don’t approve of it at all, and if you don’t stop, I’m afraid that, for both our sakes, we’ll have to go our separate ways.”

“Well, then, Peterkin,” replied Jack, with a smile, “what would you have?”

“Well, then, Peterkin,” Jack replied with a smile, “what do you want?”

“Have?” said Peterkin, “I would have nothing. I didn’t say I wanted to have; I said that I wanted to do.”

“Have?” said Peterkin, “I wouldn’t have anything. I didn’t say I wanted to have; I said that I wanted to do.”

“By the by,” said I, interrupting their conversation, “I am reminded by this that we have not yet discovered the nature of yon curious appearance that we saw near the water-spouts, on our journey round the island. Perhaps it would be well to go for that purpose.”

“By the way,” I said, interrupting their conversation, “this reminds me that we still haven’t figured out what that strange sight was that we saw near the water spouts on our trip around the island. Maybe it would be a good idea to go check it out.”

“Humph!” ejaculated Peterkin, “I know the nature of it well enough.”

“Humph!” exclaimed Peterkin, “I know exactly what it is.”

“What was it?” said I.

“What was that?” I asked.

“It was of a mysterious nature to be sure!” said he, with a wave of his hand, while he rose from the log on which he had been sitting, and buckled on his belt, into which he thrust his enormous club.

“It was definitely a mysterious thing!” he said, waving his hand as he got up from the log he had been sitting on and buckled his belt, into which he slid his huge club.

“Well then, let us away to the water-spouts,” cried Jack, going up to the bower for his bow and arrows; “and bring your spear, Peterkin. It may be useful.”

“Well then, let’s go to the water jets,” Jack shouted, heading to the shelter for his bow and arrows; “and bring your spear, Peterkin. It might come in handy.”

We now, having made up our minds to examine into this matter, sallied forth eagerly in the direction of the water-spout rocks, which, as I have before mentioned, were not far from our present place of abode. On arriving there we hastened down to the edge of the rocks, and gazed over into the sea, where we observed the pale-green object still distinctly visible, moving its tail slowly to and fro in the water.

We had now decided to look into this matter, so we eagerly set off towards the water-spout rocks, which, as I mentioned earlier, weren't far from where we were staying. When we got there, we quickly made our way to the edge of the rocks and looked out over the sea, where we saw the pale-green object still clearly visible, moving its tail slowly back and forth in the water.

“Most remarkable!” said Jack.

"That's amazing!" said Jack.

“Exceedingly curious,” said I.

“Really curious,” I said.

“Beats everything!” said Peterkin.

“Beats everything!” Peterkin exclaimed.

“Now, Jack,” he added, “you made such a poor figure in your last attempt to stick that object, that I would advise you to let me try it. If it has got a heart at all, I’ll engage to send my spear right through the core of it; if it hasn’t got a heart, I’ll send it through the spot where its heart ought to be.”

“Now, Jack,” he added, “you did such a bad job in your last attempt to hit that target that I suggest you let me take a shot at it. If it has a heart at all, I’ll promise to drive my spear straight through the center of it; if it doesn’t have a heart, I’ll pierce it where its heart should be.”

“Fire away, then, my boy,” replied Jack with a laugh.

“Go ahead, then, my boy,” Jack responded with a laugh.

Peterkin immediately took the spear, poised it for a second or two above his head, then darted it like an arrow into the sea. Down it went straight into the centre of the green object, passed quite through it, and came up immediately afterwards, pure and unsullied, while the mysterious tail moved quietly as before!

Peterkin quickly grabbed the spear, held it above his head for a moment, then threw it like an arrow into the sea. It went straight down into the middle of the green object, went right through it, and came back up immediately, clean and unblemished, while the mysterious tail kept moving quietly as before!

“Now,” said Peterkin, gravely, “that brute is a heartless monster; I’ll have nothing more to do with it.”

“Now,” Peterkin said seriously, “that beast is a heartless monster; I want nothing more to do with it.”

“I’m pretty sure now,” said Jack, “that it is merely a phosphoric light; but I must say I’m puzzled at its staying always in that exact spot.”

“I’m fairly certain now,” said Jack, “that it’s just a phosphoric light; but I have to admit I’m confused about why it always stays in that exact spot.”

I also was much puzzled, and inclined to think with Jack that it must be phosphoric light; of which luminous appearance we had seen much while on our voyage to these seas. “But,” said I, “there is nothing to hinder us from diving down to it, now that we are sure it is not a shark.”

I was also very puzzled and started to agree with Jack that it had to be phosphorescent light, which we had seen a lot of during our journey to these waters. “But,” I said, “there’s nothing stopping us from diving down to it now that we know it’s not a shark.”

“True,” returned Jack, stripping off his clothes; “I’ll go down, Ralph, as I’m better at diving than you are. Now then, Peterkin, out o’ the road!” Jack stepped forward, joined his hands above his head, bent over the rocks, and plunged into the sea. For a second or two the spray caused by his dive hid him from view, then the water became still, and we saw him swimming far down in the midst of the green object. Suddenly he sank below it, and vanished altogether from our sight! We gazed anxiously down at the spot where he had disappeared, for nearly a minute, expecting every moment to see him rise again for breath; but fully a minute passed, and still he did not reappear. Two minutes passed! and then a flood of alarm rushed in upon my soul, when I considered that during all my acquaintance with him, Jack had never stayed underwater more than a minute at a time; indeed seldom so long.

“True,” replied Jack, taking off his clothes; “I’ll go down, Ralph, since I’m better at diving than you. Now, Peterkin, get out of the way!” Jack stepped forward, clasped his hands above his head, leaned over the rocks, and plunged into the sea. For a second or two, the spray from his dive obscured him, then the water calmed, and we saw him swimming deep among the green seaweed. Suddenly, he sank below it and completely disappeared from our view! We anxiously stared at the spot where he had vanished, expecting him to surface for air any moment. A full minute went by, and he still didn’t reappear. Two minutes passed! A wave of panic swept over me as I realized that during all the time I had known him, Jack had never stayed underwater for more than a minute; in fact, he rarely lasted that long.

“Oh, Peterkin!” I said, in a voice that trembled with increasing anxiety, “something has happened. It is more than three minutes now!” But Peterkin did not answer and I observed that he was gazing down into the water with a look of intense fear mingled with anxiety, while his face was overspread with a deadly paleness. Suddenly he sprang to his feet and rushed about in a frantic state, wringing his hands, and exclaiming, “Oh, Jack, Jack! he is gone! It must have been a shark, and he is gone for ever!”

“Oh, Peterkin!” I said, my voice shaking with growing anxiety, “something’s wrong. It’s been over three minutes now!” But Peterkin didn’t reply, and I noticed he was staring down into the water, his face a mix of intense fear and anxiety, completely pale. Suddenly, he jumped to his feet and started running around in a panic, wringing his hands and shouting, “Oh, Jack, Jack! He’s gone! It must have been a shark, and he’s gone for good!”

For the next five minutes I know not what I did. The intensity of my feelings almost bereft me of my senses. But I was recalled to myself by Peterkin seizing me by the shoulder and staring wildly into my face, while he exclaimed, “Ralph! Ralph! perhaps he has only fainted. Dive for him, Ralph!”

For the next five minutes, I couldn’t tell you what I did. The intensity of my emotions nearly overwhelmed me. But I snapped back to reality when Peterkin grabbed my shoulder and stared at me with wild eyes, shouting, “Ralph! Ralph! Maybe he just fainted. Dive for him, Ralph!”

It seemed strange that this did not occur to me sooner. In a moment I rushed to the edge of the rocks, and, without waiting to throw off my garments, was on the point to spring into the waves, when I observed something black rising up through the green object. In another moment Jack’s head rose to the surface, and he gave a wild shout, flinging back the spray from his locks, as was his wont after a dive. Now we were almost as much amazed at seeing him reappear, well and strong, as we had been at first at his non-appearance; for, to the best of our judgment, he had been nearly ten minutes under water, perhaps longer, and it required no exertion of our reason to convince us that this was utterly impossible for mortal man to do and retain his strength and faculties. It was therefore with a feeling akin to superstitious awe that I held down my hand and assisted him to clamber up the steep rocks. But no such feeling affected Peterkin. No sooner did Jack gain the rocks and seat himself on one, panting for breath, than he threw his arms round his neck, and burst into a flood of tears. “Oh, Jack, Jack!” said he, “where were you? What kept you so long?”

It felt odd that I hadn't thought of this sooner. In a moment, I rushed to the edge of the rocks and, without bothering to take off my clothes, was about to jump into the waves when I saw something dark rising through the green water. A moment later, Jack’s head popped up, and he let out a wild shout, shaking the spray from his hair, just like he always did after a dive. We were almost as shocked to see him come back up, alive and well, as we had been when he first disappeared; because, as far as we could tell, he had been under water for nearly ten minutes, maybe even longer, and it didn’t take much reasoning to realize that it was completely impossible for a human to do that and still be strong and alert. So, with a feeling that was almost superstitious, I reached down and helped him climb up the steep rocks. But Peterkin didn’t share that feeling. As soon as Jack reached the rocks and sat down, gasping for breath, he threw his arms around him and burst into tears. “Oh, Jack, Jack!” he said, “where were you? What took you so long?”

After a few moments Peterkin became composed enough to sit still and listen to Jack’s explanation, although he could not restrain himself from attempting to wink every two minutes at me, in order to express his joy at Jack’s safety. I say he attempted to wink, but I am bound to add that he did not succeed, for his eyes were so much swollen with weeping, that his frequent attempts only resulted in a series of violent and altogether idiotical contortions of the face, that were very far from expressing what he intended. However, I knew what the poor fellow meant by it, so I smiled to him in return, and endeavoured to make believe that he was winking.

After a few moments, Peterkin calmed down enough to sit still and listen to Jack's explanation, although he couldn't help but try to wink at me every couple of minutes to show his happiness about Jack's safety. I say he tried to wink, but I have to say he didn’t succeed because his eyes were so swollen from crying that his many attempts resulted in a series of awkward and completely silly facial contortions that were far from what he intended. However, I understood what the poor guy meant by it, so I smiled back at him and tried to pretend that he was winking.

“Now, lads,” said Jack, when we were composed enough to listen to him, “yon green object is not a shark; it is a stream of light issuing from a cave in the rocks. Just after I made my dive, I observed that this light came from the side of the rock above which we are now sitting; so I struck out for it, and saw an opening into some place or other that appeared to be luminous within. For one instant I paused to think whether I ought to venture. Then I made up my mind, and dashed into it. For you see, Peterkin, although I take some time to tell this, it happened in the space of a few seconds, so that I knew I had wind enough in me to serve to bring me out o’ the hole and up to the surface again. Well, I was just on the point of turning,—for I began to feel a little uncomfortable in such a place,—when it seemed to me as if there was a faint light right above me. I darted upwards, and found my head out of water. This relieved me greatly, for I now felt that I could take in air enough to enable me to return the way I came. Then it all at once occurred to me that I might not be able to find the way out again; but, on glancing downwards, my mind was put quite at rest by seeing the green light below me streaming into the cave, just like the light that we had seen streaming out of it, only what I now saw was much brighter.

“Now, guys,” Jack said once we were calm enough to listen, “that green thing over there isn’t a shark; it’s a beam of light coming from a cave in the rocks. Right after I dove in, I noticed that the light was coming from the side of the rock we’re currently sitting on; so I swam toward it and saw an opening that looked like it was glowing inside. For a moment, I hesitated, wondering if I should go for it. Then I decided to dive in. You see, Peterkin, even though I’m taking a while to explain this, it all happened in just a few seconds, and I was sure I had enough breath to get out of the hole and back to the surface. Well, I was about to turn around because I started to feel a bit uneasy in there when I noticed a faint light right above me. I shot upwards and found my head above water. That made me feel a lot better because I knew I could breathe enough to go back the way I came. Then it hit me that I might not find the way out again; but when I looked down, I felt relieved seeing the green light streaming into the cave below me, just like the light we had seen coming out, but this was way brighter.

“At first I could scarcely see anything as I gazed around me, it was so dark; but gradually my eyes became accustomed to it, and I found that I was in a huge cave, part of the walls of which I observed on each side of me. The ceiling just above me was also visible, and I fancied that I could perceive beautiful glittering objects there, but the farther end of the cave was shrouded in darkness. While I was looking around me in great wonder, it came into my head that you two would think I was drowned; so I plunged down through the passage again in a great hurry, rose to the surface, and—here I am!”

“At first, I could barely see anything as I looked around; it was so dark. But gradually, my eyes adjusted, and I realized I was in a massive cave, with the walls visible on either side. The ceiling above me was also clear, and I thought I could see beautiful, sparkling objects up there, but the far end of the cave was completely hidden in darkness. While I was gazing around in amazement, it hit me that you two might think I had drowned, so I quickly plunged back through the passage, surfaced, and—here I am!”

When Jack concluded his recital of what he had seen in this remarkable cave, I could not rest satisfied till I had dived down to see it; which I did, but found it so dark, as Jack had said, that I could scarcely see anything. When I returned, we had a long conversation about it, during which I observed that Peterkin had a most lugubrious expression on his countenance.

When Jack finished sharing what he had seen in that amazing cave, I couldn't shake the urge to dive down and check it out for myself; I did just that, but it was so dark, as Jack had mentioned, that I could hardly see anything. When I got back, we had an extensive discussion about it, and I noticed that Peterkin had a very mournful look on his face.

“What’s the matter, Peterkin?” said I.

"What's wrong, Peterkin?" I asked.

“The matter?” he replied. “It’s all very well for you two to be talking away like mermaids about the wonders of this cave, but you know I must be content to hear about it, while you are enjoying yourselves down there like mad dolphins. It’s really too bad.”

“The issue?” he said. “It’s all nice for you two to chat like mermaids about the amazing things in this cave, but you know I have to be satisfied just hearing about it while you’re down there having a blast like crazy dolphins. It’s really too bad.”

“I’m very sorry for you, Peterkin, indeed I am,” said Jack, “but we cannot help you. If you would only learn to dive—”

“I really feel bad for you, Peterkin, I honestly do,” said Jack, “but we can’t help you. If you would just learn to dive—”

“Learn to fly, you might as well say!” retorted Peterkin, in a very sulky tone.

“Learn to fly, you might as well say!” Peterkin replied, sounding very grumpy.

“If you would only consent to keep still,” said I, “we would take you down with us in ten seconds.”

“If you would just agree to stay quiet,” I said, “we could take you down with us in ten seconds.”

“Hum!” returned Peterkin; “suppose a salamander was to propose to you ‘only to keep still,’ and he would carry you through a blazing fire in a few seconds, what would you say?”

“Hum!” replied Peterkin; “what if a salamander asked you to ‘just stay quiet,’ and promised to carry you through a blazing fire in a few seconds, what would you say?”

We both laughed and shook our heads, for it was evident that nothing was to be made of Peterkin in the water. But we could not rest satisfied till we had seen more of this cave; so, after further consultation, Jack and I determined to try if we could take down a torch with us, and set fire to it in the cavern. This we found to be an undertaking of no small difficulty; but we accomplished it at last by the following means:—First, we made a torch of a very inflammable nature out of the bark of a certain tree, which we cut into strips, and, after twisting, cemented together with a kind of resin or gum, which we also obtained from another tree; neither of which trees, however, was known by name to Jack. This, when prepared, we wrapped up in a great number of plies of cocoa-nut cloth, so that we were confident it could not get wet during the short time it should be under water. Then we took a small piece of the tinder, which we had carefully treasured up lest we should require it, as before said, when the sun should fail us; also, we rolled up some dry grass and a few chips, which, with a little bow and drill, like those described before, we made into another bundle, and wrapped it up in cocoa-nut cloth. When all was ready we laid aside our garments, with the exception of our trousers, which, as we did not know what rough scraping against the rocks we might be subjected to, we kept on.

We both laughed and shook our heads, because it was clear that nothing could be done with Peterkin in the water. But we weren't satisfied until we had explored more of this cave, so after more discussion, Jack and I decided to see if we could bring a torch with us and light it in the cavern. We found this task to be quite challenging, but we managed it in the end by following these steps: First, we made a torch from a very flammable tree bark, which we cut into strips, twisted, and glued together with a type of resin or gum from another tree; neither of which trees Jack knew the name of. Once prepared, we wrapped it in many layers of coconut cloth, confident it wouldn't get wet during the short time it would be underwater. Then we took a small piece of tinder that we had carefully saved in case we needed it when the sun wasn't shining; we also rolled up some dry grass and a few chips, which we bundled together and wrapped in coconut cloth, using a bow and drill as described before. When everything was ready, we set aside our clothes, except for our trousers, which we kept on since we didn't know what rough contact with the rocks we might encounter.

Then we advanced to the edge of the rocks, Jack carrying one bundle, with the torch; I the other, with the things for producing fire.

Then we moved to the edge of the rocks, Jack carrying one bundle with the torch, and I the other with the items for starting a fire.

“Now don’t weary for us, Peterkin, should we be gone some time,” said Jack; “we’ll be sure to return in half-an-hour at the very latest, however interesting the cave should be, that we may relieve your mind.”

“Now don’t worry about us, Peterkin, if we’re gone for a while,” said Jack; “we’ll definitely be back in half an hour at the latest, no matter how interesting the cave is, so you can relax.”

“Farewell!” said Peterkin, coming up to us with a look of deep but pretended solemnity, while he shook hands and kissed each of us on the cheek. “Farewell! and while you are gone I shall repose my weary limbs under the shelter of this bush, and meditate on the changefulness of all things earthly, with special reference to the forsaken condition of a poor ship-wrecked sailor boy!” So saying, Peterkin waved his hand, turned from us, and cast himself upon the ground with a look of melancholy resignation, which was so well feigned, that I would have thought it genuine had he not accompanied it with a gentle wink. We both laughed, and, springing from the rocks together, plunged head first into the sea.

“Goodbye!” said Peterkin, walking over to us with a look of serious but fake solemnity as he shook hands and kissed each of us on the cheek. “Goodbye! While you're away, I’ll rest my tired body under this bush and think about the unpredictability of everything on this earth, especially the sad situation of a poor shipwrecked sailor boy!” With that, Peterkin waved his hand, turned away from us, and threw himself onto the ground with a look of sad resignation that was so well acted that I would have believed it was real if he hadn’t followed it up with a playful wink. We both laughed and jumped off the rocks together, diving headfirst into the sea.

We gained the interior of the submarine cave without difficulty, and, on emerging from the waves, supported ourselves for some time by treading-water, while we held the two bundles above our heads. This we did in order to let our eyes become accustomed to the obscurity. Then, when we could see sufficiently, we swam to a shelving rock, and landed in safety. Having wrung the water from our trousers, and dried ourselves as well as we could under the circumstances, we proceeded to ignite the torch. This we accomplished without difficulty in a few minutes; and no sooner did it flare up than we were struck dumb with the wonderful objects that were revealed to our gaze. The roof of the cavern just above us seemed to be about ten feet high, but grew higher as it receded into the distance, until it was lost in darkness. It seemed to be made of coral, and was supported by massive columns of the same material. Immense icicles (as they appeared to us) hung from it in various places. These, however, were formed, not of ice, but of a species of limestone, which seemed to flow in a liquid form towards the point of each, where it became solid. A good many drops fell, however, to the rock below, and these formed little cones, which rose to meet the points above. Some of them had already met, and thus we saw how the pillars were formed, which at first seemed to us as if they had been placed there by some human architect to support the roof. As we advanced farther in, we saw that the floor was composed of the same material as the pillars; and it presented the curious appearance of ripples, such as are formed on water when gently ruffled by the wind. There were several openings on either hand in the walls, that seemed to lead into other caverns; but these we did not explore at this time. We also observed that the ceiling was curiously marked in many places, as if it were the fret-work of a noble cathedral; and the walls, as well as the roof, sparkled in the light of our torch, and threw back gleams and flashes, as if they were covered with precious stones. Although we proceeded far into this cavern, we did not come to the end of it; and we were obliged to return more speedily than we would otherwise have done, as our torch was nearly expended. We did not observe any openings in the roof, or any indications of places whereby light might enter; but near the entrance to the cavern stood an immense mass of pure white coral rock, which caught and threw back the little light that found an entrance through the cave’s mouth, and thus produced, we conjectured, the pale-green object which had first attracted our attention. We concluded, also, that the reflecting power of this rock was that which gave forth the dim light that faintly illumined the first part of the cave.

We entered the inside of the submarine cave easily, and after coming up from the waves, we kept ourselves afloat for a while by treading water, holding our two bundles above our heads. We did this to let our eyes adjust to the dim light. Once we could see well enough, we swam to a sloping rock and landed safely. After wringing out the water from our pants and drying ourselves as best we could, we proceeded to light the torch. We managed to do this without any trouble in just a few minutes; and as soon as it flared up, we were speechless at the amazing sights that were revealed to us. The ceiling of the cave above us seemed to be about ten feet high, but it got higher as it receded into the darkness. It looked like it was made of coral, supported by massive columns of the same material. Huge icicles (as they appeared to us) hung from it in various spots. However, these were not made of ice but were a type of limestone that seemed to flow in liquid form towards the tips of each icicle, where it became solid. Quite a few drops fell onto the rock below, forming little cones that rose to meet the points above. Some of them had already connected, showing us how the pillars were formed, which initially looked like they had been placed there by some human architect to support the roof. As we went further in, we saw that the floor was made of the same material as the pillars, presenting a curious appearance of ripples, like those formed on water when gently stirred by the wind. There were several openings on either side in the walls that seemed to lead to other caverns, but we didn't explore them this time. We also noticed that the ceiling was marked in many places, resembling the intricate work of a grand cathedral; and both the walls and roof sparkled in the light of our torch, reflecting glimmers and flashes as if they were covered in precious stones. Even though we went deep into this cavern, we didn’t reach the end; we had to head back sooner than we wanted since our torch was almost burnt out. We didn’t see any openings in the ceiling or indications of how light might enter, but near the entrance to the cavern stood a massive chunk of pure white coral rock, which caught and reflected the limited light that managed to enter through the cave’s mouth, and we suspected this was what created the pale-green object that first caught our eye. We also believed that the reflective quality of this rock provided the dim light that faintly lit up the initial part of the cave.

Before diving through the passage again we extinguished the small piece of our torch that remained, and left it in a dry spot; conceiving that we might possibly stand in need of it, if at any future time we should chance to wet our torch while diving into the cavern. As we stood for a few minutes after it was out, waiting till our eyes became accustomed to the gloom, we could not help remarking the deep, intense stillness and the unutterable gloom of all around us; and, as I thought of the stupendous dome above, and the countless gems that had sparkled in the torch-light a few minutes before, it came into my mind to consider how strange it is that God should make such wonderful and exquisitely beautiful works never to be seen at all, except, indeed, by chance visitors such as ourselves.

Before diving through the passage again, we turned off the small piece of our torch that was left and placed it in a dry spot, thinking we might need it in the future if we happened to wet our torch while exploring the cavern. As we stood for a few minutes after it went out, waiting for our eyes to adjust to the darkness, we couldn’t help but notice the deep, intense silence and the overwhelming gloom surrounding us. As I thought about the enormous dome above and the countless gems that had sparkled in the light of our torch just moments before, it struck me how strange it is that God would create such amazing and beautifully delicate works that are only seen by chance visitors like us.

I afterwards found that there were many such caverns among the islands of the South Seas, some of them larger and more beautiful than the one I have just described.

I later discovered that there were many more caves like that among the islands in the South Seas, some of them larger and more beautiful than the one I just described.

“Now, Ralph, are you ready?” said Jack, in a low voice, that seemed to echo up into the dome above.

“Hey, Ralph, are you ready?” Jack said in a low voice that seemed to echo up into the dome above.

“Quite ready.”

"All set."

“Come along, then,” said he; and, plunging off the ledge of the rock into the water, we dived through the narrow entrance. In a few seconds we were panting on the rocks above, and receiving the congratulations of our friend Peterkin.

“Come on, then,” he said; and, jumping off the ledge of the rock into the water, we dove through the narrow entrance. In a few seconds, we were gasping on the rocks above and getting congratulated by our friend Peterkin.

CHAPTER XIV.

Strange peculiarity of the tides—Also of the twilight—Peterkin’s remarkable conduct in embracing a little pig and killing a big sow—Sage remarks on jesting—Also on love.

Strange oddity of the tides—Also of the twilight—Peterkin’s unusual behavior in hugging a little pig and slaughtering a big sow—Wise comments on joking—Also on love.

It was quite a relief to us to breathe the pure air and to enjoy the glad sunshine after our long ramble in the Diamond Cave, as we named it; for, although we did not stay more than half an hour away, it seemed to us much longer. While we were dressing, and during our walk home, we did our best to satisfy the curiosity of poor Peterkin, who seemed to regret, with lively sincerity, his inability to dive.

It was such a relief to breathe the fresh air and enjoy the warm sunshine after our long trek in the Diamond Cave, as we called it; because, even though we didn’t spend more than half an hour away, it felt like a lot longer. While we were getting dressed and during our walk back home, we did our best to satisfy Peterkin's curiosity, as he genuinely regretted not being able to dive.

There was no help for it, however, so we condoled with him as we best could. Had there been any great rise or fall in the tide of these seas, we might perhaps have found it possible to take him down with us at low water; but as the tide never rose or fell more than eighteen inches or two feet, this was impossible.

There was no way around it, so we offered him our support as best we could. If there had been any significant change in the tide of these seas, we might have been able to take him down with us at low tide; but since the tide only changed by about eighteen inches or two feet, this was not possible.

This peculiarity of the tide—its slight rise and fall—had not attracted our observation till some time after our residence on the island. Neither had we observed another curious circumstance until we had been some time there. This was the fact, that the tide rose and fell with constant regularity, instead of being affected by the changes of the moon as in our own country, and as it is in most other parts of the world,—at least in all those parts with which I am acquainted. Every day and every night, at twelve o’clock precisely, the tide is at the full; and at six o’clock every morning and evening it is ebb. I can speak with much confidence on this singular circumstance, as we took particular note of it, and never found it to alter. Of course, I must admit, we had to guess the hour of twelve midnight, and I think we could do this pretty correctly; but in regard to twelve noon we are quite positive, because we easily found the highest point that the sun reached in the sky by placing ourselves at a certain spot whence we observed the sharp summit of a cliff resting against the sky, just where the sun passed.

This unusual aspect of the tide—its small rise and fall—hadn't caught our attention until some time after we started living on the island. We also hadn't noticed another interesting fact until we had been there for a while. This was that the tide rose and fell with constant regularity, instead of being influenced by the moon's phases like it is in our home country and in most other places I know of. Every day and night, at exactly twelve o'clock, the tide is at its highest; and at six o'clock every morning and evening, it goes out. I'm quite confident about this unique situation since we took careful note of it and never saw it change. Of course, I should mention that we had to estimate the time for midnight, and I think we got it right pretty consistently; but for noon, we're absolutely sure because we could easily determine the sun's highest point in the sky by standing at a specific spot where we could see the sharp peak of a cliff against the sky, right where the sun passed.

Jack and I were surprised that we had not noticed this the first few days of our residence here, and could only account for it by our being so much taken up with the more obvious wonders of our novel situation. I have since learned, however, that this want of observation is a sad and very common infirmity of human nature, there being hundreds of persons before whose eyes the most wonderful things are passing every day, who nevertheless are totally ignorant of them. I therefore have to record my sympathy with such persons, and to recommend to them a course of conduct which I have now for a long time myself adopted,—namely, the habit of forcing my attention upon all things that go on around me, and of taking some degree of interest in them, whether I feel it naturally or not. I suggest this the more earnestly, though humbly, because I have very frequently come to know that my indifference to a thing has generally been caused by my ignorance in regard to it.

Jack and I were surprised that we hadn't noticed this in the first few days of living here, and the only reason we could think of was that we were so caught up in the more obvious wonders of our new situation. However, I've since learned that this lack of observation is a real and common flaw in human nature; there are countless people who let incredible things happen right in front of them every day and are completely unaware of it. So, I want to express my sympathy for those individuals and recommend a course of action that I've now been following for quite a while: the habit of deliberately focusing my attention on everything happening around me and taking some interest in it, whether I naturally feel like it or not. I suggest this with genuine sincerity because I’ve often realized that my indifference to something usually comes from my lack of knowledge about it.

We had much serious conversation on this subject of the tides; and Jack told us, in his own quiet, philosophical way, that these tides did great good to the world in many ways, particularly in the way of cleansing the shores of the land, and carrying off the filth that was constantly poured into the sea there-from; which, Peterkin suggested, was remarkably tidy of it to do. Poor Peterkin could never let slip an opportunity to joke, however inopportune it might be: which at first we found rather a disagreeable propensity, as it often interrupted the flow of very agreeable conversation; and, indeed, I cannot too strongly record my disapprobation of this tendency in general: but we became so used to it at last that we found it no interruption whatever; indeed, strange to say, we came to feel that it was a necessary part of our enjoyment (such is the force of habit), and found the sudden outbursts of mirth, resulting from his humorous disposition, quite natural and refreshing to us in the midst of our more serious conversations. But I must not misrepresent Peterkin. We often found, to our surprise, that he knew many things which we did not; and I also observed that those things which he learned from experience were never forgotten. From all these things I came at length to understand that things very opposite and dissimilar in themselves, when united, do make an agreeable whole; as, for example, we three on this our island, although most unlike in many things, when united, made a trio so harmonious that I question if there ever met before such an agreeable triumvirate. There was, indeed, no note of discord whatever in the symphony we played together on that sweet Coral Island; and I am now persuaded that this was owing to our having been all tuned to the same key, namely, that of love! Yes, we loved one another with much fervency while we lived on that island; and, for the matter of that, we love each other still.

We had a serious discussion about the tides, and Jack, in his usual calm and thoughtful manner, explained that these tides benefit the world in many ways, especially by cleansing the shores and carrying off the waste that constantly washes into the sea. Peterkin chimed in, saying it was quite tidy of the tides to do that. Poor Peterkin could never resist making a joke, no matter how inappropriate the timing might be. At first, we found this rather annoying, as it often disrupted our enjoyable conversations; I have to say, I really didn’t like this habit in general. However, we eventually got used to it, and it became no interruption at all. Strangely enough, we started feeling that his sudden bursts of laughter were a vital part of our enjoyment (such is the power of habit), making them seem quite natural and refreshing amid our serious talks. But I don't want to misrepresent Peterkin. We often discovered, to our surprise, that he knew many things we didn’t, and I noticed that the lessons he learned from experience were never forgotten. From all this, I gradually came to realize that completely different things, when combined, can create a pleasing whole; for instance, the three of us on this island, though very different in many ways, formed such a harmonious trio that I doubt any other trio has ever been quite so agreeable. There was definitely no discord in the symphony we created together on that beautiful Coral Island, and I now believe it was because we were all tuned to the same key—namely, that of love! Yes, we loved each other deeply while we lived on that island, and, for that matter, we still love each other.

And while I am on this subject, or rather the subject that just preceded it—namely, the tides—I may here remark on another curious natural phenomenon. We found that there was little or no twilight in this island. We had a distinct remembrance of the charming long twilight at home, which some people think the most delightful part of the day, though for my part I have always preferred sunrise; and when we first landed, we used to sit down on some rocky point or eminence, at the close of our day’s work, to enjoy the evening breeze; but no sooner had the sun sunk below the horizon than all became suddenly dark. This rendered it necessary that we should watch the sun when we happened to be out hunting, for to be suddenly left in the dark while in the woods was very perplexing, as, although the stars shone with great beauty and brilliancy, they could not pierce through the thick umbrageous boughs that interlaced above our heads.

And while I'm on this topic, or more specifically the topic that just came before it—namely, the tides—I should mention another interesting natural phenomenon. We noticed that there was hardly any twilight on this island. We vividly remembered the lovely long twilight back home, which some people consider the most delightful part of the day, although I have always preferred sunrise. When we first arrived, we would sit on some rocky point or high ground at the end of our workday to enjoy the evening breeze; but as soon as the sun dipped below the horizon, everything would suddenly go dark. This made it essential for us to keep an eye on the sun when we were out hunting, as being suddenly plunged into darkness while in the woods was quite disorienting. Even though the stars shone beautifully and brilliantly, they couldn't break through the thick leafy branches overhead.

But, to return: After having told all we could to Peterkin about the Diamond Cave under Spouting Cliff, as we named the locality, we were wending our way rapidly homewards, when a grunt and a squeal were borne down by the land breeze to our ears.

But, to get back to it: After telling Peterkin everything we could about the Diamond Cave under Spouting Cliff, which is what we called the place, we were heading home quickly when a grunt and a squeal came to our ears carried by the land breeze.

“That’s the ticket!” was Peterkin’s remarkable exclamation, as he started convulsively, and levelled his spear.

"That's it!" was Peterkin's excited shout as he jumped and aimed his spear.

“Hist!” cried Jack; “these are your friends, Peterkin. They must have come over expressly to pay you a friendly visit, for it is the first time we have seen them on this side the island.”

“Shh!” shouted Jack; “those are your friends, Peterkin. They must have come over just to visit you, since it’s the first time we’ve seen them on this side of the island.”

“Come along!” cried Peterkin, hurrying towards the wood, while Jack and I followed, smiling at his impatience.

“Come on!” shouted Peterkin, rushing towards the woods, while Jack and I followed, grinning at his eagerness.

Another grunt and half a dozen squeals, much louder than before, came down the valley. At this time we were just opposite the small vale which lay between the Valley of the Wreck and Spouting Cliff.

Another grunt and half a dozen squeals, much louder than before, came down the valley. At this time we were just across from the small valley that lay between the Valley of the Wreck and Spouting Cliff.

“I say, Peterkin,” cried Jack, in a hoarse whisper.

“I say, Peterkin,” Jack exclaimed in a raspy whisper.

“Well, what is’t?”

“Well, what is it?”

“Stay a bit, man. These grunters are just up there on the hill side. If you go and stand with Ralph in the lee of yon cliff, I’ll cut round behind and drive them through the gorge, so that you’ll have a better chance of picking out a good one. Now, mind you pitch into a fat young pig, Peterkin,” added Jack, as he sprang into the bushes.

“Stay a minute, man. Those grunters are just up on the hillside. If you go stand with Ralph on the side of that cliff, I’ll sneak around behind and drive them through the gorge, so you’ll have a better shot at picking out a good one. Now, make sure you go for a fat young pig, Peterkin,” added Jack as he jumped into the bushes.

“Won’t I, just!” said Peterkin, licking his lips, as we took our station beside the cliff. “I feel quite a tender affection for young pigs in my heart. Perhaps it would be more correct to say in my s—.”

“Won’t I, indeed!” said Peterkin, licking his lips, as we set up beside the cliff. “I feel a real fondness for young pigs in my heart. Maybe it would be better to say in my s—.”

“There they come!” cried I, as a terrific yell from Jack sent the whole herd screaming down the hill. Now, Peterkin, being unable to hold back, crept a short way up a very steep grassy mound, in order to get a better view of the hogs before they came up; and just as he raised his head above its summit, two little pigs, which had outrun their companions, rushed over the top with the utmost precipitation. One of these brushed close past Peterkin’s ear; the other, unable to arrest its headlong flight, went, as Peterkin himself afterwards expressed it, “bash” into his arms with a sudden squeal, which was caused more by the force of the blow than the will of the animal, and both of them rolled violently down to the foot of the mound. No sooner was this reached than the little pig recovered its feet, tossed up its tail, and fled shrieking from the spot. But I slang a large stone after it, which, being fortunately well aimed, hit it behind the ear, and felled it to the earth.

“There they come!” I shouted, as a loud yell from Jack made the whole herd scream and run down the hill. Peterkin, unable to resist, climbed a short way up a steep grassy mound to get a better view of the pigs before they arrived. Just as he peeked over the top, two little pigs, which had outpaced the others, rushed over the summit in a frenzy. One of them brushed closely past Peterkin’s ear; the other, unable to stop its fast dash, collided with him, as Peterkin later described it, “bashing” into his arms with a sudden squeal caused more by the impact than the pig's intention, and they both rolled down to the bottom of the mound. As soon as they hit the ground, the little pig got back on its feet, lifted its tail, and ran away screaming. But I threw a large stone after it, which fortunately hit its mark, striking it behind the ear and knocking it to the ground.

“Capital, Ralph! that’s your sort!” cried Peterkin, who, to my surprise and great relief, had risen to his feet. Apparently unhurt, though much dishevelled, he rushed franticly towards the gorge, which the yells of the hogs told us they were now approaching. I had made up my mind that I would abstain from killing another, as, if Peterkin should be successful, two were more than sufficient for our wants at the present time. Suddenly they all burst forth,—two or three little round ones in advance, and an enormous old sow with a drove of hogs at her heels.

“Capital, Ralph! That’s your style!” shouted Peterkin, who, to my surprise and relief, had gotten to his feet. He seemed unhurt, though he was quite disheveled, and he rushed wildly toward the gorge, where the hogs' yells indicated they were getting closer. I had decided not to kill another one since, if Peterkin was successful, two would be more than enough for our current needs. Suddenly, they all came charging out—two or three little ones in front, followed by a massive old sow with a herd of hogs behind her.

“Now, Peterkin,” said I, “there’s a nice little fat one; just spear it.”

“Now, Peterkin,” I said, “there’s a nice little fat one; just spear it.”

But Peterkin did not move; he allowed it to pass unharmed. I looked at him in surprise, and saw that his lips were compressed and his eyebrows knitted, as if he were about to fight with some awful enemy.

But Peterkin didn’t move; he let it go by without a scratch. I looked at him in surprise and saw that his lips were pressed together and his eyebrows were furrowed, as if he was about to confront a terrible opponent.

“What is it?” I inquired, with some trepidation.

"What is it?" I asked, feeling a bit nervous.

Suddenly he levelled his spear, darted forward, and, with a yell that nearly froze the blood in my veins, stabbed the old sow to the heart. Nay, so vigorously was it done that the spear went in at one side and came out at the other!

Suddenly, he aimed his spear, charged ahead, and with a shout that almost sent chills down my spine, plunged it into the old sow’s heart. It was done with such force that the spear entered one side and came out the other!

“Oh, Peterkin!” said I, going up to him, “what have you done?”

“Oh, Peterkin!” I said, approaching him, “what have you done?”

“Done? I’ve killed their great-great-grandmother, that’s all,” said he, looking with a somewhat awe-struck expression at the transfixed animal.

“Done? I’ve killed their great-great-grandmother, that’s all,” he said, looking at the frozen animal with a somewhat amazed expression.

“Hallo! what’s this?” said Jack, as he came up. “Why, Peterkin, you must be fond of a tough chop. If you mean to eat this old hog, she’ll try your jaws, I warrant. What possessed you to stick her, Peterkin?”

“Hey! What’s this?” said Jack, as he approached. “Wow, Peterkin, you must really like a tough cut of meat. If you plan to eat this old hog, it’ll be a challenge for your jaw, I guarantee it. What made you decide to hunt her, Peterkin?”

“Why, the fact is I want a pair of shoes.”

“Honestly, I just want a pair of shoes.”

“What have your shoes to do with the old hog?’ said I, smiling.

“What do your shoes have to do with the old pig?” I said, smiling.

“My present shoes have certainly nothing to do with her,” replied Peterkin; “nevertheless she will have a good deal to do with my future shoes. The fact is, when I saw you floor that pig so neatly, Ralph, it struck me that there was little use in killing another. Then I remembered all at once that I had long wanted some leather or tough substance to make shoes of, and this old grandmother seemed so tough that I just made up my mind to stick her, and you see I’ve done it!”

“My current shoes definitely have nothing to do with her,” Peterkin replied. “But she will have a big impact on my future shoes. The truth is, when I saw you take down that pig so skillfully, Ralph, it made me realize there wasn't much point in killing another one. Then I suddenly remembered that I had always needed some leather or strong material to make shoes, and this old grandmother seemed tough enough, so I decided to go for it, and, as you can see, I’ve done it!”

“That you certainly have, Peterkin,” said Jack, as he was examining the transfixed animal.

"Absolutely, you do have that, Peterkin," said Jack, as he was looking at the frozen animal.

We now considered how we were to carry our game home, for, although the distance was short, the hog was very heavy. At length we hit on the plan of tying its four feet together, and passing the spear handle between them. Jack took one end on his shoulder, I took the other on mine, and Peterkin carried the small pig.

We now thought about how we were going to bring our game home because, even though the distance wasn’t far, the hog was really heavy. Finally, we decided to tie its four feet together and run the spear handle through them. Jack slung one end over his shoulder, I took the other end, and Peterkin carried the smaller pig.

Thus we returned in triumph to our bower, laden, as Peterkin remarked, with the glorious spoils of a noble hunt. As he afterwards spoke in similarly glowing terms in reference to the supper that followed, there is every reason to believe that we retired that night to our leafy beds in a high state of satisfaction.

Thus we returned in triumph to our shelter, loaded, as Peterkin noted, with the amazing spoils of a great hunt. Since he later spoke in equally enthusiastic terms about the dinner that followed, there's every reason to believe that we went to bed that night in our leafy beds feeling very satisfied.

CHAPTER XV.

Boat-building extraordinary—Peterkin tries his hand at cookery and fails most signally—The boat finished—Curious conversation with the cat, and other matters.

Boat-building is impressive—Peterkin tries to cook and fails spectacularly—The boat is done—Interesting conversation with the cat, and other things.

For many days after this Jack applied himself with unremitting assiduity to the construction of our boat, which at length began to look somewhat like one. But those only who have had the thing to do can entertain a right idea of the difficulty involved in such an undertaking, with no other implements than an axe, a bit of hoop-iron, a sail-needle, and a broken pen-knife. But Jack did it. He was of, that disposition which will not be conquered. When he believed himself to be acting rightly, he overcame all obstacles. I have seen Jack, when doubtful whether what he was about to do were right or wrong, as timid and vacillating as a little girl,—and I honour him for it!

For many days after this, Jack dedicated himself tirelessly to building our boat, which finally started to resemble one. But only those who have attempted such a task can truly understand the challenges involved, with no tools other than an axe, a piece of hoop-iron, a sail needle, and a broken penknife. But Jack managed it. He had a determination that simply wouldn't be beaten. When he believed he was doing the right thing, he pushed through all obstacles. I’ve seen Jack when he was unsure if what he was about to do was right or wrong, as timid and indecisive as a little girl—and I respect him for that!

As this boat was a curiosity in its way, a few words here relative to the manner of its construction may not be amiss.

As this boat was quite an interesting piece in its own way, a few words about how it was built might be worth sharing.

I have already mentioned the chestnut tree with its wonderful buttresses or planks. This tree, then, furnished us with the chief part of our material. First of all Jack sought out a limb of a tree of such a form and size as, while it should form the keel a bend at either end should form the stem and stern posts. Such a piece, however, was not easy to obtain, but at last he procured it, by rooting up a small tree which had a branch growing at the proper angle about ten feet up its stem, with two strong roots growing in such a form as enabled him to make a flat-sterned boat. This placed, he procured three branching roots of suitable size, which he fitted to the keel at equal distances, thus forming three strong ribs. Now, the squaring and shaping of these, and the cutting of the grooves in the keel, was an easy enough matter, as it was all work for the axe, in the use of which Jack was become wonderfully expert; but it was quite a different affair when he came to nailing the ribs to the keel, for we had no instrument capable of boring a large hole, and no nails to fasten them with. We were, indeed, much perplexed here; but Jack at length devised an instrument that served very well. He took the remainder of our hoop-iron and beat it into the form of a pipe or cylinder, about as thick as a man’s finger. This he did by means of our axe and the old rusty axe we had found at the house of the poor man at the other side of the island. This, when made red hot, bored slowly though the timbers; and, the better to retain the heat, Jack shut up one end of it and filled it with sand. True, the work was very slowly done, but it mattered not—we had little else to do. Two holes were bored in each timber, about an inch and a half apart, and also down into the keel, but not quite through. Into these were placed stout pegs made of a tree called iron-wood; and, when they were hammered well home, the timbers were as firmly fixed as if they had been nailed with iron. The gunwales, which were very stout, were fixed in a similar manner. But, besides the wooden nails, they were firmly lashed to the stem and stern posts and ribs by means of a species of cordage which we had contrived to make out of the fibrous husk of the cocoa nut. This husk was very tough, and when a number of the threads were joined together they formed excellent cordage. At first we tied the different lengths together, but this was such a clumsy and awkward complication of knots, that we contrived, by careful interlacing of the ends together before twisting, to make good cordage of any size or length we chose. Of course it cost us much time and infinite labour, but Jack kept up our spirits when we grew weary, and so all that we required was at last constructed.

I’ve already talked about the chestnut tree with its amazing buttresses or planks. This tree provided us with most of our materials. First, Jack found a limb of a tree that was the right shape and size to form the keel while bending at both ends to create the stem and stern posts. However, this wasn’t easy to get, but eventually he found it by uprooting a small tree that had a branch growing at the right angle about ten feet up its trunk, with two strong roots that allowed him to make a flat-sterned boat. Once he had that, he found three branching roots of the right size, which he attached to the keel at equal distances, forming three strong ribs. Squaring and shaping them and cutting grooves in the keel was straightforward since it all just took an axe, which Jack had become quite skilled with. However, nailing the ribs to the keel was another story because we didn't have anything to drill large holes or any nails to use. We were pretty stumped at that point, but eventually Jack came up with a tool that worked well. He took the leftover hoop iron and pounded it into a pipe or cylinder about the thickness of a finger. He did this with our axe and the old rusty axe we found at the house of the poor man on the other side of the island. When it was made red hot, it drilled slowly through the wood, and to keep the heat better, Jack closed one end and filled it with sand. It was slow work, but that didn’t matter since we had plenty of time. Two holes were drilled in each timber, spaced about an inch and a half apart, and also down into the keel, but not all the way through. Sturdy pegs made of a tree called iron-wood were placed into these holes, and when they were pounded in well, the timbers were as firmly fixed as if they were nailed with iron. The gunwales, which were really thick, were attached in a similar way. Besides the wooden nails, they were tightly lashed to the stem, stern posts, and ribs using a type of cordage we made from the fibrous husk of the coconut. This husk was very strong, and when several threads were joined together, they created excellent cordage. At first, we tied the different lengths together, but that turned into a messy tangle of knots, so we figured out how to interlace the ends before twisting to make good cordage of any size or length. It took a lot of time and effort, but Jack kept our spirits up when we got tired, and eventually, we constructed everything we needed.

Planks were now cut off the chestnut trees of about an inch thick. These were dressed with the axe,—but clumsily, for an axe is ill adapted for such work. Five of these planks on each side were sufficient, and we formed the boat in a very rounded, barrel-like shape, in order to have as little twisting of the planks as possible; for, although we could easily bend them, we could not easily twist them. Having no nails to rivet the planks with, we threw aside the ordinary fashion of boat building and adopted one of our own. The planks were therefore placed on each other’s edges, and sewed together with the tough cordage already mentioned. They were also thus sewed to the stem, the stern, and the keel. Each stitch or tie was six inches apart, and was formed thus: Three holes were bored in the upper plank and three in the lower,—the holes being above each other, that is, in a vertical line. Through these holes the cord was passed, and, when tied, formed a powerful stitch of three ply. Besides this, we placed between the edges of the planks, layers of cocoa-nut fibre, which, as it swelled when wetted, would, we hoped, make our little vessel water-tight. But in order further to secure this end, we collected a large quantity of pitch from the bread-fruit tree, with which, when boiled in our old iron pot, we payed the whole of the inside of the boat, and, while it was yet hot, placed large pieces of cocoa-nut cloth on it, and then gave it another coat above that. Thus the interior was covered with a tough water-tight material; while the exterior, being uncovered, and so exposed to the swelling action of the water, was we hoped, likely to keep the boat quite dry. I may add that our hopes were not disappointed.

Planks about an inch thick were cut from the chestnut trees. These were shaped with an axe, though not very well, since an axe isn’t suited for such tasks. Five of these planks on each side were enough, and we built the boat in a rounded, barrel-like shape to minimize twisting of the planks. While we could easily bend them, twisting was more difficult. Lacking nails to secure the planks, we abandoned traditional boat building methods and created our own. The planks were laid on each other’s edges and sewn together with the strong cord we’d mentioned earlier. They were also sewn to the front, back, and bottom of the boat. Each stitch was spaced six inches apart and was made like this: three holes were drilled in the upper plank and three in the lower, all aligned vertically. The cord was threaded through these holes, and when tied, it created a strong three-ply stitch. Additionally, we added layers of coconut fiber between the edges of the planks, which we hoped would swell when wet and make the boat watertight. To enhance this, we gathered a large amount of pitch from the breadfruit tree. After boiling it in our old iron pot, we coated the entire inside of the boat and, while it was still hot, placed large pieces of coconut cloth on it, followed by another layer on top. This way, the interior was covered with a durable, watertight material, while the outside remained uncovered, exposed to moisture, which we hoped would keep the boat dry. I can say our hopes were not let down.

While Jack was thus engaged, Peterkin and I sometimes assisted him, but, as our assistance was not much required, we more frequently went a-hunting on the extensive mud-flats at the entrance of the long valley which lay nearest to our bower. Here we found large flocks of ducks of various kinds, some of them bearing so much resemblance to the wild ducks of our own country that I think they must have been the same. On these occasions we took the bow and the sling, with both of which we were often successful, though I must confess I was the least so. Our suppers were thus pleasantly varied, and sometimes we had such a profusion spread out before us that we frequently knew not with which of the dainties to begin.

While Jack was busy, Peterkin and I sometimes helped him, but since he didn't really need our help, we often went hunting on the wide mud-flats at the entrance of the long valley closest to our home. Here, we found large groups of ducks of various kinds, some of which looked so much like the wild ducks from our own country that I think they must have been the same. During these hunting trips, we took the bow and the sling, and we were often successful, although I have to admit I had the least luck. Our dinners were nicely varied, and sometimes we had so much spread out in front of us that we often didn't know which delicious dish to start with.

I must also add, that the poor old cat which we had brought home had always a liberal share of our good things, and so well was it looked after, especially by Peterkin, that it recovered much of its former strength, and seemed to improve in sight as well as hearing.

I should also mention that the poor old cat we brought home always got its fair share of our good food, and it was cared for so well, especially by Peterkin, that it regained much of its former strength and seemed to improve in both sight and hearing.

The large flat stone, or rock of coral, which stood just in front of the entrance to our bower, was our table. On this rock we had spread out the few articles we possessed the day we were shipwrecked; and on the same rock, during many a day afterwards, we spread out the bountiful supply with which we had been blessed on our Coral Island. Sometimes we sat down at this table to a feast consisting of hot rolls,—as Peterkin called the newly baked bread fruit,—a roast pig, roast duck, boiled and roasted yams, cocoa nuts, taro, and sweet potatoes; which we followed up with a dessert of plums, apples, and plantains,—the last being a large-sized and delightful fruit, which grew on a large shrub or tree not more than twelve feet high, with light-green leaves of enormous length and breadth. These luxurious feasts were usually washed down with cocoa-nut lemonade.

The big flat stone, or coral rock, right in front of our shelter was our table. On this rock, we laid out the few things we had the day we were shipwrecked; and on the same rock, for many days after, we displayed the abundant food we had been fortunate enough to find on our Coral Island. Sometimes we sat at this table for a feast that included hot rolls—what Peterkin called the freshly baked breadfruit—a roasted pig, roast duck, boiled and roasted yams, coconuts, taro, and sweet potatoes; we finished with a dessert of plums, apples, and plantains—the last being a large, delicious fruit that grew on a tall shrub or tree no more than twelve feet high, with light-green leaves that were incredibly long and wide. We usually washed down these wonderful feasts with coconut lemonade.

Occasionally Peterkin tried to devise some new dish,—“a conglomerate,” as he used to say; but these generally turned out such atrocious compounds that he was ultimately induced to give up his attempts in extreme disgust. Not forgetting, however, to point out to Jack that his failure was a direct contradiction to the proverb which he, Jack, was constantly thrusting down his throat, namely, that “where there’s a will there’s a way.” For he had a great will to become a cook, but could by no means find a way to accomplish that end.

Occasionally, Peterkin tried to come up with new dishes—“a mix,” as he used to say—but these usually ended up being such terrible combinations that he finally gave up in complete disgust. He didn’t forget to point out to Jack that his failure directly contradicted the saying that Jack was always insisting on, which was, “where there’s a will, there’s a way.” Peterkin had a strong desire to become a cook, but he just couldn’t find a way to make it happen.

One day, while Peterkin and I were seated beside our table on which dinner was spread, Jack came up from the beach, and, flinging down his axe, exclaimed,—

One day, while Peterkin and I were sitting at our table with dinner laid out, Jack came up from the beach and, throwing down his axe, shouted,—

“There, lads, the boat’s finished at last! so we’ve nothing to do now but shape two pair of oars, and then we may put to sea as soon as we like.”

“There, guys, the boat’s finally done! So we just need to make two pairs of oars, and then we can set sail whenever we want.”

This piece of news threw us into a state of great joy; for although we were aware that the boat had been gradually getting near its completion, it had taken so long that we did not expect it to be quite ready for at least two or three weeks. But Jack had wrought hard and said nothing, in order to surprise us.

This news filled us with immense joy; even though we knew the boat was getting closer to being finished, it had taken so long that we didn’t expect it to be ready for at least another two or three weeks. But Jack had worked hard and said nothing to surprise us.

“My dear fellow,” cried Peterkin, “you’re a perfect trump. But why did you not tell us it was so nearly ready? won’t we have a jolly sail to-morrow? eh?”

“My dear friend,” exclaimed Peterkin, “you’re absolutely amazing. But why didn’t you let us know it was almost ready? Are we going to have a great sail tomorrow? Huh?”

“Don’t talk so much, Peterkin,” said Jack; “and, pray, hand me a bit of that pig.”

“Don’t talk so much, Peterkin,” said Jack; “and please pass me a piece of that pig.”

“Certainly, my dear,” cried Peterkin, seizing the axe; “what part will you have? a leg, or a wing, or a piece of the breast; which?”

“Sure thing, my friend,” shouted Peterkin, grabbing the axe; “which part do you want? a leg, a wing, or a piece of the breast; what’s it gonna be?”

“A hind leg, if you please,” answered Jack; “and, pray, be so good as to include the tail.”

“A hind leg, please,” Jack replied; “and, if you would, make sure to include the tail.”

“With all my heart,” said Peterkin, exchanging the axe for his hoop-iron knife, with which he cut off the desired portion. “I’m only too glad, my dear boy, to see that your appetite is so wholesale; and there’s no chance whatever of its dwindling down into re-tail again, at least in so far as this pig is concerned. Ralph, lad, why don’t you laugh?—eh?” he added turning suddenly to me with a severe look of inquiry.

“With all my heart,” said Peterkin, swapping the axe for his hoop-iron knife, which he used to cut off the part he wanted. “I’m really happy to see that you have such a big appetite, my dear boy; and there’s no chance of it shrinking back down for this pig, at least. Ralph, why aren’t you laughing?—eh?” he added, suddenly turning to me with a serious look of inquiry.

“Laugh?” said I; “what at, Peterkin? why should I laugh?”

“Laugh?” I said. “What’s so funny, Peterkin? Why should I laugh?”

Both Jack and Peterkin answered this inquiry by themselves laughing so immoderately that I was induced to believe I had missed noticing some good joke, so I begged that it might be explained to me; but as this only produced repeated roars of laughter, I smiled and helped myself to another slice of plantain.

Both Jack and Peterkin answered this question by laughing so hard that I couldn’t help but think I had missed some great joke, so I asked them to explain it to me; but this just made them laugh even more, so I smiled and took another slice of plantain.

“Well, but,” continued Peterkin, “I was talking of a sail to-morrow. Can’t we have one, Jack?”

“Well, but,” Peterkin went on, “I was talking about a sail tomorrow. Can’t we go, Jack?”

“No,” replied Jack, “we can’t have a sail, but I hope we shall have a row, as I intend to work hard at the oars this afternoon, and, if we can’t get them finished by sunset we’ll light our candle-nuts, and turn them out of hands before we turn into bed.”

“No,” replied Jack, “we can’t go sailing, but I hope we can row instead, since I plan to really put in the effort with the oars this afternoon. If we can’t finish before sunset, we’ll light our candle-nuts and get everything done before we head to bed.”

“Very good,” said Peterkin, tossing a lump of pork to the cat, who received it with a mew of satisfaction. “I’ll help you, if I can.”

“Sounds great,” said Peterkin, throwing a piece of pork to the cat, who caught it with a satisfied meow. “I’ll help you, if I can.”

“Afterwards,” continued Jack, “we will make a sail out of the cocoa-nut cloth, and rig up a mast, and then we shall be able to sail to some of the other islands, and visit our old friends the penguins.”

“Afterward,” continued Jack, “we’ll make a sail out of the coconut cloth, set up a mast, and then we’ll be able to sail to some of the other islands and visit our old friends the penguins.”

The prospect of being so soon in a position to extend our observations to the other islands, and enjoy a sail over the beautiful sea, afforded us much delight, and, after dinner, we set about making the oars in good earnest. Jack went into the woods and blocked them roughly out with the axe, and I smoothed them down with the knife, while Peterkin remained in the bower, spinning, or, rather, twisting some strong thick cordage with which to fasten them to the boat.

The idea of soon being able to explore the other islands and enjoy a sail on the stunning sea filled us with joy, so after dinner, we got serious about making the oars. Jack headed into the woods and roughly shaped them with the axe, while I refined them with the knife. Meanwhile, Peterkin stayed in the bower, spinning—more like twisting—some strong, thick rope to attach them to the boat.

We worked hard and rapidly, so that, when the sun went down, Jack and I returned to the bower with four stout oars, which required little to be done to them save a slight degree of polishing with the knife. As we drew near we were suddenly arrested by the sound of a voice! We were not a little surprised at this—indeed I may almost say alarmed—for, although Peterkin was undoubtedly fond of talking, we had never, up to this time, found him talking to himself. We listened intently, and still heard the sound of a voice as if in conversation. Jack motioned me to be silent, and, advancing to the bower on tip-toe, we peeped in.

We worked hard and quickly, so that when the sun set, Jack and I returned to the shelter with four sturdy oars, which needed little more than a bit of polishing with a knife. As we got closer, we were suddenly stopped by the sound of a voice! We were quite surprised—actually, I’d say we were a bit alarmed—because although Peterkin definitely liked to talk, we had never heard him talking to himself before. We listened closely and could still hear the sound of someone in conversation. Jack signaled for me to be quiet, and, tiptoeing toward the shelter, we peeked inside.

The sight that met our gaze was certainly not a little amusing. On the top of a log which we sometimes used as a table, sat the black cat, with a very demure expression on its countenance; and in front of it, sitting on the ground, with his legs extended on either side of the log, was Peterkin. At the moment we saw him he was gazing intently into the cat’s face, with his nose about four inches from it,—his hands being thrust into his breeches pockets.

The scene we saw was definitely a bit funny. On top of a log that we sometimes used as a table, sat a black cat, looking very prim and proper; and in front of it, sitting on the ground with his legs stretched out on either side of the log, was Peterkin. At that moment, he was staring closely into the cat's face, with his nose just four inches away, while his hands were shoved into his pants pockets.

“Cat,” said Peterkin, turning his head a little on one side, “I love you!”

“Cat,” Peterkin said, tilting his head slightly, “I love you!”

There was a pause, as if Peterkin awaited a reply to this affectionate declaration but the cat said nothing.

There was a pause, as if Peterkin was waiting for a response to this heartfelt statement, but the cat said nothing.

“Do you hear me?” cried Peterkin, sharply. “I love you—I do. Don’t you love me?”

“Do you hear me?” Peterkin shouted, urgently. “I love you—I really do. Don’t you love me?”

To this touching appeal the cat said “Mew,” faintly.

To this heartfelt plea, the cat softly responded, “Mew.”

“Ah! that’s right. You’re a jolly old rascal. Why did you not speak at once? eh?” and Peterkin put forward his mouth and kissed the cat on the nose!

“Ah! that’s right. You’re a cheerful old rascal. Why didn’t you say something right away? Huh?” and Peterkin puckered his lips and kissed the cat on the nose!

“Yes,” continued Peterkin, after a pause, “I love you. D’you think I’d say so if I didn’t, you black villain? I love you because I’ve got to take care of you, and to look after you, and to think about you, and to see that you don’t die—”

“Yes,” continued Peterkin, after a pause, “I love you. Do you think I’d say that if I didn’t, you black villain? I love you because I have to take care of you, look after you, think about you, and make sure you don’t die—”

“Mew, me-a-w!” said the cat.

“Mew, me-a-w!” said the cat.

“Very good,” continued Peterkin, “quite true, I have no doubt; but you’ve no right to interrupt me, sir. Hold your tongue till I have done speaking. Moreover, cat, I love you because you came to me the first time you ever saw me, and didn’t seem to be afraid, and appeared to be fond of me, though you didn’t know that I wasn’t going to kill you. Now, that was brave, that was bold, and very jolly, old boy, and I love you for it—I do!”

“Very good,” Peterkin continued, “that’s completely true, I’m sure; but you have no right to interrupt me, sir. Be quiet until I finish speaking. Also, cat, I love you because you came up to me the first time we met, and didn’t seem scared, and acted like you liked me, even though you didn’t know I wasn’t going to hurt you. That was brave, that was bold, and really great, old buddy, and I love you for it—I really do!”

Again there was a pause of a few minutes, during which the cat looked placid, and Peterkin dropped his eyes upon its toes as if in contemplation. Suddenly he looked up.

Again there was a pause of a few minutes, during which the cat looked calm, and Peterkin lowered his gaze to its toes as if lost in thought. Suddenly, he looked up.

“Well, cat, what are you thinking about now? won’t speak? eh? Now, tell me; don’t you think it’s a monstrous shame that these two scoundrels, Jack and Ralph, should keep us waiting for our supper so long?”

“Well, cat, what are you thinking about now? Won’t speak? Huh? Now, tell me; don’t you think it’s a ridiculous shame that these two jerks, Jack and Ralph, are making us wait so long for our dinner?”

Here the cat arose, put up its back and stretched itself; yawned slightly, and licked the point of Peterkin’s nose!

Here the cat got up, arched its back, and stretched; yawned a little, and licked the tip of Peterkin's nose!

“Just so, old boy, you’re a clever fellow,—I really do believe the brute understands me!” said Peterkin, while a broad grin overspread his face, as he drew back and surveyed the cat.

“Just like that, old friend, you’re a smart guy—I really think the creature gets what I’m saying!” said Peterkin, with a wide grin spreading across his face as he stepped back and looked at the cat.

At this point Jack burst into a loud fit of laughter. The cat uttered an angry fuff and fled, while Peterkin sprang up and exclaimed,—

At this point, Jack broke into a loud fit of laughter. The cat let out an annoyed huff and ran away, while Peterkin jumped up and exclaimed,—

“Bad luck to you, Jack! you’ve nearly made the heart jump out of my body, you have.”

“Bad luck to you, Jack! You almost gave me a heart attack!”

“Perhaps I have,” replied Jack, laughing, as we entered the bower, “but, as I don’t intend to keep you or the cat any longer from your supper, I hope that you’ll both forgive me.”

“Maybe I have,” Jack said with a laugh as we stepped into the bower, “but since I don't want to keep you or the cat from your dinner any longer, I hope you'll both forgive me.”

Peterkin endeavoured to turn this affair off with a laugh, but I observed that he blushed very deeply at the time we discovered ourselves, and he did not seem to relish any allusion to the subject afterwards; so we refrained from remarking on it ever after,—though it tickled us not a little at the time.

Peterkin tried to brush off this situation with a laugh, but I noticed he blushed deeply when we realized what had happened, and he didn't seem to enjoy any mention of it afterwards. So, we decided not to bring it up again, even though it amused us quite a bit at the time.

After supper we retired to rest and to dream of wonderful adventures in our little boat, and distant voyages upon the sea.

After dinner, we went to bed and dreamed of amazing adventures in our little boat and far-off journeys across the sea.

CHAPTER XVI.

The boat launched—We visit the coral reef—The great breaker that never goes down—Coral insects—The way in which coral islands are made—The boat’s sail—We tax our ingenuity to form fish-hooks—Some of the fish we saw—And a monstrous whale—Wonderful shower of little fish—Water-spouts.

The boat set sail—We explore the coral reef—The huge wave that never crashes down—Coral polyps—How coral islands are formed—The boat's sail—We use our creativity to make fish hooks—Some of the fish we spotted—And a giant whale—Amazing shower of tiny fish—Water spouts.

It was a bright, clear, beautiful morning, when we first launched our little boat and rowed out upon the placid waters of the lagoon. Not a breath of wind ruffled the surface of the deep. Not a cloud spotted the deep blue sky. Not a sound that was discordant broke the stillness of the morning, although there were many sounds, sweet, tiny, and melodious, that mingled in the universal harmony of nature. The sun was just rising from the Pacific’s ample bosom and tipping the mountain tops with a red glow. The sea was shining like a sheet of glass, yet heaving with the long deep swell that, all the world round, indicates the life of ocean; and the bright sea-weeds and the brilliant corals shone in the depths of that pellucid water, as we rowed over it, like rare and precious gems. Oh! it was a sight fitted to stir the soul of man to its profoundest depths, and, if he owned a heart at all, to lift that heart in adoration and gratitude to the great Creator of this magnificent and glorious universe.

It was a bright, clear, beautiful morning when we first launched our little boat and rowed out onto the calm waters of the lagoon. Not a breath of wind disturbed the surface of the deep. Not a cloud dotted the deep blue sky. There was no jarring sound to break the stillness of the morning, although many sweet, small, and melodious sounds blended into the universal harmony of nature. The sun was just rising from the Pacific's expansive horizon, casting a red glow on the mountain tops. The sea sparkled like a sheet of glass, yet rolled gently with the long deep swell that signifies the life of the ocean all around the world; and the bright seaweeds and brilliant corals glimmered in the depths of that clear water, like rare and precious gems as we rowed over it. Oh! it was a sight that could stir the deepest parts of a person's soul and, if one had a heart at all, lift that heart in awe and gratitude to the great Creator of this magnificent and glorious universe.

At first, in the strength of our delight, we rowed hither and thither without aim or object. But after the effervescence of our spirits was abated, we began to look about us and to consider what we should do.

At first, full of excitement, we paddled back and forth aimlessly. But as our energy started to fade, we began to look around and think about what we should do next.

“I vote that we row to the reef,” cried Peterkin.

“I say we row to the reef,” shouted Peterkin.

“And I vote that we visit the islands within the lagoon,” said I.

“And I say we should visit the islands in the lagoon,” I said.

“And I vote we do both,” cried Jack, “so pull away, boys.”

“And I say we do both,” shouted Jack, “so let’s go, guys.”

As I have already said, we had made four oars, but our boat was so small that only two were necessary. The extra pair were reserved in case any accident should happen to the others. It was therefore only needful that two of us should row, while the third steered, by means of an oar, and relieved the rowers occasionally.

As I mentioned before, we made four oars, but our boat was so small that only two were needed. The extra pair were kept in case something happened to the others. So, it was only necessary for two of us to row while the third steered with an oar and took turns helping the rowers.

First we landed on one of the small islands and ran all over it, but saw nothing worthy of particular notice. Then we landed on a larger island, on which were growing a few cocoa-nut trees. Not having eaten anything that morning, we gathered a few of the nuts and breakfasted. After this we pulled straight out to sea and landed on the coral reef.

First, we landed on one of the small islands and explored it, but didn’t find anything worth mentioning. Then we landed on a bigger island, where there were a few coconut trees. Since we hadn’t eaten anything that morning, we picked some of the nuts and had breakfast. After that, we headed straight out to sea and landed on the coral reef.

This was indeed a novel and interesting sight to us. We had now been so long on shore that we had almost forgotten the appearance of breakers, for there were none within the lagoon; but now, as we stood beside the foam-crested billow of the open sea, all the enthusiasm of the sailor was awakened in our breasts; and, as we gazed on the wide-spread ruin of that single magnificent breaker that burst in thunder at our feet, we forgot the Coral Island behind us; we forgot our bower and the calm repose of the scented woods; we forgot all that had passed during the last few months, and remembered nothing but the storms, the calms, the fresh breezes and the surging billows of the open sea.

This was really a new and exciting sight for us. We had been on land for so long that we had almost forgotten what waves looked like, since there were none in the lagoon; but now, as we stood next to the frothy waves of the open sea, all the excitement of being sailors bubbled up inside us. As we watched the spectacular crash of that single huge wave thunder at our feet, we forgot about the Coral Island behind us; we forgot our cozy spot and the peaceful smells of the trees; we forgot everything that had happened over the past few months and remembered only the storms, the calm, the refreshing breezes, and the rolling waves of the open sea.

This huge, ceaseless breaker, to which I have so often alluded, was a much larger and more sublime object than we had at all imagined it to be. It rose many yards above the level of the sea, and could be seen approaching at some distance from the reef. Slowly and majestically it came on, acquiring greater volume and velocity as it advanced, until it assumed the form of a clear watery arch, which sparkled in the bright sun. On it came with resistless and solemn majesty,—the upper edge lipped gently over, and it fell with a roar that seemed as though the heart of Ocean were broken in the crash of tumultuous water, while the foam-clad coral reef appeared to tremble beneath the mighty shock!

This massive, nonstop wave, which I've mentioned many times, was far bigger and more impressive than we ever thought it would be. It rose several feet above the sea level and could be spotted from a distance near the reef. It moved slowly and grandly, gaining size and speed as it approached, until it took the shape of a clear, sparkling arch of water in the bright sunlight. It surged forward with unstoppable and serious grandeur—the top edge curling gently over, crashing down with a roar that felt like the heart of the Ocean was shattering in the tumultuous water, while the foamy coral reef seemed to shake under the tremendous impact!

We gazed long and wonderingly at this great sight, and it was with difficulty we could tear ourselves away from it. As I have once before mentioned, this wave broke in many places over the reef and scattered some of its spray into the lagoon, but in most places the reef was sufficiently broad and elevated to receive and check its entire force. In many places the coral rocks were covered with vegetation,—the beginning, as it appeared to us, of future islands. Thus, on this reef, we came to perceive how most of the small islands of those seas are formed. On one part we saw the spray of the breaker washing over the rocks, and millions of little, active, busy creatures continuing the work of building up this living rampart. At another place, which was just a little too high for the waves to wash over it, the coral insects were all dead; for we found that they never did their work above water. They had faithfully completed the mighty work which their Creator had given them to do, and they were now all dead. Again, in other spots the ceaseless lashing of the sea had broken the dead coral in pieces, and cast it up in the form of sand. Here sea-birds had alighted, little pieces of sea-weed and stray bits of wood had been washed up, seeds of plants had been carried by the wind and a few lovely blades of bright green had already sprung up, which, when they died, would increase the size and fertility of these emeralds of Ocean. At other places these islets had grown apace, and were shaded by one or two cocoa-nut trees, which grew, literally, in the sand, and were constantly washed by the ocean spray; yet, as I have before remarked, their fruit was most refreshing and sweet to our taste.

We stared for a long time at this amazing sight, and it was hard to pull ourselves away from it. As I mentioned before, this wave broke in many spots over the reef and sent some of its spray into the lagoon, but in most areas, the reef was wide and high enough to absorb its full force. In many places, the coral rocks were covered with plants—the beginning, it seemed to us, of future islands. Thus, on this reef, we began to understand how most of the small islands in those seas are formed. In one area, we saw the spray from the waves washing over the rocks, and millions of tiny, busy creatures were continuing to build this living barrier. In another spot, which was just a bit too high for the waves to reach, the coral insects were all dead; it turned out they never did their work above water. They had faithfully completed the huge task their Creator had given them, and now they were all gone. Again, in other areas, the relentless pounding of the sea had broken the dead coral into pieces and reshaped it into sand. Here, seabirds had landed, small pieces of seaweed and stray bits of wood had washed ashore, seeds from plants had been blown in by the wind, and a few beautiful green blades had already sprouted, which, when they died, would add to the size and fertility of these ocean gems. Elsewhere, these islets had rapidly grown, shaded by one or two coconut trees that literally thrived in the sand and were constantly sprayed by ocean mist; yet, as I noted before, their fruit was incredibly refreshing and sweet to our taste.

Again at this time Jack and I pondered the formation of the large coral islands. We could now understand how the low ones were formed, but the larger islands cost us much consideration, yet we could arrive at no certain conclusion on the subject.

Again at this time, Jack and I thought about how the large coral islands were formed. We could now understand how the smaller ones came to be, but the bigger islands had us stumped, and we couldn't come to any definite conclusion on the topic.

Having satisfied our curiosity and enjoyed ourselves during the whole day, in our little boat, we returned, somewhat wearied, and, withal, rather hungry, to our bower.

Having satisfied our curiosity and had a great time all day in our little boat, we returned, a bit tired and also quite hungry, to our cozy spot.

“Now,” said Jack, “as our boat answers so well, we will get a mast and sail made immediately.”

“Now,” Jack said, “since our boat is performing so well, let’s get a mast and sail made right away.”

“So we will,” cried Peterkin, as we all assisted to drag the boat above high-water mark; “we’ll light our candle and set about it this very night. Hurrah, my boys, pull away!”

“So we will,” shouted Peterkin, as we all helped to pull the boat above the high-water mark; “we’ll light our candle and get to it tonight. Hurrah, guys, keep going!”

As we dragged our boat, we observed that she grated heavily on her keel; and, as the sands were in this place mingled with broken coral rocks, we saw portions of the wood being scraped off.

As we pulled our boat, we noticed that it was scraping hard against the keel; and since the sand in this area was mixed with broken coral rocks, we could see bits of wood being worn away.

“Hallo!” cried Jack, on seeing this. “That won’t do. Our keel will be worn off in no time at this rate.”

“Hey!” shouted Jack, upon seeing this. “That won't work. Our keel will wear down in no time at this rate.”

“So it will,” said I, pondering deeply as to how this might be prevented. But I am not of a mechanical turn, naturally, so I could conceive no remedy save that of putting a plate of iron on the keel, but as we had no iron I knew not what was to be done. “It seems to me, Jack,” I added, “that it is impossible to prevent the keel being worn off thus.”

“So it will,” I said, thinking hard about how to stop this. But I’m not naturally good with mechanics, so the only solution I could think of was putting a plate of iron on the keel. Since we didn’t have any iron, I didn’t know what to do. “It seems to me, Jack,” I added, “that it’s impossible to prevent the keel from wearing down like this.”

“Impossible!” cried Peterkin, “my dear Ralph, you are mistaken, there is nothing so easy—”

“Impossible!” shouted Peterkin, “my dear Ralph, you’re wrong, there’s nothing easier—”

“How?” I inquired, in some surprise.

“How?” I asked, a bit surprised.

“Why, by not using the boat at all!” replied Peterkin.

“Why, by not using the boat at all!” replied Peterkin.

“Hold your impudent tongue, Peterkin,” said Jack, as he shouldered the oars, “come along with me and I’ll give you work to do. In the first place, you will go and collect cocoa-nut fibre, and set to work to make sewing twine with it—”

“Keep your rude comments to yourself, Peterkin,” Jack said as he picked up the oars. “Come with me, and I’ll give you something to do. First, you’ll go collect coconut fiber and start making sewing twine with it—”

“Please, captain,” interrupted Peterkin, “I’ve got lots of it made already,—more than enough, as a little friend of mine used to be in the habit of saying every day after dinner.”

“Please, captain,” interrupted Peterkin, “I’ve already made a lot of it—more than enough, as a little friend of mine used to say every day after dinner.”

“Very well,” continued Jack; “then you’ll help Ralph to collect cocoa-nut cloth, and cut it into shape, after which we’ll make a sail of it. I’ll see to getting the mast and the gearing; so let’s to work.”

“Alright,” Jack said. “Then you’ll help Ralph gather coconut fiber and cut it to shape, and then we’ll make a sail from it. I’ll take care of getting the mast and the rigging, so let’s get started.”

And to work we went right busily, so that in three days from that time we had set up a mast and sail, with the necessary rigging, in our little boat. The sail was not, indeed, very handsome to look at, as it was formed of a number of oblong patches of cloth; but we had sewed it well by means of our sail-needle, so that it was strong, which was the chief point. Jack had also overcome the difficulty about the keel, by pinning to it a false keel. This was a piece of tough wood, of the same length and width as the real keel, and about five inches deep. He made it of this depth because the boat would be thereby rendered not only much more safe, but more able to beat against the wind; which, in a sea where the trade-winds blow so long and so steadily in one direction, was a matter of great importance. This piece of wood was pegged very firmly to the keel; and we now launched our boat with the satisfaction of knowing that when the false keel should be scraped off we could easily put on another; whereas, should the real keel have been scraped away, we could not have renewed it without taking our boat to pieces, which Peterkin said made his “marrow quake to think upon.”

And we got to work right away, so that within three days we had set up a mast and sail, along with the necessary rigging, on our little boat. The sail wasn't exactly great to look at, as it was made from several oblong patches of cloth. However, we sewed it together well with our sail needle, making it strong, which was the most important thing. Jack also solved the issue with the keel by attaching a false keel to it. This was a sturdy piece of wood, the same length and width as the actual keel, and about five inches deep. He made it that deep because it would make the boat much safer and better able to sail against the wind, which was really important in a place where the trade winds blow steadily in one direction. This piece of wood was securely attached to the keel, and we launched our boat feeling satisfied that when the false keel wore down, we could easily add another. If the real keel had been damaged, though, we couldn't replace it without taking the whole boat apart, which made Peterkin say it made his “marrow quake to think about.”

The mast and sail answered excellently; and we now sailed about in the lagoon with great delight, and examined with much interest the appearance of our island from a distance. Also, we gazed into the depths of the water, and watched for hours the gambols of the curious and bright-coloured fish among the corals and sea-weed. Peterkin also made a fishing line, and Jack constructed a number of hooks, some of which were very good, others remarkably bad. Some of these hooks were made of iron-wood, which did pretty well, the wood being extremely hard, and Jack made them very thick and large. Fish there are not particular. Some of the crooked bones in fish-heads also answered for this purpose pretty well. But that which formed our best and most serviceable hook was the brass finger-ring belonging to Jack. It gave him not a little trouble to manufacture it. First he cut it with the axe; then twisted it into the form of a hook. The barb took him several hours to cut. He did it by means of constant sawing with the broken pen-knife. As for the point, an hour’s rubbing on a piece of sandstone made an excellent one.

The mast and sail worked great, and we now sailed around the lagoon with a lot of joy, looking closely at how our island looked from a distance. We also peered into the water’s depths and spent hours watching the playful, colorful fish dart among the corals and seaweed. Peterkin made a fishing line, and Jack created several hooks, some of which were quite good, while others were surprisingly bad. Some of these hooks were made from ironwood, which worked well since the wood is very hard, and Jack made them thick and large. Fish aren’t picky. Some of the crooked bones from fish heads also worked pretty well for this purpose. But our best and most useful hook was Jack’s brass finger ring. It took him quite a bit of effort to shape it. First, he chopped it with an axe, then twisted it into a hook shape. The barb took him several hours to carve out with a broken penknife. As for the point, an hour of rubbing on a piece of sandstone created an excellent tip.

It would be a matter of much time and labour to describe the appearance of the multitudes of fish that were day after day drawn into our boat by means of the brass hook. Peterkin always caught them,—for we observed that he derived much pleasure from fishing,—while Jack and I found ample amusement in looking on, also in gazing down at the coral groves, and in baiting the hook. Among the fish that we saw, but did not catch, were porpoises and sword-fish, whales and sharks. The porpoises came frequently into our lagoon in shoals, and amused us not a little by their bold leaps into the air, and their playful gambols in the sea. The sword-fish were wonderful creatures; some of them apparently ten feet in length, with an ivory spear, six or eight feet long, projecting from their noses. We often saw them darting after other fish, and no doubt they sometimes killed them with their ivory swords. Jack remembered having heard once of a sword-fish attacking a ship,—which seemed strange indeed; but, as they are often in the habit of attacking whales, perhaps it mistook the ship for one. This sword-fish ran against the vessel with such force, that it drove its sword quite through the thick planks; and when the ship arrived in harbour, long afterwards, the sword was found still sticking in it!

It would take a lot of time and effort to describe the many fish that were caught in our boat day after day with the brass hook. Peterkin always caught them—since we noticed he really enjoyed fishing—while Jack and I found plenty of fun watching him, looking down at the coral reefs, and baiting the hook. Among the fish we saw but didn’t catch were porpoises, swordfish, whales, and sharks. The porpoises often swam into our lagoon in groups and entertained us with their daring jumps and playful antics in the water. The swordfish were amazing creatures; some seemed to be ten feet long, with an ivory spear, six or eight feet long, sticking out from their snouts. We often saw them rushing after other fish, and they probably sometimes killed them with their ivory swords. Jack remembered hearing once about a swordfish attacking a ship—which sounded pretty strange—but since they often target whales, maybe it mistook the ship for one. This swordfish hit the vessel with such force that it drove its sword all the way through the thick planks; and when the ship eventually made it to harbor, the sword was still stuck in it!

Sharks did not often appear; but we took care never again to bathe in deep water without leaving one of our number in the boat to give us warning, if he should see a shark approaching. As for the whales, they never came into our lagoon, but we frequently saw them spouting in the deep water beyond the reef. I shall never forget my surprise the first day I saw one of these huge monsters close to me. We had been rambling about on the reef during the morning, and were about to re-embark in our little boat, to return home, when a loud blowing sound caused us to wheel rapidly round. We were just in time to see a shower of spray falling, and the flukes or tail of some monstrous fish disappear in the sea a few hundred yards off. We waited some time to see if he would rise again. As we stood, the sea seemed to open up at our very feet; an immense spout of water was sent with a snort high into the air, and the huge blunt head of a sperm whale arose before us. It was so large that it could easily have taken our little boat, along with ourselves, into its mouth! It plunged slowly back into the sea, like a large ship foundering, and struck the water with its tail so forcibly as to cause a sound like a cannon shot. We also saw a great number of flying fish, although we caught none; and we noticed that they never flew out of the water except when followed by their bitter foe, the dolphin, from whom they thus endeavoured to escape. But of all the fish that we saw, none surprised us so much as those that we used to find in shallow pools after a shower of rain; and this not on account of their appearance, for they were ordinary-looking and very small, but on account of their having descended in a shower of rain! We could account for them in no other way, because the pools in which we found these fish were quite dry before the shower, and at some distance above high-water mark. Jack, however, suggested a cause which seemed to me very probable. We used often to see water-spouts in the sea. A water-spout is a whirling body of water, which rises from the sea like a sharp-pointed pillar. After rising a good way, it is met by a long tongue, which comes down from the clouds; and when the two have joined, they look something like an hour-glass. The water-spout is then carried by the wind, sometimes gently, sometimes with violence, over the sea, sometimes up into the clouds, and then, bursting asunder, it descends in a deluge. This often happens over the land as well as over the sea; and it sometimes does much damage, but frequently it passes gently away. Now, Jack thought that the little fish might perhaps have been carried up in a water-spout, and so sent down again in a shower of rain. But we could not be certain as to this point; yet we thought it likely.

Sharks didn't show up often, but we made sure never to swim in deep water again without leaving someone in the boat to warn us if a shark came near. As for whales, they never entered our lagoon, but we often saw them spouting in the deeper water beyond the reef. I'll never forget my surprise the first time I saw one of these massive creatures up close. We had been exploring the reef in the morning and were about to get back in our little boat to head home when a loud blast of air made us turn around quickly. Just in time, we saw a spray of water shooting up, and the flukes or tail of some gigantic fish disappearing in the sea a few hundred yards away. We waited for a while to see if it would resurface. While we stood there, the sea seemed to open up right in front of us; a huge jet of water shot high into the air with a snort, and the massive blunt head of a sperm whale rose before us. It was so big it could have easily swallowed our little boat and us too! It slowly sank back into the sea like a large ship going down and hit the water with its tail so hard it sounded like a cannon shot. We also spotted a lot of flying fish, although we didn’t catch any; and we noticed they only jumped out of the water when they were being chased by their dreaded enemy, the dolphin, from whom they tried to escape. But of all the fish we saw, none amazed us as much as those we found in shallow pools after a rain shower; not because of how they looked—they were plain and very small—but because they had come down in a rain shower! We couldn't explain it any other way since the pools where we found these fish had been completely dry before the rain, located far above the high-water mark. Jack, however, proposed a theory that seemed pretty reasonable to me. We often observed water spouts at sea. A water spout is a swirling column of water that rises from the sea like a sharp-pointed pillar. After rising a bit, it meets a long tongue coming down from the clouds; when they connect, they resemble an hourglass. The water spout is then carried by the wind, sometimes gently, sometimes violently, over the sea, sometimes into the clouds, and when it bursts apart, it falls as a downpour. This happens over land as well as over the sea; it can cause a lot of damage but often passes quietly. Now, Jack thought that maybe the little fish had been lifted up in a water spout and then dropped back down in the rain. But we couldn't be sure about this, though we thought it was likely.

During these delightful fishing and boating excursions we caught a good many eels, which we found to be very good to eat. We also found turtles among the coral rocks, and made excellent soup in our iron kettle. Moreover, we discovered many shrimps and prawns, so that we had no lack of variety in our food; and, indeed, we never passed a week without making some new and interesting discovery of some sort or other, either on the land or in the sea.

During these fun fishing and boating trips, we caught quite a few eels, which we found to be really tasty. We also came across turtles among the coral rocks and made excellent soup in our iron pot. Plus, we discovered many shrimp and prawns, so we had plenty of variety in our meals; in fact, we never went a week without making some new and interesting discovery of some kind, either on land or in the sea.

CHAPTER XVII.

A monster wave and its consequences—The boat lost and found—Peterkin’s terrible accident—Supplies of food for a voyage in the boat—We visit Penguin Island, and are amazed beyond measure—Account of the penguins.

A massive wave and its aftermath—the boat that was lost and then found—Peterkin’s awful accident—Food supplies for a trip in the boat—we visit Penguin Island, and are totally blown away—Details about the penguins.

One day, not long after our little boat was finished, we were sitting on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, and talking of an excursion which we intended to make to Penguin Island the next day.

One day, shortly after our small boat was completed, we were sitting on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, discussing a trip we planned to take to Penguin Island the following day.

“You see,” said Peterkin, “it might be all very well for a stupid fellow like me to remain here and leave the penguins alone, but it would be quite inconsistent with your characters as philosophers to remain any longer in ignorance of the habits and customs of these birds; so the sooner we go the better.”

“You see,” said Peterkin, “it might be fine for a dumb guy like me to stay here and leave the penguins alone, but it would be totally inconsistent with your roles as philosophers to stay any longer without knowing the habits and customs of these birds; so the sooner we go, the better.”

“Very true,” said I; “there is nothing I desire so much as to have a closer inspection of them.”

“Very true,” I said; “there's nothing I want more than to take a closer look at them.”

“And I think,” said Jack, “that you had better remain at home, Peterkin, to take care of the cat; for I’m sure the hogs will be at it in your absence, out of revenge for your killing their great-grandmother so recklessly.”

“And I think,” said Jack, “that you should stay home, Peterkin, to look after the cat; because I’m sure the hogs will make trouble in your absence, out of revenge for you killing their great-grandmother so carelessly.”

“Stay at home?” cried Peterkin; “my dear fellow, you would certainly lose your way, or get upset, if I were not there to take care of you.”

“Stay home?” shouted Peterkin. “My friend, you would definitely get lost or freak out if I wasn’t here to look after you.”

“Ah, true,” said Jack, gravely, “that did not occur to me; no doubt you must go. Our boat does require a good deal of ballast; and all that you say, Peterkin, carries so much weight with it, that we won’t need stones if you go.”

“Ah, true,” said Jack seriously, “I didn’t think of that; you definitely have to go. Our boat needs a good amount of ballast, and everything you’re saying, Peterkin, is so valid that we won’t need rocks if you leave.”

Now, while my companions were talking, a notable event occurred, which, as it is not generally known, I shall be particular in recording here.

Now, while my friends were chatting, something significant happened that isn’t widely known, so I will make sure to note it down here.

While we were talking, as I have said, we noticed a dark line, like a low cloud or fog-bank, on the seaward horizon. The day was a fine one, though cloudy, and a gentle breeze was blowing, but the sea was not rougher, or the breaker on the reef higher, than usual. At first we thought that this looked like a thunder-cloud; and, as we had had a good deal of broken weather of late, accompanied by occasional peals of thunder, we supposed that a storm must be approaching. Gradually, however, this line seemed to draw nearer, without spreading up over the sky, as would certainly have been the case if it had been a storm-cloud. Still nearer it came, and soon we saw that it was moving swiftly towards the island; but there was no sound till it reached the islands out at sea. As it passed these islands, we observed, with no little anxiety, that a cloud of white foam encircled them, and burst in spray into the air: it was accompanied by a loud roar. This led us to conjecture that the approaching object was an enormous wave of the sea; but we had no idea how large it was till it came near to ourselves. When it approached the outer reef, however, we were awe-struck with its unusual magnitude; and we sprang to our feet, and clambered hastily up to the highest point of the precipice, under an indefinable feeling of fear.

While we were talking, as I mentioned, we noticed a dark line on the seaward horizon, like a low cloud or fog. The day was nice, though cloudy, and a gentle breeze was blowing, but the sea was just as calm, and the surf on the reef was no higher than usual. At first, we thought it looked like a thundercloud; and since we had been experiencing a lot of stormy weather lately, with occasional thunder, we assumed a storm was coming. Gradually, though, this line seemed to get closer without spreading across the sky, which would have happened if it were a storm cloud. It continued to approach us, and soon we saw it rapidly moving toward the island, but there was no sound until it reached the islands out at sea. As it passed these islands, we watched with growing anxiety as a cloud of white foam surrounded them, bursting into spray: there was a loud roar. This made us suspect that the approaching object was an enormous wave, but we had no idea how huge it was until it got closer to us. When it reached the outer reef, we were struck with awe at its massive size; we jumped to our feet and hurried up to the highest point of the cliff, overwhelmed by an indescribable sense of fear.

I have said before that the reef opposite Spouting Cliff was very near to the shore, while, just in front of the bower, it was at a considerable distance out to sea. Owing to this formation, the wave reached the reef at the latter point before it struck at the foot of Spouting Cliff. The instant it touched the reef we became aware, for the first time, of its awful magnitude. It burst completely over the reef at all points, with a roar that seemed louder to me than thunder; and this roar continued for some seconds, while the wave rolled gradually along towards the cliff on which we stood. As its crest reared before us, we felt that we were in great danger, and turned to flee; but we were too late. With a crash that seemed to shake the solid rocks the gigantic billow fell, and instantly the spouting-holes sent up a gush of water-spouts with such force that they shrieked on issuing from their narrow vents. It seemed to us as if the earth had been blown up with water. We were stunned and confused by the shock, and so drenched and blinded with spray, that we knew not for a few moments whither to flee for shelter. At length we all three gained an eminence beyond the reach of the water; but what a scene of devastation met our gaze as we looked along the shore! This enormous wave not only burst over the reef, but continued its way across the lagoon, and fell on the sandy beach of the island with such force that passed completely over it and dashed into the woods, levelling the smaller trees and bushes in its headlong course!

I’ve mentioned before that the reef in front of Spouting Cliff was very close to shore, while right in front of the bower, it was much farther out to sea. Because of this layout, the wave reached the reef at the latter point before it hit the base of Spouting Cliff. The moment it hit the reef, we realized for the first time how massive it was. It completely exploded over the reef at all points, with a roar that sounded even louder to me than thunder; and this roar went on for several seconds as the wave rolled towards the cliff where we stood. As its crest rose up before us, we sensed that we were in serious danger and tried to run; but we were too late. With a crash that seemed to shake the solid rocks, the gigantic wave fell, and immediately the spouting-holes sent up jets of water with such force that they screamed as they shot out from their narrow openings. It felt as if the earth had exploded with water. We were stunned and disoriented by the impact, drenched and blinded by the spray, not knowing where to escape for cover. Eventually, all three of us made it to higher ground, out of reach of the water; but what a scene of destruction awaited us as we looked along the shore! This enormous wave not only crashed over the reef but continued across the lagoon and slammed onto the island's sandy beach with such force that it completely washed over it and crashed into the woods, flattening the smaller trees and bushes in its reckless path!

On seeing this, Jack said he feared our bower must have been swept away, and that the boat, which was on the beach, must have been utterly destroyed. Our hearts sank within us as we thought of this, and we hastened round through the woods towards our home. On reaching it we found, to our great relief of mind, that the force of the wave had been expended just before reaching the bower; but the entrance to it was almost blocked up by the torn-up bushes and tangled heaps of sea-weed. Having satisfied ourselves as to the bower, we hurried to the spot where the boat had been left; but no boat was there! The spot on which it had stood was vacant, and no sign of it could we see on looking around us.

On seeing this, Jack said he feared our shelter must have been swept away, and that the boat, which was on the beach, must have been completely destroyed. Our hearts sank as we thought about this, and we quickly made our way through the woods towards home. When we got there, we were greatly relieved to find that the force of the wave had stopped just before reaching the shelter; however, the entrance was nearly blocked by uprooted bushes and tangled piles of seaweed. After confirming that the shelter was okay, we rushed to where the boat had been left; but there was no boat! The spot where it had been was empty, and we couldn’t see any sign of it as we looked around.

“It may have been washed up into the woods,” said Jack, hurrying up the beach as he spoke. Still, no boat was to be seen, and we were about to give ourselves over to despair, when Peterkin called to Jack and said,—

“It might have been washed up into the woods,” Jack said, rushing up the beach as he spoke. Still, there was no boat in sight, and we were on the verge of giving in to despair when Peterkin called out to Jack and said,—

“Jack, my friend, you were once so exceedingly sagacious and wise as to make me acquainted with the fact that cocoa nuts grow upon trees; will you now be so good as to inform me what sort of fruit that is growing on the top of yonder bush? for I confess to being ignorant, or, at least, doubtful on the point.”

“Jack, my friend, you were once so incredibly smart that you made me realize that coconuts grow on trees; can you now tell me what kind of fruit is growing on top of that bush over there? Because I have to admit, I'm not sure about that.”

We looked towards the bush indicated, and there, to our surprise, beheld our little boat snugly nestled among the leaves! We were very much overjoyed at this, for we would have suffered any loss rather than the loss of our boat. We found that the wave had actually borne the boat on its crest from the beach into the woods, and there launched it into the heart of this bush; which was extremely fortunate, for had it been tossed against a rock or a tree, it would have been dashed to pieces, whereas it had not received the smallest injury. It was no easy matter, however, to get it out of the bush and down to the sea again. This cost us two days of hard labour to accomplish.

We looked toward the indicated bush, and there, to our surprise, we saw our little boat snugly tucked among the leaves! We were incredibly happy about this, because we would have endured any loss rather than lose our boat. We discovered that the wave had actually carried the boat on its crest from the beach into the woods and launched it into the heart of this bush, which was extremely lucky, because if it had been tossed against a rock or a tree, it would have been destroyed. Instead, it hadn’t suffered the slightest damage. However, it wasn’t easy to get it out of the bush and back to the sea. It took us two days of hard work to accomplish that.

We had also much ado to clear away the rubbish from before the bower, and spent nearly a week in constant labour ere we got the neighbourhood to look as clean and orderly as before; for the uprooted bushes and sea-weed that lay on the beach formed a more dreadfully confused-looking mass than one who had not seen the place after the inundation could conceive.

We also had a lot of work to do to clear away the debris from in front of the shelter, and we spent almost a week working hard before the area looked as clean and tidy as it did before; the uprooted bushes and seaweed that were on the beach created a chaotic mess that would be hard for anyone who hadn't seen the place after the flooding to imagine.

Before leaving the subject I may mention, for the sake of those who interest themselves in the curious natural phenomena of our world, that this gigantic wave occurs regularly on some of the islands of the Pacific, once, and sometimes twice in the year. I heard this stated by the missionaries during my career in those seas. They could not tell me whether it visited all of the islands, but I was certainly assured that it occurred periodically in some of them.

Before moving on, I should mention, for those interested in the fascinating natural phenomena of our world, that this massive wave happens regularly at some of the Pacific islands, once, and sometimes twice a year. I heard this from the missionaries during my time in those waters. They couldn’t tell me if it affected all the islands, but I was definitely told that it happened periodically in some of them.

After we had got our home put to rights and cleared of the debris of the inundation, we again turned our thoughts to paying the penguins a visit. The boat was therefore overhauled and a few repairs done. Then we prepared a supply of provisions, for we intended to be absent at least a night or two, perhaps longer. This took us some time to do, for while Jack was busy with the boat, Peterkin was sent into the woods to spear a hog or two, and had to search long, sometimes, ere he found them. Peterkin was usually sent on this errand, when we wanted a pork chop (which was not seldom), because he was so active, and could run so wonderfully fast that he found no difficulty in overtaking the hogs; but, being dreadfully reckless, he almost invariably tumbled over stumps and stones in the course of his wild chase, and seldom returned home without having knocked the skin off his shins. Once, indeed, a more serious accident happened to him. He had been out all morning alone and did not return at the usual time to dinner. We wondered at this, for Peterkin was always very punctual at the dinner hour. As supper-time drew near we began to be anxious about him, and at length sallied forth to search the woods. For a long time we sought in vain, but a little before dark we came upon the tracks of the hogs, which we followed up until we came to the brow of a rather steep bank or precipice. Looking over this we beheld Peterkin lying in a state of insensibility at the foot, with his cheek resting on the snout of a little pig, which was pinned to the earth by the spear! We were dreadfully alarmed, but hastened to bathe his forehead with water, and had soon the satisfaction of seeing him revive. After we had carried him home he related to as how the thing had happened.

After we got our home sorted out and cleaned up from the flood, we turned our thoughts back to visiting the penguins. So we went over the boat and made a few repairs. Then we stocked up on supplies because we planned to be gone for at least a night or two, maybe longer. This took us a while, since while Jack worked on the boat, Peterkin was sent into the woods to hunt a hog or two, which he sometimes had to search a long time to find. Peterkin was usually assigned this task when we wanted pork chops (which was often) because he was so quick and could easily catch up to the hogs. However, he was incredibly reckless and almost always tripped over stumps and rocks during his wild chase, rarely coming home without scraped shins. Once, he even had a more serious accident. He had been out all morning by himself and hadn’t returned at the usual time for dinner. We were surprised because Peterkin was always very punctual for meals. As supper time approached, we started to worry about him, and finally, we headed out to search the woods. We searched for quite a while with no luck, but just before it got dark, we came across the tracks of the hogs, which we followed until we reached the edge of a pretty steep bank or cliff. Looking over, we saw Peterkin lying unconscious at the bottom, with his cheek resting on the snout of a little pig that was pinned to the ground by his spear! We were extremely worried but quickly rushed down to wash his forehead with water and were soon relieved to see him come around. After we brought him home, he told us how it had happened.

“You must know,” said he, “I walked about all the forenoon, till I was as tired as an old donkey, without seeing a single grunter, not so much as a track of one; but, as I was determined not to return empty-handed, I resolved to go without my dinner and—”

“You should know,” he said, “I walked around all morning until I was as tired as an old donkey, without seeing a single pig, not even a trace of one; but since I was determined not to go back empty-handed, I decided to skip lunch and—”

“What!” exclaimed Jack, “did you really resolve to do that?”

“What!” exclaimed Jack, “did you seriously decide to do that?”

“Now, Jack, hold your tongue,” returned Peterkin; “I say that I resolved to forego my dinner and to push to the head of the small valley, where I felt pretty sure of discovering the hogs. I soon found that I was on the right scent, for I had scarcely walked half a mile in the direction of the small plum tree we found there the other day, when a squeak fell on my ear. ‘Ho, ho,’ said I, ‘there you go, my boys;’ and I hurried up the glen. I soon started them, and singling out a fat pig, ran tilt at him. In a few seconds I was up with him, and stuck my spear right through his dumpy body. Just as I did so, I saw that we were on the edge of a precipice, whether high or low I knew not, but I had been running at such a pace that I could not stop, so the pig and I gave a howl in concert and went plunging over together. I remembered nothing more after that, till I came to my senses and found you bathing my temples, and Ralph wringing his hands over me.”

“Now, Jack, keep quiet,” Peterkin replied; “I decided to skip my dinner and head to the top of the small valley, where I was pretty sure I’d find the pigs. I quickly realized I was onto something because I had barely walked half a mile toward the little plum tree we found the other day when I heard a squeak. ‘Hey, hey,’ I said, ‘there you are, my friends;’ and I rushed up the glen. I soon spotted them and zeroed in on a fat pig, charging at him. In just a few seconds, I caught up to him and pushed my spear right through his chubby body. Just as I did that, I noticed we were at the edge of a cliff, whether it was high or low I didn’t know, but I had been running so fast that I couldn’t stop. So the pig and I let out a scream together and both went tumbling over the edge. I didn’t remember anything after that until I regained consciousness and found you treating my forehead, with Ralph fretting over me.”

But although Peterkin was often unfortunate, in the way of getting tumbles, he was successful on the present occasion in hunting, and returned before evening with three very nice little hogs. I, also, was successful in my visit to the mud-flats, where I killed several ducks. So that, when we launched and loaded our boat at sunrise the following morning, we found our store of provisions to be more than sufficient. Part had been cooked the night before, and, on taking note of the different items, we found the account to stand thus:—

But even though Peterkin often had bad luck and kept falling over, he managed to do well this time while hunting and came back before evening with three nice little pigs. I also did well on my trip to the mud-flats, where I shot several ducks. So, when we launched and loaded our boat at sunrise the next morning, we realized we had more than enough supplies. Some had been cooked the night before, and when we took stock of the different items, the account looked like this:—

10 Bread-fruits, (two baked, eight unbaked.)
20 Yams, (six roasted, the rest raw.)
6 Taro roots.
50 Fine large plums.
6 Cocoa nuts, ripe.
6 Ditto green, (for drinking.)
4 Large ducks and two small ones, raw.
3 Cold roast pigs, with stuffing.

10 Bread-fruits, (two baked, eight unbaked.)
20 Yams, (six roasted, the rest raw.)
6 Taro roots.
50 Large, high-quality plums.
6 Ripe coconuts.
6 Green coconuts, (for drinking.)
4 Large ducks and two small ones, raw.
3 Cold roasted pigs, with stuffing.

I may here remark that the stuffing had been devised by Peterkin specially for the occasion. He kept the manner of its compounding a profound secret, so I cannot tell what it was; but I can say, with much confidence, that we found it to be atrociously bad, and, after the first tasting, scraped it carefully out and threw it overboard. We calculated that this supply would last us for several days, but we afterwards found that it was much more than we required, especially in regard to the cocoa nuts, of which we found large supplies wherever we went. However, as Peterkin remarked, it was better to have too much than too little, as we knew not to what straits we might be put during our voyage.

I should mention that Peterkin created the stuffing specifically for this occasion. He kept the recipe a complete secret, so I can't say exactly what was in it; but I can confidently say that it was extremely bad, and after the first taste, we carefully scraped it out and threw it overboard. We thought this supply would last us for several days, but we later realized we had way more than we needed, especially with the large amounts of coconuts we found wherever we went. However, as Peterkin pointed out, it’s better to have too much than too little, since we didn’t know what challenges we might face during our voyage.

It was a very calm sunny morning when we launched forth and rowed over the lagoon towards the outlet in the reef, and passed between the two green islets that guard the entrance. We experienced some difficulty and no little danger in passing the surf of the breaker, and shipped a good deal of water in the attempt; but, once past the billow, we found ourselves floating placidly on the long oily swell that rose and fell slowly as it rolled over the wide ocean.

It was a very calm, sunny morning when we set out and rowed across the lagoon toward the opening in the reef, passing between the two green islets that protect the entrance. We faced some challenges and a fair amount of danger getting through the surf of the breaker, and we took on quite a bit of water in the process; but once we got past the waves, we found ourselves peacefully floating on the smooth, gentle swell that rose and fell slowly as it rolled over the vast ocean.

Penguin Island lay on the other side of our own island, at about a mile beyond the outer reef, and we calculated that it must be at least twenty miles distant by the way we should have to go. We might, indeed, have shortened the way by coasting round our island inside of the lagoon, and going out at the passage in the reef nearly opposite to Penguin Island, but we preferred to go by the open sea; first, because it was more adventurous; and, secondly, because we should have the pleasure of again feeling the motion of the deep, which we all loved very much, not being liable to sea sickness.

Penguin Island was on the other side of our island, about a mile past the outer reef, and we estimated that it was at least twenty miles away based on the route we needed to take. We could have actually taken a shortcut by navigating around our island inside the lagoon and exiting at the passage in the reef nearly across from Penguin Island, but we chose to go by the open sea; first, because it felt more adventurous; and secondly, because we wanted to enjoy the sensation of the deep water again, which we all loved a lot since we weren't prone to seasickness.

“I wish we had a breeze,” said Jack.

“I wish we had a breeze,” Jack said.

“So do I,” cried Peterkin, resting on his oar and wiping his heated brow; “pulling is hard work. Oh dear, if we could only catch a hundred or two of these gulls, tie them to the boat with long strings, and make them fly as we want them, how capital it would be!”

“So do I,” shouted Peterkin, pausing on his oar and wiping his sweaty forehead; “rowan is tough work. Oh man, if we could just catch a hundred or so of these gulls, tie them to the boat with long strings, and make them fly where we want them, how awesome would that be!”

“Or bore a hole through a shark’s tail, and reeve a rope through it, eh?” remarked Jack. “But, I say, it seems that my wish is going to be granted, for here comes a breeze. Ship your oar, Peterkin. Up with the mast, Ralph; I’ll see to the sail. Mind your helm; look out for squalls!”

“Or drill a hole through a shark’s tail and thread a rope through it, right?” said Jack. “But hey, it looks like my wish is coming true, because here comes a breeze. Stow your oar, Peterkin. Raise the mast, Ralph; I’ll handle the sail. Watch your course; keep an eye out for squalls!”

This last speech was caused by the sudden appearance of a dark blue line on the horizon, which, in an incredibly short space of time, swept down on us, lashing up the sea in white foam as it went. We presented the stern of the boat to its first violence, and, in a few seconds, it moderated into a steady breeze, to which we spread our sail and flew merrily over the waves. Although the breeze died away soon afterwards, it had been so stiff while it lasted, that we were carried over the greater part of our way before it fell calm again; so that, when the flapping of the sail against the mast told us that it was time to resume the oars, we were not much more than a mile from Penguin Island.

This last speech was triggered by the sudden appearance of a dark blue line on the horizon, which quickly rushed towards us, whipping up the sea into white foam as it approached. We turned the stern of the boat into its first onslaught, and within seconds, it eased into a steady breeze, which we took advantage of by spreading our sail and happily skimming over the waves. Although the breeze faded soon after, it had been strong enough while it lasted that we made it most of the way before it calmed down again; so when the sail started flapping against the mast, signaling that it was time to pick up the oars, we were just about a mile away from Penguin Island.

“There go the soldiers!” cried Peterkin as we came in sight of it; “how spruce their white trousers look, this morning! I wonder if they will receive us kindly. D’you think they are hospitable, Jack?”

“There go the soldiers!” Peterkin shouted as we caught sight of them. “Their white trousers look sharp this morning! I wonder if they’ll welcome us warmly. Do you think they’re friendly, Jack?”

“Don’t talk, Peterkin, but pull away, and you shall see shortly.”

“Don’t talk, Peterkin, just pull away, and you’ll see soon.”

As we drew near to the island we were much amused by the manoeuvres and appearance of these strange birds. They seemed to be of different species, for some had crests on their heads while others had none, and while some were about the size of a goose others appeared nearly as large as a swan. We also saw a huge albatross soaring above the heads of the penguins. It was followed and surrounded by numerous flocks of sea-gulls. Having approached to within a few yards of the island, which was a low rock, with no other vegetation on it than a few bushes, we lay on our oars and gazed at the birds with surprise and pleasure, they returning our gaze with interest. We now saw that their soldier-like appearance was owing to the stiff, erect manner in which they sat on their short legs,—“Bolt-up-right,” as Peterkin expressed it. They had black heads, long sharp beaks, white breasts, and bluish backs. Their wings were so short that they looked more like the fins of a fish, and, indeed, we soon saw that they used them for the purpose of swimming under water. There were no quills on these wings, but a sort of scaly feathers; which also thickly covered their bodies. Their legs were short, and placed so far back that the birds, while on land, were obliged to stand quite upright in order to keep their balance; but in the water they floated like other water-fowl. At first we were so stunned with the clamour which they and other sea-birds kept up around us, that we knew not which way to look,—for they covered the rocks in thousands; but, as we continued to gaze, we observed several quadrupeds (as we thought) walking in the midst of the penguins.

As we got closer to the island, we found the actions and appearance of these unusual birds quite entertaining. They seemed to be different species; some had crests on their heads while others did not, and while some were about the size of a goose, others looked almost as big as a swan. We also spotted a giant albatross soaring above the penguins, followed and surrounded by numerous flocks of seagulls. After approaching within a few yards of the island, which was a low rock with nothing but a few bushes on it, we paused and watched the birds with surprise and joy, and they looked back at us with curiosity. We then noticed that their soldier-like stance was due to the stiff, upright way they sat on their short legs—“Bolt-up-right,” as Peterkin put it. They had black heads, long sharp beaks, white chests, and bluish backs. Their wings were so short that they resembled fish fins, and we soon realized they used them for swimming underwater. There were no quills on these wings, just a kind of scaly feathers that also covered their bodies thickly. Their legs were short and positioned so far back that the birds had to stand almost upright on land to maintain their balance; however, in the water, they floated like other waterfowl. At first, we were so overwhelmed by the noise from them and other seabirds surrounding us that we didn’t know where to look, as they covered the rocks in thousands. But as we kept watching, we noticed several quadrupeds (or so we thought) walking among the penguins.

“Pull in a bit,” cried Peterkin, “and let’s see what these are. They must be fond of noisy company, to consort with such creatures.”

“Pull in a bit,” shouted Peterkin, “and let’s see what these are. They must like noisy company to be hanging out with such creatures.”

To our surprise we found that these were no other than penguins which had gone down on all fours, and were crawling among the bushes on their feet and wings, just like quadrupeds. Suddenly one big old bird, that had been sitting on a point very near to us, gazing in mute astonishment, became alarmed, and, scuttling down the rocks, plumped or fell, rather than ran, into the sea. It dived in a moment, and, a few seconds afterwards, came out of the water far a-head, with such a spring, and such a dive back into the sea again, that we could scarcely believe it was not a fish that had leaped in sport.

To our surprise, we discovered that these were actually penguins, which had dropped down on all fours and were crawling through the bushes on their feet and wings, just like four-legged animals. Suddenly, one large old bird, which had been sitting on a nearby rock, staring at us in silent amazement, got startled and hurried down the rocks, plopping—or rather falling—into the sea instead of running. It dove under immediately, and just a few seconds later, it popped out of the water far ahead, with such a leap and such a dive back into the sea that we could hardly believe it wasn’t a fish jumping for fun.

“That beats everything,” said Peterkin, rubbing his nose, and screwing up his face with an expression of exasperated amazement. “I’ve heard of a thing being neither fish, flesh, nor fowl, but I never did expect to live to see a brute that was all three together,—at once—in one! But look there!” he continued, pointing with a look of resignation to the shore, “look there! there’s no end to it. What has that brute got under its tail?”

“That beats everything,” said Peterkin, rubbing his nose and scrunching his face in exasperated amazement. “I’ve heard of something being neither fish, flesh, nor fowl, but I never expected to see a beast that was all three at once—in one! But look there!” he continued, pointing with a resigned expression at the shore, “look there! there’s no end to it. What does that beast have under its tail?”

We turned to look in the direction pointed out, and there saw a penguin walking slowly and very sedately along the shore with an egg under its tail. There were several others, we observed, burdened in the same way; and we found afterwards that these were a species of penguins that always carried their eggs so. Indeed, they had a most convenient cavity for the purpose, just between the tail and the legs. We were very much impressed with the regularity and order of this colony. The island seemed to be apportioned out into squares, of which each penguin possessed one, and sat in stiff solemnity in the middle of it, or took a slow march up and down the spaces between. Some were hatching their eggs, but others were feeding their young ones in a manner that caused us to laugh not a little. The mother stood on a mound or raised rock, while the young one stood patiently below her on the ground. Suddenly the mother raised her head and uttered a series of the most discordant cackling sounds.

We turned to look where it was pointed out, and there we saw a penguin walking slowly and calmly along the shore with an egg under its tail. We noticed several others carrying eggs in the same way; later, we learned that these were a species of penguins that always did this. They had a really convenient space for it, just between their tail and legs. We were quite impressed with the orderliness of this colony. The island appeared to be divided into squares, with each penguin claiming one and sitting stiffly in the middle of it, or slowly walking back and forth in the spaces between. Some were hatching their eggs, while others were feeding their young ones in a way that made us laugh quite a bit. The mother stood on a mound or raised rock, while the young one stood patiently below her on the ground. Suddenly, the mother lifted her head and let out a series of the most jarring cackling sounds.

“She’s going to choke,” cried Peterkin.

“She’s going to choke,” shouted Peterkin.

But this was not the case, although, I confess, she looked like it. In a few seconds she put down her head and opened her mouth, into which the young one thrust its beak and seemed to suck something from her throat. Then the cackling was renewed, the sucking continued, and so the operation of feeding was carried on till the young one was satisfied; but what she fed her little one with, we could not tell.

But that wasn't really true, even though I admit she looked like it. In just a few seconds, she lowered her head and opened her mouth, into which the young one pecked and seemed to draw something from her throat. Then the cackling started up again, the pecking went on, and this process of feeding continued until the young one was satisfied; but we couldn't figure out what she was feeding her little one.

“Now, just look yonder!” said Peterkin, in an excited tone; “if that isn’t the most abominable piece of maternal deception I ever saw. That rascally old lady penguin has just pitched her young one into the sea, and there’s another about to follow her example.”

“Now, just look over there!” said Peterkin, excitedly; “if that isn’t the most awful act of maternal trickery I’ve ever seen. That sneaky old lady penguin just threw her chick into the sea, and there’s another one about to do the same.”

This indeed seemed to be the cue, for, on the top of a steep rock close to the edge of the sea, we observed an old penguin endeavouring to entice her young one into the water; but the young one seemed very unwilling to go, and, notwithstanding the enticements of its mother, moved very slowly towards her. At last she went gently behind the young bird and pushed it a little towards the water, but with great tenderness, as much as to say, ‘Don’t be afraid, darling! I won’t hurt you, my pet!’ but no sooner did she get it to the edge of the rock, where it stood looking pensively down at the sea, than she gave it a sudden and violent push, sending it headlong down the slope into the water, where its mother left it to scramble ashore as it best could. We observed many of them employed in doing this, and we came to the conclusion that this is the way in which old penguins teach their children to swim.

This really seemed to be the signal, because on top of a steep rock near the sea, we saw an old penguin trying to coax her chick into the water. The chick, however, seemed hesitant to go, and despite its mother's urgings, moved very slowly towards her. Finally, she gently went behind the chick and nudged it a little towards the water, being very careful, as if to say, “Don’t be scared, sweetie! I won’t hurt you, my little one!” But as soon as she got it to the edge of the rock, where it stood staring pensively down at the sea, she gave it a sudden and forceful push, sending it tumbling down the slope into the water, where she left it to scramble onto the shore as best as it could. We saw many penguins doing this and concluded that this is how older penguins teach their young to swim.

Scarcely had we finished making our remarks on this, when we were startled by about a dozen of the old birds hopping in the most clumsy and ludicrous manner towards the sea. The beach, here, was a sloping rock, and when they came to it, some of them succeeded in hopping down in safety, but others lost their balance and rolled and scrambled down the slope in the most helpless manner. The instant they reached the water, however, they seemed to be in their proper element. They dived and bounded out of it and into it again with the utmost agility; and so, diving and bounding and spluttering, for they could not fly, they went rapidly out to sea.

As soon as we finished talking about it, we were surprised by about a dozen of the old birds awkwardly hopping toward the sea. The beach here was a sloped rock, and when they reached it, some managed to hop down safely, while others lost their balance and tumbled down the slope in a pretty helpless way. However, as soon as they hit the water, they seemed to be right where they belonged. They dove in and out with incredible agility; and so, diving, jumping, and spluttering since they couldn’t fly, they quickly made their way out to sea.

On seeing this, Peterkin turned with a grave face to us and said, “It’s my opinion that these birds are all stark, staring mad, and that this is an enchanted island. I therefore propose that we should either put about ship and fly in terror from the spot, or land valorously on the island, and sell our lives as dearly as we can.”

On seeing this, Peterkin turned to us with a serious expression and said, “I think these birds are completely out of their minds, and that we’re on a cursed island. So, I suggest we either turn the ship around and escape in fear, or bravely land on the island and fight for our lives.”

“I vote for landing, so pull in, lads,” said Jack, giving a stroke with his oar that made the boat spin. In a few seconds we ran the boat into a little creek where we made her fast to a projecting piece of coral, and, running up the beach, entered the ranks of the penguins armed with our cudgels and our spear. We were greatly surprised to find that, instead of attacking us or showing signs of fear at our approach, these curious birds did not move from their places until we laid hands on them, and merely turned their eyes on us in solemn, stupid wonder as we passed. There was one old penguin, however, that began to walk slowly toward the sea, and Peterkin took it into his head that he would try to interrupt its progress, so he ran between it and the sea and brandished his cudgel in its face. But this proved to be a resolute old bird. It would not retreat; nay, more, it would not cease to advance, but battled with Peterkin bravely and drove him before it until it reached the sea. Had Peterkin used his club he could easily have felled it, no doubt; but, as he had no wish to do so cruel an act merely out of sport, he let the bird escape.

“I’m voting for landing, so pull in, guys,” said Jack, making a stroke with his oar that spun the boat around. In just a few seconds, we brought the boat into a small creek where we secured it to a sticking-out piece of coral, and, running up the beach, joined the penguins with our clubs and spear. We were really surprised to find that instead of attacking us or showing any fear as we approached, these curious birds stayed right where they were until we touched them, just turning their eyes toward us in solemn, dumbfounded wonder as we walked by. There was one old penguin, though, that started walking slowly toward the sea, and Peterkin decided he would try to block its path, so he ran between it and the ocean and waved his club in its face. But this old bird was determined. It wouldn’t back down; in fact, it kept moving forward, bravely pushing Peterkin back until it reached the sea. If Peterkin had used his club, he could have easily knocked it down, no doubt; but since he didn't want to do something so cruel just for fun, he let the bird go.

We spent fully three hours on this island in watching the habits of these curious birds, and, when we finally left them, we all three concluded, after much consultation, that they were the most wonderful creatures we had ever seen; and further, we thought it probable that they were the most wonderful creatures in the world!

We spent a whole three hours on this island observing the behaviors of these fascinating birds, and when we finally left, we all agreed, after a lot of discussion, that they were the most amazing creatures we had ever seen; in fact, we believed they might be the most amazing creatures in the world!

CHAPTER XVIII.

An awful storm and its consequences—Narrow escape—A rock proves a sure foundation—A fearful night and a bright morning—Deliverance from danger.

An awful storm and its aftermath—Narrow escape—A rock proves to be a solid foundation—A terrifying night and a bright morning—Rescue from danger.

It was evening before we left the island of the penguins. As we had made up our minds to encamp for the night on a small island, whereon grew a few cocoa-nut trees, which was about two miles off, we lay to our oars with some energy. But a danger was in store for us which we had not anticipated. The wind, which had carried us so quickly to Penguin Island, freshened as evening drew on, to a stiff breeze, and, before we had made half the distance to the small island, it became a regular gale. Although it was not so directly against us as to prevent our rowing in the course we wished to go, yet it checked us very much; and although the force of the sea was somewhat broken by the island, the waves soon began to rise, and to roll their broken crests against our small craft, so that she began to take in water, and we had much ado to keep ourselves afloat. At last the wind and sea together became so violent that we found it impossible to make the island, so Jack suddenly put the head of the boat round and ordered Peterkin and me to hoist a corner of the sail, intending to run back to Penguin Island.

It was evening when we finally left the island of the penguins. Since we had decided to set up camp for the night on a small island with a few coconut trees about two miles away, we got to work with our oars. But a danger was waiting for us that we hadn’t expected. As evening approached, the wind that had propelled us swiftly to Penguin Island intensified into a strong breeze, and before we had covered half the distance to the small island, it escalated into a full-blown gale. Although the wind wasn't directly against us enough to stop our progress, it really slowed us down; and even though the island protected us somewhat from the force of the sea, the waves started to rise and crash over our small boat, causing her to take on water, and we struggled to stay afloat. Eventually, the wind and sea became so fierce that reaching the island seemed impossible, so Jack abruptly turned the boat around and told Peterkin and me to hoist a corner of the sail, planning to head back to Penguin Island.

“We shall at least have the shelter of the bushes,” he said, as the boat flew before the wind, “and the penguins will keep us company.”

“We’ll at least have the shelter of the bushes,” he said, as the boat raced with the wind, “and the penguins will keep us company.”

As Jack spoke, the wind suddenly shifted, and blew so much against us that we were forced to hoist more of the sail in order to beat up for the island, being by this change thrown much to leeward of it. What made matters worse was, that the gale came in squalls, so that we were more than once nearly upset.

As Jack talked, the wind suddenly changed direction, blowing hard against us, forcing us to raise more of the sail to head toward the island, as we had been pushed much farther off course. To make things worse, the strong wind came in bursts, and we were almost capsized more than once.

“Stand by, both of you,” cried Jack, in a quick, earnest tone; “be ready to dowse the sail. I very much fear we won’t make the island after all.”

“Hang on, both of you,” shouted Jack urgently; “get ready to douse the sail. I really fear we won’t reach the island after all.”

Peterkin and I were so much in the habit of trusting everything to Jack that we had fallen into the way of not considering things, especially such things as were under Jack’s care. We had, therefore, never doubted for a moment that all was going well, so that it was with no little anxiety that we heard him make the above remark. However, we had no time for question or surmise, for, at the moment he spoke, a heavy squall was bearing down upon us, and, as we were then flying with our lee gunwale dipping occasionally under the waves, it was evident that we should have to lower our sail altogether. In a few seconds the squall struck the boat, but Peterkin and I had the sail down in a moment, so that it did not upset us; but, when it was past, we were more than half full of water. This I soon baled out, while Peterkin again hoisted a corner of the sail; but the evil which Jack had feared came upon us. We found it quite impossible to make Penguin Island. The gale carried us quickly past it towards the open sea, and the terrible truth flashed upon us that we should be swept out and left to perish miserably in a small boat in the midst of the wide ocean.

Peterkin and I were so used to relying on Jack for everything that we didn’t really think about things, especially those that were under his responsibility. So, we never doubted for a second that everything was okay, which made us anxious when we heard him make that remark. However, we didn’t have time to ask questions or make guesses because, at that moment, a heavy squall was approaching, and since we were flying along with our leeward gunwale occasionally dipping under the waves, it was clear that we would have to lower our sail completely. Just seconds after the squall hit the boat, Peterkin and I quickly got the sail down, preventing us from capsizing; but once it passed, we found ourselves more than half full of water. I quickly bailed out the water while Peterkin hoisted a corner of the sail again, but the disaster Jack had feared became a reality. We realized it was impossible to reach Penguin Island. The gale pushed us rapidly past it into the open sea, and the horrifying truth dawned on us: we would be swept away and left to perish in a small boat in the vast ocean.

This idea was forced very strongly upon us because we saw nothing in the direction whither the wind was blowing us save the raging billows of the sea; and, indeed, we trembled as we gazed around us, for we were now beyond the shelter of the islands, and it seemed as though any of the huge billows, which curled over in masses of foam, might swallow us up in a moment. The water, also, began to wash in over our sides, and I had to keep constantly baling, for Jack could not quit the helm nor Peterkin the sail for an instant, without endangering our lives. In the midst of this distress Jack uttered an exclamation of hope, and pointed towards a low island or rock which lay directly ahead. It had been hitherto unobserved, owing to the dark clouds that obscured the sky and the blinding spray that seemed to fill the whole atmosphere.

This idea was strongly imposed on us because we saw nothing in the direction the wind was taking us except the crashing waves of the sea; and, in fact, we shook with fear as we looked around, for we were now beyond the protection of the islands, and it felt like any of the massive waves, which curled over in foamy masses, could swallow us whole at any moment. The water also started washing over our sides, and I had to keep bailing constantly, as Jack couldn't leave the helm nor could Peterkin abandon the sail for even a second without putting our lives at risk. In the midst of this turmoil, Jack shouted out in hope and pointed towards a low island or rock that lay straight ahead. We hadn’t noticed it before because of the dark clouds that covered the sky and the blinding spray that seemed to fill the entire atmosphere.

As we neared this rock we observed that it was quite destitute of trees and verdure, and so low that the sea broke completely over it. In fact it was nothing more than the summit of one of the coral formations, which rose only a few feet above the level of the water, and was, in stormy weather, all but invisible. Over this island the waves were breaking in the utmost fury, and our hearts sank within us as we saw that there was not a spot where we could thrust our little boat without its being dashed to pieces.

As we got closer to the rock, we noticed it was completely bare of trees and greenery, and so low that the sea crashed over it entirely. It was basically just the peak of one of the coral formations, rising only a few feet above the water's surface, and in rough weather, it was nearly invisible. The waves were smashing over this island with great force, and we felt a sinking feeling in our chests as we realized there was no place to land our small boat without it being wrecked.

“Show a little bit more sail,” cried Jack, as we swept past the weather side of the rock with fearful speed.

“Show a little more sail,” shouted Jack, as we rushed past the windward side of the rock at a terrifying speed.

“Ay, ay,” answered Peterkin, hoisting about a foot more of our sail.

“Ay, ay,” replied Peterkin, adjusting the sail by about a foot.

Little though the addition was it caused the boat to lie over and creak so loudly, as we cleft the foaming waves, that I expected to be upset every instant; and I blamed Jack in my heart for his rashness. But I did him injustice, for, although during two seconds the water rushed in-board in a torrent, he succeeded in steering us sharply round to the leeward side of the rock, where the water was comparatively calm, and the force of the breeze broken.

Though it was a small addition, it made the boat tilt and creak so loudly as we sliced through the foamy waves that I expected we'd capsize at any moment; I secretly blamed Jack for his reckless decision. But I was being unfair to him, because even though for a couple of seconds water flooded into the boat, he managed to steer us quickly around to the leeward side of the rock, where the water was relatively calm and the wind was less intense.

“Out your oars now, lads; that’s well done. Give way!” We obeyed instantly. The oars splashed into the waves together. One good hearty pull, and we were floating in a comparatively calm creek that was so narrow as to be barely able to admit our boat. Here we were in perfect safety, and, as we leaped on shore and fastened our cable to the rocks, I thanked God in my heart for our deliverance from so great danger. But, although I have said we were now in safety, I suspect that few of my readers would have envied our position. It is true we had no lack of food, but we were drenched to the skin; the sea was foaming round us and the spray flying over our heads, so that we were completely enveloped, as it were, in water; the spot on which we had landed was not more than twelve yards in diameter, and from this spot we could not move without the risk of being swept away by the storm. At the upper end of the creek was a small hollow or cave in the rock, which sheltered us from the fury of the winds and waves; and as the rock extended in a sort of ledge over our heads, it prevented the spray from falling upon us.

“Out with your oars now, guys; that’s well done. Let’s go!” We jumped to action immediately. The oars splashed into the waves in unison. With one strong pull, we were floating in a relatively calm creek that was so narrow it barely fit our boat. We were safe here, and as we jumped ashore and tied our cable to the rocks, I quietly thanked God for our escape from such great danger. However, even though I’ve said we were safe now, I doubt many of my readers would have envied our situation. It’s true we had plenty of food, but we were soaked to the bone; the sea was churning around us and the spray was flying over our heads, completely drenching us; the spot where we landed was no more than twelve yards across, and we couldn’t move from there without risking being swept away by the storm. At the upper end of the creek was a small hollow or cave in the rock, which protected us from the rage of the winds and waves; and since the rock extended in a sort of ledge above us, it kept the spray from falling on us.

“Why,” said Peterkin, beginning to feel cheery again, “it seems to me that we have got into a mermaid’s cave, for there is nothing but water all round us; and as for earth or sky, they are things of the past.”

“Why,” said Peterkin, starting to feel cheerful again, “it looks to me like we’ve entered a mermaid’s cave, since it’s just water all around us; and as for land or sky, they’re things of the past.”

Peterkin’s idea was not inappropriate, for, what with the sea roaring in white foam up to our very feet, and the spray flying in white sheets continually over our heads, and the water dripping heavily from the ledge above like a curtain in front of our cave, it did seem to us very much more like being below than above water.

Peterkin's idea wasn't entirely off-base. With the sea crashing in white foam right at our feet, the spray continually flying over our heads in big sheets, and the water dripping heavily from the ledge above like a curtain in front of our cave, it really felt much more like being below the water than above it.

“Now, boys,” cried Jack, “bestir yourselves, and let’s make ourselves comfortable. Toss out our provisions, Peterkin; and here, Ralph, lend a hand to haul up the boat. Look sharp.”

“Alright, guys,” shouted Jack, “let’s get moving and make ourselves comfortable. Throw out our supplies, Peterkin; and here, Ralph, help pull up the boat. Let’s go.”

“Ay, ay, captain,” we cried, as we hastened to obey, much cheered by the hearty manner of our comrade.

“Sure thing, captain,” we shouted, as we rushed to comply, feeling encouraged by our friend's enthusiastic demeanor.

Fortunately the cave, although not very deep, was quite dry, so that we succeeded in making ourselves much more comfortable than could have been expected. We landed our provisions, wrung the water out of our garments, spread our sail below us for a carpet, and, after having eaten a hearty meal, began to feel quite cheerful. But as night drew on, our spirits sank again, for with the daylight all evidence of our security vanished away. We could no longer see the firm rock on which we lay, while we were stunned with the violence of the tempest that raged around us. The night grew pitchy dark, as it advanced, so that we could not see our hands when we held them up before our eyes, and were obliged to feel each other occasionally to make sure that we were safe, for the storm at last became so terrible that it was difficult to make our voices audible. A slight variation of the wind, as we supposed, caused a few drops of spray ever and anon to blow into our faces; and the eddy of the sea, in its mad boiling, washed up into our little creek until it reached our feet and threatened to tear away our boat. In order to prevent this latter calamity, we hauled the boat farther up and held the cable in our hands. Occasional flashes of lightning shone with a ghastly glare through the watery curtains around us, and lent additional horror to the scene. Yet we longed for those dismal flashes, for they were less appalling than the thick blackness that succeeded them. Crashing peals of thunder seemed to tear the skies in twain, and fell upon our ears through the wild yelling of the hurricane as if it had been but a gentle summer breeze; while the billows burst upon the weather side of the island until we fancied that the solid rock was giving way, and, in our agony, we clung to the bare ground, expecting every moment to be whirled away and whelmed in the black howling sea! Oh! it was a night of terrible anxiety, and no one can conceive the feelings of intense gratitude and relief with which we at last saw the dawn of day break through the vapory mists around us.

Fortunately, the cave, while not very deep, was pretty dry, so we were able to make ourselves much more comfortable than we expected. We unloaded our supplies, wrung the water out of our clothes, spread our sail on the ground as a carpet, and after having a hearty meal, started to feel quite cheerful. But as night approached, our spirits sank again because, with the daylight, all signs of our safety disappeared. We could no longer see the solid rock beneath us, and we were overwhelmed by the violent storm raging around us. The night grew pitch black, and we couldn’t see our hands when we held them up in front of our faces, feeling the need to touch each other occasionally to ensure we were safe. The storm had become so fierce that it was hard to hear ourselves over the noise. A slight change in the wind caused a few drops of spray to occasionally hit our faces, and the turbulent sea surged into our little cove, reaching our feet and threatening to drag our boat away. To prevent this disaster, we pulled the boat further up and held onto the rope tightly. Occasional flashes of lightning illuminated the dark rain around us, adding to the horror of the situation. Yet, we craved those eerie flashes because they were less frightening than the deep darkness that followed. Thunder cracked across the sky, making it sound as if the heavens were splitting apart, all while the hurricane howled as if it were merely a gentle summer breeze. Waves crashed against the exposed side of the island until we feared that the solid rock would give way, and in our panic, we clung to the ground, expecting to be swept away into the dark, raging sea at any moment! Oh, it was a night full of terror, and no one can truly understand the intense gratitude and relief we felt when we finally saw the dawn breaking through the mist around us.

For three days and three nights we remained on this rock, while the storm continued to rage with unabated fury. On the morning of the fourth day it suddenly ceased, and the wind fell altogether; but the waves still ran so high that we did not dare to put off in our boat. During the greater part of this period we scarcely slept above a few minutes at a time, but on the third night we slept soundly and awoke early on the fourth morning to find the sea very much down, and the sun shining brightly again in the clear blue sky.

For three days and nights, we stayed on this rock while the storm kept raging fiercely. On the morning of the fourth day, it suddenly stopped, and the wind died down completely; but the waves were still so high that we didn’t dare to launch our boat. During most of this time, we barely slept for more than a few minutes at a time, but on the third night, we slept soundly and woke up early on the fourth morning to find the sea much calmer and the sun shining brightly again in the clear blue sky.

It was with light hearts that we launched forth once more in our little boat and steered away for our island home, which, we were overjoyed to find, was quite visible on the horizon, for we had feared that we had been blown out of sight of it altogether. As it was a dead calm we had to row during the greater part of the day; but towards the afternoon a fair breeze sprang up, which enabled us to hoist our sail. We soon passed Penguin Island, and the other island which we had failed to reach on the day the storm commenced; but as we had still enough of provisions, and were anxious to get home, we did not land, to the great disappointment of Peterkin, who seemed to entertain quite an affection for the penguins.

We set off once again in our little boat, feeling lighthearted, and happily noticed our island home clearly visible on the horizon. We had worried we might have been blown out of sight altogether. Since it was completely calm, we had to row for most of the day; but in the afternoon, a nice breeze picked up, allowing us to raise our sail. We quickly passed Penguin Island and the other island we hadn't reached the day the storm began. However, since we still had enough supplies and were eager to get home, we didn’t stop, much to Peterkin's disappointment, as he seemed quite fond of the penguins.

Although the breeze was pretty fresh for several hours, we did not reach the outer reef of our island till night-fall, and before we had sailed more than a hundred yards into the lagoon, the wind died away altogether, so that we had to take to our oars again. It was late and the moon and stars were shining brightly when we arrived opposite the bower and leaped upon the strand. So glad were we to be safe back again on our beloved island, that we scarcely took time to drag the boat a short way up the beach, and then ran up to see that all was right at the bower. I must confess, however, that my joy was mingled with a vague sort of fear lest our home had been visited and destroyed during our absence; but on reaching it we found everything just as it had been left, and the poor black cat curled up, sound asleep, on the coral table in front of our humble dwelling.

Even though the breeze was pretty strong for several hours, we didn’t get to the outer reef of our island until nightfall. Before we had sailed more than a hundred yards into the lagoon, the wind completely died down, forcing us to use our oars again. It was late, and the moon and stars were shining brightly when we arrived at the bower and jumped onto the shore. We were so happy to be safely back on our beloved island that we hardly took the time to pull the boat a little way up the beach before rushing to check if everything was okay at the bower. I have to admit, though, that my happiness was mixed with a vague fear that our home might have been visited and damaged while we were gone; but when we got there, we found everything just as we had left it, and the poor black cat was curled up, sound asleep on the coral table in front of our humble home.

CHAPTER XIX.

Shoemaking—The even tenor of our way suddenly interrupted—An unexpected visit and an appalling battle—We all become warriors, and Jack proves himself be a hero.

Shoemaking—Our routine was suddenly interrupted—An unexpected visit and a shocking battle—We all turned into warriors, and Jack showed himself to be a hero.

For many months after this we continued to live on our island in uninterrupted harmony and happiness. Sometimes we went out a-fishing in the lagoon, and sometimes went a-hunting in the woods, or ascended to the mountain top, by way of variety, although Peterkin always asserted that we went for the purpose of hailing any ship that might chance to heave in sight. But I am certain that none of us wished to be delivered from our captivity, for we were extremely happy, and Peterkin used to say that as we were very young we should not feel the loss of a year or two. Peterkin, as I have said before, was thirteen years of age, Jack eighteen, and I fifteen. But Jack was very tall, strong, and manly for his age, and might easily have been mistaken for twenty.

For many months after this, we continued to live on our island in uninterrupted harmony and happiness. Sometimes we went fishing in the lagoon, and sometimes we hunted in the woods, or climbed to the mountain top for variety, although Peterkin always claimed we went to signal any ship that might happen to appear. But I’m sure none of us wanted to escape our situation, because we were extremely happy, and Peterkin would say that since we were so young, we wouldn’t miss a year or two. As I mentioned before, Peterkin was thirteen, Jack was eighteen, and I was fifteen. But Jack was very tall, strong, and mature for his age, and could easily have been mistaken for twenty.

The climate was so beautiful that it seemed to be a perpetual summer, and as many of the fruit-trees continued to bear fruit and blossom all the year round, we never wanted for a plentiful supply of food. The hogs, too, seemed rather to increase than diminish, although Peterkin was very frequent in his attacks on them with his spear. If at any time we failed in finding a drove, we had only to pay a visit to the plum-tree before mentioned, where we always found a large family of them asleep under its branches.

The weather was so nice that it felt like it was always summer, and since many of the fruit trees kept producing fruit and blooming all year long, we never ran out of food. The pigs also seemed to multiply instead of decrease, even though Peterkin often tried to hunt them with his spear. Whenever we couldn't find a group of them, we just had to go to the plum tree mentioned earlier, where we always found a big family of them sleeping under its branches.

We employed ourselves very busily during this time in making various garments of cocoa-nut cloth, as those with which we had landed were beginning to be very ragged. Peterkin also succeeded in making excellent shoes out of the skin of the old hog, in the following manner:—He first cut a piece of the hide, of an oblong form, a few inches longer than his foot. This he soaked in water, and, while it was wet, he sewed up one end of it, so as to form a rough imitation of that part of the heel of a shoe where the seam is. This done, he bored a row of holes all round the edge of the piece of skin, through which a tough line was passed. Into the sewed-up part of this shoe he thrust his heel, then, drawing the string tight, the edges rose up and overlapped his foot all round. It is true there were a great many ill-looking puckers in these shoes, but we found them very serviceable notwithstanding, and Jack came at last to prefer them to his long boots. We ago made various other useful articles, which added to our comfort, and once or twice spoke of building us a house, but we had so great an affection for the bower, and, withal, found it so serviceable, that we determined not to leave it, nor to attempt the building of a house, which, in such a climate, might turn out to be rather disagreeable than useful.

We kept ourselves busy during this time making various clothes out of coconut fabric, since the ones we had arrived in were starting to get pretty tattered. Peterkin also managed to make some great shoes from the skin of the old pig by doing the following: He first cut a piece of the hide into an oblong shape, a few inches longer than his foot. He soaked it in water and, while it was wet, stitched up one end to create a rough version of the heel seam of a shoe. Once that was done, he punched a row of holes around the edge of the skin piece and threaded a tough line through them. He shoved his heel into the sewn-up part of the shoe, and then, pulling the string tight, the edges curled up and overlapped his foot. It's true there were a lot of unsightly puckers in these shoes, but we found them really useful anyway, and eventually Jack came to prefer them over his long boots. We also made other handy items that improved our comfort, and we talked a couple of times about building a house, but we were so fond of the bower and found it so practical that we decided not to leave it or try to build a house, which might end up being more unpleasant than useful in such a climate.

We often examined the pistol that we had found in the house on the other side of the island, and Peterkin wished much that we had powder and shot, as it would render pig-killing much easier; but, after all, we had become so expert in the use of our sling and bow and spear, that we were independent of more deadly weapons.

We often looked at the pistol we found in the house on the other side of the island, and Peterkin really wished we had some gunpowder and bullets because it would make killing pigs a lot easier. But, in the end, we had become so skilled with our sling, bow, and spear that we didn’t really need more dangerous weapons.

Diving in the Water Garden also continued to afford us as much pleasure as ever; and Peterkin began to be a little more expert in the water from constant practice. As for Jack and I, we began to feel as if water were our native element, and revelled in it with so much confidence and comfort that Peterkin said he feared we would turn into fish some day, and swim off and leave him; adding, that he had been for a long time observing that Jack was becoming more and more like a shark every day. Whereupon Jack remarked, that if he, Peterkin, were changed into a fish, he would certainly turn into nothing better or bigger than a shrimp. Poor Peterkin did not envy us our delightful excursions under water, except, indeed, when Jack would dive down to the bottom of the Water Garden, sit down on a rock and look up and make faces at him. Peterkin did feel envious then, and often said he would give anything to be able to do that. I was much amused when Peterkin said this; for if he could only have seen his own face when he happened to take a short dive, he would have seen that Jack’s was far surpassed by it. The great difference being, however, that Jack made faces on purpose—Peterkin couldn’t help it!

Diving in the Water Garden continued to bring us as much joy as ever, and Peterkin started to get a bit better in the water from all the practice. As for Jack and me, we began to feel like water was our true element, enjoying it with so much confidence and comfort that Peterkin joked he was worried we’d turn into fish one day and swim off, leaving him behind. He added that he had noticed Jack becoming more and more like a shark every day. Jack replied that if Peterkin were turned into a fish, he would definitely be nothing better or bigger than a shrimp. Poor Peterkin didn’t envy us our fun underwater adventures, except when Jack would dive to the bottom of the Water Garden, sit on a rock, and make faces at him. That was when Peterkin felt envious and often said he would give anything to be able to do that. I found it very amusing when Peterkin said this; if only he could have seen his own face when he took a quick dive, he would have realized that Jack’s face was far outshone by his. The big difference, though, was that Jack made faces on purpose—Peterkin couldn’t help it!

Now, while we were engaged with these occupations and amusements, an event occurred one day which was as unexpected as it was exceedingly alarming and very horrible.

Now, while we were caught up in these activities and distractions, an event happened one day that was as unexpected as it was extremely frightening and truly terrible.

Jack and I were sitting, as we were often wont to do, on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, and Peterkin was wringing the water from his garments, having recently fallen by accident into the sea,—a thing he was constantly doing,—when our attention was suddenly arrested by two objects which appeared on the horizon.

Jack and I were sitting, as we often did, on the rocks at Spouting Cliff, and Peterkin was wringing out his clothes after accidentally falling into the sea—a thing he did all the time—when our attention was suddenly caught by two objects that appeared on the horizon.

“What are yon, think you?” I said, addressing Jack.

“What do you think those are?” I asked, looking at Jack.

“I can’t imagine,” answered he; “I’ve noticed them for some time, and fancied they were black sea-gulls, but the more I look at them the more I feel convinced they are much larger than gulls.”

“I can’t imagine,” he replied; “I’ve been watching them for a while and thought they were black seagulls, but the more I look at them, the more I’m convinced they are much bigger than gulls.”

“They seem to be coming towards us,” said I.

"They look like they're coming toward us," I said.

“Hallo! what’s wrong?” inquired Peterkin, coming up.

“Hey! What’s wrong?” Peterkin asked, approaching.

“Look there,” said Jack.

"Check that out," said Jack.

“Whales!” cried Peterkin, shading his eyes with his hand. “No! eh! can they be boats, Jack?”

“Whales!” shouted Peterkin, shielding his eyes with his hand. “No! Wait, could those be boats, Jack?”

Our hearts beat with excitement at the very thought of seeing human faces again.

Our hearts race with excitement at the mere thought of seeing human faces again.

“I think you are about right, Peterkin;—but they seem to me to move strangely for boats,” said Jack, in a low tone, as if he were talking to himself.

“I think you’re about right, Peterkin;—but they seem to move strangely for boats,” said Jack, in a quiet voice, as if he were thinking out loud.

I noticed that a shade of anxiety crossed Jack’s countenance as he gazed long and intently at the two objects, which were now nearing us fast. At last he sprang to his feet. “They are canoes, Ralph! whether war-canoes or not I cannot tell, but this I know, that all the natives of the South Sea Islands are fierce cannibals, and they have little respect for strangers. We must hide if they land here, which I earnestly hope they will not do.”

I saw a hint of anxiety on Jack’s face as he looked closely at the two objects that were quickly approaching us. Finally, he jumped to his feet. “They’re canoes, Ralph! I can’t tell if they’re for war or not, but I do know that all the natives of the South Sea Islands are fierce cannibals, and they don’t respect strangers at all. We need to hide if they come ashore here, which I really hope they won’t.”

I was greatly alarmed at Jack’s speech, but I confess I thought less of what he said than of the earnest, anxious manner in which he said it, and it was with very uncomfortable feelings that Peterkin and I followed him quickly into the woods.

I was really worried by Jack’s speech, but honestly, I focused more on the serious, concerned way he delivered it than on the actual words he used. Peterkin and I followed him into the woods quickly, feeling very uneasy.

“How unfortunate,” said I, as we gained the shelter of the bushes, “that we have forgotten our arms.”

“How unfortunate,” I said, as we reached the shelter of the bushes, “that we forgot our weapons.”

“It matters not,” said Jack; “here are clubs enough and to spare.” As he spoke, he laid his hand on a bundle of stout poles of various sizes, which Peterkin’s ever-busy hands had formed, during our frequent visits to the cliff, for no other purpose, apparently, than that of having something to do.

“It doesn’t matter,” said Jack; “we have plenty of clubs.” As he spoke, he placed his hand on a bundle of sturdy poles of different sizes, which Peterkin’s always-busy hands had created during our many trips to the cliff, seemingly just to keep himself occupied.

We each selected a stout club according to our several tastes, and lay down behind a rock, whence we could see the canoes approach, without ourselves being seen. At first we made an occasional remark on their appearance, but after they entered the lagoon, and drew near the beach, we ceased to speak, and gazed with intense interest at the scene before us.

We each picked a sturdy club based on our personal preferences and laid down behind a rock, from which we could watch the canoes come in without being noticed ourselves. At first, we commented on how they looked, but once they entered the lagoon and got closer to the beach, we stopped talking and stared with intense interest at the scene in front of us.

We now observed that the foremost canoe was being chased by the other, and that it contained a few women and children, as well as men,—perhaps forty souls altogether; while the canoe which pursued it contained only men. They seemed to be about the same in number, but were better armed, and had the appearance of being a war party. Both crews were paddling with all their might, and it seemed as if the pursuers exerted themselves to overtake the natives ere they could land. In this, however, they failed. The foremost canoe made for the beach close beneath the rocks behind which we were concealed. Their short paddles flashed like meteors in the water, and sent up a constant shower of spray. The foam curled from the prow, and the eyes of the rowers glistened in their black faces as they strained every muscle of their naked bodies; nor did they relax their efforts till the canoe struck the beach with a violent shock; then, with a shout of defiance, the whole party sprang, as if by magic, from the canoe to the shore. Three women, two of whom carried infants in their arms, rushed into the woods; and the men crowded to the water’s edge, with stones in their hands, spears levelled, and clubs brandished, to resist the landing of their enemies.

We saw that the first canoe was being chased by the other, which held a few women and children, along with men—maybe about forty people in total; while the pursuing canoe had only men. They seemed to be roughly the same in number but were better armed and looked like a war party. Both crews were paddling as hard as they could, and it appeared that the pursuers were trying to catch up to the natives before they reached the shore. However, they did not succeed. The first canoe aimed for the beach right beneath the rocks where we were hiding. Their short paddles splashed in the water like meteors, creating a constant spray. The foam curled from the front of the canoe, and the rowers' eyes sparkled on their dark faces as they strained every muscle of their bare bodies; they didn’t ease up until the canoe hit the beach with a loud thud; then, with a shout of defiance, everyone jumped from the canoe to the shore as if by magic. Three women, two of whom were holding infants, dashed into the woods; and the men gathered at the water’s edge, armed with stones, spears aimed, and clubs raised, ready to fend off their attackers.

The distance between the two canoes had been about half a mile, and, at the great speed they were going, this was soon passed. As the pursuers neared the shore, no sign of fear or hesitation was noticeable. On they came like a wild charger,—received but recked not of a shower of stones. The canoe struck, and, with a yell that seemed to issue from the throats of incarnate fiends, they leaped into the water, and drove their enemies up the beach.

The distance between the two canoes was about half a mile, and at the speed they were going, that distance was quickly closed. As the pursuers got closer to the shore, there was no sign of fear or hesitation. They charged ahead like a wild horse—unfazed by the rain of stones. The canoe hit the shore, and with a yell that sounded like it came from the mouths of demons, they jumped into the water and forced their enemies up the beach.

The battle that immediately ensued was frightful to behold. Most of the men wielded clubs of enormous size and curious shapes, with which they dashed out each other’s brains. As they were almost entirely naked, and had to bound, stoop, leap, and run, in their terrible hand-to-hand encounters, they looked more like demons than human beings. I felt my heart grow sick at the sight of this bloody battle, and would fain have turned away, but a species of fascination seemed to hold me down and glue my eyes upon the combatants. I observed that the attacking party was led by a most extraordinary being, who, from his size and peculiarity, I concluded was a chief. His hair was frizzed out to an enormous extent, so that it resembled a large turban. It was of a light-yellow hue, which surprised me much, for the man’s body was as black as coal, and I felt convinced that the hair must have been dyed. He was tattooed from head to foot; and his face, besides being tattooed, was besmeared with red paint, and streaked with white. Altogether, with his yellow turban-like hair, his Herculean black frame, his glittering eyes and white teeth, he seemed the most terrible monster I ever beheld. He was very active in the fight, and had already killed four men.

The battle that followed was terrifying to see. Most of the men were swinging huge, oddly shaped clubs, smashing each other's heads in. Since they were almost completely naked and had to jump, bend, leap, and run during their brutal close combat, they looked more like monsters than humans. I felt my stomach turn at the sight of this bloody fight, and I wanted to look away, but a strange fascination kept me rooted in place, my gaze fixed on the fighters. I noticed that the attacking group was led by an extraordinary figure, who, because of his size and distinctiveness, I guessed was a chief. His hair was frizzed out to such an extent that it looked like a large turban. It was a light yellow color, which surprised me, since the man’s body was as black as coal, and I was convinced that his hair had to be dyed. He was covered in tattoos from head to toe; in addition to that, his face was not only tattooed but also smeared with red paint and streaked with white. All together, with his yellow turban-like hair, his muscular black body, his shining eyes, and white teeth, he looked like the most frightening monster I had ever seen. He was very active in the fight and had already killed four men.

Suddenly the yellow-haired chief was attacked by a man quite as strong and large as himself. He flourished a heavy club something like an eagle’s beak at the point. For a second or two these giants eyed each other warily, moving round and round, as if to catch each other at a disadvantage, but seeing that nothing was to be gained by this caution, and that the loss of time might effectually turn the tide of battle either way, they apparently made up their minds to attack at the same instant, for, with a wild shout and simultaneous spring, they swung their heavy clubs, which met with a loud report. Suddenly the yellow-haired savage tripped, his enemy sprang forward, the ponderous club was swung, but it did not descend, for at that moment the savage was felled to the ground by a stone from the hand of one who had witnessed his chief’s danger. This was the turning-point in the battle. The savages who landed first turned and fled towards the bush, on seeing the fall of their chief. But not one escaped. They were all overtaken and felled to the earth. I saw, however, that they were not all killed. Indeed, their enemies, now that they were conquered, seemed anxious to take them alive; and they succeeded in securing fifteen, whom they bound hand and foot with cords, and, carrying them up into the woods, laid them down among the bushes. Here they left them, for what purpose I knew not, and returned to the scene of the late battle, where the remnant of the party were bathing their wounds.

Suddenly, the yellow-haired chief was attacked by a man just as strong and big as he was. The attacker waved a heavy club that resembled an eagle’s beak at the end. For a moment, the two giants eyed each other cautiously, circling around as if trying to catch one another off guard, but realizing that this caution was pointless and that wasting time could change the outcome of the battle, they seemed to decide to strike at the same moment. With a wild shout and a simultaneous leap, they swung their heavy clubs, which clashed loudly. Suddenly, the yellow-haired warrior tripped. His enemy lunged forward, swinging the heavy club, but it didn’t come down because at that moment, the warrior was knocked to the ground by a stone thrown by someone who had seen his chief in danger. This was the turning point in the battle. The first group of warriors turned and fled into the brush upon seeing their chief fall. But none of them escaped. They were all caught and knocked down. I noticed, however, that not all of them were killed. In fact, their enemies, now that they had won, seemed eager to capture them alive, and they managed to secure fifteen, binding them hand and foot with cords and carrying them into the woods, where they laid them among the bushes. They left them there for reasons I didn’t know and went back to where the remaining party members were tending to their wounds.

Out of the forty blacks that composed the attacking party, only twenty-eight remained alive, two of whom were sent into the bush to hunt for the women and children. Of the other party, as I have said, only ten survived, and these were lying bound and helpless on the grass.

Out of the forty Black individuals in the attacking group, only twenty-eight were still alive, two of whom were sent into the bush to look for the women and children. As I mentioned, only ten from the other group survived, and they were lying tied up and helpless on the grass.

Jack and Peterkin and I now looked at each other, and whispered our fears that the savages might clamber up the rocks to search for fresh water, and so discover our place of concealment; but we were so much interested in watching their movements that we agreed to remain where we were; and, indeed, we could not easily have risen without exposing ourselves to detection. One of the savages now went up to the wood and soon returned with a bundle of fire-wood, and we were not a little surprised to see him set fire to it by the very same means used by Jack the time we made our first fire,—namely, with the bow and drill. When the fire was kindled, two of the party went again to the woods and returned with one of the bound men. A dreadful feeling of horror crept over my heart, as the thought flashed upon me that they were going to burn their enemies. As they bore him to the fire my feelings almost overpowered me. I gasped for breath, and seizing my club, endeavoured to spring to my feet; but Jack’s powerful arm pinned me to the earth. Next moment one of the savages raised his club, and fractured the wretched creature’s skull. He must have died instantly, and, strange though it may seem, I confess to a feeling of relief when the deed was done, because I now knew that the poor savage could not be burned alive. Scarcely had his limbs ceased to quiver when the monsters cut slices of flesh from his body, and, after roasting them slightly over the fire, devoured them.

Jack, Peterkin, and I looked at each other and whispered our fears that the savages might climb up the rocks to search for fresh water and discover our hiding place. However, we were so focused on watching their movements that we agreed to stay put; besides, it would have been difficult to get up without being seen. One of the savages went to the woods and soon came back with a bundle of firewood, and we were quite surprised to see him ignite it using the same method Jack used when we first made fire—with the bow and drill. Once the fire was lit, two of the group went back to the woods and returned with one of the captured men. A terrible sense of dread filled my heart as it struck me that they were going to burn their enemy. As they carried him to the fire, my emotions nearly overwhelmed me. I gasped for air and grabbed my club, trying to jump to my feet, but Jack’s strong arm held me down. In the next moment, one of the savages raised his club and crushed the poor man's skull. He must have died instantly, and, strange as it may seem, I felt relieved once it was done because now I knew the poor savage wouldn't be burned alive. No sooner had his limbs stopped moving than the monsters sliced pieces of flesh from his body and, after roasting them lightly over the fire, began to eat them.

Suddenly there arose a cry from the woods, and, in a few seconds, the two savages hastened towards the fire dragging the three women and their two infants along with them. One of those women was much younger than her companions, and we were struck with the modesty of her demeanour and the gentle expression of her face, which, although she had the flattish nose and thick lips of the others, was of a light-brown colour, and we conjectured that she must be of a different race. She and her companions wore short petticoats and a kind of tippet on their shoulders. Their hair was jet black, but instead of being long, was short and curly,—though not woolly—somewhat like the hair of a young boy. While we gazed with interest and some anxiety at these poor creatures, the big chief advanced to one of the elder females and laid his hand upon the child. But the mother shrank from him, and clasping the little one to her bosom, uttered a wail of fear. With a savage laugh, the chief tore the child from her arms and tossed it into the sea. A low groan burst from Jack’s lips as we witnessed this atrocious act and heard the mother’s shriek, as she fell insensible on the sand. The rippling waves rolled the child on the beach, as if they refused to be a party in such a foul murder, and we could observe that the little one still lived.

Suddenly, a scream came from the woods, and within moments, the two savages rushed towards the fire, dragging three women and their two infants along with them. One of the women was much younger than her companions, and we were struck by her modest demeanor and the gentle expression on her face. Although she had the flat nose and thick lips of the others, her skin was a light brown color, suggesting she might be from a different background. She and her companions wore short skirts and some sort of shawl on their shoulders. Their hair was jet black but short and curly—not woolly—similar to that of a young boy. As we watched these poor women with both interest and concern, the big chief approached one of the older women and placed his hand on the child. The mother recoiled from him, clutching the little one to her chest and letting out a cry of fear. With a savage laugh, the chief snatched the child from her arms and threw it into the sea. A low groan escaped Jack’s lips as we witnessed this horrific act and heard the mother’s scream as she collapsed, unconscious, on the sand. The gentle waves rolled the child onto the beach, as if they refused to be complicit in such a gruesome murder, and we could see that the little one was still alive.

The young girl was now brought forward, and the chief addressed her; but although we heard his voice, and even the words distinctly, of course we could not understand what he said. The girl made no answer to his fierce questions, and we saw by the way in which he pointed to the fire that he threatened her life.

The young girl was brought forward, and the chief spoke to her; even though we could hear his voice and the words clearly, we obviously couldn't understand what he was saying. The girl didn't respond to his aggressive questions, and we could tell from how he pointed to the fire that he was threatening her life.

“Peterkin,” said Jack in a hoarse whisper, “have you got your knife?”

“Peterkin,” Jack said in a rough whisper, “do you have your knife?”

“Yes,” replied Peterkin, whose face was pale as death.

“Yes,” replied Peterkin, his face as pale as death.

“That will do. Listen to me, and do my bidding quick. Here is the small knife, Ralph. Fly both of you through the bush, cut the cords that bind the prisoners and set them free. There! quick, ere it be too late.” Jack sprang up, and seized a heavy but short bludgeon, while his strong frame trembled with emotion, and large drops rolled down his forehead.

“That’s enough. Listen to me and do what I say quickly. Here’s the small knife, Ralph. Both of you hurry through the bushes, cut the ropes that bind the prisoners, and set them free. Hurry! Before it’s too late.” Jack jumped up and grabbed a heavy but short club, his strong body shaking with emotion as large drops of sweat rolled down his forehead.

At this moment the man who had butchered the savage a few minutes before advanced towards the girl with his heavy club. Jack uttered a yell that rang like a death-shriek among the rocks. With one bound he leaped over a precipice full fifteen feet high, and, before the savages had recovered from their surprise, was in the midst of them; while Peterkin and I dashed through the bushes towards the prisoners. With one blow of his staff Jack felled the man with the club, then, turning round with a look of fury, he rushed upon the big chief with the yellow hair. Had the blow which Jack aimed at his head taken effect, the huge savage would have needed no second stroke; but he was agile as a cat, and avoided it by springing to one side, while, at the same time, he swung his ponderous club at the head of his foe. It was now Jack’s turn to leap aside, and well was it for him that the first outburst of his blind fury was over, else he had become an easy prey to his gigantic antagonist; but Jack was cool now. He darted his blows rapidly and well, and the superiority of his light weapon was strikingly proved in this combat, for while he could easily evade the blows of the chief’s heavy club, the chief could not so easily evade those of his light one. Nevertheless, so quick was he, and so frightfully did he fling about the mighty weapon, that, although Jack struck him almost every blow, the strokes had to be delivered so quickly that they wanted force to be very effectual.

At that moment, the man who had just killed the savage a few minutes earlier approached the girl with his heavy club. Jack let out a scream that echoed like a death cry among the rocks. With one leap, he jumped over a sheer drop of about fifteen feet and, before the savages could regain their composure, found himself among them. Meanwhile, Peterkin and I rushed through the bushes towards the prisoners. With a single swing of his staff, Jack knocked down the man with the club. Then, turning around with a furious expression, he charged at the big chief with the yellow hair. If Jack's blow aimed at the chief's head had landed, the massive savage wouldn't have needed a second hit; however, he was as agile as a cat and avoided it by leaping to the side while simultaneously swinging his heavy club at Jack's head. Now it was Jack’s turn to dodge, and it was lucky for him that the initial surge of his blind rage had passed; otherwise, he would have easily fallen victim to his enormous opponent. But Jack was composed now. He delivered his blows quickly and accurately, and the advantage of his lighter weapon was clearly demonstrated in this fight. While he could easily dodge the chief’s heavy club, the chief had a harder time avoiding the lighter strikes from Jack. Nevertheless, the chief was so fast and wildly swung his massive weapon that, even though Jack managed to hit him almost every time, the rapid nature of the strikes left them lacking the force to be truly effective.

It was lucky for Jack that the other savages considered the success of their chief in this encounter to be so certain that they refrained from interfering. Had they doubted it, they would have probably ended the matter at once by felling him. But they contented themselves with awaiting the issue.

It was fortunate for Jack that the other savages believed their chief's success in this situation was so assured that they decided not to get involved. If they had any doubts, they likely would have ended things right there by taking him down. Instead, they were satisfied to wait and see how it turned out.

The force which the chief expended in wielding his club now began to be apparent. His movements became slower, his breath hissed through his clenched teeth, and the surprised savages drew nearer in order to render assistance. Jack observed this movement. He felt that his fate was sealed, and resolved to cast his life upon the next blow. The chiefs club was again about to descend on his head. He might have evaded it easily, but instead of doing so, he suddenly shortened his grasp of his own club, rushed in under the blow, struck his adversary right between the eyes with all his force and fell to the earth, crushed beneath the senseless body of the chief. A dozen clubs flew high in air ready to descend on the head of Jack, but they hesitated a moment, for the massive body of the chief completely covered him. That moment saved his life. Ere the savages could tear the chief’s body away, seven of their number fell prostrate beneath the clubs of the prisoners whom Peterkin and I had set free, and two others fell under our own hand. We could never have accomplished this had not our enemies been so engrossed with the fight between Jack and their chief that they had failed to observe us until we were upon them. They still out-numbered our party by three, but we were flushed with victory while they were taken by surprise and dispirited by the fall of their chief. Moreover, they were awe-struck by the sweeping fury of Jack, who seemed to have lost his senses altogether, and had no sooner shaken himself free of the chief’s body than he rushed into the midst of them, and in three blows equalized our numbers. Peterkin and I flew to the rescue, the savages followed us, and, in less than ten minutes, the whole of our opponents were knocked down or made prisoners, bound hand and foot, and extended side by side upon the sea shore.

The strength the chief used to swing his club was becoming clear. His movements slowed, his breath hissed through clenched teeth, and the astonished savages moved closer to help him. Jack noticed this shift. He knew his fate was sealed and decided to risk everything on the next blow. The chief's club was about to come down on him again. He could have easily dodged it, but instead, he suddenly shortened his grip on his own club, charged in under the swing, hit the chief square between the eyes with all his might, and collapsed to the ground, pinned under the chief's lifeless body. A dozen clubs flew into the air, ready to hit Jack, but they hesitated for a moment since the chief's heavy body covered him completely. That moment saved his life. Before the savages could pull the chief's body away, seven of them fell to the ground, struck down by the prisoners Peterkin and I had freed, while two others fell at our own hands. We could never have achieved this if our enemies hadn’t been so focused on the fight between Jack and their chief that they didn't notice us until we were right on top of them. They still outnumbered us by three, but we were energized by victory while they were caught off guard and demoralized by the loss of their chief. Plus, they were stunned by Jack's fierce attack, as he seemed completely unhinged. As soon as he freed himself from the chief's body, he charged into the thick of them, and with three blows, he equalized our numbers. Peterkin and I rushed to help, the savages followed us, and in less than ten minutes, all of our opponents were either knocked down or taken prisoner, tied up, and laid out side by side on the beach.

CHAPTER XX.

Intercourse with the savages—Cannibalism prevented—The slain are buried and the survivors depart, leaving us again alone on our Coral Island.

Interacting with the natives—Cannibalism avoided—The deceased are buried and the survivors leave, leaving us alone once more on our Coral Island.

After the battle was over, the savages crowded round us and gazed at us in surprise, while they continued to pour upon us a flood of questions, which, being wholly unintelligible, of course we could not answer. However, by way of putting an end to it, Jack took the chief (who had recovered from the effects of his wound) by the hand and shook it warmly. No sooner did the blacks see that this was meant to express good-will than they shook hands with us all round. After this ceremony was gone through Jack went up to the girl, who had never once moved from the rock where she had been left, but had continued an eager spectator of all that had passed. He made signs to her to follow him and then, taking the chief by the hand, was about to conduct him to the bower when his eye fell on the poor infant which had been thrown into the sea and was still lying on the shore. Dropping the chief’s hand he hastened towards it, and, to his great joy, found it to be still alive. We also found that the mother was beginning to recover slowly.

After the battle was over, the locals gathered around us, looking at us in surprise while bombarding us with a stream of questions that we couldn't understand at all. To wrap it up, Jack took the chief, who had recovered from his injury, by the hand and shook it warmly. As soon as the locals realized this was a gesture of goodwill, they shook hands with all of us in turn. After the handshake, Jack approached the girl, who had stayed by the rock where he left her, eagerly watching everything that had happened. He gestured for her to follow him and then, taking the chief by the hand, was about to lead him to the shelter when he noticed the poor baby that had been tossed into the sea and was still lying on the shore. Letting go of the chief’s hand, he hurried over to it and, to his great relief, found it still alive. We also discovered that the mother was beginning to slowly recover.

“Here, get out o’ the way,” said Jack, pushing us aside, as we stooped over the poor woman and endeavoured to restore her, “I’ll soon bring her round.” So saying, he placed the infant on her bosom and laid its warm cheek on hers. The effect was wonderful. The woman opened her eyes, felt the child, looked at it, and with a cry of joy clasped it in her arms, at the same time endeavouring to rise, for the purpose, apparently, of rushing into the woods.

“Move aside,” said Jack, pushing us out of the way as we leaned over the poor woman, trying to help her, “I’ll get her back on her feet in no time.” With that, he placed the baby on her chest and pressed its warm cheek against hers. The effect was incredible. The woman opened her eyes, felt the child, looked at it, and with a cry of joy, pulled it into her arms while trying to get up, seemingly ready to run into the woods.

“There, that’s all right,” said Jack, once more taking the chief by the hand. “Now Ralph and Peterkin, make the women and these fellows follow me to the bower. Well entertain them as hospitably as we can.”

“There, that’s all good,” said Jack, once again shaking the chief’s hand. “Now Ralph and Peterkin, have the women and these guys follow me to the shelter. Let’s treat them as well as we can.”

In a few minutes the savages were all seated on the ground in front of the bower making a hearty meal off a cold roast pig, several ducks, and a variety of cold fish, together with an unlimited supply of cocoa-nuts, bread-fruits, yams, taro, and plums; with all of which they seemed to be quite familiar and perfectly satisfied.

In a few minutes, the natives were all sitting on the ground in front of the shelter, enjoying a hearty meal of cold roast pig, several ducks, and a variety of cold fish, along with an endless supply of coconuts, breadfruit, yams, taro, and plums; they seemed completely comfortable with all of it and perfectly satisfied.

Meanwhile, we three being thoroughly knocked up with our day’s work, took a good draught of cocoa-nut lemonade, and throwing ourselves on our beds fell fast asleep. The savages it seems followed our example, and in half-an-hour the whole camp was buried in repose.

Meanwhile, the three of us, completely exhausted from our day's work, drank some coconut lemonade and collapsed onto our beds, falling fast asleep. The natives, it seems, followed our lead, and within half an hour, the whole camp was in deep slumber.

How long we slept I cannot tell, but this I know, that when we lay down the sun was setting and when we awoke it was high in the heavens. I awoke Jack, who started up in surprise, being unable at first to comprehend our situation. “Now, then,” said he, springing up, “let’s see after breakfast. Hallo! Peterkin, lazy fellow, how long do you mean to lie there?”

How long we slept, I can't say, but I do know that when we lay down, the sun was setting, and when we woke up, it was high in the sky. I woke Jack, who jumped up in surprise, unable at first to understand our situation. "Alright then," he said, springing up, "let's go get breakfast. Hey! Peterkin, you lazy guy, how long are you going to lie there?"

Peterkin yawned heavily. “Well!” said he, opening his eyes and looking up after some trouble, “if it isn’t to-morrow morning, and me thinking it was to-day all this time. Hallo! Venus, where did you come from? you seem tolerably at home, any how. Bah! might as well speak to the cat as to you—better, in fact, for it understands me, and you don’t.”

Peterkin yawned widely. “Well!” he said, opening his eyes and looking up with some effort, “if it isn’t tomorrow morning, and I’ve been thinking it was today all this time. Hey! Venus, where did you come from? You seem pretty comfortable, anyway. Ugh! I might as well talk to the cat as to you—actually, it’s better because the cat understands me, and you don’t.”

This remark was called forth by the sight of one of the elderly females, who had seated herself on the rock in front of the bower, and, having placed her child at her feet, was busily engaged in devouring the remains of a roast pig.

This comment was triggered by the sight of one of the older women, who had sat down on the rock in front of the shelter, and, having set her child at her feet, was happily eating the leftovers of a roast pig.

By this time the natives outside were all astir, and breakfast in an advanced state of preparation. During the course of it we made sundry attempts to converse with the natives by signs, but without effect. At last we hit upon a plan of discovering their names. Jack pointed to his breast and said “Jack,” very distinctly; then he pointed to Peterkin and to me, repeating our names at the same time. Then he pointed to himself again, and said “Jack,” and laying his finger on the breast of the chief, looked inquiringly into his face. The chief instantly understood him and said “Tararo,” twice, distinctly. Jack repeated it after him, and the chief, nodding his head approvingly, said “Chuck.” On hearing which, Peterkin exploded with laughter; but Jack turned and with a frown rebuked him, saying, “I must look even more indignantly at you than I feel, Peterkin, you rascal, for these fellows don’t like to be laughed at.” Then turning towards the youngest of the women, who was seated at the door of the bower, he pointed to her; whereupon the chief said, “Avatea;” and pointing towards the sun, raised his finger slowly towards the zenith, where it remained steadily for a minute or two.

By this time, the locals outside were all busy, and breakfast was well underway. During the meal, we tried a few different ways to communicate with the locals using gestures, but it didn’t work. Finally, we came up with a method to learn their names. Jack pointed to himself and clearly said “Jack.” Then, he pointed to Peterkin and me, saying our names at the same time. Next, he pointed to himself again and said “Jack,” then touched the chief’s chest and looked at him questioningly. The chief understood immediately and said “Tararo” twice, very clearly. Jack repeated it, and the chief nodded approvingly, then said “Chuck.” Hearing this, Peterkin burst out laughing, but Jack turned and frowned at him, saying, “I have to look more upset with you than I actually feel, Peterkin, you trickster, because these people don’t appreciate being laughed at.” Then, turning to the youngest woman who was sitting at the entrance of the bower, he pointed to her, and the chief said, “Avatea,” while pointing toward the sun and slowly raising his finger to the highest point in the sky, where it stayed for a minute or two.

“What can that mean, I wonder,” said Jack, looking puzzled.

“What could that mean, I wonder,” Jack said, looking confused.

“Perhaps,” said Peterkin, “the chief means she is an angel come down to stay here for a while. If so, she’s an uncommonly black one!”

“Maybe,” said Peterkin, “the main reason she’s here is that she’s an angel who came down to stay for a bit. If that’s true, she’s definitely a very dark one!”

We did not feel quite satisfied with this explanation, so Jack went up to her and said, “Avatea.” The woman smiled sadly, and nodded her head, at the same time pointing to her breast and then to the sun, in the same manner as the chief had done. We were much puzzled to know what this could signify, but as there was no way of solving our difficulty we were obliged to rest content.

We weren't completely satisfied with this explanation, so Jack approached her and said, “Avatea.” The woman smiled sadly and nodded, pointing to her chest and then to the sun, just like the chief had done. We were confused about what this meant, but since there was no way to figure it out, we had to accept it.

Jack now made signs to the natives to follow him, and, taking up his axe, he led them to the place where the battle had been fought. Here we found the prisoners, who had passed the night on the beach having been totally forgotten by us, as our minds had been full of our guests, and were ultimately overcome by sleep. They did not seem the worse for their exposure, however, as we judged by the hearty appetite with which they devoured the breakfast that was soon after given to them. Jack then began to dig a hole in the sand, and, after working a few seconds, he pointed to it and to the dead bodies that lay exposed on the beach. The natives immediately perceived what he wanted, and, running for their paddles, dug a hole in the course of half an hour that was quite large enough to contain all the bodies of the slain. When it was finished they tossed their dead enemies into it with so much indifference that we felt assured they would not have put themselves to this trouble had we not asked them to do so. The body of the yellow-haired chief was the last thrown in. This wretched man would have recovered from the blow with which Jack felled him, and, indeed, he did endeavour to rise during the melee that followed his fall, but one of his enemies, happening to notice the action, dealt him a blow with his club that killed him on the spot.

Jack gestured for the natives to follow him, and, picking up his axe, he led them to the site of the battle. There, we found the prisoners who had spent the night on the beach, completely overlooked by us since we were occupied with our guests and eventually fell asleep. They didn’t seem to have suffered from their ordeal, as we could tell by the hearty way they devoured the breakfast we soon provided for them. Jack then started to dig a hole in the sand, and after a short while, he pointed to it and to the dead bodies lying on the beach. The natives quickly understood his intention, and racing for their paddles, they dug a hole big enough to hold all the bodies of the slain in just half an hour. Once it was done, they casually tossed their dead enemies into it, so much so that we felt they wouldn't have bothered if we hadn't asked them to. The last body to be thrown in was that of the yellow-haired chief. This unfortunate man could have survived the blow Jack dealt him; in fact, he tried to get up during the chaos that followed his fall. However, one of his enemies noticed him and struck him with a club, killing him instantly.

While they were about to throw the sand over this chief, one of the savages stooped over him, and with a knife, made apparently of stone, cut a large slice of flesh from his thigh. We knew at once that he intended to make use of this for food, and could not repress a cry of horror and disgust.

While they were about to throw sand over this chief, one of the savages bent down and, with a knife that looked like it was made of stone, cut a large piece of flesh from his thigh. We immediately realized that he planned to use this for food, and we couldn't help but cry out in horror and disgust.

“Come, come, you blackguard,” cried Jack, starting up and seizing the man by the arm, “pitch that into the hole. Do you hear?”

“Come on, you scoundrel,” yelled Jack, jumping up and grabbing the man by the arm, “throw that into the hole. Do you hear me?”

The savage of course did not understand the command, but he perfectly understood the look of disgust with which Jack regarded the flesh, and his fierce gaze as he pointed towards the hole. Nevertheless he did not obey. Jack instantly turned to Tararo and made signs to him to enforce obedience. The chief seemed to understand the appeal, for he stepped forward, raised his club, and was on the point of dashing out the brains of his offending subject, when Jack sprang forward and caught his uplifted arm.

The savage, of course, didn’t understand the command, but he clearly understood the look of disgust Jack had for the flesh and the fierce glare Jack gave as he pointed to the hole. Still, he did not obey. Jack quickly turned to Tararo and signaled for him to make him comply. The chief seemed to get the message because he stepped forward, lifted his club, and was about to smash the brains of his defiant subject when Jack rushed forward and grabbed his raised arm.

“Stop!” he shouted, “you blockhead, I don’t want you to kill the man.” He then pointed again to the flesh and to the hole. The chief uttered a few words, which had the desired effect; for the man threw the flesh into the hole, which was immediately filled up. This man was of a morose, sulky disposition, and, during all the time he remained on the island, regarded us, especially Jack, with a scowling visage. His name, we found, was Mahine.

“Stop!” he shouted, “you fool, I don’t want you to kill the man.” He then pointed again to the flesh and to the hole. The chief said a few words, which worked, because the man threw the flesh into the hole, and it was immediately filled. This man was gloomy and sulky, and throughout his time on the island, he looked at us, especially Jack, with a scowling face. We found out his name was Mahine.

The next three or four days were spent by the savages in mending their canoe, which had been damaged by the violent shock it had sustained on striking the shore. This canoe was a very curious structure. It was about thirty feet long, and had a high towering stern. The timbers, of which it was partly composed, were fastened much in the same way as those of our little boat were put together; but the part that seemed most curious to us was a sort of out-rigger, or long plank, which was attached to the body of the canoe by means of two stout cross beams. These beams kept the plank parallel with the canoe, but not in contact with it, for it floated in the water with an open space between; thus forming a sort of double canoe. This we found was intended to prevent the upsetting of the canoe, which was so narrow that it could not have maintained an upright position without the out-rigger. We could not help wondering both at the ingenuity and the clumsiness of this contrivance.

The next three or four days were spent by the natives fixing their canoe, which had been damaged by the violent jolt it received when it hit the shore. This canoe was a really interesting design. It was about thirty feet long and had a tall, raised stern. The timbers it was partly made of were fastened together much like the way our little boat was built; but the part that seemed most unusual to us was a kind of outrigger, or long plank, that was attached to the canoe's body with two sturdy cross beams. These beams kept the plank parallel to the canoe, but not touching it, as it floated in the water with an open space between, creating a sort of double canoe. We discovered this was meant to prevent the canoe from tipping over, as it was so narrow that it couldn’t stay upright without the outrigger. We couldn’t help but marvel at both the creativity and the awkwardness of this design.

When the canoe was ready, we assisted the natives to carry the prisoners into it, and helped them to load it with provisions and fruit. Peterkin also went to the plum-tree for the purpose of making a special onslaught upon the hogs, and killed no less than six of them. These we baked and presented to our friends on the day of their departure. On that day Tararo made a great many energetic signs to us, which, after much consideration, we came to understand were proposals that we should go away with him to his island; but, having no desire to do so, we shook our heads very decidedly. However, we consoled him by presenting him with our rusty axe, which we thought we could spare, having the excellent one which had been so providentially washed ashore to us the day we were wrecked. We also gave him a piece of wood with our names carved on it, and a piece of string to hang it round his neck as an ornament.

When the canoe was ready, we helped the locals carry the prisoners into it and loaded it with food and fruit. Peterkin also went to the plum tree to take down some hogs and ended up killing six of them. We baked those and presented them to our friends on the day they left. That day, Tararo made a lot of energetic gestures to us, which we eventually figured out were invitations for us to go to his island with him, but we had no interest in doing that, so we shook our heads firmly. However, we cheered him up by giving him our rusty axe, which we thought we could part with, especially since we had the great one that had miraculously washed ashore the day we were shipwrecked. We also gave him a piece of wood with our names carved into it, along with a string for him to wear it around his neck as a decoration.

In a few minutes more we were all assembled on the beach. Being unable to speak to the savages, we went through the ceremony of shaking hands, and expected they would depart; but, before doing so, Tararo went up to Jack and rubbed noses with him, after which he did the same with Peterkin and me! Seeing that this was their mode of salutation, we determined to conform to their custom, so we rubbed noses heartily with the whole party, women and all! The only disagreeable part of the process was, when we came to rub noses with Mahine, and Peterkin afterwards said, that when he saw his wolfish eyes glaring so close to his face, he felt much more inclined to bang than to rub his nose. Avatea was the last to take leave of us, and we experienced a feeling of real sorrow when she approached to bid us farewell. Besides her modest air and gentle manners she was the only one of the party who exhibited the smallest sign of regret at parting from us. Going up to Jack, she put out her flat little nose to be rubbed, and thereafter paid the same compliment to Peterkin and me.

In just a few minutes, we were all gathered on the beach. Since we couldn't talk to the natives, we went through the motions of shaking hands, expecting they would leave. But before they did, Tararo walked up to Jack and rubbed noses with him, then did the same with Peterkin and me! Realizing this was their way of greeting, we decided to follow their lead, so we rubbed noses energetically with the whole group, women included! The only uncomfortable part was when we had to rub noses with Mahine; Peterkin later said that when he saw Mahine's wolf-like eyes so close to his face, he felt more like hitting than rubbing noses. Avatea was the last one to say goodbye, and we felt a genuine sadness when she came to bid us farewell. Besides her modest demeanor and gentle ways, she was the only one in the group who showed any sign of sadness about leaving us. Approaching Jack, she extended her flat little nose for a rub, and then offered the same gesture to Peterkin and me.

An hour later the canoe was out of sight, and we, with an indefinable feeling of sadness creeping round our hearts, were seated in silence beneath the shadow of our bower, meditating on the wonderful events of the last few days.

An hour later, the canoe was gone, and we sat in silence under the shade of our bower, with an inexplicable sense of sadness settling in our hearts, reflecting on the amazing events of the past few days.

CHAPTER XXI.

Sagacious and moral remarks in regard to life—A sail!—An unexpected salute—The end of the black cat—A terrible dive—An incautious proceeding and a frightful catastrophe.

Wise and ethical comments about life—A sail!—A surprising greeting—The demise of the black cat—A horrible plunge—A reckless action and a dreadful disaster.

Life is a strange compound. Peterkin used to say of it, that it beat a druggist’s shop all to sticks; for, whereas the first is a compound of good and bad, the other is a horrible compound of all that is utterly detestable. And indeed the more I consider it the more I am struck with the strange mixture of good and evil that exists not only in the material earth but in our own natures. In our own Coral Island we had experienced every variety of good that a bountiful Creator could heap on us. Yet on the night of the storm we had seen how almost, in our case,—and altogether, no doubt, in the case of others less fortunate—all this good might be swept away for ever. We had seen the rich fruit-trees waving in the soft air, the tender herbs shooting upwards under the benign influence of the bright sun; and, the next day, we had seen these good and beautiful trees and plants uprooted by the hurricane, crushed and hurled to the ground in destructive devastation. We had lived for many months in a clime for the most part so beautiful, that we had often wondered whether Adam and Eve had found Eden more sweet; and we had seen the quiet solitudes of our paradise suddenly broken in upon by ferocious savages, and the white sands stained with blood and strewed with lifeless forms; yet, among these cannibals, we had seen many symptoms of a kindly nature. I pondered these things much, and, while I considered them, there recurred to my memory those words which I had read in my Bible,—the works of God are wonderful, and his ways past finding out.

Life is a strange mix. Peterkin used to say it was more chaotic than a pharmacy; because while the first is a mix of good and bad, the latter is a terrible blend of everything that's completely awful. The more I think about it, the more I'm struck by the odd combination of good and evil that exists not just in the physical world but in our own natures too. In our own Coral Island, we experienced every kind of good that a generous Creator could shower upon us. Yet on the night of the storm, we saw how easily—at least for us, and definitely for others less fortunate—all this good could vanish forever. We watched the lush fruit trees swaying in the gentle breeze and the tender herbs growing strong under the warm sun; and then, the next day, we saw those good and beautiful trees and plants ripped from the ground by the hurricane, smashed and thrown down in devastating destruction. We had spent many months in a place that was mostly so beautiful, we often wondered if Adam and Eve found Eden even sweeter; and we had witnessed the peaceful solitude of our paradise suddenly shattered by violent savages, with the white sands stained with blood and scattered with lifeless bodies; yet, among these cannibals, we noticed many signs of a kind nature. I thought about these things a lot, and as I reflected, those words from the Bible came back to me—the works of God are amazing, and his ways are beyond understanding.

After these poor savages had left us, we used to hold long and frequent conversations about them, and I noticed that Peterkin’s manner was now much altered. He did not, indeed, jest less heartily than before, but he did so less frequently, and often there was a tone of deep seriousness in his manner, if not in his words, which made him seem to Jack and me as if he had grown two years older within a few days. But indeed I was not surprised at this, when I reflected on the awful realities which we had witnessed so lately. We could by no means shake off a tendency to gloom for several weeks afterwards; but, as time wore away, our usual good spirits returned somewhat, and we began to think of the visit of the savages with feelings akin to those with which we recall a terrible dream.

After those poor savages left us, we started having long and frequent talks about them, and I noticed that Peterkin had changed a lot. He didn’t joke around as much as before, although when he did, he still laughed heartily. However, there was often a tone of deep seriousness in his manner, if not in his words, which made him seem to Jack and me like he had aged two years in just a few days. I wasn’t really surprised by this, considering the awful realities we had just witnessed. For several weeks afterwards, we couldn’t shake off a tendency to feel gloomy, but as time passed, our usual good spirits gradually returned, and we began to think about the visit from the savages with feelings similar to those we have when we remember a terrible dream.

One day we were all enjoying ourselves in the Water Garden, preparatory to going on a fishing excursion; for Peterkin had kept us in such constant supply of hogs that we had become quite tired of pork, and desired a change. Peterkin was sunning himself on the ledge of rock, while we were creeping among the rocks below. Happening to look up, I observed Peterkin cutting the most extraordinary capers and making violent gesticulations for us to come up; so I gave Jack a push, and rose immediately.

One day we were all having a great time in the Water Garden, getting ready for a fishing trip; because Peterkin had kept us so well-stocked with pork that we were pretty tired of it and wanted something different. Peterkin was lying on a rock ledge in the sun while we were exploring the rocks below. When I looked up, I saw Peterkin making a scene and waving his arms frantically for us to join him, so I nudged Jack and got up right away.

“A sail! a sail! Ralph, look! Jack, away on the horizon there, just over the entrance to the lagoon!” cried Peterkin, as we scrambled up the rocks.

“A sail! A sail! Ralph, look! Jack, way out on the horizon there, just beyond the entrance to the lagoon!” Peterkin shouted as we climbed up the rocks.

“So it is, and a schooner, too!” said Jack, as he proceeded hastily to dress.

“So it is, and a schooner, too!” said Jack, as he quickly got dressed.

Our hearts were thrown into a terrible flutter by this discovery, for if it should touch at our island we had no doubt the captain would be happy to give us a passage to some of the civilized islands, where we could find a ship sailing for England, or some other part of Europe. Home, with all its associations, rushed in upon my heart like a flood, and, much though I loved the Coral Island and the bower which had now been our home so long, I felt that I could have quitted all at that moment without a sigh. With joyful anticipations we hastened to the highest point of rock near our dwelling, and awaited the arrival of the vessel, for we now perceived that she was making straight for the island, under a steady breeze.

Our hearts raced with excitement at this discovery, because if it reached our island, we were sure the captain would gladly give us a ride to one of the civilized islands, where we could catch a ship to England or somewhere else in Europe. The thought of home, with all its memories, overwhelmed me like a wave, and even though I loved Coral Island and the bower that had been our home for so long, I realized I could leave it all behind in that moment without a second thought. Filled with joyful anticipation, we rushed to the highest point of rock near our home and waited for the ship, as we noticed it was heading straight for the island with a steady breeze.

In less than an hour she was close to the reef, where she rounded to, and backed her topsails in order to survey the coast. Seeing this, and fearing that they might not perceive us, we all three waved pieces of cocoa-nut cloth in the air, and soon had the satisfaction of seeing them beginning to lower a boat and bustle about the decks as if they meant to land. Suddenly a flag was run up to the peak, a little cloud of white smoke rose from the schooner’s side, and, before we could guess their intentions, a cannon-shot came crashing through the bushes, carried away several cocoa-nut trees in its passage, and burst in atoms against the cliff a few yards below the spot on which we stood.

In less than an hour, she was near the reef, where she turned and backed her topsails to check out the coast. Seeing this and worried that they might not notice us, the three of us waved pieces of coconut cloth in the air, and soon we were pleased to see them start lowering a boat and getting busy on the decks as if they planned to come ashore. Suddenly, a flag was raised at the peak, a small puff of white smoke rose from the side of the schooner, and before we could figure out what they were up to, a cannon shot came crashing through the trees, taking out several coconut trees as it went, and exploded against the cliff just a few yards below us.

With feelings of terror we now observed that the flag at the schooner’s peak was black, with a Death’s head and cross bones upon it. As we gazed at each other in blank amazement, the word “pirate” escaped our lips simultaneously.

With a sense of dread, we now saw that the flag at the top of the schooner was black, featuring a skull and crossbones. As we looked at each other in shock, the word “pirate” slipped from our mouths at the same time.

“What is to be done?” cried Peterkin, as we observed a boat shoot from the vessel’s side, and make for the entrance of the reef. “If they take us off the island, it will either be to throw us overboard for sport, or to make pirates of us.”

“What should we do?” shouted Peterkin, as we watched a boat leave the side of the ship and head for the entrance of the reef. “If they rescue us from the island, it will either be to toss us overboard for fun, or to turn us into pirates.”

I did not reply, but looked at Jack, as being our only resource in this emergency. He stood with folded arms, and his eyes fixed with a grave, anxious expression on the ground. “There is but one hope,” said he, turning with a sad expression of countenance to Peterkin; “perhaps, after all, we may not have to resort to it. If these villains are anxious to take us, they will soon overrun the whole island. But come, follow me.”

I didn’t respond, but turned to Jack, our only option in this crisis. He stood there with his arms crossed, his eyes focused on the ground, looking serious and anxious. “There’s only one hope,” he said, turning to Peterkin with a sad look on his face. “Maybe we won’t have to go down that road after all. If these bad guys are eager to catch us, they’ll quickly take over the entire island. But come on, follow me.”

Stopping abruptly in his speech, Jack bounded into the woods, and led us by a circuitous route to Spouting Cliff. Here he halted, and, advancing cautiously to the rocks, glanced over their edge. We were soon by his side, and saw the boat, which was crowded with armed men, just touching the shore. In an instant the crew landed, formed line, and rushed up to our bower.

Stopping suddenly in his speech, Jack ran into the woods and took us on a roundabout path to Spouting Cliff. There, he stopped and, moving carefully to the rocks, looked over the edge. We soon joined him and saw the boat, packed with armed men, just reaching the shore. In a moment, the crew got off, lined up, and charged up to our shelter.

In a few seconds we saw them hurrying back to the boat, one of them swinging the poor cat round his head by the tail. On reaching the water’s edge, he tossed it far into the sea, and joined his companions, who appeared to be holding a hasty council.

In a few seconds, we saw them rushing back to the boat, one of them swinging the poor cat around his head by the tail. When they reached the water's edge, he flung it far out into the sea and joined his friends, who seemed to be having a quick discussion.

“You see what we may expect,” said Jack bitterly. “The man who will wantonly kill a poor brute for sport will think little of murdering a fellow-creature. Now, boys, we have but one chance left,—the Diamond Cave.”

“You see what we can expect,” Jack said bitterly. “The guy who will kill a poor animal for fun will think nothing of murdering another person. Now, guys, we have only one chance left—the Diamond Cave.”

“The Diamond Cave!” cried Peterkin, “then my chance is a poor one, for I could not dive into it if all the pirates on the Pacific were at my heels.”

“The Diamond Cave!” shouted Peterkin, “then I’ve got a slim chance, because I couldn’t dive into it even if all the pirates in the Pacific were chasing me.”

“Nay, but,” said I, “we will take you down, Peterkin, if you will only trust us.”

“Nah, but,” I said, “we'll take you down, Peterkin, if you just trust us.”

As I spoke, we observed the pirates scatter over the beach, and radiate, as if from a centre, towards the woods and along shore.

As I spoke, we watched the pirates spread out across the beach, fanning out like rays from a center toward the woods and along the shoreline.

“Now, Peterkin,” said Jack, in a solemn tone, “you must make up your mind to do it, or we must make up our minds to die in your company.”

“Now, Peterkin,” Jack said seriously, “you need to decide to do it, or we have to accept that we might die with you.”

“Oh, Jack, my dear friend,” cried Peterkin, turning pale, “leave me; I don’t believe they’ll think it worth while to kill me. Go, you and Ralph, and dive into the cave.”

“Oh, Jack, my dear friend,” cried Peterkin, turning pale, “leave me; I don’t think they’ll find it worth it to kill me. Go, you and Ralph, and dive into the cave.”

“That will not I,” answered Jack quietly, while he picked up a stout cudgel from the ground. “So now, Ralph, we must prepare to meet these fellows. Their motto is, ‘No quarter.’ If we can manage to floor those coming in this direction, we may escape into the woods for a while.”

“That won’t be me,” Jack replied calmly, picking up a heavy stick from the ground. “So now, Ralph, we need to get ready to face these guys. Their motto is, ‘No mercy.’ If we can take down those coming this way, we might be able to escape into the woods for a bit.”

“There are five of them,” said I; “we have no chance.”

“There are five of them,” I said; “we don't stand a chance.”

“Come, then,” cried Peterkin, starting up, and grasping Jack convulsively by the arm, “let us dive; I will go.”

“Come on,” shouted Peterkin, jumping up and grabbing Jack tightly by the arm, “let's dive; I’m in.”

Those who are not naturally expert in the water know well the feelings of horror that overwhelm them, when in it, at the bare idea of being held down, even for a few seconds,—that spasmodic, involuntary recoil from compulsory immersion which has no connection whatever with cowardice; and they will understand the amount of resolution that it required in Peterkin to allow himself to be dragged down to a depth of ten feet, and then, through a narrow tunnel, into an almost pitch-dark cavern. But there was no alternative. The pirates had already caught sight of us, and were now within a short distance of the rocks.

Those who aren't naturally good at swimming know the intense fear that hits them when they’re in the water, just thinking about being submerged, even for a few seconds—it’s that sudden, instinctive urge to pull away from being forced underwater, which has nothing to do with being a coward. They'll understand how much courage it took for Peterkin to let himself be pulled down to a depth of ten feet, then through a narrow tunnel into a nearly pitch-black cave. But there was no choice. The pirates had already spotted us and were now just a short distance from the rocks.

Jack and I seized Peterkin by the arms.

Jack and I grabbed Peterkin by the arms.

“Now, keep quite still, no struggling,” said Jack, “or we are lost.”

“Now, stay completely still, don’t fight it,” said Jack, “or we’re done for.”

Peterkin made no reply, but the stern gravity of his marble features, and the tension of his muscles, satisfied us that he had fully made up his mind to go through with it. Just as the pirates gained the foot of the rocks, which hid us for a moment from their view, we bent over the sea, and plunged down together head foremost. Peterkin behaved like a hero. He floated passively between us like a log of wood, and we passed the tunnel and rose into the cave in a shorter space of time than I had ever done it before.

Peterkin didn’t say anything, but the serious look on his stone-like face and the tightness in his muscles made it clear that he was totally committed to going through with it. Just as the pirates reached the bottom of the rocks, which briefly shielded us from their sight, we leaned over the sea and jumped in together, diving headfirst. Peterkin acted like a champ. He floated between us like a piece of timber, and we got through the tunnel and emerged into the cave faster than I had ever done before.

Peterkin drew a long, deep breath on reaching the surface; and in a few seconds we were all standing on the ledge of rock in safety. Jack now searched for the tinder and torch, which always lay in the cave. He soon found them, and, lighting the torch, revealed to Peterkin’s wondering gaze the marvels of the place. But we were too wet to waste much time in looking about us. Our first care was to take off our clothes, and wring them as dry as we could. This done, we proceeded to examine into the state of our larder, for, as Jack truly remarked, there was no knowing how long the pirates might remain on the island.

Peterkin took a long, deep breath when he reached the surface, and in just a few seconds, we were all standing safely on the rock ledge. Jack then looked for the tinder and torch, which were always kept in the cave. He quickly found them and, after lighting the torch, showed Peterkin the amazing sights of the place. But we were too wet to spend much time exploring. Our first priority was to take off our clothes and wring them out as dry as we could. Once that was done, we checked the condition of our food supplies because, as Jack rightly pointed out, we had no idea how long the pirates might stay on the island.

“Perhaps,” said Peterkin, “they may take it into their heads to stop here altogether, and so we shall be buried alive in this place.”

"Maybe," said Peterkin, "they'll decide to just stay here completely, and we'll end up buried alive in this place."

“Don’t you think, Peterkin, that it’s the nearest thing to being drowned alive that you ever felt?” said Jack with a smile. “But I’ve no fear of that. These villains never stay long on shore. The sea is their home, so you may depend upon it that they won’t stay more than a day or two at the furthest.”

“Don’t you think, Peterkin, that it’s the closest thing to being drowned alive that you’ve ever felt?” said Jack with a smile. “But I’m not worried about that. These villains never hang around on land for long. The sea is their home, so you can count on them not staying more than a day or two at the most.”

We now began to make arrangements for spending the night in the cavern. At various periods Jack and I had conveyed cocoa nuts and other fruits, besides rolls of cocoa-nut cloth, to this submarine cave, partly for amusement, and partly from a feeling that we might possibly be driven one day to take shelter here from the savages. Little did we imagine that the first savages who would drive us into it would be white savages, perhaps our own countrymen. We found the cocoa-nuts in good condition, and the cooked yams, but the bread-fruits were spoiled. We also found the cloth where we had left it; and, on opening it out, there proved to be sufficient to make a bed; which was important, as the rock was damp. Having collected it all together, we spread out our bed, placed our torch in the midst of us, and ate our supper. It was indeed a strange chamber to feast in; and we could not help remarking on the cold, ghastly appearance of the walls, and the black water at our side, with the thick darkness beyond, and the sullen sound of the drops that fell at long intervals from the roof of the cavern into the still water; and the strong contrast between all this and our bed and supper, which, with our faces, were lit up with the deep red flame of the torch.

We started making plans to spend the night in the cave. Over time, Jack and I had brought cocoa nuts and other fruits, as well as rolls of cocoa-nut cloth, to this underwater cave, partly for fun and partly because we thought we might need to hide here from the savages someday. We had no idea that the first savages to drive us into it would be white savages, possibly our own countrymen. The cocoa nuts we found were in good shape, and the cooked yams were fine, but the bread-fruits were spoiled. We located the cloth where we left it, and when we unfolded it, we found enough to make a bed, which was important since the rock was damp. After gathering everything together, we spread out our bed, placed our torch in the middle, and had our supper. It was definitely a strange place to eat; we couldn’t help but notice the cold, eerie look of the walls, the black water beside us, the thick darkness beyond, and the gloomy sound of drops falling occasionally from the cave's ceiling into the still water; it was a stark contrast to our bed and supper, which, along with our faces, were illuminated by the deep red glow of the torch.

We sat long over our meal, talking together in subdued voices, for we did not like the dismal echoes that rang through the vault above when we happened to raise them. At last the faint light that came through the opening died away, warning us that it was night and time for rest. We therefore put out our torch and lay down to sleep.

We lingered over our meal, talking softly to each other, as we didn't want to disturb the gloomy echoes above us when we spoke too loudly. Eventually, the dim light from the opening faded, signaling that night had come and it was time to rest. So, we extinguished our torch and settled down to sleep.

On awaking, it was some time ere we could collect our faculties so as to remember where we were, and we were in much uncertainty as to whether it was early or late. We saw by the faint light that it was day, but could not guess at the hour; so Jack proposed that he should dive out and reconnoitre.

On waking up, it took us a while to gather our thoughts and remember where we were, and we were unsure if it was early or late. We could tell by the dim light that it was daytime, but we couldn’t figure out the time; so Jack suggested that he would jump out and scout around.

“No, Jack,” said I, “do you rest here. You’ve had enough to do during the last few days. Rest yourself now, and take care of Peterkin, while I go out to see what the pirates are about. I’ll be very careful not to expose myself, and I’ll bring you word again in a short time.”

“No, Jack,” I said, “you stay here. You’ve done enough these last few days. Take a break now and look after Peterkin while I go check on what the pirates are up to. I’ll be really careful not to put myself in danger, and I’ll let you know what I find out shortly.”

“Very well, Ralph,” answered Jack, “please yourself, but don’t be long; and if you’ll take my advice you’ll go in your clothes, for I would like to have some fresh cocoa nuts, and climbing trees without clothes is uncomfortable, to say the least of it.”

“Okay, Ralph,” Jack replied, “suit yourself, but don’t take too long; and if you want my advice, you should go in your clothes because I’d like to grab some fresh coconuts, and climbing trees without clothes is uncomfortable, to say the least.”

“The pirates will be sure to keep a sharp lookout,” said Peterkin, “so, pray, be careful.”

“The pirates will definitely be keeping a close watch,” said Peterkin, “so please, be careful.”

“No fear,” said I; “good-bye.”

"No worries," I said; "bye."

“Good-bye,” answered my comrades.

"Goodbye," replied my friends.

And while the words were yet sounding in my ears, I plunged into the water, and in a few seconds found myself in the open air. On rising, I was careful to come up gently and to breathe softly, while I kept close in beside the rocks; but, as I observed no one near me, I crept slowly out, and ascended the cliff a step at a time, till I obtained a full view of the shore. No pirates were to be seen,—even their boat was gone; but as it was possible they might have hidden themselves, I did not venture too boldly forward. Then it occurred to me to look out to sea, when, to my surprise, I saw the pirate schooner sailing away almost hull-down on the horizon! On seeing this I uttered a shout of joy. Then my first impulse was to dive back to tell my companions the good news; but I checked myself, and ran to the top of the cliff, in order to make sure that the vessel I saw was indeed the pirate schooner. I looked long and anxiously at her, and, giving vent to a deep sigh of relief, said aloud, “Yes, there she goes; the villains have been baulked of their prey this time at least.”

And while the words were still echoing in my ears, I jumped into the water and, in a few seconds, found myself in the open air. When I came up, I was careful to surface gently and breathe quietly while staying close to the rocks; but as I noticed no one around me, I slowly crawled out and climbed the cliff one step at a time until I had a full view of the shore. I didn’t see any pirates—not even their boat was in sight—but since they might have hidden themselves, I didn’t move too boldly forward. Then I thought to look out to sea, and to my surprise, I saw the pirate schooner sailing away, almost out of sight on the horizon! Seeing this made me shout with joy. My first instinct was to dive back and tell my friends the good news; but I held back and ran to the top of the cliff to confirm that the vessel I saw was indeed the pirate schooner. I stared at her for a long time, feeling anxious, and let out a deep sigh of relief, saying out loud, “Yes, there she goes; this time, at least, the villains have been thwarted in their plans.”

“Not so sure of that!” said a deep voice at my side; while, at the same moment, a heavy hand grasped my shoulder, and held it as if in a vice.

“Not so sure about that!” said a deep voice beside me, while at the same time, a strong hand gripped my shoulder and held it like a vice.

CHAPTER XXII.

I fall into the hands of pirates—How they treated me, and what I said to them—The result of the whole ending in a melancholy separation and in a most unexpected gift.

I ended up in the hands of pirates—how they treated me, and what I said to them—the outcome was a sad separation and a completely unexpected gift.

My heart seemed to leap into my throat at the words; and, turning round, I beheld a man of immense stature, and fierce aspect regarding me with a smile of contempt. He was a white man,—that is to say, he was a man of European blood, though his face, from long exposure to the weather, was deeply bronzed. His dress was that of a common seaman, except that he had on a Greek skull-cap, and wore a broad shawl of the richest silk round his waist. In this shawl were placed two pair of pistols and a heavy cutlass. He wore a beard and moustache, which, like the locks on his head, were short, curly, and sprinkled with gray hairs.

My heart felt like it was about to jump out of my chest at those words; and, turning around, I saw a very tall man with a fierce look on his face, smiling at me with disdain. He was a white man—that is, of European descent—though his skin was deeply tanned from years in the sun. He was dressed like a regular sailor, but he wore a Greek skullcap and had a wide silk shawl wrapped around his waist. In this shawl, he had two pairs of pistols and a heavy cutlass. He had a beard and mustache that, like his hair, were short, curly, and mixed with gray hairs.

“So, youngster,” he said, with a sardonic smile, while I felt his grasp tighten on my shoulder, “the villains have been baulked of their prey, have they? We shall see, we shall see. Now, you whelp, look yonder.” As he spoke, the pirate uttered a shrill whistle. In a second or two it was answered, and the pirate-boat rowed round the point at the Water Garden, and came rapidly towards us. “Now, go, make a fire on that point; and hark’ee, youngster, if you try to run away, I’ll send a quick and sure messenger after you,” and he pointed significantly at his pistols.

“So, kid,” he said with a sarcastic smile, while I felt his grip tighten on my shoulder, “the bad guys have been denied their target, huh? We’ll see about that. Now, you little brat, look over there.” As he spoke, the pirate let out a sharp whistle. Within a couple of seconds, it was answered, and the pirate boat rounded the point at the Water Garden, coming quickly toward us. “Now, go make a fire on that point; and listen here, kid, if you try to run away, I’ll send a fast and certain messenger after you,” and he pointed meaningfully at his guns.

I obeyed in silence, and as I happened to have the burning-glass in my pocket, a fire was speedily kindled, and a thick smoke ascended into the air. It had scarcely appeared for two minutes when the boom of a gun rolled over the sea, and, looking up, I saw that the schooner was making for the island again. It now flashed across me that this was a ruse on the part of the pirates, and that they had sent their vessel away, knowing that it would lead us to suppose that they had left altogether. But there was no use of regret now. I was completely in their power, so I stood helplessly beside the pirate watching the crew of the boat as they landed on the beach. For an instant I contemplated rushing over the cliff into the sea, but this I saw I could not now accomplish, as some of the men were already between me and the water.

I nodded silently, and since I had a magnifying glass in my pocket, I quickly started a fire, and thick smoke rose into the air. Hardly two minutes had passed when the sound of a gun echoed over the sea, and looking up, I noticed that the schooner was heading back to the island. It suddenly struck me that this was a trick by the pirates; they had sent their ship away, knowing it would make us think they had left for good. But there was no point in regretting it now. I was completely at their mercy, so I stood helplessly next to the pirate, watching as the crew of the boat came ashore. For a moment, I thought about jumping off the cliff into the sea, but I realized I couldn’t do that now because some of the men were already between me and the water.

There was a good deal of jesting at the success of their scheme, as the crew ascended the rocks and addressed the man who had captured me by the title of captain. They were a ferocious set of men, with shaggy beards and scowling brows. All of them were armed with cutlasses and pistols, and their costumes were, with trifling variations, similar to that of the captain. As I looked from one to the other, and observed the low, scowling brows, that never unbent, even when the men laughed, and the mean, rascally expression that sat on each face, I felt that my life hung by a hair.

There was a lot of joking about the success of their plan as the crew climbed the rocks and called the man who had captured me "captain." They were a fierce group, with unkempt beards and scowling faces. Each of them was armed with cutlasses and pistols, and their outfits were, with minor variations, similar to the captain's. As I looked from one to the other and noticed their low, scowling brows that never relaxed, even when they laughed, along with the sneaky, dubious look on each face, I felt like my life was hanging by a thread.

“But where are the other cubs?” cried one of the men, with an oath that made me shudder. “I’ll swear to it there were three, at least, if not more.”

“But where are the other cubs?” shouted one of the men, swearing in a way that made me flinch. “I swear there were at least three, if not more.”

“You hear what he says, whelp; where are the other dogs?” said the captain.

“You hear what he says, pup; where are the other dogs?” said the captain.

“If you mean my companions,” said I, in a low voice, “I won’t tell you.”

“If you’re talking about my friends,” I replied quietly, “I’m not going to tell you.”

A loud laugh burst from the crew at this answer.

A loud laugh erupted from the crew at this answer.

The pirate captain looked at me in surprise. Then drawing a pistol from his belt, he cocked it and said, “Now, youngster, listen to me. I’ve no time to waste here. If you don’t tell me all you know, I’ll blow your brains out! Where are your comrades?”

The pirate captain stared at me in shock. Then, pulling a pistol from his belt, he cocked it and said, “Now, kid, listen up. I don’t have time to waste. If you don’t tell me everything you know, I’ll blow your brains out! Where are your friends?”

For an instant I hesitated, not knowing what to do in this extremity. Suddenly a thought occurred to me.

For a moment, I paused, unsure of what to do in this situation. Then a thought struck me.

“Villain,” said I, shaking my clenched fist in his face, “to blow my brains out would make short work of me, and be soon over. Death by drowning is as sure, and the agony prolonged, yet, I tell you to your face, if you were to toss me over yonder cliff into the sea, I would not tell you where my companions are, and I dare you to try me!”

“Villain,” I said, shaking my clenched fist in his face, “shooting me would be quick and easy, and it would be over fast. Drowning is just as certain, but the suffering lasts longer. Still, I’ll tell you to your face, if you were to throw me over that cliff into the sea, I wouldn’t tell you where my friends are, and I dare you to try it!”

The pirate captain grew white with rage as I spoke. “Say you so?” cried he, uttering a fierce oath. “Here, lads, take him by the legs and heave him in,—quick!”

The pirate captain turned pale with anger as I spoke. "Is that what you're saying?" he shouted, swearing fiercely. "Hey, guys, grab him by the legs and throw him in—hurry!"

The men, who were utterly silenced with surprise at my audacity, advanced, and seized me, and, as they carried me towards the cliff, I congratulated myself not a little on the success of my scheme, for I knew that once in the water I should be safe, and could rejoin Jack and Peterkin in the cave. But my hopes were suddenly blasted by the captain crying out, “Hold on, lads, hold on. We’ll give him a taste of the thumb-screws before throwing him to the sharks. Away with him into the boat. Look alive! the breeze is freshening.”

The men, completely stunned by my boldness, moved in and grabbed me. As they took me towards the cliff, I felt pretty pleased with my plan, because I knew that once I hit the water, I’d be safe and could reunite with Jack and Peterkin in the cave. But my hopes were quickly dashed when the captain shouted, “Hold on, guys, hold on. We’ll give him a taste of the thumb-screws before we toss him to the sharks. Get him into the boat. Hurry up! The wind's picking up.”

The men instantly raised me shoulder high, and, hurrying down the rocks, tossed me into the bottom of the boat, where I lay for some time stunned with the violence of my fall.

The guys quickly lifted me up over their shoulders and, rushing down the rocks, threw me into the bottom of the boat, where I lay for a while, dazed from the force of my fall.

On recovering sufficiently to raise myself on my elbow, I perceived that we were already outside the coral reef, and close alongside the schooner, which was of small size and clipper built. I had only time to observe this much, when I received a severe kick on the side from one of the men, who ordered me, in a rough voice, to jump aboard. Rising hastily I clambered up the side. In a few minutes the boat was hoisted on deck, the vessel’s head put close to the wind, and the Coral Island dropped slowly astern as we beat up against a head sea.

As I recovered enough to prop myself up on my elbow, I noticed that we were already outside the coral reef and right next to the small, clipper-built schooner. I barely had time to take this in before one of the men kicked me hard in the side and roughly told me to get on board. Quickly, I scrambled up the side. In just a few minutes, the boat was lifted onto the deck, the ship’s bow turned into the wind, and the Coral Island slowly fell behind as we fought against the waves.

Immediately after coming aboard, the crew were too busily engaged in working the ship and getting in the boat to attend to me, so I remained leaning against the bulwarks close to the gangway, watching their operations. I was surprised to find that there were no guns or carronades of any kind in the vessel, which had more of the appearance of a fast-sailing trader than a pirate. But I was struck with the neatness of everything. The brass work of the binnacle and about the tiller, as well as the copper belaying-pins, were as brightly polished as if they had just come from the foundry. The decks were pure white, and smooth. The masts were clean-scraped and varnished, except at the cross-trees and truck, which were painted black. The standing and running rigging was in the most perfect order, and the sails white as snow. In short, everything, from the single narrow red stripe on her low black hull to the trucks on her tapering masts, evinced an amount of care and strict discipline that would have done credit to a ship of the Royal Navy. There was nothing lumbering or unseemly about the vessel, excepting, perhaps, a boat, which lay on the deck with its keel up between the fore and main masts. It seemed disproportionately large for the schooner; but, when I saw that the crew amounted to between thirty and forty men, I concluded that this boat was held in reserve, in case of any accident compelling the crew to desert the vessel.

As soon as I got on board, the crew was too busy working the ship and preparing the boat to pay attention to me, so I leaned against the rail near the gangway, watching what they were doing. I was surprised to see that there were no guns or cannons on the ship; it looked more like a fast-moving trader than a pirate vessel. But I was impressed by how tidy everything was. The brass on the binnacle and around the tiller, as well as the copper belaying pins, shone bright like they had just come from the factory. The decks were pure white and smooth. The masts were clean and varnished, except for the cross-trees and truck, which were painted black. The standing and running rigging was in perfect condition, and the sails were as white as snow. Overall, everything, from the narrow red stripe on the sleek black hull to the trucks on the tall masts, showed a level of care and discipline that would impress any ship in the Royal Navy. There was nothing clunky or out of place about the vessel, except maybe a boat that lay on the deck, keel up, between the fore and main masts. It seemed too big for the schooner, but with the crew being around thirty to forty men, I figured that the boat was kept on standby in case of any emergency that required the crew to abandon the ship.

As I have before said, the costumes of the men were similar to that of the captain. But in head gear they differed not only from him but from each other, some wearing the ordinary straw hat of the merchant service, while others wore cloth caps and red worsted night-caps. I observed that all their arms were sent below; the captain only retaining his cutlass and a single pistol in the folds of his shawl. Although the captain was the tallest and most powerful man in the ship, he did not strikingly excel many of his men in this respect, and the only difference that an ordinary observer would have noticed was, a certain degree of open candour, straightforward daring, in the bold, ferocious expression of his face, which rendered him less repulsive than his low-browed associates, but did not by any means induce the belief that he was a hero. This look was, however, the indication of that spirit which gave him the pre-eminence among the crew of desperadoes who called him captain. He was a lion-like villain; totally devoid of personal fear, and utterly reckless of consequences, and, therefore, a terror to his men, who individually hated him, but unitedly felt it to be their advantage to have him at their head.

As I mentioned before, the men's outfits were similar to the captain's. However, their headwear varied not just from his but among themselves as well; some wore the typical straw hats of the merchant service, while others had cloth caps and red woollen night caps. I noticed that all their weapons were put away, with the captain keeping only his cutlass and a single pistol tucked in his shawl. Even though the captain was the tallest and strongest man on the ship, he wasn’t significantly bigger than many of his crew. The only difference an average observer might notice was a certain openness, straightforward bravery in the fierce expression on his face, making him seem less unappealing than his scowling companions, though it didn't exactly paint him as a hero. This look, however, reflected the spirit that set him apart among the band of outlaws who called him captain. He was a lion-like villain—completely fearless and totally reckless about the outcomes—which made him a source of fear for his men, who individually despised him but collectively saw having him as their leader as beneficial.

But my thoughts soon reverted to the dear companions whom I had left on shore, and as I turned towards the Coral Island, which was now far away to leeward, I sighed deeply, and the tears rolled slowly down my cheeks as I thought that I might never see them more.

But soon my mind went back to the dear friends I had left onshore. As I looked toward Coral Island, which was now far away behind me, I sighed deeply, and tears slowly rolled down my cheeks at the thought that I might never see them again.

“So you’re blubbering, are you, you obstinate whelp?” said the deep voice of the captain, as he came up and gave me a box on the ear that nearly felled me to the deck. “I don’t allow any such weakness aboard o’ this ship. So clap a stopper on your eyes or I’ll give you something to cry for.”

“So you’re crying, are you, you stubborn brat?” said the captain’s deep voice as he approached and slapped me hard enough that I almost fell to the deck. “I won’t tolerate any weakness on this ship. So shut your eyes or I’ll give you a real reason to cry.”

I flushed with indignation at this rough and cruel treatment, but felt that giving way to anger would only make matters worse, so I made no reply, but took out my handkerchief and dried my eyes.

I felt a rush of anger at this harsh and cruel treatment, but I knew that showing my anger would only make things worse, so I didn’t say anything. Instead, I took out my handkerchief and wiped my eyes.

“I thought you were made of better stuff,” continued the captain, angrily; “I’d rather have a mad bull-dog aboard than a water-eyed puppy. But I’ll cure you, lad, or introduce you to the sharks before long. Now go below, and stay there till I call you.”

“I thought you were made of stronger stuff,” the captain continued, angrily. “I’d rather have a crazed bulldog on board than a watery-eyed puppy. But I’ll fix you, kid, or I’ll send you to the sharks before long. Now go below and stay there until I call you.”

As I walked forward to obey, my eye fell on a small keg standing by the side of the main-mast, on which the word gunpowder was written in pencil. It immediately flashed across me that, as we were beating up against the wind, anything floating in the sea would be driven on the reef encircling the Coral Island. I also recollected—for thought is more rapid than the lightning—that my old companions had a pistol. Without a moment’s hesitation, therefore, I lifted the keg from the deck and tossed it into the sea! An exclamation of surprise burst from the captain and some of the men who witnessed this act of mine.

As I stepped forward to comply, I noticed a small keg next to the main mast with the word gunpowder written in pencil. It suddenly struck me that since we were sailing against the wind, anything floating in the water would end up on the reef surrounding the Coral Island. I also recalled—since thoughts move faster than lightning—that my old friends had a pistol. Without a moment's hesitation, I picked up the keg from the deck and threw it into the sea! An exclamation of surprise came from the captain and some of the crew who saw what I did.

Striding up to me, and uttering fearful imprecations, the captain raised his hand to strike me, while he shouted, “Boy! whelp! what mean you by that?”

Striding up to me and shouting angry curses, the captain raised his hand to hit me while he yelled, “Hey! You little brat! What do you think you’re doing?”

“If you lower your hand,” said I, in a loud voice, while I felt the blood rush to my temples, “I’ll tell you. Until you do so I’m dumb!”

“If you lower your hand,” I said loudly, feeling the blood rush to my temples, “I’ll tell you. Until you do, I’m not saying anything!”

The captain stepped back and regarded me with a look of amazement.

The captain stepped back and looked at me with amazement.

“Now,” continued I, “I threw that keg into the sea because the wind and waves will carry it to my friends on the Coral Island, who happen to have a pistol, but no powder. I hope that it will reach them soon, and my only regret is that the keg was not a bigger one. Moreover, pirate, you said just now that you thought I was made of better stuff! I don’t know what stuff I am made of,—I never thought much about that subject; but I’m quite certain of this, that I am made of such stuff as the like of you shall never tame, though you should do your worst.”

“Now,” I continued, “I threw that keg into the sea because the wind and waves will carry it to my friends on Coral Island, who have a pistol but no powder. I hope it reaches them soon, and my only regret is that the keg wasn’t bigger. Also, pirate, you just said you thought I was made of better stuff! I don't know what I'm made of—I haven’t thought much about it—but I’m sure of one thing: I'm made of stuff that someone like you will never control, even if you try your hardest.”

To my surprise the captain, instead of flying into a rage, smiled, and, thrusting his hand into the voluminous shawl that encircled his waist, turned on his heel and walked aft, while I went below.

To my surprise, the captain, instead of getting really angry, smiled and, reaching into the big shawl wrapped around his waist, turned around and walked to the back, while I went below.

Here, instead of being rudely handled, as I had expected, the men received me with a shout of laughter, and one of them, patting me on the back, said, “Well done, lad! you’re a brick, and I have no doubt will turn out a rare cove. Bloody Bill, there, was just such a fellow as you are, and he’s now the biggest cut-throat of us all.”

Here, rather than being treated roughly, as I had anticipated, the guys welcomed me with a burst of laughter, and one of them, giving me a friendly pat on the back, said, “Great job, kid! You’re solid, and I’m sure you’ll become quite the character. Bloody Bill over there was just like you, and now he’s the biggest villain of us all.”

“Take a can of beer, lad,” cried another, “and wet your whistle after that speech o’ your’n to the captain. If any one o’ us had made it, youngster, he would have had no whistle to wet by this time.”

“Grab a beer, dude,” shouted another, “and loosen up after that speech of yours to the captain. If any of us had given it, kid, he wouldn’t have had a whistle left to wet by now.”

“Stop your clapper, Jack,” vociferated a third; “give the boy a junck o’ meat. Don’t you see he’s a’most goin’ to kick the bucket?”

“Shut up, Jack,” shouted a third person; “give the boy a chunk of meat. Can’t you see he’s about to kick the bucket?”

“And no wonder,” said the first speaker, with an oath, “after the tumble you gave him into the boat. I guess it would have broke your neck if you had got it.”

“And no wonder,” said the first speaker, with a curse, “after the fall you gave him into the boat. I bet it would have broken your neck if you had taken that hit.”

I did indeed feel somewhat faint; which was owing, doubtless, to the combined effects of ill-usage and hunger; for it will be recollected that I had dived out of the cave that morning before breakfast, and it was now near mid-day. I therefore gladly accepted a plate of boiled pork and a yam, which were handed to me by one of the men from the locker on which some of the crew were seated eating their dinner. But I must add that the zest with which I ate my meal was much abated in consequence of the frightful oaths and the terrible language that flowed from the lips of these godless men, even in the midst of their hilarity and good-humour. The man who had been alluded to as Bloody Bill was seated near me, and I could not help wondering at the moody silence he maintained among his comrades. He did indeed reply to their questions in a careless, off-hand tone, but he never volunteered a remark. The only difference between him and the others was his taciturnity and his size, for he was nearly, if not quite, as large a man as the captain.

I definitely felt a bit faint, probably from the combination of mistreatment and hunger. Remember, I had dived out of the cave that morning before breakfast, and now it was almost noon. So, I happily accepted a plate of boiled pork and a yam, which one of the men handed to me from the locker where some of the crew were sitting down to their meal. However, I must say that my enthusiasm for the food was dampened by the foul curses and terrible language that these godless men were throwing around, even while they were enjoying themselves. The guy referred to as Bloody Bill was sitting near me, and I couldn’t help but notice his moody silence among his friends. He did respond to their questions in a casual, uninterested way, but he never initiated any conversation. The only things that set him apart from the others were his quietness and his size, as he was nearly, if not exactly, as large as the captain.

During the remainder of the afternoon I was left to my own reflections, which were anything but agreeable, for I could not banish from my mind the threat about the thumb-screws, of the nature and use of which I had a vague but terrible conception. I was still meditating on my unhappy fate when, just after night-fall, one of the watch on deck called down the hatchway,—

During the rest of the afternoon, I was alone with my thoughts, and they were anything but pleasant, as I couldn’t shake the unsettling idea of the thumb-screws, which I had a vague but dreadful understanding of. I was still thinking about my unfortunate situation when, shortly after dark, one of the guards on deck shouted down the hatchway,—

“Hallo there! one o’ you, tumble up and light the cabin lamp, and send that boy aft to the captain—sharp!”

“Hello there! One of you, get up and turn on the cabin lamp, and send that boy to the captain—hurry!”

“Now then, do you hear, youngster? the captain wants you. Look alive,” said Bloody Bill, raising his huge frame from the locker on which he had been asleep for the last two hours. He sprang up the ladder and I instantly followed him, and, going aft, was shown into the cabin by one of the men, who closed the door after me.

“Hey, do you hear me, kid? The captain wants you. Stay sharp,” said Bloody Bill, getting up from the locker where he had been sleeping for the last two hours. He jumped up the ladder and I immediately followed him. Once we got to the back, one of the men showed me into the cabin and then closed the door behind me.

A small silver lamp which hung from a beam threw a dim soft light over the cabin, which was a small apartment, and comfortably but plainly finished. Seated on a camp-stool at the table, and busily engaged in examining a chart of the Pacific, was the captain, who looked up as I entered, and, in a quiet voice, bade me be seated, while he threw down his pencil, and, rising from the table, stretched himself on a sofa at the upper end of the cabin.

A small silver lamp hanging from a beam cast a dim, soft light over the cabin, which was a cozy yet simply furnished apartment. The captain was seated on a camp-stool at the table, absorbed in examining a chart of the Pacific. He looked up as I entered and, in a calm voice, invited me to sit down. He put down his pencil, stood up from the table, and stretched out on a sofa at the end of the cabin.

“Boy,” said he, looking me full in the face, “what is your name?”

“Hey,” he said, looking me straight in the eye, “what’s your name?”

“Ralph Rover,” I replied.

“Ralph Rover,” I said.

“Where did you come from, and how came you to be on that island? How many companions had you on it? Answer me, now, and mind you tell no lies.”

“Where did you come from, and how did you end up on that island? How many companions did you have with you? Answer me now, and make sure you don't lie.”

“I never tell lies,” said I, firmly.

"I never lie," I said firmly.

The captain received this reply with a cold sarcastic smile, and bade me answer his questions.

The captain received this reply with a cold, sarcastic smile and told me to answer his questions.

I then told him the history of myself and my companions from the time we sailed till the day of his visit to the island, taking care, however, to make no mention of the Diamond Cave. After I had concluded, he was silent for a few minutes; then, looking up, he said—“Boy, I believe you.”

I then shared the story of myself and my friends from the time we set sail until the day he visited the island, making sure not to mention the Diamond Cave. When I finished, he was silent for a few minutes; then, looking up, he said, “Kid, I believe you.”

I was surprised at this remark, for I could not imagine why he should not believe me. However, I made no reply.

I was taken aback by this comment because I couldn't understand why he wouldn't believe me. Still, I didn't say anything.

“And what,” continued the captain, “makes you think that this schooner is a pirate?”

“And what,” the captain continued, “makes you think this schooner is a pirate?”

“The black flag,” said I, “showed me what you are; and if any further proof were wanting I have had it in the brutal treatment I have received at your hands.”

“The black flag,” I said, “revealed who you really are; and if I needed any more proof, the brutal way you've treated me has been more than enough.”

The captain frowned as I spoke, but subduing his anger he continued—“Boy, you are too bold. I admit that we treated you roughly, but that was because you made us lose time and gave us a good deal of trouble. As to the black flag, that is merely a joke that my fellows play off upon people sometimes in order to frighten them. It is their humour, and does no harm. I am no pirate, boy, but a lawful trader,—a rough one, I grant you, but one can’t help that in these seas, where there are so many pirates on the water and such murderous blackguards on the land. I carry on a trade in sandal-wood with the Feejee Islands; and if you choose, Ralph, to behave yourself and be a good boy, I’ll take you along with me and give you a good share of the profits. You see I’m in want of an honest boy like you, to look after the cabin and keep the log, and superintend the traffic on shore sometimes. What say you, Ralph, would you like to become a sandal-wood trader?”

The captain frowned as I spoke, but managing his anger, he continued—“Kid, you’re too bold. I admit we treated you roughly, but that was because you made us lose time and caused us a lot of trouble. As for the black flag, it’s just a joke my crew plays on people to scare them. It’s their sense of humor, and it doesn’t do any harm. I’m not a pirate, kid, but a legitimate trader—rough, I’ll give you that, but you can’t help that in these waters, where there are so many pirates out at sea and such violent thugs on land. I trade in sandalwood with the Fiji Islands, and if you decide to behave and be a good kid, I’ll take you with me and give you a good share of the profits. You see, I need an honest kid like you to help with the cabin, keep the log, and supervise the trade onshore sometimes. What do you say, Ralph, would you like to become a sandalwood trader?”

I was much surprised by this explanation, and a good deal relieved to find that the vessel, after all, was not a pirate; but instead of replying I said, “If it be as you state, then why did you take me from my island, and why do you not now take me back?”

I was really surprised by this explanation and pretty relieved to discover that the ship wasn’t a pirate after all. Instead of responding, I said, “If it’s as you say, then why did you take me from my island, and why don’t you take me back now?”

The captain smiled as he replied, “I took you off in anger, boy, and I’m sorry for it. I would even now take you back, but we are too far away from it. See, there it is,” he added, laying his finger on the chart, “and we are now here,—fifty miles at least. It would not be fair to my men to put about now, for they have all an interest in the trade.”

The captain smiled as he said, “I took you off in anger, kid, and I’m sorry for it. I would even take you back now, but we’re too far from it. Look, there it is,” he added, pointing at the chart, “and we’re here now—at least fifty miles away. It wouldn’t be fair to my crew to turn back now, since they all have a stake in the trade.”

I could make no reply to this; so, after a little more conversation, I agreed to become one of the crew, at least until we could reach some civilized island where I might be put ashore. The captain assented to this proposition, and after thanking him for the promise, I left the cabin and went on deck with feelings that ought to have been lighter, but which were, I could not tell why, marvellously heavy and uncomfortable still.

I couldn’t respond to that, so after chatting a bit more, I agreed to join the crew, at least until we reached a civilized island where I could get off. The captain agreed to this suggestion, and after thanking him for it, I left the cabin and went on deck with feelings that should have been lighter, but for some reason, they felt surprisingly heavy and uncomfortable instead.

CHAPTER XXIII.

Bloody Bill—Dark surmises—A strange sail, and a strange crew, and a still stranger cargo—New reasons for favouring missionaries—A murderous massacre, and thoughts thereon.

Bloody Bill—Dark guesses—An unusual ship, and an unusual crew, and an even stranger cargo—New reasons to support missionaries—A brutal massacre, and reflections on it.

Three weeks after the conversation narrated in the last chapter, I was standing on the quarter-deck of the schooner watching the gambols of a shoal of porpoises that swam round us. It was a dead calm. One of those still, hot, sweltering days, so common in the Pacific, when Nature seems to have gone to sleep, and the only thing in water or in air that proves her still alive, is her long, deep breathing, in the swell of the mighty sea. No cloud floated in the deep blue above; no ripple broke the reflected blue below. The sun shone fiercely in the sky, and a ball of fire blazed, with almost equal power, from out the bosom of the water. So intensely still was it, and so perfectly transparent was the surface of the deep, that had it not been for the long swell already alluded to, we might have believed the surrounding universe to be a huge blue liquid ball, and our little ship the one solitary material speck in all creation, floating in the midst of it.

Three weeks after the conversation described in the last chapter, I was on the quarter-deck of the schooner, watching a group of porpoises swim around us. It was completely calm. One of those still, hot, muggy days that are so typical in the Pacific, when it feels like Nature has fallen asleep, and the only sign of her being alive is the long, deep breathing of the ocean's swell. No cloud floated in the deep blue above; no ripple disturbed the reflected blue below. The sun blazed fiercely in the sky, and a fiery ball lit up the water almost as brightly. It was so eerily still, and the surface of the ocean was so clear that without the long swell I mentioned, we might have thought the entire universe was just a massive blue liquid ball, with our tiny ship being the only solid speck in all of existence, floating in the middle of it.

No sound broke on our ears save the soft puff now and then of a porpoise, the slow creak of the masts, as we swayed gently on the swell, the patter of the reef-points, and the occasional flap of the hanging sails. An awning covered the fore and after parts of the schooner, under which the men composing the watch on deck lolled in sleepy indolence, overcome with excessive heat. Bloody Bill, as the men invariably called him, was standing at the tiller, but his post for the present was a sinecure, and he whiled away the time by alternately gazing in dreamy abstraction at the compass in the binnacle, and by walking to the taffrail in order to spit into the sea. In one of these turns he came near to where I was standing, and, leaning over the side, looked long and earnestly down into the blue wave.

No sound reached our ears except for the occasional soft puff of a porpoise, the slow creaking of the masts as we swayed gently on the waves, the light splashes from the reef-points, and the occasional flap of the hanging sails. An awning covered the front and back parts of the schooner, where the men on deck lounged in a sleepy daze, overcome by the heat. Bloody Bill, as everyone called him, was at the helm, but his role was pretty much a free ride, so he passed the time by staring dreamily at the compass in the binnacle and walking to the back of the ship to spit into the sea. During one of these strolls, he came close to where I was standing and leaned over the side, gazing intently down into the blue water.

This man, although he was always taciturn and often surly, was the only human being on board with whom I had the slightest desire to become better acquainted. The other men, seeing that I did not relish their company, and knowing that I was a protege of the captain, treated me with total indifference. Bloody Bill, it is true, did the same; but as this was his conduct towards every one else, it was not peculiar in reference to me. Once or twice I tried to draw him into conversation, but he always turned away after a few cold monosyllables. As he now leaned over the taffrail close beside me, I said to him,—

This guy, even though he was always quiet and often grumpy, was the only person on board I actually wanted to get to know better. The other guys, seeing that I didn’t enjoy their company and knowing I was the captain’s protégé, completely ignored me. It’s true that Bloody Bill did the same thing, but that was just how he treated everyone, so it wasn’t personal. A couple of times, I tried to start a conversation with him, but he always turned away after a few curt replies. As he leaned over the railing next to me, I said to him,—

“Bill, why is it that you are so gloomy? Why do you never speak to any one?”

“Bill, why are you so down? Why don’t you ever talk to anyone?”

Bill smiled slightly as he replied, “Why, I s’pose it’s because I haint got nothin’ to say!”

Bill smiled a little as he replied, “Well, I guess it’s because I don't have anything to say!”

“That’s strange,” said I, musingly; “you look like a man that could think, and such men can usually speak.”

"That's odd," I said, thinking out loud; "you seem like someone who can think, and people like that usually know how to express themselves."

“So they can, youngster,” rejoined Bill, somewhat sternly; “and I could speak too if I had a mind to, but what’s the use o’ speakin’ here! The men only open their mouths to curse and swear, an’ they seem to find it entertaining; but I don’t, so I hold my tongue.”

“So they can, kid,” Bill replied, a bit seriously; “and I could talk too if I felt like it, but what’s the point of speaking here! The guys only open their mouths to curse and swear, and they act like it’s fun; but I don’t, so I keep my mouth shut.”

“Well, Bill, that’s true, and I would rather not hear you speak at all than hear you speak like the other men; but I don’t swear, Bill, so you might talk to me sometimes, I think. Besides, I’m weary of spending day after day in this way, without a single soul to say a pleasant word to. I’ve been used to friendly conversation, Bill, and I really would take it kind if you would talk with me a little now and then.”

“Well, Bill, that's true, and I would rather not hear you talk at all than hear you talk like the other guys; but I don’t swear, Bill, so I think you could talk to me sometimes. Besides, I’m tired of spending day after day like this, without anyone to say a kind word to. I’m used to friendly conversation, Bill, and I would really appreciate it if you could chat with me a little now and then.”

Bill looked at me in surprise, and I thought I observed a sad expression pass across his sun-burnt face.

Bill looked at me in surprise, and I thought I saw a sad look flash across his sunburned face.

“An’ where have you been used to friendly conversation,” said Bill, looking down again into the sea; “not on that Coral Island, I take it?”

“Where have you been having friendly conversations?” said Bill, glancing down at the sea again. “Not on that Coral Island, I assume?”

“Yes, indeed,” said I energetically; “I have spent many of the happiest months in my life on that Coral Island;” and without waiting to be further questioned, I launched out into a glowing account of the happy life that Jack and Peterkin and I had spent together, and related minutely every circumstance that befell us while on the island.

“Yes, definitely,” I said excitedly; “I have spent some of the happiest months of my life on that Coral Island;” and without waiting for more questions, I started sharing a vivid account of the great time Jack, Peterkin, and I had together, detailing everything that happened to us while we were on the island.

“Boy, boy,” said Bill, in a voice so deep that it startled me, “this is no place for you.”

“Hey, kid,” Bill said, in a voice so deep it caught me off guard, “you shouldn't be here.”

“That’s true,” said I; “I’m of little use on board, and I don’t like my comrades; but I can’t help it, and at anyrate I hope to be free again soon.”

“That's true,” I said; “I'm not much help on the ship, and I don’t really like my coworkers; but I can’t change that, and I at least hope to be free again soon.”

“Free?” said Bill, looking at me in surprise.

“Free?” Bill asked, looking at me in surprise.

“Yes, free,” returned I; “the captain said he would put me ashore after this trip was over.”

“Yes, free,” I replied; “the captain said he would drop me off once this trip is over.”

This trip! Hark’ee, boy,” said Bill, lowering his voice, “what said the captain to you the day you came aboard?”

This trip! Hey, kid,” said Bill, lowering his voice, “what did the captain say to you the day you came on board?”

“He said that he was a trader in sandal-wood and no pirate, and told me that if I would join him for this trip he would give me a good share of the profits or put me on shore in some civilized island if I chose.”

“He said he was a sandalwood trader, not a pirate, and told me that if I joined him on this trip, he would give me a fair share of the profits or drop me off on a civilized island if I wanted.”

Bill’s brows lowered savagely as he muttered, “Ay, he said truth when he told you he was a sandal-wood trader, but he lied when—”

Bill's brows furrowed intensely as he muttered, “Yeah, he spoke the truth when he said he was a sandalwood trader, but he lied when—”

“Sail ho!” shouted the look-out at the masthead.

“Sail ahead!” shouted the lookout at the top of the mast.

“Where, away?” cried Bill, springing to the tiller; while the men, startled by the sudden cry jumped up and gazed round the horizon.

“Where to?” shouted Bill, jumping to the tiller; while the men, startled by the sudden shout, got up and looked around the horizon.

“On the starboard quarter, hull down, sir,” answered the look-out.

“On the starboard side, hull down, sir,” replied the lookout.

At this moment the captain came on deck, and mounting into the rigging, surveyed the sail through the glass. Then sweeping his eye round the horizon he gazed steadily at a particular point.

At that moment, the captain came on deck and climbed up into the rigging to look at the sail through the binoculars. Then, scanning the horizon, he focused intently on a specific point.

“Take in top-sails,” shouted the captain, swinging himself down on the deck by the main-back stay.

“Reef the topsails,” shouted the captain, swinging himself down onto the deck by the main backstay.

“Take in top-sails,” roared the first mate.

“Bring in the top sails,” shouted the first mate.

“Ay, ay, sir-r-r,” answered the men as they sprang into the rigging and went aloft like cats.

“Ay, ay, sir,” replied the men as they jumped into the rigging and climbed up like cats.

Instantly all was bustle on board the hitherto quiet schooner. The top-sails were taken in and stowed, the men stood by the sheets and halyards, and the captain gazed anxiously at the breeze which was now rushing towards us like a sheet of dark blue. In a few seconds it struck us. The schooner trembled as if in surprise at the sudden onset, while she fell away, then bending gracefully to the wind, as though in acknowledgment of her subjection, she cut through the waves with her sharp prow like a dolphin, while Bill directed her course towards the strange sail.

Instantly, the previously calm schooner erupted into activity. The topsails were taken in and secured, the crew stood ready by the sheets and halyards, and the captain watched nervously as the breeze rushed toward us like a sheet of dark blue. Within seconds, it hit us. The schooner shook as if surprised by the sudden change, then veered off, gracefully yielding to the wind. Acknowledging its power, she sliced through the waves with her sharp bow like a dolphin, while Bill steered her towards the unfamiliar sail.

In half an hour we neared her sufficiently to make out that she was a schooner, and, from the clumsy appearance of her masts and sails we judged her to be a trader. She evidently did not like our appearance, for, the instant the breeze reached her, she crowded all sail and showed us her stern. As the breeze had moderated a little our top-sails were again shaken out, and it soon became evident,—despite the proverb, “A stern chase is a long one,” that we doubled her speed and would overhaul her speedily. When within a mile we hoisted British colours, but receiving no acknowledgment, the captain ordered a shot to be fired across her bows. In a moment, to my surprise, a large portion of the bottom of the boat amidships was removed, and in the hole thus exposed appeared an immense brass gun. It worked on a swivel and was elevated by means of machinery. It was quickly loaded and fired. The heavy ball struck the water a few yards ahead of the chase, and, ricochetting into the air, plunged into the sea a mile beyond it.

In half an hour, we got close enough to see that she was a schooner, and judging by the awkward look of her masts and sails, we figured she was a trader. She clearly didn’t like our presence, because the moment the wind hit her, she set all her sails and showed us her back. As the breeze calmed down a bit, we shook out our top sails again, and it quickly became clear—despite the saying, “A stern chase is a long one”—that we were going twice as fast as her and would catch up soon. When we were within a mile, we raised British colors, but since we got no response, the captain ordered a shot to be fired across her bow. To my surprise, a large section of the boat's bottom in the middle was removed, revealing a huge brass gun. It was mounted on a swivel and raised using machinery. It was loaded in no time and fired. The heavy shot hit the water just a few yards ahead of the chase, bouncing up into the air and then plunging into the sea a mile beyond.

This produced the desired effect. The strange vessel backed her top-sails and hove-to, while we ranged up and lay-to, about a hundred yards off.

This created the desired effect. The odd ship backed her top sails and stopped, while we moved up and stopped about a hundred yards away.

“Lower the boat,” cried the captain.

“Lower the boat,” shouted the captain.

In a second the boat was lowered and manned by a part of the crew, who were all armed with cutlasses and pistols. As the captain passed me to get into it, he said, “jump into the stern sheets, Ralph, I may want you.” I obeyed, and in ten minutes more we were standing on the stranger’s deck. We were all much surprised at the sight that met our eyes. Instead of a crew of such sailors as we were accustomed to see, there were only fifteen blacks standing on the quarter-deck and regarding us with looks of undisguised alarm. They were totally unarmed and most of them unclothed; one or two, however, wore portions of European attire. One had on a pair of duck trousers which were much too large for him and stuck out in a most ungainly manner. Another wore nothing but the common scanty native garment round the loins, and a black beaver hat. But the most ludicrous personage of all, and one who seemed to be chief, was a tall middle-aged man, of a mild, simple expression of countenance, who wore a white cotton shirt, a swallow-tailed coat, and a straw hat, while his black brawny legs were totally uncovered below the knees.

In an instant, the boat was launched and staffed by some of the crew, all of whom were armed with cutlasses and pistols. As the captain walked past me to get in, he said, “Jump into the stern sheets, Ralph; I might need you.” I complied, and in just ten more minutes, we were standing on the stranger’s deck. We were all quite surprised by what we saw. Instead of a crew of the sailors we were used to, there were only fifteen Black people standing on the quarter-deck, looking at us with obvious fear. They were completely unarmed and most of them were barely clothed; however, a couple wore bits of European clothing. One had on a pair of duck trousers that were way too big for him and looked quite awkward. Another wore nothing but a typical short native garment around his waist and a black beaver hat. But the most ridiculous figure of all, who seemed to be in charge, was a tall, middle-aged man with a gentle, simple expression. He was dressed in a white cotton shirt, a swallow-tailed coat, and a straw hat, while his muscular black legs were completely bare below the knees.

“Where’s the commander of this ship?” inquired our captain, stepping up to this individual.

“Where’s the captain of this ship?” our captain asked as he approached the individual.

“I is capin,” he answered, taking off his straw hat and making a low bow.

“I’m the captain,” he replied, removing his straw hat and bowing slightly.

“You!” said our captain, in surprise. “Where do you come from, and where are you bound? What cargo have you aboard?”

“Hey!” our captain exclaimed, surprised. “Where are you coming from, and where are you headed? What cargo do you have on board?”

“We is come,” answered the man with the swallow-tail, “from Aitutaki; we was go for Rarotonga. We is native miss’nary ship; our name is de Olive Branch; an’ our cargo is two tons cocoa-nuts, seventy pigs, twenty cats, and de Gosp’l.”

“We've arrived,” answered the man in the swallow-tail coat, “from Aitutaki; we were heading for Rarotonga. We are a native missionary ship; our name is the Olive Branch; and our cargo includes two tons of coconuts, seventy pigs, twenty cats, and the Gospel.”

This announcement was received by the crew of our vessel with a shout of laughter, which, however, was peremptorily checked by the captain, whose expression instantly changed from one of severity to that of frank urbanity as he advanced towards the missionary and shook him warmly by the hand.

This announcement was met by the crew of our ship with a burst of laughter, but it was quickly silenced by the captain, whose expression shifted from strict to genuinely friendly as he walked up to the missionary and shook his hand warmly.

“I am very glad to have fallen in with you,” said he, “and I wish you much success in your missionary labours. Pray take me to your cabin, as I wish to converse with you privately.”

“I’m really happy to have met you,” he said, “and I wish you lots of success in your missionary work. Please take me to your cabin, as I’d like to talk to you privately.”

The missionary immediately took him by the hand, and as he led him away I heard him saying, “Me most glad to find you trader; we t’ought you be pirate. You very like one ’bout the masts.”

The missionary quickly took him by the hand, and as he led him away, I heard him say, “I’m really glad to find you, trader; we thought you were a pirate. You look a lot like one up by the masts.”

What conversation the captain had with this man I never heard, but he came on deck again in a quarter of an hour, and, shaking hands cordially with the missionary, ordered us into our boat and returned to the schooner, which was immediately put before the wind. In a few minutes the Olive Branch was left far behind us.

What the captain talked about with this man, I never found out, but he came back on deck after about fifteen minutes, shook hands warmly with the missionary, told us to get into our boat, and went back to the schooner, which was then set to sail with the wind. In just a few minutes, the Olive Branch was far behind us.

That afternoon, as I was down below at dinner, I heard the men talking about this curious ship.

That afternoon, while I was downstairs having dinner, I overheard the men discussing this strange ship.

“I wonder,” said one, “why our captain looked so sweet on yon swallow-tailed super-cargo o’ pigs and Gospels. If it had been an ordinary trader, now, he would have taken as many o’ the pigs as he required and sent the ship with all on board to the bottom.”

“I wonder,” said one, “why our captain seemed so taken with that flashy cargo ship full of pigs and Gospels. If it had been a regular trader, he would have just taken as many pigs as he needed and sunk the ship with everyone on board.”

“Why, Dick, you must be new to these seas if you don’t know that,” cried another. “The captain cares as much for the gospel as you do (an’ that’s precious little), but he knows, and everybody knows, that the only place among the southern islands where a ship can put in and get what she wants in comfort, is where the gospel has been sent to. There are hundreds o’ islands, at this blessed moment, where you might as well jump straight into a shark’s maw as land without a band o’ thirty comrades armed to the teeth to back you.”

“Hey, Dick, you must be new to these waters if you don't know that,” shouted another. “The captain cares as much for the gospel as you do (and that’s not much), but he knows, and everyone knows, that the only place among the southern islands where a ship can dock and get what it needs comfortably is where the gospel has been spread. Right now, there are hundreds of islands where you might as well jump straight into a shark’s mouth as land without a group of thirty armed friends to support you.”

“Ay,” said a man with a deep scar over his right eye, “Dick’s new to the work. But if the captain takes us for a cargo o’ sandal-wood to the Feejees he’ll get a taste o’ these black gentry in their native condition. For my part I don’t know, an’ I don’t care, what the gospel does to them; but I know that when any o’ the islands chance to get it, trade goes all smooth an’ easy; but where they ha’nt got it, Beelzebub himself could hardly desire better company.”

“Ay,” said a man with a deep scar over his right eye, “Dick’s new to the work. But if the captain takes us for a load of sandalwood to the Feejees, he’ll get a taste of these black folks in their natural state. Personally, I don’t know, and I don’t care, what the gospel does for them; but I know that wherever the islands happen to get it, trade goes along smooth and easy; but where they don’t have it, even Beelzebub himself couldn’t want better company.”

“Well, you ought to be a good judge,” cried another, laughing, “for you’ve never kept any company but the worst all your life!”

“Well, you should be a good judge,” shouted another, laughing, “because you’ve only ever surrounded yourself with the worst company your whole life!”

“Ralph Rover!” shouted a voice down the hatchway. “Captain wants you, aft.”

“Ralph Rover!” shouted a voice from the hatchway. “The captain wants you at the back.”

Springing up the ladder I hastened to the cabin, pondering as I went the strange testimony borne by these men to the effect of the gospel on savage natures;—testimony which, as it was perfectly disinterested, I had no doubt whatever was strictly true.

Springing up the ladder, I rushed to the cabin, thinking about the unusual witness these men provided regarding the impact of the gospel on wild natures;—a witness that, being completely unbiased, I had no doubt was absolutely true.

On coming again on deck I found Bloody Bill at the helm, and as we were alone together I tried to draw him into conversation. After repeating to him the conversation in the forecastle about the missionaries, I said,—

On coming back on deck, I found Bloody Bill at the helm, and since it was just the two of us, I tried to get him talking. After I shared the conversation from the forecastle about the missionaries, I said,—

“Tell me, Bill, is this schooner really a trader in sandal-wood?”

“Tell me, Bill, is this schooner really a sandalwood trader?”

“Yes, Ralph, she is; but she’s just as really a pirate. The black flag you saw flying at the peak was no deception.”

“Yes, Ralph, she is; but she’s just as much a pirate. The black flag you saw flying at the top was no trick.”

“Then how can you say she’s a trader?” asked I.

“Then how can you say she’s a trader?” I asked.

“Why, as to that, she trades when she can’t take by force, but she takes by force, when she can, in preference. Ralph,” he added, lowering his voice, “if you had seen the bloody deeds that I have witnessed done on these decks you would not need to ask if we were pirates. But you’ll find it out soon enough. As for the missionaries, the captain favours them because they are useful to him. The South-Sea islanders are such incarnate fiends that they are the better of being tamed, and the missionaries are the only men who can do it.”

“Look, she trades when she can’t take by force, but she definitely prefers to take by force when she can. Ralph,” he said, lowering his voice, “if you had seen the bloody acts I’ve witnessed on these decks, you wouldn’t need to ask if we were pirates. But you’ll find out soon enough. As for the missionaries, the captain supports them because they’re useful to him. The South-Sea islanders are such pure devils that they are better off being tamed, and the missionaries are the only ones who can do it.”

Our track after this lay through several clusters of small islets, among which we were becalmed more than once. During this part of our voyage the watch on deck and the look-out at the mast-head were more than usually vigilant, as we were not only in danger of being attacked by the natives, who, I learned from the captain’s remarks, were a bloody and deceitful tribe at this group, but we were also exposed to much risk from the multitudes of coral reefs that rose up in the channels between the islands, some of them just above the surface, others a few feet below it. Our precautions against the savages I found were indeed necessary.

Our route after this took us through several clusters of small islands, where we were stuck without wind more than once. During this part of our journey, the crew on deck and the lookout at the mast were especially alert, as we were not only at risk of being attacked by the locals—who I learned from the captain's comments were a violent and tricky group in this area—but we also faced significant danger from the many coral reefs that popped up in the channels between the islands, some just above the water, others a few feet beneath it. I realized our precautions against the locals were truly necessary.

One day we were becalmed among a group of small islands, most of which appeared to be uninhabited. As we were in want of fresh water the captain sent the boat ashore to bring off a cask or two. But we were mistaken in thinking there were no natives; for scarcely had we drawn near to the shore when a band of naked blacks rushed out of the bush and assembled on the beach, brandishing their clubs and spears in a threatening manner. Our men were well armed, but refrained from showing any signs of hostility, and rowed nearer in order to converse with the natives; and I now found that more than one of the crew could imperfectly speak dialects of the language peculiar to the South Sea islanders. When within forty yards of the shore, we ceased rowing, and the first mate stood up to address the multitude; but, instead of answering us, they replied with a shower of stones, some of which cut the men severely. Instantly our muskets were levelled, and a volley was about to be fired, when the captain hailed us in a loud voice from the schooner, which lay not more than five or six hundred yards off the shore.

One day, we found ourselves stuck near a group of small islands, most of which seemed uninhabited. Since we needed fresh water, the captain sent a boat to the shore to get a cask or two. But we were wrong to assume there were no locals; as soon as we got close to the shore, a group of naked men rushed out of the bushes and gathered on the beach, waving their clubs and spears in a threatening way. Our crew was well-armed but chose not to show any aggression, rowing closer to communicate with the locals. I learned that more than one crew member could speak some of the dialects used by the South Sea islanders. When we were about forty yards from the shore, we stopped rowing, and the first mate stood up to address the crowd; however, instead of responding, they attacked us with a shower of stones, injuring some of the men. Immediately, our muskets were aimed, and we were about to fire a volley when the captain shouted loudly from the schooner, which was only about five or six hundred yards away from the shore.

“Don’t fire,” he shouted, angrily. “Pull off to the point ahead of you.”

“Don’t shoot,” he yelled, frustrated. “Get over to the point in front of you.”

The men looked surprised at this order, and uttered deep curses as they prepared to obey, for their wrath was roused and they burned for revenge. Three or four of them hesitated, and seemed disposed to mutiny.

The men looked shocked at this order and muttered harsh curses as they got ready to follow it, their anger flaring and craving revenge. Three or four of them hesitated and appeared ready to revolt.

“Don’t distress yourselves, lads,” said the mate, while a bitter smile curled his lip. “Obey orders. The captain’s not the man to take an insult tamely. If Long Tom does not speak presently I’ll give myself to the sharks.”

“Don’t worry, guys,” said the mate, a bitter smile on his face. “Just follow the orders. The captain isn’t someone who takes an insult lightly. If Long Tom doesn’t speak up soon, I’ll throw myself to the sharks.”

The men smiled significantly as they pulled from the shore, which was now crowded with a dense mass of savages, amounting, probably, to five or six hundred. We had not rowed off above a couple of hundred yards when a loud roar thundered over the sea, and the big brass gun sent a withering shower of grape point blank into the midst of the living mass, through which a wide lane was cut, while a yell, the like of which I could not have imagined, burst from the miserable survivors as they fled to the woods. Amongst the heaps of dead that lay on the sand, just where they had fallen, I could distinguish mutilated forms writhing in agony, while ever and anon one and another rose convulsively from out the mass, endeavoured to stagger towards the wood, and ere they had taken a few steps, fell and wallowed on the bloody sand. My blood curdled within me as I witnessed this frightful and wanton slaughter; but I had little time to think, for the captain’s deep voice came again over the water towards us: “Pull ashore, lads, and fill your water casks.” The men obeyed in silence, and it seemed to me as if even their hard hearts were shocked by the ruthless deed. On gaining the mouth of the rivulet at which we intended to take in water, we found it flowing with blood, for the greater part of those who were slain had been standing on the banks of the stream, a short way above its mouth. Many of the wretched creatures had fallen into it, and we found one body, which had been carried down, jammed between two rocks, with the staring eyeballs turned towards us and his black hair waving in the ripples of the blood-red stream. No one dared to oppose our landing now, so we carried our casks to a pool above the murdered group, and having filled them, returned on board. Fortunately a breeze sprang up soon afterwards and carried us away from the dreadful spot; but it could not waft me away from the memory of what I had seen.

The men smiled knowingly as they pulled away from the shore, which was now packed with a dense crowd of savages, probably numbering five or six hundred. We had only rowed a couple of hundred yards when a loud roar boomed over the sea, and the big brass gun fired a devastating blast of grape shot straight into the center of the crowd, cutting a wide path through the living mass. A yell, one I could never have imagined, erupted from the desperate survivors as they ran for the woods. Among the piles of dead lying in the sand, exactly where they had fallen, I could see mutilated bodies writhing in pain. Every now and then, one would rise convulsively from the heap, trying to stagger toward the woods, only to collapse and roll in the bloody sand after just a few steps. My blood ran cold as I watched this horrific and senseless slaughter, but I had little time to reflect because the captain's deep voice called to us across the water: "Pull ashore, lads, and fill your water casks." The men obeyed in silence, and it seemed like even their hardened hearts were shaken by the ruthless act. When we reached the mouth of the stream where we planned to get water, we found it flowing with blood, as many of those who were killed had been standing on the banks upstream. Several of the unfortunate souls had fallen into it, and we discovered one body that had been carried down, wedged between two rocks, its staring eyes looking toward us and its black hair waving in the ripples of the blood-red stream. No one dared to stop our landing now, so we took our casks to a pool above the slaughtered group, filled them, and returned to the ship. Fortunately, a breeze picked up soon after and carried us away from the horrific scene, but it couldn’t carry away the memory of what I had witnessed.

“And this,” thought I, gazing in horror at the captain, who, with a quiet look of indifference, leaned upon the taffrail smoking a cigar and contemplating the fertile green islets as they passed like a lovely picture before our eyes—“this is the man who favours the missionaries because they are useful to him and can tame the savages better than any one else can do it!” Then I wondered in my mind whether it were possible for any missionary to tame him!

“And this,” I thought, staring in shock at the captain, who, with a calm look of indifference, leaned against the railing smoking a cigar and watching the lush green islands drift by like a beautiful painting before us—“this is the guy who supports the missionaries because they’re useful to him and can handle the natives better than anyone else!” Then I wondered to myself if it was even possible for any missionary to tame him!

CHAPTER XXIV.

Bloody Bill is communicative and sagacious—Unpleasant prospects—Retrospective meditations interrupted by volcanic agency—The pirates negotiate with a Feejee chief—Various etceteras that are calculated to surprise and horrify.

Bloody Bill is talkative and wise—Unpleasant possibilities—Reflective thoughts interrupted by explosive events—The pirates make a deal with a Feejee chief—Various other things that are sure to surprise and shock.

It was many days after the events just narrated ere I recovered a little of my wonted spirits. I could not shake off the feeling for a long time that I was in a frightful dream, and the sight of our captain filled me with so much horror that I kept out of his way as much as my duties about the cabin would permit. Fortunately he took so little notice of me that he did not observe my changed feelings towards him, otherwise it might have been worse for me.

It was many days after the events I just described before I started to feel like myself again. I couldn’t shake the feeling for a long time that I was trapped in a terrifying dream, and seeing our captain filled me with such fear that I tried to avoid him as much as my responsibilities in the cabin would allow. Luckily, he paid so little attention to me that he didn’t notice my changed feelings towards him; otherwise, things could have been worse for me.

But I was now resolved that I would run away the very first island we should land at, and commit myself to the hospitality of the natives rather than remain an hour longer than I could help in the pirate schooner. I pondered this subject a good deal, and at last made up my mind to communicate my intention to Bloody Bill; for, during several talks I had had with him of late, I felt assured that he too would willingly escape if possible. When I told him of my design he shook his head. “No, no, Ralph,” said he, “you must not think of running away here. Among some of the groups of islands you might do so with safety, but if you tried it here you would find that you had jumped out of the fryin’ pan into the fire.”

But I was now determined to run away as soon as we landed on the first island, and I'd rather rely on the goodwill of the locals than stay another minute on the pirate ship. I thought about this a lot and finally decided to share my plan with Bloody Bill; after several conversations with him lately, I was convinced he’d also want to escape if he could. When I told him what I was thinking, he shook his head. “No, no, Ralph,” he said, “you can’t think about running away here. In some of the island groups, you might be safe doing that, but if you try it here, you’d end up jumping out of the frying pan and into the fire.”

“How so, Bill?” said I, “would the natives not receive me?”

“How come, Bill?” I asked, “won’t the locals accept me?”

“That they would, lad; but they would eat you too.”

"Sure they would, kid; but they'd eat you too."

“Eat me!” said I in surprise, “I thought the South Sea islanders never ate anybody except their enemies.”

“Eat me!” I said in surprise, “I thought the South Sea islanders only ate their enemies.”

“Humph!” ejaculated Bill. “I s’pose ’twas yer tender-hearted friends in England that put that notion into your head. There’s a set o’ soft-hearted folk at home that I knows on, who don’t like to have their feelin’s ruffled, and when you tell them anything they don’t like—that shocks them, as they call it—no matter how true it be, they stop their ears and cry out, ‘Oh, that is too horrible! We can’t believe that!’ An’ they say truth. They can’t believe it ’cause they won’t believe it. Now, I believe there’s thousands o’ the people in England who are sich born drivellin’ won’t-believers that they think the black fellows hereaway, at the worst, eat an enemy only now an’ then, out o’ spite; whereas, I know for certain, and many captains of the British and American navies know as well as me, that the Feejee islanders eat not only their enemies but one another; and they do it not for spite, but for pleasure. It’s a fact that they prefer human flesh to any other. But they don’t like white men’s flesh so well as black. They say it makes them sick.”

“Humph!” exclaimed Bill. “I guess it was your soft-hearted friends in England who put that idea in your head. There are some sentimental people back home that I know, who don’t want to have their feelings hurt, and when you tell them something they dislike—that shocks them, as they say—no matter how true it is, they cover their ears and yell, ‘Oh, that is too horrible! We can’t believe that!’ And they’re right. They can’t believe it because they won’t believe it. Now, I believe there are thousands of people in England who are such born whiners that they think the native people here only eat an enemy occasionally, out of spite; whereas, I know for sure, and many captains of the British and American navies know just as well as I do, that the Fiji Islanders eat not only their enemies but each other; and they do it not out of spite, but for pleasure. It’s a fact that they prefer human flesh to any other. But they don’t like white men’s flesh as much as black. They say it makes them sick.”

“Why, Bill,” said I, “you told me just now that they would eat me if they caught me.”

“Why, Bill,” I said, “you just told me that they would eat me if they caught me.”

“So I did; and so I think they would. I’ve only heard some o’ them say they don’t like white men so well as black; but if they was hungry they wouldn’t be particular. Anyhow, I’m sure they would kill you. You see, Ralph, I’ve been a good while in them parts, and I’ve visited the different groups of islands oftentimes as a trader. And thorough goin’ blackguards some o’ them traders are. No better than pirates, I can tell you. One captain that I sailed with was not a chip better than the one we’re with now. He was tradin’ with a friendly chief one day, aboard his vessel. The chief had swam off to us with the things for trade tied a-top of his head, for them chaps are like otters in the water. Well, the chief was hard on the captain, and would not part with some o’ his things. When their bargainin’ was over they shook hands, and the chief jumped over board to swim ashore; but before he got forty yards from the ship the captain seized a musket and shot him dead. He then hove up anchor and put to sea, and as we sailed along shore, he dropped six black-fellows with his rifle, remarkin’ that ‘that would spoil the trade for the next comers.’ But, as I was sayin’, I’m up to the ways o’ these fellows. One o’ the laws o’ the country is, that every shipwrecked person who happens to be cast ashore, be he dead or alive, is doomed to be roasted and eaten. There was a small tradin’ schooner wrecked off one of these islands when we were lyin’ there in harbour during a storm. The crew was lost, all but three men, who swam ashore. The moment they landed they were seized by the natives and carried up into the woods. We knew pretty well what their fate would be, but we could not help them, for our crew was small, and if we had gone ashore they would likely have killed us all. We never saw the three men again; but we heard frightful yelling, and dancing, and merry-making that night; and one of the natives, who came aboard to trade with us next day, told us that the long pigs, as he called the men, had been roasted and eaten, and their bones were to be converted into sail needles. He also said that white men were bad to eat, and that most o’ the people on shore were sick.”

“So I did; and I think they would too. I’ve only heard some of them say they don’t like white men as much as black; but if they were hungry, they wouldn’t be picky. Anyway, I’m sure they would kill you. You see, Ralph, I’ve been in those parts for a while, and I’ve visited the different groups of islands many times as a trader. And some of those traders are really lowlifes. No better than pirates, I can tell you. One captain I sailed with was no better than the one we’re with now. He was trading with a friendly chief one day on his vessel. The chief had swum out to us with goods for trade balanced on top of his head, since those guys are like otters in the water. Well, the chief was tough on the captain and wouldn’t give up some of his things. After they finished bargaining, they shook hands, and the chief jumped overboard to swim ashore; but before he got forty yards from the ship, the captain grabbed a musket and shot him dead. He then hoisted anchor and set sail, and as we sailed along the shore, he shot six locals with his rifle, saying that ‘that would spoil the trade for the next arrivals.’ But, as I was saying, I know the ways of these guys. One of the laws of the land is that every shipwrecked person who washes ashore, alive or dead, is destined to be roasted and eaten. There was a small trading schooner wrecked off one of these islands while we were anchored there during a storm. The crew was lost, except for three men who swam ashore. The moment they landed, they were seized by the natives and taken up into the woods. We pretty much knew what their fate would be, but we could not help them because our crew was small, and if we had gone ashore, they likely would have killed us all. We never saw the three men again; but that night, we heard terrible yelling, dancing, and partying; and one of the natives who came aboard to trade with us the next day told us that the ‘long pigs,’ as he called the men, had been roasted and eaten, and their bones were to be turned into sail needles. He also said that white men were bad to eat, and that most of the people on shore were sick.”

I was very much shocked and cast down in my mind at this terrible account of the natives, and asked Bill what he would advise me to do. Looking round the deck to make sure that we were not overheard, he lowered his voice and said, “There are two or three ways that we might escape, Ralph, but none o’ them’s easy. If the captain would only sail for some o’ the islands near Tahiti, we might run away there well enough, because the natives are all Christians; an’ we find that wherever the savages take up with Christianity they always give over their bloody ways, and are safe to be trusted. I never cared for Christianity myself,” he continued, in a soliloquising voice, “and I don’t well know what it means; but a man with half an eye can see what it does for these black critters. However, the captain always keeps a sharp look out after us when we get to these islands, for he half suspects that one or two o’ us are tired of his company. Then, we might manage to cut the boat adrift some fine night when it’s our watch on deck, and clear off before they discovered that we were gone. But we would run the risk o’ bein’ caught by the blacks. I wouldn’t like to try that plan. But you and I will think over it, Ralph, and see what’s to be done. In the meantime it’s our watch below, so I’ll go and turn in.”

I was really shocked and down in my mind after hearing this terrible story about the locals, so I asked Bill what he thought I should do. He looked around the deck to make sure we weren't being overheard, then lowered his voice and said, “There are a couple of ways we might get away, Ralph, but none of them are easy. If the captain would just sail to some of the islands near Tahiti, we could easily escape there since the locals are all Christians; and we’ve noticed that wherever the savages adopt Christianity, they tend to drop their violent ways and are safe to trust. I’ve never cared for Christianity myself,” he continued, speaking to himself, “and I don’t really know what it means; but anyone with half a brain can see what it does for these people. However, the captain always keeps a close eye on us when we reach these islands because he suspects that one or two of us want to leave his company. We could also try cutting the boat loose on a nice night while it’s our watch, and slip away before they realize we’re gone. But we’d risk getting caught by the locals. I really wouldn’t want to try that. But you and I can think it over, Ralph, and figure out what to do. In the meantime, it’s our watch below, so I’m going to go get some sleep.”

Bill then bade me good night, and went below, while a comrade took his place at the helm; but, feeling no desire to enter into conversation with him, I walked aft, and, leaning over the stern, looked down into the phosphorescent waves that gargled around the ladder, and streamed out like a flame of blue light in the vessel’s wake. My thoughts were very sad, and I could scarce refrain from tears as I contrasted my present wretched position with the happy, peaceful time, I had spent on the Coral Island with my dear companions. As I thought upon Jack and Peterkin anxious forebodings crossed my mind, and I pictured to myself the grief and dismay with which they would search every nook and corner of the island, in a vain attempt to discover my dead body; for I felt assured that if they did not see any sign of the pirate schooner or boat, when they came out of the cave to look for me, they would never imagine that I had been carried away. I wondered, too, how Jack would succeed in getting Peterkin out of the cave without my assistance; and I trembled when I thought that he might lose presence of mind, and begin to kick when he was in the tunnel! These thoughts were suddenly interrupted and put to flight by a bright red blaze which lighted up the horizon to the southward, and cut a crimson glow far over the sea. This appearance was accompanied by a low growling sound, as of distant thunder, and, at the same time, the sky above us became black, while a hot stifling wind blew around us in fitful gusts.

Bill then said good night to me and went below deck, while a shipmate took his place at the helm; however, not wanting to chat with him, I walked to the back of the boat and leaned over the stern, gazing down at the glowing waves that splashed around the ladder, streaming out like a flame of blue light in the ship’s wake. My thoughts were very sad, and I could barely hold back tears as I compared my current miserable situation to the happy, peaceful time I had spent on Coral Island with my dear friends. As I thought about Jack and Peterkin, anxious worries filled my mind, and I imagined the grief and despair they would feel searching every nook and cranny of the island, desperately trying to find my lifeless body; I was certain that if they didn’t see any sign of the pirate schooner or boat when they emerged from the cave to look for me, they would never suspect that I had been taken away. I also wondered how Jack would manage to get Peterkin out of the cave without my help, and I shuddered at the thought that he might panic and start kicking while they were in the tunnel! These thoughts were suddenly interrupted by a bright red blaze lighting up the southern horizon, casting a crimson glow far across the sea. This sight came with a low rumbling sound, like distant thunder, and at the same time, the sky above us turned dark, while a hot, suffocating wind blew around us in sudden gusts.

The crew assembled hastily on deck, and most of them were under the belief that a frightful hurricane was pending; but the captain coming on deck, soon explained the phenomena.

The crew gathered quickly on deck, and most of them thought a terrible hurricane was coming; but when the captain arrived on deck, he soon explained what was happening.

“It’s only a volcano,” said he. “I knew there was one hereabouts, but thought it was extinct. Up there and furl top-gallant-sails; we’ll likely have a breeze, and it’s well to be ready.”

“It’s just a volcano,” he said. “I knew there was one around here, but I thought it was extinct. Let’s go up and furl the topsails; we’ll probably catch a breeze, and it’s good to be prepared.”

As he spoke, a shower began to fall, which we quickly observed was not rain, but fine ashes. As we were many miles distant from the volcano, these must have been carried to us from it by the wind. As the captain had predicted, a stiff breeze soon afterwards sprang up, under the influence of which we speedily left the volcano far behind us; but during the greater part of the night we could see its lurid glare and hear its distant thunder. The shower did not cease to fall for several hours, and we must have sailed under it for nearly forty miles, perhaps farther. When we emerged from the cloud, our decks and every part of the rigging were completely covered with a thick coat of ashes. I was much interested in this, and recollected that Jack had often spoken of many of the islands of the Pacific as being volcanoes, either active or extinct, and had said that the whole region was more or less volcanic, and that some scientific men were of opinion that the islands of the Pacific were nothing more or less than the mountain tops of a huge continent which had sunk under the influence of volcanic agency.

As he spoke, a shower started to fall, which we quickly realized wasn’t rain but fine ashes. Since we were many miles away from the volcano, these must have been carried to us by the wind. Just as the captain had predicted, a strong breeze soon picked up, helping us to quickly leave the volcano behind; but for most of the night, we could see its eerie glow and hear its distant rumble. The shower didn’t stop for several hours, and we must have traveled under it for nearly forty miles, maybe even farther. When we finally came out from under the cloud, our decks and all the rigging were completely coated with a thick layer of ashes. I found this really fascinating, and I remembered that Jack had often talked about many of the islands in the Pacific being volcanoes, either active or dormant, and he’d said that the whole region was more or less volcanic. Some scientists believe that the Pacific islands are just the mountain peaks of a massive continent that sank due to volcanic activity.

Three days after passing the volcano, we found ourselves a few miles to windward of an island of considerable size and luxuriant aspect. It consisted of two mountains, which seemed to be nearly four thousand feet high. They were separated from each other by a broad valley, whose thick-growing trees ascended a considerable distance up the mountain sides; and rich level plains, or meadow-land, spread round the base of the mountains, except at the point immediately opposite the large valley, where a river seemed to carry the trees, as it were, along with it down to the white sandy shore. The mountain tops, unlike those of our Coral Island, were sharp, needle-shaped, and bare, while their sides were more rugged and grand in outline than anything I had yet seen in those seas. Bloody Bill was beside me when the island first hove in sight.

Three days after we passed the volcano, we found ourselves a few miles upwind of a large and lush island. It had two mountains that seemed to be nearly four thousand feet tall. They were separated by a wide valley, filled with thick trees that climbed a good way up the mountainsides. Rich, flat plains or meadows spread around the base of the mountains, except for the area directly across from the big valley, where a river appeared to carry the trees along with it down to the white sandy shore. Unlike the peaks of our Coral Island, the mountain tops here were sharp, needle-like, and bare, while their sides were more rugged and impressive than anything I had seen in those waters. Bloody Bill was next to me when we first spotted the island.

“Ha!” he exclaimed, “I know that island well. They call it Emo.”

“Ha!” he said, “I know that island well. They call it Emo.”

“Have you been here before, then?” I inquired.

“Have you been here before?” I asked.

“Ay, that I have, often, and so has this schooner. ’Tis a famous island for sandal-wood. We have taken many cargoes off it already, and have paid for them too; for the savages are so numerous that we dared not try to take it by force. But our captain has tried to cheat them so often, that they’re beginnin’ not to like us overmuch now. Besides, the men behaved ill the last time we were here; and I wonder the captain is not afraid to venture. But he’s afraid o’ nothing earthly, I believe.”

“Yeah, I have, a lot, and so has this schooner. It’s a famous island for sandalwood. We’ve already taken many loads from it and have paid for them too because there are so many natives that we didn’t dare to try to take it by force. But our captain has tried to cheat them so often that they’re starting not to like us very much now. Also, the crew acted badly the last time we were here, and I wonder why the captain isn’t afraid to take the risk. But I believe he’s afraid of nothing on this earth.”

We soon ran inside the barrier coral-reef, and let go our anchor in six fathoms water, just opposite the mouth of a small creek, whose shores were densely covered with mangroves and tall umbrageous trees. The principal village of the natives lay about half a mile from this point. Ordering the boat out, the captain jumped into it, and ordered me to follow him. The men, fifteen in number, were well armed; and the mate was directed to have Long Tom ready for emergencies.

We quickly moved inside the coral reef and dropped our anchor in six fathoms of water, right across from the entrance of a small creek. The banks were thick with mangroves and tall, shady trees. The main village of the locals was about half a mile from there. I was told to get into the boat after the captain jumped in. The crew, which consisted of fifteen well-armed men, was instructed to have Long Tom ready for any emergencies.

“Give way, lads,” cried the captain.

“Make way, guys,” shouted the captain.

The oars fell into the water at the word, the boat shot from the schooner’s side, and in a few minutes reached the shore. Here, contrary to our expectation, we were met with the utmost cordiality by Romata, the principal chief of the island, who conducted us to his house, and gave us mats to sit upon. I observed in passing that the natives, of whom there were two or three thousand, were totally unarmed.

The oars hit the water at the signal, and the boat quickly moved away from the side of the schooner, reaching the shore in just a few minutes. To our surprise, we were greeted with warm hospitality by Romata, the main chief of the island, who took us to his home and provided us with mats to sit on. As we passed by, I noticed that the locals, numbering around two or three thousand, were completely unarmed.

After a short preliminary palaver, a feast of baked pigs and various roots was spread before us; of which we partook sparingly, and then proceeded to business. The captain stated his object in visiting the island, regretted that there had been a slight misunderstanding during the last visit, and hoped that no ill-will was borne by either party, and that a satisfactory trade would be accomplished.

After a brief introductory chat, a feast of roasted pigs and different root vegetables was laid out for us; we ate modestly and then got down to business. The captain explained his purpose for coming to the island, expressed regret for a minor misunderstanding during the last visit, and hoped that neither side held any grudges and that a successful trade could be achieved.

Romata answered that he had forgotten there had been any differences between them, protested that he was delighted to see his friends again, and assured them they should have every assistance in cutting and embarking the wood. The terms were afterwards agreed on, and we rose to depart. All this conversation was afterwards explained to me by Bill, who understood the language pretty well.

Romata replied that he had forgotten there were any issues between them, expressed that he was happy to see his friends again, and assured them they would have all the help they needed in cutting and loading the wood. The terms were later agreed upon, and we got ready to leave. Bill explained all this conversation to me afterward, as he understood the language quite well.

Romata accompanied us on board, and explained that a great chief from another island was then on a visit to him, and that he was to be ceremoniously entertained on the following day. After begging to be allowed to introduce him to us, and receiving permission, he sent his canoe ashore to bring him off. At the same time he gave orders to bring on board his two favourites, a cock and a paroquet. While the canoe was gone on this errand, I had time to regard the savage chief attentively. He was a man of immense size, with massive but beautifully moulded limbs and figure, only parts of which, the broad chest and muscular arms, were uncovered; for, although the lower orders generally wore no other clothing than a strip of cloth called maro round their loins, the chief, on particular occasions, wrapped his person in voluminous folds of a species of native cloth made from the bark of the Chinese paper-mulberry. Romata wore a magnificent black beard and moustache, and his hair was frizzed out to such an extent that it resembled a large turban, in which was stuck a long wooden pin! I afterwards found that this pin served for scratching the head, for which purpose the fingers were too short without disarranging the hair. But Romata put himself to much greater inconvenience on account of his hair, for we found that he slept with his head resting on a wooden pillow, in which was cut a hollow for the neck, so that the hair of the sleeper might not be disarranged.

Romata came on board with us and explained that a great chief from another island was visiting him and was going to be ceremoniously entertained the next day. After asking if he could introduce him to us and getting permission, he sent his canoe to shore to bring him over. At the same time, he ordered his two favorites, a rooster and a parakeet, to be brought on board. While the canoe was gone, I had time to carefully observe the savage chief. He was a huge man, with strong but beautifully shaped limbs and body, though only parts of him—his broad chest and muscular arms—were uncovered. The lower class generally wore just a strip of cloth called maro around their waists, but the chief, on special occasions, wrapped himself in large folds of a type of native cloth made from the bark of the Chinese paper-mulberry. Romata had a magnificent black beard and mustache, and his hair was frizzed out so much that it looked like a large turban, with a long wooden pin sticking out of it! I later discovered that this pin was used for scratching his head since his fingers were too short to reach without messing up his hair. But Romata had even more trouble because we found out he slept with his head on a wooden pillow that had a hollow cut out for his neck, so his hair wouldn’t get messed up while he slept.

In ten minutes the canoe returned, bringing the other chief, who certainly presented a most extraordinary appearance, having painted one half of his face red and the other half yellow, besides ornamenting it with various designs in black! Otherwise he was much the same in appearance as Romata, though not so powerfully built. As this chief had never seen a ship before, except, perchance, some of the petty traders that at long intervals visit these remote islands, he was much taken up with the neatness and beauty of all the fittings of the schooner. He was particularly struck with a musket which was shown to him, and asked where the white men got hatchets hard enough to cut the tree of which the barrel was made! While he was thus engaged, his brother chief stood aloof, talking with the captain, and fondling a superb cock and a little blue-headed paroquet, the favourites of which I have before spoken. I observed that all the other natives walked in a crouching posture while in the presence of Romata. Before our guests left us, the captain ordered the brass gun to be uncovered and fired for their gratification; and I have every reason to believe he did so for the purpose of showing our superior power, in case the natives should harbour any evil designs against us. Romata had never seen this gun before, as it had not been uncovered on previous visits, and the astonishment with which he viewed it was very amusing. Being desirous of knowing its power, he begged that the captain would fire it. So a shot was put into it. The chiefs were then directed to look at a rock about two miles out at sea, and the gun was fired. In a second the top of the rock was seen to burst asunder, and to fall in fragments into the sea.

In ten minutes, the canoe came back, bringing the other chief, who had a really striking look. He had painted one half of his face red and the other half yellow, and there were various black designs on it! Other than that, he looked a lot like Romata, though he wasn’t as muscular. Since this chief had never seen a ship before, except maybe for the small traders that occasionally visit these remote islands, he was really impressed by how neat and beautiful all the schooner's fittings were. He was especially fascinated by a musket we showed him and asked where the white people got axes strong enough to cut the tree the barrel was made from! While he was busy with that, his brother chief stood off to the side, chatting with the captain and playing with a magnificent rooster and a cute little blue-headed parakeet that I've mentioned before. I noticed that all the other natives walked with a crouched posture around Romata. Before our guests left, the captain had the brass gun uncovered and fired it for their enjoyment; I believe he did this to demonstrate our superior power in case the natives had any hostile intentions. Romata had never seen this gun before since it hadn’t been uncovered during prior visits, and his astonishment at it was quite entertaining. Curious about its power, he asked the captain to fire it. So, a shot was loaded. The chiefs were then asked to look at a rock about two miles out at sea, and the gun was fired. In an instant, the top of the rock exploded, breaking apart and falling into the sea.

Romata was so delighted with the success of this shot, that he pointed to a man who was walking on the shore, and begged the captain to fire at him, evidently supposing that his permission was quite sufficient to justify the captain in such an act. He was therefore surprised, and not a little annoyed, when the captain refused to fire at the native, and ordered the gun to be housed.

Romata was so thrilled with the success of this shot that he pointed to a man walking on the shore and asked the captain to shoot at him, clearly thinking that his permission was enough to make it okay. He was therefore surprised and a bit annoyed when the captain refused to shoot the native and ordered the gun to be put away.

Of all the things, however, that afforded matter of amusement to these savages, that which pleased Romata’s visitor most was the ship’s pump. He never tired of examining it, and pumping up the water. Indeed, so much was he taken up with this pump, that he could not be prevailed on to return on shore, but sent a canoe to fetch his favourite stool, on which he seated himself, and spent the remainder of the day in pumping the bilge-water out of the ship!

Of all the things that amused these savages, the one that entertained Romata’s visitor the most was the ship’s pump. He couldn’t get enough of checking it out and pumping up the water. In fact, he was so captivated by this pump that he wouldn’t be convinced to go back to shore and instead sent a canoe to bring his favorite stool, which he sat on, spending the rest of the day pumping the bilge water out of the ship!

Next day the crew went ashore to cut sandal-wood, while the captain, with one or two men, remained on board, in order to be ready, if need be, with the brass gun, which was unhoused and conspicuously elevated, with its capacious muzzle directed point blank at the chief’s house. The men were fully armed as usual; and the captain ordered me to go with them, to assist in the work. I was much pleased with this order, for it freed me from the captain’s company, which I could not now endure, and it gave me an opportunity of seeing the natives.

The next day, the crew went ashore to cut sandalwood, while the captain, along with one or two men, stayed on board to be ready, if necessary, with the brass gun, which was set up and clearly visible, aimed directly at the chief’s house. The men were fully armed as usual, and the captain told me to go with them to help with the work. I was very happy with this order because it got me away from the captain’s company, which I could no longer stand, and it gave me a chance to see the locals.

As we wound along in single file through the rich fragrant groves of banana, cocoa-nut, bread-fruit, and other trees, I observed that there were many of the plum and banian trees, with which I had become familiar on the Coral Island. I noticed also large quantities of taro-roots, yams, and sweet potatoes, growing in enclosures. On turning into an open glade of the woods, we came abruptly upon a cluster of native houses. They were built chiefly of bamboos, and were thatched with the large thick leaves of the pandanus; but many of them had little more than a sloping roof and three sides with an open front, being the most simple shelter from the weather that could well be imagined. Within these, and around them, were groups of natives—men, women, and children—who all stood up to gaze at us as we marched along, followed by the party of men whom the chief had sent to escort us. About half a mile inland we arrived at the spot where the sandal-wood grew, and, while the men set to work, I clambered up an adjoining hill to observe the country.

As we walked in a single line through the fragrant groves of banana, coconut, breadfruit, and other trees, I noticed many of the plum and banyan trees that I had recognized from Coral Island. I also saw a lot of taro roots, yams, and sweet potatoes growing in fenced areas. When we turned into an open clearing in the woods, we suddenly came across a cluster of native houses. They were mostly made of bamboo and thatched with large thick leaves from the pandanus. However, many of them had little more than a sloping roof and three walls with an open front, providing the simplest form of shelter from the weather imaginable. Inside and around these houses were groups of natives—men, women, and children—who all stood up to watch us as we marched by, followed by a group of men that the chief had sent to guide us. About half a mile inland, we reached the area where the sandalwood grew, and while the men got to work, I climbed up a nearby hill to take in the view of the landscape.

About mid-day, the chief arrived with several followers, one of whom carried a baked pig on a wooden platter, with yams and potatoes on several plantain leaves, which he presented to the men, who sat down under the shade of a tree to dine. The chief sat down to dine also; but, to my surprise, instead of feeding himself, one of his wives performed that office for him! I was seated beside Bill, and asked him the reason of this.

About midday, the chief arrived with several followers, one of whom carried a roasted pig on a wooden platter, along with yams and potatoes on several plantain leaves, which he offered to the men seated under the shade of a tree to eat. The chief also took a seat to eat; but, to my surprise, instead of serving himself, one of his wives did that for him! I was sitting next to Bill and asked him why this was the case.

“It is beneath his dignity, I believe, to feed himself,” answered Bill; “but I daresay he’s not particular, except on great occasions. They’ve a strange custom among them, Ralph, which is called tabu, and they carry it to great lengths. If a man chooses a particular tree for his god, the fruit o’ that tree is tabued to him; and if he eats it, he is sure to be killed by his people, and eaten, of course, for killing means eating hereaway. Then, you see that great mop o’ hair on the chief’s head? Well, he has a lot o’ barbers to keep it in order; and it’s a law that whoever touches the head of a living chief or the body of a dead one, his hands are tabued; so, in that way, the barbers’ hands are always tabued, and they daren’t use them for their lives, but have to be fed like big babies, as they are, sure enough!”

“It’s beneath his dignity, I think, to feed himself,” Bill replied. “But I guess he doesn’t mind, except on special occasions. They have a weird tradition among them, Ralph, called tabu, and they take it very seriously. If a man selects a specific tree as his god, the fruit from that tree is off-limits to him; if he eats it, his people will definitely kill him and, of course, eat him too, because killing means eating around here. Now, you see that big mop of hair on the chief’s head? He has a bunch of barbers to take care of it, and there’s a rule that whoever touches the head of a living chief or the body of a dead one has their hands made tabu; so, because of this, the barbers' hands are always tabu, and they can’t use them for anything, meaning they have to be fed like big babies, which they certainly are!”

“That’s odd, Bill. But look there,” said I, pointing to a man whose skin was of a much lighter colour than the generality of the natives. “I’ve seen a few of these light-skinned fellows among the Fejeeans. They seem to me to be of quite a different race.”

“That’s strange, Bill. But look over there,” I said, pointing to a man whose skin was much lighter than that of the other locals. “I’ve seen a few of these light-skinned guys among the Fijians. They seem to me to be from a completely different race.”

“So they are,” answered Bill. “These fellows come from the Tongan Islands, which lie a long way to the eastward. They come here to build their big war-canoes; and as these take two, and sometimes four years, to build, there’s always some o’ the brown-skins among the black sarpents o’ these islands.”

“So they are,” replied Bill. “These guys come from the Tongan Islands, which are quite a distance to the east. They come here to build their large war canoes; and since these take two, and sometimes even four years, to build, there are always some of the brown-skinned folks among the black serpents of these islands.”

“By the way, Bill,” said I, “your mentioning serpents, reminds me that I have not seen a reptile of any kind since I came to this part of the world.”

“By the way, Bill,” I said, “your mention of snakes reminds me that I haven’t seen any reptiles at all since I got to this part of the world.”

“No more there are any,” said Bill, “if ye except the niggers themselves, there’s none on the islands, but a lizard or two and some sich harmless things. But I never seed any myself. If there’s none on the land, however, there’s more than enough in the water, and that minds me of a wonderful brute they have here. But, come, I’ll show it to you.” So saying, Bill arose, and, leaving the men still busy with the baked pig, led me into the forest. After proceeding a short distance we came upon a small pond of stagnant water. A native lad had followed us, to whom we called and beckoned him to come to us. On Bill saying a few words to him, which I did not understand, the boy advanced to the edge of the pond, and gave a low peculiar whistle. Immediately the water became agitated and an enormous eel thrust its head above the surface and allowed the youth to touch it. It was about twelve feet long, and as thick round the body as a man’s thigh.

“No more here are there,” said Bill, “other than the locals themselves, there’s none on the islands, just a lizard or two and some harmless things. But I’ve never seen any myself. If there aren’t any on the land, though, there’s plenty in the water, and that reminds me of an amazing creature they have here. But come on, I’ll show it to you.” With that, Bill got up and, leaving the men busy with the roasted pig, led me into the forest. After walking a short distance, we came across a small pond of stagnant water. A local boy had followed us, so we called him over. After Bill said a few words to him, which I didn’t understand, the boy approached the edge of the pond and let out a low, unique whistle. Immediately, the water started to ripple, and a huge eel lifted its head above the surface, letting the boy touch it. It was about twelve feet long and as thick around as a man’s thigh.

“There,” said Bill, his lip curling with contempt, “what do you think of that for a god, Ralph? This is one o’ their gods, and it has been fed with dozens o’ livin’ babies already. How many more it’ll get afore it dies is hard to say.”

“There,” Bill said, his lip curling in disdain, “what do you think of that for a god, Ralph? This is one of their gods, and it has already been fed with dozens of living babies. It’s hard to say how many more it’ll get before it dies."

“Babies?” said I, with an incredulous look

"Babies?" I asked, sounding shocked.

“Ay, babies,” returned Bill. “Your soft-hearted folk at home would say, ‘Oh, horrible! impossible!’ to that, and then go away as comfortable and unconcerned as if their sayin’ ‘horrible! impossible!’ had made it a lie. But I tell you, Ralph, it’s a fact. I’ve seed it with my own eyes the last time I was here, an’ mayhap if you stop a while at this accursed place, and keep a sharp look out, you’ll see it too. They don’t feed it regularly with livin’ babies, but they give it one now and then as a treat. Bah! you brute!’ cried Bill, in disgust, giving the reptile a kick on the snout with his heavy boot, that sent it sweltering back in agony into its loathsome pool. I thought it lucky for Bill, indeed for all of us, that the native youth’s back happened to be turned at the time, for I am certain that if the poor savages had come to know that we had so rudely handled their god, we should have had to fight our way back to the ship. As we retraced our steps I questioned my companion further on this subject.

“Yeah, babies,” Bill replied. “Your soft-hearted folks back home would say, ‘Oh, that’s terrible! No way!’ to that, and then walk away feeling all comfortable and unconcerned as if their saying ‘terrible! No way!’ made it untrue. But I tell you, Ralph, it’s a fact. I saw it with my own eyes the last time I was here, and maybe if you hang around this cursed place for a bit and keep a close eye out, you’ll see it too. They don’t feed it living babies regularly, but they give it one now and then as a treat. Ugh! you monster!” Bill shouted in disgust, kicking the reptile on the snout with his heavy boot, sending it thrashing back into its disgusting pool. I thought it was lucky for Bill, and for all of us, that the local guy’s back happened to be turned at that moment because I’m sure if the poor natives had known we had so rudely treated their god, we would have had to fight our way back to the ship. As we made our way back, I asked my companion more about this.

“How comes it, Bill, that the mothers allow such a dreadful thing to be done?”

“How is it, Bill, that the mothers let such an awful thing happen?”

“Allow it? the mothers do it! It seems to me that there’s nothing too fiendish or diabolical for these people to do. Why, in some of the islands they have an institution called the Areoi, and the persons connected with that body are ready for any wickedness that mortal man can devise. In fact they stick at nothing; and one o’ their customs is to murder their infants the moment they are born. The mothers agree to it, and the fathers do it. And the mildest ways they have of murdering them is by sticking them through the body with sharp splinters of bamboo, strangling them with their thumbs, or burying them alive and stamping them to death while under the sod.”

“Allow it? The mothers do it! It seems to me that there’s nothing too wicked or evil for these people to do. In fact, in some of the islands, they have an institution called the Areoi, and the people involved with it are ready for any kind of depravity a person can think of. They won’t hold back at anything; one of their customs is to kill their newborns the moment they are born. The mothers agree to it, and the fathers carry it out. The mildest methods they use to murder them involve stabbing them with sharp bamboo splinters, strangling them with their thumbs, or burying them alive and stomping them to death while they’re under the ground.”

I felt sick at heart while my companion recited these horrors.

I felt a knot in my stomach while my friend talked about these awful things.

“But it’s a curious fact,” he continued, after a pause, during which we walked in silence towards the spot where we had left our comrades,—“it’s a curious fact, that wherever the missionaries get a footin’ all these things come to an end at once, an’ the savages take to doin’ each other good, and singin’ psalms, just like Methodists.”

“But it’s an interesting fact,” he continued, after a pause, during which we walked in silence toward the spot where we had left our friends, “it’s an interesting fact that wherever the missionaries gain a foothold, all these things come to an end immediately, and the natives start doing good for each other and singing hymns, just like Methodists.”

“God bless the missionaries!” said I, while a feeling of enthusiasm filled my heart, so that I could speak with difficulty. “God bless and prosper the missionaries till they get a footing in every island of the sea!”

“God bless the missionaries!” I exclaimed, my heart filled with enthusiasm so much that I could hardly speak. “God bless and support the missionaries until they establish a presence on every island in the ocean!”

“I would say Amen to that prayer, Ralph, if I could,” said Bill, in a deep, sad voice; “but it would be a mere mockery for a man to ask a blessing for others who dare not ask one for himself. But, Ralph,” he continued, “I’ve not told you half o’ the abominations I have seen durin’ my life in these seas. If we pull long together, lad, I’ll tell you more; and if times have not changed very much since I was here last, it’s like that you’ll have a chance o’ seeing a little for yourself before long.”

“I would say Amen to that prayer, Ralph, if I could,” Bill said in a deep, sad voice. “But it would just be a mockery for a man to ask for a blessing for others when he can’t ask one for himself. But, Ralph,” he continued, “I haven’t told you half of the horrors I’ve seen during my life at sea. If we stick together, kid, I’ll share more with you, and if things haven’t changed too much since I was here last, you’ll probably get a chance to see a bit for yourself soon.”

CHAPTER XXV.

The Sandal-wood party—Native children’s games, somewhat surprising—Desperate amusements suddenly and fatally brought to a close—An old friend recognised—News—Romata’s mad conduct.

The Sandalwood party—native children's games, a bit unexpected—desperate fun suddenly and tragically cut short—an old friend recognized—news—Romata's crazy behavior.

Next day the wood-cutting party went ashore again, and I accompanied them as before. During the dinner hour I wandered into the woods alone, being disinclined for food that day. I had not rambled far when I found myself unexpectedly on the sea-shore, having crossed a narrow neck of land which separated the native village from a large bay. Here I found a party of the islanders busy with one of their war-canoes, which was almost ready for launching. I stood for a long time watching this party with great interest, and observed that they fastened the timbers and planks to each other very much in the same way in which I had seen Jack fasten those of our little boat. But what surprised me most was its immense length, which I measured very carefully, and found to be a hundred feet long; and it was so capacious that it could have held three hundred men. It had the unwieldy out-rigger and enormously high stern-posts which I had remarked on the canoe that came to us while I was on the Coral Island. Observing some boys playing at games a short way along the beach, I resolved to go and watch them; but as I turned from the natives who were engaged so busily and cheerfully at their work, I little thought of the terrible event that hung on the completion of that war-canoe.

The next day, the wood-cutting crew went ashore again, and I went along with them like before. During lunch, I ventured into the woods alone because I just wasn't in the mood for food that day. I hadn’t gone far when I unexpectedly found myself at the shore, having crossed a narrow strip of land that separated the village from a big bay. Here, I saw a group of islanders busy with one of their war canoes, which was nearly ready to launch. I stood there for a long time, watching them with great interest, and noticed that they fastened the wood and planks together much like I had seen Jack do with our little boat. But what surprised me the most was its incredible length; I measured it carefully and found it was a hundred feet long, and it was so spacious that it could hold three hundred men. It had the bulky outrigger and very high stern-posts that I remembered from the canoe that visited us while I was on Coral Island. Noticing some boys playing games a little way down the beach, I decided to go watch them. But as I turned away from the natives who were so happily and busily working, I had no idea of the awful event that awaited the completion of that war canoe.

Advancing towards the children, who were so numerous that I began to think this must be the general play-ground of the village, I sat down on a grassy bank under the shade of a plantain-tree, to watch them. And a happier or more noisy crew I have never seen. There were at least two hundred of them, both boys and girls, all of whom were clad in no other garments than their own glossy little black skins, except the maro, or strip of cloth round the loins of the boys, and a very short petticoat or kilt on the girls. They did not all play at the same game, but amused themselves in different groups.

Advancing towards the children, who were so many that I began to think this must be the main playground of the village, I sat down on a grassy bank under the shade of a plantain tree to watch them. I’ve never seen a happier or noisier group. There were at least two hundred of them, both boys and girls, all wearing nothing but their shiny black skin, except for the maro, or strip of cloth around the boys' waists, and a very short skirt or kilt on the girls. They weren’t all playing the same game but were having fun in different groups.

One band was busily engaged in a game exactly similar to our blind-man’s-buff. Another set were walking on stilts, which raised the children three feet from the ground. They were very expert at this amusement and seldom tumbled. In another place I observed a group of girls standing together, and apparently enjoying themselves very much; so I went up to see what they were doing, and found that they were opening their eye-lids with their fingers till their eyes appeared of an enormous size, and then thrusting pieces of straw between the upper and lower lids, across the eye-ball, to keep them in that position! This seemed to me, I must confess, a very foolish as well as dangerous amusement. Nevertheless the children seemed to be greatly delighted with the hideous faces they made. I pondered this subject a good deal, and thought that if little children knew how silly they seem to grown-up people when they make faces, they would not be so fond of doing it. In another place were a number of boys engaged in flying kites, and I could not help wondering that some of the games of those little savages should be so like to our own, although they had never seen us at play. But the kites were different from ours in many respects, being of every variety of shape. They were made of very thin cloth, and the boys raised them to a wonderful height in the air by means of twine made from the cocoa-nut husk. Other games there were, some of which showed the natural depravity of the hearts of these poor savages, and made me wish fervently that missionaries might be sent out to them. But the amusement which the greatest number of the children of both sexes seemed to take chief delight in, was swimming and diving in the sea; and the expertness which they exhibited was truly amazing. They seemed to have two principal games in the water, one of which was to dive off a sort of stage which had been erected near a deep part of the sea, and chase each other in the water. Some of them went down to an extraordinary depth; others skimmed along the surface, or rolled over and over like porpoises, or diving under each other, came up unexpectedly and pulled each other down by a leg or an arm. They never seemed to tire of this sport, and, from the great heat of the water in the South Seas, they could remain in it nearly all day without feeling chilled. Many of these children were almost infants, scarce able to walk; yet they staggered down the beach, flung their round fat little black bodies fearlessly into deep water, and struck out to sea with as much confidence as ducklings.

One group was busy playing a game just like our blind man's buff. Another group was walking on stilts, which lifted the kids three feet off the ground. They were really good at this activity and hardly ever fell. In another spot, I saw a group of girls standing together, clearly having a great time, so I went over to see what they were up to. I found out that they were using their fingers to open their eyelids until their eyes looked huge, and then shoving pieces of straw between their upper and lower lids, across their eyeballs, to keep them that way! I have to admit, I thought this was a pretty foolish and dangerous game. Still, the kids seemed to really enjoy the goofy faces they made. I thought about this for a while and figured that if little kids understood how silly they looked to adults when they made faces, they wouldn’t be so eager to do it. In another area, a bunch of boys were flying kites, and I couldn't help but find it interesting that some of the games these little kids played were so similar to ours, even though they had never seen us playing. However, their kites were different from ours in many ways, coming in all sorts of shapes. They were made from very thin cloth, and the boys got them up to incredible heights using twine made from coconut husks. There were other games too, some of which showed the natural mischief in these poor kids, and I wished earnestly that missionaries could be sent to them. But the activity that most of the children, both boys and girls, seemed to love the most was swimming and diving in the sea; their skills were truly impressive. They appeared to have two main games in the water: one was diving off a sort of platform built near a deep part of the sea and chasing each other around. Some of them dove to impressive depths; others skimmed along the surface, rolled over like dolphins, or dove underneath and popped up unexpectedly to pull each other down by a leg or an arm. They never seemed to get tired of this fun, and because the water in the South Seas was so warm, they could stay in it nearly all day without getting cold. Many of these kids were still almost babies, barely able to walk; yet they stumbled down the beach, boldly launched their plump little black bodies into the deep water, and swam out to sea with as much confidence as ducklings.

The other game to which I have referred was swimming in the surf. But as this is an amusement in which all engage, from children of ten to gray-headed men of sixty, and as I had an opportunity of witnessing it in perfection the day following, I shall describe it more minutely.

The other activity I mentioned was swimming in the waves. Since this is something everyone participates in, from ten-year-old kids to sixty-year-old men, and since I got to see it done perfectly the next day, I’ll describe it in more detail.

I suppose it was in honour of their guest that this grand swimming-match was got up, for Romata came and told the captain that they were going to engage in it, and begged him to “come and see.”

I guess this big swimming match was organized to honor their guest, because Romata came and told the captain that they were going to participate in it, and asked him to "come and see."

“What sort of amusement is this surf swimming?” I inquired of Bill, as we walked together to a part of the shore on which several thousands of the natives were assembled.

“What kind of fun is this surf swimming?” I asked Bill as we walked together to a spot on the beach where thousands of locals had gathered.

“It’s a very favourite lark with these ’xtr’or’nary critters,” replied Bill, giving a turn to the quid of tobacco that invariably bulged out his left cheek. “Ye see, Ralph, them fellows take to the water as soon a’most as they can walk, an’ long before they can do that anything respectably, so that they are as much at home in the sea as on the land. Well, ye see, I ’spose they found swimmin’ for miles out to sea, and divin’ fathoms deep, wasn’t exciting enough, so they invented this game o’ the surf. Each man and boy, as you see, has got a short board or plank, with which he swims out for a mile or more to sea, and then, gettin’ on the top o’ yon thundering breaker, they come to shore on the top of it, yellin’ and screechin’ like fiends. It’s a marvel to me that they’re not dashed to shivers on the coral reef, for sure an’ sartin am I that if any o’ us tried it, we wouldn’t be worth the fluke of a broken anchor after the wave fell. But there they go!”

“It’s a favorite thing for these extraordinary folks,” replied Bill, adjusting the wad of tobacco that always bulged out of his left cheek. “You see, Ralph, those guys take to the water almost as soon as they can walk, and long before they can do that properly, so they’re just as comfortable in the sea as they are on land. Well, I guess they found swimming for miles out to sea and diving deep wasn’t thrilling enough, so they came up with this surf game. Each person, as you can see, has a short board or plank, with which they swim out a mile or more into the ocean, and then, riding on top of that massive wave, they come back to shore, yelling and screaming like maniacs. It’s a wonder to me that they’re not smashed to bits on the coral reef, because I’m sure if any of us tried it, we wouldn’t survive a single wave. But there they go!”

As he spoke, several hundreds of the natives, amongst whom we were now standing, uttered a loud yell, rushed down the beach, plunged into the surf, and were carried off by the seething foam of the retreating wave.

As he spoke, several hundred of the locals, among whom we were now standing, let out a loud shout, charged down the beach, jumped into the surf, and were swept away by the swirling foam of the retreating wave.

At the point where we stood, the encircling coral reef joined the shore, so that the magnificent breakers, which a recent stiff breeze had rendered larger than usual, fell in thunder at the feet of the multitudes who lined the beach. For some time the swimmers continued to strike out to sea, breasting over the swell like hundreds of black seals. Then they all turned, and, watching an approaching billow, mounted its white crest, and, each laying his breast on the short flat board, came rolling towards the shore, careering on the summit of the mighty wave, while they and the onlookers shouted and yelled with excitement. Just as the monster wave curled in solemn majesty to fling its bulky length upon the beach, most of the swimmers slid back into the trough behind; others, slipping off their boards, seized them in their hands, and, plunging through the watery waste, swam out to repeat the amusement; but a few, who seemed to me the most reckless, continued their career until they were launched upon the beach, and enveloped in the churning foam and spray. One of these last came in on the crest of the wave most manfully, and landed with a violent bound almost on the spot where Bill and I stood. I saw by his peculiar head-dress that he was the chief whom the tribe entertained as their guest. The sea-water had removed nearly all the paint with which his face had been covered; and, as he rose panting to his feet, I recognised, to my surprise, the features of Tararo, my old friend of the Coral Island!

At the spot where we stood, the surrounding coral reef met the shore, so the incredible waves, made bigger than usual by a recent strong breeze, crashed thunderously at the feet of the crowds lining the beach. For a while, the swimmers continued to head out to sea, diving over the swells like hundreds of black seals. Then they all turned, and, spotting an incoming wave, rode its white crest, each laying their chest on a short flat board, gliding toward the shore, racing on top of the powerful wave, as they and the onlookers cheered and shouted with excitement. Just as the massive wave bent in grand form to crash its heavy body onto the beach, most of the swimmers slipped back into the trough behind; others, falling off their boards, grabbed them in their hands and dove through the water, swimming out to enjoy the thrill again; but a few, who seemed the most daring, continued their ride until they were launched onto the beach, surrounded by the swirling foam and spray. One of these last came in on the crest of the wave heroically, landing with a strong leap almost right where Bill and I stood. I noticed by his distinctive headgear that he was the chief whom the tribe had entertained as their guest. The sea had washed away most of the paint that had covered his face; and as he got to his feet, panting, I recognized, to my surprise, the features of Tararo, my old friend from Coral Island!

Tararo at the same moment recognised me, and, advancing quickly, took me round the neck and rubbed noses; which had the effect of transferring a good deal of the moist paint from his nose to mine. Then, recollecting that this was not the white man’s mode of salutation, he grasped me by the hand and shook it violently.

Tararo recognized me at that moment and, moving quickly, wrapped his arms around my neck and rubbed noses with me, which ended up smudging a lot of wet paint from his nose onto mine. Then, remembering that this wasn’t how white people greet each other, he took my hand and shook it vigorously.

“Hallo, Ralph!” cried Bill, in surprise, “that chap seems to have taken a sudden fancy to you, or he must be an old acquaintance.”

“Hey, Ralph!” shouted Bill in surprise, “that guy seems to have taken a sudden liking to you, or he must be an old friend.”

“Right, Bill,” I replied, “he is indeed an old acquaintance;” and I explained in a few words that he was the chief whose party Jack and Peterkin and I had helped to save.

“Right, Bill,” I replied, “he’s definitely an old acquaintance;” and I briefly explained that he was the chief whose group Jack, Peterkin, and I had helped to rescue.

Tararo having thrown away his surf-board, entered into an animated conversation with Bill, pointing frequently during the course of it to me; whereby I concluded he must be telling him about the memorable battle, and the part we had taken in it. When he paused, I begged of Bill to ask him about the woman Avatea, for I had some hope that she might have come with Tararo on this visit. “And ask him,” said I, “who she is, for I am persuaded she is of a different race from the Feejeeans.” On the mention of her name the chief frowned darkly, and seemed to speak with much anger.

Tararo, having tossed aside his surfboard, got into a lively conversation with Bill, frequently pointing at me during their talk. I figured he must be telling him about the unforgettable battle and our roles in it. When he paused, I asked Bill to inquire about the woman Avatea, as I hoped she might have come with Tararo on this trip. “And ask him,” I said, “who she is, because I’m convinced she’s from a different race than the Fijians.” When her name was mentioned, the chief frowned seriously and seemed to speak with a lot of anger.

“You’re right, Ralph,” said Bill, when the chief had ceased to talk; “she’s not a Feejee girl, but a Samoan. How she ever came to this place the chief does not very clearly explain, but he says she was taken in war, and that he got her three years ago, an’ kept her as his daughter ever since. Lucky for her, poor girl, else she’d have been roasted and eaten like the rest.”

“You're right, Ralph,” Bill said after the chief finished speaking. “She’s not a Feejee girl; she’s Samoan. The chief doesn’t really explain how she ended up here, but he says she was taken in war, and that he got her three years ago and has kept her as his daughter ever since. She’s lucky, poor girl, otherwise she would’ve been roasted and eaten like the others.”

“But why does Tararo frown and look so angry?” said I.

“But why does Tararo look so upset and angry?” I asked.

“Because the girl’s somewhat obstinate, like most o’ the sex, an’ won’t marry the man he wants her to. It seems that a chief of some other island came on a visit to Tararo and took a fancy to her, but she wouldn’t have him on no account, bein’ already in love, and engaged to a young chief whom Tararo hates, and she kicked up a desperate shindy; so, as he was going on a war expedition in his canoe, he left her to think about it, sayin’ he’d be back in six months or so, when he hoped she wouldn’t be so obstropolous. This happened just a week ago; an’ Tararo says that if she’s not ready to go, when the chief returns, as his bride, she’ll be sent to him as a long pig.”

“Because the girl’s pretty stubborn, like most women, and won’t marry the man he wants her to. It turns out a chief from another island visited Tararo and took a liking to her, but she refused him at all costs, since she’s already in love and engaged to a young chief whom Tararo dislikes, and she made a huge fuss about it. So, since he was heading off on a war expedition in his canoe, he left her to think it over, saying he’d be back in about six months, hoping she wouldn’t be so difficult. This happened just a week ago; and Tararo says that if she’s not ready to go with the chief when he returns, as his bride, she’ll be sent to him as a long pig.”

“As a long pig!” I exclaimed in surprise; “why what does he mean by that?”

“As a long pig!” I said, surprised. “What's he talking about?”

“He means somethin’ very unpleasant,” answered Bill with a frown. “You see these blackguards eat men an’ women just as readily as they eat pigs; and, as baked pigs and baked men are very like each other in appearance, they call men long pigs. If Avatea goes to this fellow as a long pig, it’s all up with her, poor thing.”

“He means something really unpleasant,” answered Bill with a frown. “You see, these scoundrels eat men and women just as easily as they eat pigs; and since baked pigs and baked men look pretty much the same, they call men long pigs. If Avatea goes to this guy as a long pig, it’s all over for her, poor thing.”

“Is she on the island now?” I asked eagerly.

“Is she on the island right now?” I asked eagerly.

“No, she’s at Tararo’s island.”

“No, she’s at Tararo’s island.”

“And where does it lie?”

"Where is it located?"

“About fifty or sixty miles to the south’ard o’ this,” returned Bill; “but I—”

“About fifty or sixty miles to the south of this,” Bill replied; “but I—”

At this moment we were startled by the cry of “Mao! mao!—a shark! a shark!” which was immediately followed by a shriek that rang clear and fearfully loud above the tumult of cries that arose from the savages in the water and on the land. We turned hastily towards the direction whence the cry came, and had just time to observe the glaring eye-balls of one of the swimmers as he tossed his arms in the air. Next instant he was pulled under the waves. A canoe was instantly launched, and the hand of the drowning man was caught, but only half of his body was dragged from the maw of the monster, which followed the canoe until the water became so shallow that it could scarcely swim. The crest of the next billow was tinged with red as it rolled towards the shore.

At that moment, we were startled by the shout of “Mao! Mao! A shark! A shark!” This was quickly followed by a scream that cut through the chaos of cries coming from the savages in the water and on land. We quickly turned towards the source of the cry and barely had time to see the wild eyes of one of the swimmers as he waved his arms in panic. In an instant, he was pulled underwater. A canoe was launched right away, and they grabbed the drowning man’s hand, but only half of his body was pulled from the jaws of the beast, which chased the canoe until the water got so shallow that it could barely swim. The top of the next wave was stained red as it rolled towards the shore.

In most countries of the world this would have made a deep impression on the spectators, but the only effect it had upon these islanders was to make them hurry with all speed out of the sea, lest a similar fate should befall some of the others; but, so utterly reckless were they of human life, that it did not for a moment suspend the progress of their amusements. It is true the surf-swimming ended for that time somewhat abruptly, but they immediately proceeded with other games. Bill told me that sharks do not often attack the surf-swimmers, being frightened away by the immense numbers of men and boys in the water, and by the shouting and splashing that they make. “But,” said he, “such a thing as you have seen just now don’t frighten them much. They’ll be at it again to-morrow or next day, just as if there wasn’t a single shark between Feejee and Nova Zembla.”

In most countries, this would have left a strong impression on the spectators, but the only effect it had on these islanders was to make them quickly leave the water, fearing that the same fate might happen to others. However, they were so indifferent to human life that it didn't stop their fun for even a moment. It's true that surfing ended suddenly for that time, but they immediately moved on to other games. Bill told me that sharks don't usually attack surfers because they're scared off by the huge numbers of men and boys in the water, along with all the shouting and splashing. “But,” he said, “what you just saw doesn’t scare them much. They'll be back in the water tomorrow or the next day, as if there wasn’t a single shark from Feejee to Nova Zembla.”

After this the natives had a series of wrestling and boxing matches; and being men of immense size and muscle, they did a good deal of injury to each other, especially in boxing, in which not only the lower orders, but several of the chiefs and priests engaged. Each bout was very quickly terminated, for they did not pretend to a scientific knowledge of the art, and wasted no time in sparring, but hit straight out at each other’s heads, and their blows were delivered with great force. Frequently one of the combatants was knocked down with a single blow; and one gigantic fellow hit his adversary so severely that he drove the skin entirely off his forehead. This feat was hailed with immense applause by the spectators.

After that, the locals had a series of wrestling and boxing matches. Being incredibly big and muscular, they caused quite a bit of injury to each other, especially in boxing, where not just the lower ranks but also several chiefs and priests participated. Each match ended quickly, as they didn't pretend to have any technical knowledge of the sport and wasted no time sparring; they just threw punches directly at each other’s heads, delivering their blows with great force. Often, one fighter would be knocked down with a single hit, and one gigantic guy struck his opponent so hard that he completely removed the skin from his forehead. This act received huge applause from the spectators.

During these exhibitions, which were very painful to me, though I confess I could not refrain from beholding them, I was struck with the beauty of many of the figures and designs that were tattooed on the persons of the chiefs and principal men. One figure, that seemed to me very elegant, was that of a palm-tree tattooed on the back of a man’s leg, the roots rising, as it were, from under his heel, the stem ascending the tendon of the ankle, and the graceful head branching out upon the calf. I afterwards learned that this process of tattooing is very painful, and takes long to do, commencing at the age of ten, and being continued at intervals up to the age of thirty. It is done by means of an instrument made of bone, with a number of sharp teeth with which the skin is punctured. Into these punctures a preparation made from the kernel of the candle-nut, mixed with cocoa-nut oil, is rubbed, and the mark thus made is indelible. The operation is performed by a class of men whose profession it is, and they tattoo as much at a time, as the person on whom they are operating can bear; which is not much, the pain and inflammation caused by tattooing being very great, sometimes causing death. Some of the chiefs were tattooed with an ornamental stripe down the legs, which gave them the appearance of being clad in tights. Others had marks round the ankles and insteps, which looked like tight-fitting and elegant boots. Their faces were also tattooed, and their breasts were very profusely marked with every imaginable species of device,—muskets, dogs, birds, pigs, clubs, and canoes, intermingled with lozenges, squares, circles, and other arbitrary figures.

During these exhibitions, which were very painful for me, although I admit I couldn't help but watch, I was struck by the beauty of many of the designs tattooed on the bodies of the chiefs and important men. One design that I found particularly elegant was a palm tree tattooed on the back of a man's leg, with the roots appearing to rise from under his heel, the trunk climbing up the ankle, and the graceful branches spreading out over the calf. I later learned that this tattooing process is very painful and takes a long time, starting at the age of ten and continuing in intervals until the age of thirty. It’s done with a bone tool that has sharp teeth to puncture the skin. A mixture made from the kernel of the candle-nut and coconut oil is rubbed into these punctures, and the mark is permanent. The procedure is carried out by a group of men who specialize in this, and they tattoo only as much as the person can handle at a time; which isn’t much, since the pain and swelling from tattooing can be quite severe and can sometimes lead to death. Some of the chiefs had ornamental stripes down their legs that made them look like they were wearing tights. Others had marks around their ankles and insteps that resembled tight-fitting and stylish boots. Their faces were also tattooed, and their chests were covered with countless different designs—muskets, dogs, birds, pigs, clubs, and canoes, mixed with diamonds, squares, circles, and other random shapes.

The women were not tattooed so much as the men, having only a few marks on their feet and arms. But I must say, however objectionable this strange practice may be, it nevertheless had this good effect, that it took away very much from their appearance of nakedness.

The women weren't as heavily tattooed as the men, having just a few marks on their feet and arms. But I have to say, no matter how odd this practice may seem, it did have the positive effect of reducing their appearance of nudity.

Next day, while we were returning from the woods to our schooner, we observed Romata rushing about in the neighbourhood of his house, apparently mad with passion.

Next day, as we were coming back from the woods to our schooner, we saw Romata running around near his house, seemingly crazed with anger.

“Ah!” said Bill to me, “there he’s at his old tricks again. That’s his way when he gets drink. The natives make a sort of drink o’ their own, and it makes him bad enough; but when he gets brandy he’s like a wild tiger. The captain, I suppose, has given him a bottle, as usual, to keep him in good humour. After drinkin’ he usually goes to sleep, and the people know it well and keep out of his way, for fear they should waken him. Even the babies are taken out of ear-shot; for, when he’s waked up, he rushes out just as you see him now, and spears or clubs the first person he meets.”

“Ah!” Bill said to me, “there he is with his old tricks again. That’s what he does when he drinks. The locals make their own kind of drink, and that’s bad enough; but when he gets brandy, he’s like a wild tiger. I guess the captain has given him a bottle, as usual, to keep him happy. After drinking, he usually falls asleep, and everyone knows it and stays out of his way, so they don’t wake him up. Even the babies are taken far away; because when he wakes up, he charges out just like you see him now, and spears or clubs the first person he encounters.”

It seemed at the present time, however, that no deadly weapon had been in his way, for the infuriated chief was raging about without one. Suddenly he caught sight of an unfortunate man who was trying to conceal himself behind a tree. Rushing towards him, Romata struck him a terrible blow on the head, which knocked out the poor man’s eye and also dislocated the chief’s finger. The wretched creature offered no resistance; he did not even attempt to parry the blow. Indeed, from what Bill said, I found that he might consider himself lucky in having escaped with his life, which would certainly have been forfeited had the chief been possessed of a club at the time.

It seemed that, at that moment, no deadly weapon was in the chief's way because he was furiously rampaging without one. Suddenly, he spotted an unfortunate man trying to hide behind a tree. Charging at him, Romata delivered a brutal blow to the man's head, knocking out his eye and dislocating the chief's finger in the process. The poor guy offered no resistance; he didn't even try to block the hit. In fact, from what Bill said, he was lucky to have escaped with his life, which he definitely would have lost if the chief had a club at that moment.

“Have these wretched creatures no law among themselves,” said I, “which can restrain such wickedness?”

“Do these miserable beings have no rules among themselves,” I said, “that can stop such evil?”

“None,” replied Bill. “The chief’s word is law. He might kill and eat a dozen of his own subjects any day for nothing more than his own pleasure, and nobody would take the least notice of it.”

“None,” replied Bill. “The chief’s word is law. He could kill and eat a dozen of his own people any day just for his own enjoyment, and nobody would even notice.”

This ferocious deed took place within sight of our party as we wended our way to the beach, but I could not observe any other expression on the faces of the men than that of total indifference or contempt. It seemed to me a very awful thing that it should be possible for men to come to such hardness of heart and callousness to the sight of bloodshed and violence; but, indeed, I began to find that such constant exposure to scenes of blood was having a slight effect upon myself, and I shuddered when I came to think that I, too, was becoming callous.

This brutal act happened within view of our group as we made our way to the beach, but I couldn't see any expression on the men's faces except total indifference or disdain. It struck me as incredibly awful that men could become so hardened and indifferent to bloodshed and violence; however, I started to realize that constant exposure to such scenes was beginning to change me, and I shuddered when I thought that I, too, was becoming numb.

I thought upon this subject much that night while I walked up and down the deck during my hours of watch; and I came to the conclusion that if I, who hated, abhorred, and detested such bloody deeds as I had witnessed within the last few weeks, could so soon come to be less sensitive about them, how little wonder that these poor ignorant savages, who were born and bred in familiarity therewith, should think nothing of them at all, and should hold human life in so very slight esteem.

I thought about this a lot that night while I paced the deck during my shift, and I realized that if I, who hated and loathed the violent acts I had seen in the past few weeks, could become less affected by them so quickly, then it’s no surprise that these poor, ignorant people, who grew up around such brutality, wouldn’t think much of it at all and would value human life so little.

CHAPTER XXVI.

Mischief brewing—My blood is made to run cold—Evil consultations and wicked resolves—Bloody Bill attempts to do good and fails—The attack—Wholesale murder—The flight—The escape.

Mischief brewing—My blood runs cold—Evil plans and wicked decisions—Bloody Bill tries to do good but fails—The attack—Mass murder—The escape—The getaway.

Next morning I awoke with a feverish brow and a feeling of deep depression at my heart; and the more I thought on my unhappy fate, the more wretched and miserable did I feel.

Next morning I woke up with a feverish forehead and a heavy sense of depression in my heart; and the more I pondered my unfortunate fate, the more wretched and miserable I felt.

I was surrounded on all sides by human beings of the most dreadful character, to whom the shedding of blood was mere pastime. On shore were the natives, whose practices were so horrible that I could not think of them without shuddering. On board were none but pirates of the blackest dye, who, although not cannibals, were foul murderers, and more blameworthy even than the savages, inasmuch as they knew better. Even Bill, with whom I had, under the strange circumstances of my lot, formed a kind of intimacy, was so fierce in his nature as to have acquired the title of “Bloody” from his vile companions. I felt very much cast down the more I considered the subject and the impossibility of delivery, as it seemed to me, at least for a long time to come. At last, in my feeling of utter helplessness, I prayed fervently to the Almighty that he would deliver me out of my miserable condition; and when I had done so I felt some degree of comfort.

I was surrounded on all sides by people with the worst character, for whom killing was just a pastime. On shore were the natives, whose practices were so horrific that I couldn’t think about them without shuddering. On board were only ruthless pirates, who, although not cannibals, were ruthless murderers and even more despicable than the savages, since they knew better. Even Bill, with whom I had, under the strange circumstances of my situation, formed a sort of bond, was so fierce in nature that he earned the nickname “Bloody” from his vile companions. I felt increasingly downcast the more I contemplated my situation and the seeming impossibility of escape, at least for a long time. Finally, in my complete helplessness, I prayed sincerely to the Almighty to deliver me from my miserable condition; and once I had done so, I felt some sense of comfort.

When the captain came on deck, before the hour at which the men usually started for the woods, I begged of him to permit me to remain aboard that day, as I did not feel well; but he looked at me angrily, and ordered me, in a surly tone, to get ready to go on shore as usual. The fact was that the captain had been out of humour for some time past. Romata and he had had some differences, and high words had passed between them, during which the chief had threatened to send a fleet of his war-canoes, with a thousand men, to break up and burn the schooner; whereupon the captain smiled sarcastically, and going up to the chief gazed sternly in his face, while he said, “I have only to raise my little finger just now, and my big gun will blow your whole village to atoms in five minutes!” Although the chief was a bold man, he quailed before the pirate’s glance and threat, and made no reply; but a bad feeling had been raised and old sores had been opened.

When the captain came on deck, before the time the crew usually headed into the woods, I asked him to let me stay on the ship that day because I wasn't feeling well. He looked at me angrily and told me, in a gruff tone, to get ready to go ashore as usual. The truth was that the captain had been in a bad mood for a while. He had some disagreements with Romata, and there were harsh words exchanged between them, during which the chief had threatened to send a fleet of his war canoes with a thousand men to break up and burn the schooner. In response, the captain just gave a sarcastic smile and walked up to the chief, looking sternly into his face while saying, “I only need to raise my little finger right now, and my big gun will blow your whole village to pieces in five minutes!” Although the chief was a brave man, he shrank back from the pirate's fierce gaze and threat, saying nothing in response; but it had stirred bad feelings and reopened old wounds.

I had, therefore, to go with the wood-cutters that day. Before starting, however, the captain called me into the cabin, and said,—

I had to go with the wood-cutters that day. Before we started, though, the captain called me into the cabin and said,—

“Here, Ralph, I’ve got a mission for you, lad. That blackguard Romata is in the dumps, and nothing will mollify him but a gift; so do you go up to his house and give him these whales’ teeth, with my compliments. Take with you one of the men who can speak the language.”

“Hey Ralph, I’ve got a task for you, dude. That scoundrel Romata is feeling down, and the only thing that will cheer him up is a gift. So, head over to his place and give him these whales’ teeth, with my regards. Take one of the guys who can speak the language with you.”

I looked at the gift in some surprise, for it consisted of six white whales’ teeth, and two of the same dyed bright red, which seemed to me very paltry things. However, I did not dare to hesitate or ask any questions; so, gathering them up, I left the cabin and was soon on my way to the chief’s house, accompanied by Bill. On expressing my surprise at the gift, he said,—

I looked at the gift in some surprise; it was made up of six white whales’ teeth and two that were dyed bright red, which seemed to me like a pretty meager offering. However, I didn't want to hesitate or ask any questions, so I picked them up and left the cabin, soon heading towards the chief’s house with Bill. When I mentioned my surprise about the gift, he said,—

“They’re paltry enough to you or me, Ralph, but they’re considered of great value by them chaps. They’re a sort o’ cash among them. The red ones are the most prized, one of them bein’ equal to twenty o’ the white ones. I suppose the only reason for their bein’ valuable is that there ain’t many of them, and they’re hard to be got.”

“They may seem worthless to you or me, Ralph, but to those guys, they’re really valuable. They’re like cash to them. The red ones are the most sought after, one of them being worth twenty of the white ones. I guess the only reason they’re valuable is that there aren’t many of them, and they’re hard to come by.”

On arriving at the house we found Romata sitting on a mat, in the midst of a number of large bales of native cloth and other articles, which had been brought to him as presents from time to time by inferior chiefs. He received us rather haughtily, but on Bill explaining the nature of our errand he became very condescending, and his eyes glistened with satisfaction when he received the whales’ teeth, although he laid them aside with an assumption of kingly indifference.

On arriving at the house, we found Romata sitting on a mat surrounded by several large bales of native cloth and other items that had been presented to him over time by lesser chiefs. He greeted us a bit arrogantly, but when Bill explained the purpose of our visit, he became much more gracious, and his eyes sparkled with delight when he received the whale teeth, although he set them aside with a display of royal indifference.

“Go,” said he, with a wave of the hand,—“go, tell your captain that he may cut wood to-day, but not to-morrow. He must come ashore,—I want to have a palaver with him.”

“Go,” he said, waving his hand. “Go, tell your captain that he can chop wood today, but not tomorrow. He needs to come ashore—I want to have a chat with him.”

As we left the house to return to the woods, Bill shook his head:

As we left the house to head back to the woods, Bill shook his head:

“There’s mischief brewin’ in that black rascal’s head. I know him of old. But what comes here?”

“There’s trouble brewing in that black rascal’s head. I know him well. But what’s happening here?”

As he spoke, we heard the sound of laughter and shouting in the wood, and presently there issued from it a band of savages, in the midst of whom were a number of men bearing burdens on their shoulders. At first I thought that these burdens were poles with something rolled round them, the end of each pole resting on a man’s shoulder. But on a nearer approach I saw that they were human beings, tied hand and foot, and so lashed to the poles that they could not move. I counted twenty of them as they passed.

As he spoke, we heard laughter and shouting coming from the woods, and soon a group of savages emerged, with several men carrying loads on their shoulders. At first, I thought these loads were poles with something wrapped around them, with each pole resting on a man’s shoulder. But as we got closer, I realized they were human beings, tied up hand and foot, strapped to the poles in a way that made it impossible for them to move. I counted twenty of them as they went by.

“More murder!” said Bill, in a voice that sounded between a hoarse laugh and a groan.

“More killing!” said Bill, in a voice that sounded like a mix of a rough laugh and a groan.

“Surely they are not going to murder them?” said I, looking anxiously into Bill’s face.

“Surely they aren’t going to kill them?” I said, looking anxiously at Bill’s face.

“I don’t know, Ralph,” replied Bill, “what they’re goin’ to do with them; but I fear they mean no good when they tie fellows up in that way.”

“I don’t know, Ralph,” replied Bill, “what they’re going to do with them; but I’m worried they have bad intentions when they tie people up like that.”

As we continued our way towards the wood-cutters, I observed that Bill looked anxiously over his shoulder, in the direction where the procession had disappeared. At last he stopped, and turning abruptly on his heel, said,—

As we made our way toward the wood-cutters, I noticed that Bill kept glancing nervously over his shoulder, in the direction where the procession had vanished. Finally, he halted and, turning sharply, said,—

“I tell ye what it is, Ralph, I must be at the bottom o’ that affair. Let us follow these black scoundrels and see what they’re goin’ to do.”

“I’ll tell you what it is, Ralph, I need to get to the bottom of that situation. Let’s follow these shady characters and see what they’re up to.”

I must say I had no wish to pry further into their bloody practices; but Bill seemed bent on it, so I turned and went. We passed rapidly through the bush, being guided in the right direction by the shouts of the savages. Suddenly there was a dead silence, which continued for some time, while Bill and I involuntarily quickened our pace until we were running at the top of our speed across the narrow neck of land previously mentioned. As we reached the verge of the wood, we discovered the savages surrounding the large war-canoe, which they were apparently on the point of launching. Suddenly the multitude put their united strength to the canoe; but scarcely had the huge machine begun to move, when a yell, the most appalling that ever fell upon my ear, rose high above the shouting of the savages. It had not died away when another and another smote upon my throbbing ear; and then I saw that these inhuman monsters were actually launching their canoe over the living bodies of their victims. But there was no pity in the breasts of these men. Forward they went in ruthless indifference, shouting as they went, while high above their voices rang the dying shrieks of those wretched creatures, as, one after another, the ponderous canoe passed over them, burst the eyeballs from their sockets, and sent the life’s blood gushing from their mouths. Oh, reader, this is no fiction. I would not, for the sake of thrilling you with horror, invent so terrible a scene. It was witnessed. It is true; true as that accursed sin which has rendered the human heart capable of such diabolical enormities!

I have to admit I really didn't want to dig deeper into their gruesome practices, but Bill seemed set on it, so I turned and left. We rushed through the bush, following the direction of the shouts from the natives. Suddenly, there was complete silence that lasted for a while, causing Bill and me to instinctively speed up until we were sprinting as fast as we could across the narrow strip of land I mentioned earlier. When we reached the edge of the woods, we saw the natives surrounding the large war canoe, which they were about to launch. Suddenly, the crowd put all their strength into pushing the canoe, but just as it started to move, a scream, the most terrifying sound I’ve ever heard, cut through the noise of the natives. Before that sound faded, another scream followed, then another, and I realized these brutal monsters were actually launching their canoe over the living bodies of their victims. There was no mercy in these men. They continued ruthlessly, shouting as they moved forward, while above their voices echoed the dying cries of those poor souls, as one by one, the heavy canoe rolled over them, popping their eyes from their sockets and making their blood pour from their mouths. Oh, reader, this isn’t fiction. I wouldn’t invent such a horrifying scene just to thrill you. It was real. It’s true; as true as that damn sin that has made the human heart capable of such monstrous acts!

When it was over I turned round and fell upon the grass with a deep groan; but Bill seized me by the arm, and lifting me up as if I had been a child, cried,—

When it was over, I turned around and collapsed onto the grass with a deep groan; but Bill grabbed me by the arm and lifted me up as if I were a child, shouting,—

“Come along, lad; let’s away!”—and so, staggering and stumbling over the tangled underwood, we fled from the fatal spot.

“Come on, kid; let’s go!”—and so, stumbling and tripping over the tangled brush, we ran away from the dangerous place.

During the remainder of that day I felt as if I were in a horrible dream. I scarce knew what was said to me, and was more than once blamed by the men for idling my time. At last the hour to return aboard came. We marched down to the beach, and I felt relief for the first time when my feet rested on the schooner’s deck.

During the rest of that day, I felt like I was in a terrible nightmare. I hardly understood what was being said to me, and more than once, the men criticized me for wasting my time. Finally, the time came to head back on board. We walked down to the beach, and for the first time, I felt relief when my feet touched the schooner’s deck.

In the course of the evening I overheard part of a conversation between the captain and the first mate, which startled me not a little. They were down in the cabin, and conversed in an under-tone, but the sky-light being off, I overheard every word that was said.

In the evening, I overheard part of a conversation between the captain and the first mate that really surprised me. They were in the cabin and spoke softly, but with the skylight open, I caught every word.

“I don’t half like it,” said the mate. “It seems to me that we’ll only have hard fightin’ and no pay.”

“I really don’t like it,” said the mate. “It seems to me that we’ll only have tough fighting and no pay.”

“No pay!” repeated the captain, in a voice of suppressed anger. “Do you call a good cargo all for nothing no pay?”

“No pay!” the captain repeated, his voice filled with restrained anger. “Do you really think a good cargo means nothing, no pay?”

“Very true,” returned the mate; “but we’ve got the cargo aboard. Why not cut your cable and take French leave o’ them? What’s the use o’ tryin’ to lick the blackguards when it’ll do us no manner o’ good?”

“Very true,” replied the mate; “but we’ve got the cargo loaded. Why not cut your cable and leave without saying anything to them? What’s the point in trying to take on the crooks when it won’t help us at all?”

“Mate,” said the captain, in a low voice, “you talk like a fresh-water sailor. I can only attribute this shyness to some strange delusion; for surely” (his voice assumed a slightly sneering tone as he said this) “surely I am not to suppose that you have become soft-hearted! Besides, you are wrong in regard to the cargo being aboard; there’s a good quarter of it lying in the woods, and that blackguard chief knows it and won’t let me take it off. He defied us to do our worst, yesterday.”

“Dude,” the captain said in a low voice, “you sound like a landlubber. I can only guess this hesitation is some weird misunderstanding; surely” (his voice took on a slightly mocking tone as he said this) “surely I’m not to think that you have gotten soft! Besides, you’re mistaken about the cargo being on board; there’s a good chunk of it in the woods, and that scoundrel chief knows it and won’t let me take it. He challenged us to do our worst yesterday.”

“Defied us! did he?” cried the mate, with a bitter laugh. “Poor contemptible thing!”

“Defied us, did he?” the mate exclaimed with a bitter laugh. “What a pathetic little thing!”

“And yet he seems not so contemptible but that you are afraid to attack him.”

“And yet he doesn’t seem so despicable that you’re afraid to confront him.”

“Who said I was afraid?” growled the mate, sulkily. “I’m as ready as any man in the ship. But, captain, what is it that you intend to do?”

“Who said I was scared?” the mate growled, sulking. “I’m as ready as any guy on the ship. But, captain, what do you plan to do?”

“I intend to muffle the sweeps and row the schooner up to the head of the creek there, from which point we can command the pile of sandal-wood with our gun. Then I shall land with all the men except two, who shall take care of the schooner and be ready with the boat to take us off. We can creep through the woods to the head of the village, where these cannibals are always dancing round their suppers of human flesh, and if the carbines of the men are loaded with a heavy charge of buck-shot, we can drop forty or fifty at the first volley. After that the thing will be easy enough. The savages will take to the mountains in a body, and we shall take what we require, up anchor, and away.”

“I plan to quiet the sails and row the schooner up to the top of the creek, from where we can aim our gun at the pile of sandalwood. Then I’ll go ashore with all the men except for two, who will stay with the schooner and be ready with the boat to bring us back. We can sneak through the woods to the edge of the village, where these cannibals are always dancing around their meals of human flesh, and if the guys' carbines are loaded with heavy buckshot, we can take out forty or fifty with the first shot. After that, it’ll be pretty easy. The savages will run to the mountains as a group, and we’ll take what we need, raise the anchor, and head out.”

To this plan the mate at length agreed. As he left the cabin I heard the captain say,—

To this plan, the first mate finally agreed. As he exited the cabin, I heard the captain say,—

“Give the men an extra glass of grog, and don’t forget the buck-shot.”

“Give the guys an extra glass of grog, and don’t forget the buckshot.”

The reader may conceive the horror with which I heard this murderous conversation. I immediately repeated it to Bill, who seemed much perplexed about it. At length he said,—

The reader can imagine the shock I felt when I heard this deadly conversation. I quickly told Bill about it, and he seemed really confused. Finally, he said,—

“I’ll tell you what I’ll do, Ralph: I’ll swim ashore after dark and fix a musket to a tree not far from the place where we’ll have to land, and I’ll tie a long string to the trigger, so that when our fellows cross it they’ll let it off, and so alarm the village in time to prevent an attack, but not in time to prevent us gettin’ back to the boat; so, master captain,” added Bill with a smile that for the first time seemed to me to be mingled with good-natured cheerfulness, “you’ll be baulked at least for once in your life by Bloody Bill.”

“I’ll tell you what I’m going to do, Ralph: I’ll swim to shore after dark and set up a musket on a tree not far from where we’ll land. I’ll tie a long string to the trigger, so when our guys trip it, it’ll fire and warn the village in time to stop an attack, but not in time to keep us from getting back to the boat. So, master captain,” Bill added with a smile that for the first time seemed to have a touch of good-natured cheerfulness, “you’ll at least be frustrated once in your life by Bloody Bill.”

After it grew dark, Bill put this resolve in practice. He slipped over the side with a musket in his left hand, while with his right he swam ashore and entered the woods. He soon returned, having accomplished his purpose, and got on board without being seen,—I being the only one on deck.

After it got dark, Bill put his plan into action. He quietly climbed over the side with a musket in his left hand while swimming to shore with his right. He soon returned, having completed his goal, and boarded the ship without being noticed—I was the only one on deck.

When the hour of midnight approached the men were mustered on deck, the cable was cut and the muffled sweeps got out. These sweeps were immensely large oars, each requiring a couple of men to work it. In a few minutes we entered the mouth of the creek, which was indeed the mouth of a small river, and took about half an hour to ascend it, although the spot where we intended to land was not more than six hundred yards from the mouth, because there was a slight current against us, and the mangroves which narrowed the creek, impeded the rowers in some places. Having reached the spot, which was so darkened by overhanging trees that we could see with difficulty, a small kedge anchor attached to a thin line was let softly down over the stern.

As midnight approached, the men gathered on deck, the cable was cut, and the muffled oars were brought out. These oars were massive, each needing a couple of men to handle. In just a few minutes, we entered the mouth of the creek, which was actually the beginning of a small river, and it took us about half an hour to navigate it, even though the place where we planned to land was only about six hundred yards from the entrance. There was a slight current pushing against us, and the mangroves that narrowed the creek made it tough for the rowers in some areas. Once we reached the spot, which was so darkened by overhanging trees that we could barely see, a small anchor on a thin line was quietly lowered over the back of the boat.

“Now, lads,” whispered the captain, as he walked along the line of men, who were all armed to the teeth, “don’t be in a hurry, aim low, and don’t waste your first shots.”

“Alright, guys,” whispered the captain, as he walked along the line of men, who were all fully armed, “don’t rush it, aim low, and don’t waste your first shots.”

He then pointed to the boat, into which the men crowded in silence. There was no room to row, but oars were not needed, as a slight push against the side of the schooner sent the boat gliding to the shore.

He then pointed to the boat, into which the men gathered in silence. There wasn't enough room to row, but oars weren't necessary, as a gentle push against the side of the schooner sent the boat gliding to the shore.

“There’s no need of leaving two in the boat,” whispered the mate, as the men stepped out; “we shall want all our hands. Let Ralph stay.”

“There's no need to leave two in the boat,” whispered the mate, as the men got out; “we'll need all our hands. Let Ralph stay.”

The captain assented, and ordered me to stand in readiness with the boat-hook, to shove ashore at a moment’s notice if they should return, or to shove off if any of the savages should happen to approach. He then threw his carbine into the hollow of his arm and glided through the bushes followed by his men. With a throbbing head I awaited the result of our plan. I knew the exact locality where the musket was placed, for Bill had described it to me, and I kept my straining eyes fixed upon the spot. But no sound came, and I began to fear that either they had gone in another direction or that Bill had not fixed the string properly. Suddenly I heard a faint click, and observed one or two bright sparks among the bushes. My heart immediately sank within me, for I knew at once that the trigger had indeed been pulled but that the priming had not caught. The plan, therefore, had utterly failed. A feeling of dread now began to creep over me as I stood in the boat, in that dark, silent spot, awaiting the issue of this murderous expedition. I shuddered as I glanced at the water that glided past like a dark reptile. I looked back at the schooner, but her hull was just barely visible, while her tapering masts were lost among the trees which overshadowed her. Her lower sails were set, but so thick was the gloom that they were quite invisible.

The captain agreed and told me to be ready with the boat-hook, to push ashore at a moment’s notice if they returned, or to shove off if any of the savages came near. He then tucked his carbine under his arm and moved through the bushes, followed by his men. With a pounding headache, I waited for the outcome of our plan. I knew exactly where the musket was placed because Bill had described it to me, and I kept my straining eyes on that spot. But there was no sound, and I started to worry that they had either gone in a different direction or that Bill hadn't set the string correctly. Suddenly, I heard a faint click and saw one or two bright sparks among the bushes. My heart sank, for I realized that the trigger had been pulled but the priming hadn't ignited. The plan had completely failed. A feeling of dread began to wash over me as I stood in the boat, in that dark, silent place, waiting for the outcome of this deadly mission. I shuddered as I looked at the water sliding by like a dark snake. I glanced back at the schooner, but her hull was barely visible, while her tall masts were lost among the trees that overshadowed her. Her lower sails were set, but the gloom was so thick that they were completely hidden.

Suddenly I heard a shot. In a moment a thousand voices raised a yell in the village; again the cry rose on the night air, and was followed by broken shouts as of scattered parties of men bounding into the woods. Then I heard another shout loud and close at hand. It was the voice of the captain cursing the man who had fired the premature shot. Then came the order, “Forward,” followed by the wild hurrah of our men, as they charged the savages. Shots now rang in quick succession, and at last a loud volley startled the echoes of the woods. It was followed by a multitude of wild shrieks, which were immediately drowned in another “hurrah” from the men; the distance of the sound proving that they were driving their enemies before them towards the sea.

Suddenly, I heard a gunshot. In an instant, a thousand voices erupted in the village; again, the cry rose into the night air, followed by fragmented shouts from groups of men rushing into the woods. Then I heard another shout, loud and close by. It was the captain's voice, cursing the man who had fired the premature shot. Then came the command, “Forward,” followed by the wild cheer of our men as they charged at the savages. Shots rang out in quick succession, and finally, a loud volley echoed through the woods. It was followed by a chorus of wild screams, quickly drowned out by another cheer from the men, the distance of the sound showing that they were driving their enemies toward the sea.

While I was listening intently to these sounds, which were now mingled in confusion, I was startled by the rustling of the leaves not far from me. At first I thought it was a party of savages who had observed the schooner, but I was speedily undeceived by observing a body of natives—apparently several hundreds, as far as I could guess in the uncertain light—bounding through the woods towards the scene of battle. I saw at once that this was a party who had out-flanked our men, and would speedily attack them in the rear. And so it turned out, for, in a short time, the shouts increased ten-fold, and among them I thought I heard a death-cry uttered by voices familiar to my ear.

While I was listening closely to these sounds, which were now mixed up in confusion, I was startled by the rustling of leaves nearby. At first, I thought it was a group of savages who had spotted the schooner, but I quickly realized it was a group of natives—several hundred, or so I could guess in the dim light—charging through the woods towards the battlefield. I understood immediately that this was a group that had outflanked our men and would soon attack them from behind. And that’s exactly what happened because, shortly after, the shouts grew tenfold, and among them, I thought I heard a familiar death-cry.

At length the tumult of battle ceased, and, from the cries of exultation that now arose from the savages, I felt assured that our men had been conquered. I was immediately thrown into dreadful consternation. What was I now to do? To be taken by the savages was too horrible to be thought of; to flee to the mountains was hopeless, as I should soon be discovered; and to take the schooner out of the creek without assistance was impossible. I resolved, however, to make the attempt, as being my only hope, and was on the point of pushing off when my hand was stayed and my blood chilled by an appalling shriek in which I recognised the voice of one of the crew. It was succeeded by a shout from the savages. Then came another, and another shriek of agony, making my ears to tingle, as I felt convinced they were murdering the pirate crew in cold blood. With a bursting heart and my brain whirling as if on fire, I seized the boat-hook to push from shore when a man sprang from the bushes.

At last, the chaos of battle stopped, and from the triumphant shouts that erupted from the savages, I realized that our men had been defeated. Panic hit me hard. What was I supposed to do now? Being captured by the savages was a nightmare I couldn't even consider; running to the mountains seemed pointless since I would be found quickly; and taking the schooner out of the creek alone was out of the question. Still, I decided to give it a try since it was my only chance, and I was about to push off when I was frozen in place, my blood running cold at an awful scream that I recognized as one of the crew's voices. It was followed by a shout from the savages. Then came another scream, then another, filling my ears with an agonizing ringing as I was convinced they were killing the pirate crew mercilessly. With my heart racing and my mind spinning, I grabbed the boat-hook to push away from the shore just as a man jumped out from the bushes.

“Stop! Ralph, stop!—there now, push off,” he cried, and bounded into the boat so violently as nearly to upset her. It was Bill’s voice! In another moment we were on board,—the boat made fast, the line of the anchor cut, and the sweeps run out. At the first stroke of Bill’s giant arm the schooner was nearly pulled ashore, for in his haste he forgot that I could scarcely move the unwieldy oar. Springing to the stern he lashed the rudder in such a position as that, while it aided me, it acted against him, and so rendered the force of our strokes nearly equal. The schooner now began to glide quickly down the creek, but before we reached its mouth, a yell from a thousand voices on the bank told that we were discovered. Instantly a number of the savages plunged into the water and swam towards us; but we were making so much way that they could not overtake us. One, however, an immensely powerful man, succeeded in laying hold of the cut rope that hung from the stern, and clambered quickly upon deck. Bill caught sight of him the instant his head appeared above the taffrail. But he did not cease to row, and did not appear even to notice the savage until he was within a yard of him; then, dropping the sweep, he struck him a blow on the forehead with his clenched fist that felled him to the deck. Lifting him up he hurled him overboard and resumed the oar. But now a greater danger awaited us, for the savages had outrun us on the bank and were about to plunge into the water ahead of the schooner. If they succeeded in doing so our fate was sealed. For one moment Bill stood irresolute. Then, drawing a pistol from his belt, he sprang to the brass gun, held the pan of his pistol over the touch-hole and fired. The shot was succeeded by the hiss of the cannon’s priming, then the blaze and the crashing thunder of the monstrous gun burst upon the savages with such deafening roar that it seemed as if their very mountains had been rent asunder.

“Stop! Ralph, stop!—there we go, push off,” he shouted, and jumped into the boat so forcefully that it almost tipped over. It was Bill’s voice! In a moment, we were on board—the boat secured, the anchor line cut, and the oars out. With the first stroke of Bill’s powerful arm, the schooner nearly sailed ashore because, in his rush, he forgot that I could barely move the heavy oar. He jumped to the back and secured the rudder in a way that helped me while working against him, balancing our strokes. The schooner started to glide quickly down the creek, but before we got to the mouth, a shout from a thousand voices on the bank let us know we had been spotted. Immediately, several of the savages jumped into the water and swam toward us; however, we were moving so fast that they couldn’t catch up. One, a huge man, managed to grab the cut rope hanging from the stern and quickly climbed onto the deck. Bill saw him the moment his head popped up over the railing. But he didn’t stop rowing and didn’t seem to notice the savage until he was just a yard away; then, dropping the oar, he punched him in the forehead with his fist, knocking him to the deck. He lifted him up, threw him overboard, and went back to rowing. But now a bigger danger was ahead, as the savages had run ahead of us on the bank and were about to dive into the water in front of the schooner. If they managed to do that, we were doomed. For a brief moment, Bill hesitated. Then, pulling a pistol from his belt, he jumped to the brass cannon, held the pistol over the touch-hole, and fired. The shot was followed by the hissing of the cannon’s priming, then the flash and the thunder of the enormous gun erupted upon the savages with such a deafening roar that it felt like their very mountains had torn apart.

This was enough. The moment of surprise and hesitation caused by the unwonted sound, gave us time to pass the point; a gentle breeze, which the dense foliage had hitherto prevented us from feeling, bulged out our sails; the schooner bent before it, and the shouts of the disappointed savages grew fainter and fainter in the distance as we were slowly wafted out to sea.

This was enough. The moment of surprise and hesitation caused by the unusual sound gave us time to get past the point; a gentle breeze, which the thick foliage had kept us from feeling until now, filled our sails; the schooner leaned forward into it, and the shouts of the frustrated savages faded more and more in the distance as we were slowly carried out to sea.

CHAPTER XXVII.

Reflections—The wounded man—The squall—True consolation—Death.

Reflections—The injured man—The storm—Real comfort—Death.

There is a power of endurance in human beings, both in their bodies and in their minds, which, I have often thought, seems to be wonderfully adapted and exactly proportioned to the circumstances in which individuals may happen to be placed,—a power which, in most cases, is sufficient to carry a man through and over every obstacle that may happen to be thrown in his path through life, no matter how high or how steep the mountain may be, but which often forsakes him the moment the summit is gained, the point of difficulty passed; and leaves him prostrated, with energies gone, nerves unstrung, and a feeling of incapacity pervading the entire frame that renders the most trifling effort almost impossible.

There is a power of endurance in humans, both in their bodies and minds, which I often think is wonderfully suited and perfectly balanced for the situations in which people find themselves. This power, in most cases, is enough to help a person overcome any obstacle they encounter in life, no matter how tall or steep the mountain may be. However, it often abandons them the moment they reach the top, the hardest part passed; leaving them exhausted, with their energy spent, nerves frayed, and a sense of incapacity that makes even the smallest effort feel nearly impossible.

During the greater part of that day I had been subjected to severe mental and much physical excitement, which had almost crushed me down by the time I was relieved from duty in the course of the evening. But when the expedition, whose failure has just been narrated, was planned, my anxieties and energies had been so powerfully aroused that I went through the protracted scenes of that terrible night without a feeling of the slightest fatigue. My mind and body were alike active and full of energy. No sooner was the last thrilling fear of danger past, however, than my faculties were utterly relaxed; and, when I felt the cool breezes of the Pacific playing around my fevered brow, and heard the free waves rippling at the schooner’s prow, as we left the hated island behind us, my senses forsook me and I fell in a swoon upon the deck.

During most of that day, I had experienced intense mental and physical stress that nearly overwhelmed me by the time I was done with my duty in the evening. However, when the mission, which has just been described as a failure, was organized, my worries and drive were so heightened that I managed to endure the long events of that terrifying night without feeling even a hint of exhaustion. Both my mind and body were fully engaged and energized. But as soon as the last gripping fear of danger was behind me, my strength completely faded; and when I felt the cool Pacific breeze on my heated forehead and heard the waves gently lapping against the bow of the schooner as we sailed away from that dreaded island, I lost all my senses and fainted on the deck.

From this state I was quickly aroused by Bill, who shook me by the arm, saying,—

From this state, I was quickly jolted awake by Bill, who shook me by the arm, saying,—

“Hallo! Ralph, boy, rouse up, lad, we’re safe now. Poor thing, I believe he’s fainted.” And raising me in his arms he laid me on the folds of the gaff-top-sail, which lay upon the deck near the tiller. “Here, take a drop o’ this, it’ll do you good, my boy,” he added, in a voice of tenderness which I had never heard him use before, while he held a brandy-flask to my lips.

“Hey! Ralph, come on, wake up, we’re safe now. Poor thing, I think he’s passed out.” And picking me up, he laid me on the folds of the gaff-top-sail that was on the deck near the tiller. “Here, have a sip of this, it’ll help you out, my boy,” he said, in a gentle tone I had never heard him use before, while he held a brandy flask to my lips.

I raised my eyes gratefully, as I swallowed a mouthful; next moment my head sank heavily upon my arm and I fell fast asleep. I slept long, for when I awoke the sun was a good way above the horizon. I did not move on first opening my eyes, as I felt a delightful sensation of rest pervading me, and my eyes were riveted on and charmed with the gorgeous splendour of the mighty ocean, that burst upon my sight. It was a dead calm; the sea seemed a sheet of undulating crystal, tipped and streaked with the saffron hues of sunrise, which had not yet merged into the glowing heat of noon; and there was a deep calm in the blue dome above, that was not broken even by the usual flutter of the sea-fowl. How long I would have lain in contemplation of this peaceful scene I know not, but my mind was recalled suddenly and painfully to the past and the present by the sight of Bill, who was seated on the deck at my feet with his head reclining, as if in sleep, on his right arm, which rested on the tiller. As he seemed to rest peacefully I did not mean to disturb him, but the slight noise I made in raising myself on my elbow caused him to start and look round.

I lifted my gaze gratefully as I swallowed a mouthful; the next moment, my head sank heavily onto my arm and I fell fast asleep. I slept for a long time because when I finally woke up, the sun was well above the horizon. I didn’t move at first as I felt a wonderful sensation of rest washing over me, and my eyes were captivated by the stunning beauty of the vast ocean that greeted me. It was completely calm; the sea looked like a sheet of undulating crystal, touched and streaked with the golden colors of sunrise, which hadn’t yet turned into the intense heat of noon; and there was a deep stillness in the blue sky above, untouched even by the usual flurry of seagulls. I’m not sure how long I would have lingered in awe of this serene scene, but my thoughts were suddenly and painfully pulled back to reality by the sight of Bill, who was sitting on the deck at my feet with his head resting, as if sleeping, on his right arm, which was draped over the tiller. Since he looked so peaceful, I didn't want to disturb him, but the small noise I made as I pushed myself up on my elbow caused him to wake up and look around.

“Well, Ralph, awake at last, my boy; you have slept long and soundly,” he said, turning towards me.

“Well, Ralph, you're awake at last, my boy; you've slept for a long time and really well,” he said, turning toward me.

On beholding his countenance I sprang up in anxiety. He was deadly pale, and his hair, which hung in dishevelled locks over his face, was clotted with blood. Blood also stained his hollow cheeks and covered the front of his shirt, which, with the greater part of dress, was torn and soiled with mud.

On seeing his face, I jumped up in panic. He was incredibly pale, and his hair, which was messy and hanging over his face, was matted with blood. Blood also marked his sunken cheeks and covered the front of his shirt, which, along with most of his clothes, was torn and dirty with mud.

“Oh, Bill!” said I, with deep anxiety, “what is the matter with you? You are ill. You must have been wounded.”

“Oh, Bill!” I said, feeling really worried. “What’s wrong with you? You look sick. You must have been hurt.”

“Even so, lad,” said Bill in a deep soft voice, while he extended his huge frame on the couch from which I had just risen. “I’ve got an ugly wound, I fear, and I’ve been waiting for you to waken, to ask you to get me a drop o’ brandy and a mouthful o’ bread from the cabin lockers. You seemed to sleep so sweetly, Ralph, that I didn’t like to disturb you. But I don’t feel up to much just now.”

“Even so, kid,” Bill said in a deep, gentle voice, as he stretched out his large frame on the couch I had just vacated. “I think I’ve got a nasty wound, and I’ve been waiting for you to wake up so I could ask you to grab me a bit of brandy and some bread from the cabin lockers. You looked like you were sleeping so peacefully, Ralph, that I didn’t want to wake you. But I’m not feeling too great at the moment.”

I did not wait till he had done talking, but ran below immediately, and returned in a few seconds with a bottle of brandy and some broken biscuit. He seemed much refreshed after eating a few morsels and drinking a long draught of water mingled with a little of the spirits. Immediately afterwards he fell asleep, and I watched him anxiously until he awoke, being desirous of knowing the nature and extent of his wound.

I didn’t wait for him to finish talking; I ran downstairs right away and came back in a few seconds with a bottle of brandy and some broken biscuits. He looked a lot better after eating a few bites and taking a long drink of water mixed with a bit of the brandy. Shortly after, he fell asleep, and I watched him carefully until he woke up, eager to find out how serious his injury was.

“Ha!” he exclaimed, on awaking suddenly, after a slumber of an hour, “I’m the better of that nap, Ralph; I feel twice the man I was;” and he attempted to rise, but sank back again immediately with a deep groan.

“Ha!” he exclaimed, waking up suddenly after an hour of sleep, “I feel so much better from that nap, Ralph; I feel twice as strong as I was before;” and he tried to get up, but immediately sank back down with a deep groan.

“Nay, Bill you must not move, but lie still while I look at your wound. I’ll make a comfortable bed for you here on deck, and get you some breakfast. After that you shall tell me how you got it. Cheer up, Bill,” I added, seeing that he turned his head away; “you’ll be all right in a little, and I’ll be a capital nurse to you though I’m no doctor.”

“Nah, Bill, you need to stay still while I check out your wound. I’ll set up a comfy spot for you here on the deck and get you some breakfast. After that, you can tell me how you got hurt. Cheer up, Bill,” I said, noticing he turned his head away; “you’ll be fine in no time, and I’ll take great care of you even though I’m not a doctor.”

I then left him, and lighted a fire in the caboose. While it was kindling, I went to the steward’s pantry and procured the materials for a good breakfast, with which, in little more than half an hour, I returned to my companion. He seemed much better, and smiled kindly on me as I set before him a cup of coffee and a tray with several eggs and some bread on it.

I then left him and started a fire in the caboose. While it was getting going, I went to the steward's pantry and got everything I needed for a nice breakfast. In just over half an hour, I returned to my friend. He looked much better and smiled warmly at me as I set down a cup of coffee and a tray with several eggs and some bread.

“Now then, Bill,” said I, cheerfully, sitting down beside him on the deck, “let’s fall to. I’m very hungry myself, I can tell you; but—I forgot—your wound,” I added, rising; “let me look at it.”

“Alright then, Bill,” I said cheerfully, sitting down next to him on the deck, “let’s dig in. I’m really hungry, I have to say; but—I forgot—your wound,” I added, getting up; “let me check it.”

I found that the wound was caused by a pistol shot in the chest. It did not bleed much, and, as it was on the right side, I was in hopes that it might not be very serious. But Bill shook his head. “However,” said he, “sit down, Ralph, and I’ll tell you all about it.”

I discovered that the injury was from a gunshot wound to the chest. It didn’t bleed much, and since it was on the right side, I hoped it wouldn’t be too serious. But Bill shook his head. “Anyway,” he said, “sit down, Ralph, and I’ll explain everything to you.”

“You see, after we left the boat an’ began to push through the bushes, we went straight for the line of my musket, as I had expected; but by some unlucky chance it didn’t explode, for I saw the line torn away by the men’s legs, and heard the click o’ the lock; so I fancy the priming had got damp and didn’t catch. I was in a great quandary now what to do, for I couldn’t concoct in my mind, in the hurry, any good reason for firin’ off my piece. But they say necessity’s the mother of invention; so, just as I was givin’ it up and clinchin’ my teeth to bide the worst o’t, and take what should come, a sudden thought came into my head. I stepped out before the rest, seemin’ to be awful anxious to be at the savages, tripped my foot on a fallen tree, plunged head foremost into a bush, an’, ov coorse, my carbine exploded! Then came such a screechin’ from the camp as I never heard in all my life. I rose at once, and was rushin’ on with the rest when the captain called a halt.

“You see, after we left the boat and started to push through the bushes, we headed straight for my musket, just like I expected; but by some unfortunate chance, it didn’t fire, because I saw the line get dragged away by the guys' legs and heard the lock click. So I guess the priming got damp and didn’t ignite. I was in a real bind about what to do next, because I couldn’t come up with a good reason to fire my gun in the rush. But they say necessity is the mother of invention; just when I was about to give up and grit my teeth to endure whatever happened, a sudden idea popped into my head. I stepped out ahead of the others, pretending to be really eager to get at the savages, tripped over a fallen tree, and fell headfirst into some bushes, and of course, my carbine went off! Then there was a scream from the camp like I’ve never heard before. I got up quickly and was about to run on with the others when the captain called a stop.”

“‘You did that a-purpose, you villain!’ he said, with a tremendous oath, and, drawin’ a pistol from his belt, let fly right into my breast. I fell at once, and remembered no more till I was startled and brought round by the most awful yell I ever heard in my life, except, maybe, the shrieks o’ them poor critters that were crushed to death under yon big canoe. Jumpin’ up, I looked round, and, through the trees, saw a fire gleamin’ not far off, the light o’ which showed me the captain and men tied hand and foot, each to a post, and the savages dancin’ round them like demons. I had scarce looked for a second, when I saw one o’ them go up to the captain flourishing a knife, and, before I could wink, he plunged it into his breast, while another yell, like the one that roused me, rang upon my ear. I didn’t wait for more, but, bounding up, went crashing through the bushes into the woods. The black fellows caught sight of me, however, but not in time to prevent me jumpin’ into the boat, as you know.”

“‘You did that on purpose, you villain!’ he shouted, swearing loudly, and pulling a gun from his belt, shot right into my chest. I collapsed instantly and didn’t remember anything until I was jolted awake by the most terrifying scream I’ve ever heard in my life, except maybe the cries of those poor creatures that were crushed under that big canoe. I jumped up, looked around, and through the trees, I saw a fire glowing not far away, its light revealing the captain and the men tied up, each to a post, while the savages danced around them like demons. I had barely looked for a second when I saw one of them approach the captain waving a knife, and before I could blink, he stabbed him in the chest, while another scream, like the one that woke me, echoed in my ears. I didn’t wait for more, but sprang up and crashed through the bushes into the woods. The dark-skinned men spotted me, but not in time to stop me from jumping into the boat, as you know.”

Bill seemed to be much exhausted after this recital, and shuddered frequently during the narrative, so I refrained from continuing the subject at that time, and endeavoured to draw his mind to other things.

Bill appeared to be quite worn out after this performance, and he shivered often during the story, so I decided not to pursue the topic any further at that moment and tried to shift his focus to other things.

“But now, Bill,” said I, “it behoves us to think about the future, and what course of action we shall pursue. Here we are, on the wide Pacific, in a well-appointed schooner, which is our own,—at least no one has a better claim to it than we have,—and the world lies before us. Moreover, here comes a breeze, so we must make up our minds which way to steer.”

“But now, Bill,” I said, “we need to think about the future and what actions we’ll take. Here we are, on the vast Pacific, in a well-equipped schooner that belongs to us—at least no one has a stronger claim to it than we do—and the world is open to us. Plus, a breeze is coming, so we need to decide which way to go.”

“Ralph, boy,” said my companion, “it matters not to me which way we go. I fear that my time is short now. Go where you will. I’m content.”

“Ralph, my friend,” said my companion, “I don’t care which way we go. I’m afraid my time is running out. Go wherever you want. I’m okay with it.”

“Well then, Bill, I think we had better steer to the Coral Island, and see what has become of my dear old comrades, Jack and Peterkin. I believe the island has no name, but the captain once pointed it out to me on the chart, and I marked it afterwards; so, as we know pretty well our position just now, I think I can steer to it. Then, as to working the vessel, it is true I cannot hoist the sails single-handed, but luckily we have enough of sail set already, and if it should come on to blow a squall, I could at least drop the peaks of the main and fore sails, and clew them up partially without help, and throw her head close into the wind, so as to keep her all shaking till the violence of the squall is past. And if we have continued light breezes, I’ll rig up a complication of blocks and fix them to the top-sail halyards, so that I shall be able to hoist the sails without help. ’Tis true I’ll require half a day to hoist them, but we don’t need to mind that. Then I’ll make a sort of erection on deck to screen you from the sun, Bill; and if you can only manage to sit beside the tiller and steer for two hours every day, so as to let me get a nap, I’ll engage to let you off duty all the rest of the twenty-four hours. And if you don’t feel able for steering, I’ll lash the helm and heave to, while I get you your breakfasts and dinners; and so we’ll manage famously, and soon reach the Coral Island.”

"Well then, Bill, I think we should head to Coral Island and see what’s become of my good friends, Jack and Peterkin. I believe the island is unnamed, but the captain pointed it out to me on the map, and I marked it down; so since we have a pretty good idea of where we are right now, I think I can navigate to it. As for handling the boat, it's true I can't raise the sails on my own, but luckily we already have enough sail up, and if a squall hits, I can at least lower the peaks of the main and fore sails, partially tie them up without help, and turn the boat into the wind to keep it stable until the worst of the squall passes. If we have steady light breezes, I’ll set up some blocks and attach them to the top-sail halyards so that I’ll be able to raise the sails on my own. It’s true I’ll need half a day to do that, but that’s not a problem. Then I’ll build something on deck to shade you from the sun, Bill; and if you can just sit next to the tiller and steer for two hours each day to give me a chance to nap, I promise you can rest for the rest of the twenty-four hours. And if you’re not up for steering, I’ll tie the helm and stop the boat while I make you breakfast and lunch; and we’ll manage just fine and soon reach Coral Island."

Bill smiled faintly as I ran on in this strain.

Bill smiled faintly as I continued speaking like this.

“And what will you do,” said he, “if it comes on to blow a storm?”

“And what will you do,” he asked, “if a storm starts to blow?”

This question silenced me, while I considered what I should do in such a case. At length I laid my hand an his arm, and said, “Bill, when a man has done all that he can do, he ought to leave the rest to God.”

This question left me speechless as I thought about what I should do in that situation. Finally, I put my hand on his arm and said, “Bill, when a man has done all he can do, he should leave the rest to God.”

“Oh, Ralph,” said my companion, in a faint voice, looking anxiously into my face, “I wish that I had the feelin’s about God that you seem to have, at this hour. I’m dyin’, Ralph; yet I, who have braved death a hundred times, am afraid to die. I’m afraid to enter the next world. Something within tells me there will be a reckoning when I go there. But it’s all over with me, Ralph. I feel that there’s no chance o’ my bein’ saved.”

“Oh, Ralph,” my friend said softly, looking worriedly into my face, “I wish I had the feelings about God that you seem to have right now. I’m dying, Ralph; yet I, who have faced death a hundred times, am scared to die. I’m scared to step into the next world. Something inside me says there will be a reckoning when I get there. But it’s all over for me, Ralph. I feel like there’s no chance of me being saved.”

“Don’t say that, Bill,” said I, in deep compassion, “don’t say that. I’m quite sure there’s hope even for you, but I can’t remember the words of the Bible that make me think so. Is there not a Bible on board, Bill?”

“Don’t say that, Bill,” I said, feeling really sorry for him. “Don’t say that. I really believe there’s hope for you, but I can’t recall the Bible verses that give me that idea. Isn’t there a Bible on the ship, Bill?”

“No; the last that was in the ship belonged to a poor boy that was taken aboard against his will. He died, poor lad, I think, through ill treatment and fear. After he was gone the captain found his Bible and flung it overboard.”

“No; the last thing that was on the ship belonged to a poor boy who was taken aboard against his will. He died, poor kid, I think, because of mistreatment and fear. After he was gone, the captain found his Bible and threw it overboard.”

I now reflected, with great sadness and self-reproach, on the way in which I had neglected my Bible; and it flashed across me that I was actually in the sight of God a greater sinner than this blood-stained pirate; for, thought I, he tells me that he never read the Bible, and was never brought up to care for it; whereas I was carefully taught to read it by my own mother, and had read it daily as long as I possessed one, yet to so little purpose that I could not now call to mind a single text that would meet this poor man’s case, and afford him the consolation he so much required. I was much distressed, and taxed my memory for a long time. At last a text did flash into my mind, and I wondered much that I had not thought of it before.

I now reflected, with great sadness and regret, on how I had neglected my Bible; and it hit me that, in God's eyes, I was actually a bigger sinner than this blood-stained pirate. He told me he had never read the Bible and was never raised to care about it; while I had been taught by my own mother to read it and had read it daily for as long as I owned one. Yet, it was so ineffective that I couldn’t remember a single verse that would help this poor man and give him the comfort he desperately needed. I felt very distressed and strained my memory for a long time. Finally, a verse came to mind, and I was surprised I hadn’t thought of it sooner.

“Bill,” said I, in a low voice, “‘Believe on the Lord Jesus Christ and thou shalt be saved.’”

“Bill,” I said quietly, “’Believe in the Lord Jesus Christ and you will be saved.’”

“Ay, Ralph, I’ve heard the missionaries say that before now, but what good can it do me? It’s not for me that. It’s not for the likes o’ me.”

“Ay, Ralph, I’ve heard the missionaries say that before, but what good will it do me? It’s not for me. It’s not for people like me.”

I knew not now what to say, for, although I felt sure that that word was for him as well as for me, I could not remember any other word whereby I could prove it.

I didn't know what to say now, because even though I was sure that word was meant for him as much as for me, I couldn't think of any other word to prove it.

After a short pause, Bill raised his eyes to mine and said, “Ralph, I’ve led a terrible life. I’ve been a sailor since I was a boy, and I’ve gone from bad to worse ever since I left my father’s roof. I’ve been a pirate three years now. It is true I did not choose the trade, but I was inveigled aboard this schooner and kept here by force till I became reckless and at last joined them. Since that time my hand has been steeped in human blood again and again. Your young heart would grow cold if I—; but why should I go on? ’Tis of no use, Ralph; my doom is fixed.”

After a brief pause, Bill looked into my eyes and said, “Ralph, I’ve had a terrible life. I’ve been a sailor since I was a kid, and things have just gotten worse since I left my father’s home. I’ve been a pirate for three years now. It’s true I didn’t choose this life, but I was tricked onto this schooner and kept here by force until I became reckless and finally joined them. Since then, my hands have been covered in blood time and time again. Your young heart would turn cold if I—; but why should I continue? It’s no use, Ralph; my fate is sealed.”

“Bill,” said I, “‘Though your sins be red like crimson, they shall be white as snow.’ ‘Only believe.’”

“Bill,” I said, “‘Even if your sins are as red as crimson, they will be as white as snow.’ ‘Just believe.’”

“Only believe!” cried Bill, starting up on his elbow; “I’ve heard men talk o’ believing as if it was easy. Ha! ’tis easy enough for a man to point to a rope and say, ‘I believe that would bear my weight;’ but ’tis another thing for a man to catch hold o’ that rope, and swing himself by it over the edge of a precipice!”

“Just believe!” Bill shouted, propping himself up on his elbow. “I’ve heard guys talk about believing like it’s a walk in the park. Ha! It’s easy for someone to point at a rope and say, ‘I believe that can hold me up;’ but it’s a whole different story for someone to actually grab that rope and swing themselves over the edge of a cliff!”

The energy with which he said this, and the action with which it was accompanied, were too much for Bill. He sank back with a deep groan. As if the very elements sympathized with this man’s sufferings, a low moan came sweeping over the sea.

The intensity with which he said this, along with the gesture that came with it, overwhelmed Bill. He fell back with a heavy sigh. As if the very forces of nature shared in this man's pain, a soft moan rolled in from the sea.

“Hist! Ralph,” said Bill, opening his eves; “there’s a squall coming, lad. Look alive, boy. Clew up the fore-sail. Drop the main-sail peak. Them squalls come quick sometimes.”

“Hey! Ralph,” said Bill, opening his eyes; “there’s a storm coming, kid. Stay alert, boy. Tie up the front sail. Lower the main sail peak. Those storms can hit fast sometimes.”

I had already started to my feet, and saw that a heavy squall was indeed bearing down on us. It had hitherto escaped my notice, owing to my being so much engrossed by our conversation. I instantly did as Bill desired, for the schooner was still lying motionless on the glassy sea. I observed with some satisfaction that the squall was bearing down on the larboard bow, so that it would strike the vessel in the position in which she would be best able to stand the shock. Having done my best to shorten sail, I returned aft, and took my stand at the helm.

I had already gotten to my feet and saw that a heavy storm was indeed coming our way. I hadn’t noticed it before because I was so wrapped up in our conversation. I immediately did what Bill asked, since the schooner was still sitting still on the calm sea. I felt some satisfaction as I noticed the storm approaching from the left front, meaning it would hit the boat in a way that it would be best able to handle the impact. After I did my best to reduce the sails, I headed back to the rear and took my place at the helm.

“Now, boy,” said Bill, in a faint voice, “keep her close to the wind.”

“Now, kid,” said Bill, in a weak voice, “keep her close to the wind.”

A few seconds afterwards he said, “Ralph, let me hear those two texts again.”

A few seconds later, he said, “Ralph, let me hear those two texts again.”

I repeated them.

I said them again.

“Are ye sure, lad, ye saw them in the Bible?”

“Are you sure, kid, you saw them in the Bible?”

“Quite sure,” I replied.

"Definitely," I replied.

Almost before the words had left my lips the wind burst upon us, and the spray dashed over our decks. For a time the schooner stood it bravely, and sprang forward against the rising sea like a war-horse. Meanwhile clouds darkened the sky, and the sea began to rise in huge billows. There was still too much sail on the schooner, and, as the gale increased, I feared that the masts would be torn out of her or carried away, while the wind whistled and shrieked through the strained rigging. Suddenly the wind shifted a point, a heavy sea struck us on the bow, and the schooner was almost laid on her beam-ends, so that I could scarcely keep my legs. At the same moment Bill lost his hold of the belaying-pin which had served to steady him, and he slid with stunning violence against the sky-light. As he lay on the deck close beside me, I could see that the shock had rendered him insensible, but I did not dare to quit the tiller for an instant, as it required all my faculties, bodily and mental, to manage the schooner. For an hour the blast drove us along, while, owing to the sharpness of the vessel’s bow and the press of canvass, she dashed through the waves instead of breasting over them, thereby drenching the decks with water fore and aft. At the end of that time the squall passed away, and left us rocking on the bosom of the agitated sea.

Almost before the words had left my lips, the wind hit us hard, and the spray crashed over our decks. For a while, the schooner held its own and surged forward against the rising sea like a warhorse. Meanwhile, clouds darkened the sky, and the sea started to rise in huge waves. There was still too much sail on the schooner, and as the gale intensified, I worried that the masts would be ripped out or destroyed while the wind howled and shrieked through the strained rigging. Suddenly, the wind shifted direction, a heavy wave hit us on the bow, and the schooner nearly tipped over, making it hard for me to stay on my feet. At the same moment, Bill lost his grip on the belaying pin that had been keeping him steady and crashed violently against the skylight. As he lay on the deck next to me, I could see that the impact had knocked him out, but I couldn’t leave the tiller for even a second, as it took all my physical and mental effort to control the schooner. For an hour, the storm pushed us along, and due to the sharpness of the vessel’s bow and the tension in the sails, she plowed through the waves instead of riding over them, soaking the decks with water from front to back. After that time, the squall passed, leaving us rocking on the restless sea.

My first care, the instant I could quit the helm, was to raise Bill from the deck and place him on the couch. I then ran below for the brandy bottle and rubbed his face and hands with it, and endeavoured to pour a little down his throat. But my efforts, although I continued them long and assiduously, were of no avail; as I let go the hand which I had been chafing it fell heavily on the deck. I laid my hand over his heart, and sat for some time quite motionless, but there was no flutter there—the pirate was dead!

My first concern, as soon as I could step away from the helm, was to lift Bill off the deck and put him on the couch. I then went below to grab the brandy bottle and rubbed it on his face and hands, trying to pour some down his throat. But despite my persistent efforts, it was no use; when I released the hand I had been rubbing, it fell heavily to the deck. I placed my hand over his heart and sat there for a while completely still, but there was no heartbeat— the pirate was dead!

CHAPTER XXVIII.

Alone on the deep—Necessity the mother of invention—A valuable book discovered—Natural phenomenon—A bright day in my history.

Alone in the depths—Necessity is the mother of invention—A valuable book found—Natural phenomenon—A significant day in my life.

It was with feelings of awe, not unmingled with fear, that I now seated myself on the cabin sky-light and gazed upon the rigid features of my late comrade, while my mind wandered over his past history and contemplated with anxiety my present position. Alone! in the midst of the wide Pacific, having a most imperfect knowledge of navigation, and in a schooner requiring at least eight men as her proper crew. But I will not tax the reader’s patience with a minute detail of my feelings and doings during the first few days that followed the death of my companion. I will merely mention that I tied a cannon ball to his feet and, with feelings of the deepest sorrow, consigned him to the deep.

It was with a mix of awe and fear that I now sat on the cabin skylight, staring at the lifeless face of my late comrade, while my mind drifted through his past and anxiously considered my current situation. Alone! in the vast Pacific, with very little knowledge of navigation, and in a schooner that needed at least eight crew members. But I won’t bore the reader with a detailed account of my feelings and actions during the first few days after my companion's death. I’ll just note that I tied a cannonball to his feet and, filled with deep sorrow, sent him to the depths.

For fully a week after that a steady breeze blew from the east, and, as my course lay west-and-by-north, I made rapid progress towards my destination. I could not take an observation, which I very much regretted, as the captain’s quadrant was in the cabin; but, from the day of setting sail from the island of the savages, I had kept a dead reckoning, and as I knew pretty well now how much lee-way the schooner made, I hoped to hit the Coral Island without much difficulty. In this I was the more confident that I knew its position on the chart (which I understood was a very good one), and so had its correct bearings by compass.

For a full week after that, a steady breeze came from the east, and since my course was west-and-by-north, I made quick progress toward my destination. I couldn't take a reading, which I deeply regretted, as the captain’s quadrant was in the cabin. However, since the day I set sail from the island of the savages, I had been keeping a dead reckoning, and I knew pretty well how much leeway the schooner was making, so I hoped to reach Coral Island without much trouble. I was even more confident because I knew its position on the chart (which I understood was quite good) and had its correct bearings by compass.

As the weather seemed now quite settled and fine, and as I had got into the trade-winds, I set about preparations for hoisting the top-sails. This was a most arduous task, and my first attempts were complete failures, owing, in a great degree, to my reprehensible ignorance of mechanical forces. The first error I made was in applying my apparatus of blocks and pulleys to a rope which was too weak, so that the very first heave I made broke it in two, and sent me staggering against the after-hatch, over which I tripped, and, striking against the main-boom, tumbled down the companion ladder into the cabin. I was much bruised and somewhat stunned by this untoward accident. However, I considered it fortunate that I was not killed. In my next attempt I made sure of not coming by a similar accident, so I unreeved the tackling and fitted up larger blocks and ropes. But although the principle on which I acted was quite correct, the machinery was now so massive and heavy that the mere friction and stiffness of the thick cordage prevented me from moving it at all. Afterwards, however, I came to proportion things more correctly; but I could not avoid reflecting at the time how much better it would have been had I learned all this from observation and study, instead of waiting till I was forced to acquire it through the painful and tedious lessons of experience.

As the weather seemed to be quite settled and nice, and since I had entered the trade winds, I started getting ready to hoist the top sails. This was a really tough job, and my first attempts were total failures, mostly because of my shameful lack of knowledge about mechanical forces. My first mistake was using my system of blocks and pulleys on a rope that was too weak, so the very first pull I made snapped it in two and sent me staggering against the after-hatch. I tripped over it and hit the main boom, falling down the companion ladder into the cabin. I was pretty bruised and a bit dazed by this unfortunate accident. However, I considered it lucky that I wasn't killed. In my next try, I made sure to avoid a similar accident, so I took apart the rigging and set up larger blocks and ropes. But even though the principle I followed was correct, the equipment was now so heavy and cumbersome that the friction and stiffness of the thick ropes made it impossible for me to move it at all. Later, though, I figured out how to proportion things better; but I couldn't help thinking at the time how much better it would have been if I had learned all of this through observation and study, rather than waiting until I had to learn it through the painful and slow lessons of experience.

After the tackling was prepared and in good working order, it took me the greater part of a day to hoist the main-top sail. As I could not steer and work at this at the same time, I lashed the helm in such a position that, with a little watching now and then, it kept the schooner in her proper course. By this means I was enabled also to go about the deck and down below for things that I wanted, as occasion required; also to cook and eat my victuals. But I did not dare to trust to this plan during the three hours of rest that I allowed myself at night, as the wind might have shifted, in which case I should have been blown far out of my course ere I awoke. I was, therefore, in the habit of heaving-to during those three hours; that is, fixing the rudder and the sails in such a position as that by acting against each other, they would keep the ship stationary. After my night’s rest, therefore, I had only to make allowance for the lee-way she had made, and so resume my course.

After I got the tackling ready and working well, it took me most of a day to hoist the main top sail. Since I couldn't steer and work on that at the same time, I secured the helm in a way that allowed the schooner to stay on course with just a bit of occasional monitoring. This setup also let me move around the deck and below deck to grab what I needed, and it gave me time to cook and eat my meals. However, I didn’t feel comfortable relying on this plan during the three hours of rest I allowed myself at night, since the wind could have changed, which would have blown me off course by the time I woke up. So, I usually parked the boat during those three hours, which meant setting the rudder and sails in a way that they worked against each other to keep the ship in place. After my night’s rest, I just needed to account for any drift and then get back on my course.

Of course I was to some extent anxious lest another squall should come, but I made the best provision I could in the circumstances, and concluded that by letting go the weather-braces of the top-sails and the top-sail halyards at the same time, I should thereby render these sails almost powerless. Besides this, I proposed to myself to keep a sharp look-out on the barometer in the cabin, and if I observed at any time a sudden fall in it, I resolved that I would instantly set about my multiform appliances for reducing sail, so as to avoid being taken at unawares. Thus I sailed prosperously for two weeks, with a fair wind, so that I calculated I must be drawing near to the Coral Island; at the thought of which my heart bounded with joyful expectation.

Of course, I was somewhat anxious that another storm might hit, but I made the best preparations I could under the circumstances. I decided to loosen the weather braces of the topsails and the topsail halyards at the same time, which would make those sails almost useless. Additionally, I planned to keep a close eye on the barometer in the cabin, and if I noticed a sudden drop, I promised myself I would immediately start reducing sail to avoid being caught off guard. For two weeks, I sailed smoothly with a good wind, and I figured I must be getting close to Coral Island, which made my heart race with excitement.

The only book I found on board, after a careful search, was a volume of Captain Cook’s voyages. This, I suppose, the pirate captain had brought with him in order to guide him, and to furnish him with information regarding the islands of these seas. I found this a most delightful book indeed, and I not only obtained much interesting knowledge about the sea in which I was sailing, but I had many of my own opinions, derived from experience, corroborated; and not a few of them corrected. Besides the reading of this charming book, and the daily routine of occupations, nothing of particular note happened to me during this voyage, except once, when on rising one night, after my three hours’ nap, while it was yet dark, I was amazed and a little alarmed to find myself floating in what appeared to be a sea of blue fire! I had often noticed the beautiful appearance of phosphorescent light, but this far exceeded anything of the sort I ever saw before. The whole sea appeared somewhat like milk and was remarkably luminous.

The only book I found on board, after searching carefully, was a volume of Captain Cook’s voyages. I guess the pirate captain had brought it to guide him and provide information about the islands in these seas. I found it to be a really enjoyable book, and I not only gained a lot of interesting knowledge about the sea I was sailing in, but many of my own opinions, based on experience, were confirmed and some corrected. Besides reading this lovely book and going through my daily routine, nothing particularly notable happened to me during this voyage, except for one time when, after waking up from a three-hour nap while it was still dark, I was astonished and a little scared to find myself floating in what looked like a sea of blue fire! I had often noticed the beautiful phosphorescent light, but this was far more impressive than anything I had seen before. The entire sea looked somewhat like milk and was incredibly luminous.

I rose in haste, and, letting down a bucket into the sea, brought some of the water on board and took it down to the cabin to examine it; but no sooner did I approach the light than the strange appearance disappeared, and when I removed the cabin lamp the luminous light appeared again. I was much puzzled with this, and took up a little of the water in the hollow of my hand and then let it run off, when I found that the luminous substance was left behind on my palm. I ran with it to the lamp; but when I got there it was gone. I found, however, that when I went into the dark my hand shone again; so I took the large glass of the ship’s telescope and examined my hand minutely, when I found that there were on it one or two small patches of a clear, transparent substance like jelly, which were so thin as to be almost invisible to the naked eye. Thus I came to know that the beautiful phosphoric light, which I had so often admired before, was caused by animals, for I had no doubt that these were of the same kind as the medusae or jelly-fish which are seen in all parts of the world.

I quickly got up and lowered a bucket into the sea, pulling some water on board and taking it down to the cabin to check it out. But as soon as I got near the light, the strange appearance vanished, and when I switched off the cabin lamp, the glowing light came back. I was really confused by this, so I scooped a little of the water into my hand and let it drip out, only to find that the glowing substance was left on my palm. I rushed to the lamp, but by the time I got there, it was gone. However, I noticed that when I went into the dark, my hand shone again. So, I grabbed the big lens of the ship’s telescope and examined my hand closely, discovering one or two small patches of a clear, jelly-like substance that were so thin they were almost invisible to the naked eye. That’s when I figured out that the beautiful phosphorescent light I had admired before was produced by animals, as I had no doubt these were similar to the jellyfish found all around the world.

On the evening of my fourteenth day, I was awakened out of a nap into which I had fallen by a loud cry, and starting up, I gazed around me. I was surprised and delighted to see a large albatross soaring majestically over the ship. I immediately took it into my head that this was the albatross I had seen at Penguin Island. I had, of course, no good reason for supposing this, but the idea occurred to me, I know not why, and I cherished it, and regarded the bird with as much affection as if he had been an old friend. He kept me company all that day and left me as night fell.

On the evening of my fourteenth day, I was jolted awake from a nap by a loud cry. Sitting up, I looked around. I was both surprised and thrilled to see a large albatross soaring gracefully over the ship. I immediately thought this was the albatross I had seen at Penguin Island. I didn’t really have any good reason to think that, but the idea came to me for some reason, and I held onto it, watching the bird with as much fondness as if it were an old friend. It stayed with me all day and flew away as night fell.

Next morning as I stood motionless and with heavy eyes at the helm, for I had not slept well, I began to weary anxiously for day-light, and peered towards the horizon, where I thought I observed something like a black cloud against the dark sky. Being always on the alert for squalls, I ran to the bow. There could be no doubt it was a squall, and as I listened I thought I heard the murmur of the coming gale. Instantly I began to work might and main at my cumbrous tackle for shortening sail, and in the course of an hour and a half had the most of it reduced,—the top-sail yards down on the caps, the top-sails clewed up, the sheets hauled in, the main and fore peaks lowered, and the flying-jib down. While thus engaged the dawn advanced, and I cast an occasional furtive glance ahead in the midst of my labour. But now that things were prepared for the worst, I ran forward again and looked anxiously over the bow. I now heard the roar of the waves distinctly, and as a single ray of the rising sun gleamed over the ocean I saw—what! could it be that I was dreaming?—that magnificent breaker with its ceaseless roar!—that mountain top!—yes, once more I beheld the Coral Island!

The next morning, as I stood still with heavy eyes at the helm because I hadn’t slept well, I started to anxiously wait for daylight and squinted toward the horizon, where I thought I saw something like a black cloud against the dark sky. Always on the lookout for squalls, I rushed to the bow. There was no doubt it was a squall, and as I listened, I thought I could hear the low rumble of the approaching wind. Right away, I began to work hard on my cumbersome equipment to reduce the sail, and within an hour and a half, I had most of it taken down—the top-sail yards lowered onto the caps, the top-sails furled, the sheets pulled in, the main and fore peaks lowered, and the flying-jib down. While I was busy, dawn broke, and I stole a few glances ahead as I worked. But now that I was ready for the worst, I ran forward again and looked anxiously over the bow. I could hear the roar of the waves clearly, and as a single ray of the rising sun shimmered over the ocean, I saw—what! Could I be dreaming?—that magnificent breaker with its endless roar!—that mountain peak!—yes, once again I saw the Coral Island!

CHAPTER XXIX.

The effect of a cannon-shot—A happy reunion of a somewhat moist nature—Retrospects and explanations—An awful dive—New plans—The last of the Coral Island.

The impact of a cannon blast—A joyful reunion that’s a bit damp—Looking back and clarifying—A terrifying plunge—Fresh plans—The final moments on Coral Island.

I almost fell upon the deck with the tumult of mingled emotions that filled my heart, as I gazed ardently towards my beautiful island. It was still many miles away, but sufficiently near to enable me to trace distinctly the well-remembered outlines of the two mountains. My first impulse was to utter an exclamation of gratitude for being carried to my former happy home in safety; my second, to jump up, clap my hands, shout, and run up and down the deck, with no other object in view than that of giving vent to my excited feelings. Then I went below for the telescope, and spent nearly ten minutes of the utmost impatience in vainly trying to get a focus, and in rubbing the skin nearly off my eyes, before I discovered that having taken off the large glass to examine the phosphoric water with I had omitted to put it on again.

I almost fell on the deck from the rush of mixed emotions that filled my heart as I stared longingly at my beautiful island. It was still miles away, but close enough for me to clearly see the familiar shapes of the two mountains. My first instinct was to shout out in gratitude for being safely brought back to my former happy home; my second was to jump up, clap my hands, shout, and run back and forth on the deck, just to let out my excitement. Then I went below for the telescope and spent nearly ten minutes in extreme frustration trying to get a focus and rubbing my eyes almost raw, only to realize that after taking off the large lens to check the glowing water, I had forgotten to put it back on.

After that I looked up impatiently at the sails, which I now regretted having lowered so hastily, and for a moment thought of hoisting the main-top sail again; but recollecting that it would take me full half a day to accomplish, and that, at the present rate of sailing, two hours would bring me to the island, I immediately dismissed the idea.

After that, I looked up at the sails with frustration, realizing I regretted lowering them so quickly. For a moment, I considered raising the main topsail again, but then I remembered it would take me half a day to do that, and at the current speed, I’d reach the island in just two hours. So, I quickly dismissed the thought.

The remainder of the time I spent in making feverish preparations for arriving and seeing my dear comrades. I remembered that they were not in the habit of rising before six, and, as it was now only three, I hoped to arrive before they were awake. Moreover, I set about making ready to let go the anchor, resolving in my own mind that, as I knew the depth of water in the passage of the reef and within the lagoon, I would run the schooner in and bring up opposite the bower. Fortunately the anchor was hanging at the cat-head, otherwise I should never have been able to use it. Now, I had only to cut the tackling, and it would drop of its own weight. After searching among the flags, I found the terrible black one, which I ran up to the peak. While I was doing this, a thought struck me. I went to the powder magazine, brought up a blank cartridge and loaded the big brass gun, which, it will be remembered, was unhoused when we set sail, and, as I had no means of housing it, there it had stood, bristling alike at fair weather and foul all the voyage. I took care to grease its mouth well, and, before leaving the fore part of the ship, thrust the poker into the fire.

I spent the rest of my time nervously getting ready to arrive and see my dear friends. I remembered that they usually didn't wake up before six, and since it was only three, I hoped to get there before they were up. I also started preparing to drop the anchor, deciding that since I knew the water depth in the reef passage and the lagoon, I'd bring the schooner in and drop anchor opposite the bower. Luckily, the anchor was hanging at the cat-head; if it weren't, I wouldn't have been able to use it. Now, I just had to cut the tackle, and it would drop by itself. After searching through the flags, I found the dreaded black one, which I hoisted to the peak. While I was doing this, a thought hit me. I went to the powder magazine, brought up a blank cartridge, and loaded the big brass gun, which, as you'll recall, had been exposed since we set sail, and since I couldn't cover it, it had been standing there, exposed to the elements for the whole trip. I made sure to grease its mouth well, and before leaving the front of the ship, I stuck the poker in the fire.

All was now ready. A steady five-knot breeze was blowing, so that I was now not more than quarter of a mile from the reef. I was soon at the entrance, and, as the schooner glided quietly through, I glanced affectionately at the huge breaker, as if it had been the same one I had seen there when I bade adieu, as I feared for ever, to the island. On coming opposite the Water Garden, I put the helm hard down. The schooner came round with a rapid, graceful bend, and lost way just opposite the bower. Running forward, I let go the anchor, caught up the red-hot poker, applied it to the brass gun, and the mountains with a bang, such as had only once before broke their slumbering echoes!

All was now ready. A steady five-knot breeze was blowing, so I was now no more than a quarter of a mile from the reef. I soon reached the entrance, and as the schooner glided smoothly through, I glanced fondly at the huge breaker, as if it was the same one I had seen when I said goodbye, fearing it would be forever, to the island. When I was opposite the Water Garden, I turned the helm hard down. The schooner turned with a quick, graceful curve and came to a stop right in front of the bower. Running forward, I dropped the anchor, grabbed the red-hot poker, applied it to the brass gun, and the mountains echoed with a bang, the likes of which had only once before broken their slumbering silence!

Effective although it was, however, it was scarcely equal to the bang with which, instantly after, Peterkin bounded from the bower, in scanty costume, his eye-balls starting from his head with surprise and terror. One gaze he gave, one yell, and then fled into the bushes like a wild cat. The next moment Jack went through exactly the same performance, the only difference being, that his movements were less like those of Jack-in-the-box, though not less vigorous and rapid than those of Peterkin.

Effective as it was, it still couldn’t match the shock when, right after, Peterkin jumped out of the bower in minimal clothing, his eyes wide with surprise and fear. He took one look, let out a scream, and then darted into the bushes like a wildcat. Moments later, Jack did the exact same thing, the only difference being that his movements were less like a Jack-in-the-box, but just as energetic and quick as Peterkin’s.

“Hallo!” I shouted, almost mad with joy, “what, ho! Peterkin! Jack! hallo! it’s me!”

“Hey!” I yelled, nearly crazy with happiness, “what’s up! Peterkin! Jack! hey! it’s me!”

My shout was just in time to arrest them. They halted and turned round, and, the instant I repeated the cry, I saw that they recognised my voice, by both of them running at full speed towards the beach. I could no longer contain myself. Throwing off my jacket, I jumped overboard at the same moment that Jack bounded into the sea. In another moment we met in deep water, clasped each other round the neck, and sank, as a matter of course, to the bottom! We were well-nigh choked, and instantly struggled to the surface, where Peterkin was spluttering about like a wounded duck, laughing and crying by turns, and choking himself with salt water!

My shout was perfectly timed to stop them. They stopped and turned around, and as soon as I yelled again, I could see they recognized my voice, both of them sprinting full speed towards the beach. I couldn't hold back anymore. I tossed off my jacket and jumped overboard just as Jack leaped into the water. Moments later, we met in deep water, wrapped our arms around each other, and naturally sank to the bottom! We were almost choking and quickly struggled to the surface, where Peterkin was floundering like a wounded duck, laughing and crying at the same time while gagging on salt water!

It would be impossible to convey to my reader, by description, an adequate conception of the scene that followed my landing on the beach, as we stood embracing each other indiscriminately in our dripping garments, and giving utterance to incoherent rhapsodies, mingled with wild shouts. It can be more easily imagined than described, so I will draw a curtain over this part of my history, and carry the reader forward over an interval of three days.

It would be impossible to adequately describe to my reader the scene that followed my arrival on the beach, as we stood hugging each other in our soaked clothes and expressing incoherent joy, mixed with loud shouts. It’s easier to imagine than to describe, so I’ll skip over this part of my story and bring the reader forward three days.

During the greater part of that period Peterkin did nothing but roast pigs, taro, and bread-fruit, and ply me with plantains, plums, potatoes, and cocoa-nuts, while I related to him and Jack the terrible and wonderful adventures I had gone through since we last met. After I had finished the account, they made me go all over it again; and, when I had concluded the second recital, I had to go over it again, while they commented upon it piecemeal. They were much affected by what I told them of the probable fate of Avatea, and Peterkin could by no means brook the idea of the poor girl being converted into a long pig! As for Jack, he clenched his teeth, and shook his fist towards the sea, saying at the same time, that he was sorry he had not broken Tararo’s head, and he only hoped that one day he should be able to plant his knuckles on the bridge of that chief’s nose! After they had “pumped me dry,” as Peterkin said, I begged to be informed of what had happened to them during my long absence, and particularly as to how they got out of the Diamond Cave.

During most of that time, Peterkin only cooked pigs, taro, and breadfruit, while serving me plantains, plums, potatoes, and coconuts, as I shared with him and Jack the amazing and terrifying adventures I had experienced since we last saw each other. After I finished my story, they insisted that I go through it again, and when I wrapped up the second telling, I had to go over it yet again while they commented on it piece by piece. They were very moved by what I told them about Avatea’s likely fate, and Peterkin couldn't stand the thought of the poor girl being turned into a long pig! As for Jack, he gritted his teeth and shook his fist at the sea, saying that he regretted not smashing Tararo’s head and he hoped that someday he could land a punch on that chief’s nose! After they had “pumped me dry,” as Peterkin put it, I asked to hear what had happened to them during my long absence, especially how they escaped from the Diamond Cave.

“Well, you must know,” began Jack, “after you had dived out of the cave, on the day you were taken away from us, we waited very patiently for half an hour, not expecting you to return before the end of that time. Then we began to upbraid you for staying so long, when you knew we would be anxious; but when an hour passed, we became alarmed, and I resolved at all hazards to dive out, and see what had become of you, although I felt for poor Peterkin, because, as he truly said, ‘If you never come back, I’m shut up here for life.’ However, I promised not to run any risk, and he let me go; which, to say truth, I thought very courageous of him!”

“Well, you should know,” Jack started, “after you jumped out of the cave on the day you were taken from us, we waited patiently for half an hour, not expecting you to be back before that time. Then we started to scold you for taking so long, knowing we’d be worried; but when an hour passed, we got really worried, and I decided I had to jump out and see what happened to you, even though I felt bad for poor Peterkin, because as he honestly said, ‘If you don’t come back, I’m stuck here for life.’ Still, I promised not to take any risks, and he let me go, which, to be honest, I thought was really brave of him!”

“I should just think it was!” interrupted Peterkin, looking at Jack over the edge of a monstrous potato which he happened to be devouring at the time.

“I should just think it was!” interrupted Peterkin, glancing at Jack over the edge of a huge potato he happened to be eating at the time.

“Well,” continued Jack, “you may guess my consternation when you did not answer to my halloo. At first I imagined that the pirates must have killed you, and left you in the bush, or thrown you into the sea; then it occurred to me that this would have served no end of theirs, so I came to the conclusion that they must have carried you away with them. As this thought struck me, I observed the pirate schooner standing away to the nor’ard, almost hull-down on the horizon, and I sat down on the rocks to watch her as she slowly sank from my sight. And I tell you, Ralph, my boy, that I shed more tears that time, at losing you, than I have done, I verify believe, all my life before—”

“Well,” Jack continued, “you can imagine my panic when you didn’t respond to my shout. At first, I thought the pirates might’ve killed you and left you in the bushes or thrown you into the sea; then it hit me that wouldn’t really benefit them, so I figured they must have taken you with them. As that thought crossed my mind, I saw the pirate schooner drifting northward, barely visible on the horizon, and I sat down on the rocks to watch as it slowly disappeared from sight. And I tell you, Ralph, my friend, I cried more tears this time, over losing you, than I think I ever have in my whole life—”

“Pardon me, Jack, for interrupting,” said Peterkin; “surely you must be mistaken in that; you’ve often told me that, when you were a baby, you used to howl and roar from morning to—”

“Excuse me, Jack, for interrupting,” said Peterkin; “you must be mistaken about that; you’ve often told me that, when you were a baby, you used to cry and scream from morning to—”

“Hold your tongue, Peterkin,” cried Jack. “Well, after the schooner had disappeared, I dived back into the cave, much to Peterkin’s relief, and told him what I had seen. We sat down and had a long talk over this matter, and then we agreed to make a regular, systematic search through the woods, so as to make sure, at least, that you had not been killed. But now we thought of the difficulty of getting out of the cave without your help. Peterkin became dreadfully nervous when he thought of this; and I must confess that I felt some alarm, for, of course, I could not hope alone to take him out so quickly as we two together had brought him in; and he himself vowed that, if we had been a moment longer with him that time, he would have had to take a breath of salt water. However, there was no help for it, and I endeavoured to calm his fears as well as I could: ‘for,’ said I, ‘you can’t live here, Peterkin;’ to which he replied, ‘Of course not, Jack, I can only die here, and, as that’s not at all desirable, you had better propose something.’ So I suggested that he should take a good long breath, and trust himself to me.

“Be quiet, Peterkin,” Jack shouted. “Well, after the schooner had vanished, I dove back into the cave, much to Peterkin’s relief, and I told him what I had seen. We sat down and had a long discussion about this situation, and then we decided to conduct a proper, organized search through the woods to at least ensure that you hadn’t been killed. But then we remembered the challenge of getting out of the cave without your help. Peterkin became extremely anxious when he thought about it; and I must admit I felt some worry too, because, of course, I couldn’t expect to get him out on my own as quickly as we had brought him in together; and he insisted that if we had stayed with him just a moment longer that time, he would have had to take a breath of salt water. Anyway, there was no other choice, and I tried my best to calm his fears: ‘because,’ I said, ‘you can’t live here, Peterkin;’ to which he replied, ‘Of course not, Jack, I can only die here, and since that’s not at all desirable, you’d better suggest something.’ So I suggested that he take a deep breath and trust me.

“‘Might we not make a large bag of cocoa-nut cloth, into which I could shove my head, and tie it tight round my neck?’ he asked, with a haggard smile. ‘It might let me get one breath under water!’

“‘What if we made a big bag out of coconut fabric, so I could stick my head in and tie it tightly around my neck?’ he asked, with a weary smile. ‘It might help me take one breath underwater!’”

“‘No use,’ said I; ‘it would fill in a moment and suffocate you. I see nothing for it, Peterkin, if you really can’t keep your breath so long, but to let me knock you down, and carry you out while in a state of insensibility.’

“‘There’s no point,’ I said; ‘it would fill up in no time and suffocate you. I don’t see any other option, Peterkin, if you really can’t hold your breath that long, but for me to knock you out and carry you out while you’re unconscious.’”

“But Peterkin didn’t relish this idea. He seemed to fear that I could not be able to measure the exact force of the blow, and might, on the one hand, hit him so softly as to render a second or third blow necessary, which would be very uncomfortable; or, on the other hand, give him such a smash as would entirely spoil his figure-head, or, mayhap, knock the life out of him altogether! At last I got him persuaded to try to hold his breath, and commit himself to me; so he agreed, and down we went. But I had not got him half way through, when he began to struggle and kick like a wild bull, burst from my grasp, and hit against the roof of the tunnel. I was therefore, obliged to force him violently back into the cave gain, where he rose panting to the surface. In short, he had lost his presence of mind, and—”

“But Peterkin didn't like this idea. He seemed to worry that I might not be able to hit him with just the right amount of force. On one hand, I could hit him too lightly, making it necessary to hit him a second or third time, which would be really uncomfortable; or, on the other hand, I could hit him so hard that it would mess up his appearance completely or even knock the life out of him! Eventually, I convinced him to try holding his breath and trust me, so he agreed, and down we went. But I hadn't even gotten him halfway through when he started to struggle and kick like a wild bull, broke free from my grip, and banged against the roof of the tunnel. So, I had to force him back into the cave, where he surfaced panting. In short, he had lost his composure, and—”

“Nothing of the sort,” cried Peterkin, indignantly, “I had only lost my wind; and if I had not had presence of mind enough to kick as I did, I should have bu’st in your arms!”

“Nothing like that,” shouted Peterkin, indignantly. “I just lost my breath; and if I hadn’t been quick enough to kick like I did, I would’ve collapsed in your arms!”

“Well, well, so be it,” resumed Jack, with a smile, “but the upshot of it was, that we had to hold another consultation on the point, and I really believe that, had it not been for a happy thought of mine, we should have been consulting there yet.”

“Well, well, fine then,” Jack continued with a smile, “but the result was that we had to hold another meeting about it, and I honestly think that if it hadn't been for a clever idea of mine, we would still be discussing it.”

“I wish we had,” again interrupted Peterkin with a sigh. “I’m sure, Ralph, if I had thought that you were coming back again, I would willingly have awaited your return for months, rather than have endured the mental agony which I went through! But proceed.”

“I wish we had,” Peterkin interrupted again with a sigh. “I’m sure, Ralph, if I had known you were coming back, I would have gladly waited for you for months instead of going through the mental anguish I experienced! But go on.”

“The thought was this,” continued Jack, “that I should tie Peterkin’s hands and feet with cords, and then lash him firmly to a stout pole about five feet long, in order to render him quite powerless, and keep him straight and stiff. You should have seen his face of horror, Ralph, when I suggested this: but he came to see that it was his only chance, and told me to set about it as fast as I could; ‘for,’ said he, ‘this is no jokin’, Jack, I can tell you, and the sooner it’s done the better.’ I soon procured the cordage and a suitable pole, with which I returned to the cave, and lashed him as stiff and straight as an Egyptian mummy; and, to say truth, he was no bad representation of what an English mummy would be, if there were such things, for he was as white as a dead man.”

“The idea was this,” Jack went on, “that I should tie Peterkin’s hands and feet with ropes, and then secure him tightly to a sturdy pole about five feet long, to make him completely powerless and keep him straight and rigid. You should have seen the horror on his face, Ralph, when I suggested this: but he realized it was his only chance and told me to get on with it as quickly as I could; ‘because,’ he said, ‘this is no joke, Jack, I can tell you, and the sooner it’s done the better.’ I quickly got the ropes and a suitable pole, and returned to the cave, tying him up as stiff and straight as an Egyptian mummy; and honestly, he was a pretty good representation of what an English mummy would look like, if such a thing existed, because he was as pale as a dead man.”

“‘Now,’ said Peterkin, in a tremulous voice, ‘swim with me as near to the edge of the hole as you can before you dive, then let me take a long breath, and, as I sha’nt be able to speak after I’ve taken it, you’ll watch my face, and the moment you see me wink—dive! And oh!’ he added, earnestly, ‘pray don’t be long!’

“‘Now,’ said Peterkin, in a shaky voice, ‘swim with me as close to the edge of the hole as you can before you dive. Then let me take a deep breath, and since I won’t be able to speak after that, you’ll need to watch my face. The moment you see me wink—dive! And oh!’ he added, urgently, ‘please don’t take too long!’”

“I promised to pay the strictest attention to his wishes, and swam with him to the outlet of the cave. Here I paused. ‘Now then,’ said I, ‘pull away at the wind, lad.’”

“I promised to pay close attention to what he wanted, and I swam with him to the cave's exit. Here I stopped. ‘Alright,’ I said, ‘pull hard at the sail, buddy.’”

Peterkin drew in a breath so long that I could not help thinking of the frog in the fable, that wanted to swell itself as big as the ox. Then I looked into his face earnestly. Slap went the lid of his right eye; down went my head, and up went my heels. We shot through the passage like an arrow, and rose to the surface of the open sea before you could count twenty!

Peterkin took a deep breath, making me think of the frog from that fable that wanted to puff itself up as big as the ox. Then I looked intently at his face. The lid of his right eye snapped shut; I ducked my head, and my heels shot up. We zipped through the passage like an arrow and shot up to the surface of the open sea before you could even count to twenty!

“Peterkin had taken in such an awful load of wind that, on reaching the free air, he let it out with a yell loud enough to have been heard a mile off, and then, the change in his feelings was so sudden and great, that he did not wait till we landed, but began, tied up as he was, to shout and sing for joy as I supported him with my left arm to the shore. However, in the middle of a laugh that a hyaena might have envied, I let him accidentally slip, which extinguished him in a moment.

“Peterkin had taken in such a huge gulp of air that, as soon as he hit the open air, he let it out with a yell loud enough to be heard a mile away. The change in how he felt was so sudden and intense that he didn’t wait for us to land; he started shouting and singing with joy while I supported him with my left arm to the shore. However, in the middle of a laugh that even a hyena would have envied, I accidentally let him slip, and that shut him up in an instant.”

“After this happy deliverance, we immediately began our search for your dead body, Ralph, and you have no idea how low our hearts sank as we set off, day after day, to examine the valleys and mountain sides with the utmost care. In about three weeks we completed the survey of the whole island, and had at least the satisfaction of knowing that you had not been killed. But it occurred to us that you might have been thrown into the sea, so we examined the sands and the lagoon carefully, and afterwards went all round the outer reef. One day, while we were upon the reef, Peterkin espied a small dark object lying among the rocks, which seemed to be quite different from the surrounding stones. We hastened towards the spot, and found it to be a small keg. On knocking out the head we discovered that it was gunpowder.”

“After this fortunate escape, we immediately started our search for your body, Ralph, and you can't imagine how heavy our hearts felt as we went out day after day to carefully check the valleys and mountainsides. About three weeks later, we finished searching the entire island, and at least we were relieved to know that you hadn’t been killed. But we thought you might have been tossed into the sea, so we carefully examined the sands and the lagoon, and then explored the entire outer reef. One day, while we were on the reef, Peterkin spotted a small dark object among the rocks that looked entirely different from the surrounding stones. We hurried over to check it out and found it was a small keg. When we knocked out the head, we discovered it was filled with gunpowder.”

“It was I who sent you that, Jack,” said I, with a smile.

“It was me who sent you that, Jack,” I said with a smile.

“Fork out!” cried Peterkin, energetically, starting to his feet and extending his open hand to Jack. “Down with the money, sir, else I’ll have you shut up for life in a debtor’s prison the moment we return to England!”

“Pay up!” yelled Peterkin, jumping to his feet and holding out his open hand to Jack. “Hand over the cash, or I’ll have you thrown in debtor’s prison for life as soon as we get back to England!”

“I’ll give you an I.O.U. in the meantime,” returned Jack, laughing, “so sit down and be quiet. The fact is, Ralph, when we discovered this keg of powder, Peterkin immediately took me a bet of a thousand pounds that you had something to do with it, and I took him a bet of ten thousand that you had not.

“I’ll give you an I.O.U. for now,” Jack said, laughing, “so just sit down and be quiet. The truth is, Ralph, when we found this keg of powder, Peterkin instantly bet me a thousand pounds that you were involved, and I bet him ten thousand that you weren’t.

“Peterkin was right then,” said I, explaining how the thing had occurred.

“Peterkin was right then,” I said, explaining how it all happened.

“Well, we found it very useful,” continued Jack; “although some of it had got a little damp; and we furbished up the old pistol, with which Peterkin is a crack shot now. But, to continue. We did not find any other vestige of you on the reef, and, finally, gave up all hope of ever seeing you again. After this the island became a dreary place to us, and we began to long for a ship to heave in sight and take us off. But now that you’re back again, my dear fellow, it looks as bright and cheerful as it used to do, and I love it as much as ever.”

“Well, we found it really useful,” Jack continued; “even though some of it got a bit damp; and we polished up the old pistol, which Peterkin is a great shot with now. But to keep going. We didn’t find any other sign of you on the reef, and we eventually gave up all hope of ever seeing you again. After that, the island felt like a gloomy place to us, and we started to wish for a ship to show up and take us away. But now that you’re back, my dear friend, it looks as bright and cheerful as it used to, and I love it just as much as ever.”

“And now,” continued Jack, “I have a great desire to visit some of the other islands of the South Seas. Here we have a first-rate schooner at our disposal, so I don’t see what should hinder us.”

“And now,” Jack continued, “I really want to explore some of the other islands in the South Seas. We have an excellent schooner available, so I don’t see what could stop us.”

“Just the very thing I was going to propose,” cried Peterkin; “I vote for starting at once.”

“Exactly what I was about to suggest,” shouted Peterkin; “I say we start right now.”

“Well, then,” said Jack, “it seems to me that we could not do better than shape our course for the island on which Avatea lives, and endeavour to persuade Tararo to let her marry the black fellow to whom she is engaged, instead of making a long pig of her. If he has a spark of gratitude in him he’ll do it. Besides, having become champions for this girl once before, it behoves us, as true knights, not to rest until we set her free; at least, all the heroes in all the story-books I have ever read would count it foul disgrace to leave such a work unfinished.”

“Well, then,” said Jack, “it seems to me that we can't do better than head to the island where Avatea lives and try to convince Tararo to let her marry the guy she’s engaged to instead of turning her into a long pig. If he has any gratitude, he’ll agree. Besides, since we’ve already stood up for this girl before, it's our duty as true knights to keep fighting until we set her free; at least, all the heroes in every storybook I've ever read would consider it a disgrace to leave such a task unfinished.”

“I’m sure I don’t know, or care, what your knights in story-books would do,” said Peterkin, “but I’m certain that it would be capital fun, so I’m your man whenever you want me.”

“I don’t know, and honestly don’t care, what your knights in fairy tales would do,” said Peterkin, “but I know it would be a lot of fun, so I’m in whenever you need me.”

This plan of Jack’s was quite in accordance with his romantic, impulsive nature; and, having made up his mind to save this black girl, he could not rest until the thing was commenced.

This plan of Jack’s fit perfectly with his romantic, impulsive nature; and, having decided to save this Black girl, he couldn’t relax until he got started.

“But there may be great danger in this attempt,” he said, at the end of a long consultation on the subject; “will you, lads, go with me in spite of this?”

“But there might be a lot of danger in this effort,” he said, after a long discussion on the topic; “will you, guys, come with me despite this?”

“Go with you?” we repeated in the same breath.

“Go with you?” we echoed in unison.

“Can you doubt it?” said I.

“Can you really doubt it?” I asked.

“For a moment,” added Peterkin.

“For a moment,” Peterkin said.

I need scarcely say that, having made up our minds to go on this enterprise, we lost no time in making preparations to quit the island; and as the schooner was well laden with stores of every kind for a long cruise, we had little to do except to add to our abundant supply a quantity of cocoa-nuts, bread-fruit, taro, yams, plums, and potatoes, chiefly with the view of carrying the fragrance of our dear island along with us as long as we could.

I hardly need to say that, once we decided to take on this mission, we wasted no time getting ready to leave the island. Since the schooner was already packed with supplies for a long journey, we really only had to add some cocoa nuts, breadfruit, taro, yams, plums, and potatoes, mainly to bring a bit of the sweet scent of our beloved island with us for as long as possible.

When all was ready, we paid a farewell visit to the different familiar spots where most of our time had been spent. We ascended the mountain top, and gazed for the last time at the rich green foliage in the valleys, the white sandy beach, the placid lagoon, and the barrier coral-reef with its crested breakers. Then we descended to Spouting Cliff, and looked down at the pale-green monster which we had made such fruitless efforts to spear in days gone by. From this we hurried to the Water Garden and took a last dive into its clear waters, and a last gambol amongst its coral groves. I hurried out before my companions, and dressed in haste, in order to have a long examination of my tank, which Peterkin, in the fulness of his heart, had tended with the utmost care, as being a vivid remembrancer of me, rather than out of love for natural history. It was in superb condition;—the water as clear and pellucid as crystal; the red and green sea-weed of the most brilliant hues; the red, purple, yellow, green, and striped anemones fully expanded, and stretching out their arms as if to welcome and embrace their former master; the starfish, zoophytes, sea-pens, and other innumerable marine insects, looking fresh and beautiful; and the crabs, as Peterkin said, looking as wide awake, impertinent, rampant, and pugnacious as ever. It was indeed so lovely and so interesting that I would scarcely allow myself to be torn away from it.

When everything was ready, we took a farewell trip to the familiar places where we had spent most of our time. We climbed to the top of the mountain and took one last look at the lush green trees in the valleys, the white sandy beach, the calm lagoon, and the coral reef with its waves crashing. Then we hurried down to Spouting Cliff and peered down at the pale-green creature we had tried so hard to spear in the past. From there, we rushed to the Water Garden and took one last swim in its clear waters, playing once more among its coral groves. I went out ahead of my friends and quickly got dressed to spend some time checking on my tank, which Peterkin had taken great care of, more as a reminder of me than out of a love for natural history. It was in excellent condition—the water as clear as crystal; the red and green seaweed displaying the brightest colors; the red, purple, yellow, green, and striped anemones fully open, reaching out their arms as if greeting their former owner; the starfish, zoophytes, sea pens, and countless other marine creatures looking fresh and beautiful; and the crabs, as Peterkin said, looking as alert, cheeky, lively, and feisty as ever. It was so beautiful and captivating that I could hardly bring myself to leave it.

Last of all, we returned to the bower and collected the few articles we possessed, such as the axe, the pencil-case, the broken telescope, the pen-knife, the hook made from the brass ring, and the sail-needle, with which we had landed on the island;—also, the long boots and the pistol, besides several curious articles of costume which we had manufactured from time to time.

Last of all, we went back to the shelter and gathered the few things we had, like the axe, the pencil case, the broken telescope, the penknife, the hook made from the brass ring, and the sail-needle we used when we arrived on the island; also, the long boots and the pistol, along with several interesting costume pieces we had made over time.

These we conveyed on board in our little boat, after having carved our names on a chip of iron-wood, thus:—

These we brought on board in our small boat, after carving our names on a piece of ironwood like this:—

JACK MARTIN,
RALPH ROVER,
PETERKIN GAY,

JACK MARTIN,
RALPH ROVER,
PETERKIN GAY,

which we fixed up inside of the bower. The boat was then hoisted on board and the anchor weighed; which latter operation cost us great labour and much time, as the anchor was so heavy that we could not move it without the aid of my complex machinery of blocks and pulleys. A steady breeze was blowing off shore when we set sail, at a little before sunset. It swept us quickly past the reef and out to sea. The shore grew rapidly more indistinct as the shades of evening fell, while our clipper bark bounded lightly over the waves. Slowly the mountain top sank on the horizon, until it became a mere speck. In another moment the sun and the Coral Island sank together into the broad bosom of the Pacific.

which we fixed up inside the bower. The boat was then lifted on board and the anchor was raised; this latter task took us a lot of effort and time, as the anchor was so heavy that we couldn't move it without the help of my complex system of blocks and pulleys. A steady breeze was blowing offshore when we set sail, just before sunset. It quickly carried us past the reef and out to sea. The shore became less distinct as the evening shadows deepened, while our clipper bark sailed smoothly over the waves. Slowly the mountain peak disappeared on the horizon, until it was just a tiny spot. In another moment, the sun and the Coral Island sank together into the vast Pacific.

CHAPTER XXX.

The voyage—The island, and a consultation in which danger is scouted as a thing unworthy of consideration—Rats and cats—The native teacher—Awful revelations—Wonderful effects of Christianity.

The journey—The island, and a meeting where danger is brushed off as unimportant—Rats and cats—The local teacher—Terrifying discoveries—Amazing impact of Christianity.

Our voyage during the next two weeks was most interesting and prosperous. The breeze continued generally fair, and at all times enabled us to lie our course; for being, as I have said before, clipper-built, the pirate schooner could lie very close to the wind, and made little lee-way. We had no difficulty now in managing our sails, for Jack was heavy and powerful, while Peterkin was active as a kitten. Still, however, we were a very insufficient crew for such a vessel, and if any one had proposed to us to make such a voyage in it before we had been forced to go through so many hardships from necessity, we would have turned away with pity from the individual making such proposal as from a madman. I pondered this a good deal, and at last concluded that men do not know how much they are capable of doing till they try, and that we should never give way to despair in any undertaking, however difficult it may seem:—always supposing, however, that our cause is a good one, and that we can ask the divine blessing on it.

Our journey over the next two weeks was really interesting and successful. The breeze was mostly favorable, which allowed us to stay on course. As I mentioned before, the pirate schooner was designed to be fast, so it could sail very close to the wind and hardly drift off course. We managed the sails easily since Jack was strong and powerful, while Peterkin was as nimble as a kitten. However, we were still a pretty small crew for a ship like that, and if someone had suggested making this trip before we had to face so many hardships, we would have looked at them like they were crazy. I thought about this a lot, and eventually realized that people often don’t know what they’re capable of until they try, and we should never give up hope in any task, no matter how tough it seems—provided, of course, that our intentions are good and we can seek divine help for it.

Although, therefore, we could now manage our sails easily, we nevertheless found that my pulleys were of much service to us in some things; though Jack did laugh heartily at the uncouth arrangement of ropes and blocks, which had, to a sailor’s eye, a very lumbering and clumsy appearance. But I will not drag my reader through the details of this voyage. Suffice it to say, that, after an agreeable sail of about three weeks, we arrived off the island of Mango, which I recognised at once from the description that the pirate, Bill, had given me of it during one of our conversations.

Although we could now handle our sails easily, we still found that my pulleys were really helpful in some situations; however, Jack laughed loudly at the awkward setup of ropes and blocks, which looked quite heavy and clumsy to a sailor. But I won’t bore you with the details of this journey. It’s enough to say that after a pleasant sail of about three weeks, we arrived off the island of Mango, which I recognized immediately from the description that the pirate, Bill, had given me during one of our talks.

As soon as we came within sight of it we hove the ship to, and held a council of war.

As soon as we saw it, we stopped the ship and held a meeting to discuss our next move.

“Now, boys,” said Jack, as we seated ourselves beside him on the cabin sky-light, “before we go farther in this business, we must go over the pros and cons of it; for, although you have so generously consented to stick by me through thick and thin, it would be unfair did I not see that you thoroughly understand the danger of what we are about to attempt.”

“Alright, guys,” said Jack, as we settled next to him on the cabin skylight, “before we dive deeper into this, we need to weigh the pros and cons; because, even though you’ve so kindly agreed to stand by me through everything, it wouldn’t be fair if I didn’t ensure that you fully understand the risks of what we’re about to try.”

“Oh! bother the danger,” cried Peterkin; “I wonder to hear you, Jack, talk of danger. When a fellow begins to talk about it, he’ll soon come to magnify it to such a degree that he’ll not be fit to face it when it comes, no more than a suckin’ baby!”

“Oh! Forget the danger,” cried Peterkin; “I’m surprised to hear you, Jack, talking about danger. Once someone starts talking about it, they’ll end up blowing it out of proportion to the point where they won’t be ready to handle it when it actually arrives, just like a little baby!”

“Nay, Peterkin,” replied Jack, gravely, “I won’t be jested out of it. I grant you, that, when we’ve once resolved to act, and have made up our minds what to do, we should think no more of danger. But, before we have so resolved, it behoves us to look at it straight in the face, and examine into it, and walk round it; for if we flinch at a distant view, we’re sure to run away when the danger is near. Now, I understand from you, Ralph, that the island is inhabited by thorough-going, out-and-out cannibals, whose principal law is—‘Might is right, and the weakest goes to the wall?’”

“Nah, Peterkin,” Jack replied seriously, “I won’t let you joke me out of it. I admit that once we've decided to act and figured out what we want to do, we shouldn’t think about the danger anymore. But before we make that decision, we need to face it head-on, examine it, and walk around it; because if we hesitate when we see it from a distance, we’ll definitely run when the danger gets close. Now, Ralph, I understand from you that the island is home to serious, full-on cannibals, whose main rule is—‘Might makes right, and the weak can go to hell?’”

“Yes,” said I, “so Bill gave me to understand. He told me, however, that, at the southern side of it, the missionaries had obtained a footing amongst an insignificant tribe. A native teacher had been sent there by the Wesleyans, who had succeeded in persuading the chief at that part to embrace Christianity. But instead of that being of any advantage to our enterprise, it seems the very reverse; for the chief Tararo is a determined heathen, and persecutes the Christians,—who are far too weak in numbers to offer any resistance,—and looks with dislike upon all white men, whom he regards as propagators of the new faith.”

“Yes,” I said, “that’s what Bill hinted to me. He mentioned that on the southern side, the missionaries have managed to establish a presence among a small tribe. A native teacher was sent there by the Wesleyans, and he managed to convince the local chief to adopt Christianity. But instead of helping our cause, it seems to be the opposite; Chief Tararo is a staunch pagan who persecutes the Christians—who are way too few in number to fight back—and he dislikes all white men, viewing them as spreaders of the new faith.”

“’Tis a pity,” said Jack, “that the Christian tribe is so small, for we shall scarcely be safe under their protection, I fear. If Tararo takes it into his head to wish for our vessel, or to kill ourselves, he could take us from them by force. You say that the native missionary talks English?”

“It’s a shame,” said Jack, “that the Christian community is so small, because I’m worried we won’t be safe under their protection. If Tararo decides he wants our ship or wants to get rid of us, he could take us from them by force. You mentioned that the local missionary speaks English?”

“So I believe.”

"So I think."

“Then, what I propose is this,” said Jack: “We will run round to the south side of the island, and cut anchor off the Christian village. We are too far away just now to have been descried by any of the savages, so we shall get there unobserved, and have time to arrange our plans before the heathen tribes know of our presence. But, in doing this, we run the risk of being captured by the ill-disposed tribes, and being very ill used, if not—a—”

“Then, here’s what I suggest,” said Jack: “We’ll head around to the south side of the island and drop anchor near the Christian village. We’re too far away right now for any of the savages to see us, so we’ll get there without being noticed and have some time to plan before the heathen tribes realize we’re here. However, by doing this, we risk getting caught by the hostile tribes, and it could go very badly for us, if not—”

“Roasted alive and eaten,” cried Peterkin. “Come, out with it, Jack; according to your own showing, it’s well to look the danger straight in the face!”

“Roasted alive and eaten,” shouted Peterkin. “Come on, spill it, Jack; by your own admission, it’s better to face the danger head-on!”

“Well, that is the worst of it, certainly. Are you prepared, then, to take your chance of that?”

“Well, that’s definitely the worst part. Are you ready to take your chance with that?”

“I’ve been prepared and had my mind made up long ago,” cried Peterkin, swaggering about the deck with his hands thrust into his breeches’ pockets. “The fact is, Jack, I don’t believe that Tararo will be so ungrateful as to eat us; and I’m quite sure that he’ll be too happy to grant us whatever we ask: so the sooner we go in and win the better.”

“I’ve been ready and made my decision a long time ago,” Peterkin shouted, strutting around the deck with his hands in his pants pockets. “Honestly, Jack, I can’t see Tararo being so ungrateful as to eat us; I’m pretty sure he’ll be more than happy to give us whatever we want: so the sooner we go in and win, the better.”

Peterkin was wrong, however, in his estimate of savage gratitude, as the sequel will show.

Peterkin was mistaken, though, in his understanding of savage gratitude, as the following will demonstrate.

The schooner was now put before the wind, and, after making a long run to the south’ard, we put about and beat up for the south side of Mango, where we arrived before sunset, and hove-to off the coral reef. Here we awaited the arrival of a canoe, which immediately put off on our rounding to. When it arrived, a mild-looking native, of apparently forty years of age, came on board, and, taking off his straw hat, made us a low bow. He was clad in a respectable suit of European clothes; and the first words he uttered, as he stepped up to Jack and shook hands with him, were,—

The schooner was now headed into the wind, and after a long journey south, we turned around and sailed towards the south side of Mango, where we arrived before sunset and anchored near the coral reef. We waited for a canoe, which quickly set off as we came to a stop. When it got here, a gentle-looking local man, who looked about forty, came on board, removed his straw hat, and gave us a polite bow. He was dressed in a nice set of European clothes, and the first words he said as he approached Jack and shook his hand were,—

“Good day, gentlemen; we are happy to see you at Mango—you are heartily welcome.”

“Hello, everyone; we’re glad to see you at Mango—you’re very welcome.”

After returning his salutation, Jack exclaimed, “You must be the native missionary teacher of whom I have heard—are you not?”

After returning his greeting, Jack said, “You must be the local missionary teacher I've heard about—right?”

“I am. I have the joy to be a servant of the Lord Jesus at this station.”

“I am. I have the privilege of being a servant of the Lord Jesus at this time.”

“You’re the very man I want to see, then,” replied Jack; “that’s lucky. Come down to the cabin, friend, and have a glass of wine. I wish particularly to speak with you. My men there” (pointing to Peterkin and me) “will look after your people.”

“You’re exactly the person I wanted to see,” Jack replied. “That’s great. Come down to the cabin, my friend, and have a glass of wine. I really want to talk with you. My men over there” (pointing to Peterkin and me) “will take care of your people.”

“Thank you,” said the teacher, as he followed Jack to the cabin, “I do not drink wine or any strong drink.”

“Thank you,” the teacher said as he followed Jack to the cabin, “I don’t drink wine or any strong beverages.”

“Oh! then, there’s lots of water, and you can have biscuit.”

“Oh! then, there’s plenty of water, and you can have a biscuit.”

“Now, ’pon my word, that’s cool!” said Peterkin; “his men, forsooth! Well, since we are to be men, we may as well come it as strong over these black chaps as we can. Hallo, there!” he cried to the half dozen of natives who stood upon the deck, gazing in wonder at all they saw, “here’s for you;” and he handed them a tray of broken biscuit and a can of water. Then, thrusting his hands into his pockets, he walked up and down the deck with an enormous swagger, whistling vociferously.

“Wow, that’s awesome!” said Peterkin. “His men, seriously! Since we’re supposed to be men, we might as well show these guys what we’ve got. Hey, you there!” he shouted to the half dozen natives standing on the deck, staring in amazement at everything they saw, “this is for you,” and he handed them a tray of broken biscuits and a can of water. Then, shoving his hands into his pockets, he strutted back and forth on the deck with a big swagger, whistling loudly.

In about half an hour Jack and the teacher came on deck, and the latter, bidding us a cheerful good evening, entered his canoe and paddled to the shore. When he was gone, Peterkin stepped up to Jack, and, touching his cap, said,—

In about half an hour, Jack and the teacher came up on deck, and the teacher, wishing us a cheerful good evening, got into his canoe and paddled to the shore. After he left, Peterkin approached Jack and, touching his cap, said,—

“Well, captain, have you any communications to make to your men?”

“Well, captain, do you have any messages for your men?”

“Yes,” cried Jack; “ready about, mind the helm and clew up your tongue, while I con the schooner through the passage in the reef. The teacher, who seems a first-rate fellow, says it’s quite deep, and good anchorage within the lagoon close to the shore.”

“Yes,” shouted Jack; “get ready, watch the steering and keep quiet while I navigate the schooner through the gap in the reef. The teacher, who appears to be a really good guy, says it’s pretty deep and there's good anchorage in the lagoon near the shore.”

While the vessel was slowly advancing to her anchorage, under a light breeze, Jack explained to us that Avatea was still on the island, living amongst the heathens; that she had expressed a strong desire to join the Christians, but Tararo would not let her, and kept her constantly in close confinement.

While the boat was slowly making its way to the anchorage, with a gentle breeze, Jack told us that Avatea was still on the island, living among the heathens; that she had expressed a strong desire to join the Christians, but Tararo wouldn’t allow her and kept her locked up all the time.

“Moreover,” continued Jack, “I find that she belongs to one of the Samoan Islands, where Christianity had been introduced long before her capture by the heathens of a neighbouring island; and the very day after she was taken, she was to have joined the church which had been planted there by that excellent body, the London Missionary Society. The teacher tells me, too, that the poor girl has fallen in love with a Christian chief, who lives on an island some fifty miles or so to the south of this one, and that she is meditating a desperate attempt at escape. So, you see, we have come in the nick of time. I fancy that this chief is the fellow whom you heard of, Ralph, at the Island of Emo. Besides all this, the heathen savages are at war among themselves, and there’s to be a battle fought the day after to-morrow, in which the principal leader is Tararo; so that we’ll not be able to commence our negotiations with the rascally chief till the day after.”

“Moreover,” continued Jack, “I’ve learned that she comes from one of the Samoan Islands, where Christianity was introduced long before the heathens from a neighboring island captured her. The very day after she was taken, she was supposed to join the church established there by the excellent London Missionary Society. The teacher also tells me that the poor girl has fallen in love with a Christian chief, who lives about fifty miles to the south of here, and that she’s planning a desperate escape attempt. So, you see, we’ve arrived just in time. I believe this chief is the one you heard about, Ralph, at the Island of Emo. On top of all this, the heathen savages are currently at war with each other, and there’s going to be a battle the day after tomorrow, with Tararo as the main leader; so we won’t be able to start our negotiations with the dishonest chief until the day after.”

The village off which we anchored was beautifully situated at the head of a small bay, from the margin of which trees of every description peculiar to the tropics rose in the richest luxuriance to the summit of a hilly ridge, which was the line of demarcation between the possessions of the Christians and those of the neighbouring heathen chief.

The village where we anchored was nicely located at the end of a small bay, where trees of all kinds typical of the tropics grew abundantly up to the top of a hilly ridge. This ridge marked the boundary between the lands of the Christians and those of the nearby non-Christian chief.

The site of the settlement was an extensive plot of flat land, stretching in a gentle slope from the sea to the mountain. The cottages stood several hundred yards from the beach, and were protected from the glare of the sea by the rich foliage of rows of large Barringtonia and other trees, which girt the shore. The village was about a mile in length, and perfectly straight, with a wide road down the middle, on either side of which were rows of the tufted-topped ti tree, whose delicate and beautiful blossoms, hanging beneath their plume-crested tops, added richness to the scene. The cottages of the natives were built beneath these trees, and were kept in the most excellent order, each having a little garden in front, tastefully laid out and planted, while the walks were covered with black and white pebbles.

The settlement was located on a large flat area that gently sloped from the sea to the mountains. The cottages were a few hundred yards from the beach and were shaded from the bright sunlight by lush rows of tall Barringtonia and other trees lining the shore. The village stretched about a mile long and was perfectly straight, with a wide road running through the center, flanked by rows of tufted ti trees. Their delicate and beautiful flowers, hanging beneath their plume-like tops, enriched the scenery. The native cottages were built under these trees and were kept in excellent condition, each featuring a small, attractively arranged garden in front, with pathways covered in black and white pebbles.

Every house had doors and Venetian windows, painted partly with lamp black made from the candle-nut, and partly with red ochre, which contrasted powerfully with the dazzling coral lime that covered the walls. On a prominent position stood a handsome church, which was quite a curiosity in its way. It was a hundred feet long by fifty broad, and was seated throughout to accommodate upwards of two thousand persons. It had six large folding doors and twelve windows with Venetian blinds; and, although a large and substantial edifice, it had been built, we were told by the teacher, in the space of two months! There was not a single iron nail in the fabric, and the natives had constructed it chiefly with their stone and bone axes and other tools, having only one or two axes or tools of European manufacture. Everything around this beautiful spot wore an aspect of peace and plenty, and, as we dropped our anchor within a stone’s cast of the substantial coral wharf, I could not avoid contrasting it with the wretched village of Emo, where I had witnessed so many frightful scenes. When the teacher afterwards told me that the people of this tribe had become converts only a year previous to our arrival, and that they had been living before that in the practice of the most bloody system of idolatry, I could not refrain from exclaiming, “What a convincing proof that Christianity is of God!”

Every house had doors and Venetian windows, painted partly with lamp black made from candle-nuts and partly with red ochre, which created a striking contrast with the bright coral lime that covered the walls. A beautiful church stood prominently, quite a curiosity in its own right. It was a hundred feet long and fifty feet wide, designed to seat over two thousand people. It had six large folding doors and twelve windows fitted with Venetian blinds; despite being a large and sturdy building, we were told by the teacher that it had been constructed in just two months! There wasn't a single iron nail in the structure, and the locals built it mostly with their stone and bone axes and other tools, having only one or two axes or tools of European origin. Everything around this lovely spot exuded an air of peace and abundance, and as we dropped anchor within a stone's throw of the solid coral wharf, I couldn't help but compare it to the miserable village of Emo, where I had witnessed so many horrifying scenes. When the teacher later told me that the people of this tribe had converted to Christianity only a year before our arrival, and that prior to that they had been engaged in a horrific system of idol worship, I couldn't help but exclaim, “What a compelling proof that Christianity is of God!”

On landing from our little boat, we were received with a warm welcome by the teacher and his wife; the latter being also a native, clothed in a simple European gown and straw bonnet. The shore was lined with hundreds of natives, whose persons were all more or less clothed with native cloth. Some of the men had on a kind of poncho formed of this cloth, their legs being uncovered. Others wore clumsily-fashioned trousers, and no upper garment except hats made of straw and cloth. Many of the dresses, both of women and men, were grotesque enough, being very bad imitations of the European garb; but all wore a dress of some sort or other. They seemed very glad to see us, and crowded round us as the teacher led the way to his dwelling, where we were entertained, in the most sumptuous manner, on baked pig and all the varieties of fruits and vegetables that the island produced. We were much annoyed, however, by the rats: they seemed to run about the house like domestic animals. As we sat at table, one of them peeped up at us over the edge of the cloth, close to Peterkin’s elbow, who floored it with a blow on the snout from his knife, exclaiming as he did so—

On landing from our little boat, we were warmly welcomed by the teacher and his wife; she was also a local, dressed in a simple European gown and straw bonnet. The shore was packed with hundreds of locals, most of whom were wearing traditional clothing. Some of the men had on a kind of poncho made from this fabric, leaving their legs exposed. Others wore poorly made trousers and no top other than hats made of straw and cloth. Many of the outfits, for both women and men, were quite odd, being very poor imitations of European clothing; but everyone wore some kind of attire. They seemed really happy to see us and gathered around as the teacher led us to his home, where we were treated lavishly to baked pig and all sorts of fruits and vegetables that the island produced. We were quite annoyed, however, by the rats: they scurried around the house like pets. While we sat at the table, one of them peeked up at us over the edge of the cloth, right next to Peterkin’s elbow, who slammed it down with a blow from his knife, exclaiming as he did so—

“I say, Mister Teacher, why don’t you set traps for these brutes?—surely you are not fond of them!”

“I’m asking you, Mister Teacher, why don’t you set traps for these animals? Surely you don’t like them!”

“No,” replied the teacher, with a smile; “we would be glad to get rid of them if we could; but if we were to trap all the rats on the island, it would occupy our whole time.”

“No,” replied the teacher, smiling; “we’d be happy to get rid of them if we could; but if we tried to trap all the rats on the island, it would take up all our time.”

“Are they, then, so numerous?” inquired Jack.

“Are they really that many?” Jack asked.

“They swarm everywhere. The poor heathens on the north side eat them, and think them very sweet. So did my people formerly; but they do not eat so many now, because the missionary who was last here expressed disgust at it. The poor people asked if it was wrong to eat rats; and he told them that it was certainly not wrong, but that the people of England would be much disgusted were they asked to eat rats.”

“They're everywhere. The poor people on the north side eat them and think they taste really sweet. My people used to feel the same way, but they don’t eat them as much now because the last missionary who came here was grossed out by it. The poor folks asked if it was wrong to eat rats, and he told them that it wasn’t wrong, but that people in England would be really disgusted if they were asked to eat rats.”

We had not been an hour in the house of this kind-hearted man when we were convinced of the truth of his statement as to their numbers, for the rats ran about the floors in dozens, and, during our meal, two men were stationed at the table to keep them off!

We hadn’t even been in this kind-hearted man’s house for an hour when we realized he was right about how many rats there were. They were scurrying across the floors in droves, and while we were eating, two guys stood at the table to keep them away!

“What a pity you have no cats,” said Peterkin, as he aimed a blow at another reckless intruder, and missed it.

“What a shame you don't have any cats,” said Peterkin, as he swung at another careless intruder and missed.

“We would, indeed, be glad to have a few,” rejoined the teacher, “but they are difficult to be got. The hogs, we find, are very good rat-killers, but they do not seem to be able to keep the numbers down. I have heard that they are better than cats.”

“We would definitely be happy to have a few,” replied the teacher, “but they are hard to come by. We’ve found that pigs are great at catching rats, but they don’t seem to be able to control their numbers. I’ve heard they’re better than cats.”

As the teacher said this, his good-natured black face was wrinkled with a smile of merriment. Observing that I had noticed it, he said:—

As the teacher said this, his cheerful black face was creased with a happy smile. Noticing that I had caught on, he said:—

“I smiled just now when I remembered the fate of the first cat that was taken to Raratonga. This is one of the stations of the London Missionary Society. It, like our own, is infested with rats, and a cat was brought at last to the island. It was a large black one. On being turned loose, instead of being content to stay among men, the cat took to the mountains, and lived in a wild state, sometimes paying visits during the night to the houses of the natives; some of whom, living at a distance from the settlement, had not heard of the cat’s arrival, and were dreadfully frightened in consequence, calling it a ‘monster of the deep,’ and flying in terror away from it. One night the cat, feeling a desire for company, I suppose, took its way to the house of a chief, who had recently been converted to Christianity, and had begun to learn to read and pray. The chief’s wife, who was sitting awake at his side while he slept, beheld with horror two fires glistening in the doorway, and heard with surprise a mysterious voice. Almost petrified with fear, she awoke her husband, and began to upbraid him for forsaking his old religion, and burning his god, who, she declared, was now come to be avenged of them. ‘Get up and pray! get up and pray!’ she cried. The chief arose, and, on opening his eyes, beheld the same glaring lights, and heard the same ominous sound. Impelled by the extreme urgency of the case, he commenced, with all possible vehemence, to vociferate the alphabet, as a prayer to God to deliver them from the vengeance of Satan! On hearing this, the cat, as much alarmed as themselves, fled precipitately away, leaving the chief and his wife congratulating themselves on the efficacy of their prayer.”

“I just smiled when I remembered what happened to the first cat that was taken to Raratonga. This is one of the stations of the London Missionary Society. Like our own, it had a huge rat problem, so eventually they brought a cat to the island. It was a big black cat. Once it was let loose, instead of sticking around people, the cat ran off into the mountains and lived wild, sometimes sneaking into the homes of the locals at night. Some of them, who lived far from the settlement and hadn’t heard about the cat’s arrival, were terrified and called it a ‘monster of the deep,’ running away in fear. One night, feeling lonely, the cat made its way to the house of a chief who had recently converted to Christianity and started to learn how to read and pray. The chief’s wife was sitting awake by his side while he slept. She saw two glowing eyes in the doorway and heard a mysterious sound. Almost frozen with fear, she woke her husband and started scolding him for leaving his old religion and burning his god, who, she insisted, had come to take revenge on them. ‘Get up and pray! Get up and pray!’ she shouted. The chief got up, and when he opened his eyes, he saw the same glowing eyes and heard the same unsettling sound. Feeling an urgent need to act, he began shouting the alphabet, praying to God to save them from Satan’s wrath! Hearing this, the cat, just as scared as they were, quickly ran away, leaving the chief and his wife relieved and congratulating themselves on the power of their prayer.”

We were much diverted with this anecdote, which the teacher related in English so good, that we certainly could not have supposed him a native but for the colour of his face and the foreign accent in his tone. Next day we walked out with this interesting man, and were much entertained and instructed by his conversation, as we rambled through the cool shady groves of bananas, citrons, limes, and other trees, or sauntered among the cottages of the natives, and watched them while they laboured diligently in the taro beds, or manufactured the tapa or native cloth. To some of these Jack put questions through the medium of the missionary; and the replies were such as to surprise us at the extent of their knowledge. Indeed, Peterkin very truly remarked that “they seemed to know a considerable deal more than Jack himself!”

We were really entertained by this story, which the teacher shared in such fluent English that we definitely wouldn’t have guessed he wasn't a native speaker if it weren't for the color of his skin and his foreign accent. The next day, we went out with this interesting man and were both entertained and educated by his conversation as we wandered through the cool, shady groves of bananas, citrons, limes, and other trees, or strolled among the cottages of the locals and watched them as they worked hard in the taro beds or made tapa, the native cloth. Jack asked some of them questions through the missionary, and their answers surprised us with how much they knew. In fact, Peterkin accurately pointed out that “they seemed to know quite a bit more than Jack himself!”

Among other pieces of interesting information that we obtained was the following, in regard to coral formations:—

Among other interesting pieces of information we gathered was the following about coral formations:—

“The islands of the Pacific,” said our friend, “are of three different kinds or classes. Those of the first class are volcanic, mountainous, and wild; some shooting their jagged peaks into the clouds at an elevation of ten and fifteen thousand feet. Those of the second class are of crystalized limestone, and vary in height from one hundred to five hundred feet. The hills on these are not so wild or broken as those of the first class, but are richly clothed with vegetation, and very beautiful. I have no doubt that the Coral Island on which you were wrecked was one of this class. They are supposed to have been upheaved from the bottom of the sea by volcanic agency, but they are not themselves volcanic in their nature, neither are they of coral formation. Those of the third class are the low coralline islands usually having lagoons of water in their midst; they are very numerous.

“The islands of the Pacific,” said our friend, “are divided into three different types. The first type includes volcanic, mountainous, and wild islands, some of which have jagged peaks that rise into the clouds at heights of ten to fifteen thousand feet. The second type consists of crystallized limestone islands, ranging in height from one hundred to five hundred feet. The hills on these islands are not as wild or jagged as those in the first type, but they are lush with vegetation and very beautiful. I'm sure the Coral Island where you were shipwrecked is one of this type. These islands are thought to have pushed up from the sea floor through volcanic activity, but they are not volcanic themselves, nor are they formed from coral. The third type includes low coral islands, which usually have lagoons of water in their centers; they are quite numerous.”

“As to the manner in which coral islands and reefs are formed; there are various opinions on this point. I will give you what seems to me the most probable theory,—a theory, I may add, which is held by some of the good and scientific missionaries. It is well known that there is much lime in salt water; it is also known that coral is composed of lime. It is supposed that the polypes, or coral insects, have the power of attracting this lime to their bodies; and with this material they build their little cells or habitations. They choose the summit of a volcano, or the top of a submarine mountain, as a foundation on which to build; for it is found that they never work at any great depth below the surface. On this they work; the polypes on the mountain top, of course, reach the surface first, then those at the outer edges reach the top sooner than the others between them and the centre, thus forming the coral reef surrounding the lagoon of water and the central island; after that the insects within the lagoon cease working. When the surface of the water is reached, these myriads of wonderful creatures die. Then birds visit the spot, and seeds are thus conveyed thither, which take root, and spring up, and flourish. Thus are commenced those coralline islets of which you have seen so many in these seas. The reefs round the large islands are formed in a similar manner. When we consider,” added the missionary, “the smallness of the architects used by our heavenly Father in order to form those lovely and innumerable islands, we are filled with much of that feeling which induced the ancient king to exclaim, ‘How manifold, O God, are thy works! in wisdom thou hast made them all.’”

“As for how coral islands and reefs are formed, there are many opinions on this topic. I will share what seems to me the most likely theory—a theory that some knowledgeable and scientific missionaries also support. It’s well-known that there is a lot of lime in saltwater, and coral is made up of lime. It's believed that the polyps, or coral insects, can attract this lime to their bodies; with this material, they construct their small cells or habitats. They choose the summit of a volcano or the top of an underwater mountain as a base to build on since they are found to work only at shallow depths below the surface. They start working at the mountain top, with the polyps reaching the surface first, and those at the outer edges reach the top before the ones closer to the center, forming the coral reef that surrounds the lagoon of water and the central island. After that, the insects within the lagoon stop working. When they reach the water's surface, these countless amazing creatures die. Then, birds come to the area, bringing seeds that take root and grow. This is how those coral islets, which you’ve seen so many of in these seas, begin. The reefs around large islands are formed in a similar way. When we think about,” added the missionary, “the small size of the builders used by our heavenly Father to create those beautiful and countless islands, we are filled with much of that awe that made the ancient king exclaim, ‘How manifold, O God, are thy works! In wisdom, thou hast made them all.’”

We all heartily agreed with the missionary in this sentiment, and felt not a little gratified to find that the opinions which Jack and I had been led to form from personal observation on our Coral Island were thus to a great extent corroborated.

We all completely agreed with the missionary on this point, and we were quite pleased to see that the views Jack and I had formed from our own experiences on Coral Island were largely confirmed.

The missionary also gave us an account of the manner in which Christianity had been introduced among them. He said: “When missionaries were first sent here, three years ago, a small vessel brought them; and the chief, who is now dead, promised to treat well the two native teachers who were left with their wives on the island. But scarcely had the boat which landed them returned to the ship, than the natives began to maltreat their guests, taking away all they possessed, and offering them further violence, so that, when the boat was sent in haste to fetch them away, the clothes of both men and women were torn nearly off their backs.

The missionary also shared how Christianity was introduced among them. He said: “When missionaries were first sent here three years ago, a small boat brought them, and the chief, who has since passed away, promised to take good care of the two native teachers who were left with their wives on the island. But as soon as the boat that landed them returned to the ship, the locals started to mistreat their guests, taking away everything they had and even threatening them. By the time the boat rushed back to pick them up, both the men’s and women’s clothes were nearly torn off their backs.

“Two years after this the vessel visited them again, and I, being in her, volunteered to land alone, without any goods whatever; begging that my wife might be brought to me the following year,—that is, this year; and, as you see, she is with me. But the surf was so high that the boat could not land me; so with nothing on but my trousers and shirt, and with a few catechisms and a Bible, besides some portions of the Scripture translated into the Mango tongue, I sprang into the sea, and swam ashore on the crest of a breaker. I was instantly dragged up the beach by the natives; who, on finding I had nothing worth having upon me, let me alone. I then made signs to my friends in the ship to leave me; which they did. At first the natives listened to me in silence, but laughed at what I said while I preached the gospel of our blessed Saviour Jesus Christ to them. Afterwards they treated me ill sometimes; but I persevered, and continued to dwell among them, and dispute, and exhort them to give up their sinful ways of life, burn their idols, and come to Jesus.

“Two years later, the ship came back, and I, being on board, offered to go ashore alone, without any supplies. I asked that my wife be brought to me the following year—that is, this year; and, as you can see, she’s here with me now. But the waves were so high that the boat couldn’t get me to land, so with just my pants and shirt on, along with a few catechisms and a Bible, plus some parts of the Scripture translated into the Mango language, I jumped into the water and swam to shore on top of a wave. I was quickly pulled up the beach by the locals, who, upon realizing I had nothing of value on me, left me alone. I then waved to my friends on the ship to depart, which they did. At first, the locals listened to me quietly, but they laughed at my words while I preached the gospel of our Savior Jesus Christ to them. Afterward, they didn’t always treat me well, but I kept at it, staying with them, debating, and urging them to abandon their sinful lifestyles, destroy their idols, and follow Jesus.”

“About a month after I landed, I heard that the chief was dead. He was the father of the present chief, who is now a most consistent member of the church. It is a custom here that, when a chief dies, his wives are strangled and buried with him. Knowing this, I hastened to his house to endeavour to prevent such cruelty if possible. When I arrived, I found two of the wives had already been killed, while another was in the act of being strangled. I pleaded hard for her, but it was too late; she was already dead. I then entreated the son to spare the fourth wife; and, after much hesitation, my prayer was granted: but, in half an hour afterwards, this poor woman repented of being unfaithful, as she termed it, to her husband, and insisted on being strangled; which was accordingly done.

“About a month after I arrived, I heard that the chief had died. He was the father of the current chief, who is now a very active member of the church. It's tradition here that when a chief dies, his wives are strangled and buried with him. Knowing this, I rushed to his house to try to stop such cruelty if I could. When I got there, I found that two of the wives had already been killed, and another was in the process of being strangled. I pleaded intensely for her, but it was too late; she was already dead. I then begged the son to save the fourth wife; after much hesitation, my request was granted: but, half an hour later, this poor woman regretted being unfaithful, as she called it, to her husband and insisted on being strangled; which was done.

“All this time the chief’s son was walking up and down before his father’s house with a brow black as thunder. When he entered, I went in with him, and found, to my surprise, that his father was not dead! The old man was sitting on a mat in a corner, with an expression of placid resignation on his face.

“All this time, the chief’s son was pacing back and forth in front of his father’s house, his face clouded with anger. When he went inside, I followed him and, to my surprise, discovered that his father was not dead! The old man was sitting on a mat in a corner, wearing a look of calm acceptance.”

“‘Why,’ said I, ‘have you strangled your father’s wives before he is dead?’

“‘Why,’ I asked, ‘did you strangle your father's wives before he’s even dead?’”

“To this the son replied, ‘He is dead. That is no longer my father. He is as good as dead now. He is to be buried alive.’

“To this the son replied, ‘He is dead. That is no longer my father. He is as good as dead now. He is to be buried alive.’”

“I now remembered having heard that it is a custom among the Feejee islanders, that when the reigning chief grows old or infirm, the heir to the chieftainship has a right to depose his father; in which case he is considered as dead, and is buried alive. The young chief was now about to follow this custom, and, despite my earnest entreaties and pleadings, the old chief was buried that day before my eyes in the same grave with his four strangled wives! Oh! my heart groaned when I saw this, and I prayed to God to open the hearts of these poor creatures, as he had already opened mine, and pour into them the light and the love of the gospel of Jesus. My prayer was answered very soon. A week afterwards, the son, who was now chief of the tribe, came to me, bearing his god on his shoulders, and groaning beneath its weight. Flinging it down at my feet, he desired me to burn it!

“I remembered hearing that it's a custom among the Fijian islanders that when the reigning chief gets old or weak, the heir to the chieftainship has the right to depose his father; in which case, the father is considered dead and is buried alive. The young chief was about to follow this custom, and despite my desperate pleas and arguments, the old chief was buried that day before my eyes in the same grave with his four strangled wives! Oh! My heart ached when I saw this, and I prayed to God to open the hearts of these poor souls, just as He had already opened mine, and to fill them with the light and love of the gospel of Jesus. My prayer was answered very soon. A week later, the son, who was now chief of the tribe, came to me, carrying his idol on his shoulders, struggling under its weight. He threw it down at my feet and asked me to burn it!”

“You may conceive how overjoyed I was at this. I sprang up and embraced him, while I shed tears of joy. Then we made a fire, and burned the god to ashes, amid an immense concourse of the people, who seemed terrified at what was being done, and shrank back when we burned the god, expecting some signal vengeance to be taken upon us; but seeing that nothing happened, they changed their minds, and thought that our God must be the true one after all. From that time the mission prospered steadily, and now, while there is not a single man in the tribe who has not burned his household gods, and become a convert to Christianity, there are not a few, I hope, who are true followers of the Lamb, having been plucked as brands from the burning by Him who can save unto the uttermost. I will not tell you more of our progress at this time, but you see,” he said, waving his hand around him, “the village and the church did not exist a year ago!”

“You can imagine how thrilled I was by this. I jumped up and hugged him, tears of joy streaming down my face. Then we built a fire and turned the god to ashes in front of a huge crowd of people who looked scared and stepped back when we burned the god, expecting some kind of punishment to come our way; but when nothing happened, they changed their minds and figured that our God must be the real one after all. From that point on, the mission thrived steadily, and now, while there isn’t a single person in the tribe who hasn’t burned their household gods and become a Christian, there are many, I hope, who are genuine followers of the Lamb, saved from destruction by Him who can save completely. I won’t share more about our progress right now, but you see,” he said, waving his hand around, “the village and the church didn’t even exist a year ago!”

We were indeed much interested in this account, and I could not help again in my heart praying God to prosper those missionary societies that send such inestimable blessings to these islands of dark and bloody idolatry. The teacher also added that the other tribes were very indignant at this one for having burned its gods, and threatened to destroy it altogether, but they had done nothing yet; “and if they should,” said the teacher, “the Lord is on our side; of whom shall we be afraid?”

We were really intrigued by this story, and I couldn’t help but silently pray for God to support the missionary societies bringing such invaluable blessings to these islands filled with dark and bloody idolatry. The teacher also mentioned that the other tribes were very angry at this one for burning its idols and had threatened to wipe it out completely, but so far, they hadn't acted on it; “and if they do,” said the teacher, “the Lord is on our side; who should we fear?”

“Have the missionaries many stations in these seas?” inquired Jack.

“Do the missionaries have a lot of stations in these seas?” Jack asked.

“Oh, yes. The London Missionary Society have a great many in the Tahiti group, and other islands in that quarter. Then the Wesleyans have the Feejee Islands all to themselves, and the Americans have many stations in other groups. But still, my friend, there are hundreds of islands here the natives of which have never heard of Jesus, or the good word of God, or the Holy Spirit; and thousands are living and dying in the practice of those terrible sins and bloody murders of which you have already heard. I trust, my friends,” he added, looking earnestly into our faces, “I trust that if you ever return to England, you will tell your Christian friends that the horrors which they hear of in regard to these islands are literally true, and that when they have heard the worst, the ‘half has not been told them;’ for there are perpetrated here foul deeds of darkness of which man may not speak. You may also tell them,” he said, looking around with a smile, while a tear of gratitude trembled in his eye and rolled down his coal-black cheek,—“tell them of the blessings that the gospel has wrought here!”

“Oh, absolutely. The London Missionary Society has a lot of presence in the Tahiti group and other nearby islands. The Wesleyans have the Fiji Islands all to themselves, and the Americans have numerous missions in other groups. But still, my friend, there are hundreds of islands where the locals have never heard of Jesus, or the word of God, or the Holy Spirit; and thousands are living and dying in the midst of those terrible sins and violent murders that you've already heard about. I hope, my friends,” he added, looking sincerely into our eyes, “I hope that if you ever go back to England, you will tell your Christian friends that the horrors they hear about regarding these islands are absolutely true, and that when they've heard the worst, the ‘half has not been told to them;’ for there are atrocious acts of darkness happening here that can't be spoken of. You can also tell them,” he said, smiling as a tear of gratitude shimmered in his eye and rolled down his coal-black cheek, “tell them about the blessings that the gospel has brought here!”

We assured our friend that we would certainly not forget his request. On returning towards the village, about noon, we remarked on the beautiful whiteness of the cottages.

We assured our friend that we would definitely not forget his request. As we made our way back to the village around noon, we commented on the lovely white color of the cottages.

“That is owing to the lime with which they are plastered,” said the teacher. “When the natives were converted, as I have described, I set them to work to build cottages for themselves, and also this handsome church which you see. When the framework and other parts of the houses were up, I sent the people to fetch coral from the sea. They brought immense quantities. Then I made them cut wood, and, piling the coral above it, set it on fire.

“That is because of the lime they're coated with,” said the teacher. “When the locals were converted, as I mentioned, I had them start building cottages for themselves and this beautiful church you see. Once the framework and other parts of the houses were up, I sent the people to collect coral from the sea. They brought back huge amounts. Then I had them cut wood and, stacking the coral on top, set it on fire.

“‘Look! look!’ cried the poor people, in amazement; ‘what wonderful people the Christians are! He is roasting stones. We shall not need taro or bread-fruit any more; we may eat stones!’

“‘Look! Look!’ shouted the poor people, in disbelief; ‘what amazing people the Christians are! He is roasting stones. We won’t need taro or breadfruit anymore; we can eat stones!’”

“But their surprise was still greater when the coral was reduced to a fine soft white powder. They immediately set up a great shout, and, mingling the lime with water, rubbed their faces and their bodies all over with it, and ran through the village screaming with delight. They were also much surprised at another thing they saw me do. I wished to make some household furniture, and constructed a turning-lathe to assist me. The first thing that I turned was the leg of a sofa; which was no sooner finished than the chief seized it with wonder and delight, and ran through the village exhibiting it to the people, who looked upon it with great admiration. The chief then, tying a string to it, hung it round his neck as an ornament! He afterwards told me that if he had seen it before he became a Christian he would have made it his god!”

“But their surprise was even greater when the coral was turned into a fine soft white powder. They immediately started shouting loudly and, mixing the lime with water, rubbed it all over their faces and bodies, running through the village and screaming with joy. They were also amazed by something else I did. I wanted to make some furniture, so I built a turning lathe to help me. The first thing I made was a leg for a sofa; as soon as I finished, the chief grabbed it with wonder and excitement and ran through the village showing it off to the people, who admired it greatly. The chief then tied a string to it and wore it around his neck like an ornament! Later, he told me that if he had seen it before he became a Christian, he would have made it his god!”

As the teacher concluded this anecdote we reached his door. Saying that he had business to attend to, he left us to amuse ourselves as we best could.

As the teacher finished this story, we reached his door. He said he had things to take care of and left us to entertain ourselves as best we could.

“Now, lads,” said Jack, turning abruptly towards us, and buttoning up his jacket as he spoke, “I’m off to see the battle. I’ve no particular fondness for seein’ blood-shed, but I must find out the nature o’ these fellows and see their customs with my own eyes, so that I may be able to speak of it again, if need be, authoritatively. It’s only six miles off, and we don’t run much more risk than that of getting a rap with a stray stone or an over-shot arrow. Will you go?”

“Alright, guys,” Jack said, turning quickly towards us and buttoning up his jacket as he spoke, “I’m heading out to see the battle. I don't particularly like seeing bloodshed, but I need to find out what these guys are like and see their customs for myself so I can talk about it confidently if it comes up. It’s only six miles away, and our only real danger is getting hit by a stray stone or an over-shot arrow. Are you coming?”

“To be sure we will,” said Peterkin.

"Of course we will," said Peterkin.

“If they chance to see us we’ll cut and run for it,” added Jack.

“If they happen to see us, we’ll make a run for it,” added Jack.

“Dear me!” cried Peterkin,—“you run! thought you would scorn to run from any one.”

“Wow!” exclaimed Peterkin, “You run! I thought you would never run from anyone.”

“So I would, if it were my duty to fight,” returned Jack, coolly; “but as I don’t want to fight, and don’t intend to fight, if they offer to attack us I’ll run away like the veriest coward that ever went by the name of Peterkin. So come along.”

“So I would, if it were my duty to fight,” replied Jack, casually; “but since I don’t want to fight, and I don’t plan to fight, if they decide to attack us, I’ll just run away like the biggest coward that ever went by the name of Peterkin. So let’s go.”

CHAPTER XXXI.

A strange and bloody battle—The lion bearded in his den—Frightful scenes of cruelty, and fears for the future.

A bizarre and violent battle—the lion in its den—terrifying acts of brutality, and worries about what’s to come.

We had ascertained from the teacher the direction to the spot on which the battle was to be fought, and after a walk of two hours reached it. The summit of a bare hill was the place chosen; for, unlike most of the other islanders, who are addicted to bush-fighting, those of Mango are in the habit of meeting on open ground. We arrived before the two parties had commenced the deadly struggle, and, creeping as close up as we dared among the rocks, we lay and watched them.

We found out from the teacher where the battle would take place and after a two-hour walk, we got there. The chosen location was the top of a bare hill; unlike most of the other islanders who prefer fighting in the bushes, the people from Mango usually meet in open areas. We got there before the two groups started their fierce battle, and we crept as close as we could among the rocks and lay there, watching them.

The combatants were drawn up face to face, each side ranged in rank four deep. Those in the first row were armed with long spears; the second, with clubs to defend the spearmen; the third row was composed of young men with slings; and the fourth consisted of women, who carried baskets of stones for the slingers, and clubs and spears with which to supply the warriors. Soon after we arrived, the attack was made with great fury. There was no science displayed. The two bodies of savages rushed headlong upon each other and engaged in a general melee, and a more dreadful set of men I have never seen. They wore grotesque war-caps made of various substances and decorated with feathers. Their faces and bodies were painted so as to make them look as frightful as possible; and as they brandished their massive clubs, leaped, shouted, yelled, and dashed each other to the ground, I thought I had never seen men look so like demons before.

The fighters stood facing each other, each side lined up in ranks of four. The front row had long spears; the second row had clubs to protect the spearmen; the third row was made up of young men with slings; and the fourth row included women carrying baskets of stones for the slingers, along with clubs and spears to support the warriors. Shortly after we arrived, the attack began with intense ferocity. There was no strategy involved. The two groups of savages charged at each other and engaged in an all-out brawl, and I’ve never seen a more terrifying group of men. They wore bizarre war caps made from all sorts of materials, decorated with feathers. Their faces and bodies were painted to look as terrifying as possible, and as they swung their heavy clubs, jumped, shouted, and knocked each other to the ground, I thought I had never seen men look so much like demons before.

We were much surprised at the conduct of the women, who seemed to be perfect furies, and hung about the heels of their husbands in order to defend them. One stout young women we saw, whose husband was hard pressed and about to be overcome: she lifted a large stone, and throwing it at his opponent’s head, felled him to the earth. But the battle did not last long. The band most distant from us gave way and were routed, leaving eighteen of their comrades dead upon the field. These the victors brained as they lay; and putting some of their brains on leaves went off with them, we were afterwards informed, to their temples, to present them to their gods as an earnest of the human victims who were soon to be brought there.

We were really surprised by the actions of the women, who seemed to be wild and stuck close to their husbands to protect them. One strong young woman we saw, whose husband was struggling and about to be defeated, lifted a big stone and threw it at her opponent’s head, taking him down. But the fight didn’t go on for long. The group farthest from us gave in and were defeated, leaving eighteen of their friends dead on the ground. The victors then killed those who were still alive and took some of their brains on leaves, later we heard, to their temples, to offer them to their gods as a sign of the human sacrifices that were soon to be made there.

We hastened back to the Christian village with feelings of the deepest sadness at the sanguinary conflict which we had just witnessed.

We rushed back to the Christian village, feeling deeply saddened by the brutal conflict we had just witnessed.

Next day, after breakfasting with our friend the teacher, we made preparations for carrying out our plan. At first the teacher endeavoured to dissuade us.

Next day, after having breakfast with our friend the teacher, we got ready to carry out our plan. At first, the teacher tried to talk us out of it.

“You do not know,” said he, turning to Jack, “the danger you run in venturing amongst these ferocious savages. I feel much pity for poor Avatea; but you are not likely to succeed in saving her, and you may die in the attempt.”

“You don't understand,” he said, turning to Jack, “the danger you're putting yourself in by getting involved with these fierce savages. I really feel for poor Avatea, but you're probably not going to succeed in saving her, and you could end up dying in the process.”

“Well,” said Jack, quietly, “I am not afraid to die in a good cause.”

“Well,” Jack said quietly, “I’m not afraid to die for a good cause.”

The teacher smiled approvingly at him as he said this, and after a little further conversation agreed to accompany us as interpreter; saying that, although Tararo was unfriendly to him, he had hitherto treated him with respect.

The teacher smiled approvingly at him as he said this, and after a bit more conversation, agreed to join us as an interpreter, saying that although Tararo was unfriendly to him, he had always treated him with respect.

We now went on board the schooner, having resolved to sail round the island and drop anchor opposite the heathen village. We manned her with natives, and hoped to overawe the savages by displaying our brass gun to advantage. The teacher soon after came on board, and setting our sails we put to sea. In two hours more we made the cliffs reverberate with the crash of the big gun, which we fired by way of salute, while we ran the British ensign up to the peak and cast anchor. The commotion on shore showed us that we had struck terror into the hearts of the natives; but seeing that we did not offer to molest them, a canoe at length put off and paddled cautiously towards us. The teacher showed himself, and explaining that we were friends and wished to palaver with the chief, desired the native to go and tell him to come on board.

We boarded the schooner, having decided to sail around the island and anchor near the village. We staffed the ship with locals and hoped to intimidate the natives by showcasing our brass gun. Shortly after, the teacher arrived on board, and we set our sails to head out to sea. In two hours, we made the cliffs echo with the sound of the big gun, which we fired as a salute while hoisting the British flag to the peak and dropping anchor. The activity onshore showed that we had frightened the natives, but since we didn’t threaten them, a canoe eventually set off and cautiously paddled toward us. The teacher introduced himself and explained that we were friends and wanted to talk with the chief, asking the native to go and tell him to come on board.

We waited long and with much impatience for an answer. During this time the native teacher conversed with us again, and told us many things concerning the success of the gospel among those islands; and perceiving that we were by no means so much gratified as we ought to have been at the hearing of such good news, he pressed us more closely in regard to our personal interest in religion, and exhorted us to consider that our souls were certainly in as great danger as those of the wretched heathen whom we pitied so much, if we had not already found salvation in Jesus Christ. “Nay, further,” he added, “if such be your unhappy case, you are, in the sight of God, much worse than these savages (forgive me, my young friends, for saying so); for they have no knowledge, no light, and do not profess to believe; while you, on the contrary, have been brought up in the light of the blessed gospel and call yourselves Christians. These poor savages are indeed the enemies of our Lord; but you, if ye be not true believers, are traitors!”

We waited a long time, feeling very impatient, for an answer. During this time, the local teacher talked to us again and shared many things about the success of the gospel in those islands. He noticed that we weren't as pleased as we should have been to hear such good news, so he pushed us more about our personal interest in religion. He urged us to consider that our souls were just as much at risk as those of the miserable heathens we felt sorry for, unless we had already found salvation in Jesus Christ. “Moreover,” he added, “if that's your unfortunate situation, you are, in God's eyes, much worse than these savages (please forgive me, my young friends, for saying this); because they have no knowledge, no light, and don't claim to believe, while you, on the other hand, have been raised in the light of the blessed gospel and call yourselves Christians. These poor savages may indeed be the enemies of our Lord; but you, if you aren't true believers, are traitors!”

I must confess that my heart condemned me while the teacher spoke in this earnest manner, and I knew not what to reply. Peterkin, too, did not seem to like it, and I thought would willingly have escaped; but Jack seemed deeply impressed, and wore an anxious expression on his naturally grave countenance, while he assented to the teacher’s remarks and put to him many earnest questions. Meanwhile the natives who composed our crew, having nothing particular to do, had squatted down on the deck and taken out their little books containing the translated portions of the New Testament, along with hymns and spelling-books, and were now busily engaged, some vociferating the alphabet, others learning prayers off by heart, while a few sang hymns,—all of them being utterly unmindful of our presence. The teacher soon joined them, and soon afterwards they all engaged in a prayer which was afterwards translated to us, and proved to be a petition for the success of our undertaking and for the conversion of the heathen.

I have to admit that I felt guilty while the teacher spoke so seriously, and I didn’t know how to respond. Peterkin also seemed uncomfortable and looked like he wanted to escape; but Jack appeared deeply moved, wearing a worried look on his usually serious face as he agreed with the teacher and asked him many sincere questions. Meanwhile, the locals who made up our crew had nothing specific to do, so they sat down on the deck and pulled out their little books containing translated sections of the New Testament, along with hymns and spelling books. They got busy, some loudly practicing the alphabet, others memorizing prayers, while a few sang hymns—completely ignoring our presence. The teacher soon joined them, and shortly after, they all participated in a prayer that was later translated for us. It turned out to be a request for the success of our mission and for the conversion of the non-believers.

While we were thus engaged a canoe put off from shore and several savages leaped on deck, one of whom advanced to the teacher and informed him that Tararo could not come on board that day, being busy with some religious ceremonies before the gods, which could on no account be postponed. He was also engaged with a friendly chief who was about to take his departure from the island, and therefore begged that the teacher and his friends would land and pay a visit to him. To this the teacher returned answer that we would land immediately.

While we were busy, a canoe came from the shore and several locals jumped onto the deck. One of them approached the teacher and told him that Tararo couldn't come on board that day because he was occupied with some religious ceremonies for the gods that couldn't be delayed. He was also meeting with a friendly chief who was about to leave the island, and he asked the teacher and his friends to come ashore and visit him. The teacher replied that we would land right away.

“Now, lads,” said Jack, as we were about to step into our little boat, “I’m not going to take any weapons with me, and I recommend you to take none either. We are altogether in the power of these savages, and the utmost we could do, if they were to attack us, would be to kill a few of them before we were ourselves overpowered. I think that our only chance of success lies in mild measures. Don’t you think so?”

“Alright, guys,” Jack said as we were getting ready to hop into our small boat, “I’m not bringing any weapons, and I suggest you don’t either. We’re completely at the mercy of these savages, and the most we could hope for if they attacked us is to take out a few of them before we get overwhelmed. I believe our best chance of succeeding lies in being calm and cautious. Don’t you agree?”

To this I assented gladly, and Peterkin replied by laying down a huge bell-mouthed blunderbuss, and divesting himself of a pair of enormous horse-pistols with which he had purposed to overawe the natives! We then jumped into our boat and rowed ashore.

To this, I happily agreed, and Peterkin responded by putting down a large bell-shaped blunderbuss and taking off a pair of massive horse pistols he had planned to intimidate the locals with! We then hopped into our boat and rowed to the shore.

On reaching the beach we were received by a crowd of naked savages, who shouted a rude welcome, and conducted us to a house or shed where a baked pig and a variety of vegetables were prepared for us. Having partaken of these, the teacher begged to be conducted to the chief; but there seemed some hesitation, and after some consultation among themselves, one of the men stood forward and spoke to the teacher.

On arriving at the beach, we were greeted by a group of naked natives who shouted an unwelcoming greeting and led us to a hut where a roasted pig and several types of vegetables were ready for us. After we finished eating, the teacher asked to meet the chief; however, there was some hesitation, and after discussing among themselves, one of the men stepped forward and spoke to the teacher.

“What says he?” inquired Jack when the savage had concluded.

“What does he say?” Jack asked when the savage had finished.

“He says that the chief is just going to the temple of his god and cannot see us yet; so we must be patient, my friend.”

“He says that the chief is currently at the temple of his god and can’t meet with us right now, so we need to be patient, my friend.”

“Well,” cried Jack, rising; “if he won’t come to see me, I’ll e’en go and see him. Besides, I have a great desire to witness their proceedings at this temple of theirs. Will you go with me, friend?”

“Well,” shouted Jack, getting up; “if he won’t come to see me, I’ll just go see him. Plus, I really want to see what they’re doing at their temple. Will you come with me, friend?”

“I cannot,” said the teacher, shaking his head; “I must not go to the heathen temples and witness their inhuman rites, except for the purpose of condemning their wickedness and folly.”

“I can't,” said the teacher, shaking his head; “I shouldn't go to the pagan temples and see their inhumane rituals, unless it's to condemn their wickedness and foolishness.”

“Very good,” returned Jack; “then I’ll go alone, for I cannot condemn their doings till I have seen them.”

“Sounds good,” replied Jack. “Then I’ll go by myself, because I can’t judge what they’re doing until I’ve seen it.”

Jack arose, and we, having determined to go also, followed him through the banana groves to a rising ground immediately behind the village, on the top of which stood the Buré, or temple, under the dark shade of a group of iron-wood trees. As we went through the village, I was again led to contrast the rude huts and sheds, and their almost naked savage-looking inhabitants, with the natives of the Christian village, who, to use the teacher’s scriptural expression, were now “clothed and in their right mind.”

Jack got up, and since we decided to go too, we followed him through the banana groves to a higher ground right behind the village, where the Buré, or temple, stood under the dark shade of a group of ironwood trees. As we walked through the village, I couldn't help but compare the rough huts and sheds and their almost naked, savage-looking residents with the people from the Christian village, who, to use the teacher's biblical phrase, were now “dressed and in their right mind.”

As we turned into a broad path leading towards the hill, we were arrested by the shouts of an approaching multitude in the rear. Drawing aside into the bushes we awaited their coming up, and as they drew near we observed that it was a procession of the natives, many of whom were dancing and gesticulating in the most frantic manner. They had an exceedingly hideous aspect, owing to the black, red, and yellow paints with which their faces and naked bodies were bedaubed. In the midst of these came a band of men carrying three or four planks, on which were seated in rows upwards of a dozen men. I shuddered involuntarily as I recollected the sacrifice of human victims at the island of Emo, and turned with a look of fear to Jack as I said,—

As we turned onto a wide path leading up the hill, we were startled by the sounds of a crowd coming up from behind. We stepped into the bushes to wait for them, and as they got closer, we saw it was a procession of locals, many of whom were dancing and waving their arms wildly. They looked extremely frightening because their faces and bare bodies were smeared with black, red, and yellow paint. Among them was a group of men carrying three or four planks, on which more than a dozen men were seated in rows. I couldn't help but shudder as I recalled the human sacrifices at the island of Emo and turned to Jack with a look of fear as I said,—

“Oh, Jack! I have a terrible dread that they are going to commit some of their cruel practices on these wretched men. We had better not go to the temple. We shall only be horrified without being able to do any good, for I fear they are going to kill them.”

“Oh, Jack! I have a horrible feeling that they’re going to carry out their cruel practices on these poor men. We should probably avoid going to the temple. We’ll just be shocked without being able to help, because I’m afraid they’re going to kill them.”

Jack’s face wore an expression of deep compassion as he said, in a low voice, “No fear, Ralph; the sufferings of these poor fellows are over long ago.”

Jack's face showed deep compassion as he said in a soft voice, “Don't worry, Ralph; the suffering of these poor guys ended a long time ago.”

I turned with a start as he spoke, and, glancing at the men, who were now quite near to the spot where we stood, saw that they were all dead. They were tied firmly with ropes in a sitting posture on the planks, and seemed, as they bent their sightless eye-balls and grinning mouths over the dancing crew below, as if they were laughing in ghastly mockery at the utter inability of their enemies to hurt them now. These, we discovered afterwards, were the men who had been slain in the battle of the previous day, and were now on their way to be first presented to the gods, and then eaten. Behind these came two men leading between them a third, whose hands were pinioned behind his back. He walked with a firm step, and wore a look of utter indifference on his face, as they led him along; so that we concluded he must be a criminal who was about to receive some slight punishment for his faults. The rear of the procession was brought up by a shouting crowd of women and children, with whom we mingled and followed to the temple.

I jumped when he spoke, and glancing at the men, who were now really close to where we were standing, I saw that they were all dead. They were tightly bound with ropes, sitting on the planks, and as they turned their sightless eyes and grinning mouths toward the dancing crew below, it looked like they were laughing in horrifying mockery at their enemies' complete inability to harm them now. We later learned that these were the men who had been killed in the battle the day before, and were now being taken to be first offered to the gods, and then eaten. Behind them were two men guiding a third, whose hands were tied behind his back. He walked confidently and had an expression of complete indifference on his face as they led him, leading us to believe he must be a criminal about to face some minor punishment for his wrongdoings. The end of the procession was filled with a shouting crowd of women and children, and we mingled in with them and followed to the temple.

Here we arrived in a few minutes. The temple was a tall circular building, open at one side. Around it were strewn heaps of human bones and skulls. At a table inside sat the priest, an elderly man, with a long gray beard. He was seated on a stool, and before him lay several knives, made of wood, bone, and splinters of bamboo, with which he performed his office of dissecting dead bodies. Farther in lay a variety of articles that had been dedicated to the god, and among them were many spears and clubs. I observed among the latter some with human teeth sticking in them, where the victims had been clubbed in their mouths.

Here we arrived in just a few minutes. The temple was a tall, circular building, open on one side. Around it were piles of human bones and skulls. Inside, an elderly priest with a long gray beard sat at a table. He was on a stool, with several knives made of wood, bone, and bamboo splinters in front of him, which he used to perform his duties of dissecting dead bodies. Further in, there were various items that had been offered to the god, including many spears and clubs. I noticed some of the clubs had human teeth embedded in them, indicating where the victims had been struck in the mouth.

Before this temple the bodies, which were painted with vermilion and soot, were arranged in a sitting posture; and a man, called a “dan-vosa” (orator), advanced, and, laying his hands on their heads, began to chide them, apparently, in a low bantering tone. What he said we knew not, but, as he went on, he waxed warm, and at last shouted to them at the top of his lungs, and finally finished by kicking the bodies over and running away, amid the shouts and laughter of the people, who now rushed forward. Seizing the bodies by a leg, or an arm, or by the hair of the head, they dragged them over stumps and stones and through sloughs, until they were exhausted. The bodies were then brought back to the temple and dissected by the priest, after which they were taken out to be baked.

Before this temple, the bodies, which were painted with red and soot, were arranged in a sitting position. A man, known as a “dan-vosa” (orator), stepped forward and, placing his hands on their heads, started to scold them in a low, playful tone. We couldn’t hear exactly what he said, but as he continued, he got more passionate and eventually shouted at them at the top of his lungs. He ended by kicking the bodies over and running away, while the crowd erupted in shouts and laughter as they rushed forward. Grabbing the bodies by a leg, an arm, or by their hair, they dragged them over stumps, stones, and through muddy patches until they were worn out. The bodies were then brought back to the temple to be dissected by the priest, after which they were taken out to be baked.

Close to the temple a large fire was kindled, in which stones were heated red hot. When ready these were spread out on the ground, and a thick coating of leaves strewn over them to slack the heat. On this “lovo,” or oven, the bodies were then placed, covered over, and left to bake.

Close to the temple, a large fire was lit, heating stones until they were red hot. Once ready, these stones were spread out on the ground, and a thick layer of leaves was scattered over them to cool them down. On this “lovo,” or oven, the bodies were then placed, covered, and left to cook.

The crowd now ran, with terrible yells, towards a neighbouring hill or mound, on which we observed the frame-work of a house lying ready to be erected. Sick with horror, yet fascinated by curiosity, we staggered after them mechanically, scarce knowing where we were going or what we did, and feeling a sort of impression that all we saw was a dreadful dream.

The crowd now ran, screaming loudly, toward a nearby hill or mound, where we saw the framework of a house ready to be built. Sick with fear but also curious, we mechanically followed them, hardly aware of where we were going or what we were doing, feeling as if everything we saw was just a terrible nightmare.

Arrived at the place, we saw the multitude crowding round a certain spot. We pressed forward and obtained a sight of what they were doing. A large wooden beam or post lay on the ground, beside the other parts of the frame-work of the house, and close to the end of it was a hole about seven feet deep and upwards of two feet wide. While we looked, the man whom we had before observed with his hands pinioned, was carried into the circle. His hands were now free, but his legs were tightly strapped together. The post of the house was then placed in the hole, and the man put in beside it. His head was a good way below the surface of the hole, and his arms were clasped round the post. Earth was now thrown in until all was covered over and stamped down; and this, we were afterwards told, was a ceremony usually performed at the dedication of a new temple, or the erection of a chief’s house!

When we arrived, we saw a crowd gathered around a specific spot. We pushed our way forward to see what was happening. A large wooden beam or post was lying on the ground alongside other parts of the house's framework, and near one end of it was a hole about seven feet deep and over two feet wide. As we watched, the man we'd seen earlier with his hands tied was brought into the circle. His hands were free now, but his legs were tightly strapped together. The post for the house was then placed in the hole, and the man was put next to it. His head was well below the surface of the hole, and his arms wrapped around the post. Dirt was then piled in until everything was covered and compacted down; and we were later informed that this was a ceremony typically performed during the dedication of a new temple or the construction of a chief’s house!

“Come, come,” cried Jack, on beholding this horrible tragedy, “we have seen enough, enough, far more than enough! Let us go.”

“Come on, come on,” shouted Jack, seeing this awful tragedy, “we’ve seen enough, way more than enough! Let’s get out of here.”

Jack’s face looked ghastly pale and haggard as we hurried back to rejoin the teacher, and I have no doubt that he felt terrible anxiety when he considered the number and ferocity of the savages, and the weakness of the few arms which were ready indeed to essay, but impotent to effect, Avatea’s deliverance from these ruthless men.

Jack’s face looked ghostly pale and worn out as we rushed back to find the teacher, and I’m sure he felt intense anxiety thinking about the number and fierceness of the attackers, along with the weakness of the few weapons we had that were ready to try, but unable to actually save Avatea from these brutal men.

CHAPTER XXXII.

An unexpected discovery, and a bold, reckless defiance, with its consequences—Plans of escape, and heroic resolves.

An unexpected discovery and a daring, reckless defiance, along with its consequences—Plans for escape and brave decisions.

When we returned to the shore, and related to our friend what had passed, he was greatly distressed, and groaned in spirit; but we had not sat long in conversation, when we were interrupted by the arrival of Tararo on the beach, accompanied by a number of followers bearing baskets of vegetables and fruits on their heads.

When we got back to the shore and told our friend what had happened, he was really upset and sighed deeply; but we hadn’t been talking for long when we were interrupted by Tararo arriving on the beach, along with several followers carrying baskets of vegetables and fruits on their heads.

We advanced to meet him, and he expressed, through our interpreter, much pleasure in seeing us.

We approached him, and he conveyed, through our interpreter, that he was very pleased to see us.

“And what is it that my friends wish to say to me?” he inquired.

“And what do my friends want to say to me?” he asked.

The teacher explained that we came to beg that Avatea might be spared.

The teacher explained that we had come to ask for Avatea to be spared.

“Tell him,” said Jack, “that I consider that I have a right to ask this of him, having not only saved the girl’s life, but the lives of his own people also; and say that I wish her to be allowed to follow her own wishes, and join the Christians.”

“Tell him,” Jack said, “that I believe I have the right to ask this of him, having not only saved the girl's life but also the lives of his own people; and let him know that I want her to be allowed to follow her own wishes and join the Christians.”

While this was being translated, the chiefs brow lowered, and we could see plainly that our request met with no favourable reception. He replied with considerable energy, and at some length.

While this was being translated, the chief's brow furrowed, and we could clearly see that our request was not received well. He responded with a lot of energy and at some length.

“What says he?” inquired Jack.

“What does he say?” asked Jack.

“I regret to say that he will not listen to the proposal. He says he has pledged his word to his friend that the girl shall be sent to him, and a deputy is even now on this island awaiting the fulfilment of the pledge.”

“I’m sorry to say that he won’t consider the proposal. He claims he has promised his friend that the girl will be sent to him, and a representative is currently on this island waiting for that promise to be fulfilled.”

Jack bit his lip in suppressed anger. “Tell Tararo,” he exclaimed with flashing eye, “that if he does not grant my demand, it will be worse for him. Say I have a big gun on board my schooner that will blow his village into the sea, if he does not give up the girl.”

Jack bit his lip, holding back his anger. “Tell Tararo,” he said with fiery eyes, “that if he doesn’t meet my demands, it will be bad for him. Let him know I have a big gun on my schooner that can blow his village into the sea if he doesn’t hand over the girl.”

“Nay, my friend,” said the teacher, gently, “I will not tell him that; we must overcome evil with good.’”

“Nah, my friend,” said the teacher softly, “I won’t tell him that; we need to overcome evil with good.”

“What does my friend say?” inquired the chief, who seemed nettled by Jack’s looks of defiance.

“What does my friend say?” asked the chief, who looked annoyed by Jack’s defiant expression.

“He is displeased,” replied the teacher.

“He's not happy,” replied the teacher.

Tararo turned away with a smile of contempt, and walked towards the men who carried the baskets of vegetables, and who had now emptied the whole on the beach in an enormous pile.

Tararo turned away with a sneer and walked toward the men who were carrying the baskets of vegetables, which they had now dumped on the beach in a massive pile.

“What are they doing there?” I inquired.

"What are they doing over there?" I asked.

“I think that they are laying out a gift which they intend to present to some one,” said the teacher.

“I think they’re preparing a gift to give to someone,” said the teacher.

At this moment a couple of men appeared leading a young girl between them; and, going towards the heap of fruits and vegetables, placed her on the top of it. We started with surprise and fear, for in the young female before us we recognised the Samoan girl, Avatea!

At that moment, a couple of guys showed up, guiding a young girl between them. They walked over to the pile of fruits and vegetables and set her on top of it. We were taken aback with shock and fear because we recognized her as the Samoan girl, Avatea!

We stood rooted to the earth with surprise and thick coming fears.

We stood frozen in place, filled with shock and overwhelming fear.

“Oh! my dear young friend,” whispered the teacher, in a voice of deep emotion, while he seized Jack by the arm, “she is to be made a sacrifice even now!”

“Oh! my dear young friend,” whispered the teacher, in a voice full of emotion, as he grabbed Jack by the arm, “she is about to be sacrificed right now!”

“Is she?” cried Jack, with a vehement shout, spurning the teacher aside, and dashing over two natives who stood in his way, while he rushed towards the heap, sprang up its side, and seized Avatea by the arm. In another moment he dragged her down, placed her back to a large tree, and, wrenching a war-club from the hand of a native who seemed powerless and petrified with surprise, whirled it above his head, and yelled, rather than shouted, while his face blazed with fury, “Come on, the whole nation of you, an ye like it, and do your worst!”

“Is she?” shouted Jack, pushing the teacher aside and sprinting past two locals who were in his way. He rushed toward the pile, climbed up the side, and grabbed Avatea by the arm. In no time, he pulled her down, backed her against a large tree, and snatched a war club from a native who looked stunned and frozen in shock. He swung it above his head and yelled, rather than shouted, with anger on his face, “Come on, all of you, if you want to, and do your worst!”

It seemed as though the challenge had been literally accepted; for every savage on the ground ran precipitately at Jack with club and spear, and, doubtless, would speedily have poured out his brave blood on the sod, had not the teacher rushed in between them, and, raising his voice to its utmost, cried.—

It seemed as if the challenge had truly been accepted; every savage on the ground rushed toward Jack with clubs and spears, and would undoubtedly have spilled his brave blood on the ground, if the teacher hadn't stepped in between them and shouted at the top of his lungs.—

“Stay your hands, warriors! It is not your part to judge in this matter. It is for Tararo, the chief, to say whether or not the young man shall live or die.”

“Hold on, warriors! It's not your place to make this decision. That's for Tararo, the chief, to decide whether the young man lives or dies.”

The natives were arrested; and I know not whether it was the gratifying acknowledgment of his superiority thus made by the teacher, or some lingering feeling of gratitude for Jack’s former aid in time of need, that influenced Tararo, but he stepped forward, and, waving his hand, said to his people,—“Desist. The young man’s life is mine.” Then, turning to Jack, he said, “You have forfeited your liberty and life to me. Submit yourself, for we are more numerous than the sand upon the shore. You are but one; why should you die?”

The locals were arrested; and I’m not sure if it was the satisfying acknowledgment of his superiority from the teacher, or some lingering sense of gratitude for Jack’s past help in a time of need, that influenced Tararo, but he stepped forward and waved his hand, saying to his people, “Stop. The young man’s life belongs to me.” Then, turning to Jack, he said, “You’ve given up your freedom and life to me. Surrender, because we are more numerous than the sand on the shore. You are just one person; why should you die?”

“Villain!” exclaimed Jack, passionately, “I may die, but, assuredly, I shall not perish alone. I will not submit until you promise that this girl shall not be injured.”

“Villain!” shouted Jack, passionately. “I might die, but I definitely won’t go down alone. I won’t back down until you promise that this girl won’t be harmed.”

“You are very bold,” replied the chief, haughtily, “but very foolish. Yet I will say that Avatea shall not be sent away, at least for three days.”

“You're really bold,” the chief replied arrogantly, “but also very foolish. Still, I’ll say that Avatea won’t be sent away, at least for three days.”

“You had better accept these terms,” whispered the teacher, entreatingly. “If you persist in this mad defiance, you will be slain, and Avatea will be lost. Three days are worth having.”

“You should really accept these terms,” the teacher whispered earnestly. “If you continue this crazy defiance, you'll be killed, and Avatea will be doomed. Three days are worth having.”

Jack hesitated a moment, then lowered his club, and, throwing it moodily to the ground, crossed his arms on his breast, and hung down his head in silence.

Jack paused for a moment, then dropped his club and, tossing it to the ground in frustration, crossed his arms over his chest and hung his head in silence.

Tararo seemed pleased by his submission, and told the teacher to say that he did not forget his former services, and, therefore, would leave him free as to his person, but that the schooner would be detained till he had further considered the matter.

Tararo appeared satisfied with his submission and instructed the teacher to convey that he did not forget his previous services. Therefore, he would allow him his personal freedom, but the schooner would be held until he had thought about the issue further.

While the teacher translated this, he approached as near to where Avatea was standing as possible, without creating suspicion, and whispered to her a few words in the native language. Avatea, who, during the whole of the foregoing scene, had stood leaning against the tree perfectly passive, and seemingly quite uninterested in all that was going on, replied by a single rapid glance of her dark eye, which was instantly cast down again on the ground at her feet.

While the teacher translated this, he got as close to Avatea as he could without raising suspicion and whispered a few words to her in the native language. Avatea, who had been leaning against the tree the entire time, seeming completely uninterested in everything happening around her, responded with a quick glance from her dark eye, which she immediately cast down to the ground at her feet.

Tararo now advanced, and taking the girl by the hand, led her unresistingly away, while Jack, Peterkin, and I returned with the teacher on board the schooner.

Tararo stepped forward and took the girl by the hand, leading her away without resistance, while Jack, Peterkin, and I went back with the teacher on the schooner.

On reaching the deck, we went down to the cabin, where Jack threw himself, in a state of great dejection, on a couch; but the teacher seated himself by his side, and, laying his hand upon his shoulder, said,—

On reaching the deck, we went down to the cabin, where Jack threw himself onto a couch, feeling really down. But the teacher sat next to him, and, putting his hand on his shoulder, said,—

“Do not give way to anger, my young friend. God has given us three days, and we must use the means that are in our power to free this poor girl from slavery. We must not sit in idle disappointment, we must act”—

“Don't let anger take over, my young friend. God has given us three days, and we need to use every resource we have to save this poor girl from slavery. We can't sit around feeling disappointed; we need to take action—”

“Act!” cried Jack, raising himself, and tossing back his hair wildly; “it is mockery to balk of acting when one is bound hand and foot. How can I act? I cannot fight a whole nation of savages single-handed. Yes,” he said, with a bitter smile, “I can fight them, but I cannot conquer them, or save Avatea.”

“Act!” shouted Jack, sitting up and tossing his hair back wildly. “It’s pointless to hesitate when I'm completely tied up. How can I act? I can’t take on an entire nation of savages by myself. Yes,” he said, with a bitter smile, “I can fight them, but I can’t defeat them or save Avatea.”

“Patience, my friend; your spirit is not a good one just now. You cannot expect that blessing which alone can insure success, unless you are more submissive. I will tell you my plans if you will listen.”

“Patience, my friend; your mood isn't great right now. You can’t expect to receive the blessing that guarantees success unless you’re more willing to accept things. I'll share my plans if you're willing to listen.”

“Listen!” cried Jack, eagerly, “of course I will, my good fellow; I did not know you had any plans. Out with them. I only hope you will show me how I can get the girl on board of this schooner, and I’d up anchor and away in no time. But proceed with your plans.”

“Listen!” Jack shouted eagerly, “of course I will, my friend; I didn’t know you had any plans. Spill it. I just hope you can show me how to get the girl on this schooner, and I’d raise the anchor and be gone in no time. But go ahead with your plans.”

The teacher smiled sadly: “Ah! my friend, if one fathom of your anchor chain were to rattle, as you drew it in, a thousand warriors would be standing on your deck. No, no, that could not be done. Even now, your ship would be taken from you were it not that Tararo has some feeling of gratitude toward you. But I know Tararo well. He is a man of falsehood, as all the unconverted savages are. The chief to whom he has promised this girl is very powerful, and Tararo must fulfil his promise. He has told you that he would do nothing to the girl for three days; but that is because the party who are to take her away will not be ready to start for three days. Still, as he might have made you a prisoner during those three days, I say that God has given them to us.”

The teacher smiled sadly: “Ah! my friend, if even a little bit of your anchor chain were to rattle as you pulled it in, a thousand warriors would be standing on your deck. No, no, that can’t happen. Even now, your ship would be taken from you if it weren't for Tararo having some sense of gratitude toward you. But I know Tararo well. He’s a man of lies, just like all the unconverted savages. The chief he promised this girl to is very powerful, and Tararo has to keep his promise. He told you he wouldn’t do anything to the girl for three days; but that’s only because the group that’s supposed to take her will not be ready to leave for three days. Still, since he could have made you a prisoner during those three days, I say that God has given us this time.”

“Well, but what do you propose to do?” said Jack, impatiently.

“Well, what do you plan to do?” Jack asked, impatiently.

“My plan involves much danger, but I see no other, and I think you have courage to brave it. It is this: There is an island about fifty miles to the south of this, the natives of which are Christians, and have been so for two years or more, and the principal chief is Avatea’s lover. Once there, Avatea would be safe. Now, I suggest that you should abandon your schooner. Do you think that you can make so great a sacrifice?”

“My plan involves a lot of danger, but I don’t see any other options, and I believe you have the courage to face it. Here it is: There’s an island about fifty miles south of here, where the locals are Christians and have been for two years or so, and the main chief is Avatea’s lover. Once there, Avatea would be safe. Now, I propose that you should give up your schooner. Do you think you can make such a big sacrifice?”

“Friend,” replied Jack, “when I make up my mind to go through with a thing of importance, I can make any sacrifice.”

“Friend,” replied Jack, “when I decide to follow through with something important, I can make any sacrifice.”

The teacher smiled. “Well, then, the savages could not conceive it possible that, for the sake of a girl, you would voluntarily lose your fine vessel; therefore as long as she lies here they think they have you all safe: so I suggest that we get a quantity of stores conveyed to a sequestered part of the shore, provide a small canoe, put Avatea on board, and you three would paddle to the Christian island.”

The teacher smiled. “So, the natives can't believe that for a girl, you'd willingly give up your great ship; therefore, as long as she's here, they think they have you all secured. So I suggest we move some supplies to a hidden spot on the shore, get a small canoe, put Avatea on board, and you three can paddle to the Christian island.”

“Bravo!” cried Peterkin, springing up and seizing the teacher’s hand. “Missionary, you’re a regular brick. I didn’t think you had so much in you.”

“Bravo!” shouted Peterkin, jumping up and grabbing the teacher’s hand. “Missionary, you’re awesome. I didn’t think you had it in you.”

“As for me,” continued the teacher, “I will remain on board till they discover that you are gone. Then they will ask me where you are gone to, and I will refuse to tell.”

“As for me,” continued the teacher, “I’ll stay on board until they realize you’re missing. Then they’ll ask me where you’ve gone, and I’ll refuse to say.”

“And what’ll be the result of that?” inquired Jack.

“And what will that lead to?” Jack asked.

“I know not. Perhaps they will kill me; but,” he added, looking at Jack with a peculiar smile, “I too am not afraid to die in a good cause!”

“I don't know. They might kill me; but,” he added, looking at Jack with a strange smile, “I'm not afraid to die for a good reason either!”

“But how are we to get hold of Avatea?” inquired Jack.

“But how are we supposed to get ahold of Avatea?” Jack asked.

“I have arranged with her to meet us at a particular spot, to which I will guide you to-night. We shall then arrange about it. She will easily manage to elude her keepers, who are not very strict in watching her, thinking it impossible that she could escape from the island. Indeed, I am sure that such an idea will never enter their heads. But, as I have said, you run great danger. Fifty miles in a small canoe, on the open sea, is a great voyage to make. You may miss the island, too, in which case there is no other in that direction for a hundred miles or more; and if you lose your way and fall among other heathens, you know the law of Feejee—a cast-away who gains the shore is doomed to die. You must count the cost, my young friend.”

“I’ve set up a meeting with her at a specific spot, which I will lead you to tonight. We’ll sort everything out then. She’ll have no trouble getting away from her keepers, who aren’t very strict about watching her, thinking it’s impossible for her to escape from the island. In fact, I’m sure that idea won’t even cross their minds. However, as I mentioned, you’re taking a big risk. Fifty miles in a small canoe on the open sea is quite a journey. You might miss the island, and if you do, there won’t be another one for a hundred miles or more; and if you lose your way and end up among other natives, you know the law of Feejee—a castaway who makes it to shore is doomed to die. You need to weigh the risks, my young friend.”

“I have counted it,” replied Jack. “If Avatea consents to run the risk, most certainly I will; and so will my comrades also. Besides,” added Jack, looking seriously into the teacher’s face, “your Bible,—our Bible, tells of ONE who delivers those who call on Him in the time of trouble; who holds the winds in his fists and the waters in the hollow of his hand.”

“I’ve counted it,” Jack replied. “If Avatea is willing to take the risk, then I definitely will; and my friends will too. Besides,” Jack added, looking seriously at the teacher, “your Bible—our Bible—talks about ONE who saves those who call on Him in times of trouble; who has the winds in His fists and the waters in the palm of His hand.”

We now set about active preparations for the intended voyage; collected together such things as we should require, and laid out on the deck provisions sufficient to maintain us for several weeks, purposing to load the canoe with as much as she could hold consistently with speed and safety. These we covered with a tarpaulin, intending to convey them to the canoe only a few hours before starting. When night spread her sable curtain over the scene, we prepared to land; but, first, kneeling along with the natives and the teacher, the latter implored a blessing on our enterprise. Then we rowed quietly to the shore and followed our sable guide, who led us by a long detour, in order to avoid the village, to the place of rendezvous. We had not stood more than five minutes under the gloomy shade of the thick foliage when a dark figure glided noiselessly up to us.

We started getting ready for the upcoming trip. We gathered everything we needed and laid out enough supplies on the deck to last us for several weeks, planning to load the canoe with as much as it could carry while still being fast and safe. We covered these with a tarp, intending to move them to the canoe only a few hours before we left. When night fell, we prepared to land, but first, we knelt with the locals and the teacher, who asked for a blessing on our journey. Then we quietly rowed to the shore and followed our dark guide, who took us on a long detour to avoid the village and reach the meeting spot. We had barely been under the thick, dark foliage for five minutes when a dark figure silently approached us.

“Ah! here you are,” said Jack, as Avatea approached. “Now, then, tell her what we’ve come about, and don’t waste time.”

“Ah! there you are,” said Jack, as Avatea approached. “Alright, tell her why we’re here, and don’t waste any time.”

“I understan’ leetl English,” said Avatea, in a low voice.

“I understand a little English,” said Avatea, in a low voice.

“Why, where did you pick up English?” exclaimed Jack, in amazement; “you were dumb as a stone when I saw you last.”

“Wow, where did you learn English?” Jack exclaimed in surprise. “You were completely mute when I last saw you.”

“She has learned all she knows of it from me,” said the teacher, “since she came to the island.”

“She has learned everything she knows about it from me,” said the teacher, “since she arrived on the island.”

We now gave Avatea a full explanation of our plans, entering into all the details, and concealing none of the danger, so that she might be fully aware of the risk she ran. As we had anticipated, she was too glad of the opportunity thus afforded her to escape from her persecutors to think of the danger or risk.

We now gave Avatea a complete rundown of our plans, covering all the details and not hiding any of the dangers, so she could fully understand the risks she was taking. As we expected, she was so happy to have the chance to escape from her tormentors that she didn't think about the risks or dangers.

“Then you’re willing to go with us, are you?” said Jack.

“Then you’re up for going with us, right?” said Jack.

“Yis, I am willing to go.”

“Yeah, I'm down to go.”

“And you’re not afraid to trust yourself out on the deep sea so far?”

“And you’re not scared to trust yourself out in the deep sea this far?”

“No, I not ’fraid to go. Safe with Christian.”

“No, I'm not afraid to go. I'm safe with Christian.”

After some further consultation, the teacher suggested that it was time to return, so we bade Avatea good night, and having appointed to meet at the cliff where the canoe lay, on the following night, just after dark, we hastened away—we to row on board the schooner with muffled oars—Avatea to glide back to her prison-hut among the Mango savages.

After some more discussion, the teacher suggested it was time to head back, so we said goodnight to Avatea, and planned to meet at the cliff where the canoe was, the next night just after dark. We rushed away—us to row onto the schooner with quiet oars—Avatea to return to her prison-hut among the Mango tribe.

CHAPTER XXXIII.

The flight—The pursuit—Despair and its results—The lion bearded in his den again—Awful danger threatened and wonderfully averted—A terrific storm.

The flight—The chase—Despair and its outcomes—The lion confronted in his den once more—Terrifying danger looming and remarkably avoided—A fierce storm.

As the time for our meditated flight drew near, we became naturally very fearful lest our purpose should be discovered, and we spent the whole of the following day in a state of nervous anxiety. We resolved to go a-shore and ramble about the village, as if to observe the habits and dwellings of the people, as we thought that an air of affected indifference to the events of the previous day would be more likely than any other course of conduct to avert suspicion as to our intentions. While we were thus occupied, the teacher remained on board with the Christian natives, whose powerful voices reached us ever and anon as they engaged in singing hymns or in prayer.

As the time for our planned escape approached, we naturally felt very anxious about our purpose being discovered, and we spent the entire next day on edge. We decided to go ashore and wander around the village, pretending to observe the locals' habits and homes, thinking that acting indifferent to the events of the previous day would be the best way to avoid raising suspicion about our intentions. While we were busy with this, the teacher stayed on the boat with the Christian natives, whose strong voices sometimes drifted to us as they sang hymns or prayed.

At last the long and tedious day came to a close, the sank into the sea, and the short-lived twilight of those regions, to which I have already referred, ended abruptly in a dark night. Hastily throwing a few blankets into our little boat, we stepped into it, and, whispering farewell to the natives in the schooner, rowed gently over the lagoon, taking care to keep as near to the beach as possible. We rowed in the utmost silence and with muffled oars, so that had any one observed us at the distance of a few yards, he might have almost taken us for a phantom-boat or a shadow on the dark water. Not a breath of air was stirring; but fortunately the gentle ripple of the sea upon the shore, mingled with the soft roar of the breaker on the distant reef, effectually drowned the slight plash that we unavoidably made in the water by the dipping of our oars.

At last, the long and tedious day came to an end, the sun sank into the sea, and the brief twilight of those regions, which I’ve mentioned before, abruptly faded into a dark night. Quickly tossing a few blankets into our small boat, we climbed in and, whispering goodbye to the natives on the schooner, paddled softly across the lagoon, taking care to stay as close to the shore as possible. We rowed in complete silence with muffled oars, so that if anyone had noticed us just a few yards away, they might have thought we were a ghost boat or a shadow on the dark water. Not a breeze was blowing; but luckily, the gentle lapping of the sea on the shore, mixed with the distant roar of the waves on the reef, effectively drowned out the slight splashes we made with our oars.

Quarter of an hour sufficed to bring us to the over-hanging cliff under whose black shadow our little canoe lay, with her bow in the water ready to be launched, and most of her cargo already stowed away. As the keel of our little boat grated on the sand, a hand was laid upon the bow, and a dim form was seen.

Fifteen minutes was enough to get us to the overhanging cliff, where our small canoe rested in the dark shadow, its bow in the water, ready to launch, and most of its cargo already packed. As the bottom of our little boat scraped against the sand, a hand reached out to the bow, and a blurry figure appeared.

“Ha!” said Peterkin in a whisper, as he stepped upon the beach, “is that you, Avatea?”

“Ha!” Peterkin whispered as he stepped onto the beach, “Is that you, Avatea?”

“Yis, it am me,” was the reply.

“Yeah, it's me,” was the reply.

“All right! Now, then, gently. Help me to shove off the canoe,” whispered Jack to the teacher; “and Peterkin, do you shove these blankets aboard, we may want them before long. Avatea, step into the middle;—that’s right.”

“All right! Now, gently. Help me push the canoe off,” whispered Jack to the teacher; “and Peterkin, you get these blankets onboard, we might need them soon. Avatea, step into the middle;—that’s right.”

“Is all ready?” whispered the teacher.

“Is everything ready?” whispered the teacher.

“Not quite,” replied Peterkin. “Here, Ralph, lay hold o’ this pair of oars, and stow them away if you can. I don’t like paddles. After we’re safe away I’ll try to rig up rollicks for them.”

“Not quite,” replied Peterkin. “Here, Ralph, take these oars and stash them away if you can. I’m not a fan of paddles. Once we’re safe, I’ll try to set up some rigging for them.”

“Now, then, in with you and shove off.”

"Alright, now get in and push off."

One more earnest squeeze of the kind teacher’s hand, and, with his whispered blessing yet sounding in our ears, we shot like an arrow from the shore, sped over the still waters of the lagoon, and paddled as swiftly as strong arms and willing hearts could urge us over the long swell of the open sea.

One last firm squeeze of the kind teacher's hand, and with his whispered blessing still echoing in our ears, we launched like an arrow from the shore, glided over the calm waters of the lagoon, and paddled as fast as our strong arms and eager hearts could push us over the long waves of the open sea.

All that night and the whole of the following day we plied our paddles in almost total silence and without halt, save twice to recruit our failing energies with a mouthful of food and a draught of water. Jack had taken the bearing of the island just after starting, and laying a small pocket-compass before him, kept the head of the canoe due south, for our chance of hitting the island depended very much on the faithfulness of our steersman in keeping our tiny bark exactly and constantly on its proper course. Peterkin and I paddled in the bow, and Avatea worked untiringly in the middle.

All night long and throughout the next day, we paddled in almost complete silence without stopping, except twice to eat a little food and drink some water. Jack took the direction of the island right after we started and set a small pocket compass in front of him, keeping the canoe heading due south. Our chances of reaching the island depended a lot on how well our steersman kept us on course. Peterkin and I paddled at the front while Avatea worked tirelessly in the middle.

As the sun’s lower limb dipped on the gilded edge of the sea Jack ceased working, threw down his paddle, and called a halt.

As the sun sank down toward the shiny edge of the sea, Jack stopped working, dropped his paddle, and called it a day.

“There,” he cried, heaving a deep, long-drawn sigh, “we’ve put a considerable breadth of water between us and these black rascals, so now we’ll have a hearty supper and a sound sleep.”

“There,” he exclaimed, letting out a long, deep sigh, “we’ve put a good distance between us and those nasty guys, so now we can enjoy a nice dinner and get some solid sleep.”

“Hear, hear,” cried Peterkin. “Nobly spoken, Jack. Hand me a drop water, Ralph. Why, girl what’s wrong with you? You look just like a black owl blinking in the sunshine.”

“Hear, hear,” shouted Peterkin. “Well said, Jack. Pass me some water, Ralph. What’s wrong with you, girl? You look like a black owl squinting in the sunlight.”

Avatea smiled. “I sleepy,” she said; and as if to prove the truth of this, she laid her head on the edge of the canoe and fell fast asleep.

Avatea smiled. “I’m sleepy,” she said; and to prove her point, she rested her head on the edge of the canoe and fell fast asleep.

“That’s uncommon sharp practice,” said Peterkin, with a broad grin. “Don’t you think we should awake her to make her eat something first? or, perhaps,” he added, with a grave, meditative look, “perhaps we might put some food in her mouth, which is so elegantly open at the present moment, and see if she’d swallow it while asleep. If so, Ralph, you might come round to the front here and feed her quietly, while Jack and I are tucking into the victuals. It would be a monstrous economy of time.”

“That’s some pretty sharp practice,” said Peterkin, grinning widely. “Don’t you think we should wake her up to get her to eat something first? Or, maybe,” he added, with a serious, thoughtful look, “maybe we could just put some food in her mouth, which is conveniently open right now, and see if she’d swallow it while she’s asleep. If that works, Ralph, you could come over to the front and feed her quietly while Jack and I dig into the food. It’d save us a lot of time.”

I could not help smiling at Peterkin’s idea, which, indeed, when I pondered it, seemed remarkably good in theory; nevertheless I declined to put it in practice, being fearful of the result should the victual chance to go down the wrong throat. But, on suggesting this to Peterkin, he exclaimed—

I couldn't help but smile at Peterkin's idea, which, when I thought about it, seemed really good in theory; however, I chose not to try it out because I was worried about what would happen if the food went down the wrong throat. But when I mentioned this to Peterkin, he exclaimed—

“Down the wrong throat, man! why, a fellow with half an eye might see that if it went down Avatea’s throat it could not go down the wrong throat!—unless, indeed, you have all of a sudden become inordinately selfish, and think that all the throats in the world are wrong ones except your own. However, don’t talk so much, and hand me the pork before Jack finishes it. I feel myself entitled to at least one minute morsel.”

“Down the wrong throat, man! Seriously, even someone with half an eye could see that if it went down Avatea’s throat, it couldn’t go down the wrong throat! Unless, of course, you’ve suddenly become extremely selfish and think that all the throats in the world are wrong except for yours. Anyway, stop talking so much and give me the pork before Jack finishes it. I think I deserve at least one little piece.”

“Peterkin, you’re a villain. A paltry little villain,” said Jack, quietly, as he tossed the hind legs (including the tail) of a cold roast pig to his comrade; “and I must again express my regret that unavoidable circumstances have thrust your society upon me, and that necessity has compelled me to cultivate your acquaintance. Were it not that you are incapable of walking upon the water, I would order you, sir, out of the canoe.”

“Peterkin, you’re a jerk. A pathetic little jerk,” said Jack quietly, as he tossed the hind legs (including the tail) of a cold roast pig to his comrade; “and I have to say again how sorry I am that unavoidable circumstances have forced me to spend time with you, and that I’ve had to get to know you out of necessity. If it weren’t for the fact that you can’t walk on water, I would kick you out of the canoe, sir.”

“There! you’ve wakened Avatea with your long tongue,” retorted Peterkin, with a frown, as the girl gave vent to a deep sigh. “No,” he continued, “it was only a snore. Perchance she dreameth of her black Apollo. I say, Ralph, do leave just one little slice of that yam. Between you and Jack I run a chance of being put on short allowance, if not—yei—a—a—ow!”

“There! You've woken Avatea with your chatter,” Peterkin shot back, frowning as the girl let out a deep sigh. “No,” he continued, “that was just a snore. Maybe she's dreaming of her dark Apollo. Hey, Ralph, could you leave just one little piece of that yam? With you and Jack around, I might end up with a tiny portion, if not—yikes—ow!”

Peterkin’s concluding remark was a yawn of so great energy that Jack recommended him to postpone the conclusion of his meal till next morning,—a piece of advice which he followed so quickly, that I was forcibly reminded of his remark, a few minutes before, in regard to the sharp practice of Avatea.

Peterkin’s final comment was such an intense yawn that Jack suggested he should finish his meal the next morning. Peterkin took this advice so quickly that I was reminded of what he had said just a few minutes earlier about Avatea’s tricky tactics.

My readers will have observed, probably, by this time, that I am much given to meditation; they will not, therefore, be surprised to learn that I fell into a deep reverie on the subject of sleep, which was continued without intermission into the night, and prolonged without interruption into the following morning. But I cannot feel assured that I actually slept during that time, although I am tolerably certain that I was not awake.

My readers have likely noticed by now that I tend to think deeply; so, they won't be surprised to hear that I got lost in thought about sleep, which lasted non-stop into the night and continued uninterrupted into the next morning. But I'm not completely sure I actually slept during that time, even though I'm fairly certain I wasn't awake.

Thus we lay like a shadow on the still bosom of the ocean, while the night closed in, and all around was calm, dark, and silent.

Thus we lay like a shadow on the still surface of the ocean, while night fell, and everything around us was calm, dark, and silent.

A thrilling cry of alarm from Peterkin startled us in the morning, just as the gray dawn began to glimmer in the east.

A thrilling cry of alarm from Peterkin startled us in the morning, just as the gray dawn began to glimmer in the east.

“What’s wrong?” cried Jack, starting up.

“What’s wrong?” Jack shouted, jumping up.

Peterkin replied by pointing with a look of anxious dread towards the horizon; and a glance sufficed to show us that one of the largest sized war-canoes was approaching us!

Peterkin responded by nervously pointing toward the horizon, and a quick look was enough to reveal that one of the biggest war canoes was heading our way!

With a groan of mingled despair and anger Jack seized his paddle, glanced at the compass, and, in a suppressed voice, commanded us to “give way.”

With a groan of mixed despair and anger, Jack grabbed his paddle, looked at the compass, and, in a quiet voice, told us to "row."

But we did not require to be urged. Already our four paddles were glancing in the water, and the canoe bounded over the glassy sea like a dolphin, while a shout from our pursuers told that they had observed our motions.

But we didn’t need any encouragement. Our four paddles were already splashing in the water, and the canoe leaped over the smooth sea like a dolphin, while a shout from our pursuers indicated that they had noticed our movements.

“I see something like land ahead,” said Jack, in a hopeful tone. “It seems impossible that we could have made the island yet; still, if it is so, we may reach it before these fellows can catch us, for our canoe is light and our muscles are fresh.”

“I see something like land ahead,” Jack said, sounding hopeful. “It seems unlikely that we could have reached the island yet; still, if that’s the case, we might get there before those guys catch us, because our canoe is light and we’re still strong.”

No one replied; for, to say truth, we felt that, in a long chase, we had no chance whatever with a canoe which held nearly a hundred warriors. Nevertheless, we resolved to do our utmost to escape, and paddled with a degree of vigour that kept us well in advance of our pursuers. The war-canoe was so far behind us that it seemed but a little speck on the sea, and the shouts, to which the crew occasionally gave vent, came faintly towards us on the morning breeze. We therefore hoped that we should be able to keep in advance for an hour or two, when we might, perhaps, reach the land ahead. But this hope was suddenly crushed by the supposed land, not long after, rising up into the sky; thus proving itself to be a fog-bank!

No one answered; to be honest, we knew that after a long chase, we stood no chance against a canoe that carried nearly a hundred warriors. Still, we decided to do our best to escape and paddled with enough energy to stay well ahead of our pursuers. The war canoe was so far behind that it looked like a tiny dot on the sea, and the shouts from the crew occasionally drifted to us on the morning breeze. So, we hoped we could stay ahead for an hour or two, and maybe reach the land up ahead. But this hope was abruptly shattered when what we thought was land rose into the sky, revealing itself to be a fog bank!

A bitter feeling of disappointment filled each heart, and was expressed on each countenance, as we beheld this termination to our hopes. But we had little time to think of regret. Our danger was too great and imminent to permit of a moment’s relaxation from our exertions. No hope now animated our bosoms; but a feeling of despair, strange to say, lent us power to work, and nerved our arms with such energy, that it was several hours ere the savages overtook us. When we saw that there was indeed no chance of escape, and that paddling any longer would only serve to exhaust our strength, without doing any good, we turned the side of our canoe towards the approaching enemy, and laid down our paddles.

A sense of bitter disappointment filled every heart and was clear on every face as we faced the end of our hopes. But we had little time to dwell on regret. Our danger was too great and close to allow for even a moment of rest. No hope now inspired us; instead, oddly enough, a feeling of despair gave us the strength to keep going and fueled our efforts with such energy that it took several hours for the savages to catch up with us. When we realized there was truly no chance of escape and that paddling any longer would only tire us out without helping, we turned our canoe toward the approaching enemy and laid down our paddles.

Silently, and with a look of bitter determination on his face, Jack lifted one of the light boat-oars that we had brought with us, and, resting it on his shoulder, stood up in an attitude of bold defiance. Peterkin took the other oar and also stood up, but there was no anger visible on his countenance. When not sparkling with fun, it usually wore a mild, sad expression, which was deepened on the present occasion, as he glanced at Avatea, who sat with her face resting in her hands upon her knees. Without knowing very well what I intended to do, I also arose and grasped my paddle with both hands.

Silently, with a look of fierce determination on his face, Jack picked up one of the light boat oars we had brought with us, rested it on his shoulder, and stood up in a bold, defiant stance. Peterkin took the other oar and stood up too, but there was no anger on his face. When he wasn't sparkling with humor, he usually had a gentle, sad expression, which was even more pronounced now as he looked at Avatea, who sat with her face resting in her hands on her knees. Not really sure what I intended to do, I also stood up and gripped my paddle with both hands.

On came the large canoe like a war-horse of the deep, with the foam curling from its sharp bow, and the spear-heads of the savages glancing the beams of the rising sun. Perfect silence was maintained on both sides, and we could hear the hissing water, and see the frowning eyes of the warriors, as they came rushing on. When about twenty yards distant, five or six of the savages in the bow rose, and, laying aside their paddles, took up their spears. Jack and Peterkin raised their oars, while, with a feeling of madness whirling in my brain, I grasped my paddle and prepared for the onset. But, before any of us could strike a blow, the sharp prow of the war-canoe struck us like a thunderbolt on the side, and hurled us into the sea!

On came the large canoe like a war horse of the sea, with foam curling off its sharp bow and the spear points of the warriors glinting in the rising sun. There was perfect silence on both sides, and we could hear the hissing water and see the fierce expressions of the warriors as they charged forward. When they were about twenty yards away, five or six of the warriors in the front rose, put down their paddles, and took up their spears. Jack and Peterkin raised their oars while, with a feeling of madness swirling in my head, I grabbed my paddle and got ready for the attack. But before any of us could strike a blow, the sharp prow of the war canoe slammed into us like a thunderbolt from the side and sent us crashing into the sea!

What occurred after this I cannot tell, for I was nearly drowned; but when I recovered from the state of insensibility into which I had been thrown, I found myself stretched on my back, bound hand and foot between Jack and Peterkin, in the bottom of the large canoe.

What happened next, I can't say, because I was almost drowned; but when I came to, after being knocked out, I found myself lying on my back, tied up hand and foot, between Jack and Peterkin, at the bottom of the large canoe.

In this condition we lay the whole day, during which time the savages only rested one hour. When night came, they rested again for another hour, and appeared to sleep just as they sat. But we were neither unbound nor allowed to speak to each other during the voyage, nor was a morsel of food or a draught of water given to us. For food, however, we cared little; but we would have given much for a drop of water to cool our parched lips, and we would have been glad, too, had they loosened the cords that bound us, for they were tightly fastened and occasioned us much pain. The air, also, was unusually hot, so much so that I felt convinced that a storm was brewing. This also added to our sufferings. However, these were at length relieved by our arrival at the island from which we had fled.

In this condition, we lay the whole day, during which the savages only took a break for an hour. When night fell, they rested again for another hour and seemed to sleep while sitting up. But we weren't unbound or allowed to talk to each other during the journey, nor were we given any food or water. We didn’t care much about food, but we would have given a lot for a drop of water to soothe our dry lips, and we would have been happy if they had loosened the ropes that bound us, as they were tightly tied and caused us a lot of pain. The air was also unusually hot, making me feel certain that a storm was coming. This added to our suffering. However, our discomfort was finally eased by our arrival at the island we had escaped from.

While we were being led ashore, we caught a glimpse of Avatea, who was seated in the hinder part of the canoe. She was not fettered in any way. Our captors now drove us before them towards the hut of Tararo, at which we speedily arrived, and found the chief seated with an expression on his face that boded us no good. Our friend the teacher stood beside him, with a look of anxiety on his mild features.

While we were being taken ashore, we caught a glimpse of Avatea, who was sitting at the back of the canoe. She wasn’t tied up at all. Our captors then pushed us forward toward Tararo’s hut, where we quickly arrived and found the chief sitting there with a look on his face that didn’t suggest anything good for us. Our friend the teacher stood beside him, looking anxious on his gentle face.

“How comes it,” said Tararo, turning to the teacher, “that these youths have abused our hospitality?”

“How is it,” said Tararo, turning to the teacher, “that these young people have taken advantage of our hospitality?”

“Tell him,” replied Jack, “that we have not abused his hospitality, for his hospitality has not been extended to us. I came to the island to deliver Avatea, and my only regret is that I have failed to do so. If I get another chance, I will try to save her yet.”

“Tell him,” Jack replied, “that we haven't taken advantage of his hospitality because he hasn't offered it to us. I came to the island to deliver Avatea, and my only regret is that I haven’t succeeded. If I get another chance, I'll do my best to save her.”

The teacher shook his head. “Nay, my young friend, I had better not tell him that. It will only incense him.”

The teacher shook his head. “No, my young friend, I shouldn't tell him that. It will only make him angry.”

“Fear not,” replied Jack. “If you don’t tell him that, you’ll tell him nothing, for I won’t say anything softer.”

“Don’t worry,” Jack replied. “If you don’t say that, you won’t say anything at all, because I won’t say anything kinder.”

On hearing Jack’s speech, Tararo frowned and his eye flashed with anger.

On hearing Jack’s speech, Tararo frowned and his eyes flashed with anger.

“Go,” he said, “presumptuous boy. My debt to you is cancelled. You and your companions shall die.”

“Go,” he said, “confident kid. I owe you nothing now. You and your friends are going to die.”

As he spoke he rose and signed to several of his attendants, who seized Jack, and Peterkin, and me, violently by the collars, and, dragging us from the hut of the chief, led us through the wood to the outskirts of the village. Here they thrust us into a species of natural cave in a cliff, and, having barricaded the entrance, left us in total darkness.

As he spoke, he got up and signaled to several of his attendants, who grabbed Jack, Peterkin, and me roughly by the collars. They dragged us out of the chief's hut and led us through the woods to the edge of the village. There, they pushed us into a kind of natural cave in a cliff, and after blocking the entrance, left us in complete darkness.

After feeling about for some time—for our legs were unshackled, although our wrists were still bound with thongs—we found a low ledge of rock running along one side of the cavern. On this we seated ourselves, and for a long time maintained unbroken silence.

After searching around for a while—our legs were free, but our wrists were still tied with thongs—we found a low rock ledge along one side of the cave. We sat down on it and stayed in silence for a long time.

At last I could restrain my feelings no longer. “Alas! dear Jack and Peterkin,” said I, “what is to become of us? I fear that we are doomed to die.”

At last, I could no longer hold back my feelings. “Oh no! dear Jack and Peterkin,” I said, “what's going to happen to us? I’m afraid we’re doomed to die.”

“I know not,” replied Jack, in a tremulous voice, “I know not; Ralph, I regret deeply the hastiness of my violent temper, which, I must confess, has been the chief cause of our being brought to this sad condition. Perhaps the teacher may do something for us. But I have little hope.”

"I don’t know," replied Jack, his voice shaking. "I don’t know; Ralph, I really regret how quickly I lost my temper, which I have to admit has mostly caused us to end up in this unfortunate situation. Maybe the teacher can help us. But I have very little hope."

“Ah! no,” said Peterkin, with a heavy sigh; “I am sure he can’t help us. Tararo doesn’t care more for him than for one of his dogs.”

“Ah! no,” said Peterkin, with a heavy sigh; “I’m sure he can’t help us. Tararo doesn’t care any more for him than for one of his dogs.”

“Truly,” said I, “there seems no chance of deliverance, unless the Almighty puts forth his arm to save us. Yet I must say that I have great hope, my comrades, for we have come to this dark place by no fault of ours—unless it be a fault to try to succour a woman in distress.”

“Honestly,” I said, “it looks like there’s no way out, unless God reaches out to save us. But I have to say that I’m really hopeful, my friends, because we ended up in this dark place through no fault of our own—unless trying to help a woman in trouble is considered a fault.”

I was interrupted in my remarks by a noise at the entrance to the cavern, which was caused by the removal of the barricade. Immediately after, three men entered, and, taking us by the collars of our coats, led us away through the forest. As we advanced, we heard much shouting and beating of native drums in the village, and at first we thought that our guards were conducting us to the hut of Tararo again. But in this we were mistaken. The beating of drums gradually increased, and soon after we observed a procession of the natives coming towards us. At the head of this procession we were placed, and then we all advanced together towards the temple where human victims were wont to be sacrificed!

I was interrupted in my speech by a noise at the entrance of the cave, caused by the removal of the barricade. Right after that, three men walked in and grabbed us by the collars of our coats, leading us through the forest. As we moved forward, we heard a lot of shouting and the pounding of native drums from the village, and at first, we thought our captors were taking us back to Tararo's hut. But we were wrong. The drumming grew louder, and soon we noticed a group of natives approaching us. We were put at the front of this group, and then we all moved together towards the temple where human sacrifices were usually made!

A thrill of horror ran through my heart as I recalled to mind the awful scenes that I had before witnessed at that dreadful spot. But deliverance came suddenly from a quarter whence we little expected it. During the whole of that day there had been an unusual degree of heat in the atmosphere, and the sky assumed that lurid aspect which portends a thunder-storm. Just as we were approaching the horrid temple, a growl of thunder burst overhead and heavy drops of rain began to fall.

A rush of fear shot through my heart as I remembered the terrible sights I had seen at that awful place. But help came unexpectedly. The whole day had been unusually hot, and the sky took on that ominous look that signals a thunderstorm. Just as we were getting close to the frightening temple, thunder rumbled overhead and heavy raindrops started to fall.

Those who have not witnessed gales and storms in tropical regions can form but a faint conception of the fearful hurricane that burst upon the island of Mango at this time. Before we reached the temple, the storm burst upon us with a deafening roar, and the natives, who knew too well the devastation that was to follow, fled right and left through the woods in order to save their property, leaving us alone in the midst of the howling storm. The trees around us bent before the blast like willows, and we were about to flee in order to seek shelter, when the teacher ran toward us with a knife in his hand.

Those who haven't experienced strong winds and storms in tropical areas can only imagine the terrifying hurricane that hit the island of Mango at this moment. Before we reached the temple, the storm hit us with a deafening roar, and the locals, who were all too familiar with the destruction that was about to happen, scattered through the woods to save their belongings, leaving us alone in the middle of the raging storm. The trees around us bent in the wind like willows, and just as we were about to run for cover, the teacher came rushing towards us with a knife in his hand.

“Thank the Lord,” he said, cutting our bonds, “I am in time! Now, seek the shelter of the nearest rock.”

“Thank God,” he said, cutting our ties, “I made it in time! Now, find the shelter of the nearest rock.”

This we did without a moment’s hesitation, for the whistling wind burst, ever and anon, like thunder-claps among the trees, and, tearing them from their roots, hurled them with violence to the ground. Rain cut across the land in sheets, and lightning played like forked serpents in the air; while, high above the roar of the hissing tempest, the thunder crashed, and burst, and rolled in awful majesty.

This we did without a second thought, as the whistling wind erupted, now and then, like thunder among the trees, ripping them from their roots and violently throwing them to the ground. Rain poured down in sheets, and lightning flashed like forked snakes in the sky; meanwhile, high above the roaring storm, the thunder crashed, boomed, and rolled with stunning power.

In the village the scene was absolutely appalling. Roofs were blown completely off the houses in many cases; and in others, the houses themselves were levelled with the ground. In the midst of this, the natives were darting to and fro, in some instances saving their goods, but in many others seeking to save themselves from the storm of destruction that whirled around them. But, terrific although the tempest was on land, it was still more tremendous on the mighty ocean. Billows sprang, as it were, from the great deep, and while their crests were absolutely scattered into white mist, they fell upon the beach with a crash that seemed to shake the solid land. But they did not end there. Each successive wave swept higher and higher on the beach, until the ocean lashed its angry waters among the trees and bushes, and at length, in a sheet of white curdled foam, swept into the village and upset and carried off, or dashed into wreck, whole rows of the native dwellings! It was a sublime, an awful scene, calculated, in some degree at least, to impress the mind of beholders with the might and the majesty of God.

In the village, the scene was absolutely horrifying. Roofs were completely blown off many houses, and in some cases, the houses themselves were flattened to the ground. In the chaos, the locals were running around, sometimes saving their belongings, but in many instances, trying to escape the storm of destruction swirling around them. The tempest was terrifying on land, but it was even more intense on the vast ocean. Waves seemed to rise from the deep, their crests turning into white mist as they crashed onto the beach with a force that shook the ground. But it didn't stop there. Each wave rose higher and higher on the shore, until the ocean flung its furious waters into the trees and bushes, finally flooding into the village and overturning or destroying entire rows of the locals' homes! It was a breathtaking and terrifying scene, designed, at least in some way, to impress spectators with the power and grandeur of God.

We found shelter in a cave that night and all the next day, during which time the storm raged in fury; but on the night following it abated somewhat, and in the morning we went to the village to seek for food, being so famished with hunger that we lost all feeling of danger and all wish to escape in our desire to satisfy the cravings of nature. But no sooner had we obtained food than we began to wish that we had rather endeavoured to make our escape into the mountains. This we attempted to do soon afterwards, but the natives were now able to look after us, and on our showing a disposition to avoid observation and make towards the mountains, we were seized by three warriors, who once more bound our wrists and thrust us into our former prison.

We found shelter in a cave that night and all the next day while the storm raged fiercely. By the following night, it had calmed down a bit, and in the morning, we headed to the village to find food, so starving that we completely lost our sense of danger and our desire to escape in our need to satisfy our hunger. But as soon as we got food, we wished we had tried to escape into the mountains instead. We attempted to do that soon after, but the locals were now on high alert, and when we tried to slip away and head towards the mountains, three warriors caught us, bound our wrists again, and threw us back into our old prison.

It is true Jack made a vigorous resistance, and knocked down the first savage who seized him, with a well-directed blow of his fist, but he was speedily overpowered by others. Thus we were again prisoners, with the prospect of torture and a violent death before us.

It’s true Jack fought back fiercely and knocked down the first savage who grabbed him with a solid punch, but he was quickly overwhelmed by others. So, we were prisoners again, facing the possibility of torture and a brutal death.

CHAPTER XXXIV.

Imprisonment—Sinking hopes—Unexpected freedom to more than one, and in more senses than one.

Imprisonment—Fading hopes—Surprising freedom for more than one person, and in more ways than one.

For a long long month we remained in our dark and dreary prison, during which dismal time we did not see the face of a human being, except that of the silent savage who brought us our daily food.

For a long, gloomy month, we stayed in our dark and depressing prison, during which we didn't see another person, except for the silent wild man who delivered our daily meals.

There have been one or two seasons in my life during which I have felt as if the darkness of sorrow and desolation that crushed my inmost heart could never pass away, until death should make me cease to feel the present was such a season.

There have been one or two times in my life when I felt like the darkness of sorrow and despair that weighed down my heart would never go away, until death put an end to my feelings.

During the first part of our confinement we felt a cold chill at our hearts every time we heard a foot-fall near the cave—dreading lest it should prove to be that of our executioner. But as time dragged heavily on, we ceased to feel this alarm, and began to experience such a deep, irrepressible longing for freedom, that we chafed and fretted in our confinement like tigers. Then a feeling of despair came over us, and we actually longed for the time when the savages would take us forth to die! But these changes took place very gradually, and were mingled sometimes with brighter thoughts; for there were times when we sat in that dark cavern on our ledge of rock and conversed almost pleasantly about the past, until we well-nigh forgot the dreary present. But we seldom ventured to touch upon the future.

During the first part of our confinement, we felt a cold chill in our hearts every time we heard footsteps near the cave, fearing it might be our executioner. But as time dragged on, we stopped feeling that fear and began to feel an intense, unstoppable desire for freedom, moving restlessly in our confinement like tigers. Then a sense of despair settled over us, and we actually started wishing for the moment when the savages would take us out to die! But these changes happened very slowly and were sometimes mixed with brighter thoughts; there were moments when we sat in that dark cavern on our ledge of rock and talked almost happily about the past, until we nearly forgot the miserable present. However, we rarely dared to discuss the future.

A few decayed leaves and boughs formed our bed; and a scanty supply of yams and taro, brought to us once a-day, constituted our food.

A few decayed leaves and branches made our bed; and a limited supply of yams and taro, delivered to us once a day, made up our food.

“Well, Ralph, how have you slept?” said Jack, in a listless tone, on rising one morning from his humble couch. “Were you much disturbed by the wind last night?”

“Well, Ralph, how did you sleep?” said Jack, in a disinterested tone, as he got up one morning from his simple bed. “Did the wind keep you up much last night?”

“No,” said I; “I dreamed of home all night, and I thought that my mother smiled upon me, and beckoned me to go to her; but I could not, for I was chained.”

“No,” I said; “I dreamed of home all night, and I thought my mother was smiling at me and calling me to come to her; but I couldn't, because I was chained.”

“And I dreamed, too,” said Peterkin; “but it was of our happy home on the Coral Island. I thought we were swimming in the Water Garden; then the savages gave a yell, and we were immediately in the cave at Spouting Cliff, which, somehow or other, changed into this gloomy cavern; and I awoke to find it true.”

“And I had a dream, too,” Peterkin said. “But it was about our happy home on Coral Island. I imagined we were swimming in the Water Garden; then the savages yelled, and suddenly we were in the cave at Spouting Cliff, which somehow turned into this dark cavern; and I woke up to find it was real.”

Peterkin’s tone was so much altered by the depressing influence of his long imprisonment, that, had I not known it was he who spoke, I should scarcely have recognised it, so sad was it, and so unlike to the merry, cheerful voice we had been accustomed to hear. I pondered this much, and thought of the terrible decline of happiness that may come on human beings in so short a time; how bright the sunshine in the sky at one time, and, in a short space, how dark the overshadowing cloud! I had no doubt that the Bible would have given me much light and comfort on this subject, if I had possessed one, and I once more had occasion to regret deeply having neglected to store my memory with its consoling truths.

Peterkin’s tone had changed so much from being locked up for so long that, if I hadn’t known it was him speaking, I would hardly have recognized it. It sounded so sad and so different from the cheerful voice we were used to hearing. I thought a lot about this and considered how quickly happiness can fade in people’s lives; how bright the sun can shine one moment and how quickly it can be overshadowed by dark clouds. I was sure that the Bible would have offered me a lot of comfort and insight on this topic if I’d had one, and I once again regretted not having taken the time to memorize its comforting truths.

While I meditated thus, Peterkin again broke the silence of the cave, by saying, in a melancholy tone, “Oh, I wonder if we shall ever see our dear island more.”

While I was deep in thought, Peterkin once again interrupted the quiet of the cave, saying in a sad tone, “Oh, I wonder if we’ll ever see our beloved island again.”

His voice trembled, and, covering his face with both hands, he bent down his head and wept. It was an unusual sight for me to see our once joyous companion in tears, and I felt a burning desire to comfort him; but, alas! what could I say? I could hold out no hope; and although I essayed twice to speak, the words refused to pass my lips. While I hesitated, Jack sat down beside him, and whispered a few words in his ear, while Peterkin threw himself on his friend’s breast, and rested his head on his shoulder.

His voice shook, and covering his face with both hands, he bent his head and cried. It was strange for me to see our once happy friend in tears, and I felt a strong urge to comfort him; but, unfortunately, what could I say? I couldn't offer any hope; and even though I tried to speak twice, the words wouldn't come out. While I hesitated, Jack sat down next to him and whispered a few words in his ear, while Peterkin threw himself against his friend's chest and rested his head on his shoulder.

Thus we sat for some time in deep silence. Soon after, we heard footsteps at the entrance of the cave, and immediately our jailer entered. We were so much accustomed to his regular visits, however, that we paid little attention to him, expecting that he would set down our meagre fare, as usual, and depart. But, to our surprise, instead of doing so, he advanced towards us with a knife in his hand, and, going up to Jack, he cut the thongs that bound his wrists, then he did the same to Peterkin and me! For fully five minutes we stood in speechless amazement, with our freed hands hanging idly by our sides. The first thought that rushed into my mind was, that the time had come to put us to death; and although, as I have said before, we actually wished for death in the strength of our despair, now that we thought it drew really near I felt all the natural love of life revive in my heart, mingled with a chill of horror at the suddenness of our call.

So we sat in silence for a while. Soon after, we heard footsteps at the cave entrance, and our jailer walked in. We were so used to his regular visits that we barely paid attention to him, expecting him to drop off our meager food and leave. But to our surprise, instead of doing that, he walked over to us with a knife in his hand. He went up to Jack and cut the ropes binding his wrists, then did the same for Peterkin and me! For a full five minutes, we stood there in stunned silence, our freed hands hanging by our sides. The first thought that hit me was that it was time for us to be executed; and although, as I mentioned before, we actually yearned for death in our despair, now that it seemed so close, I felt an intense love for life surge back in my heart, mixed with a cold terror at how suddenly it was happening.

But I was mistaken. After cutting our bonds, the savage pointed to the cave’s mouth, and we marched, almost mechanically, into the open air. Here, to our surprise, we found the teacher standing under a tree, with his hands clasped before him, and the tears trickling down his dark cheeks. On seeing Jack, who came out first, he sprang towards him, and clasping him in his arms, exclaimed,—

But I was wrong. After cutting our ties, the savage pointed to the entrance of the cave, and we walked, almost like robots, into the fresh air. To our surprise, we found the teacher standing under a tree, with his hands together in front of him, and tears streaming down his dark cheeks. When he saw Jack, who was the first to come out, he rushed toward him and hugged him tightly, exclaiming,—

“Oh! my dear young friend, through the great goodness of God you are free!”

“Oh! my dear young friend, thanks to God's great goodness, you are free!”

“Free!” cried Jack.

"Free!" shouted Jack.

“Ay, free,” repeated the teacher, shaking us warmly by the hands again and again; “free to go and come as you will. The Lord has unloosed the bands of the captive and set the prisoners free. A missionary has been sent to us, and Tararo has embraced the Christian religion! The people are even now burning their gods of wood! Come, my dear friends, and see the glorious sight.”

“Yeah, free,” the teacher said, shaking our hands warmly over and over. “Free to come and go as you please. The Lord has released the captives and set the prisoners free. A missionary has come to us, and Tararo has accepted the Christian faith! The people are even now burning their wooden idols! Come, my dear friends, and witness this amazing sight.”

We could scarcely credit our senses. So long had we been accustomed in our cavern to dream of deliverance, that we imagined for a moment this must surely be nothing more than another vivid dream. Our eyes and minds were dazzled, too, by the brilliant sunshine, which almost blinded us after our long confinement to the gloom of our prison, so that we felt giddy with the variety of conflicting emotions that filled our throbbing bosoms; but as we followed the footsteps of our sable friend, and beheld the bright foliage of the trees, and heard the cries of the paroquets, and smelt the rich perfume of the flowering shrubs, the truth, that we were really delivered from prison and from death, rushed with overwhelming power into our souls, and, with one accord, while tears sprang to our eyes, we uttered a loud long cheer of joy.

We could hardly believe our senses. We had spent so long in our cave dreaming of freedom that for a moment we thought this must just be another vivid dream. Our eyes and minds were overwhelmed by the bright sunshine, which almost blinded us after being stuck in the darkness of our prison for so long, making us feel dizzy with a mix of conflicting emotions. But as we followed the footsteps of our dark-skinned friend, saw the bright leaves of the trees, heard the calls of the parrots, and smelled the rich fragrance of the flowering bushes, the truth that we were truly free from prison and from death washed over our minds with intense power. With tears in our eyes, we all shouted a loud cheer of joy together.

It was replied to by a shout from a number of the natives who chanced to be near. Running towards us, they shook us by the hand with every demonstration of kindly feeling. They then fell behind, and, forming a sort of procession, conducted us to the dwelling of Tararo.

It was answered with a shout from several locals who happened to be nearby. Running up to us, they greeted us warmly, shaking our hands with signs of friendliness. Then they fell back, forming a kind of procession, and led us to Tararo's house.

The scene that met our eyes here was one that I shall never forget. On a rude bench in front of his house sat the chief. A native stood on his left hand, who, from his dress, seemed to be a teacher. On his right stood an English gentleman, who, I at once and rightly concluded, was a missionary. He was tall, thin, and apparently past forty, with a bald forehead, and thin gray hair. The expression of his countenance was the most winning I ever saw, and his clear gray eye beamed with a look that was frank, fearless, loving, and truthful. In front of the chief was an open space, in the centre of which lay a pile of wooden idols, ready to be set on fire; and around these were assembled thousands of natives, who had come to join in or to witness the unusual sight. A bright smile overspread the missionary’s face as he advanced quickly to meet us, and he shook us warmly by the hands.

The scene that faced us was one I'll never forget. Sitting on a rough bench in front of his house was the chief. A native, dressed like a teacher, stood on his left, while an English gentleman, whom I quickly realized was a missionary, stood on his right. He was tall and thin, apparently over forty, with a bald forehead and thin gray hair. His expression was the most welcoming I've ever seen, and his clear gray eyes radiated a frank, fearless, loving, and honest look. In front of the chief was an open area with a pile of wooden idols in the center, set to be burned, surrounded by thousands of natives who had gathered to participate in or watch this unusual event. A bright smile spread across the missionary's face as he quickly approached us, shaking our hands warmly.

“I am overjoyed to meet you, my dear young friends,” he said. “My friend, and your friend, the teacher, has told me your history; and I thank our Father in heaven, with all my heart, that he has guided me to this island, and made me the instrument of saving you.”

“I’m so happy to meet you, my dear young friends,” he said. “My friend, and your friend, the teacher, has shared your story with me; and I thank our Father in heaven, with all my heart, for guiding me to this island and making me the one who can save you.”

We thanked the missionary most heartily, and asked him in some surprise how he had succeeded in turning the heart of Tararo in our favour.

We thanked the missionary sincerely and asked him, somewhat surprised, how he managed to win Tararo's heart over to our side.

“I will tell you that at a more convenient time,” he answered, “meanwhile we must not forget the respect due to the chief. He waits to receive you.”

“I’ll let you know at a better time,” he replied, “but in the meantime, we shouldn’t forget to show respect to the chief. He’s waiting to see you.”

In the conversation that immediately followed between us and Tararo, the latter said that the light of the gospel of Jesus Christ had been sent to the island, and that to it we were indebted for our freedom. Moreover, he told us that we were at liberty to depart in our schooner whenever we pleased, and that we should be supplied with as much provision as we required. He concluded by shaking hands with us warmly, and performing the ceremony of rubbing noses.

In the conversation that immediately followed between us and Tararo, he said that the light of the gospel of Jesus Christ had come to the island and that we owed our freedom to it. He also told us that we were free to leave in our schooner whenever we wanted and that we would be supplied with as much food as we needed. He finished by warmly shaking hands with us and performing the tradition of rubbing noses.

This was indeed good news to us, and we could hardly find words to express our gratitude to the chief and to the missionary.

This was really great news for us, and we could barely find the words to show our thanks to the chief and the missionary.

“And what of Avatea?” inquired Jack.

“And what about Avatea?” Jack asked.

The missionary replied by pointing to a group of natives in the midst of whom the girl stood. Beside her was a tall, strapping fellow, whose noble mien and air of superiority bespoke him a chief of no ordinary kind.

The missionary responded by pointing to a group of natives among whom the girl was standing. Next to her was a tall, strong man, whose dignified presence and confident demeanor indicated that he was an extraordinary chief.

“That youth is her lover. He came this very morning in his war-canoe to treat with Tararo for Avatea. He is to be married in a few days, and afterwards returns to his island home with his bride!”

“That young man is her lover. He arrived this morning in his war canoe to negotiate with Tararo for Avatea. He is set to get married in a few days, and afterward, he’ll be going back to his island home with his bride!”

“That’s capital,” said Jack, as he stepped up to the savage and gave him a hearty shake of the hand. “I wish you joy, my lad;—and you too, Avatea.”

“That's great,” said Jack, as he approached the savage and gave him a firm handshake. “Congratulations, my friend;—and you too, Avatea.”

As Jack spoke, Avatea’s lover took him by the hand and led him to the spot where Tararo and the missionary stood, surrounded by most of the chief men of the tribe. The girl herself followed, and stood on his left hand while her lover stood on his right, and, commanding silence, made the following speech, which was translated by the missionary:—

As Jack spoke, Avatea’s boyfriend took him by the hand and led him to where Tararo and the missionary stood, surrounded by most of the tribe's chief men. The girl herself followed and stood on his left while her boyfriend stood on his right, and, asking for silence, made the following speech, which the missionary translated:—

“Young friend, you have seen few years, but your head is old. Your heart also is large and very brave. I and Avatea are your debtors, and we wish, in the midst of this assembly, to acknowledge our debt, and to say that it is one which we can never repay. You have risked your life for one who was known to you only for a few days. But she was a woman in distress, and that was enough to secure to her the aid of a Christian man. We, who live in these islands of the sea, know that the true Christians always act thus. Their religion is one of love and kindness. We thank God that so many Christians have been sent here—we hope many more will come. Remember that I and Avatea will think of you and pray for you and your brave comrades when you are far away.”

“Young friend, you may be young, but you have an old soul. Your heart is big and full of courage. Avatea and I owe you a great debt, and we want to acknowledge that debt here in front of everyone; it’s something we can never fully repay. You risked your life for someone you only knew for a few days. But she was in trouble, and that was enough to inspire a Christian man to help her. We, who live on these islands, know that true Christians always act this way. Their faith is based on love and kindness. We thank God for the many Christians who have come here—we hope even more will arrive. Just know that Avatea and I will think of you and pray for you and your brave friends when you are far away.”

To this kind speech Jack returned a short sailor-like reply, in which he insisted that he had only done for Avatea what he would have done for any woman under the sun. But Jack’s forte did not lie in speech-making, so he terminated rather abruptly by seizing the chief’s hand and shaking it violently, after which he made a hasty retreat.

To this kind comment, Jack gave a brief, sailor-like response, insisting that he had only done for Avatea what he would have done for any woman anywhere. However, Jack wasn't great at giving speeches, so he ended rather suddenly by grabbing the chief's hand and shaking it hard, after which he quickly left.

“Now, then, Ralph and Peterkin,” said Jack, as we mingled with the crowd, “it seems to me that the object we came here for having been satisfactorily accomplished, we have nothing more to do but get ready for sea as fast as we can, and hurrah for dear old England!”

“Alright, Ralph and Peterkin,” said Jack, as we blended in with the crowd, “it looks like we’ve successfully completed the goal we came here for, so all that’s left to do is get ready for sea as quickly as possible, and cheers for dear old England!”

“That’s my idea precisely,” said Peterkin, endeavouring to wink, but he had wept so much of late, poor fellow, that he found it difficult; “however, I’m not going away till I see these fellows burn their gods.”

“That’s exactly my idea,” said Peterkin, trying to wink, but he had cried so much recently, poor guy, that he found it hard to do; “anyway, I’m not leaving until I see these guys burn their gods.”

Peterkin had his wish, for, in a few minutes afterwards, fire was put to the pile, the roaring flames ascended, and, amid the acclamations of the assembled thousands, the false gods of Mango were reduced to ashes!

Peterkin got his wish, because just a few minutes later, they were set fire to the pile, the flames roared up, and, amidst the cheers of the gathered thousands, the false gods of Mango turned to ashes!

CHAPTER XXXV.

Conclusion.

Conclusion.

To part is the lot of all mankind. The world is a scene of constant leave-taking, and the hands that grasp in cordial greeting to-day, are doomed ere long to unite for the last time, when the quivering lips pronounce the word—“Farewell.” It is a sad thought, but should we on that account exclude it from our minds? May not a lesson worth learning be gathered in the contemplation of it? May it not, perchance, teach us to devote our thoughts more frequently and attentively to that land where we meet, but part no more?

To say goodbye is part of being human. The world is a place of constant farewells, and the hands that shake warmly today will soon join for the last time when the trembling lips say, “Farewell.” It’s a bittersweet thought, but should we push it out of our minds? Could we learn something valuable by thinking about it? Might it remind us to focus more often and deeply on the place where we meet again, but never part?

How many do we part from in this world with a light “Good-bye,” whom we never see again! Often do I think, in my meditations on this subject, that if we realized more fully the shortness of the fleeting intercourse that we have in this world with many of our fellow-men, we would try more earnestly to do them good, to give them a friendly smile, as it were, in passing (for the longest intercourse on earth is little more than a passing word and glance), and show that we have sympathy with them in the short quick struggle of life, by our kindly words and looks and action.

How many people do we say a light “Good-bye” to in this world, never to see them again! I often think, while reflecting on this, that if we truly understood how brief our interactions with many of our fellow humans are, we would genuinely strive to do good for them, to offer a friendly smile as we pass by (because even the longest interactions on earth are just passing words and glances), and show that we relate to them in life's short and swift struggles through our kind words, looks, and actions.

The time soon drew near when we were to quit the islands of the South Seas; and, strange though it may appear, we felt deep regret at parting with the natives of the island of Mango; for, after they embraced the Christian faith, they sought, by showing us the utmost kindness, to compensate for the harsh treatment we had experienced at their hands; and we felt a growing affection for the native teachers and the missionary, and especially for Avatea and her husband.

The time was approaching when we would leave the islands of the South Seas, and, oddly enough, we felt a deep sadness about saying goodbye to the locals of Mango Island. After they adopted the Christian faith, they tried to make up for the harsh treatment we had received from them by treating us with incredible kindness. We developed a growing fondness for the native teachers and the missionary, particularly for Avatea and her husband.

Before leaving, we had many long and interesting conversations with the missionary, in one of which he told us that he had been making for the island of Raratonga when his native-built sloop was blown out of its course, during a violent gale, and driven to this island. At first the natives refused to listen to what he had to say; but, after a week’s residence among them, Tararo came to him and said that he wished to become a Christian, and would burn his idols. He proved himself to be sincere, for, as we have seen, he persuaded all his people to do likewise. I use the word persuaded advisedly; for, like all the other Feejee chiefs, Tararo was a despot and might have commanded obedience to his wishes; but he entered so readily into the spirit of the new faith that he perceived at once the impropriety of using constraint in the propagation of it. He set the example, therefore; and that example was followed by almost every man of the tribe.

Before leaving, we had many long and interesting conversations with the missionary, during one of which he told us he had been heading to the island of Raratonga when a severe storm blew his native-built sloop off course and brought him to this island. At first, the locals wouldn’t listen to him, but after staying among them for a week, Tararo approached him and expressed his desire to become a Christian and to burn his idols. He proved to be genuine, as we’ve seen, by encouraging all his people to do the same. I use the word “encouraging” intentionally; like all the other chiefs in Fiji, Tararo had the authority to demand obedience to his wishes, but he embraced the new faith so fully that he recognized the inappropriateness of using force to spread it. He led by example, and almost every man in the tribe followed his lead.

During the short time that we remained at the island, repairing our vessel and getting her ready for sea, the natives had commenced building a large and commodious church, under the superintendence of the missionary, and several rows of new cottages were marked out; so that the place bid fair to become, in a few months, as prosperous and beautiful as the Christian village at the other end of the island.

During the brief time we stayed on the island, fixing our ship and preparing her for departure, the locals began constructing a large and spacious church, overseen by the missionary, and several rows of new cottages were laid out; so it seemed that the area was on track to become, in a few months, just as thriving and attractive as the Christian village at the other end of the island.

After Avatea was married, she and her husband were sent away, loaded with presents, chiefly of an edible nature. One of the native teachers went with them, for the purpose of visiting still more distant islands of the sea, and spreading, if possible, the light of the glorious gospel there.

After Avatea got married, she and her husband were sent off, filled with gifts, mostly food. One of the local teachers accompanied them, with the intention of visiting even more distant islands and spreading, if possible, the message of the glorious gospel there.

As the missionary intended to remain for several weeks longer, in order to encourage and confirm his new converts, Jack and Peterkin and I held a consultation in the cabin of our schooner,—which we found just as we had left her, for everything that had been taken out of her was restored. We now resolved to delay our departure no longer. The desire to see our beloved native land was strong upon us, and we could not wait.

As the missionary planned to stay for a few more weeks to support his new converts, Jack, Peterkin, and I had a meeting in the cabin of our schooner—which we found just as we had left it, since everything that had been taken out was returned. We decided we couldn’t put off our departure any longer. The longing to see our beloved homeland was intense, and we couldn't wait.

Three natives volunteered to go with us to Tahiti, where we thought it likely that we should be able to procure a sufficient crew of sailors to man our vessel; so we accepted their offer gladly.

Three locals volunteered to join us on our trip to Tahiti, where we believed we could find enough sailors to crew our ship; so we happily accepted their offer.

It was a bright clear morning when we hoisted the snow-white sails of the pirate schooner and left the shores of Mango. The missionary, and thousands of the natives, came down to bid us God-speed, and to see us sail away. As the vessel bent before a light fair wind, we glided quickly over the lagoon under a cloud of canvass.

It was a bright, clear morning when we raised the snow-white sails of the pirate schooner and left the shores of Mango. The missionary, along with thousands of the locals, came down to wish us well and see us set sail. As the ship leaned into a gentle breeze, we glided swiftly across the lagoon beneath a cloud of canvas.

Just as we passed through the channel in the reef the natives gave us a loud cheer; and as the missionary waved his hat, while he stood on a coral rock with his gray hairs floating in the wind, we heard the single word “Farewell” borne faintly over the sea.

Just as we made our way through the channel in the reef, the locals cheered us loudly; and as the missionary waved his hat while standing on a coral rock with his gray hair blowing in the wind, we heard the single word “Farewell” faintly carried over the sea.

That night, as we sat on the taffrail, gazing out upon the wide sea and up into the starry firmament, a thrill of joy, strangely mixed with sadness, passed through our hearts,—for we were at length “homeward bound,” and were gradually leaving far behind us the beautiful, bright, green, coral islands of the Pacific Ocean.

That night, as we sat on the railing, looking out at the vast sea and up at the starry sky, a mix of joy and sadness swept over us—because we were finally “homeward bound,” slowly leaving behind the beautiful, bright, green coral islands of the Pacific Ocean.


Download ePUB

If you like this ebook, consider a donation!